Freescale MCZ33905BS5EK-R2 Sbc gen2 with can high speed and lin interface Datasheet

MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire®
Microcontroller User’s Manual
Devices Supported:
MCF5214
MCF5216
MCF5280
MCF5281
MCF5282
Document Number: MCF5282UM
Rev. 3
2/2009
How to Reach Us:
Home Page:
www.freescale.com
Web Support:
http://www.freescale.com/support
USA/Europe or Locations Not Listed:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Technical Information Center, EL516
2100 East Elliot Road
Tempe, Arizona 85284
1-800-521-6274 or +1-480-768-2130
www.freescale.com/support
Europe, Middle East, and Africa:
Freescale Halbleiter Deutschland GmbH
Technical Information Center
Schatzbogen 7
81829 Muenchen, Germany
+44 1296 380 456 (English)
+46 8 52200080 (English)
+49 89 92103 559 (German)
+33 1 69 35 48 48 (French)
www.freescale.com/support
Japan:
Freescale Semiconductor Japan Ltd. Headquarters
ARCO Tower 15F
1-8-1, Shimo-Meguro, Meguro-ku,
Tokyo 153-0064
Japan
0120 191014 or +81 3 5437 9125
[email protected]
Asia/Pacific:
Freescale Semiconductor China Ltd.
Exchange Building 23F
No. 118 Jianguo Road
Chaoyang District
Beijing 100022
China
+86 10 5879 8000
[email protected]
Freescale Semiconductor Literature Distribution Center
P.O. Box 5405
Denver, Colorado 80217
1-800-441-2447 or +1-303-675-2140
Fax: +1-303-675-2150
[email protected]
Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and
software implementers to use Freescale Semiconductor products. There are
no express or implied copyright licenses granted hereunder to design or
fabricate any integrated circuits or integrated circuits based on the
information in this document.
Freescale Semiconductor reserves the right to make changes without further
notice to any products herein. Freescale Semiconductor makes no warranty,
representation or guarantee regarding the suitability of its products for any
particular purpose, nor does Freescale Semiconductor assume any liability
arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically
disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or
incidental damages. “Typical” parameters that may be provided in Freescale
Semiconductor data sheets and/or specifications can and do vary in different
applications and actual performance may vary over time. All operating
parameters, including “Typicals”, must be validated for each customer
application by customer’s technical experts. Freescale Semiconductor does
not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others.
Freescale Semiconductor products are not designed, intended, or authorized
for use as components in systems intended for surgical implant into the body,
or other applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other
application in which the failure of the Freescale Semiconductor product could
create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer
purchase or use Freescale Semiconductor products for any such unintended
or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Freescale
Semiconductor and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and
distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and
reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of
personal injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized
use, even if such claim alleges that Freescale Semiconductor was negligent
regarding the design or manufacture of the part.
Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale
Semiconductor, Inc. All other product or service names are the property of their
respective owners.
© Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 2009. All rights reserved.
MCF5282UM
Rev. 3
2/2009
Overview
ColdFire Core
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
Cache
Static RAM (SRAM)
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Power Management
System Control Module (SCM)
Clock Module
Interrupt Controller Modules
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Chip Select Module
External Interface Module (EIM)
Signal Descriptions
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
DMA Controller Module
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Watchdog Timer Module
Programmable Interrupt Timer (PIT) Modules
General Purpose Timer (GPT) Modules
DMA Timers
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface Module (QSPI)
UART Modules
I2C Module
FlexCAN Module
General Purpose I/O Module
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Reset Controller Module
Debug Support
IEEE 1149.1 Test Access Port (JTAG)
Mechanical Data
Electrical Characteristics
Memory Map
Revision History
Index
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
A
B
IND
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
A
B
IND
Overview
ColdFire Core
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
Cache
Static RAM (SRAM)
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Power Management
System Control Module (SCM)
Clock Module
Interrupt Controller Modules
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Chip Select Module
External Interface Module (EIM)
Signal Descriptions
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
DMA Controller Module
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Watchdog Timer Module
Programmable Interrupt Timer (PIT) Modules
General Purpose Timer (GPT) Modules
DMA Timers
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface Module (QSPI)
UART Modules
I2C Module
FlexCAN Module
General Purpose I/O Module
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Reset Controller Module
Debug Support
IEEE 1149.1 Test Access Port (JTAG)
Mechanical Data
Electrical Characteristics
Memory Map
Revision History
Index
Chapter 1
Overview
1.1
1.2
Key Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.1.1 Version 2 ColdFire Core . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
1.1.1.1 Cache . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
1.1.1.2 SRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
1.1.1.3 Flash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
1.1.1.4 Debug Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
1.1.2 System Control Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
1.1.3 External Interface Module (EIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
1.1.4 Chip Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
1.1.5 Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
1.1.6 General Input/Output Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
1.1.7 Interrupt Controllers (INTC0/INTC1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
1.1.8 SDRAM Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
1.1.9 Test Access Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
1.1.10 UART Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
1.1.11 DMA Timers (DTIM0-DTIM3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
1.1.12 General-Purpose Timers (GPTA/GPTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
1.1.13 Periodic Interrupt Timers (PIT0-PIT3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
1.1.14 Software Watchdog Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
1.1.15 Phase Locked Loop (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
1.1.16 DMA Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
1.1.17 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
MCF5282-Specific Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
1.2.1 Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
1.2.2 FlexCAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
1.2.3 I2C Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
1.2.4 Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
1.2.5 Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Chapter 2
ColdFire Core
2.1
2.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Map/Register Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.1 Data Registers (D0–D7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.2 Address Registers (A0–A6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.3 Supervisor/User Stack Pointers (A7 and OTHER_A7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.4 Condition Code Register (CCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.5 Program Counter (PC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.6 Cache Control Register (CACR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.7 Access Control Registers (ACRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2.8 Vector Base Register (VBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-1
2-1
2-2
2-4
2-4
2-5
2-6
2-7
2-7
2-7
2-7
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
v
2.3
2.2.9 Status Register (SR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
2.2.10 Memory Base Address Registers (RAMBAR, FLASHBAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
2.3.1 Version 2 ColdFire Microarchitecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
2.3.2 Instruction Set Architecture (ISA_A+) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
2.3.3 Exception Processing Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
2.3.3.1 Exception Stack Frame Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
2.3.4 Processor Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
2.3.4.1 Access Error Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
2.3.4.2 Address Error Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
2.3.4.3 Illegal Instruction Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
2.3.4.4 Divide-By-Zero . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20
2.3.4.5 Privilege Violation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20
2.3.4.6 Trace Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20
2.3.4.7 Unimplemented Line-A Opcode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
2.3.4.8 Unimplemented Line-F Opcode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
2.3.4.9 Debug Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
2.3.4.10 RTE and Format Error Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
2.3.4.11 TRAP Instruction Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
2.3.4.12 Unsupported Instruction Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
2.3.4.13 Interrupt Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
2.3.4.14 Fault-on-Fault Halt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
2.3.4.15 Reset Exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
2.3.5 Instruction Execution Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
2.3.5.1 Timing Assumptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.3.5.2 MOVE Instruction Execution Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.3.5.3 Standard One Operand Instruction Execution Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
2.3.5.4 Standard Two Operand Instruction Execution Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
2.3.5.5 Miscellaneous Instruction Execution Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
2.3.5.6 EMAC Instruction Execution Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31
2.3.5.7 Branch Instruction Execution Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32
Chapter 3
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
3.1
3.2
3.3
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3.1.1.1 Introduction to the MAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
3.2.1 MAC Status Register (MACSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
3.2.2 Mask Register (MASK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
3.2.3 Accumulator Registers (ACC0–3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
3.2.4 Accumulator Extension Registers (ACCext01, ACCext23) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
3.3.1 Fractional Operation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
3.3.1.1 Rounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
vi
Freescale Semiconductor
3.3.2
3.3.3
3.3.4
3.3.5
3.3.1.2 Saving and Restoring the EMAC Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.3.1.3 MULS/MULU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.3.1.4 Scale Factor in MAC or MSAC Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Instruction Execution Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Data Representation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
MAC Opcodes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-11
3-12
3-12
3-12
3-13
3-14
3-14
Chapter 4
Cache
4.1
4.2
4.3
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.1.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.1 Cache Control Register (CACR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.2 Access Control Registers (ACR0, ACR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.1 Interaction with Other Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.2 Memory Reference Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.3 Cache Coherency and Invalidation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.4 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.5 Cache Miss Fetch Algorithm/Line Fills . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-1
4-1
4-1
4-2
4-3
4-6
4-7
4-7
4-8
4-8
4-8
4-9
Chapter 5
Static RAM (SRAM)
5.1
5.2
5.3
SRAM Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SRAM Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SRAM Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5.3.1 SRAM Base Address Register (RAMBAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5.3.2 SRAM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5.3.3 SRAM Initialization Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5.3.4 Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-1
5-1
5-1
5-1
5-3
5-3
5-4
Chapter 6
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.1
6.2
6.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.1 CFM Configuration Field . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.2 Flash Base Address Register (FLASHBAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.3 CFM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.1 CFM Configuration Register (CFMCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.2 CFM Clock Divider Register (CFMCLKD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-1
6-2
6-4
6-5
6-5
6-7
6-8
6-8
6-9
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
vii
6.4
6.5
6.6
6.7
6.3.4.3 CFM Security Register (CFMSEC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.4 CFM Protection Register (CFMPROT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.5 CFM Supervisor Access Register (CFMSACC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.6 CFM Data Access Register (CFMDACC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.7 CFM User Status Register (CFMUSTAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.4.8 CFM Command Register (CFMCMD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CFM Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.1 Read Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.2 Write Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.3 Program and Erase Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.3.1 Setting the CFMCLKD Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.3.2 Program, Erase, and Verify Sequences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.3.3 Flash Valid Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.3.4 Flash User Mode Illegal Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.4 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.5 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Security Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5.1 Back Door Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.5.2 Erase Verify Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-10
6-12
6-13
6-14
6-15
6-16
6-16
6-17
6-17
6-17
6-17
6-18
6-19
6-21
6-21
6-22
6-22
6-23
6-23
6-23
6-23
Chapter 7
Power Management
7.1
7.2
7.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.1 Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.2 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.3 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.3.1 Low-Power Interrupt Control Register (LPICR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.3.2 Low-Power Control Register (LPCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.1 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.1.1 Run Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.1.2 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.1.3 Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.1.4 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.1.5 Peripheral Shut Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2 Peripheral Behavior in Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.1 ColdFire Core . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.2 Static Random-Access Memory (SRAM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.3 Flash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.4 System Control Module (SCM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.5 SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.3.2.6 Chip Select Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-1
7-1
7-1
7-2
7-2
7-2
7-4
7-5
7-5
7-5
7-6
7-6
7-6
7-6
7-6
7-6
7-6
7-7
7-7
7-7
7-7
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
viii
Freescale Semiconductor
7.3.2.7 DMA Controller (DMAC0–DMA3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
7.3.2.8 UART Modules (UART0, UART1, and UART2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
7.3.2.9 I2C Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
7.3.2.10 Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
7.3.2.11 DMA Timers (DMAT0–DMAT3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
7.3.2.12 Interrupt Controllers (INTC0, INTC1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.3.2.13 Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.3.2.14 I/O Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.3.2.15 Reset Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.3.2.16 Chip Configuration Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
7.3.2.17 Clock Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
7.3.2.18 Edge Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
7.3.2.19 Watchdog Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
7.3.2.20 Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0, PIT1, PIT2 and PIT3) . . . . . 7-10
7.3.2.21 Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
7.3.2.22 General Purpose Timers (GPTA and GPTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
7.3.2.23 FlexCAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
7.3.2.24 ColdFire Flash Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
7.3.2.25 BDM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
7.3.2.26 JTAG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
7.3.3 Summary of Peripheral State During Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
Chapter 8
System Control Module (SCM)
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.6
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
8.4.1 Internal Peripheral System Base Address Register (IPSBAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
8.4.2 Memory Base Address Register (RAMBAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
8.4.3 Core Reset Status Register (CRSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
8.4.4 Core Watchdog Control Register (CWCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
8.4.5 Core Watchdog Service Register (CWSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Internal Bus Arbitration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
8.5.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
8.5.2 Arbitration Algorithms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
8.5.2.1 Round-Robin Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
8.5.2.2 Fixed Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
8.5.3 Bus Master Park Register (MPARK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
System Access Control Unit (SACU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11
8.6.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11
8.6.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12
8.6.3 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12
8.6.3.1 Master Privilege Register (MPR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13
8.6.3.2 Peripheral Access Control Registers (PACR0–PACR8) . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
ix
8.6.3.3 Grouped Peripheral Access Control Registers
(GPACR0 & GPACR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15
Chapter 9
Clock Module
9.1
9.2
9.3
9.4
9.5
9.6
9.7
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
9.2.1 Normal PLL Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
9.2.2 1:1 PLL Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
9.2.3 External Clock Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
Low-power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
9.5.1 EXTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
9.5.2 XTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
9.5.3 CLKOUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
9.5.4 CLKMOD[1:0] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
9.5.5 RSTOUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
9.6.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
9.6.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
9.6.2.1 Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
9.6.2.2 Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
9.7.1 System Clock Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
9.7.2 Clock Operation During Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11
9.7.3 System Clock Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11
9.7.4 PLL Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11
9.7.4.1 Phase and Frequency Detector (PFD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12
9.7.4.2 Charge Pump/Loop Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
9.7.4.3 Voltage Control Output (VCO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
9.7.4.4 Multiplication Factor Divider (MFD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
9.7.4.5 PLL Lock Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
9.7.4.6 PLL Loss of Lock Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14
9.7.4.7 PLL Loss of Lock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15
9.7.4.8 Loss of Clock Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15
9.7.4.9 Loss of Clock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15
9.7.4.10 Alternate Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15
9.7.4.11 Loss of Clock in Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16
Chapter 10
Interrupt Controller Modules
10.1 68K/ColdFire Interrupt Architecture Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1
10.1.1 Interrupt Controller Theory of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
x
Freescale Semiconductor
10.2
10.3
10.4
10.5
10.1.1.1 Interrupt Recognition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
10.1.1.2 Interrupt Prioritization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
10.1.1.3 Interrupt Vector Determination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
10.3.1 Interrupt Pending Registers (IPRHn, IPRLn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
10.3.2 Interrupt Mask Register (IMRHn, IMRLn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7
10.3.3 Interrupt Force Registers (INTFRCHn, INTFRCLn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
10.3.4 Interrupt Request Level Register (IRLRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11
10.3.5 Interrupt Acknowledge Level and Priority Register (IACKLPRn) . . . . . . . . . 10-11
10.3.6 Interrupt Control Register (ICRnx, (x = 1, 2,..., 63)) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
10.3.6.1 Interrupt Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-13
10.3.7 Software and Level n IACK Registers (SWIACKR, L1IACK–L7IACK) . . . . . 10-16
Prioritization Between Interrupt Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
Low-Power Wakeup Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
Chapter 11
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
11.1
11.2
11.3
11.4
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Low-Power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Interrupt/General-Purpose I/O Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.4.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.4.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.4.2.1 EPORT Pin Assignment Register (EPPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.4.2.2 EPORT Data Direction Register (EPDDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.4.2.3 Edge Port Interrupt Enable Register (EPIER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.4.2.4 Edge Port Data Register (EPDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.4.2.5 Edge Port Pin Data Register (EPPDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11.4.2.6 Edge Port Flag Register (EPFR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11-1
11-1
11-2
11-3
11-3
11-3
11-3
11-4
11-5
11-5
11-6
11-6
Chapter 12
Chip Select Module
12.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.2 Chip Select Module Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3 Chip Select Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.1 General Chip Select Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.1.1 8-, 16-, and 32-Bit Port Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.3.1.2 External Boot Chip Select Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4 Chip Select Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.1 Chip Select Module Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.1.1 Chip Select Address Registers (CSAR0–CSAR6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.1.2 Chip Select Mask Registers (CSMR0–CSMR6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12.4.1.3 Chip Select Control Registers (CSCR0–CSCR6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
12-1
12-1
12-3
12-3
12-3
12-4
12-4
12-6
12-6
12-6
12-7
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xi
Chapter 13
External Interface Module (EIM)
13.1
13.2
13.3
13.4
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-1
Bus and Control Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-1
Bus Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2
Data Transfer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2
13.4.1 Bus Cycle Execution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3
13.4.2 Data Transfer Cycle States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-4
13.4.3 Read Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
13.4.4 Write Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7
13.4.5 Fast Termination Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-8
13.4.6 Back-to-Back Bus Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
13.4.7 Burst Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
13.4.7.1 Line Transfers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
13.4.7.2 Line Read Bus Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
13.4.7.3 Line Write Bus Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-12
13.5 Misaligned Operands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-14
Chapter 14
Signal Descriptions
14.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1
14.1.1 Single-Chip Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-17
14.1.2 External Boot Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-18
14.2 External Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-18
14.2.1 External Interface Module (EIM) Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-18
14.2.1.1 Address Bus (A[23:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-19
14.2.1.2 Data Bus (D[31:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-19
14.2.1.3 Byte Strobes (BS[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-19
14.2.1.4 Output Enable (OE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-19
14.2.1.5 Transfer Acknowledge (TA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-19
14.2.1.6 Transfer Error Acknowledge (TEA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-20
14.2.1.7 Read/Write (R/W) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-20
14.2.1.8 Transfer Size(SIZ[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-20
14.2.1.9 Transfer Start (TS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-20
14.2.1.10 Transfer In Progress (TIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-21
14.2.1.11 Chip Selects (CS[6:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-21
14.2.2 SDRAM Controller Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-21
14.2.2.1 SDRAM Row Address Strobe (SRAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-21
14.2.2.2 SDRAM Column Address Strobe (SCAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-21
14.2.2.3 SDRAM Write Enable (DRAMW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-21
14.2.2.4 SDRAM Bank Selects (SDRAM_CS[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-21
14.2.2.5 SDRAM Clock Enable (SCKE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-22
14.2.3 Clock and Reset Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-22
14.2.3.1 Reset In (RSTI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-22
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xii
Freescale Semiconductor
14.2.3.2 Reset Out (RSTO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.3 EXTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.4 XTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.3.5 Clock Output (CLKOUT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4 Chip Configuration Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.1 RCON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.4.2 CLKMOD[1:0] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.5 External Interrupt Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.5.1 External Interrupts (IRQ[7:1]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6 Ethernet Module Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.1 Management Data (EMDIO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.2 Management Data Clock (EMDC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.3 Transmit Clock (ETXCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.4 Transmit Enable (ETXEN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.5 Transmit Data 0 (ETXD0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.6 Collision (ECOL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.7 Receive Clock (ERXCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.8 Receive Data Valid (ERXDV) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.9 Receive Data 0 (ERXD0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.10 Carrier Receive Sense (ECRS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.11 Transmit Data 1–3 (ETXD[3:1]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.12 Transmit Error (ETXER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.13 Receive Data 1–3 (ERXD[3:1]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.6.14 Receive Error (ERXER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.7 Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI) Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.7.1 QSPI Synchronous Serial Output (QSPI_DOUT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.7.2 QSPI Synchronous Serial Data Input (QSPI_DIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.7.3 QSPI Serial Clock (QSPI_CLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.7.4 QSPI Chip Selects (QSPI_CS[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.8 FlexCAN Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.8.1 FlexCAN Transmit (CANTX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.8.2 FlexCAN Receive (CANRX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.9 I2C Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.9.1 Serial Clock (SCL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.9.2 Serial Data (SDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.10UART Module Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.10.1 Transmit Serial Data Output (UTXD[2:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.10.2 Receive Serial Data Input (URXD[2:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.10.3 Clear-to-Send (UCTS[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.10.4 Request-to-Send (URTS[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.11General Purpose Timer Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.11.1 GPTA[3:0] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.11.2 GPTB[3:0] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.11.3 External Clock Input (SYNCA/SYNCB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.12DMA Timer Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14-22
14-22
14-22
14-22
14-22
14-22
14-22
14-23
14-23
14-23
14-23
14-23
14-23
14-23
14-23
14-24
14-24
14-24
14-24
14-24
14-24
14-24
14-24
14-25
14-25
14-25
14-25
14-25
14-25
14-25
14-25
14-25
14-26
14-26
14-26
14-26
14-26
14-26
14-26
14-27
14-27
14-27
14-27
14-27
14-27
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xiii
14.2.12.1 DMA Timer 0 Input (DTIN0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.12.2 DMA Timer 0 Output (DTOUT0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.12.3 DMA Timer 1 Input (DTIN1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.12.4 DMA Timer 1 Output (DTOUT1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.12.5 DMA Timer 2 Input (DTIN2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.12.6 DMA Timer 2 Output (DTOUT2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.12.7 DMA Timer 3 Input (DTIN3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.12.8 DMA Timer 3 Output (DTOUT3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13Analog-to-Digital Converter Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13.1 QADC Analog Input (AN0/ANW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13.2 QADC Analog Input (AN1/ANX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13.3 QADC Analog Input (AN2/ANY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13.4 QADC Analog Input (AN3/ANZ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13.5 QADC Analog Input (AN52/MA0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13.6 QADC Analog Input (AN53/MA1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13.7 QADC Analog Input (AN55/TRIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.13.8 QADC Analog Input (AN56/TRIG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.14Debug Support Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.14.1 JTAG_EN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.14.2 Development Serial Clock/Test Reset (DSCLK/TRST) . . . . . . . .
14.2.14.3 Breakpoint/Test Mode Select (BKPT/TMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.14.4 Development Serial Input/Test Data (DSI/TDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.14.5 Development Serial Output/Test Data (DSO/TDO) . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.14.6 Test Clock (TCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.14.7 Debug Data (DDATA[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.14.8 Processor Status Outputs (PST[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.15Test Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.15.1 Test (TEST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16Power and Reference Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.1 QADC Analog Reference (VRH, VRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.2 QADC Analog Supply (VDDA, VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.3 PLL Analog Supply (VDDPLL, VSSPLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.4 QADC Positive Supply (VDDH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.5 Power for Flash Erase/Program (VPP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.6 Power and Ground for Flash Array (VDDF, VSSF) . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.7 Standby Power (VSTBY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.8 Positive Supply (VDD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14.2.16.9 Ground (VSS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
14-27
14-27
14-27
14-28
14-28
14-28
14-28
14-28
14-28
14-28
14-28
14-29
14-29
14-29
14-29
14-29
14-29
14-29
14-29
14-30
14-30
14-30
14-30
14-30
14-31
14-31
14-31
14-31
14-32
14-32
14-32
14-32
14-32
14-32
14-32
14-32
14-32
14-32
Chapter 15
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.1.1 Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.1.2 Block Diagram and Major Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15.2 SDRAM Controller Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15-1
15-1
15-1
15-3
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xiv
Freescale Semiconductor
15.2.1 DRAM Controller Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-4
15.2.2 Memory Map for SDRAMC Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-4
15.2.2.1 DRAM Control Register (DCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-4
15.2.2.2 DRAM Address and Control Registers (DACR0/DACR1) . . . . . . . . 15-6
15.2.2.3 DRAM Controller Mask Registers (DMR0/DMR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-8
15.2.3 General Synchronous Operation Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-9
15.2.3.1 Address Multiplexing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-9
15.2.3.2 SDRAM Byte Strobe Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-13
15.2.3.3 Interfacing Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-13
15.2.3.4 Burst Page Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-13
15.2.3.5 Auto-Refresh Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-15
15.2.3.6 Self-Refresh Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-16
15.2.4 Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-17
15.2.4.1 Mode Register Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-18
15.3 SDRAM Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-18
15.3.1 SDRAM Interface Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-20
15.3.2 DCR Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-20
15.3.3 DACR Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-20
15.3.4 DMR Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-22
15.3.5 Mode Register Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-23
15.3.6 Initialization Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-23
Chapter 16
DMA Controller Module
16.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-1
16.1.1 DMA Module Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-2
16.2 DMA Request Control (DMAREQC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-2
16.3 DMA Transfer Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-4
16.4 DMA Controller Module Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-4
16.4.1 Source Address Registers (SAR0–SAR3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-5
16.4.2 Destination Address Registers (DAR0–DAR3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-6
16.4.3 Byte Count Registers (BCR0–BCR3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-7
16.4.4 DMA Control Registers (DCR0–DCR3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-7
16.4.5 DMA Status Registers (DSR0–DSR3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-10
16.5 DMA Controller Module Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-11
16.5.1 Transfer Requests (Cycle-Steal and Continuous Modes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-11
16.5.2 Data Transfer Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-12
16.5.2.1 Dual-Address Transfers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-12
16.5.3 Channel Initialization and Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-12
16.5.3.1 Channel Prioritization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-12
16.5.3.2 Programming the DMA Controller Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-12
16.5.4 Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-13
16.5.4.1 Auto-Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-13
16.5.4.2 Bandwidth Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-14
16.5.5 Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-14
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xv
Chapter 17
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-1
17.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-1
17.1.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-1
17.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-3
17.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
17.2.1 Full and Half Duplex Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
17.2.2 Interface Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
17.2.2.1 10 Mbps and 100 Mbps MII Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
17.2.2.2 10 Mpbs 7-Wire Interface Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
17.2.3 Address Recognition Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
17.2.4 Internal Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-4
17.3 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-5
17.4 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-5
17.4.1 MIB Block Counters Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-7
17.4.2 Ethernet Interrupt Event Register (EIR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-9
17.4.3 Interrupt Mask Register (EIMR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-10
17.4.4 Receive Descriptor Active Register (RDAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-11
17.4.5 Transmit Descriptor Active Register (TDAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-12
17.4.6 Ethernet Control Register (ECR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-12
17.4.7 MII Management Frame Register (MMFR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-13
17.4.8 MII Speed Control Register (MSCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-15
17.4.9 MIB Control Register (MIBC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-16
17.4.10Receive Control Register (RCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-16
17.4.11Transmit Control Register (TCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-17
17.4.12Physical Address Lower Register (PALR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-18
17.4.13Physical Address Upper Register (PAUR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-19
17.4.14Opcode/Pause Duration Register (OPD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-19
17.4.15Descriptor Individual Upper Address Register (IAUR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-20
17.4.16Descriptor Individual Lower Address Register (IALR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-20
17.4.17Descriptor Group Upper Address Register (GAUR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-21
17.4.18Descriptor Group Lower Address Register (GALR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-21
17.4.19Transmit FIFO Watermark Register (TFWR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-22
17.4.20FIFO Receive Bound Register (FRBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-22
17.4.21FIFO Receive Start Register (FRSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-23
17.4.22Receive Descriptor Ring Start Register (ERDSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-23
17.4.23Transmit Buffer Descriptor Ring Start Registers (ETSDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-24
17.4.24Receive Buffer Size Register (EMRBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-24
17.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-25
17.5.1 Buffer Descriptors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-25
17.5.1.1 Driver/DMA Operation with Buffer Descriptors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-25
17.5.1.2 Ethernet Receive Buffer Descriptor (RxBD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-27
17.5.1.3 Ethernet Transmit Buffer Descriptor (TxBD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-29
17.5.2 Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-30
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xvi
Freescale Semiconductor
17.5.2.1 Hardware Controlled Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.3 User Initialization (Prior to Setting ECR[ETHER_EN]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.4 Microcontroller Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.5 User Initialization (After Setting ECR[ETHER_EN]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.6 Network Interface Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.7 FEC Frame Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.7.1 Duplicate Frame Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.8 FEC Frame Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.9 Ethernet Address Recognition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.10Hash Algorithm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.11Full Duplex Flow Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.12Inter-Packet Gap (IPG) Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.13Collision Managing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.14MII Internal and External Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.15Ethernet Error-Managing Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.15.1 Transmission Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17.5.15.2 Reception Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17-30
17-31
17-32
17-32
17-32
17-33
17-34
17-35
17-35
17-38
17-41
17-42
17-42
17-42
17-42
17-43
17-43
Chapter 18
Watchdog Timer Module
18.1
18.2
18.3
18.4
18.5
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Low-Power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.2.1 Watchdog Control Register (WCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.2.2 Watchdog Modulus Register (WMR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.2.3 Watchdog Count Register (WCNTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18.5.2.4 Watchdog Service Register (WSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18-1
18-1
18-2
18-2
18-2
18-2
18-3
18-3
18-4
18-5
18-5
Chapter 19
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
19.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.1.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.1.3 Low-Power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.2 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.2.1 PIT Control and Status Register (PCSRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.2.2 PIT Modulus Register (PMRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.2.3 PIT Count Register (PCNTRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19.3.1 Set-and-Forget Timer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
19-1
19-1
19-1
19-1
19-2
19-3
19-5
19-5
19-6
19-6
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xvii
19.3.2 Free-Running Timer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-6
19.3.3 Timeout Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-7
19.3.4 Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-7
Chapter 20
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.1
20.2
20.3
20.4
20.5
20.6
20.7
20.8
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-1
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-2
Low-Power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-3
Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-3
20.4.1 GPTn[2:0] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-3
20.4.2 GPTn3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-3
20.4.3 SYNCn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-4
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-4
20.5.1 GPT Input Capture/Output Compare Select Register (GPTIOS) . . . . . . . . . . 20-5
20.5.2 GPT Compare Force Register (GPCFORC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-6
20.5.3 GPT Output Compare 3 Mask Register (GPTOC3M) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-6
20.5.4 GPT Output Compare 3 Data Register (GPTOC3D) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-7
20.5.5 GPT Counter Register (GPTCNT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-7
20.5.6 GPT System Control Register 1 (GPTSCR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-8
20.5.7 GPT Toggle-On-Overflow Register (GPTTOV) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-9
20.5.8 GPT Control Register 1 (GPTCTL1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-9
20.5.9 GPT Control Register 2 (GPTCTL2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-10
20.5.10GPT Interrupt Enable Register (GPTIE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-10
20.5.11GPT System Control Register 2 (GPTSCR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-11
20.5.12GPT Flag Register 1 (GPTFLG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-12
20.5.13GPT Flag Register 2 (GPTFLG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-12
20.5.14GPT Channel Registers (GPTCn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-13
20.5.15Pulse Accumulator Control Register (GPTPACTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-14
20.5.16Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (GPTPAFLG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-15
20.5.17Pulse Accumulator Counter Register (GPTPACNT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-16
20.5.18GPT Port Data Register (GPTPORT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-16
20.5.19GPT Port Data Direction Register (GPTDDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-17
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-17
20.6.1 Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-17
20.6.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-17
20.6.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-18
20.6.4 Pulse Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-18
20.6.5 Event Counter Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-18
20.6.6 Gated Time Accumulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-19
20.6.7 General-Purpose I/O Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-19
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21
20.8.1 GPT Channel Interrupts (CnF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21
20.8.2 Pulse Accumulator Overflow (PAOVF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xviii
Freescale Semiconductor
20.8.3 Pulse Accumulator Input (PAIF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22
20.8.4 Timer Overflow (TOF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22
Chapter 21
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
21.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-1
21.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-1
21.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-2
21.2 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-3
21.2.1 DMA Timer Mode Registers (DTMRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-3
21.2.2 DMA Timer Extended Mode Registers (DTXMRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-5
21.2.3 DMA Timer Event Registers (DTERn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-5
21.2.4 DMA Timer Reference Registers (DTRRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-7
21.2.5 DMA Timer Capture Registers (DTCRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-7
21.2.6 DMA Timer Counters (DTCNn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-8
21.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-8
21.3.1 Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-8
21.3.2 Capture Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-8
21.3.3 Reference Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-8
21.3.4 Output Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-9
21.4 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-9
21.4.1 Code Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-9
21.4.2 Calculating Time-Out Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-10
Chapter 22
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
22.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-1
22.1.1 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-1
22.1.2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-2
22.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-2
22.1.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-2
22.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-2
22.3 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-3
22.3.1 QSPI Mode Register (QMR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-3
22.3.2 QSPI Delay Register (QDLYR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-5
22.3.3 QSPI Wrap Register (QWR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-6
22.3.4 QSPI Interrupt Register (QIR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-6
22.3.5 QSPI Address Register (QAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-7
22.3.6 QSPI Data Register (QDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-8
22.3.7 Command RAM Registers (QCR0–QCR15) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-8
22.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-9
22.4.1 QSPI RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-11
22.4.1.1 Receive RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-11
22.4.1.2 Transmit RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-12
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xix
22.4.1.3 Command RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.4.2 Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.4.3 Transfer Delays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.4.4 Transfer Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.4.5 Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22.5 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
22-12
22-12
22-13
22-14
22-14
22-15
Chapter 23
UART Modules
23.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-1
23.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-1
23.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-2
23.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-3
23.3 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-3
23.3.1 UART Mode Registers 1 (UMR1n) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-5
23.3.2 UART Mode Register 2 (UMR2n) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-6
23.3.3 UART Status Registers (USRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-8
23.3.4 UART Clock Select Registers (UCSRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-9
23.3.5 UART Command Registers (UCRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-9
23.3.6 UART Receive Buffers (URBn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-11
23.3.7 UART Transmit Buffers (UTBn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-12
23.3.8 UART Input Port Change Registers (UIPCRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-12
23.3.9 UART Auxiliary Control Register (UACRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-13
23.3.10UART Interrupt Status/Mask Registers (UISRn/UIMRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-13
23.3.11UART Baud Rate Generator Registers (UBG1n/UBG2n) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-15
23.3.12UART Input Port Register (UIPn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-15
23.3.13UART Output Port Command Registers (UOP1n/UOP0n) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-16
23.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-16
23.4.1 Transmitter/Receiver Clock Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-16
23.4.1.1 Programmable Divider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-17
23.4.1.2 Calculating Baud Rates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-17
23.4.2 Transmitter and Receiver Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-18
23.4.2.1 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-18
23.4.2.2 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-20
23.4.2.3 FIFO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-21
23.4.3 Looping Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-22
23.4.3.1 Automatic Echo Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-23
23.4.3.2 Local Loopback Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-23
23.4.3.3 Remote Loopback Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-23
23.4.4 Multidrop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-24
23.4.5 Bus Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-26
23.4.5.1 Read Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-26
23.4.5.2 Write Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-26
23.5 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-26
23.5.1 Interrupt and DMA Request Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-26
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xx
Freescale Semiconductor
23.5.1.1 Setting up the UART to Generate Core Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-26
23.5.1.2 Setting up the UART to Request DMA Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-27
23.5.2 UART Module Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-29
Chapter 24
I C Interface
2
24.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-1
24.1.1 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-1
24.1.2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-2
24.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-2
24.2 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-3
24.2.1 I2C Address Register (I2ADR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-3
24.2.2 I2C Frequency Divider Register (I2FDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-3
24.2.3 I2C Control Register (I2CR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-4
24.2.4 I2C Status Register (I2SR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-5
24.2.5 I2C Data I/O Register (I2DR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-6
24.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-7
24.3.1 START Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-7
24.3.2 Slave Address Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-8
24.3.3 Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-8
24.3.4 Acknowledge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-9
24.3.5 STOP Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-9
24.3.6 Repeated START . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-9
24.3.7 Clock Synchronization and Arbitration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-11
24.3.8 Handshaking and Clock Stretching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-12
24.4 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-12
24.4.1 Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-12
24.4.2 Generation of START . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-12
24.4.3 Post-Transfer Software Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-13
24.4.4 Generation of STOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-13
24.4.5 Generation of Repeated START . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-14
24.4.6 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-14
24.4.7 Arbitration Lost . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-14
Chapter 25
FlexCAN
25.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
25.1.1 FlexCAN Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
25.1.2 External Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
25.2 The CAN System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
25.3 Message Buffers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
25.3.1 Message Buffer Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
25.3.1.1 Common Fields for Extended and Standard Format Frames . . . . . .
25.3.1.2 Fields for Extended Format Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
25-1
25-2
25-3
25-4
25-4
25-4
25-5
25-7
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xxi
25.3.1.3 Fields for Standard Format Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-7
25.3.2 Message Buffer Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-7
25.4 Functional Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-8
25.4.1 Transmit Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-8
25.4.2 Receive Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-9
25.4.2.1 Self-Received Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-10
25.4.3 Message Buffer Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-10
25.4.3.1 Serial Message Buffers (SMBs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-10
25.4.3.2 Transmit Message Buffer Deactivation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-10
25.4.3.3 Receive Message Buffer Deactivation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-10
25.4.3.4 Locking and Releasing Message Buffers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-11
25.4.4 Remote Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-11
25.4.5 Overload Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-12
25.4.6 Time Stamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-12
25.4.7 Listen-Only Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-12
25.4.8 Bit Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-12
25.4.8.1 Configuring the FlexCAN Bit Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-13
25.4.9 FlexCAN Error Counters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-13
25.4.10FlexCAN Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-14
25.4.11Special Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-15
25.4.11.1 Debug Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-15
25.4.11.2 Low-Power Stop Mode for Power Saving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-15
25.4.11.3 Auto-Power Save Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-17
25.4.12Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-17
25.5 Programmer’s Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-17
25.5.1 CAN Module Configuration Register (CANMCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-18
25.5.2 FlexCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTRL0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-20
25.5.3 FlexCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTRL1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-21
25.5.4 Prescaler Divide Register (PRESDIV) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-22
25.5.5 FlexCAN Control Register 2 (CANCTRL2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-22
25.5.6 Free Running Timer (TIMER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-23
25.5.7 Rx Mask Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-23
25.5.7.1 Receive Mask Registers (RXGMASK, RX14MASK, RX15MASK) . 25-24
25.5.8 FlexCAN Error and Status Register (ESTAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-25
25.5.9 Interrupt Mask Register (IMASK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-27
25.5.10Interrupt Flag Register (IFLAG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-28
25.5.11FlexCAN Receive Error Counter (RXECTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-29
25.5.12FlexCAN Transmit Error Counter (TXECTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-30
Chapter 26
General Purpose I/O Module
26.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
26.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
26.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
26.1.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
26-1
26-4
26-4
26-4
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xxii
Freescale Semiconductor
26.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-4
26.3 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-7
26.3.1 Register Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-7
26.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-10
26.3.2.1 Port Output Data Registers (PORTn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-10
26.3.2.2 Port Data Direction Registers (DDRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-11
26.3.2.3 Port Pin Data/Set Data Registers (PORTnP/SETn) . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-13
26.3.2.4 Port Clear Output Data Registers (CLRn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-14
26.3.2.5 Port B/C/D Pin Assignment Register (PBCDPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-16
26.3.2.6 Port E Pin Assignment Register (PEPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-17
26.3.2.7 Port F Pin Assignment Register (PFPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-19
26.3.2.8 Port J Pin Assignment Register (PJPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-20
26.3.2.9 Port SD Pin Assignment Register (PSDPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-21
26.3.2.10 Port AS Pin Assignment Register (PASPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-21
26.3.2.11 Port EH/EL Pin Assignment Register (PEHLPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-22
26.3.2.12 Port QS Pin Assignment Register (PQSPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-23
26.3.2.13 Port TC Pin Assignment Register (PTCPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-24
26.3.2.14 Port TD Pin Assignment Register (PTDPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-25
26.3.2.15 Port UA Pin Assignment Register (PUAPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-26
26.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-27
26.4.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-27
26.4.2 Port Digital I/O Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-27
26.5 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26-28
Chapter 27
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
27.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.2.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.2.2 Single-Chip Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.4 Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.4.1 RCON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.4.2 CLKMOD[1:0] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.4.3 D[26:24, 21, 19:16] (Reset Configuration Override) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.5 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.5.1 Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.5.2 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.5.3 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.5.3.1 Chip Configuration Register (CCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.5.3.2 Reset Configuration Register (RCON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.5.3.3 Chip Identification Register (CIR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.6 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.6.1 Reset Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27.6.2 Chip Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27-1
27-1
27-1
27-1
27-2
27-2
27-2
27-2
27-3
27-3
27-3
27-3
27-4
27-4
27-5
27-6
27-6
27-7
27-8
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xxiii
27.6.3 Boot Device Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-9
27.6.4 Output Pad Strength Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-9
27.6.5 Clock Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-9
27.6.6 Chip Select Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-10
27.7 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-10
27.8 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-10
Chapter 28
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
28.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-1
28.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-2
28.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-2
28.3.1 Debug Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-2
28.3.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-3
28.4 Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-3
28.4.1 Port QA Signal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-3
28.4.1.1 Port QA Analog Input Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-4
28.4.1.2 Port QA Digital Input/Output Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-4
28.4.2 Port QB Signal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-4
28.4.2.1 Port QB Analog Input Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-4
28.4.2.2 Port QB Digital I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-5
28.4.3 External Trigger Input Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-5
28.4.4 Multiplexed Address Output Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-5
28.4.5 Multiplexed Analog Input Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-5
28.4.6 Voltage Reference Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-6
28.4.7 Dedicated Analog Supply Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-6
28.4.8 Dedicated Digital I/O Port Supply Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-6
28.5 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-6
28.6 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-7
28.6.1 QADC Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-7
28.6.2 QADC Test Register (QADCTEST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-8
28.6.3 Port Data Registers (PORTQA & PORTQB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-8
28.6.4 Port QA and QB Data Direction Register (DDRQA & DDRQB) . . . . . . . . . . . 28-9
28.6.5 Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-10
28.6.5.1 QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-10
28.6.5.2 QADC Control Register 1 (QACR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-12
28.6.5.3 QADC Control Register 2 (QACR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-14
28.6.6 Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-17
28.6.6.1 QADC Status Register 0 (QASR0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-17
28.6.6.2 QADC Status Register 1 (QASR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-23
28.6.7 Conversion Command Word Table (CCW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-24
28.6.8 Result Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-27
28.6.8.1 Right-Justified Unsigned Result Register (RJURR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-27
28.6.8.2 Left-Justified Signed Result Register (LJSRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-27
28.6.8.3 Left-Justified Unsigned Result Register (LJURR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28-28
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xxiv
Freescale Semiconductor
28.7 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.1 Result Coherency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.2 External Multiplexing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.2.1 External Multiplexing Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.2.2 Module Version Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3 Analog Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3.1 Analog-to-Digital Converter Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3.2 Conversion Cycle Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3.3 Channel Decode and Multiplexer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3.4 Sample Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3.5 Comparator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3.6 Bias . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3.7 Successive Approximation Register (SAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.7.3.8 State Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8 Digital Control Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.1 Queue Priority Timing Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.1.1 Queue Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.1.2 Queue Priority Schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.2 Boundary Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.3 Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.4 Disabled Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.5 Reserved Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.6 Single-Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.6.1 Software-Initiated Single-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.6.2 Externally Triggered Single-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.6.3 Externally Gated Single-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.6.4 Interval Timer Single-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.7 Continuous-Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.7.1 Software-Initiated Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.7.2 Externally Triggered Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.7.3 Externally Gated Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.7.4 Periodic Timer Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.8 QADC Clock (QCLK) Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.9 Periodic/Interval Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.10Conversion Command Word Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.8.11Result Word Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9 Signal Connection Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9.1 Analog Reference Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9.2 Analog Power Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9.3 Conversion Timing Schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9.4 Analog Supply Filtering and Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9.5 Accommodating Positive/Negative Stress Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9.6 Analog Input Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9.7 Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.9.7.1 Settling Time for the External Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28-28
28-28
28-29
28-29
28-31
28-31
28-31
28-32
28-33
28-33
28-33
28-34
28-34
28-34
28-34
28-34
28-34
28-36
28-45
28-46
28-47
28-47
28-47
28-48
28-48
28-48
28-49
28-49
28-50
28-50
28-51
28-51
28-52
28-52
28-53
28-55
28-56
28-56
28-56
28-58
28-61
28-62
28-64
28-66
28-67
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xxv
28.9.7.2 Error Resulting from Leakage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.10Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.10.1Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28.10.2Interrupt Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28-67
28-68
28-68
28-68
Chapter 29
Reset Controller Module
29.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-1
29.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-1
29.3 Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-2
29.3.1 RSTI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-2
29.3.2 RSTO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-2
29.4 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-2
29.4.1 Reset Control Register (RCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-3
29.4.2 Reset Status Register (RSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-4
29.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-5
29.5.1 Reset Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-5
29.5.1.1 Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29.5.1.2 External Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29.5.1.3 Watchdog Timer Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29.5.1.4 Loss-of-Clock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29.5.1.5 Loss-of-Lock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29.5.1.6 Software Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29.5.1.7 LVD Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29.5.2 Reset Control Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-7
29.5.2.1 Synchronous Reset Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-9
29.5.2.2 Internal Reset Request . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-9
29.5.2.3 Power-On Reset/Low-Voltage Detect Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-9
29.5.3 Concurrent Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-9
29.5.3.1 Reset Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-9
29.5.3.2 Reset Status Flags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-10
Chapter 30
Debug Support
30.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-1
30.2 Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-2
30.3 Real-Time Trace Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-2
30.3.1 Begin Execution of Taken Branch (PST = 0x5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-4
30.4 Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-5
30.4.1 Revision A Shared Debug Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-7
30.4.2 Address Attribute Trigger Register (AATR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-7
30.4.3 Address Breakpoint Registers (ABLR, ABHR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-9
30.4.4 Configuration/Status Register (CSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-10
30.4.5 Data Breakpoint/Mask Registers (DBR, DBMR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-12
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xxvi
Freescale Semiconductor
30.5
30.6
30.7
30.8
30.4.6 Program Counter Breakpoint/Mask Registers (PBR, PBMR) . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.4.7 Trigger Definition Register (TDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Background Debug Mode (BDM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.5.1 CPU Halt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.5.2 BDM Serial Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.5.2.1 Receive Packet Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.5.2.2 Transmit Packet Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.5.3 BDM Command Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.5.3.1 ColdFire BDM Command Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.5.3.2 Command Sequence Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.5.3.3 Command Set Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Debug Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.6.1 Theory of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.6.1.1 Emulator Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.6.2 Concurrent BDM and Processor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Processor Status, DDATA Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.7.1 User Instruction Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30.7.2 Supervisor Instruction Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Freescale-Recommended BDM Pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30-13
30-14
30-16
30-16
30-18
30-18
30-19
30-19
30-20
30-21
30-22
30-37
30-37
30-38
30-38
30-39
30-39
30-43
30-45
Chapter 31
IEEE 1149.1 Test Access Port (JTAG)
31.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.3 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.3.1 Detailed Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.3.1.1 JTAG_EN — JTAG Enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.3.1.2 TCLK — Test Clock Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.3.1.3 TMS/BKPT — Test Mode Select / Breakpoint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.3.1.4 TDI/DSI — Test Data Input / Development Serial Input . . . . . . . . . .
31.3.1.5 TRST/DSCLK — Test Reset / Development Serial Clock . . . . . . . .
31.3.1.6 TDO/DSO — Test Data Output / Development Serial Output . . . . .
31.4 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.4.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.4.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.4.2.1 Instruction Shift Register (IR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.4.2.2 IDCODE Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.4.2.3 Bypass Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.4.2.4 JTAG_CFM_CLKDIV Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.4.2.5 TEST_CTRL Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.4.2.6 Boundary Scan Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.1 JTAG Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.2 TAP Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3 JTAG Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31-2
31-2
31-2
31-2
31-2
31-3
31-3
31-3
31-3
31-4
31-4
31-4
31-4
31-4
31-4
31-5
31-5
31-5
31-5
31-5
31-5
31-6
31-6
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xxvii
31.5.3.1 External Test Instruction (EXTEST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3.2 IDCODE Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3.3 SAMPLE/PRELOAD Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3.4 TEST_LEAKAGE Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3.5 ENABLE_TEST_CTRL Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3.6 HIGHZ Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3.7 LOCKOUT_RECOVERY Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3.8 CLAMP Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.5.3.9 BYPASS Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.6 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.6.1 Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31.6.2 Nonscan Chain Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31-7
31-7
31-7
31-8
31-8
31-8
31-8
31-9
31-9
31-9
31-9
31-9
Chapter 32
Mechanical Data
32.1 Pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32-1
32.2 Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32-9
Chapter 33
Electrical Characteristics
33.1 Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-1
33.2 Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-2
33.3 DC Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-3
33.4 Power Consumption Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-4
33.5 Phase Lock Loop Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-7
33.6 QADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-8
33.7 Flash Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-10
33.8 External Interface Timing Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-11
33.9 Processor Bus Output Timing Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-12
33.10General Purpose I/O Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-18
33.11Reset and Configuration Override Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-19
33.12I2C Input/Output Timing Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-20
33.13Fast Ethernet AC Timing Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-21
33.13.1MII Receive Signal Timing (ERXD[3:0], ERXDV, ERXER, and ERXCLK) . . 33-21
33.13.2MII Transmit Signal Timing (ETXD[3:0], ETXEN, ETXER, ETXCLK) . . . . . 33-22
33.13.3MII Async Inputs Signal Timing (ECRS and ECOL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-23
33.13.4MII Serial Management Channel Timing (EMDIO and EMDC) . . . . . . . . . . 33-23
33.14DMA Timer Module AC Timing Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-24
33.15QSPI Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-24
33.16JTAG and Boundary Scan Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-25
33.17Debug AC Timing Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-27
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xxviii
Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A
Register Memory Map
Appendix B
Revision History
B.1
B.2
B.3
B.4
B.5
B.6
B.7
Changes Between Rev. 0 and Rev. 0.1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1
Changes Between Rev. 0.1 and Rev. 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-2
Changes Between Rev. 1 and Rev. 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
Changes Between Rev. 2 and Rev. 2.1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7
Changes Between Rev. 2.1 and Rev. 2.2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7
Changes Between Rev. 2.2 and Rev. 2.3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7
Changes Between Rev. 2.3 and Rev. 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-8
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xxix
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xxx
Freescale Semiconductor
About This Book
The primary objective of this user’s manual is to define the functionality of the MCF5282 processor for
use by software and hardware developers.
The information in this book, except for changes to the flash and Ethernet functionality, also applies to the
MCF5280, MCF5281, MCF5216, and MCF5214.
The information in this book is subject to change without notice, as described in the disclaimers on the title
page. As with any technical documentation, it is the reader’s responsibility to be sure he is using the most
recent version of the documentation.
To locate any published errata or updates for this document, refer to the world-wide web at
http://www.freescale.com/coldfire.
Audience
This manual is intended for system software and hardware developers and applications programmers who
want to develop products with the MCF5282. It is assumed that the reader understands operating systems,
microprocessor system design, basic principles of software and hardware, and basic details of the
ColdFire® architecture.
Suggested Reading
This section lists additional reading that provides background for the information in this manual as well as
general information about the ColdFire architecture.
General Information
The following documentation provides useful information about the ColdFire architecture and computer
architecture in general:
• ColdFire Programmers Reference Manual, R1.0 (MCF5200PRM/AD)
• Using Microprocessors and Microcomputers: The Motorola Family, William C. Wray, Ross
Bannatyne, Joseph D. Greenfield
• Computer Architecture: A Quantitative Approach, Second Edition, by John L. Hennessy and David
A. Patterson.
• Computer Organization and Design: The Hardware/Software Interface, Second Edition, David A
. Patterson and John L. Hennessy.
ColdFire Documentation
ColdFire documentation is available from the sources listed on the back cover of this manual, as well as
our web site, http://www.freescale.com/coldfire.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
xxxi
•
•
•
•
User’s manuals — These books provide details about individual ColdFire implementations and are
intended to be used in conjunction with the ColdFire Programmers Reference Manual.
Data sheets — Data sheets provide specific data regarding pin-out diagrams, bus timing, signal
behavior, and AC, DC, and thermal characteristics, as well as other design considerations.
Product briefs — Each device has a product brief that provides an overview of its features. This
document is roughly equivalent to the overview (Chapter 1) of an device’s reference manual.
Application notes — These short documents address specific design issues useful to programmers
and engineers working with Freescale Semiconductor processors.
Additional literature is published as new processors become available. For a current list of ColdFire
documentation, refer to http://www.freescale.com/coldfire.
Conventions
This document uses the following notational conventions:
MNEMONICS
In text, instruction mnemonics are shown in uppercase.
mnemonics
In code and tables, instruction mnemonics are shown in lowercase.
italics
Italics indicate variable command parameters.
Book titles in text are set in italics.
0x0
Prefix to denote hexadecimal number
0b0
Prefix to denote binary number
REG[FIELD]
Abbreviations for registers are shown in uppercase. Specific bits, fields, or ranges
appear in brackets. For example, RAMBAR[BA] identifies the base address field
in the RAM base address register.
nibble
A 4-bit data unit
byte
An 8-bit data unit
word
A 16-bit data unit1
longword
A 32-bit data unit
x
In some contexts, such as signal encodings, x indicates a don’t care.
n
Used to express an undefined numerical value
~
NOT logical operator
&
AND logical operator
|
OR logical operator
1The
only exceptions to this appear in the discussion of serial communication modules that support variable-length data
transmission units. To simplify the discussion these units are referred to as words regardless of length.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
xxxii
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 1
Overview
This chapter provides an overview of the microprocessor features, including the major functional
components.
1.1
Key Features
A block diagram of the MCF528x and MCF521x is shown in Figure 1-1. The main features are as follows:
• Static Version 2 ColdFire variable-length RISC processor
— Static operation
— On-chip 32-bit address and data path
— Processor core and bus frequency up to 80 MHz
— Sixteen general-purpose 32-bit data and address registers
— ColdFire ISA_A with extensions to support the user stack pointer register, and four new
instructions for improved bit processing
— Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate (EMAC) unit with four 48-bit accumulators to support 32-bit
signal processing algorithms
— Illegal instruction decode that allows for 68K emulation support
• System debug support
— Real-time trace for determining dynamic execution path
— Background debug mode (BDM) for in-circuit debugging
— Real time debug support, with one user-visible hardware breakpoint register (PC and address
with optional data) that can be configured into a 1- or 2-level trigger
• On-chip memories
— 2-Kbyte cache, configurable as instruction-only, data-only, or split I-/D-cache
— 64-Kbyte dual-ported SRAM on CPU internal bus, accessible by core and non-core bus masters
(e.g., DMA, FEC) with standby power supply support
— 512 Kbytes of interleaved Flash memory supporting 2-1-1-1 accesses
(256 Kbytes on the MCF5281 and MCF5214, no Flash on MCF5280)
– This product incorporates SuperFlash® technology licensed from SST.
• Power management
— Fully-static operation with processor sleep and whole chip stop modes
— Very rapid response to interrupts from the low-power sleep mode (wake-up feature)
— Clock enable/disable for each peripheral when not used
• Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC) (not available on the MCF5214 and MCF5216)
— 10BaseT capability, half- or full-duplex
— 100BaseT capability, half- or limited-throughput full-duplex
— On-chip transmit and receive FIFOs
— Built-in dedicated DMA controller
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
1-1
Overview
•
•
•
— Memory-based flexible descriptor rings
— Media-independent interface (MII) to transceiver (PHY)
FlexCAN 2.0B Module
— Includes all existing features of the Freescale TouCAN module
— Full implementation of the CAN protocol specification version 2.0B
– Standard data and remote frames (up to 109 bits long)
– Extended data and remote frames (up to 127 bits long)
– 0–8 bytes data length
– Programmable bit rate up to 1 Mbit/sec
— Up to 16 message buffers (MBs)
– Configurable as receive (Rx) or transmit (Tx)
– Support standard and extended messages
— Unused message buffer (MB) space can be used as general-purpose RAM space
— Listen-only mode capability
— Content-related addressing
— No read/write semaphores
— Three programmable mask registers
– Global (for MBs 0-13)
– Special for MB14
– Special for MB15
— Programmable transmit-first scheme: lowest ID or lowest buffer number
— “Time stamp” based on 16-bit free-running timer
— Global network time, synchronized by a specific message
— Programmable I/O modes
— Maskable interrupts
Three universal asynchronous/synchronous receiver transmitters (UARTs)
— 16-bit divider for clock generation
— Interrupt control logic
— Maskable interrupts
— DMA support
— Data formats can be 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits with even, odd, or no parity
— Up to 2 stop bits in 1/16 increments
— Error-detection capabilities
— Modem support includes request-to-send (URTS) and clear-to-send (UCTS) lines for two
UARTs
— Transmit and receive FIFO buffers
I2C module
— Interchip bus interface for EEPROMs, LCD controllers, A/D converters, and keypads
— Fully compatible with industry-standard I2C bus
— Master or slave modes support multiple masters
— Automatic interrupt generation with programmable level
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
1-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Overview
•
•
•
•
Queued serial peripheral interface (QSPI)
— Full-duplex, three-wire synchronous transfers
— Up to four chip selects available
— Master mode operation only
— Programmable master bit rates
— Up to 16 pre-programmed transfers
Queued analog-to-digital converter (QADC)
— 8 direct, or up to 18 multiplexed, analog input channels
— 10-bit resolution +/- 2 counts accuracy
— Minimum 7 μS conversion time
— Internal sample and hold
— Programmable input sample time for various source impedances
— Two conversion command queues with a total of 64 entries
— Sub-queues possible using pause mechanism
— Queue complete and pause software interrupts available on both queues
— Queue pointers indicate current location for each queue
— Automated queue modes initiated by:
– External edge trigger and gated trigger
– Periodic/interval timer, within QADC module [Queue 1 and 2]
– Software command
— Single-scan or continuous-scan of queues
— Output data readable in three formats:
– Right-justified unsigned
– Left-justified signed
– Left-justified unsigned
— Unused analog channels can be used as digital I/O
— Low pin-count configuration implemented
Four 32-bit DMA timers
— 15-ns resolution at 80 MHz (66 MHz for MCF5214 and MCF5216)
— Programmable sources for clock input, including an external clock option
— Programmable prescaler
— Input-capture capability with programmable trigger edge on input pin
— Output-compare with programmable mode for the output pin
— Free run and restart modes
— Maskable interrupts on input capture or reference-compare
— DMA trigger capability on input capture or reference-compare
Two 4-channel general purpose timers
— Four 16-bit input capture/output compare channels per timer
— 16-bit architecture
— Programmable prescaler
— Pulse widths variable from microseconds to seconds
— Single 16-bit pulse accumulator
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
1-3
Overview
•
•
•
•
•
•
— Toggle-on-overflow feature for pulse-width modulator (PWM) generation
— One dual-mode pulse accumulation channel per timer
Four periodic interrupt timers (PITs)
— 16-bit counter
— Selectable as free running or count down
Software watchdog timer
— 16-bit counter
— Low-power mode support
Phase locked loop (PLL)
— Crystal or external oscillator reference
— 2- to 10-MHz reference frequency for normal PLL mode
— 33- to 80-MHz (66 MHz for MCF5214/16) oscillator reference frequency for 1:1 mode
— Low-power modes supported
— Separate clock output pin
Two interrupt controllers
— Support for up to 63 interrupt sources per interrupt controller (a total of 126), organized as
follows:
– 56 fully-programmable interrupt sources
– 7 fixed-level interrupt sources
— Seven external interrupt signals
— Unique vector number for each interrupt source
— Ability to mask any individual interrupt source or all interrupt sources (global mask-all)
— Support for hardware and software interrupt acknowledge (IACK) cycles
— Combinatorial path to provide wake-up from low-power modes
DMA controller
— Four fully programmable channels
— Dual-address transfer support with 8-, 16- and 32-bit data capability along with support for
16-byte (4 x 32-bit) burst transfers
— Source/destination address pointers that can increment or remain constant
— 24-bit byte transfer counter per channel
— Auto-alignment transfers supported for efficient block movement
— Bursting and cycle steal support
— Software-programmable connections between the 11 DMA requesters in the UARTs (3), 32-bit
timers (4) plus external logic (4) and the four DMA channels
External bus interface
— Glueless connections to external memory devices (e.g., SRAM, Flash, ROM, etc.)
— SDRAM controller supports 8-, 16-, and 32-bit wide memory devices
— Glueless interface to SRAM devices with or without byte strobe inputs
— Programmable wait state generator
— 32-bit bidirectional data bus
— 24-bit address bus
— Up to seven chip selects available
— Byte/write enables (byte strobes)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
1-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Overview
•
•
•
•
— Ability to boot from internal Flash memory or external memories that are 8, 16, or 32 bits wide
Reset
— Separate reset in and reset out signals
— Seven sources of reset:
– Power-on reset (POR)
– External
– Software
– Watchdog
– Loss of clock
– Loss of lock
– Low-voltage detection (LVD)
— Status flag indication of source of last reset
Chip integration module (CIM)
— System configuration during reset
— Support for single chip, master, and test modes
— Selects one of four clock modes
— Sets boot device and its data port width
— Configures output pad drive strength
— Unique part identification number and part revision number
General purpose I/O interface
— Up to 142 bits of general purpose I/O for MCF5280/1/2
— Up to 134 bits of general purpose I/O for MCF5214/6
— Coherent 32-bit control
— Bit manipulation supported via set/clear functions
— Unused peripheral pins may be used as extra GPIO
JTAG support for system-level board testing
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
1-5
Chip
Configuration
Reset
Controller
Power
Management
Overview
JTAG
Port
External
Interface
Module
Test
Controller
Debug Module
Ports
Module
ColdFire V2 Core
Flash
Module
64K
SRAM
Note:
Not present
on MCF5280
DIV
Interrupt
Controller 1
Internal Bus
Arbiter
System
Control
Module (SCM)
Interrupt
Controller 0
DMA
Controller
2-Kbyte
D-Cache/I-Cache
Chip
Selects
Edgeport
EMAC
DRAM
Controller
UART0
Serial
I/O
Clock Module
(PLL)
UART1
Serial
I/O
UART2
Serial
I/O
DMA
Timer
Modules
(DTIM0–
DTIM3)
I2C
Module
Watchdog
Timer
FEC
Note:
Not present on
MCF5214 and
MCF5216
QADC
General
Purpose
Timer A
General
Purpose
Timer B
QSPI
FlexCAN
PIT
Timers
(PIT0–
PIT3)
Figure 1-1. MCF528x and MCF521x Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
1-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Overview
1.1.1
Version 2 ColdFire Core
The processor core is comprised of two separate pipelines that are decoupled by an instruction buffer. The
two-stage instruction fetch pipeline (IFP) is responsible for instruction-address generation and instruction
fetch. The instruction buffer is a first-in-first-out (FIFO) buffer that holds prefetched instructions awaiting
execution in the operand execution pipeline (OEP). The OEP includes two pipeline stages. The first stage
decodes instructions and selects operands (DSOC); the second stage (AGEX) performs instruction
execution and calculates operand effective addresses, if needed.
The V2 core implements the ColdFire instruction set architecture revision A with added support for a
separate user stack pointer register and four new instructions to assist in bit processing. Additionally, the
MCF5282 core includes the enhanced multiply-accumulate unit (EMAC) for improved signal processing
capabilities. The EMAC implements a 4-stage execution pipeline, optimized for 32 x 32 bit operations,
with support for four 48-bit accumulators. Supported operands include 16- and 32-bit signed and unsigned
integers, signed fractional operands, and a complete set of instructions to process these data types. The
EMAC provides superb support for execution of DSP operations within the context of a single processor
at a minimal hardware cost.
1.1.1.1
Cache
The 2-Kbyte cache can be configured into one of three possible organizations: a 2-Kbyte instruction cache,
a 2-Kbyte data cache or a split 1-Kbyte instruction/1-Kbyte data cache. The configuration is
software-programmable by control bits within the privileged cache configuration register (CACR). In all
configurations, the cache is a direct-mapped single-cycle memory, organized as 128 lines, each containing
16 bytes of data. The memories consist of a 128-entry tag array (containing addresses and control bits) and
a 2-Kbyte data array, organized as 512 x 32 bits. The tag and data arrays are accessed in parallel using the
following address bits:
Table 1-1. Cache Configuration
Configuration
Tag Address
Data Array Address
2 Kbyte I-Cache
[10:4]
[10:2]
2 Kbyte D-Cache
[10:4]
[10:2]
Split I-/D-Cache 0
Instruction Fetches
Operand Accesses
0, [9:4]
1, [9:4]
0, [9:2]
1, [9:2]
If the desired address is mapped into the cache memory, the output of the data array is driven onto the
ColdFire core's local data bus, completing the access in a single cycle. If the data is not mapped into the
tag memory, a cache miss occurs and the processor core initiates a 16-byte line-sized fetch. The cache
module includes a 16-byte line fill buffer used as temporary storage during miss processing. For all data
cache configurations, the memory operates in write-through mode and all operand writes generate an
external bus cycle.
1.1.1.2
SRAM
The SRAM module provides a general-purpose 64-Kbyte memory block that the ColdFire core can access
in a single cycle. The location of the memory block can be set to any 64-Kbyte boundary within the
4-Gbyte address space. The memory is ideal for storing critical code or data structures, for use as the
system stack, or for storing FEC data buffers. Because the SRAM module is physically connected to the
processor's high-speed local bus, it can quickly service core-initiated accesses or memory-referencing
commands from the debug module.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
1-7
Overview
The SRAM module is also accessible by non-core bus masters, for example the DMA and/or the FEC. The
dual-ported nature of the SRAM makes it ideal for implementing applications with double-buffer schemes,
where the processor and a DMA device operate in alternate regions of the SRAM to maximize system
performance. As an example, system performance can be increased significantly if Ethernet packets are
moved from the FEC into the SRAM (rather than external memory) prior to any processing.
1.1.1.3
Flash
This product incorporates SuperFlash® technology licensed from SST. The ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
is a non-volatile memory (NVM) module for integration with the processor core. The CFM is constructed
with eight banks of 32K x 16-bit Flash arrays to generate 512 Kbytes of 32-bit Flash memory
NOTE
The CFM on the MCF5281 and MCF5214 is constructed with four banks of
32K x 16-bit Flash arrays to generate 256 Kbytes of 32-bit Flash memory.
The MCF5280 does not contain a CFM.
These arrays serve as electrically erasable and programmable, non-volatile program and data memory. The
Flash memory is ideal for program and data storage for single-chip applications allowing for field
reprogramming without requiring an external programming voltage source. The CFM interfaces to the
V2 ColdFire core through an optimized read-only memory controller which supports interleaved accesses
from the 2-cycle Flash arrays. A “backdoor” mapping of the Flash memory is used for all program, erase,
and verify operations. It also provides a read datapath for non-core masters (for example, DMA).
1.1.1.4
Debug Module
The ColdFire processor core debug interface is provided to support system debugging in conjunction with
low-cost debug and emulator development tools. Through a standard debug interface, users can access
real-time trace and debug information. This allows the processor and system to be debugged at full speed
without the need for costly in-circuit emulators. The debug interface is a superset of the BDM interface
provided on Freescale’s 683xx family of parts.
The on-chip breakpoint resources include a total of 6 programmable registers—a set of address registers
(with two 32-bit registers), a set of data registers (with a 32-bit data register plus a 32-bit data mask
register), and one 32-bit PC register plus a 32-bit PC mask register. These registers can be accessed through
the dedicated debug serial communication channel or from the processor’s supervisor mode programming
model. The breakpoint registers can be configured to generate triggers by combining the address, data, and
PC conditions in a variety of single or dual-level definitions. The trigger event can be programmed to
generate a processor halt or initiate a debug interrupt exception.
To support program trace, the Version 2 debug module provides processor status (PST[3:0]) and debug
data (DDATA[3:0]) ports. These buses and the CLKOUT output provide execution status, captured
operand data, and branch target addresses defining the dynamic execution path of the processor at the
CPU’s clock rate.
1.1.2
System Control Module
This section details the functionality of the System Control Module (SCM) which provides the
programming model for the System Access Control Unit (SACU), the system bus arbiter, a 32-bit Core
Watchdog Timer (CWT), and the system control registers and logic. Specifically, the system control
includes the internal peripheral system base address register (IPSBAR), the processor’s dual-port RAM
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
1-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Overview
base address register (RAMBAR), and system control registers that include low-power and core watchdog
timer control.
1.1.3
External Interface Module (EIM)
The external interface module handles the transfer of information between the internal core and memory,
peripherals, or other processing elements in the external address space.
Programmable chip-select outputs provide signals to enable external memory and peripheral circuits,
providing all handshaking and timing signals for automatic wait-state insertion and data bus sizing.
Base memory address and block size are programmable, with some restrictions. For example, the starting
address must be on a boundary that is a multiple of the block size. Each chip select can be configured to
provide read and write enable signals suitable for use with most popular static RAMs and peripherals. Data
bus width (8-bit, 16-bit, or 32-bit) is programmable on all chip selects, and further decoding is available
for protection from user mode access or read-only access.
1.1.4
Chip Select
Programmable chip select outputs provide a glueless connection to external memory and peripheral
circuits, providing all handshaking and timing signals for automatic wait-state insertion and data bus
sizing.
1.1.5
Power Management
The MCF5282 incorporates several low-power modes of operation which are entered under program
control and exited by several external trigger events. An integrated Power-On Reset (POR) circuit
monitors the input supply and forces an MCU reset as the supply voltage rises. The Low Voltage Detect
(LVD) section monitors the supply voltage and is configurable to force a reset or interrupt condition if it
falls below the LVD trip point. The RAM standby switch provides power to RAM when the supply voltage
is higher than the standby voltage. If the supply voltage to chip falls below the standby battery voltage, the
RAM is switched over to the standby supply.
1.1.6
General Input/Output Ports
All of the pins associated with the external bus interface may be used for several different functions. Their
primary function is to provide an external memory interface to access off-chip resources. When not used
for this function, all of the pins may be used as general-purpose digital I/O pins. In some cases, the pin
function is set by the operating mode, and the alternate pin functions are not supported.
The digital I/O pins on the MCF5282 are grouped into 8-bit ports. Some ports do not use all eight bits.
Each port has registers that configure, monitor, and control the port pins.
1.1.7
Interrupt Controllers (INTC0/INTC1)
There are two interrupt controllers on the MCF5282, each of which can support up to 63 interrupt sources
for a total of 126. Each interrupt controller is organized as 7 levels with 9 interrupt sources per level. Each
interrupt source has a unique interrupt vector, and 56 of the 63 sources of a given controller provide a
programmable level [1-7] and priority within the level.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
1-9
Overview
1.1.8
SDRAM Controller
The SDRAM controller provides all required signals for glueless interfacing to a variety of
JEDEC-compliant SDRAM devices. SRAS/SCAS address multiplexing is software configurable for
different page sizes. To maintain refresh capability without conflicting with concurrent accesses on the
address and data buses, SRAS, SCAS, DRAMW, SDRAM_CS[1:0], and SCKE are dedicated SDRAM
signals.
1.1.9
Test Access Port
The MCF5282 supports circuit board test strategies based on the Test Technology Committee of IEEE and
the Joint Test Action Group (JTAG). The test logic includes a test access port (TAP) consisting of a 16-state
controller, an instruction register, and three test registers (a 1-bit bypass register, a 256-bit boundary-scan
register, and a 32-bit ID register). The boundary scan register links the device’s pins into one shift register.
Test logic, implemented using static logic design, is independent of the device system logic.
The MCF5282 implementation supports the following:
• Perform boundary-scan operations to test circuit board electrical continuity
• Sample MCF5282 system pins during operation and transparently shift out the result in the
boundary scan register
• Bypass the MCF5282 for a given circuit board test by effectively reducing the boundary-scan
register to a single bit
• Disable the output drive to pins during circuit-board testing
• Drive output pins to stable levels
1.1.10
UART Modules
The MCF5282 contains three full-duplex UARTs that function independently. The three UARTs can be
clocked by the system clock, eliminating the need for an external crystal.
Each UART has the following features:
• Each can be clocked by the system clock, eliminating a need for an external UART clock
• Full-duplex asynchronous/synchronous receiver/transmitter channel
• Quadruple-buffered receiver
• Double-buffered transmitter
• Independently programmable receiver and transmitter clock sources
• Programmable data format:
— 5–8 data bits plus parity
— Odd, even, no parity, or force parity
— One, one-and-a-half, or two stop bits
• Each channel programmable to normal (full-duplex), automatic echo, local loop-back, or remote
loop-back mode
• Automatic wake-up mode for multidrop applications
• Four maskable interrupt conditions
• All three UARTs have DMA request capability
• Parity, framing, and overrun error detection
• False-start bit detection
• Line-break detection and generation
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
1-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Overview
•
•
Detection of breaks originating in the middle of a character
Start/end break interrupt/status
1.1.11
DMA Timers (DTIM0-DTIM3)
There are four independent, DMA-transfer-generating 32-bit timers (DTIM0, DTIM1, DTIM2, DTIM3)
on the MCF5282. Each timer module incorporates a 32-bit timer with a separate register set for
configuration and control. The timers can be configured to operate from the system clock or from an
external clock source using one of the DTINx signals. If the system clock is selected, it can be divided by
16 or 1. The selected clock is further divided by a user-programmable 8-bit prescaler which clocks the
actual timer counter register (TCRn). Each of these timers can be configured for input capture or reference
compare mode. By configuring the internal registers, each timer may be configured to assert an external
signal, generate an interrupt on a particular event, or cause a DMA transfer.
1.1.12
General-Purpose Timers (GPTA/GPTB)
The two general-purpose timers (GPTA and GPTB) are 4-channel timer modules. Each timer consists of a
16-bit programmable counter driven by a 7-stage programmable prescaler. Each of the four channels for
each timer can be configured for input capture or output compare. Additionally, one of the channels,
channel 3, can be configured as a pulse accumulator.
A timer overflow function allows software to extend the timing capability of the system beyond the 16-bit
range of the counter. The input capture and output compare functions allow simultaneous input waveform
measurements and output waveform generation. The input capture function can capture the time of a
selected transition edge. The output compare function can generate output waveforms and timer software
delays. The 16-bit pulse accumulator can operate as a simple event counter or a gated time accumulator.
1.1.13
Periodic Interrupt Timers (PIT0-PIT3)
The four periodic interrupt timers (PIT0, PIT1, PIT2, PIT3) are 16-bit timers that provide precise interrupts
at regular intervals with minimal processor intervention. Each timer can either count down from the value
written in its PIT modulus register, or it can be a free-running down-counter.
1.1.14
Software Watchdog Timer
The watchdog timer is a 16-bit timer that facilitates recovery from runaway code. The watchdog counter
is a free-running down-counter that generates a reset on underflow. To prevent a reset, software must
periodically restart the countdown.
1.1.15
Phase Locked Loop (PLL)
The clock module contains a crystal oscillator (OSC), phase-locked loop (PLL), reduced frequency divider
(RFD), status/control registers, and control logic. To improve noise immunity, the PLL and OSC have their
own power supply inputs, VDDPLL and VSSPLL. All other circuits are powered by the normal supply
pins, VDD and VSS.
1.1.16
DMA Controller
The Direct Memory Access (DMA) controller module provides an efficient way to move blocks of data
with minimal processor interaction. The DMA module provides four channels (DMA0–DMA3) that allow
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
1-11
Overview
byte, word, longword or 16-byte burst line transfers. These transfers are triggered by software, explicitly
setting a DCRn[START] bit or the occurrence of a hardware event from one of the on-chip peripheral
devices, such as a capture event or an output reference event in a DMA timer (DTIMn) for each channel.
The DMA controller supports dual-address mode to on-chip devices.
1.1.17
Reset
The reset controller is provided to determine the cause of reset, assert the appropriate reset signals to the
system, and keep track of what caused the last reset. The power management registers for the internal
low-voltage detect (LVD) circuit are implemented in the reset module. There are seven sources of reset:
• External
• Power-on reset (POR)
• Watchdog timer
• Phase-locked loop (PLL) loss of lock
• PLL loss of clock
• Software
• Low-voltage detection (LVD) reset
External reset on the RSTO pin is software-assertable independent of chip reset state. There are also
software-readable status flags indicating the cause of the last reset, and LVD control and status bits for
setup and use of LVD reset or interrupt.
1.2
1.2.1
MCF5282-Specific Features
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
The MCF5282’s integrated Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC) performs the full set of IEEE 802.3/Ethernet
CSMA/CD media access control and channel interface functions. The FEC supports connection and
functionality for the 10/100 Mbps 802.3 media independent interface (MII). It requires an external
transceiver (PHY) to complete the interface to the media.
NOTE
The MCF5214 and MCF5216 devices do not contain an FEC module.
1.2.2
FlexCAN
The FlexCAN module is a communication controller implementing the CAN protocol. The CAN protocol
can be used as an industrial control serial data bus, meeting the specific requirements of real-time
processing, reliable operation in a harsh EMI environment, cost-effectiveness, and required bandwidth.
FlexCAN contains 16 message buffers.
1.2.3
I2C Bus
The I2C bus is a two-wire, bidirectional serial bus that provides a simple, efficient method of data
exchange, minimizing the interconnection between devices. This bus is suitable for applications requiring
occasional communications over a short distance between many devices.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
1-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Overview
1.2.4
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
The queued serial peripheral interface module provides a synchronous serial peripheral interface with
queued transfer capability. It allows up to 16 transfers to be queued at once, eliminating CPU intervention
between transfers.
1.2.5
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
The QADC is a 10-bit, unipolar, successive approximation converter. A maximum of 8 analog input
channels can be supported using internal multiplexing. A maximum of 18 input channels can be supported
in the internal/external multiplexed mode.
The QADC consists of an analog front-end and a digital control subsystem. The analog section includes
input pins, an analog multiplexer, and sample and hold analog circuits. The analog conversion is performed
by the digital-to-analog converter (DAC) resistor-capacitor array and a high-gain comparator.
The digital control section contains queue control logic to sequence the conversion process and interrupt
generation logic. Also included are the periodic/interval timer, control and status registers, the 64-entry
conversion command word (CCW) table, and the 64-entry result table.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
1-13
Overview
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
1-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 2
ColdFire Core
2.1
Introduction
This section describes the organization of the Version 2 (V2) ColdFire® processor core and an overview
of the program-visible registers. For detailed information on instructions, see the ISA_A+ definition in the
ColdFire Family Programmer’s Reference Manual.
2.1.1
Overview
As with all ColdFire cores, the V2 ColdFire core is comprised of two separate pipelines decoupled by an
instruction buffer.
IAG
Instruction
Address
Generation
IC
Instruction
Fetch Cycle
IB
FIFO
Instruction Buffer
Instruction
Fetch
Pipeline
Address [ 31 :0]
Read Data[31:0]
Operand
Execution
Pipeline
& Select,
DSOC Decode
Operand Fetch
Write Data[31:0]
AGEX
Address
Generation,
Execute
Figure 2-1. V2 ColdFire Core Pipelines
The instruction fetch pipeline (IFP) is a two-stage pipeline for prefetching instructions. The prefetched
instruction stream is then gated into the two-stage operand execution pipeline (OEP), which decodes the
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-1
ColdFire Core
instruction, fetches the required operands and then executes the required function. Because the IFP and
OEP pipelines are decoupled by an instruction buffer serving as a FIFO queue, the IFP is able to prefetch
instructions in advance of their actual use by the OEP thereby minimizing time stalled waiting for
instructions.
The V2 ColdFire core pipeline stages include the following:
• Two-stage instruction fetch pipeline (IFP) (plus optional instruction buffer stage)
— Instruction address generation (IAG) — Calculates the next prefetch address
— Instruction fetch cycle (IC)—Initiates prefetch on the processor’s local bus
— Instruction buffer (IB) — Optional buffer stage minimizes fetch latency effects using FIFO
queue
• Two-stage operand execution pipeline (OEP)
— Decode and select/operand fetch cycle (DSOC)—Decodes instructions and fetches the
required components for effective address calculation, or the operand fetch cycle
— Address generation/execute cycle (AGEX)—Calculates operand address or executes the
instruction
When the instruction buffer is empty, opcodes are loaded directly from the IC cycle into the operand
execution pipeline. If the buffer is not empty, the IFP stores the contents of the fetched instruction in the
IB until it is required by the OEP.
For register-to-register and register-to-memory store operations, the instruction passes through both OEP
stages once. For memory-to-register and read-modify-write memory operations, an instruction is
effectively staged through the OEP twice: the first time to calculate the effective address and initiate the
operand fetch on the processor’s local bus, and the second time to complete the operand reference and
perform the required function defined by the instruction.
The resulting pipeline and local bus structure allow the V2 ColdFire core to deliver sustained high
performance across a variety of demanding embedded applications.
2.2
Memory Map/Register Description
The following sections describe the processor registers in the user and supervisor programming models.
The programming model is selected based on the processor privilege level (user mode or supervisor mode)
as defined by the S bit of the status register (SR). Table 2-1 lists the processor registers.
The user-programming model consists of the following registers:
• 16 general-purpose 32-bit registers (D0–D7, A0–A7)
• 32-bit program counter (PC)
• 8-bit condition code register (CCR)
• EMAC registers (described fully in Chapter 3, “Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC:
— Four 48-bit accumulator registers partitioned as follows:
– Four 32-bit accumulators (ACC0–ACC3)
– Eight 8-bit accumulator extension bytes (two per accumulator). These are grouped into two
32-bit values for load and store operations (ACCEXT01 and ACCEXT23).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-2
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
Accumulators and extension bytes can be loaded, copied, and stored, and results from EMAC
arithmetic operations generally affect the entire 48-bit destination.
— One 16-bit mask register (MASK)
— One 32-bit Status register (MACSR) including four indicator bits signaling product or
accumulation overflow (one for each accumulator: PAV0–PAV3)
The supervisor programming model is to be used only by system control software to implement restricted
operating system functions, I/O control, and memory management. All accesses that affect the control
features of ColdFire processors are in the supervisor programming model, which consists of registers
available in user mode as well as the following control registers:
• 16-bit status register (SR)
• 32-bit supervisor stack pointer (SSP)
• 32-bit vector base register (VBR)
• 32-bit cache control register (CACR)
• 32-bit access control registers (ACR0, ACR1)
•
Two 32-bit memory base address registers (RAMBAR, FLASHBAR)
Table 2-1. ColdFire Core Programming Model
BDM1
Register
Width
Access
(bits)
Reset Value
Written with
Section/Page
MOVEC
Supervisor/User Access Registers
Load: 0x080
Store: 0x180
Data Register 0 (D0)
32
R/W
0xCF20_6080
No
2.2.1/2-4
Load: 0x081
Store: 0x181
Data Register 1 (D1)
32
R/W
0x13B0_1080
No
2.2.1/2-4
Data Register 2–7 (D2–D7)
32
R/W
Undefined
No
2.2.1/2-4
32
R/W
Undefined
No
2.2.2/2-4
Supervisor/User A7 Stack Pointer (A7)
32
R/W
Undefined
No
2.2.3/2-5
0x804
MAC Status Register (MACSR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
No
3.2.1/3-3
0x805
MAC Address Mask Register (MASK)
32
R/W
0xFFFF_FFFF
No
3.2.2/3-5
MAC Accumulators 0–3 (ACC0–3)
32
R/W
Undefined
No
3.2.3/3-6
0x807
MAC Accumulator 0,1 Extension Bytes
(ACCext01)
32
R/W
Undefined
No
3.2.4/3-7
0x808
MAC Accumulator 2,3 Extension Bytes
(ACCext23)
32
R/W
Undefined
No
3.2.4/3-7
0x80E
Condition Code Register (CCR)
8
R/W
Undefined
No
2.2.4/2-6
Load: 0x082–7
Store: 0x182–7
Load: 0x088–8E Address Register 0–6 (A0–A6)
Store: 0x188–8E
Load: 0x08F
Store: 0x18F
0x806, 0x809,
0x80A, 0x80B
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-3
ColdFire Core
Table 2-1. ColdFire Core Programming Model (continued)
BDM1
Width
Access
(bits)
Register
0x80F
Program Counter (PC)
32
R/W
Written with
Section/Page
MOVEC
Reset Value
Contents of
location
0x0000_0004
No
2.2.5/2-7
Supervisor Access Only Registers
0x002
Cache Control Register (CACR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
Yes
2.2.6/2-7
Access Control Register 0–1 (ACR0–1)
32
R/W
See Section
Yes
2.2.7/2-7
0x800
User/Supervisor A7 Stack Pointer
(OTHER_A7)
32
R/W
Contents of
location
0x0000_0000
No
2.2.3/2-5
0x801
Vector Base Register (VBR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
Yes
2.2.8/2-7
0x80E
Status Register (SR)
16
R/W
0x27--
No
2.2.9/2-8
0xC04
Flash Base Address Register
(FLASHBAR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
Yes
2.2.10/2-8
0xC05
RAM Base Address Register (RAMBAR)
32
R/W
See Section
Yes
2.2.10/2-8
0x004–5
1
The values listed in this column represent the Rc field used when accessing the core registers via the BDM port. For more
information see Chapter 30, “Debug Support”.
2.2.1
Data Registers (D0–D7)
D0–D7 data registers are for bit (1-bit), byte (8-bit), word (16-bit) and longword (32-bit) operations; they
can also be used as index registers.
NOTE
Registers D0 and D1 contain hardware configuration details after reset. See
Section 2.3.4.15, “Reset Exception” for more details.
BDM: Load: 0x080 + n; n = 0-7 (Dn)
Store: 0x180 + n; n = 0-7 (Dn)
Access: User read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Data
W
Reset
– – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
(D2-D7)
Reset
(D0, D1)
See Section 2.3.4.15, “Reset Exception”
Figure 2-2. Data Registers (D0–D7)
2.2.2
Address Registers (A0–A6)
These registers can be used as software stack pointers, index registers, or base address registers. They can
also be used for word and longword operations.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-4
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
BDM: Load: 0x088 + n; n = 0–6 (An)
Store: 0x188 + n; n = 0–6 (An)
Access: User read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
Address
W
Reset – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
Figure 2-3. Address Registers (A0–A6)
2.2.3
Supervisor/User Stack Pointers (A7 and OTHER_A7)
This ColdFire architecture supports two independent stack pointer (A7) registers—the supervisor stack
pointer (SSP) and the user stack pointer (USP). The hardware implementation of these two
program-visible 32-bit registers does not identify one as the SSP and the other as the USP. Instead, the
hardware uses one 32-bit register as the active A7 and the other as OTHER_A7. Thus, the register contents
are a function of the processor operation mode, as shown in the following:
if SR[S] = 1
then
else
A7 = Supervisor Stack Pointer
OTHER_A7 = User Stack Pointer
A7 = User Stack Pointer
OTHER_A7 = Supervisor Stack Pointer
The BDM programming model supports direct reads and writes to A7 and OTHER_A7. It is the
responsibility of the external development system to determine, based on the setting of SR[S], the mapping
of A7 and OTHER_A7 to the two program-visible definitions (SSP and USP). This functionality is
enabled by setting the enable user stack pointer bit, CACR[EUSP]. If this bit is cleared, only a single stack
pointer (A7), defined for ColdFire ISA_A, is available. EUSP is cleared at reset.
To support dual stack pointers, the following two supervisor instructions are included in the ColdFire
instruction set architecture to load/store the USP:
move.l Ay,USP;move to USP
move.l USP,Ax;move from USP
These instructions are described in the ColdFire Family Programmer’s Reference Manual. All other
instruction references to the stack pointer, explicit or implicit, access the active A7 register.
NOTE
The SSP is loaded during reset exception processing with the contents of
location 0x0000_0000.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-5
ColdFire Core
BDM: Load: 0x08F (A7)
Store: 0x18F (A7)
0x800 (OTHER_A7)
Access: A7: User or BDM read/write
OTHER_A7: Supervisor or BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
Address
W
Reset – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
Figure 2-4. Stack Pointer Registers (A7 and OTHER_A7)
2.2.4
Condition Code Register (CCR)
The CCR is the LSB of the processor status register (SR). Bits 4–0 act as indicator flags for results
generated by processor operations. The extend bit (X) is also an input operand during multiprecision
arithmetic computations. The CCR register must be explicitly loaded after reset and before any compare
(CMP), Bcc, or Scc instructions are executed.
BDM: LSB of Status Register (SR)
R
Access: User read/write
BDM read/write
7
6
5
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
0
X
N
Z
V
C
—
—
—
—
—
W
Reset:
0
0
0
Figure 2-5. Condition Code Register (CCR)
Table 2-2. CCR Field Descriptions
Field
7–5
Description
Reserved, must be cleared.
4
X
Extend condition code bit. Set to the C-bit value for arithmetic operations; otherwise not affected or set to a specified
result.
3
N
Negative condition code bit. Set if most significant bit of the result is set; otherwise cleared.
2
Z
Zero condition code bit. Set if result equals zero; otherwise cleared.
1
V
Overflow condition code bit. Set if an arithmetic overflow occurs implying the result cannot be represented in operand
size; otherwise cleared.
0
C
Carry condition code bit. Set if a carry out of the operand msb occurs for an addition or if a borrow occurs in a
subtraction; otherwise cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-6
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
2.2.5
Program Counter (PC)
The PC contains the currently executing instruction address. During instruction execution and exception
processing, the processor automatically increments contents of the PC or places a new value in the PC, as
appropriate. The PC is a base address for PC-relative operand addressing.
The PC is initially loaded during reset exception processing with the contents of location 0x0000_0004.
BDM: 0x80F (PC)
Access: User read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
Address
W
Reset – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
Figure 2-6. Program Counter Register (PC)
2.2.6
Cache Control Register (CACR)
The CACR controls operation of the instruction/data cache memories. It includes bits for enabling,
freezing, and invalidating cache contents. It also includes bits for defining the default cache mode and
write-protect fields. The CACR is described in Section 4.2.1, “Cache Control Register (CACR).”
2.2.7
Access Control Registers (ACRn)
The access control registers define attributes for user-defined memory regions. These attributes include the
definition of cache mode, write protect, and buffer write enables. The ACRs are described in Section 4.2.2,
“Access Control Registers (ACR0, ACR1).”
2.2.8
Vector Base Register (VBR)
The VBR contains the base address of the exception vector table in memory. To access the vector table,
the displacement of an exception vector is added to the value in VBR. The lower 20 bits of the VBR are
not implemented by ColdFire processors. They are assumed to be zero, forcing the table to be aligned on
a 1 MB boundary.
BDM: 0x801 (VBR)
Access: Supervisor read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Base Address
W
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 2-7. Vector Base Register (VBR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-7
ColdFire Core
2.2.9
Status Register (SR)
The SR stores the processor status and includes the CCR, the interrupt priority mask, and other control
bits. In supervisor mode, software can access the entire SR. In user mode, only the lower 8 bits (CCR) are
accessible. The control bits indicate the following states for the processor: trace mode (T bit), supervisor
or user mode (S bit), and master or interrupt state (M bit). All defined bits in the SR have read/write access
when in supervisor mode. The lower byte of the SR (the CCR) must be loaded explicitly after reset and
before any compare (CMP), Bcc, or Scc instructions execute.
BDM: 0x80E (SR)
Access: Supervisor read/write
BDM read/write
System Byte
15
R
W
Reset
T
0
14
0
0
13
12
S
M
1
0
11
Condition Code Register (CCR)
10
0
0
9
8
I
1
1
1
7
6
5
0
0
0
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
0
X
N
Z
V
C
—
—
—
—
—
Figure 2-8. Status Register (SR)
Table 2-3. SR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15
T
Trace enable. When set, the processor performs a trace exception after every instruction.
14
Reserved, must be cleared.
13
S
Supervisor/user state.
0 User mode
1 Supervisor mode
12
M
Master/interrupt state. Bit is cleared by an interrupt exception and software can set it during execution of the RTE or
move to SR instructions.
11
Reserved, must be cleared.
10–8
I
Interrupt level mask. Defines current interrupt level. Interrupt requests are inhibited for all priority levels less than or
equal to current level, except edge-sensitive level 7 requests, which cannot be masked.
7–0
CCR
Refer to Section 2.2.4, “Condition Code Register (CCR)”.
2.2.10
Memory Base Address Registers (RAMBAR, FLASHBAR)
The memory base address registers are used to specify the base address of the internal SRAM and flash
modules and indicate the types of references mapped to each. Each base address register includes a base
address, write-protect bit, address space mask bits, and an enable bit. FLASHBAR determines the base
address of the on-chip flash, and RAMBAR determines the base address of the on-chip RAM. For more
information, refer to Section 5.3.1, “SRAM Base Address Register (RAMBAR)” and Section 6.3.2,
“Flash Base Address Register (FLASHBAR)”.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-8
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
2.3
2.3.1
Functional Description
Version 2 ColdFire Microarchitecture
From the block diagram in Figure 2-1, the non-Harvard architecture of the processor is readily apparent.
The processor interfaces to the local memory subsystem via a single 32-bit address and two unidirectional
32-bit data buses. This structure minimizes the core size without compromising performance to a large
degree.
A more detailed view of the hardware structure within the two pipelines is presented in Figure 2-9 and
Figure 2-10 below. In these diagrams, the internal structure of the instruction fetch and operand execution
pipelines is shown:
IAG
+4
IC
IB
Opword
Core Bus
Address
Extension 1
Core Bus
Read Data
FIFO
IB
Extension 2
Figure 2-9. Version 2 ColdFire Processor Instruction Fetch Pipeline Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-9
ColdFire Core
DSOC
AGEX
RGF
Core Bus
Address
Opword
Extension 1
Core Bus
Write Data
Extension 2
Core Bus
Read Data
Figure 2-10. Version 2 ColdFire Processor Operand Execution Pipeline Diagram
The instruction fetch pipeline prefetches instructions from local memory using a two-stage structure. For
sequential prefetches, the next instruction address is generated by adding four to the last prefetch address.
This function is performed during the IAG stage and the resulting prefetch address gated onto the core bus
(if there are no pending operand memory accesses assigned a higher priority). After the prefetch address
is driven onto the core bus, the instruction fetch cycle accesses the appropriate local memory and returns
the instruction read data back to the IFP during the cycle. If the accessed data is not present in a local
memory (e.g., an instruction cache miss, or an external access cycle is required), the IFP is stalled in the
IC stage until the referenced data is available. As the prefetch data arrives in the IFP, it can be loaded into
the FIFO instruction buffer or gated directly into the OEP.
The V2 design uses a simple static conditional branch prediction algorithm (forward-assumed as
not-taken, backward-assumed as taken), and all change-of-flow operations are calculated by the OEP and
the target instruction address fed back to the IFP.
The IFP and OEP are decoupled by the FIFO instruction buffer, allowing instruction prefetching to occur
with the available core bus bandwidth not used for operand memory accesses. For the V2 design, the
instruction buffer contains three 32-bit locations.
Consider the operation of the OEP for three basic classes of non-branch instructions:
• Register-to-register:
op
•
Embedded load:
op
•
Ry,Rx
<mem>y,Rx
Register-to-memory (store)
move
Ry,<mem>x
For simple register-to-register instructions, the first stage of the OEP performs the instruction decode and
fetching of the required register operands (OC) from the dual-ported register file, while the actual
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-10
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
instruction execution is performed in the second stage (EX) in one of the execute engines (e.g., ALU,
barrel shifter, divider, EMAC). There are no operand memory accesses associated with this class of
instructions, and the execution time is typically a single machine cycle. See Figure 2-11.
Operand Execution Pipeline
DSOC
RGF
AGEX
Rx
new Rx
Ry
Opword
Core Bus
Address
Extension 1
Core Bus
Write
Data
Extension 2
Core Bus
Read Data
Figure 2-11. V2 OEP Register-to-Register
For memory-to-register (embedded-load) instructions, the instruction is effectively staged through the
OEP twice with a basic execution time of three cycles. First, the instruction is decoded and the components
of the operand address (base register from the RGF and displacement) are selected (DS). Second, the
operand effective address is generated using the ALU execute engine (AG). Third, the memory read
operand is fetched from the core bus, while any required register operand is simultaneously fetched (OC)
from the RGF. Finally, in the fourth cycle, the instruction is executed (EX). The heavily-used 32-bit load
instruction (move.l <mem>y,Rx) is optimized to support a two-cycle execution time. The following example
in Figure 2-12 shows an effective address of the form <ea>y = (d16,Ay), i.e., a 16-bit signed displacement
added to a base register Ay.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-11
ColdFire Core
Operand Execution Pipeline
DSOC
AGEX
RGF
<ea>y
Ay
Opword
Core Bus
Address
d16
Extension 1
Core Bus
Write
Data
Extension 2
Core Bus
Read Data
Figure 2-12. V2 OEP Embedded-Load Part 1
Operand Execution Pipeline
DSOC
AGEX
Rx
RGF
new Rx
Core Bus
Address
Opword
Extension 1
Core Bus
Write
Data
Extension 2
Core Bus
Read Data
<mem>y
Figure 2-13. V2 OEP Embedded-Load Part 2
For register-to-memory (store) operations, the stage functions (DS/OC, AG/EX) are effectively performed
simultaneously allowing single-cycle execution. See Figure 2-14 where the effective address is of the form
<ea>x = (d16,Ax), i.e., a 16-bit signed displacement added to a base register Ax.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-12
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
For read-modify-write instructions, the pipeline effectively combines an embedded-load with a store
operation for a three-cycle execution time.
Operand Execution Pipeline
DSOC
AGEX
Ax
RGF
Ry
<ea>x
Opword
Extension 1
Core Bus
Address
d16
Core Bus
Write
Data
Extension 2
Core Bus
Read Data
Figure 2-14. V2 OEP Register-to-Memory
The pipeline timing diagrams of Figure 2-15 depict the execution templates for these three classes of
instructions. In these diagrams, the x-axis represents time, and the various instruction operations are shown
progressing down the operand execution pipeline.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-13
ColdFire Core
Core clock
Register-to-Register
OEP.DSOC
OC
OEP.AGEX
next
EX
Core Bus
Embedded-Load
OEP.DSOC
DS
OEP.AGEX
OC
AG
Core Bus
next
EX
op read
Register-to-Memory
(Store)
OEP.DSOC
OEP.AGEX
DSOC
next
AGEX
op write
Core Bus
Figure 2-15. V2 OEP Pipeline Execution Templates
2.3.2
Instruction Set Architecture (ISA_A+)
The original ColdFire Instruction Set Architecture (ISA_A) was derived from the M68000 family opcodes
based on extensive analysis of embedded application code. The ISA was optimized for code compiled
from high-level languages where the dominant operand size was the 32-bit integer declaration. This
approach minimized processor complexity and cost, while providing excellent performance for compiled
applications.
After the initial ColdFire compilers were created, developers noted there were certain ISA additions that
would enhance code density and overall performance. Additionally, as users implemented ColdFire-based
designs into a wide range of embedded systems, they found certain frequently-used instruction sequences
that could be improved by the creation of additional instructions.
The original ISA definition minimized support for instructions referencing byte- and word-sized operands.
Full support for the move byte and move word instructions was provided, but the only other opcodes
supporting these data types are CLR (clear) and TST (test). A set of instruction enhancements has been
implemented in subsequent ISA revisions, ISA_B and ISA_C. The new opcodes primarily addressed three
areas:
1. Enhanced support for byte and word-sized operands
2. Enhanced support for position-independent code
3. Miscellaneous instruction additions to address new functionality
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-14
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
Table 2-4 summarizes the instructions added to revision ISA_A to form revision ISA_A+. For more details
see the ColdFire Family Programmer’s Reference Manual.
Table 2-4. Instruction Enhancements over Revision ISA_A
Instruction
Description
BITREV
The contents of the destination data register are bit-reversed; new Dn[31] equals old Dn[0], new
Dn[30] equals old Dn[1],..., new Dn[0] equals old Dn[31].
BYTEREV
FF1
The contents of the destination data register are byte-reversed; new Dn[31:24] equals old
Dn[7:0],..., new Dn[7:0] equals old Dn[31:24].
The data register, Dn, is scanned, beginning from the most-significant bit (Dn[31]) and ending
with the least-significant bit (Dn[0]), searching for the first set bit. The data register is then
loaded with the offset count from bit 31 where the first set bit appears.
Move from USP USP → Destination register
Move to USP
STLDSR
2.3.3
Source register → USP
Pushes the contents of the status register onto the stack and then reloads the status register
with the immediate data value.
Exception Processing Overview
Exception processing for ColdFire processors is streamlined for performance. The ColdFire processors
differ from the M68000 family because they include:
• A simplified exception vector table
• Reduced relocation capabilities using the vector-base register
• A single exception stack frame format
• Use of separate system stack pointers for user and supervisor modes.
All ColdFire processors use an instruction restart exception model. However, Version 2 ColdFire
processors require more software support to recover from certain access errors. See Section 2.3.4.1,
“Access Error Exception” for details.
Exception processing includes all actions from fault condition detection to the initiation of fetch for first
handler instruction. Exception processing is comprised of four major steps:
1. The processor makes an internal copy of the SR and then enters supervisor mode by setting the S
bit and disabling trace mode by clearing the T bit. The interrupt exception also forces the M bit to
be cleared and the interrupt priority mask to set to current interrupt request level.
2. The processor determines the exception vector number. For all faults except interrupts, the
processor performs this calculation based on exception type. For interrupts, the processor
performs an interrupt-acknowledge (IACK) bus cycle to obtain the vector number from the
interrupt controller. The IACK cycle is mapped to special locations within the interrupt
controller’s address space with the interrupt level encoded in the address.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-15
ColdFire Core
3. The processor saves the current context by creating an exception stack frame on the system stack.
The exception stack frame is created at a 0-modulo-4 address on top of the system stack pointed to
by the supervisor stack pointer (SSP). As shown in Figure 2-16, the processor uses a simplified
fixed-length stack frame for all exceptions. The exception type determines whether the program
counter placed in the exception stack frame defines the location of the faulting instruction (fault)
or the address of the next instruction to be executed (next).
4. The processor calculates the address of the first instruction of the exception handler. By definition,
the exception vector table is aligned on a 1 MB boundary. This instruction address is generated by
fetching an exception vector from the table located at the address defined in the vector base register.
The index into the exception table is calculated as (4 × vector number). After the exception vector
has been fetched, the vector contents determine the address of the first instruction of the desired
handler. After the instruction fetch for the first opcode of the handler has initiated, exception
processing terminates and normal instruction processing continues in the handler.
All ColdFire processors support a 1024-byte vector table aligned on any 1 Mbyte address boundary (see
Table 2-5).
The table contains 256 exception vectors; the first 64 are defined for the core and the remaining 192 are
device-specific peripheral interrupt vectors. See Chapter 10, “Interrupt Controller Modules” for details on
the device-specific interrupt sources.
Table 2-5. Exception Vector Assignments
Vector
Number(s)
Vector
Offset (Hex)
Stacked
Program
Counter
Assignment
0
0x000
—
Initial supervisor stack pointer
1
0x004
—
Initial program counter
2
0x008
Fault
Access error
3
0x00C
Fault
Address error
4
0x010
Fault
Illegal instruction
5
0x014
Fault
Divide by zero
6–7
0x018–0x01C
—
Reserved
8
0x020
Fault
Privilege violation
9
0x024
Next
Trace
10
0x028
Fault
Unimplemented line-A opcode
11
0x02C
Fault
Unimplemented line-F opcode
12
0x030
Next
Debug interrupt
13
0x034
—
Reserved
14
0x038
Fault
Format error
15–23
0x03C–0x05C
—
Reserved
24
0x060
Next
Spurious interrupt
25–31
0x064–0x07C
—
Reserved
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-16
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
Table 2-5. Exception Vector Assignments (continued)
1
Vector
Number(s)
Vector
Offset (Hex)
Stacked
Program
Counter
Assignment
32–47
0x080–0x0BC
Next
Trap # 0-15 instructions
48–63
0x0C0–0x0FC
—
Reserved
64–255
0x100–0x3FC
Next
Device-specific interrupts
Fault refers to the PC of the instruction that caused the exception. Next refers to the PC
of the instruction that follows the instruction that caused the fault.
All ColdFire processors inhibit interrupt sampling during the first instruction of all exception handlers.
This allows any handler to disable interrupts effectively, if necessary, by raising the interrupt mask level
contained in the status register. In addition, the ISA_A+ architecture includes an instruction (STLDSR)
that stores the current interrupt mask level and loads a value into the SR. This instruction is specifically
intended for use as the first instruction of an interrupt service routine that services multiple interrupt
requests with different interrupt levels. For more details, see ColdFire Family Programmer’s Reference
Manual.
2.3.3.1
Exception Stack Frame Definition
Figure 2-16 shows exception stack frame. The first longword contains the 16-bit format/vector word (F/V)
and the 16-bit status register, and the second longword contains the 32-bit program counter address.
SSP →
31 30 29 28 27
Format
26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17
FS[3:2]
Vector
+ 0x4
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
FS[1:0]
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Status Register
Program Counter
Figure 2-16. Exception Stack Frame Form
The 16-bit format/vector word contains three unique fields:
• A 4-bit format field at the top of the system stack is always written with a value of 4, 5, 6, or 7 by
the processor, indicating a two-longword frame format. See Table 2-6.
Table 2-6. Format Field Encodings
•
Original SSP @ Time
of Exception, Bits 1:0
SSP @ 1st
Instruction of
Handler
Format Field
00
Original SSP - 8
0100
01
Original SSP - 9
0101
10
Original SSP - 10
0110
11
Original SSP - 11
0111
There is a 4-bit fault status field, FS[3:0], at the top of the system stack. This field is defined for
access and address errors only and written as zeros for all other exceptions. See Table 2-7.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-17
ColdFire Core
Table 2-7. Fault Status Encodings
•
FS[3:0]
Definition
00xx
Reserved
0100
Error on instruction fetch
0101
Reserved
011x
Reserved
1000
Error on operand write
1001
Attempted write to write-protected space
101x
Reserved
1100
Error on operand read
1101
Reserved
111x
Reserved
The 8-bit vector number, vector[7:0], defines the exception type and is calculated by the processor
for all internal faults and represents the value supplied by the interrupt controller in case of an
interrupt. See Table 2-5.
2.3.4
2.3.4.1
Processor Exceptions
Access Error Exception
The exact processor response to an access error depends on the memory reference being performed. For
an instruction fetch, the processor postpones the error reporting until the faulted reference is needed by an
instruction for execution. Therefore, faults during instruction prefetches followed by a change of
instruction flow do not generate an exception. When the processor attempts to execute an instruction with
a faulted opword and/or extension words, the access error is signaled and the instruction aborted. For this
type of exception, the programming model has not been altered by the instruction generating the access
error.
If the access error occurs on an operand read, the processor immediately aborts the current instruction’s
execution and initiates exception processing. In this situation, any address register updates attributable to
the auto-addressing modes, (for example, (An)+,-(An)), have already been performed, so the programming
model contains the updated An value. In addition, if an access error occurs during a MOVEM instruction
loading from memory, any registers already updated before the fault occurs contain the operands from
memory.
The V2 ColdFire processor uses an imprecise reporting mechanism for access errors on operand writes.
Because the actual write cycle may be decoupled from the processor’s issuing of the operation, the
signaling of an access error appears to be decoupled from the instruction that generated the write.
Accordingly, the PC contained in the exception stack frame merely represents the location in the program
when the access error was signaled. All programming model updates associated with the write instruction
are completed. The NOP instruction can collect access errors for writes. This instruction delays its
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-18
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
execution until all previous operations, including all pending write operations, are complete. If any
previous write terminates with an access error, it is guaranteed to be reported on the NOP instruction.
2.3.4.2
Address Error Exception
Any attempted execution transferring control to an odd instruction address (if bit 0 of the target address is
set) results in an address error exception.
Any attempted use of a word-sized index register (Xn.w) or a scale factor of eight on an indexed effective
addressing mode generates an address error, as does an attempted execution of a full-format indexed
addressing mode, which is defined by bit 8 of extension word 1 being set.
If an address error occurs on a JSR instruction, the Version 2 ColdFire processor calculates the target
address then the return address is pushed onto the stack. If an address error occurs on an RTS instruction,
the Version 2 ColdFire processor overwrites the faulting return PC with the address error stack frame.
2.3.4.3
Illegal Instruction Exception
The ColdFire variable-length instruction set architecture supports three instruction sizes: 16, 32, or 48 bits.
The first instruction word is known as the operation word (or opword), while the optional words are known
as extension word 1 and extension word 2. The opword is further subdivided into three sections: the upper
four bits segment the entire ISA into 16 instruction lines, the next 6 bits define the operation mode
(opmode), and the low-order 6 bits define the effective address. See Figure 2-17. The opword line
definition is shown in Table 2-8.
15
14
13
12
11
Line
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
OpMode
3
2
1
0
Effective Address
Mode
Register
Figure 2-17. ColdFire Instruction Operation Word (Opword) Format
Table 2-8. ColdFire Opword Line Definition
Opword[Line]
Instruction Class
0x0
Bit manipulation, Arithmetic and Logical Immediate
0x1
Move Byte
0x2
Move Long
0x3
Move Word
0x4
Miscellaneous
0x5
Add (ADDQ) and Subtract Quick (SUBQ), Set according to Condition Codes (Scc)
0x6
PC-relative change-of-flow instructions
Conditional (Bcc) and unconditional (BRA) branches, subroutine calls (BSR)
0x7
Move Quick (MOVEQ), Move with sign extension (MVS) and zero fill (MVZ)
0x8
Logical OR (OR)
0x9
Subtract (SUB), Subtract Extended (SUBX)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-19
ColdFire Core
Table 2-8. ColdFire Opword Line Definition (continued)
Opword[Line]
Instruction Class
0xA
EMAC, Move 3-bit Quick (MOV3Q)
0xB
Compare (CMP), Exclusive-OR (EOR)
0xC
Logical AND (AND), Multiply Word (MUL)
0xD
Add (ADD), Add Extended (ADDX)
0xE
Arithmetic and logical shifts (ASL, ASR, LSL, LSR)
0xF
Cache Push (CPUSHL), Write DDATA (WDDATA), Write Debug (WDEBUG)
In the original M68000 ISA definition, lines A and F were effectively reserved for user-defined operations
(line A) and co-processor instructions (line F). Accordingly, there are two unique exception vectors
associated with illegal opwords in these two lines.
Any attempted execution of an illegal 16-bit opcode (except for line-A and line-F opcodes) generates an
illegal instruction exception (vector 4). Additionally, any attempted execution of any non-MAC line-A and
most line-F opcodes generate their unique exception types, vector numbers 10 and 11, respectively.
ColdFire cores do not provide illegal instruction detection on the extension words on any instruction,
including MOVEC.
2.3.4.4
Divide-By-Zero
Attempting to divide by zero causes an exception (vector 5, offset equal 0x014).
2.3.4.5
Privilege Violation
The attempted execution of a supervisor mode instruction while in user mode generates a privilege
violation exception. See ColdFire Programmer’s Reference Manual for a list of supervisor-mode
instructions.
There is one special case involving the HALT instruction. Normally, this opcode is a supervisor mode
instruction, but if the debug module's CSR[UHE] is set, then this instruction can be also be executed in
user mode for debugging purposes.
2.3.4.6
Trace Exception
To aid in program development, all ColdFire processors provide an instruction-by-instruction tracing
capability. While in trace mode, indicated by setting of the SR[T] bit, the completion of an instruction
execution (for all but the stop instruction) signals a trace exception. This functionality allows a debugger
to monitor program execution.
The stop instruction has the following effects:
1. The instruction before the stop executes and then generates a trace exception. In the exception stack
frame, the PC points to the stop opcode.
2. When the trace handler is exited, the stop instruction executes, loading the SR with the immediate
operand from the instruction.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-20
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
3. The processor then generates a trace exception. The PC in the exception stack frame points to the
instruction after the stop, and the SR reflects the value loaded in the previous step.
If the processor is not in trace mode and executes a stop instruction where the immediate operand sets
SR[T], hardware loads the SR and generates a trace exception. The PC in the exception stack frame points
to the instruction after the stop, and the SR reflects the value loaded in step 2.
Because ColdFire processors do not support any hardware stacking of multiple exceptions, it is the
responsibility of the operating system to check for trace mode after processing other exception types. As
an example, consider a TRAP instruction execution while in trace mode. The processor initiates the trap
exception and then passes control to the corresponding handler. If the system requires that a trace exception
be processed, it is the responsibility of the trap exception handler to check for this condition (SR[T] in the
exception stack frame set) and pass control to the trace handler before returning from the original
exception.
2.3.4.7
Unimplemented Line-A Opcode
A line-A opcode is defined when bits 15-12 of the opword are 0b1010. This exception is generated by the
attempted execution of an undefined line-A opcode.
2.3.4.8
Unimplemented Line-F Opcode
A line-F opcode is defined when bits 15-12 of the opword are 0b1111. This exception is generated when
attempting to execute an undefined line-F opcode.
2.3.4.9
Debug Interrupt
See Chapter 30, “Debug Support,” for a detailed explanation of this exception, which is generated in
response to a hardware breakpoint register trigger. The processor does not generate an IACK cycle, but
rather calculates the vector number internally (vector number 12). Additionally, SR[M,I] are unaffected by
the interrupt.
2.3.4.10
RTE and Format Error Exception
When an RTE instruction is executed, the processor first examines the 4-bit format field to validate the
frame type. For a ColdFire core, any attempted RTE execution (where the format is not equal to {4,5,6,7})
generates a format error. The exception stack frame for the format error is created without disturbing the
original RTE frame and the stacked PC pointing to the RTE instruction.
The selection of the format value provides some limited debug support for porting code from M68000
applications. On M68000 family processors, the SR was located at the top of the stack. On those
processors, bit 30 of the longword addressed by the system stack pointer is typically zero. Thus, if an RTE
is attempted using this old format, it generates a format error on a ColdFire processor.
If the format field defines a valid type, the processor: (1) reloads the SR operand, (2) fetches the second
longword operand, (3) adjusts the stack pointer by adding the format value to the auto-incremented address
after the fetch of the first longword, and then (4) transfers control to the instruction address defined by the
second longword operand within the stack frame.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-21
ColdFire Core
2.3.4.11
TRAP Instruction Exception
The TRAP #n instruction always forces an exception as part of its execution and is useful for implementing
system calls. The TRAP instruction may be used to change from user to supervisor mode.
2.3.4.12
Unsupported Instruction Exception
If execution of a valid instruction is attempted but the required hardware is not present in the processor, an
unsupported instruction exception is generated. The instruction functionality can then be emulated in the
exception handler, if desired.
All ColdFire cores record the processor hardware configuration in the D0 register immediately after the
negation of RESET. See Section 2.3.4.15, “Reset Exception,” for details.
2.3.4.13
Interrupt Exception
Interrupt exception processing includes interrupt recognition and the fetch of the appropriate vector from
the interrupt controller using an IACK cycle. See ,” for details on the interrupt controller.
2.3.4.14
Fault-on-Fault Halt
If a ColdFire processor encounters any type of fault during the exception processing of another fault, the
processor immediately halts execution with the catastrophic fault-on-fault condition. A reset is required to
to exit this state.
2.3.4.15
Reset Exception
Asserting the reset input signal (RESET) to the processor causes a reset exception. The reset exception has
the highest priority of any exception; it provides for system initialization and recovery from catastrophic
failure. Reset also aborts any processing in progress when the reset input is recognized. Processing cannot
be recovered.
The reset exception places the processor in the supervisor mode by setting the SR[S] bit and disables
tracing by clearing the SR[T] bit. This exception also clears the SR[M] bit and sets the processor’s SR[I]
field to the highest level (level 7, 0b111). Next, the VBR is initialized to zero (0x0000_0000). The control
registers specifying the operation of any memories (e.g., cache and/or RAM modules) connected directly
to the processor are disabled.
NOTE
Other implementation-specific registers are also affected. Refer to each
module in this reference manual for details on these registers.
After the processor is granted the bus, it performs two longword read-bus cycles. The first longword at
address 0x0000_0000 is loaded into the supervisor stack pointer and the second longword at address
0x0000_0004 is loaded into the program counter. After the initial instruction is fetched from memory,
program execution begins at the address in the PC. If an access error or address error occurs before the first
instruction is executed, the processor enters the fault-on-fault state.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-22
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
ColdFire processors load hardware configuration information into the D0 and D1 general-purpose
registers after system reset. The hardware configuration information is loaded immediately after the
reset-in signal is negated. This allows an emulator to read out the contents of these registers via the BDM
to determine the hardware configuration.
Information loaded into D0 defines the processor hardware configuration as shown in Figure 2-18.
BDM: Load: 0x080 (D0)
Store: 0x180 (D0)
31
30
29
Access: User read-only
BDM read-only
28
R
27
26
25
24
23
22
PF
21
20
19
18
VER
17
16
REV
W
Reset
1
15
R MAC
1
14
DIV
0
0
1
1
13
12
11
10
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC FPU
1
1
0
0
9
8
7
6
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
ISA
DEBUG
W
Reset
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-18. D0 Hardware Configuration Info
Table 2-9. D0 Hardware Configuration Info Field Description
Field
Description
31–24
PF
Processor family. This field is fixed to a hex value of 0xCF indicating a ColdFire core is present.
23–20
VER
ColdFire core version number. Defines the hardware microarchitecture version of ColdFire core.
0001 V1 ColdFire core
0010 V2 ColdFire core (This is the value used for this device.)
0011 V3 ColdFire core
0100 V4 ColdFire core
0101 V5 ColdFire core
Else Reserved for future use
19–16
REV
Processor revision number. The default is 0b0000.
15
MAC
MAC present. This bit signals if the optional multiply-accumulate (MAC) execution engine is present in processor core.
0 MAC execute engine not present in core. (This is the value used for this device.)
1 MAC execute engine is present in core.
14
DIV
Divide present. This bit signals if the hardware divider (DIV) is present in the processor core.
0 Divide execute engine not present in core.
1 Divide execute engine is present in core. (This is the value used for this device.)
13
EMAC
12
FPU
EMAC present. This bit signals if the optional enhanced multiply-accumulate (EMAC) execution engine is present in
processor core.
0 EMAC execute engine not present in core.
1 EMAC execute engine is present in core. (This is the value used for this device.)
FPU present. This bit signals if the optional floating-point (FPU) execution engine is present in processor core.
0 FPU execute engine not present in core. (This is the value used for this device.)
1 FPU execute engine is present in core.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-23
ColdFire Core
Table 2-9. D0 Hardware Configuration Info Field Description (continued)
Field
Description
11–8
Reserved.
7–4
ISA
ISA revision. Defines the instruction-set architecture (ISA) revision level implemented in ColdFire processor core.
0000 ISA_A
0001 ISA_B
0010 ISA_C
1000 ISA_A+ (This is the value used for this device.)
Else Reserved
3–0
Debug module revision number. Defines revision level of the debug module used in the ColdFire processor core.
DEBUG 0000 DEBUG_A
0001 DEBUG_B
0010 DEBUG_C
0011 DEBUG_D
0100 DEBUG_E
1001 DEBUG_B+
1011 DEBUG_D+
1111 DEBUG_D+PST Buffer
Else Reserved
Information loaded into D1 defines the local memory hardware configuration as shown in the figure below.
BDM: Load: 0x1 (D1)
Store: 0x1 (D1)
31
R
30
CLSZ
Access: User read-only
BDM read-only
29
28
27
CCAS
26
25
24
23
22
CCSZ
21
20
19
FLASHSZ
18
17
16
0
0
0
W
Reset
R
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
MBSZ
UCAS
SRAMSZ
W
Reset
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-19. D1 Hardware Configuration Info
Table 2-10. D1 Hardware Configuration Information Field Description
Field
Description
31–30
CLSZ
Cache line size. This field is fixed to a hex value of 0x0 indicating a 16-byte cache line size.
29–28
CCAS
Configurable cache associativity.
00
Four-way
01
Direct mapped (This is the value used for this device)
Else Reserved for future use
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-24
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
Table 2-10. D1 Hardware Configuration Information Field Description (continued)
Field
Description
27–24
CCSZ
Configurable cache size. Indicates the amount of instruction/data cache. The cache configuration options
available are 50% instruction/50% data, 100% instruction, or 100% data, and are specified in the CACR register.
0000 No configurable cache
0001 512B configurable cache
0010 1KB configurable cache
0011 2KB configurable cache (This is the value used for this device)
0100 4KB configurable cache
0101 8KB configurable cache
0110 16KB configurable cache
0111 32KB configurable cache
Else Reserved
23–19
FLASHSZ
Flash bank size.
0000-0111 No flash
1000 64-KB flash
1001 128-KB flash
1010 256-KB flash
1011 512-KB flash (This is the value used for this device)
Else Reserved for future use.
18–16
Reserved
15–14
MBSZ
Bus size. Defines the width of the ColdFire master bus datapath.
00
32-bit system bus datapath (This is the value used for this device)
01
64-bit system bus datapath
Else Reserved
13–8
Reserved, resets to 0b010000
7–3
SRAMSZ
2–0
2.3.5
SRAM bank size.
00000 No SRAM
00010 512 bytes
00100 1 KB
00110 2 KB
01000 4 KB
01010 8 KB
01100 16 KB
01110 32 KB
10000 64 KB (This is the value used for this device)
10010 128 KB
Else Reserved for future use
Reserved.
Instruction Execution Timing
This section presents processor instruction execution times in terms of processor-core clock cycles. The
number of operand references for each instruction is enclosed in parentheses following the number of
processor clock cycles. Each timing entry is presented as C(R/W) where:
• C is the number of processor clock cycles, including all applicable operand fetches and writes, and
all internal core cycles required to complete the instruction execution.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-25
ColdFire Core
•
R/W is the number of operand reads (R) and writes (W) required by the instruction. An operation
performing a read-modify-write function is denoted as (1/1).
This section includes the assumptions concerning the timing values and the execution time details.
2.3.5.1
Timing Assumptions
For the timing data presented in this section, these assumptions apply:
1. The OEP is loaded with the opword and all required extension words at the beginning of each
instruction execution. This implies that the OEP does not wait for the IFP to supply opwords and/or
extension words.
2. The OEP does not experience any sequence-related pipeline stalls. The most common example of
stall involves consecutive store operations, excluding the MOVEM instruction. For all STORE
operations (except MOVEM), certain hardware resources within the processor are marked as busy
for two clock cycles after the final decode and select/operand fetch cycle (DSOC) of the store
instruction. If a subsequent STORE instruction is encountered within this 2-cycle window, it is
stalled until the resource again becomes available. Thus, the maximum pipeline stall involving
consecutive STORE operations is two cycles. The MOVEM instruction uses a different set of
resources and this stall does not apply.
3. The OEP completes all memory accesses without any stall conditions caused by the memory itself.
Thus, the timing details provided in this section assume that an infinite zero-wait state memory is
attached to the processor core.
4. All operand data accesses are aligned on the same byte boundary as the operand size; for example,
16-bit operands aligned on 0-modulo-2 addresses, 32-bit operands aligned on 0-modulo-4
addresses.
The processor core decomposes misaligned operand references into a series of aligned accesses as
shown in Table 2-11.
Table 2-11. Misaligned Operand References
2.3.5.2
address[1:0]
Size
Bus
Operations
Additional
C(R/W)
01 or 11
Word
Byte, Byte
2(1/0) if read
1(0/1) if write
01 or 11
Long
Byte, Word,
Byte
3(2/0) if read
2(0/2) if write
10
Long
Word, Word
2(1/0) if read
1(0/1) if write
MOVE Instruction Execution Times
Table 2-12 lists execution times for MOVE.{B,W} instructions; Table 2-13 lists timings for MOVE.L.
NOTE
For all tables in this section, the execution time of any instruction using the
PC-relative effective addressing modes is the same for the comparable
An-relative mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-26
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
ET with {<ea> = (d16,PC)}
equals ET with {<ea> = (d16,An)}
ET with {<ea> = (d8,PC,Xi*SF)}
equals ET with {<ea> = (d8,An,Xi*SF)}
The nomenclature xxx.wl refers to both forms of absolute addressing, xxx.w
and xxx.l.
Table 2-12. MOVE Byte and Word Execution Times
Destination
Source
Rx
(Ax)
(Ax)+
-(Ax)
(d16,Ax)
(d8,Ax,Xi*SF)
xxx.wl
Dy
1(0/0)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
2(0/1)
1(0/1)
Ay
1(0/0)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
2(0/1)
1(0/1)
(Ay)
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1))
3(1/1)
(Ay)+
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1))
3(1/1)
-(Ay)
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1))
3(1/1)
(d16,Ay)
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
—
(d8,Ay,Xi*SF)
4(1/0)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
—
—
—
xxx.w
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
—
—
xxx.l
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
—
—
(d16,PC)
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
—
(d8,PC,Xi*SF)
4(1/0)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1))
—
—
—
#xxx
1(0/0)
3(0/1)
3(0/1)
3(0/1)
—
—
—
Table 2-13. MOVE Long Execution Times
Destination
Source
Rx
(Ax)
(Ax)+
-(Ax)
(d16,Ax)
(d8,Ax,Xi*SF)
xxx.wl
Dy
1(0/0)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
2(0/1)
1(0/1)
Ay
1(0/0)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
2(0/1)
1(0/1)
(Ay)
2(1/0)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
3(1/1)
2(1/1)
(Ay)+
2(1/0)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
3(1/1)
2(1/1)
-(Ay)
2(1/0)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
3(1/1)
2(1/1)
(d16,Ay)
2(1/0)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
—
—
(d8,Ay,Xi*SF)
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
—
—
xxx.w
2(1/0)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
—
—
—
xxx.l
2(1/0)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
—
—
—
(d16,PC)
2(1/0)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
2(1/1)
—
—
(d8,PC,Xi*SF)
3(1/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
—
—
#xxx
1(0/0)
2(0/1)
2(0/1)
2(0/1)
—
—
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-27
ColdFire Core
2.3.5.3
Standard One Operand Instruction Execution Times
Table 2-14. One Operand Instruction Execution Times
Effective Address
Opcode
<EA>
Rn
(An)
(An)+
-(An)
(d16,An)
(d8,An,Xn*SF)
xxx.wl
#xxx
BITREV
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
BYTEREV
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CLR.B
<ea>
1(0/0)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
2(0/1)
1(0/1)
—
CLR.W
<ea>
1(0/0)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
2(0/1)
1(0/1)
—
CLR.L
<ea>
1(0/0)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
1(0/1)
2(0/1)
1(0/1)
—
EXT.W
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
EXT.L
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
EXTB.L
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
FF1
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
NEG.L
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
NEGX.L
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
NOT.L
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SCC
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SWAP
Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TST.B
<ea>
1(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
1(0/0)
TST.W
<ea>
1(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
1(0/0)
TST.L
<ea>
1(0/0)
2(1/0)
2(1/0)
2(1/0)
2(1/0)
3(1/0)
2(1/0)
1(0/0)
2.3.5.4
Standard Two Operand Instruction Execution Times
Table 2-15. Two Operand Instruction Execution Times
Effective Address
Opcode
<EA>
Rn
(An)
(An)+
-(An)
(d16,An) (d8,An,Xn*SF)
(d16,PC) (d8,PC,Xn*SF)
xxx.wl
#xxx
ADD.L
<ea>,Rx
1(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
1(0/0)
ADD.L
Dy,<ea>
—
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
ADDI.L
#imm,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADDQ.L
#imm,<ea>
1(0/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
ADDX.L
Dy,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
AND.L
<ea>,Rx
1(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
1(0/0)
AND.L
Dy,<ea>
—
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
ANDI.L
#imm,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-28
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
Table 2-15. Two Operand Instruction Execution Times (continued)
Effective Address
Opcode
<EA>
Rn
(An)
(An)+
-(An)
(d16,An) (d8,An,Xn*SF)
(d16,PC) (d8,PC,Xn*SF)
xxx.wl
#xxx
ASL.L
<ea>,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
ASR.L
<ea>,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
BCHG
Dy,<ea>
2(0/0)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
5(1/1)
4(1/1)
—
BCHG
#imm,<ea>
2(0/0)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
—
—
—
BCLR
Dy,<ea>
2(0/0)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
5(1/1)
4(1/1)
—
BCLR
#imm,<ea>
2(0/0)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
—
—
—
BSET
Dy,<ea>
2(0/0)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
5(1/1)
4(1/1)
—
BSET
#imm,<ea>
2(0/0)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
4(1/1)
—
—
—
BTST
Dy,<ea>
2(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
—
BTST
#imm,<ea>
1(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
—
—
—
CMP.L
<ea>,Rx
1(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
1(0/0)
CMPI.L
#imm,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DIVS.W
<ea>,Dx
20(0/0)
23(1/0)
23(1/0)
23(1/0)
23(1/0)
24(1/0)
23(1/0)
20(0/0)
DIVU.W
<ea>,Dx
20(0/0)
23(1/0)
23(1/0)
23(1/0)
23(1/0)
24(1/0)
23(1/0)
20(0/0)
DIVS.L
<ea>,Dx
≤35(0/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0)
—
—
—
DIVU.L
<ea>,Dx
≤35(0/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0)
—
—
—
EOR.L
Dy,<ea>
1(0/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
EORI.L
#imm,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LEA
<ea>,Ax
—
1(0/0)
—
—
1(0/0)
2(0/0)
1(0/0)
—
LSL.L
<ea>,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
LSR.L
<ea>,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
MOVEQ.L
#imm,Dx
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
OR.L
<ea>,Rx
1(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
1(0/0)
OR.L
Dy,<ea>
—
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
ORI.L
#imm,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
REMS.L
<ea>,Dx
≤35(0/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0)
—
—
—
REMU.L
<ea>,Dx
≤35(0/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0) ≤38(1/0)
—
—
—
SUB.L
<ea>,Rx
1(0/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
1(0/0)
SUB.L
Dy,<ea>
—
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
SUBI.L
#imm,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SUBQ.L
#imm,<ea>
1(0/0)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
3(1/1)
4(1/1)
3(1/1)
—
SUBX.L
Dy,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-29
ColdFire Core
2.3.5.5
Miscellaneous Instruction Execution Times
Table 2-16. Miscellaneous Instruction Execution Times
Effective Address
Opcode
<EA>
Rn
(An)
(An)+
-(An)
(d16,An)
(d8,An,Xn*SF)
xxx.wl
#xxx
CPUSHL
(Ax)
—
11(0/1)
—
—
—
—
—
—
LINK.W
Ay,#imm
2(0/1)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.L
Ay,USP
3(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.L
USP,Ax
3(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.W
CCR,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.W
<ea>,CCR
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
MOVE.W
SR,Dx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.W
<ea>,SR
7(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
7(0/0) 2
MOVEC
Ry,Rc
9(0/1)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVEM.L
<ea>,and
list
—
1+n(n/0)
—
—
1+n(n/0)
—
—
—
MOVEM.L
and
list,<ea>
—
1+n(0/n)
—
—
1+n(0/n)
—
—
—
3(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2(0/1)
—
NOP
PEA
<ea>
PULSE
2(0/1)
4
5
—
2(0/1)
—
—
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
3(0/1)
STLDSR
#imm
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
5(0/1)
STOP
#imm
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
3(0/0) 3
TRAP
#imm
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
15(1/2)
TPF
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TPF.W
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TPF.L
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
UNLK
Ax
2(1/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
WDDATA
<ea>
—
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
3(1/0)
4(1/0)
3(1/0)
—
WDEBUG
<ea>
—
5(2/0)
—
—
5(2/0)
—
—
—
1The
n is the number of registers moved by the MOVEM opcode.
a MOVE.W #imm,SR instruction is executed and imm[13] equals 1, the execution time is 1(0/0).
3The execution time for STOP is the time required until the processor begins sampling continuously for interrupts.
4PEA execution times are the same for (d16,PC).
5
PEA execution times are the same for (d8,PC,Xn*SF).
2If
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-30
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Core
2.3.5.6
EMAC Instruction Execution Times
Table 2-17. EMAC Instruction Execution Times
Effective Address
Opcode
<EA>
Rn
(An)
(An)+
-(An)
(d16,An)
(d8,An,
xxx.wl
Xn*SF)
#xxx
MAC.L
Ry, Rx, Raccx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MAC.L
Ry, Rx, <ea>, Rw, Raccx
—
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)1
—
—
—
MAC.W
Ry, Rx, Raccx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MAC.W
Ry, Rx, <ea>, Rw, Raccx
—
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)1
—
—
—
MOVE.L
<ea>y, Raccx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
MOVE.L
Raccy,Raccx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.L
<ea>y, MACSR
5(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
5(0/0)
MOVE.L
<ea>y, Rmask
4(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
4(0/0)
MOVE.L
<ea>y,Raccext01
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
MOVE.L
<ea>y,Raccext23
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
1(0/0)
MOVE.L
Raccx,<ea>x
1(0/0)2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.L
MACSR,<ea>x
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.L
Rmask, <ea>x
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.L
Raccext01,<ea.x
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOVE.L
Raccext23,<ea>x
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MSAC.L
Ry, Rx, Raccx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MSAC.W
Ry, Rx, Raccx
1(0/0)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MSAC.L Ry, Rx, <ea>, Rw, Raccx
—
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)1
—
—
—
MSAC.W Ry, Rx, <ea>, Rw, Raccx
—
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)1
—
—
—
MULS.L
<ea>y, Dx
4(0/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
—
—
—
MULS.W
<ea>y, Dx
4(0/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
4(0/0)
MULU.L
<ea>y, Dx
4(0/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
—
—
—
MULU.W
<ea>y, Dx
4(0/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
(1/0)
4(0/0)
1
2
Effective address of (d16,PC) not supported
Storing an accumulator requires one additional processor clock cycle when saturation is enabled, or fractional
rounding is performed (MACSR[7:4] equals 1---, -11-, --11)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
2-31
ColdFire Core
NOTE
The execution times for moving the contents of the Racc, Raccext[01,23],
MACSR, or Rmask into a destination location <ea>x shown in this table
represent the best-case scenario when the store instruction is executed and
there are no load or M{S}AC instructions in the EMAC execution pipeline.
In general, these store operations require only a single cycle for execution,
but if preceded immediately by a load, MAC, or MSAC instruction, the
depth of the EMAC pipeline is exposed and the execution time is four
cycles.
2.3.5.7
Branch Instruction Execution Times
Table 2-18. General Branch Instruction Execution Times
Effective Address
Opcode
<EA>
Rn
(An)
(An)+
-(An)
(d16,An)
(d16,PC)
(d8,An,Xi*SF)
(d8,PC,Xi*SF)
xxx.wl
#xxx
BRA
—
—
—
—
2(0/1)
—
—
—
BSR
—
—
—
—
3(0/1)
—
—
—
JMP
<ea>
—
3(0/0)
—
—
3(0/0)
4(0/0)
3(0/0)
—
JSR
<ea>
—
3(0/1)
—
—
3(0/1)
4(0/1)
3(0/1)
—
RTE
—
—
10(2/0)
—
—
—
—
—
RTS
—
—
5(1/0)
—
—
—
—
—
Table 2-19. Bcc Instruction Execution Times
Opcode
Forward
Taken
Forward
Not Taken
Backward
Taken
Backward
Not Taken
Bcc
3(0/0)
1(0/0)
2(0/0)
3(0/0)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
2-32
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 3
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
3.1
Introduction
This chapter describes the functionality, microarchitecture, and performance of the enhanced
multiply-accumulate (EMAC) unit in the ColdFire family of processors.
3.1.1
Overview
The EMAC design provides a set of DSP operations that can improve the performance of embedded code
while supporting the integer multiply instructions of the baseline ColdFire architecture.
The MAC provides functionality in three related areas:
1. Signed and unsigned integer multiplication
2. Multiply-accumulate operations supporting signed and unsigned integer operands as well as
signed, fixed-point, and fractional operands
3. Miscellaneous register operations
The ColdFire family supports two MAC implementations with different performance levels and
capabilities. The original MAC features a three-stage execution pipeline optimized for 16-bit operands,
with a 16x16 multiply array and a single 32-bit accumulator. The EMAC features a four-stage pipeline
optimized for 32-bit operands, with a fully pipelined 32 × 32 multiply array and four 48-bit accumulators.
The first ColdFire MAC supported signed and unsigned integer operands and was optimized for 16x16
operations, such as those found in applications including servo control and image compression. As
ColdFire-based systems proliferated, the desire for more precision on input operands increased. The result
was an improved ColdFire MAC with user-programmable control to optionally enable use of fractional
input operands.
EMAC improvements target three primary areas:
• Improved performance of 32 × 32 multiply operation.
• Addition of three more accumulators to minimize MAC pipeline stalls caused by exchanges
between the accumulator and the pipeline’s general-purpose registers
• A 48-bit accumulation data path to allow a 40-bit product, plus 8 extension bits increase the
dynamic number range when implementing signal processing algorithms
The three areas of functionality are addressed in detail in following sections. The logic required to support
this functionality is contained in a MAC module (Figure 3-1).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-1
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
Operand Y
Operand X
X
Shift 0,1,-1
+/-
Accumulator(s)
Figure 3-1. Multiply-Accumulate Functionality Diagram
3.1.1.1
Introduction to the MAC
The MAC is an extension of the basic multiplier in most microprocessors. It is typically implemented in
hardware within an architecture and supports rapid execution of signal processing algorithms in fewer
cycles than comparable non-MAC architectures. For example, small digital filters can tolerate some
variance in an algorithm’s execution time, but larger, more complicated algorithms such as orthogonal
transforms may have more demanding speed requirements beyond scope of any processor architecture and
may require full DSP implementation.
To balance speed, size, and functionality, the ColdFire MAC is optimized for a small set of operations that
involve multiplication and cumulative additions. Specifically, the multiplier array is optimized for
single-cycle pipelined operations with a possible accumulation after product generation. This functionality
is common in many signal processing applications. The ColdFire core architecture is also modified to
allow an operand to be fetched in parallel with a multiply, increasing overall performance for certain DSP
operations.
Consider a typical filtering operation where the filter is defined as in Equation 3-1.
N–1
y(i) =
N–1
∑ a ( k )y ( i – k ) + ∑ b ( k )x ( i – k )
k=1
Eqn. 3-1
k=0
Here, the output y(i) is determined by past output values and past input values. This is the general form of
an infinite impulse response (IIR) filter. A finite impulse response (FIR) filter can be obtained by setting
coefficients a(k) to zero. In either case, the operations involved in computing such a filter are multiplies
and product summing. To show this point, reduce Equation 3-1 to a simple, four-tap FIR filter, shown in
Equation 3-2, in which the accumulated sum is a past data values and coefficients sum.
3
y(i) =
∑ b ( k )x ( i – k ) = b ( 0 )x ( i ) + b ( 1 )x ( i – 1 ) + b ( 2 )x ( i – 2 ) + b ( 3 )x ( i – 3 )
Eqn. 3-2
k=0
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
3.2
Memory Map/Register Definition
The following table and sections explain the MAC registers:
Table 3-1. EMAC Memory Map
BDM1
1
Register
Width
(bits)
Access
Reset Value
Section/Page
0x804
MAC Status Register (MACSR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
3.2.1/3-3
0x805
MAC Address Mask Register (MASK)
32
R/W
0xFFFF_FFFF
3.2.2/3-5
0x806
MAC Accumulator 0 (ACC0)
32
R/W
Undefined
3.2.3/3-6
0x807
MAC Accumulator 0,1 Extension Bytes (ACCext01)
32
R/W
Undefined
3.2.4/3-7
0x808
MAC Accumulator 2,3 Extension Bytes (ACCext23)
32
R/W
Undefined
3.2.4/3-7
0x809
MAC Accumulator 1 (ACC1)
32
R/W
Undefined
3.2.3/3-6
0x80A
MAC Accumulator 2 (ACC2)
32
R/W
Undefined
3.2.3/3-6
0x80B
MAC Accumulator 3 (ACC3)
32
R/W
Undefined
3.2.3/3-6
The values listed in this column represent the Rc field used when accessing the core registers via the BDM port. For more
information see Chapter 43, “Debug Module.”
3.2.1
MAC Status Register (MACSR)
The MAC status register (MACSR) contains a 4-bit operational mode field and condition flags.
Operational mode bits control whether operands are signed or unsigned and whether they are treated as
integers or fractions. These bits also control the overflow/saturation mode and the way in which rounding
is performed. Negative, zero, and multiple overflow condition flags are also provided.
BDM: 0x804 (MACSR)
Access: Supervisor read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
8
PAVn
7
6
OMC S/U
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
F/I
R/T
N
Z
V EV
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 3-2. MAC Status Register (MACSR)
Table 3-2. MACSR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–12
Reserved, must be cleared.
11–8
PAVn
Product/accumulation overflow flags. Contains four flags, one per accumulator, that indicate if past MAC or
MSAC instructions generated an overflow during product calculation or the 48-bit accumulation. When a
MAC or MSAC instruction is executed, the PAVn flag associated with the destination accumulator forms the
general overflow flag, MACSR[V]. Once set, each flag remains set until V is cleared by a move.l, MACSR
instruction or the accumulator is loaded directly.
Bit 11: Accumulator 3
...
Bit 8: Accumulator 0
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-3
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
Table 3-2. MACSR Field Descriptions (continued)
Field
Description
7
OMC
Overflow saturation mode. Enables or disables saturation mode on overflow. If set, the accumulator is set
to the appropriate constant (see S/U field description) on any operation that overflows the accumulator.
After saturation, the accumulator remains unaffected by any other MAC or MSAC instructions until the
overflow bit is cleared or the accumulator is directly loaded.
6
S/U
Signed/unsigned operations.
In integer mode:
S/U determines whether operations performed are signed or unsigned. It also determines the accumulator
value during saturation, if enabled.
0 Signed numbers. On overflow, if OMC is enabled, an accumulator saturates to the most positive
(0x7FFF_FFFF) or the most negative (0x8000_0000) number, depending on the instruction and the
product value that overflowed.
1 Unsigned numbers. On overflow, if OMC is enabled, an accumulator saturates to the smallest value
(0x0000_0000) or the largest value (0xFFFF_FFFF), depending on the instruction.
In fractional mode:
S/U controls rounding while storing an accumulator to a general-purpose register.
0 Move accumulator without rounding to a 16-bit value. Accumulator is moved to a general-purpose
register as a 32-bit value.
1 The accumulator is rounded to a 16-bit value using the round-to-nearest (even) method when moved to
a general-purpose register. See Section 3.3.1.1, “Rounding”. The resulting 16-bit value is stored in the
lower word of the destination register. The upper word is zero-filled. This rounding procedure does not
affect the accumulator value.
5
F/I
Fractional/integer mode. Determines whether input operands are treated as fractions or integers.
0 Integers can be represented in signed or unsigned notation, depending on the value of S/U.
1 Fractions are represented in signed, fixed-point, two’s complement notation. Values range from -1 to
1 - 2-15 for 16-bit fractions and -1 to 1 - 2-31 for 32-bit fractions. See Section 3.3.4, “Data
Representation."
4
R/T
Round/truncate mode. Controls rounding procedure for move.l ACCx,Rx, or MSAC.L instructions when
in fractional mode.
0 Truncate. The product’s lsbs are dropped before it is combined with the accumulator. Additionally, when
a store accumulator instruction is executed (move.l ACCx,Rx), the 8 lsbs of the 48-bit accumulator
logic are truncated.
1 Round-to-nearest (even). The 64-bit product of two 32-bit, fractional operands is rounded to the nearest
40-bit value. If the low-order 24 bits equal 0x80_0000, the upper 40 bits are rounded to the nearest even
(lsb = 0) value. See Section 3.3.1.1, “Rounding”. Additionally, when a store accumulator instruction is
executed (move.l ACCx,Rx), the lsbs of the 48-bit accumulator logic round the resulting 16- or 32-bit
value. If MACSR[S/U] is cleared and MACSR[R/T] is set, the low-order 8 bits are used to round the
resulting 32-bit fraction. If MACSR[S/U] is set, the low-order 24 bits are used to round the resulting 16-bit
fraction.
3
N
Negative. Set if the msb of the result is set, otherwise cleared. N is affected only by MAC, MSAC, and load
operations; it is not affected by MULS and MULU instructions.
2
Z
Zero. Set if the result equals zero, otherwise cleared. This bit is affected only by MAC, MSAC, and load
operations; it is not affected by MULS and MULU instructions.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
Table 3-2. MACSR Field Descriptions (continued)
Field
Description
1
V
Overflow. Set if an arithmetic overflow occurs on a MAC or MSAC instruction, indicating that the result
cannot be represented in the limited width of the EMAC. V is set only if a product overflow occurs or the
accumulation overflows the 48-bit structure. V is evaluated on each MAC or MSAC operation and uses the
appropriate PAVn flag in the next-state V evaluation.
0
EV
Extension overflow. Signals that the last MAC or MSAC instruction overflowed the 32 lsbs in integer mode
or the 40 lsbs in fractional mode of the destination accumulator. However, the result remains accurately
represented in the combined 48-bit accumulator structure. Although an overflow has occurred, the correct
result, sign, and magnitude are contained in the 48-bit accumulator. Subsequent MAC or MSAC operations
may return the accumulator to a valid 32/40-bit result.
Table 3-3 summarizes the interaction of the MACSR[S/U,F/I,R/T] control bits.
Table 3-3. Summary of S/U, F/I, and R/T Control Bits
3.2.2
S/U
F/I
R/T
Operational Modes
0
0
x
Signed, integer
0
1
0
Signed, fractional
Truncate on MAC.L and MSAC.L
No round on accumulator stores
0
1
1
Signed, fractional
Round on MAC.L and MSAC.L
Round-to-32-bits on accumulator stores
1
0
x
Unsigned, integer
1
1
0
Signed, fractional
Truncate on MAC.L and MSAC.L
Round-to-16-bits on accumulator stores
1
1
1
Signed, fractional
Round on MAC.L and MSAC.L
Round-to-16-bits on accumulator stores
Mask Register (MASK)
The 32-bit MASK implements the low-order 16 bits to minimize the alignment complications involved
with loading and storing only 16 bits. When the MASK is loaded, the low-order 16 bits of the source
operand are actually loaded into the register. When it is stored, the upper 16 bits are all forced to ones.
This register performs a simple AND with the operand address for MAC instructions. The processor
calculates the normal operand address and, if enabled, that address is then ANDed with {0xFFFF,
MASK[15:0]} to form the final address. Therefore, with certain MASK bits cleared, the operand address
can be constrained to a certain memory region. This is used primarily to implement circular queues with
the (An)+ addressing mode.
This minimizes the addressing support required for filtering, convolution, or any routine that implements
a data array as a circular queue. For MAC + MOVE operations, the MASK contents can optionally be
included in all memory effective address calculations. The syntax is as follows:
mac.sz
Ry,RxSF,<ea>yand ,Rw
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-5
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
The and operator enables the MASK use and causes bit 5 of the extension word to be set. The exact
algorithm for the use of MASK is:
if extension word, bit [5] = 1, the MASK bit, then
if <ea> = (An)
oa = An and {0xFFFF, MASK}
if <ea> = (An)+
oa = An
An = (An + 4) and
{0xFFFF, MASK}
if <ea> =-(An)
oa = (An - 4) and
An = (An - 4) and
{0xFFFF, MASK}
{0xFFFF, MASK}
if <ea> = (d16,An)
oa = (An + se_d16) and
{0xFFFF0x, MASK}
Here, oa is the calculated operand address and se_d16 is a sign-extended 16-bit displacement. For
auto-addressing modes of post-increment and pre-decrement, the updated An value calculation is also
shown.
Use of the post-increment addressing mode, {(An)+} with the MASK is suggested for circular queue
implementations.
BDM: 0x805 (MASK)
Access: User read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
W
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MASK
Reset 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Figure 3-3. Mask Register (MASK)
Table 3-4. MASK Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–16
Reserved, must be set.
15–0
MASK
Performs a simple AND with the operand address for MAC instructions.
3.2.3
Accumulator Registers (ACC0–3)
The accumulator registers store 32-bits of the MAC operation result. The accumulator extension registers
form the entire 48-bit result.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
BDM: 0x806 (ACC0)
0x809 (ACC1)
0x80A (ACC2)
0x80B (ACC3)
Access: User read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Accumulator
W
Reset – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
Figure 3-4. Accumulator Registers (ACC0–3)
Table 3-5. ACC0–3 Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–0
Accumulator
3.2.4
Store 32-bits of the result of the MAC operation.
Accumulator Extension Registers (ACCext01, ACCext23)
Each pair of 8-bit accumulator extension fields are concatenated with the corresponding 32-bit
accumulator register to form the 48-bit accumulator. For more information, see Section 3.3, “Functional
Description.”
BDM: 0x807 (ACCext01)
Access: User read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
ACC0U
W
ACC0L
8
7
ACC1U
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ACC1L
Reset – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
Figure 3-5. Accumulator Extension Register (ACCext01)
Table 3-6. ACCext01 Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–24
ACC0U
Accumulator 0 upper extension byte
23–16
ACC0L
Accumulator 0 lower extension byte
15–8
ACC1U
Accumulator 1 upper extension byte
7–0
ACC1L
Accumulator 1 lower extension byte
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-7
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
BDM: 0x808 (ACCext23)
Access: User read/write
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
W
ACC2U
ACC2L
8
7
ACC3U
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ACC3L
Reset – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
Figure 3-6. Accumulator Extension Register (ACCext23)
Table 3-7. ACCext23 Field Descriptions
Field
3.3
Description
31–24
ACC2U
Accumulator 2 upper extension byte
23–16
ACC2L
Accumulator 2 lower extension byte
15–8
ACC3U
Accumulator 3 upper extension byte
7–0
ACC3L
Accumulator 3 lower extension byte
Functional Description
The MAC speeds execution of ColdFire integer-multiply instructions (MULS and MULU) and provides
additional functionality for multiply-accumulate operations. By executing MULS and MULU in the MAC,
execution times are minimized and deterministic compared to the 2-bit/cycle algorithm with early
termination that the OEP normally uses if no MAC hardware is present.
The added MAC instructions to the ColdFire ISA provide for the multiplication of two numbers, followed
by the addition or subtraction of the product to or from the value in an accumulator. Optionally, the product
may be shifted left or right by 1 bit before addition or subtraction. Hardware support for saturation
arithmetic can be enabled to minimize software overhead when dealing with potential overflow conditions.
Multiply-accumulate operations support 16- or 32-bit input operands in these formats:
• Signed integers
• Unsigned integers
• Signed, fixed-point, fractional numbers
The EMAC is optimized for single-cycle, pipelined 32 × 32 multiplications. For word- and
longword-sized integer input operands, the low-order 40 bits of the product are formed and used with the
destination accumulator. For fractional operands, the entire 64-bit product is calculated and truncated or
rounded to the most-significant 40-bit result using the round-to-nearest (even) method before it is
combined with the destination accumulator.
For all operations, the resulting 40-bit product is extended to a 48-bit value (using sign-extension for
signed integer and fractional operands, zero-fill for unsigned integer operands) before being combined
with the 48-bit destination accumulator.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
Figure 3-7 and Figure 3-8 show relative alignment of input operands, the full 64-bit product, the resulting
40-bit product used for accumulation, and 48-bit accumulator formats.
OperandY
X
Product
32
OperandX
32
0
23
40
Extended Product
8
40
8
40
+
Accumulator
8
Extension Byte Upper [7:0]
Accumulator [31:0]
Extension Byte Lower [7:0]
Figure 3-7. Fractional Alignment
X
Product
OperandY
32
OperandX
32
24
8
32
Extended Product
+
8
8
32
Accumulator
8
8
32
Extension Byte Upper [7:0]
Accumulator [31:0]
Extension Byte Lower [7:0]
Figure 3-8. Signed and Unsigned Integer Alignment
Therefore, the 48-bit accumulator definition is a function of the EMAC operating mode. Given that each
48-bit accumulator is the concatenation of 16-bit accumulator extension register (ACCextn) contents and
32-bit ACCn contents, the specific definitions are:
if MACSR[6:5] == 00
/* signed integer mode */
Complete Accumulator[47:0] = {ACCextn[15:0], ACCn[31:0]}
if MACSR[6:5] == 01 or 11 /* signed fractional mode */
Complete Accumulator [47:0] = {ACCextn[15:8], ACCn[31:0], ACCextn[7:0]}
if MACSR[6:5] == 10
/* unsigned integer mode */
Complete Accumulator[47:0] = {ACCextn[15:0], ACCn[31:0]}
The four accumulators are represented as an array, ACCn, where n selects the register.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-9
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
Although the multiplier array is implemented in a four-stage pipeline, all arithmetic MAC instructions
have an effective issue rate of 1 cycle, regardless of input operand size or type.
All arithmetic operations use register-based input operands, and summed values are stored in an
accumulator. Therefore, an additional MOVE instruction is needed to store data in a general-purpose
register. One new feature in EMAC instructions is the ability to choose the upper or lower word of a
register as a 16-bit input operand. This is useful in filtering operations if one data register is loaded with
the input data and another is loaded with the coefficient. Two 16-bit multiply accumulates can be
performed without fetching additional operands between instructions by alternating word choice during
calculations.
The EMAC has four accumulator registers versus the MAC’s single accumulator. The additional registers
improve the performance of some algorithms by minimizing pipeline stalls needed to store an accumulator
value back to general-purpose registers. Many algorithms require multiple calculations on a given data set.
By applying different accumulators to these calculations, it is often possible to store one accumulator
without any stalls while performing operations involving a different destination accumulator.
The need to move large amounts of data presents an obstacle to obtaining high throughput rates in DSP
engines. Existing ColdFire instructions can accommodate these requirements. A MOVEM instruction can
efficiently move large data blocks by generating line-sized burst references. The ability to load an operand
simultaneously from memory into a register and execute a MAC instruction makes some DSP operations
such as filtering and convolution more manageable.
The programming model includes a mask register (MASK), which can optionally be used to generate an
operand address during MAC + MOVE instructions. The register application with auto-increment
addressing mode supports efficient implementation of circular data queues for memory operands.
3.3.1
Fractional Operation Mode
This section describes behavior when the fractional mode is used (MACSR[F/I] is set).
3.3.1.1
Rounding
When the processor is in fractional mode, there are two operations during which rounding can occur:
1. Execution of a store accumulator instruction (move.l ACCx,Rx). The lsbs of the 48-bit accumulator
logic are used to round the resulting 16- or 32-bit value. If MACSR[S/U] is cleared, the low-order
8 bits round the resulting 32-bit fraction. If MACSR[S/U] is set, the low-order 24 bits are used to
round the resulting 16-bit fraction.
2. Execution of a MAC (or MSAC) instruction with 32-bit operands. If MACSR[R/T] is zero,
multiplying two 32-bit numbers creates a 64-bit product truncated to the upper 40 bits; otherwise,
it is rounded using round-to-nearest (even) method.
To understand the round-to-nearest-even method, consider the following example involving the rounding
of a 32-bit number, R0, to a 16-bit number. Using this method, the 32-bit number is rounded to the closest
16-bit number possible. Let the high-order 16 bits of R0 be named R0.U and the low-order 16 bits be R0.L.
• If R0.L is less than 0x8000, the result is truncated to the value of R0.U.
• If R0.L is greater than 0x8000, the upper word is incremented (rounded up).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
•
If R0.L is 0x8000, R0 is half-way between two 16-bit numbers. In this case, rounding is based on
the lsb of R0.U, so the result is always even (lsb = 0).
— If the lsb of R0.U equals 1 and R0.L equals 0x8000, the number is rounded up.
— If the lsb of R0.U equals 0 and R0.L equals 0x8000, the number is rounded down.
This method minimizes rounding bias and creates as statistically correct an answer as possible.
The rounding algorithm is summarized in the following pseudocode:
if R0.L < 0x8000
then Result = R0.U
else if R0.L > 0x8000
then Result = R0.U + 1
else if lsb of R0.U = 0
then Result = R0.U
else Result = R0.U + 1
/* R0.L = 0x8000 */
The round-to-nearest-even technique is also known as convergent rounding.
3.3.1.2
Saving and Restoring the EMAC Programming Model
The presence of rounding logic in the EMAC output datapath requires special care during the EMAC’s
save/restore process. In particular, any result rounding modes must be disabled during the save/restore
process so the exact bit-wise contents of the EMAC registers are accessed. Consider the memory structure
containing the EMAC programming model:
struct
macState {
int acc0;
int acc1;
int acc2;
int acc3;
int accext01;
int accext02;
int mask;
int macsr;
} macState;
The following assembly language routine shows the proper sequence for a correct EMAC state save. This
code assumes all Dn and An registers are available for use, and the memory location of the state save is
defined by A7.
EMAC_state_save:
move.l
clr.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
movem.l
macsr,d7
d0
d0,macsr
acc0,d0
acc1,d1
acc2,d2
acc3,d3
accext01,d4
accext23,d5
mask,d6
#0x00ff,(a7)
;
;
;
;
save the macsr
zero the register to ...
disable rounding in the macsr
save the accumulators
; save the accumulator extensions
; save the address mask
; move the state to memory
This code performs the EMAC state restore:
EMAC_state_restore:
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-11
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
movem.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
(a7),#0x00ff
#0,macsr
d0,acc0
d1,acc1
d2,acc2
d3,acc3
d4,accext01
d5,accext23
d6,mask
d7,macsr
; restore the state from memory
; disable rounding in the macsr
; restore the accumulators
; restore the accumulator extensions
; restore the address mask
; restore the macsr
Executing this sequence type can correctly save and restore the exact state of the EMAC programming
model.
3.3.1.3
MULS/MULU
MULS and MULU are unaffected by fractional-mode operation; operands remain assumed to be integers.
3.3.1.4
Scale Factor in MAC or MSAC Instructions
The scale factor is ignored while the MAC is in fractional mode.
3.3.2
EMAC Instruction Set Summary
Table 3-8 summarizes EMAC unit instructions.
Table 3-8. EMAC Instruction Summary
Command
Mnemonic
Description
Multiply Signed
muls <ea>y,Dx
Multiplies two signed operands yielding a signed result
Multiply Unsigned
mulu <ea>y,Dx
Multiplies two unsigned operands yielding an unsigned result
Multiply Accumulate
mac Ry,RxSF,ACCx
msac Ry,RxSF,ACCx
Multiplies two operands and adds/subtracts the product
to/from an accumulator
Multiply Accumulate
with Load
mac Ry,Rx,<ea>y,Rw,ACCx
msac Ry,Rx,<ea>y,Rw,ACCx
Multiplies two operands and combines the product to an
accumulator while loading a register with the memory operand
Load Accumulator
move.l {Ry,#imm},ACCx
Loads an accumulator with a 32-bit operand
Store Accumulator
move.l ACCx,Rx
Writes the contents of an accumulator to a CPU register
Copy Accumulator
move.l ACCy,ACCx
Copies a 48-bit accumulator
Load MACSR
move.l {Ry,#imm},MACSR
Writes a value to MACSR
Store MACSR
move.l MACSR,Rx
Write the contents of MACSR to a CPU register
Store MACSR to CCR
move.l MACSR,CCR
Write the contents of MACSR to the CCR
Load MAC Mask Reg
move.l {Ry,#imm},MASK
Writes a value to the MASK register
Store MAC Mask Reg
move.l MASK,Rx
Writes the contents of the MASK to a CPU register
Load Accumulator
Extensions 01
move.l {Ry,#imm},ACCext01 Loads the accumulator 0,1 extension bytes with a 32-bit
operand
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
Table 3-8. EMAC Instruction Summary (continued)
Command
Mnemonic
Description
Load Accumulator
Extensions 23
move.l {Ry,#imm},ACCext23 Loads the accumulator 2,3 extension bytes with a 32-bit
operand
Store Accumulator
Extensions 01
move.l ACCext01,Rx
Writes the contents of accumulator 0,1 extension bytes into a
CPU register
Store Accumulator
Extensions 23
move.l ACCext23,Rx
Writes the contents of accumulator 2,3 extension bytes into a
CPU register
3.3.3
EMAC Instruction Execution Times
The instruction execution times for the EMAC can be found in Section 2.3.5.6, “EMAC Instruction
Execution Times”.
The EMAC execution pipeline overlaps the AGEX stage of the OEP (the first stage of the EMAC pipeline
is the last stage of the basic OEP). EMAC units are designed for sustained, fully-pipelined operation on
accumulator load, copy, and multiply-accumulate instructions. However, instructions that store contents
of the multiply-accumulate programming model can generate OEP stalls that expose the EMAC execution
pipeline depth:
mac.w
Ry, Rx, Acc0
move.l
Acc0, Rz
The MOVE.L instruction that stores the accumulator to an integer register (Rz) stalls until the
program-visible copy of the accumulator is available. Figure 3-9 shows EMAC timing.
Three-cycle
regBusy stall
move
mac
DSOC
move
AGEX
mac
move
EMAC EX1
mac
move
mac
EMAC EX2
mac
EMAC EX3
mac
EMAC EX4
Accumulator 0
old
new
Figure 3-9. EMAC-Specific OEP Sequence Stall
In Figure 3-9, the OEP stalls the store-accumulator instruction for three cycles: the EMAC pipleline depth
minus 1. The minus 1 factor is needed because the OEP and EMAC pipelines overlap by a cycle, the
AGEX stage. As the store-accumulator instruction reaches the AGEX stage where the operation is
performed, the recently updated accumulator 0 value is available.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-13
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
As with change or use stalls between accumulators and general-purpose registers, introducing intervening
instructions that do not reference the busy register can reduce or eliminate sequence-related store-MAC
instruction stalls. A major benefit of the EMAC is the addition of three accumulators to minimize stalls
caused by exchanges between accumulator(s) and general-purpose registers.
3.3.4
Data Representation
MACSR[S/U,F/I] selects one of the following three modes, where each mode defines a unique operand
type:
1. Two’s complement signed integer: In this format, an N-bit operand value lies in the range -2(N-1)
< operand < 2(N-1) - 1. The binary point is right of the lsb.
2. Unsigned integer: In this format, an N-bit operand value lies in the range 0 < operand < 2N - 1. The
binary point is right of the lsb.
3. Two’s complement, signed fractional: In an N-bit number, the first bit is the sign bit. The remaining
bits signify the first N-1 bits after the binary point. Given an N-bit number, aN-1aN-2aN-3... a2a1a0,
its value is given by the equation in Equation 3-3.
N–2
value = – ( 1 ⋅ a N – 1 ) +
∑2
–( i + 1 – N )
⋅ ai
Eqn. 3-3
i=0
This format can represent numbers in the range -1 < operand < 1 - 2(N-1).
For words and longwords, the largest negative number that can be represented is -1, whose internal
representation is 0x8000 and 0x8000_0000, respectively. The largest positive word is 0x7FFF or (1 - 2-15);
the most positive longword is 0x7FFF_FFFF or (1 - 2-31).
3.3.5
MAC Opcodes
MAC opcodes are described in the ColdFire Programmer’s Reference Manual.
Remember the following:
• Unless otherwise noted, the value of MACSR[N,Z] is based on the result of the final operation that
involves the product and the accumulator.
• The overflow (V) flag is managed differently. It is set if the complete product cannot be represented
as a 40-bit value (this applies to 32 × 32 integer operations only) or if the combination of the
product with an accumulator cannot be represented in the given number of bits. The EMAC design
includes an additional product/accumulation overflow bit for each accumulator that are treated as
sticky indicators and are used to calculate the V bit on each MAC or MSAC instruction. See
Section 3.2.1, “MAC Status Register (MACSR)”.
• For the MAC design, the assembler syntax of the MAC (multiply and add to accumulator) and
MSAC (multiply and subtract from accumulator) instructions does not include a reference to the
single accumulator. For the EMAC, assemblers support this syntax and no explicit reference to an
accumulator is interpreted as a reference to ACC0. Assemblers also support syntaxes where the
destination accumulator is explicitly defined.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
•
The optional 1-bit shift of the product is specified using the notation {<< | >>} SF, where <<1
indicates a left shift and >>1 indicates a right shift. The shift is performed before the product is
added to or subtracted from the accumulator. Without this operator, the product is not shifted. If the
EMAC is in fractional mode (MACSR[F/I] is set), SF is ignored and no shift is performed. Because
a product can overflow, the following guidelines are implemented:
— For unsigned word and longword operations, a zero is shifted into the product on right shifts.
— For signed, word operations, the sign bit is shifted into the product on right shifts unless the
product is zero. For signed, longword operations, the sign bit is shifted into the product unless
an overflow occurs or the product is zero, in which case a zero is shifted in.
— For all left shifts, a zero is inserted into the lsb position.
The following pseudocode explains basic MAC or MSAC instruction functionality. This example is
presented as a case statement covering the three basic operating modes with signed integers, unsigned
integers, and signed fractionals. Throughout this example, a comma-separated list in curly brackets, {},
indicates a concatenation operation.
switch (MACSR[6:5])
/* MACSR[S/U, F/I] */
{
case 0:
/* signed integers */
if (MACSR.OMC == 0 || MACSR.PAVn == 0)
then {
MACSR.PAVn = 0
/* select the input operands */
if (sz == word)
then {if (U/Ly == 1)
then operandY[31:0] = {sign-extended Ry[31], Ry[31:16]}
else operandY[31:0] = {sign-extended Ry[15], Ry[15:0]}
if (U/Lx == 1)
then operandX[31:0] = {sign-extended Rx[31], Rx[31:16]}
else operandX[31:0] = {sign-extended Rx[15], Rx[15:0]}
}
else {operandY[31:0] = Ry[31:0]
operandX[31:0] = Rx[31:0]
}
/* perform the multiply */
product[63:0] = operandY[31:0] * operandX[31:0]
/* check for product overflow */
if ((product[63:39] != 0x0000_00_0) and and (product[63:39] != 0xffff_ff_1))
then {
/* product overflow */
MACSR.PAVn = 1
MACSR.V = 1
if (inst == MSAC and and MACSR.OMC == 1)
then if (product[63] == 1)
then result[47:0] = 0x0000_7fff_ffff
else result[47:0] = 0xffff_8000_0000
else if (MACSR.OMC == 1)
then /* overflowed MAC,
saturationMode enabled */
if (product[63] == 1)
then result[47:0] = 0xffff_8000_0000
else result[47:0] = 0x0000_7fff_ffff
}
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-15
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
/* sign-extend to 48 bits before performing any scaling */
product[47:40] = {8{product[39]}}
/* sign-extend */
/* scale product before combining with accumulator */
switch (SF)
/* 2-bit scale factor */
{
case 0:
/* no scaling specified */
break;
case 1:
/* SF = “<< 1” */
product[40:0] = {product[39:0], 0}
break;
case 2:
/* reserved encoding */
break;
case 3:
/* SF = “>> 1” */
product[39:0] = {product[39], product[39:1]}
break;
}
if (MACSR.PAVn == 0)
then {if (inst == MSAC)
then result[47:0] = ACCx[47:0] - product[47:0]
else result[47:0] = ACCx[47:0] + product[47:0]
}
/* check for accumulation overflow */
if (accumulationOverflow == 1)
then {MACSR.PAVn = 1
MACSR.V = 1
if (MACSR.OMC == 1)
then /* accumulation overflow,
saturationMode enabled */
if (result[47] == 1)
then result[47:0] = 0x0000_7fff_ffff
else result[47:0] = 0xffff_8000_0000
}
/* transfer the result to the accumulator */
ACCx[47:0] = result[47:0]
}
MACSR.V = MACSR.PAVn
MACSR.N = ACCx[47]
if (ACCx[47:0] == 0x0000_0000_0000)
then MACSR.Z = 1
else MACSR.Z = 0
if ((ACCx[47:31] == 0x0000_0) || (ACCx[47:31] == 0xffff_1))
then MACSR.EV = 0
else MACSR.EV = 1
break;
case 1,3:
/* signed fractionals */
if (MACSR.OMC == 0 || MACSR.PAVn == 0)
then {
MACSR.PAVn = 0
if (sz == word)
then {if (U/Ly == 1)
then operandY[31:0] = {Ry[31:16], 0x0000}
else operandY[31:0] = {Ry[15:0], 0x0000}
if (U/Lx == 1)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
then operandX[31:0] = {Rx[31:16], 0x0000}
else operandX[31:0] = {Rx[15:0], 0x0000}
}
else {operandY[31:0] = Ry[31:0]
operandX[31:0] = Rx[31:0]
}
/* perform the multiply */
product[63:0] = (operandY[31:0] * operandX[31:0]) << 1
/* check for product rounding */
if (MACSR.R/T == 1)
then { /* perform convergent rounding */
if (product[23:0] > 0x80_0000)
then product[63:24] = product[63:24] + 1
else if ((product[23:0] == 0x80_0000) and and (product[24] == 1))
then product[63:24] = product[63:24] + 1
}
/* sign-extend to 48 bits and combine with accumulator */
/* check for the -1 * -1 overflow case */
if ((operandY[31:0] == 0x8000_0000) and and (operandX[31:0] == 0x8000_0000))
then product[71:64] = 0x00
/* zero-fill */
else product[71:64] = {8{product[63]}}
/* sign-extend */
if (inst == MSAC)
then result[47:0] = ACCx[47:0] - product[71:24]
else result[47:0] = ACCx[47:0] + product[71:24]
/* check for accumulation overflow */
if (accumulationOverflow == 1)
then {MACSR.PAVn = 1
MACSR.V = 1
if (MACSR.OMC == 1)
then /* accumulation overflow,
saturationMode enabled */
if (result[47] == 1)
then result[47:0] = 0x007f_ffff_ff00
else result[47:0] = 0xff80_0000_0000
}
/* transfer the result to the accumulator */
ACCx[47:0] = result[47:0]
}
MACSR.V = MACSR.PAVn
MACSR.N = ACCx[47]
if (ACCx[47:0] == 0x0000_0000_0000)
then MACSR.Z = 1
else MACSR.Z = 0
if ((ACCx[47:39] == 0x00_0) || (ACCx[47:39] == 0xff_1))
then MACSR.EV = 0
else MACSR.EV = 1
break;
case 2:
/* unsigned integers */
if (MACSR.OMC == 0 || MACSR.PAVn == 0)
then {
MACSR.PAVn = 0
/* select the input operands */
if (sz == word)
then {if (U/Ly == 1)
then operandY[31:0] = {0x0000, Ry[31:16]}
else operandY[31:0] = {0x0000, Ry[15:0]}
if (U/Lx == 1)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-17
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
then operandX[31:0] = {0x0000, Rx[31:16]}
else operandX[31:0] = {0x0000, Rx[15:0]}
}
else {operandY[31:0] = Ry[31:0]
operandX[31:0] = Rx[31:0]
}
/* perform the multiply */
product[63:0] = operandY[31:0] * operandX[31:0]
/* check for product overflow */
if (product[63:40] != 0x0000_00)
then {
/* product overflow */
MACSR.PAVn = 1
MACSR.V = 1
if (inst == MSAC and and MACSR.OMC == 1)
then result[47:0] = 0x0000_0000_0000
else if (MACSR.OMC == 1)
then /* overflowed MAC,
saturationMode enabled */
result[47:0] = 0xffff_ffff_ffff
}
/* zero-fill to 48 bits before performing any scaling */
product[47:40] = 0
/* zero-fill upper byte */
/* scale product before combining with accumulator */
switch (SF)
/* 2-bit scale factor */
{
case 0:
/* no scaling specified */
break;
case 1:
/* SF = “<< 1” */
product[40:0] = {product[39:0], 0}
break;
case 2:
/* reserved encoding */
break;
case 3:
/* SF = “>> 1” */
product[39:0] = {0, product[39:1]}
break;
}
/* combine with accumulator */
if (MACSR.PAVn == 0)
then {if (inst == MSAC)
then result[47:0] = ACCx[47:0] - product[47:0]
else result[47:0] = ACCx[47:0] + product[47:0]
}
/* check for accumulation overflow */
if (accumulationOverflow == 1)
then {MACSR.PAVn = 1
MACSR.V = 1
if (inst == MSAC and and MACSR.OMC == 1)
then result[47:0] = 0x0000_0000_0000
else if (MACSR.OMC == 1)
then /* overflowed MAC,
saturationMode enabled */
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-18
Freescale Semiconductor
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
result[47:0] = 0xffff_ffff_ffff
}
/* transfer the result to the accumulator */
ACCx[47:0] = result[47:0]
}
MACSR.V = MACSR.PAVn
MACSR.N = ACCx[47]
if (ACCx[47:0] == 0x0000_0000_0000)
then MACSR.Z = 1
else MACSR.Z = 0
if (ACCx[47:32] == 0x0000)
then MACSR.EV = 0
else MACSR.EV = 1
break;
}
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
3-19
Enhanced Multiply-Accumulate Unit (EMAC)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
3-20
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4
Cache
4.1
Introduction
This chapter describes cache operation on the ColdFire processor.
4.1.1
Features
Features include the following:
• Configurable as instruction, data, or split instruction/data cache
• 2-Kbyte direct-mapped cache
• Single-cycle access on cache hits
• Physically located on the ColdFire core's high-speed local bus
• Nonblocking design to maximize performance
• Separate instruction and data 16-Byte line-fill buffers
• Configurable instruction cache miss-fetch algorithm
4.1.2
Introduction
The cache is a direct-mapped, single-cycle memory. It may be configured as an instruction cache, a
write-through data cache, or a split instruction/data cache. The cache storage is organized as 128 lines,
each containing 16 bytes. The memory storage consists of a 128-entry tag array (containing addresses and
a valid bit), and a data array containing 2 Kbytes, organized as 512 × 32 bits.
Cache configuration is controlled by bits in the cache control register (CACR), detailed later in this
chapter. For the instruction or data-only configurations, only the associated instruction or data line-fill
buffer is used. For the split cache configuration, one-half of the tag and storage arrays is used for an
instruction cache and one-half is used for a data cache. The split cache configuration uses the instruction
and the data line-fill buffers. The core’s local bus is a unified bus used for instruction and data fetches.
Therefore, the cache can have only one fetch, instruction or data, active at one time.
For the instruction- or data-only configurations, the cache tag and storage arrays are accessed in parallel:
fetch address bits [10:4] addressing the tag array, and fetch address bits [10:2] addressing the storage array.
For the split cache configuration, the cache tag and storage arrays are accessed in parallel. The msb of the
tag array address is set for instruction fetches and cleared for operand fetches; fetch address bits [9:4]
provide the rest of the tag array address. The tag array outputs the address mapped to the given cache
location along with the valid bit for the line. This address field is compared to bits [31:11] for instructionor data-only configurations and to bits [31:10] for a split configuration of the fetch address from the local
bus to determine if a cache hit has occurred. If the desired address is mapped into the cache memory, the
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
4-1
Cache
output of the storage array is driven onto the ColdFire core's local data bus, thereby completing the access
in a single cycle.
The tag array maintains a single valid bit per line entry. Accordingly, only entire 16-byte lines are loaded
into the cache.
The cache also contains separate 16-byte instruction and data line-fill buffers that provide temporary
storage for the last line fetched in response to a cache miss. With each fetch, the contents of the associated
line fill buffer are examined. Thus, each fetch address examines the tag memory array and the associated
line fill buffer to see if the desired address is mapped into either hardware resource. A cache hit in the
memory array or the associated line-fill buffer is serviced in a single cycle. Because the line fill buffer
maintains valid bits on a longword basis, hits in the buffer can be serviced immediately without waiting
for the entire line to be fetched.
If the referenced address is not contained in the memory array or the associated line-fill buffer, the cache
initiates the required external fetch operation. In most situations, this is a 16-byte line-sized burst
reference.
The hardware implementation is a nonblocking design, meaning the ColdFire core's local bus is released
after the initial access of a miss. Thus, the cache or the SRAM module can service subsequent requests
while the remainder of the line is being fetched and loaded into the fill buffer.
External Data[31:0]
Local Address Bus
31
10
43 2 1 0
31
4
I or D Line Buffer Storage
Data Index
Tag Index
I or D Line
Buffer
Address
=
MUX
Fill Hit
31
11
TAG
VALID
0
31
0
0
DATA
511
127
=
MUX
Tag Hit
Local Data Bus
Figure 4-1. 2-Kbyte Cache Block Diagram
4.2
Memory Map/Register Definition
Three supervisor registers define the operation of the cache and local bus controller: the cache control
register (CACR) and two access control registers (ACR0, ACR1). Table 4-1 below shows the memory map
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
4-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Cache
of these registers. The CACR and ACRs can only be accessed in supervisor mode using the MOVEC
instruction with an Rc value of 0x002, 0x004 and 0x005, respectively.
Table 4-1. Cache Memory Map
BDM1
Register
Width
(bits)
Access2
Reset Value
Section/Page
0x002
Cache Control Register (CACR)
32
W
0x0000_0000
4.2.1/4-3
0x004
Access Control Register 0 (ACR0)
32
W
See Section
4.2.2/4-6
0x005
Access Control Register 1 (ACR1)
32
W
See Section
4.2.2/4-6
1
The values listed in this column represent the Rc field used when accessing the core registers via the BDM port. For
more information see Chapter 30, “Debug Support.”
2
Readable through debug.
4.2.1
Cache Control Register (CACR)
The CACR controls the operation of the cache. The CACR provides a set of default memory access
attributes used when a reference address does not map into the spaces defined by the ACRs.
The CACR is a 32-bit, write-only supervisor control register. It is accessed in the CPU address space via
the MOVEC instruction with an Rc encoding of 0x002. The CACR can be read when in background debug
mode (BDM). Therefore, the register diagram, Figure 4-2, is shown as read/write. At system reset, the
entire register is cleared.
BDM: 0x002 (CACR)
31
R
W
Reset
R
Access: Supervisor write-only
Debug read/write
30
29
0
0
0
0
0
0
15
14
13
0
0
0
0
0
0
CENB
28
27
26
25
0
0
0
0
12
11
10
0
0
0
0
CPD CFRZ
W
Reset
24
22
21
20
CINV
DISI
DISD
INVI
INVD
0
0
0
0
0
0
9
8
5
4
CEIB DCM DBWE
0
23
0
0
7
6
0
0
0
0
DWP EUSP
0
0
19
18
17
16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
3
2
0
0
0
0
CLNF
0
0
Figure 4-2. Cache Control Register (CACR)
Table 4-2. CACR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31
CENB
Cache enable. The memory array of the cache is enabled only if CENB is asserted. This bit, along with the DISI
(disable instruction caching) and DISD (disable data caching) bits, control the cache configuration.
0 Cache disabled
1 Cache enabled
Table 4-3 describes cache configuration.
30–29
Reserved, must be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
4-3
Cache
Table 4-2. CACR Field Descriptions (continued)
Field
Description
28
CPDI
Disable CPUSHL invalidation. When the privileged CPUSHL instruction is executed, the cache entry defined by bits
[10:4] of the address is invalidated if CPDI is cleared. If CPDI is set, no operation is performed.
0 Enable invalidation
1 Disable invalidation
27
CFRZ
Cache freeze. This field allows the user to freeze the contents of the cache. When CFRZ is asserted line fetches can
be initiated and loaded into the line-fill buffer, but a valid cache entry can not be overwritten. If a given cache location
is invalid, the contents of the line-fill buffer can be written into the memory array while CFRZ is asserted.
0 Normal Operation
1 Freeze valid cache lines
26–25
Reserved, must be cleared.
24
CINV
Cache invalidate. The cache invalidate operation is not a function of the CENB state (this operation is independent
of the cache being enabled or disabled). Setting this bit forces the cache to invalidate all, half, or none of the tag array
entries depending on the state of the DISI, DISD, INVI, and INVD bits. The invalidation process requires several
cycles of overhead plus 128 machine cycles to clear all tag array entries and 64 cycles to clear half of the tag array
entries, with a single cache entry cleared per machine cycle. The state of this bit is always read as a zero. After a
hardware reset, the cache must be invalidated before it is enabled.
0 No operation
1 Invalidate all cache locations
Table 4-4 describes how to set the cache invalidate all bit.
23
DISI
Disable instruction caching. When set, this bit disables instruction caching. This bit, along with the CENB (cache
enable) and DISD (disable data caching) bits, control the cache configuration. See the CENB definition for a detailed
description.
0 Enable instruction caching
1 Disable instruction caching
Table 4-3 describes cache configuration and Table 4-4 describes how to set the cache invalidate all bit.
22
DISD
Disable data caching. When set, this bit disables data caching. This bit, along with the CENB (cache enable) and
DISI (disable instruction caching) bits, control the cache configuration. See the CENB definition for a detailed
description.
0 Enable data caching
1 Disable data caching
Table 4-3 describes cache configuration and Table 4-4 describes how to set the cache invalidate all bit.
21
INVI
CINV instruction cache only. This bit can not be set unless the cache configuration is split (DISI and DISD cleared).
For instruction or data cache configurations this bit is a don’t-care. For the split cache configuration, this bit is part of
the control for the invalidate all operation. See the CINV definition for a detailed description
Table 4-4 describes how to set the cache invalidate all bit.
20
INVD
CINV data cache only. This bit can not be set unless the cache configuration is split (DISI and DISD cleared). For
instruction or data cache configurations this bit is a don’t-care. For the split cache configuration, this bit is part of the
control for the invalidate all operation. See the CINV definition for a detailed description
Table 4-4 describes how to set the cache invalidate all bit.
19–11
Reserved, must be cleared.
10
CEIB
Cache enable non-cacheable instruction bursting. Setting this bit enables the line-fill buffer to be loaded with burst
transfers under control of CLNF[1:0] for non-cacheable accesses. Non-cacheable accesses are never written into
the memory array. See Table 4-7.
0 Disable burst fetches on non-cacheable accesses
1 Enable burst fetches on non-cacheable accesses
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
4-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Cache
Table 4-2. CACR Field Descriptions (continued)
Field
Description
9
DCM
Default cache mode. This bit defines the default cache mode. For more information on the selection of the effective
memory attributes, see Section 4.3.2, “Memory Reference Attributes.
0 Caching enabled
1 Caching disabled
8
DBWE
Default buffered write enable. This bit defines the default value for enabling buffered writes. If DBWE = 0, the
termination of an operand write cycle on the processor's local bus is delayed until the external bus cycle is
completed. If DBWE = 1, the write cycle on the local bus is terminated immediately and the operation buffered in the
bus controller. In this mode, operand write cycles are effectively decoupled between the processor's local bus and
the external bus. Generally, enabled buffered writes provide higher system performance but recovery from access
errors can be more difficult. For the ColdFire core, reporting access errors on operand writes is always imprecise
and enabling buffered writes further decouples the write instruction and the signaling of the fault
0 Disable buffered writes
1 Enable buffered writes
7–6
Reserved, must be cleared.
5
DWP
Default write protection
0 Read and write accesses permitted
1 Only read accesses permitted
4
EUSP
Enable user stack pointer. See Section 2.2.3, “Supervisor/User Stack Pointers (A7 and OTHER_A7)”for more
information on the dual stack pointer implementation.
0 Disable the processor’s use of the User Stack Pointer
1 Enable the processor’s use of the User Stack Pointer
3–2
1–0
CLNF
Reserved, must be cleared.
Cache line fill. These bits control the size of the memory request the cache issues to the bus controller for different
initial instruction line access offsets. See Table 4-6 for external fetch size based on miss address and CLNF.
Table 4-3 shows the relationship between CACR[CENB, DISI, & DISD] bits and the cache configuration.
Table 4-3. Cache Configuration as Defined by CACR
CACR
[CENB]
CACR
[DISI]
CACR
[DISD]
Configuration
0
x
x
N/A
1
0
0
Split Instruction/
Data Cache
1 KByte direct-mapped instruction cache (uses upper
half of tag and storage arrays) and 1 KByte
direct-mapped write-through data cache (uses lower
half of tag and storage arrays)
1
0
1
Instruction Cache
2 KByte direct-mapped instruction cache (uses all of
tag and storage arrays)
1
1
0
Data Cache
Description
Cache is completely disabled
2 KByte direct-mapped write-through data cache
(uses all of tag and storage arrays)
Table 4-4 shows the relationship between CACR[DISI, DISD, INVI, & INVD] and setting the cache
invalidate all bit (CACR[CINV]).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
4-5
Cache
Table 4-4. Cache Invalidate All as Defined by CACR
4.2.2
CACR
[DISI]
CACR
[DISD]
CACR
[INVI]
CACR
[INVD]
0
0
0
0
Split Instruction/
Data Cache
Invalidate all entries in 1-KByte instruction
cache and 1-KByte data cache
0
0
0
1
Split Instruction/
Data Cache
Invalidate only 1 KByte data cache
0
0
1
0
Split Instruction
Data Cache
Invalidate only 1 KByte instruction cache
0
0
1
1
Split Instruction/
Data Cache
No invalidate
1
0
x
x
Instruction Cache
Invalidate 2 KByte instruction cache
0
1
x
x
Data Cache
Invalidate 2 KByte data cache
Configuration
Operation
Access Control Registers (ACR0, ACR1)
The ACRs provide a definition of memory reference attributes for two memory regions (one per ACR).
This set of effective attributes is defined for every memory reference using the ACRs or the set of default
attributes contained in the CACR. The ACRs are examined for every processor memory reference not
mapped to the flash or SRAM memories.
The ACRs are 32-bit, write-only supervisor control register. They are accessed in the CPU address space
via the MOVEC instruction with an Rc encoding of 0x004 and 0x005. The ACRs can be read when in
background debug mode (BDM). Therefore, the register diagram, Figure 4-3, is shown as read/write. At
system reset, both registers are disabled with ACRn[EN] cleared.
NOTE
IPSBAR space should not be cached. The combination of the CACR
defaults and the two ACRn registers must define the non-cacheable attribute
for this address space.
BDM: 0x004 (ACR0)
0x005 (ACR1)
Access: Supervisor write-only
BDM read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15
R
W
AB
AM
Reset – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
EN
0
14
13
SM
–
–
12
11
10
9
8
7
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
6
5
CM BWE
–
–
4
3
0
0
0
0
2
WP
–
1
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 4-3. Access Control Registers (ACRn)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
4-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Cache
Table 4-5. ACRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–24
AB
Address base. This 8-bit field is compared to address bits [31:24] from the processor's local bus under control of the
ACR address mask. If the address matches, the attributes for the memory reference are sourced from the given ACR.
23–16
AM
Address mask. Masks any AB bit. If a bit in the AM field is set, the corresponding bit of the address field comparison
is ignored.
15
EN
ACR Enable. Hardware reset clears this bit, disabling the ACR.
0 ACR disabled
1 ACR enabled
14–13
SM
Supervisor mode. Allows the given ACR to be applied to references based on operating privilege mode of the
ColdFire processor. The field uses the ACR for user references only, supervisor references only, or all accesses.
00 Match if user mode
01 Match if supervisor mode
1x Match always—ignore user/supervisor mode
12–7
Reserved, must be cleared.
6
CM
5
BWE
Cache mode.
0 Caching enabled
1 Caching disabled
Buffered write enable. Defines the value for enabling buffered writes. If BWE is cleared, the termination of an operand
write cycle on the processor's local bus is delayed until the system bus cycle is completed. Setting BWE terminates
the write cycle on the local bus immediately and the operation is then buffered in the bus controller. In this mode,
operand write cycles are effectively decoupled between the processor's local bus and the system bus.
Generally, the enabling of buffered writes provides higher system performance but recovery from access errors may
be more difficult.
For the V2 ColdFire core, the reporting of access errors on operand writes is always imprecise, and enabling buffered
writes simply decouples the write instruction from the signaling of the fault even more.
0 Writes are not buffered.
1 Writes are buffered.
4–3
Reserved, must be cleared.
2
WP
Write protect. Defines the write-protection attribute. If the effective memory attributes for a given access select the
WP bit, an access error terminates any attempted write with this bit set.
0 Read and write accesses permitted
1 Only read accesses permitted
1–0
Reserved, must be cleared.
4.3
Functional Description
The cache is physically connected to the ColdFire core's local bus, allowing it to service all fetches from
the ColdFire core and certain memory fetches initiated by the debug module. Typically, the debug module's
memory references appear as supervisor data accesses but the unit can be programmed to generate
user-mode accesses and/or instruction fetches. The cache processes any fetch access in the normal manner.
4.3.1
Interaction with Other Modules
Because the cache and high-speed SRAM module are connected to the ColdFire core's local data bus,
certain user-defined configurations can result in simultaneous fetch processing.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
4-7
Cache
If the referenced address is mapped into the SRAM module, that module services the request in a single
cycle. In this case, data accessed from the cache is simply discarded and no external memory references
are generated. If the address is not mapped into the SRAM space, the cache handles the request in the
normal fashion.
4.3.2
Memory Reference Attributes
For every memory reference the ColdFire core or the debug module generates, a set of effective attributes
is determined based on the address and the access control registers (ACRs). This set of attributes includes
the cacheable/non-cacheable definition, the precise/imprecise handling of operand write, and the
write-protect capability.
In particular, each address is compared to the values programmed in the ACRs. If the address matches one
of the ACR values, the access attributes from that ACR are applied to the reference. If the address does
not match either ACR, then the default value defined in the cache control register (CACR) is used. The
specific algorithm is as follows:
if (address == ACR0_address including mask)
Effective Attributes = ACR0 attributes
else if (address == ACR1_address including mask)
Effective Attributes = ACR1 attributes
else Effective Attributes = CACR default attributes
4.3.3
Cache Coherency and Invalidation
The cache does not monitor data references for accesses to cached instructions. Therefore, software must
maintain instruction cache coherency by invalidating the appropriate cache entries after modifying code
segments if instructions are cached.
The cache invalidation can be performed in several ways. For the instruction- or data-only configurations,
setting CACR[CINV] forces the entire cache to be marked as invalid. The invalidation operation requires
128 cycles because the cache sequences through the entire tag array, clearing a single location each cycle.
For the split configuration, CACR[INVI] and CACR[INVD] can be used in addition to CACR[CINV] to
clear the entire cache, only the instruction half, or only the data half. Any subsequent fetch accesses are
postponed until the invalidation sequence is complete.
The privileged CPUSHL instruction can invalidate a single cache line. When this instruction is executed,
the cache entry defined by bits [10:4] of the source address register is invalidated, provided CACR[CPDI]
is cleared. For the split data/instruction cache configuration, software directly controls bit 10 that selects
whether an instruction cache or data cache line is being accessed.
These invalidation operations can be initiated from the ColdFire core or the debug module.
4.3.4
Reset
A hardware reset clears the CACR and disables the cache. The contents of the tag array are not affected
by the reset. Accordingly, the system startup code must explicitly perform a cache invalidation by setting
CACR[CINV] before the cache can be enabled.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
4-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Cache
4.3.5
Cache Miss Fetch Algorithm/Line Fills
As discussed in Section 4.1.2, “Introduction,” the cache hardware includes a 16-byte, line-fill buffer for
providing temporary storage for the last fetched line.
With the cache enabled as defined by CACR[CENB], a cacheable fetch that misses in the tag memory and
the line-fill buffer generates an external fetch. For data misses, the size of the external fetch is always 16
bytes. For instruction misses, the size of the external fetch is determined by the value contained in the 2-bit
CLNF field of the CACR and the miss address. Table 4-6 shows the relationship between the CLNF bits,
the miss address, and the size of the external fetch.
Table 4-6. Initial Fetch Offset vs. CLNF Bits
Longword Address Bits[3:2]
CLNF[1:0]
00
01
10
11
00
Line
Line
Line
Longword
01
Line
Line
Longword
Longword
1X
Line
Line
Line
Line
Depending on the runtime characteristics of the application and the memory response speed, overall
performance may be increased by programming the CLNF bits to values 00 or 01.
For all cases of a line-sized fetch, the critical longword defined by bits [3:2] of the miss address is accessed
first followed by the remaining three longwords that are accessed by incrementing the longword address
in a modulo-16 fashion as shown below:
if miss address[3:2] = 00
fetch sequence = 0x0, 0x4, 0x8, 0xC
if miss address[3:2] = 01
fetch sequence = 0x4, 0x8, 0xC, 0x0
if miss address[3:2] = 10
fetch sequence = 0x8, 0xC, 0x0, 0x4
if miss address[3:2] = 11
fetch sequence = 0xC, 0x0, 0x4, 0x8
After an external fetch has been initiated and the data is loaded into the line-fill buffer, the cache maintains
a special most-recently-used indicator that tracks the contents of the associated line-fill buffer versus its
corresponding cache location. At the time of the miss, the hardware indicator is set, marking the line-fill
buffer as most recently used. If a subsequent access occurs to the cache location defined by bits [10:4] (or
bits [9:4] for split configurations of the fill buffer address), the data in the cache memory array is now most
recently used, so the hardware indicator is cleared. In all cases, the indicator defines whether the contents
of the line-fill buffer or the memory data array are most recently used. At the time of the next cache miss,
the contents of the line-fill buffer are written into the memory array if the entire line is present, and the
line-fill buffer data is most recently used compared to the memory array.
Generally, longword references are used for sequential instruction fetches. If the processor branches to an
odd word address, a word-sized instruction fetch is generated.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
4-9
Cache
For instruction fetches, the fill buffer can also be used as temporary storage for line-sized bursts of
non-cacheable references under control of CACR[CEIB]. With this bit set, a non-cacheable instruction
fetch is processed, as defined by Table 4-7. For this condition, the line-fill buffer is loaded and subsequent
references can hit in the buffer, but the data is never loaded into the memory array.
Table 4-7 shows the relationship between CACR bits CENB and CEIB and the type of instruction fetch.
Table 4-7. Instruction Cache Operation as Defined by CACR
CACR
[CENB]
CACR
[CEIB]
Type of
Instruction Fetch
0
0
N/A
Cache is completely disabled; all instruction fetches
are word or longword in size.
0
1
N/A
All instruction fetches are word or longword in size
1
X
Cacheable
1
0
Non-cacheable
All instruction fetches are word or longword in size,
and not loaded into the line-fill buffer
1
1
Non-cacheable
Instruction fetch size is defined by Table 4-6 and
loaded into the line-fill buffer, but are never written into
the memory array.
Description
Fetch size is defined by Table 4-6 and contents of the
line-fill buffer can be written into the memory array
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
4-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 5
Static RAM (SRAM)
5.1
•
•
•
•
•
5.2
SRAM Features
One 64-Kbyte SRAM
Single-cycle access
Physically located on processor's high-speed local bus
Memory location programmable on any 0-modulo-64 Kbyte address
Byte, word, longword address capabilities
SRAM Operation
The SRAM module provides a general-purpose memory block that the ColdFire processor can access in a
single cycle. The location of the memory block can be specified to any 0-modulo-64K address within the
4-GByte address space. The memory is ideal for storing critical code or data structures or for use as the
system stack. Because the SRAM module is physically connected to the processor's high-speed local bus,
it can service processor-initiated access or memory-referencing commands from the debug module.
Depending on configuration information, instruction fetches may be sent to both the cache and the SRAM
block simultaneously. If the reference is mapped into the region defined by the SRAM, the SRAM
provides the data back to the processor, and the cache data discarded. Accesses from the SRAM module
are not cached.
The SRAM is dual-ported to provide DMA access. The SRAM is partitioned into two physical memory
arrays to allow simultaneous access to both arrays by the processor core and another bus master. See
Chapter 8, “System Control Module (SCM)” for more information.
5.3
SRAM Programming Model
The SRAM programming model includes a description of the SRAM base address register (RAMBAR),
SRAM initialization, and power management.
5.3.1
SRAM Base Address Register (RAMBAR)
The configuration information in the SRAM base address register (RAMBAR) controls the operation of
the SRAM module.
• The RAMBAR holds the base address of the SRAM. The MOVEC instruction provides write-only
access to this register.
• The RAMBAR can be read or written from the debug module in a similar manner.
• All undefined bits in the register are reserved. These bits are ignored during writes to the
RAMBAR, and return zeroes when read from the debug module.
• The RAMBAR valid bit is cleared by reset, disabling the SRAM module. All other bits are
unaffected.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
5-1
Static RAM (SRAM)
The RAMBAR contains several control fields. These fields are shown in Figure 5-1
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
Field BA31 BA30 BA29 BA28 BA27 BA26 BA25 BA24 BA23 BA22 BA21 BA20 BA19 BA18 BA17 BA16
Reset
Undefined
R/W
W
15
14
Field
13
—
12
11
10
9
8
PRI1 PRI2 SPV
Reset
7
WP
6
—
5
4
3
2
1
0
C/I
SC
SD
UC
UD
V
Undefined
R/W
0
W
Address
CPU + 0xC05
Figure 5-1. SRAM Base Address Register (RAMBAR)
Table 5-1. SRAM Base Address Register
Bits
Name
Description
31–16
BA
Base address. Defines the 0-modulo-64K base address of the SRAM module. By
programming this field, the SRAM may be located on any 64-Kbyte boundary within the
processor’s 4-Gbyte address space.
15–12
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
11–10
PRI1, PRI2
Priority bit. PRI1 determines if DMA or CPU has priority in upper 32k bank of memory. PRI2
determines if DMA or CPU has priority in lower 32k bank of memory. If bit is set, CPU has
priority. If bit is cleared, DMA has priority. Priority is determined according to the following
table.
PRI[1:2]
Upper Bank
Priority
Lower Bank
Priority
00
01
10
11
DMA Accesses
DMA Accesses
CPU Accesses
CPU Accesses
DMA Accesses
CPU Accesses
DMA Accesses
CPU Accesses
NOTE: The Freescale-recommended setting for the priority bits is 00.
9
SPV
Secondary port valid. Allows access by DMA
0 DMA access to memory is disabled.
1 DMA access to memory is enabled.
NOTE: The BDE bit in the second RAMBAR register must also be set to allow dual port
access to the SRAM. For more information, see Section 8.4.2, “Memory Base Address
Register (RAMBAR).”
8
WP
Write protect. Allows only read accesses to the SRAM. When this bit is set, any attempted
write access will generate an access error exception to the ColdFire processor core.
0 Allows read and write accesses to the SRAM module
1 Allows only read accesses to the SRAM module
7–6
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
5-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Static RAM (SRAM)
Table 5-1. SRAM Base Address Register (continued)
Bits
Name
Description
5–1
C/I, SC, SD,
UC, UD
Address space masks (ASn)
These five bit fields allow certain types of accesses to be “masked,” or inhibited from
accessing the SRAM module. The address space mask bits are:
C/I = CPU space/interrupt acknowledge cycle mask
SC = Supervisor code address space mask
SD = Supervisor data address space mask
UC = User code address space mask
UD = User data address space mask
For each address space bit:
0 An access to the SRAM module can occur for this address space
1 Disable this address space from the SRAM module. If a reference using this address
space is made, it is inhibited from accessing the SRAM module, and is processed like
any other non-SRAM reference.
These bits are useful for power management as detailed in Section 5.3.4, “Power
Management.”
0
5.3.2
V
Valid. A hardware reset clears this bit. When set, this bit enables the SRAM module;
otherwise, the module is disabled.
0 Contents of RAMBAR are not valid
1 Contents of RAMBAR are valid
SRAM Initialization
After a hardware reset, the contents of the SRAM module are undefined. The valid bit of the RAMBAR
is cleared, disabling the module. If the SRAM requires initialization with instructions or data, the
following steps should be performed:
1. Load the RAMBAR mapping the SRAM module to the desired location within the address space.
2. Read the source data and write it to the SRAM. There are various instructions to support this
function, including memory-to-memory move instructions, or the MOVEM opcode. The
MOVEM instruction is optimized to generate line-sized burst fetches on 0-modulo-16 addresses,
so this opcode generally provides maximum performance.
3. After the data has been loaded into the SRAM, it may be appropriate to load a revised value into
the RAMBAR with a new set of attributes. These attributes consist of the write-protect and
address space mask fields.
The ColdFire processor or an external emulator using the debug module can perform these initialization
functions.
5.3.3
SRAM Initialization Code
The following code segment describes how to initialize the SRAM. The code sets the base address of the
SRAM at 0x20000000 and then initializes the SRAM to zeros.
RAMBASE
EQU $20000000
;set this variable to $20000000
RAMVALID
EQU $00000001
move.l
#RAMBASE+RAMVALID,D0
;load RAMBASE + valid bit into D0.
movec.l
D0, RAMBAR
;load RAMBAR and enable SRAM
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
5-3
Static RAM (SRAM)
The following loop initializes the entire SRAM to zero
lea.l
RAMBASE,A0
;load pointer to SRAM
move.l
#16384,D0
;load loop counter into D0
clr.l
(A0)+)
;clear 4 bytes of SRAM
subq.l
#1,D0
;decrement loop counter
bne.b
SRAM_INIT_LOOP
;if done, then exit; else continue looping
SRAM_INIT_LOOP:
5.3.4
Power Management
As noted previously, depending on the configuration defined by the RAMBAR, instruction fetch and
operand read accesses may be sent to the SRAM and cache simultaneously. If the access is mapped to the
SRAM module, it sources the read data and the unified cache access is discarded. If the SRAM is used
only for data operands, asserting the ASn bits associated with instruction fetches can decrease power
dissipation. Additionally, if the SRAM contains only instructions, masking operand accesses can reduce
power dissipation. Table 5-2 shows some examples of typical RAMBAR settings.
Table 5-2. Typical RAMBAR Setting Examples
Data Contained in SRAM
RAMBAR[7:0]
Code Only
0x2B
Data Only
0x35
Both Code And Data
0x21
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
5-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 6
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
The MCF5282 incorporates SuperFlash® technology licensed from SST. The ColdFire Flash Module
(CFM) is constructed with eight banks of 32K x 16-bit Flash to generate a 512-Kbyte, 32-bit wide
electrically erasable and programmable read-only memory array. The CFM is ideal for program and data
storage for single-chip applications and allows for field reprogramming without external high-voltage
sources.
The voltage required to program and erase the Flash is generated internally by on-chip charge pumps.
Program and erase operations are performed under CPU control through a command-driven interface to
an internal state machine. All Flash physical blocks can be programmed or erased at the same time;
however, it is not possible to read from a Flash physical block while the same block is being programmed
or erased. The array used makes it possible to program or erase one pair of Flash physical blocks under the
control of software routines executing out of another pair.
NOTE
The MCF5281 and MCF5214 implements only 256 Kbytes of Flash; half
that of the MCF5282 and MCF5216.
The MCF5280 does not contain a Flash module.
6.1
Features
Features of the CFM include:
• 512-Kbytes of Flash memory on the MCF5282 and MCF5216
• 256-Kbytes of Flash memory on the MCF5281 and MCF5214
• Basic Flash access time of 2 clock cycles. Optimized processor Flash interface reduces basic Flash
access time through interleaving and speculative reads.
• Automated program and erase operation
• Concurrent verify, program, and erase of all array blocks
• Read-while-write capability
• Optional interrupt on command completion
• Flexible scheme for protection against accidental program or erase operations
• Access restriction controls for both supervisor/user and data/program space operations
• Security for single-chip applications
• Single power supply (system VDD) used for all module operations
• Auto-sense amplifier timeout for low-power, low-frequency read operations
NOTE
Enabling Flash security will disable BDM communications.
NOTE
When Flash security is enabled, the chip will boot in single-chip mode
regardless of the external reset configuration.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-1
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.2
Block Diagram
The CFM module shown in Figure 6-1 contains the Flash physical blocks, the ColdFire Flash bus and IP
bus interfaces, Flash interface, register blocks, and the BIST engine.
Each 128-Kbyte Flash physical block is arranged as two 32,768-word (16 bits) memory arrays. Each of
these memory arrays is designated as xH or xL, where x represents one of the four Flash physical blocks
(0–3) and H/L represents the high or low 16 bits of each longword of logical memory. Each of these words
may be read as either individual bytes or aligned words. Aligned longword access is provided by
concatenating the outputs of the each of the two memory arrays within the Flash physical block. Simple
reads of bytes, aligned words, and aligned longwords require two 66-MHz clock cycles, although the
processor’s Flash interface includes logic that reduces the effective access time through two-way longword
interleaving and speculative reads.
Flash physical blocks are interleaved on longword (4-byte) boundaries. Therefore, all Flash program,
erase, and verify commands operate on adjacent Flash physical blocks and are initiated with a single
aligned 32-bit write to the appropriate array location. Any other write operation will cause a cycle
termination transfer error. Page erase operates simultaneously on two interleaving erase pages in adjacent
Flash physical blocks. Each Flash physical block is organized as 1024 rows of 128 bytes with a single erase
page consisting of 8 rows (1024 bytes). Since page erase operates simultaneously on two interleaving and
adjacent physical Flash blocks, each erase row is comprised of four 16-bit entries in each of two memory
arrays within each of two Flash physical blocks. The first row of Flash is made up of 0H_0L_1H_1L [0]
through 0H_0L_1H_1L [31], where each [n] represents four 16-bit words from each memory array in each
of two physical blocks, for a total of 256 bytes. Since a single erase page consists of 8 rows of 256 bytes,
or 2048 bytes, the first erase page is physically located at 0H_0L_1H_1L [0] through 0H_0L_1H_1L
[255]. Mass erase operates simultaneously on two adjacent Flash physical blocks in their entirety and
erases a total of 256 Kbytes of Flash space. Therefore, it takes two mass erase operations, one on mass
erase block 0 and one on mass erase block 1, to erase the full 512K CFM Flash on the MCF5282 and
MCF5216.
An erased Flash bit reads 1 and a programmed Flash bit reads 0. The CFM features a sense amplifier
timeout (SATO) block that automatically reduces current consumption during reads at low system clock
frequencies.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-2
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Internal Bus
Memory Array
Block 0H
32K x 16
Flash Physical
Block 3
Memory Array
Block 0L
32K x 16
SATO
SATO
•
•
•
Flash Physical
Block 0
Memory Array
Block 3H
32K x 16
SATO
Memory Array
Block 3L
32K x 16
SATO
Flash Interface
BIST
Engine
Flash Control Registers
VDDF
VSSF
Backdoor Access
Note:
Mass Erase Block 0 (256 Kbytes) = Flash Physical Block 0 and Flash Physical Block 1.
Mass Erase Block 1 (256 Kbytes) = Flash Physical Block 2 and Flash Physical Block 3 (MCF5282 and MCF5216 only)
Figure 6-1. CFM Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-3
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.3
Memory Map
Figure 6-2 shows the memory map for the CFM array. The CFM array can reside anywhere in the memory
space of the MCU. The starting address of the array is determined by the CFM array base address which
must reside on a natural size boundary; that is, the CFM array base address must be an integer multiple of
the array size. The CFM register space must reside on a 64 byte boundary as determined by the CFM
register base address. Figure 6-2 shows how multiple 32,768 by 16-bit Flash physical blocks interleave to
form a contiguous non-volatile memory space. Each pair of 32-bit blocks (even and odd) interleave every
4 bytes to form a 256-Kbyte section of memory.
NOTE
The CFM on the MCF5281 and MCF5214 is constructed with four banks of
32K x 16-bit Flash arrays to generate 256 Kbytes of 32-bit Flash memory.
Logical Block 1 (256 Kbytes)
0x0007 FFFF
Flash Physical Block 2
0x0004 000C
3H[1]
3L[1]
0x0004 0008
2H[1]
2L[1]
0x0004 0004
3H[0]
3L[0]
0x0004 0000
2H[0]
2L[0]
2H[31]
2L[31]
3H[31]
3L[31]
Memory
Array 2H
Memory
Array 2L
Memory
Array 3H
Memory
Array 3L
2H[0]
2L[0]
3H[0]
3L[0]
0x0003 FFFF
Logical Block 0 (256 Kbytes)
Flash Physical Block 0
Configuration Field
(0x0000_0400–
0x0000_0417)
1
Flash Physical Block 3
0x0000 000C
1H[1]
1L[1]
0x0000 0008
0H[1]
0L[1]
0x0000 0004
1H[1]
1L[1]
0x0000 0000
0H[0]
0L[0]
Flash Physical Block 1
0H[31]
0L[31]
1H[31]
1L[31]
Memory
Array 0H
Memory
Array 0L
Memory
Array 1H
Memory
Array 1L
0H[0]
0L[0]
1H[0]
1L[0]
The MCF5281 and MCF5214 support only Logical Block 0.
Each memory array = 64 Kbytes
(16 bits wide × 32K)
Each physical block = 128 Kbytes
(32 bits wide × 32K)
Figure 6-2. CFM Array Memory Map
The CFM module has hardware interlocks to protect data from accidental corruption. The <<BLOCK
NAME>> memory array is logically divided into 16-Kbyte sectors for the purpose of data protection and
access control. A flexible scheme allows the protection of any combination of logical sectors (see
Section 6.3.4.4, “CFM Protection Register (CFMPROT)”). A similar mechanism is available to control
supervisor/user and program/data space access to these sectors.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-4
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.3.1
CFM Configuration Field
The CFM configuration field comprises 24 bytes of reserved array memory space that determines the
module protection and access restrictions out of reset. Data to secure the Flash from unauthorized access
is also stored in the CFM configuration field. Table 6-1 describes each byte used in this field.
Table 6-1. CFM Configuration Field
Address Offset (from array
base address)
Size
in Bytes
0x0000_0400–0x0000_0407
8
Back door comparison key
0x0000_0408–0x0000_040B
4
Flash program/erase sector protection
Blocks 0H/0L (see Section 6.3.4.4, “CFM Protection Register
(CFMPROT)”)
0x0000_040C–0x0000_040F
4
Flash supervisor/user space restrictions
Blocks 0H/0L (see Section 6.3.4.5, “CFM Supervisor Access Register
(CFMSACC)”)
0x0000_0410–0x0000_0413
4
Flash program/data space restrictions
Blocks 0H/0L (see Section 6.3.4.6, “CFM Data Access Register
(CFMDACC)”)
0x0000_0414–0x0000_0417
4
Flash security longword (see Section 6.3.4.3, “CFM Security Register
(CFMSEC)”)
6.3.2
Description
Flash Base Address Register (FLASHBAR)
The configuration information in the Flash base address register (FLASHBAR) controls the operation of
the Flash module.
• The FLASHBAR holds the base address of the Flash. The MOVEC instruction provides write-only
access to this register.
• The FLASHBAR can be read or written from the debug module in a similar manner.
• All undefined bits in the register are reserved. These bits are ignored during writes to the
FLASHBAR, and return zeroes when read from the debug module.
• The back door enable bit, FLASHBAR[BDE], is cleared at reset, disabling back door access to the
Flash.
• The FLASHBAR valid bit is programmed according to the chip mode selected at reset (see
Chapter 27, “Chip Configuration Module (CCM)” for more details). All other bits are unaffected.
The FLASHBAR register contains several control fields. These fields are shown in Figure 6-3
NOTE
The default value of the FLASHBAR is determined by the chip
configuration selected at reset (see Chapter 27, “Chip Configuration
Module (CCM)” for more information). If external boot mode is used, then
the FLASHBAR located in the processor’s CPU space will be invalid and it
must be initialized with the valid bit set before the CPU (or modules) can
access the on-chip Flash.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-5
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
NOTE
Flash accesses (reads/writes) by a bus master other than the core, (DMA
controller or Fast Ethernet Controller), or writes to Flash by the core during
programming must use the backdoor Flash address of IPSBAR plus an
offset of 0x0400_0000. For example, for a DMA transfer from the first
location of Flash when IPSBAR is still at its default location of
0x4000_0000, the source register would be loaded with 0x4400_0000.
Backdoor access to Flash for reads can be made by the bus master, but it
takes 2 cycles longer than a direct read of the Flash if using its FLASHBAR
address.
NOTE
The Flash is marked as valid on reset based on the RCON (reset
configuration) pin state. Flash space is valid on reset when booting in single
chip mode (RCON pin asserted and D[26]/D[17]/D[16] set to 110), or when
booting internally in master mode (RCON asserted and D[26]/D[17]/D[16]
are set to 111 and D[18] and D[19] are set to 00). See Chapter 27, “Chip
Configuration Module (CCM)” for more details. When the default reset
configuration is not overriden, the device (by default) boots in single chip
mode and the Flash space will be marked as valid at address 0x0. The Flash
configuration field is checked during the reset sequence to see if the Flash
is secured. If it is the part will always boot from internal Flash, since it will
be marked as valid, regardless of what is done for chip configuration.
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
Field BA31 BA30 BA29 BA28 BA27 BA26 BA25 BA24 BA23 BA22 BA21 BA20 BA19
Reset
R/W
15
9
—
Address
8
WP
Reset
R/W
—
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
Field
16
7
6
—
5
4
3
2
1
0
C/I
SC
SD
UC
UD
V
0000_0001_0010_000
R
See
Note
R/W
CPU + 0xC04
Note: The reset value for the valid bit is determined by the chip mode selected at reset (see Chapter 27,
“Chip Configuration Module (CCM)”).
Figure 6-3. Flash Base Address Register (FLASHBAR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-6
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Table 6-2. FLASHBAR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
31–19
BA[31:18]
18–9
—
8
WP
7–6
—
5–1
Description
Base address field. Defines the 0-modulo-512K base address of the Flash
module. By programming this field, the Flash may be located on any 512Kbyte
boundary within the processor’s four gigabyte address space.
Reserved, should be cleared.
Write protect. Read only. Allows only read accesses to the Flash. This bit is
always set and any attempted write access will generate an access error
exception to the ColdFire processor core.
0 Allows read and write accesses to the Flash module
1 Allows only read accesses to the Flash module
Reserved, should be cleared.
C/I, SC, SD, UC, Address space masks (ASn).
UD
These five bit fields allow certain types of accesses to be “masked,” or inhibited
from accessing the Flash module. The address space mask bits are:
C/I
SC
SD
UC
UD
CPU space/interrupt acknowledge cycle mask
Supervisor code address space mask
Supervisor data address space mask
User code address space mask
User data address space mask
For each address space bit:
0 An access to the Flash module can occur for this address space
1 Disable this address space from the Flash module. If a reference using this
address space is made, it is inhibited from accessing the Flash module, and is
processed like any other non-Flash reference.
These bits are useful for power management as detailed in Chapter 7, “Power
Management.”
0
6.3.3
V
Valid. When set, this bit enables the Flash module; otherwise, the module is
disabled.
0 Contents of FLASHBAR are not valid
1 Contents of FLASHBAR are valid
CFM Registers
The CFM module also contains a set of control and status registers. The memory map for these registers
and their accessibility in supervisor and user modes is shown in Table 6-3.
Table 6-3. CFM Register Address Map
IPSBAR Offset
0x1D_0000
Bits 31–24
Bits 15–8
Bits 7–0
Access1
CFMCLKD
Reserved2
S
Bits 23–16
CFMMCR
2
0x1D_0004
Reserved
0x1D_0008
CFMSEC
S
S
0x1D_000C
Reserved
2
S
0x1D_0010
CFMPROT
S
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-7
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Table 6-3. CFM Register Address Map
IPSBAR Offset
Bits 31–24
Bits 23–16
Bits 15–8
Access1
Bits 7–0
0x1D_0014
CFMSACC
S
0x1D_0018
CFMDACC
S
0x1D_001C
2
S
Reserved
0x1D_0020
CFMUSTAT
Reserved2
S
0x1D_0024
CFMCMD
Reserved2
S
1
S = Supervisor access only. User mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in a
cycle termination transfer error.
2
Addresses not assigned to a register and undefined register bits are reserved for expansion. Write accesses
to these reserved address spaces and reserved register bits have no effect.
6.3.4
Register Descriptions
The Flash registers are described in this subsection.
6.3.4.1
CFM Configuration Register (CFMCR)
The CFMCR is used to configure and control the operation of the CFM array.
15
Field
11
—
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
LOCK PVIE AEIE CBEIE CCIE KEYACC
Reset
0
—
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1D_0000
Figure 6-4. CFM Module Configuration Register (CFMCR)
Bits 10 -5 in the CFMCR register are readable and writable with restrictions.
Table 6-4. CFMCR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
15–11
—
10
LOCK
Write lock control. The LOCK bit is always readable and is set once.
1 CFMPROT, CMFSACC, and CFMDACC register are write-locked.
0 CFMPROT, CMFSACC, and CFMDACC register are writable.
9
PVIE
Protection violation interrupt enable. The PVIE bit is readable and writable. The
PVIE bit enables an interrupt in case the protection violation flag, PVIOL, is set.
1 An interrupt will be requested whenever the PVIOL flag is set.
0 PVIOL interrupts disabled.
8
AEIE
Access error interrupt enable. The AEIE bit is readable and writable. The AEIE bit
enables an interrupt in case the access error flag, ACCERR, is set.
1 An interrupt will be requested whenever the ACCERR flag is set.
0 ACCERR interrupts disabled.
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-8
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Table 6-4. CFMCR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7
CBEIE
Command buffer empty interrupt enable. The CBEIE bit is readable and writable.
CBEIE enables an interrupt request when the command buffer for the Flash
physical blocks is empty.
1 Request an interrupt whenever the CBEIF flag is set.
0 Command buffer empty interrupts disabled
6
CCIE
5
KEYACC
4–0
—
6.3.4.2
Command complete interrupt enable. The CCIE bit is readable and writable.
CCIE enables an interrupt when the command executing for the Flash is
complete.
1 Request an interrupt whenever the CCIF flag is set.
0 Command complete interrupts disabled
Enable security key writing. The KEYACC bit is readable and only writable if the
KEYEN bit in the CFMSEC register is set.
1 Writes to the Flash array are interpreted as keys to open the back door.
0 Writes to the Flash array are interpreted as the start of a program, erase, or
verify sequence.
Reserved, should be cleared.
CFM Clock Divider Register (CFMCLKD)
The CFMCLKD is used to set the frequency of the clock used for timed events in program and erase
algorithms.
Field
7
6
DIVLD
PRDIV8
Reset
5
0
DIV
0000_0000
R/W
R
Address
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1D_0002
Figure 6-5. CFM Clock Divider Register (CFMCLKD)
All bits in CFMCLKD are readable. Bit 7 is a read-only status bit, while bits 6–0 can only be written once.
Table 6-5. CFMCLKD Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
7
DIVLD
6
PRDIV8
5–0
DIV
Description
Clock divider loaded
1 CFMCLKD has been written since the last reset.
0 CFMCLKD has not been written.
Enable prescaler divide by 8
1 Enables a prescaler that divides the CFM clock by 8 before it enters the
CFMCLKD divider.
0 The CFM clock is fed directly into the CFMCLKD divider.
Clock divider field. The combination of PRDIV8 and DIV[5:0] effectively divides the
CFM input clock down to a frequency between 150 kHz and 200 kHz. The
frequency range of the CFM clock is 150 kHz to 102.4 MHz.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-9
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
NOTE
CFMCLKD must be written with an appropriate value before programming
or erasing the Flash array. Refer to Section 6.4.3.1, “Setting the CFMCLKD
Register.”
6.3.4.3
CFM Security Register (CFMSEC)
The CFMSEC controls the Flash security features.
NOTE
Enabling Flash security will disable BDM communications.
NOTE
When Flash security is enabled, the chip will boot in single-chip mode
regardless of the external reset configuration.
31
30
29
16
Field KEYEN SECSTAT
Reset
—
See Note
R/W
R
15
0
Field
SEC
Reset
See Note
R/W
R
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1D_0008
Note: The SECSTAT bit reset value is determined by the security state of the Flash. All other bits in the register
are loaded at reset from the Flash Security longword stored at the array base address + 0x0000_0414.
Figure 6-6. CFM Security Register (CFMSEC)
Table 6-6. CFMSEC Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
31
KEYEN
30
SECSTAT
Description
Enable back door key to security
1 Back door to Flash is enabled.
0 Back door to Flash is disabled.
Flash security status
1 Flash security is enabled
0 Flash security is disabled
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-10
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Table 6-6. CFMSEC Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
29–16
—
15–0
SEC[15:0]
Description
Reserved. Should be cleared.
Security field. The SEC bits define the security state of the device; see below.
1
SEC[15:0]
Description
0x4AC8
Flash secured1
All other combinations
Flash unsecured
The 0x4AC8 value was chosen because it represents the ColdFire Halt
instruction, making it unlikely that compiled code accidentally programmed
at the security longword in the Flash configuration field location would
unintentionally secure the device.
The security features of the CFM are described in Section 6.5, “Flash Security Operation.”
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-11
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.3.4.4
CFM Protection Register (CFMPROT)
The CFMPROT specifies which Flash logical sectors are protected from program and erase operations.
31
16
Field
PROT
Reset
See Note
R/W
R/W
15
0
Field
PROT
Reset
See Note
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1D_0010
Note: The CFMPROT register is loaded at reset from the Flash Program/Erase Sector Protection longword
stored at the array base address + 0x0000_0400.
Figure 6-7. CFM Protection Register (CFMPROT)
The CFMPROT register is always readable and only writeable when LOCK = 0. To change which logical
sectors are protected on a temporary basis, write CFMPROT with a new value after the LOCK bit in
CFMCR has been cleared. To change the value of CFMPROT that will be loaded on reset, the protection
byte in the Flash configuration field must first be temporarily unprotected using the method just described
before reprogramming the protection bytes. Then the Flash Protection longword at offset 0x1D_0400 must
be written with the desired value.
Table 6-7. CFMPROT Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
31–0
PROT[31:0]
Description
Sector protection. Each Flash logical sector can be protected from program and
erase operations by setting its corresponding PROT bit.
1 Logical sector is protected.
0 Logical sector is not protected.
The CFMPROT controls the protection of thirty-two 16-Kbyte Flash logical sectors in the 512-Kbyte
Flash array. Figure 6-8 shows the association between each bit in the CFMPROT and its corresponding
logical sector.
NOTE
Since the MCF5281 and MCF5214 devices contain a 256-Kbyte Flash, only
CFMPROT[15:0] is used.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-12
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
(ARRAY_BASE + 0x0007_FFFF)
SECTOR 31
PROTECT[31]
(ARRAY_BASE + 0x0007_C000)
•
•
•
PROTECT[2]
}
16Kbyte Sector
SECTOR 2
Protected Flash Logical Sectors
as defined by CFMPROT register
(ARRAY_BASE + 0x0000_8000)
SECTOR 1
(ARRAY_BASE + 0x0000_4000)
SECTOR 0
(ARRAY_BASE + 0x0000_0000)
Figure 6-8. CFMPROT Protection Diagram
6.3.4.5
CFM Supervisor Access Register (CFMSACC)
The CFMSACC specifies the supervisor/user access permissions of Flash logical sectors.
31
16
Field
SUPV
Reset
See Note
R/W
R/W
15
0
Field
SUPV
Reset
See Note
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1D_0014
Note: The CFMPROT register is loaded at reset from the Flash Supervisor/user Space Restrictions longword
stored at the array base address + 0x0000_040C.
Figure 6-9. CFM Supervisor Access Register (CFMSACC)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-13
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Table 6-8. CFMSACC Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
31–0
SUPV[31:0]
Supervisor address space assignment. The SUPV[31:0] bits are always readable
and only writable when LOCK = 0. Each Flash logical sector can be mapped into
supervisor or unrestricted address space. CFMSACC uses the same
correspondence between logical sectors and register bits as does CFMPROT. See
Figure 6-8 for details.
When a logical sector is mapped into supervisor address space, only CPU
supervisor accesses will be allowed. A CPU user access to a location in supervisor
address space will result in a cycle termination transfer error. When a logical sector
is mapped into unrestricted address space both supervisor and user accesses are
allowed.
1 Logical sector is mapped in supervisor address space.
0 Logical sector is mapped in unrestricted address space.
6.3.4.6
CFM Data Access Register (CFMDACC)
The CFMDACC specifies the data/program access permissions of Flash logical sectors.
31
16
Field
DATA
Reset
See Note
R/W
R/W
15
0
Field
DATA
Reset
See Note
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1D_0018
Note: The CFMPROT register is loaded at reset from the Flash Program/Data Space Restrictions longword
stored at the array base address + 0x0000_0410.
Figure 6-10. CFM Data Access Register (CFMDACC)
Table 6-9. CFMDACC Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
31–0
DATA[31:0]
Data address space assignment. The DATA[31:0] bits are always readable and only
writable when LOCK = 0. Each Flash logical sector can be mapped into data or
both data and program address space. CFMDACC uses the same correspondence
between logical sectors and register bits as does CFMPROT. See Figure 6-8 for
details.
When a logical sector is mapped into data address space, only CPU data accesses
will be allowed. A CPU program access to a location in data address space will
result in a cycle termination transfer error. When an array sector is mapped into
both data and program address space both data and program accesses are
allowed.
1 Logical sector is mapped in data address space.
0 Logical sector is mapped in data and program address space.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-14
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.3.4.7
CFM User Status Register (CFMUSTAT)
The CFMUSTAT reports Flash state machine command status, array access errors, protection violations,
and blank check status.
Field
7
6
CBEIF
CCIF
Reset
5
1
PVIOL ACCERR
—
BLANK
0
—
1100_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
R
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1D_0020
Figure 6-11. CFM User Status Register (CFMUSTAT)
NOTE
Only one CFMUSTAT bit should be cleared at a time.
Table 6-10. CFMUSTAT Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7
CBEIF
Command buffer empty interrupt flag. The CBEIF flag indicates that the command
buffer for the interleaved Flash physical blocks is empty and that a new command
sequence can be started. Clear CBEIF by writing it to 1. Writing a 0 to CBEIF has
no effect but can be used to abort a command sequence. The CBEIF bit can trigger
an interrupt request if the CBEIE bit is set in CFMMCR. While CBEIF is clear, the
CFMCMD register is not writable.
1 Command buffer is ready to accept a new command.
0 Command buffer is full.
6
CCIF
Command complete interrupt flag. The CCIF flag indicates that no commands are
pending for the Flash physical blocks. CCIF is set and cleared automatically upon
start and completion of a command. Writing to CCIF has no effect. The CCIF bit
can trigger an interrupt request if the CCIE bit is set in CFMCR.
1 All commands are completed
0 Command in progress
5
PVIOL
Protection violation flag. The PVIOL flag indicates an attempt was made to initiate
a program or erase operation in a Flash logical sector denoted as protected by
CFMPROT. Clear PVIOL by writing it to 1. Writing a 0 to PVIOL has no effect. While
PVIOL is set in any this register, it is not possible to launch another command.
1 A protection violation has occurred
0 No failure
4
ACCERR
Access error flag. The ACCERR flag indicates an illegal access to the CFM array
or registers caused by a bad program or erase sequence. ACCERR is cleared by
writing it to 1. Writing a 0 to ACCERR has no effect. While ACCERR is set in this
register, it is not possible to launch another command. See Section 6.4.3.4, “Flash
User Mode Illegal Operations,” for details on what sets the ACCERR flag.
1 Access error has occurred
0 No failure
3
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-15
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Table 6-10. CFMUSTAT Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
2
BLANK
Erase Verified Flag. The BLANK flag indicates that the erase verify command
(RDARY1) has checked the two interleaved Flash physical blocks and found them
to be blank. Clear BLANK by writing it to 1. Writing a 0 has no effect.
1 Flash physical blocks verify as erased.
0 If an erase verify command has been requested, and the CCIF flag is set, then
the selected Flash physical blocks are not blank.
1–0
—
6.3.4.8
Reserved, should be cleared.
CFM Command Register (CFMCMD)
The CFMCMD is the register to which Flash program, erase, and verify commands are written.
7
Field
6
0
—
CMD
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1D_0024
Figure 6-12. CFM Command Register (CFMCMD)
Table 6-11. CFMCMD Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
7
—
6–0
CMD[6:0]
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Command. Valid Flash user mode commands are shown in Table 6-12. Writing a
command in user mode other than those listed in Table 6-12 will set the ACCERR
flag in CFMUSTAT.
CFMCMD is readable and writable in all modes. Writes to bit 7 have no effect and reads return 0.
Table 6-12. CFMCMD User Mode Commands
6.4
Command
Name
Description
0x05
RDARY1
Erase verify (all 1s)
0x20
PGM
Longword program
0x40
PGERS
Page erase
0x41
MASERS
Mass erase
0x06
PGERSVER
Page erase verify
CFM Operation
The CFM registers, subject to the restrictions previously noted, can generally be read and written (see
Section 6.3.4, “Register Descriptions” for details). Reads of the CFM array occur normally and writes
behave according to the setting of the KEYACC bit in CFMCR. Program, erase, and verify operations are
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-16
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
initiated by the CPU. Special cases of user mode apply when the CPU is in low-power or debug modes
and when the MCU boots in master mode or emulation mode.
6.4.1
Read Operations
A valid read operation occurs whenever a transfer request is initiated by the ColdFire core, the address is
equal to an address within the valid range of the CFM memory space, and the read/write control indicates
a read cycle.
In order to reduce power at low system clock frequencies, the sense amplifier timeout (SATO) block
minimizes the time during which the sense amplifiers are enabled for read operations. The sense amplifier
enable signals to the Flash timeout after approximately 50 ns.
6.4.2
Write Operations
A valid write operation occurs whenever a transfer request is initiated by the ColdFire core, the address is
equal to an address within the valid range of the CFM memory space, and the read/write control indicates
a write cycle.
The action taken on a valid CFM array write depends on the subsequent user command issued as part of a
valid command sequence. Only aligned 32-bit write operations are allowed to the CFM array. Byte and
word write operations will result in a cycle termination transfer error.
6.4.3
Program and Erase Operations
Read and write operations are both used for the program and erase algorithms described in this subsection.
These algorithms are controlled by a state machine whose timebase is derived from the CFM module clock
via a programmable counter.
The command register and associated address and data buffers operate as a two stage FIFO so that a new
command along with the necessary address and data can be stored while the previous command is still in
progress. This pipelining speeds when programming more than one longword on a specific row, as the
charge pumps can be kept on in between two programming commands, thus saving the overhead needed
to set up the charge pumps. Buffer empty and command completion are indicated by flags in the CFM user
status register. Interrupts will be requested if enabled.
6.4.3.1
Setting the CFMCLKD Register
Prior to issuing any program or erase commands, CFMCLKD must be written to set the Flash state
machine clock (FCLK). The CFM module runs at the system clock frequency ÷ 2, but FCLK must be
divided down from this frequency to a frequency between 150 kHz and 200 kHz. Use the following
procedure to set the PRDIV8 and DIV[5:0] bits in CFMCLKD:
1. If fSYS ÷ 2 is greater than 12.8 MHz, PRDIV8 = 1; otherwise PRDIV8 = 0.
2. Determine DIV[5:0] by using the following equation. Keep only the integer portion of the result
and discard any fraction. Do not round the result.
DIV[5:0] =
fSYS
2 x 200kHz x (1 + (PRDIV8 x 7))
3. Thus the Flash state machine clock will be:
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-17
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
fSYS
fCLK =
2 x (DIV[5:0] + 1) x (1 + (PRDIV8 x 7))
Consider the following example for fSYS = 66 MHz:
DIV[5:0] =
=
fSYS
2 x 200kHz x (1 + (PRDIV8 x 7))
66 MHz
400 kHz x (1 + (1 x 7))
= 20
fSYS
fCLK =
2 x (DIV[5:0] + 1) x (1 + (PRDIV8 x 7))
=
66 MHz
2 x (20 + 1) x (1 + (1 x 7))
= 196.43 kHz
So, for fSYS = 66 MHz, writing 0x54 to CFMCLKD will set fCLK to 196.43 kHz which is a valid frequency
for the timing of program and erase operations.
WARNING
For proper program and erase operations, it is critical to set fCLK between
150 kHz and 200 kHz. Array damage due to overstress can occur when fCLK
is less than 150 kHz. Incomplete programming and erasure can occur when
fCLK is greater than 200 kHz.
NOTE
Command execution time increases proportionally with the period of fCLK.
When CFMCLKD is written, the DIVLD bit is set automatically. If DIVLD is 0, CFMCLKD has not been
written since the last reset. Program and erase commands will not execute if this register has not been
written (see Section 6.4.3.4, “Flash User Mode Illegal Operations”).
6.4.3.2
Program, Erase, and Verify Sequences
A command state machine is used to supervise the write sequencing of program, erase, and verify
commands. To prepare for a command, the CFMUSTAT[CBEIF] flag should be tested to ensure that the
address, data, and command buffers are empty. If CBEIF is set, the command write sequence can be
started.
This three-step command write sequence must be strictly followed. No intermediate writes to the CFM
module are permitted between these three steps. The command write sequence is:
1. Write the 32-bit longword to be programmed to its location in the CFM array. The address and data
will be stored in internal buffers. All address bits are valid for program commands. The value of
the data written for verify and erase commands is ignored. For mass erase or verify, the address can
be any location in the CFM array. For page erase, address bits [9:0] are ignored.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-18
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
NOTE
The page erase command operates simultaneously on adjacent erase pages
in two interleaved Flash physical blocks. Thus, a single erase page is
effectively 2 Kbyte.
2. Write the program, erase, or verify command to CFMCMD, the command buffer. See
Section 6.4.3.3, “Flash Valid Commands.”
3. Launch the command by writing a 1 to the CBEIF flag. This clears CBEIF. When command
execution is complete, the Flash state machine sets the CCIF flag. The CBEIF flag is also set
again, indicating that the address, data, and command buffers are ready for a new command
sequence to begin.
The Flash state machine flags errors in command write sequences by means of the ACCERR and PVIOL
flags in the CFMUSTAT register. An erroneous command write sequence self-aborts and sets the
appropriate flag. The ACCERR or PVIOL flags must be cleared before commencing another command
write sequence.
NOTE
By writing a 0 to CBEIF, a command sequence can be aborted after the
longword write to the CFM array or the command write to the CFMCMD
and before the command is launched. The ACCERR flag will be set on
aborted commands and must be cleared before a new command write
sequence.
A summary of the programming algorithm is shown in Figure 6-13. The flow is similar for the erase and
verify algorithms with the exceptions noted in step 1 above.
6.4.3.3
Flash Valid Commands
Table 6-13 summarizes the valid Flash user commands.
Table 6-13. Flash User Commands
CFMCMD
Meaning
Description
0x05
Erase
verify
Verify that all 256 Kbytes of Flash from two interleaving physical
blocks are erased. If both blocks are erased, the BLANK bit will
be set in the CFMUSTAT register upon command completion.
0x20
Program
0x40
Page
erase
Erase 2 Kbyte of Flash. Two 1024-byte pages from interleaving
physical blocks are erased in this operation.
0x41
Mass
erase
Erase all 256 Kbytes of Flash from two interleaving physical
blocks. A mass erase is only possible when no PROTECT bits
are set for that block.
0x06
Page erase
verify
Verify that the two 1024-byte pages are erased. If both pages
are erased, the BLANK bit will be set in the CFMUSTAT register
upon command completion.
Program a 32-bit longword.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-19
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
START
READ CFMCLKD
CLOCK REGISTER
WRITTEN CHECK
NO
DIVLD SET?
YES
WRITE CFMCLKD
READ CFMUSTAT
CBEIF
SET?
NO
YES
1.
WRITE PROGRAM DATA
TO ARRAY ADDRESS
2.
WRITE PROGRAM COMMAND 0x20
TO CFMCMD
NOTE: COMMAND SEQUENCE
ABORTED BY WRITING 0x00
TO CFMUSTAT
3.
WRITE 0x80 TO CLEAR CFMUSTAT
CBEIF BIT
NOTE: COMMAND SEQUENCE
ABORTED BY WRITING 0x00
TO CFMUSTAT
READ CFMUSTAT
PVIOL
SET?
YES
WRITE 0x20 TO CLEAR
CFMUSTAT PVIOL BIT
ACCERR
SET?
YES
WRITE 0x10 TO CLEAR
CFMUSTAT ACCERR BIT
PROTECTION
VIOLATION CHECK
NO
ACCESS
ERROR CHECK
YES
NO
ADDRESS, DATA,
COMMAND BUFFER
EMPTY CHECK
CBEIF
SET?
YES
NEXT WRITE?
NO
NO
READ CFMUSTAT
BIT POLLING
FOR COMMAND
COMPLETION CHECK
CCIF
SET?
NO
YES
EXIT
Figure 6-13. Example Program Algorithm
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-20
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.4.3.4
Flash User Mode Illegal Operations
The ACCERR flag will be set during a command write sequence if any of the illegal operations below are
performed. Such operations will cause the command sequence to immediately abort.
1. Writing to the CFM array before initializing CFMCLKD.
2. Writing to the CFM array while in emulation mode.
3. Writing a byte or a word to the CFM array. Only 32-bit longword programming is allowed.
4. Writing to the CFM array while CBEIF is not set.
5. Writing an invalid user command to the CFMCMD.
6. Writing to any CFM other than CFMCMD after writing a longword to the CFM array.
7. Writing a second command to CFMCMD before executing the previously written command.
8. Writing to any CFM register other than CFMUSTAT (to clear CBEIF) after writing to the
command register.
9. Entering stop mode while a program or erase command is in progress.
10. Aborting a command sequence by writing a 0 to CBEIF after the longword write to the CFM
array or after writing a command to CFMCMD and before launching it.
The PVIOL flag will be set during a command write sequence after the longword write to the CFM array
if any of the illegal operations below are performed. Such operations will cause the command sequence to
immediately abort.
1. Writing to an address in a protected area of the CFM array.
2. Writing a mass erase command to CFMCMD while any logical sector is protected (see
Section 6.3.4.4, “CFM Protection Register (CFMPROT)”).
If a Flash physical block is read during a program or erase operation on that block (CFMUSTAT bit CCIF
= 0), the read will return non-valid data and the ACCERR flag will not be set.
6.4.4
Stop Mode
If a command is active (CCIF = 0) when the MCU enters stop mode, the command sequence monitor
performs the following:
1. The command in progress aborts
2. The Flash high voltage circuitry switches off and any pending command (CBEIF = 0) does not
executed when the MCU exits stop mode.
3. The CCIF and ACCERR flags are set if a command is active when the MCU enters stop mode.
NOTE
The state of any longword(s) being programmed or any erase pages/physical
blocks being erased is not guaranteed if the MCU enters stop mode with a
command in progress.
WARNING
Active commands are immediately aborted when the MCU enters stop
mode. Do not execute the STOP instruction during program and erase
operations.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-21
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.4.5
Master Mode
If the MCU is booted in master mode with an external memory selected as the boot device, the CFM will
not respond to the first transfer request out of reset. This will allow the external boot device to provide the
reset vector and terminate the bus cycle.
6.5
Flash Security Operation
The CFM array provides security information to the integration module and the rest of the MCU. A
longword in the Flash configuration field stores this information. This longword is read automatically after
each reset and is stored in the CFMSEC register.
NOTE
Enabling Flash security will disable BDM communications.
NOTE
When Flash security is enabled, the chip will boot in single chip mode
regardless of the external reset configuration.
In user mode, security can be bypassed via a back door access scheme using an 8-byte long key. Upon
successful completion of the back door access sequence, the module output signal and status bit indicating
that the chip is secure are cleared.
The CFM may be unsecured via one of two methods:
1. Executing a back door access scheme.
2. Passing an erase verify check.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-22
Freescale Semiconductor
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
6.5.1
Back Door Access
If the KEYEN bit is set, security can be bypassed by:
1. Setting the KEYACC bit in the CFM configuration register (CFMMCR).
2. Writing the correct 8-byte back door comparison key to the CFM array at addresses 0x0000_0400
to 0x0000_0407. This operation must consist of two 32-bit writes to address 0x0000_0400 and
0x0000_0404 in that order. The two back door write cycles can be separated by any number of
bus cycles.
3. Clearing the KEYACC bit.
4. If all 8 bytes written match the array contents at addresses 0x0000_0400 to 0x0000_0407, then
security is bypassed until the next reset.
NOTE
The security of the Flash as defined by the Flash security longword at
address 0x0000_0414 is not changed by the back door method of unsecuring
the device. After the next reset the device is again secured and the same back
door key remains in effect unless changed by program or erase operations.
The back door method of unsecuring the device has no effect on the program
and erase protections defined by the CFM protection register (CFMPROT).
6.5.2
Erase Verify Check
Security can be disabled by verifying that the CFM array is blank. If required, the mass erase command
can be executed for each pair of Flash physical blocks that comprise the array. The erase verify command
must then be executed for all Flash physical blocks within the array. The CFM will be unsecured if the
erase verify command determines that the entire array is blank. After the next reset, the security state of
the CFM will be determined by the Flash security longword, which, after being erased, will read
0xffff_ffff, thus unsecuring the module.
6.6
Reset
The CFM array is not accessible for any operations via the address and data buses during reset. If a reset
occurs while any command is in progress that command will immediately abort. The state of any longword
being programmed or any erase pages/physical blocks being erased is not guaranteed.
6.7
Interrupts
The CFM module can request an interrupt when all commands are completed or when the address, data,
and command buffers are empty. Table 6-14 shows the CFM interrupt mechanism.
Table 6-14. CFM Interrupt Sources
Interrupt Source
Command, data and address
buffers empty
Interrupt Flag
Local Enable
CBEIF
(CFMUSTAT)
CBEIE
(CFMCR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
6-23
ColdFire Flash Module (CFM)
Table 6-14. CFM Interrupt Sources (continued)
Interrupt Source
Interrupt Flag
Local Enable
All commands are completed
CCIF
(CFMUSTAT)
CCIE
(CFMCR)
Access error
ACCERR
(CFMUSTAT)
AEIE
(CFMCR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
6-24
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 7
Power Management
The power management module (PMM) controls the device’s low-power operation.
7.1
Features
The following features support low-power operation.
• Four modes of operation:
— Run
— Wait
— Doze
— Stop
• Ability to shut down most peripherals independently
• Ability to shut down the external CLKOUT pin
7.2
Memory Map and Registers
This subsection provides a description of the memory map and registers.
7.2.1
Programming Model
The PMM programming model consists of one register:
• The low-power control register (LPCR) specifies the low-power mode entered when the STOP
instruction is issued, and controls clock activity in this low-power mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
7-1
Power Management
7.2.2
Memory Map
Table 7-1. Chip Configuration Module Memory Map
IPSBAR Offset
Bits 31–24
Bits 23–16
Bits 15–8
Bits 7–0
Access1
0x0000_0010
Core Reset Status
Register (CRSR)2
Core Watchdog
Control Register
(CWCR)
Low-Power
Interrupt Control
Register (LPICR)
Core Watchdog
Service Register
(CWSR)
S
0x0011_0004
Chip Configuration Register (CCR)3
Reserved
Low-Power Control
Register (LPCR)
S
1
S = CPU supervisor mode access only. User mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in
a cycle termination transfer error.
2 The CRSR, CWCR, and CWSR are described in the System Integration Module. They are shown here only to warn
against accidental writes to these registers when accessing the LPICR.
3
The CCR is described in the Chip Configuration Module. It is shown here only to warn against accidental writes to this
register when accessing the LPCR.
7.2.3
Register Descriptions
The following subsection describes the PMM registers.
7.2.3.1
Low-Power Interrupt Control Register (LPICR)
Implementation of low-power stop mode and exit from a low-power mode via an interrupt require
communication between the CPU and logic associated with the interrupt controller. The LPICR is an 8-bit
register that enables entry into low-power stop mode, and includes the setting of the interrupt level needed
to exit a low-power mode.
NOTE
The setting of the low-power mode select (LPMD) field in the power
management module’s low-power control register (LPCR) determines
which low-power mode the device enters when a STOP instruction is issued.
If this field is set to enter stop mode, then the ENBSTOP bit in the LPICR
must also be set.
Following is the sequence of operations needed to enable this functionality:
1. The LPICR is programmed, setting the ENBSTOP bit (if stop mode is the desired low-power
mode) and loading the appropriate interrupt priority level.
2. At the appropriate time, the processor executes the privileged STOP instruction. Once the
processor has stopped execution, it asserts a specific Processor Status (PST) encoding. Issuing the
STOP instruction when the LPICR[ENBSTOP] bit is set causes the SCM to enter stop mode.
3. The entry into a low-power mode is processed by the low-power mode control logic, and the
appropriate clocks (usually those related to the high-speed processor core) are disabled.
4. After entering the low-power mode, the interrupt controller enables a combinational logic path
which evaluates any unmasked interrupt requests. The device waits for an event to generate an
interrupt request with a priority level greater than the value programmed in
LPICR[XLPM_IPL[2:0]].
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
7-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Power Management
NOTE
Only fixed (external) interrupt can bring a device out of stop mode. To exit
from other low-power modes, such as doze or wait, either fixed or
programmable interrupts may be used; however, the module generating the
interrupt must be enabled in that particular low-power mode.
5. Once an appropriately-high interrupt request level arrives, the interrupt controller signals its
presence, and the SIM responds by asserting the request to exit low-power mode.
6. The low-power mode control logic senses the request signal and re-enables the appropriate
clocks.
7. With the processor clocks enabled, the core processes the pending interrupt request.
7
6
Field ENBSTOP
Reset
1/0
4
3
0
XLPM_IPL
0
1/0
—
0
R/W
Undefined
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x012
Figure 7-1. Low-Power Interrupt Control Register (LPICR)
Table 7-2. LPICR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7
ENBSTOP
Enable low-power stop mode.
0 Low-power stop mode disabled
1 Low-power stop mode enabled. Once the core is stopped and the signal to enter stop
mode is asserted, processor clocks can be disabled.
6–4
XLPM_IPL
Exit low-power mode interrupt priority level. This field defines the interrupt priority level
needed to exit the low-power mode.Refer to Table 7-3.
3–0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
Table 7-3. XLPM_IPL Settings
XLPM_IPL[2:0]
Interrupts Level Needed to Exit Low-Power Mode
000
Any interrupt request exits low-power mode
001
Interrupt request levels [2-7] exit low-power mode
010
Interrupt request levels [3-7] exit low-power mode
011
Interrupt request levels [4-7] exit low-power mode
100
Interrupt request levels [5-7] exit low-power mode
101
Interrupt request levels [6-7] exit low-power mode
11x
Interrupt request level [7] exits low-power mode
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
7-3
Power Management
7.2.3.2
Low-Power Control Register (LPCR)
The LPCR controls chip operation and module operation during low-power modes.
7
Field
6
LPMD
5
—
Reset
4
3
STPMD
2
1
0
—
LVDSE
—
0000_0010
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x0011_0007
Figure 7-2. Low-Power Control Register (LPCR)
Table 7-4. LPCR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7–6
LPMD
Low-power mode select. Used to select the low-power mode the chip
enters once the ColdFire CPU executes the STOP instruction. These bits
must be written prior to instruction execution for them to take effect. The
LPMD[1:0] bits are readable and writable in all modes. Table 7-5 illustrates
the four different power modes that can be configured with the LPMD bit
field.
5
—
4–3
STPMD
2
—
1
LVDSE
0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
PLL/CLKOUT stop mode. Controls PLL and CLKOUT operation in stop
mode as shown in Table 7-6
Reserved, should be cleared.
LDV standby enable. Controls whether the PMM enters VREG Standby
Mode (LVD disabled) or VREG Pseudo-Standby (LVD enabled) mode when
the PMM receives a power down request. This bit has no effect if the
RCR[LVDE] bit is a logic 0.
1 VREG Pseudo-Standby mode (LVD enabled on power down request).
0 VREG Standby mode (LVD disabled on power down request).
Reserved, should be cleared.
Table 7-5. Low-Power Modes
LPMD[1:0]
Mode
11
STOP
10
WAIT
01
DOZE
00
RUN
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
7-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Power Management
Table 7-6. PLL/CLKOUT Stop Mode Operation
Operation During Stop Mode
STPMD[1:0]
System Clocks
CLKOUT
PLL
OSC
PMM
00
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
01
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
10
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
11
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Low-Power Option
NOTE
If LPCR[LPMD] is cleared, then the device stops executing code upon issue
of a STOP instruction. However, no clocks are disabled.
7.3
Functional Description
The functions and characteristics of the low-power modes, and how each module is affected by, or affects,
these modes are discussed in this section.
7.3.1
Low-Power Modes
The system enters a low-power mode by executing a STOP instruction. Which mode the device actually
enters (either stop, wait, or doze) depends on what is programmed in LPCR[LPMD]. Entry into any of
these modes idles the CPU with no cycles active, powers down the system and stops all internal clocks
appropriately. During stop mode, the system clock is stopped low.
For entry into stop mode, the LPICR[ENBSTOP] bit must be set before a STOP instruction is issued.
A wakeup event is required to exit a low-power mode and return to run mode. Wakeup events consist of
any of these conditions:
• Any type of reset
• Any valid, enabled interrupt request
The latter method of exiting from low-power mode, by a valid and enabled interrupt request, requires
several things:
• An interrupt request whose priority is higher than the value programmed in the XLPM_IPL field
of the LPICR
• An interrupt request whose priority higher than the value programmed in the interrupt priority
mask (I) field of the core’s status register
• An interrupt request from a source which is not masked in the interrupt controller’s interrupt mask
register
• An interrupt request which has been enabled at the module of the interrupt’s origin
7.3.1.1
Run Mode
Run mode is the normal system operating mode. Current consumption in this mode is related directly to
the system clock frequency.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
7-5
Power Management
7.3.1.2
Wait Mode
Wait mode is intended to be used to stop only the CPU and memory clocks until a wakeup event is
detected. In this mode, peripherals may be programmed to continue operating and can generate interrupts,
which cause the CPU to exit from wait mode.
7.3.1.3
Doze Mode
Doze mode affects the CPU in the same manner as wait mode, except that each peripheral defines
individual operational characteristics in doze mode. Peripherals which continue to run and have the
capability of producing interrupts may cause the CPU to exit the doze mode and return to run mode.
Peripherals which are stopped will restart operation on exit from doze mode as defined for each peripheral.
7.3.1.4
Stop Mode
Stop mode affects the CPU in the same manner as the wait and doze modes, except that all clocks to the
system are stopped and the peripherals cease operation.
Stop mode must be entered in a controlled manner to ensure that any current operation is properly
terminated. When exiting stop mode, most peripherals retain their pre-stop status and resume operation.
The following subsections specify the operation of each module while in and when exiting low-power
modes.
NOTE
Entering stop mode will disable the SDRAMC including the refresh counter.
If SDRAM is used, then code is required to insure proper entry and exit from
stop mode. See Section 7.3.2.5, “SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC)” for more
information.
7.3.1.5
Peripheral Shut Down
Most peripherals may be disabled by software in order to cease internal clock generation and remain in a
static state. Each peripheral has its own specific disabling sequence (refer to each peripheral description
for further details). A peripheral may be disabled at any time and will remain disabled during any
low-power mode of operation.
7.3.2
7.3.2.1
Peripheral Behavior in Low-Power Modes
ColdFire Core
The ColdFire core is disabled during any low-power mode. No recovery time is required when exiting any
low-power mode.
7.3.2.2
Static Random-Access Memory (SRAM)
SRAM is disabled during any low-power mode. No recovery time is required when exiting any low-power
mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
7-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Power Management
7.3.2.3
Flash
The Flash module is in a low-power state if not being accessed. No recovery time is required after exit
from any low-power mode.
The MCF5280 does not have a Flash module.
7.3.2.4
System Control Module (SCM)
The SCM’s core Watchdog timer can bring the device out of all low-power modes except stop mode. In
stop mode, all clocks stop, and the core Watchdog does not operate.
When enabled, the core Watchdog can bring the device out of low-power mode in one of two ways. If the
core Watchdog reset/interrupt select (CSRI) bit is set, then a core Watchdog timeout will cause a reset of
the device. If the CSRI bit is cleared, then a core Watchdog interrupt may be enabled and upon watchdog
timeout, can bring the device out of low-power mode. This system setup must meet the conditions
specified in Section 7.3.1, “Low-Power Modes” for the core Watchdog interrupt to bring the part out of
low-power mode.
7.3.2.5
SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC)
SDRAMC operation is unaffected by either the wait or doze modes; however, the SDRAMC is disabled
by stop mode. Since all clocks to the SDRAMC are disabled by stop mode, the SDRAMC will not generate
refresh cycles.
To prevent loss of data the SDRAM should be placed in self-refresh mode by setting DCR[IS] before
entering stop mode. The SDRAM self-refresh mode allows the SDRAM to enter a low-power state where
internal refresh operations are used to maintain the integrity of the data stored in the SDRAM.
When stop mode is exited clearing the DCR[IS] bit will cause the SDRAM to exit the self-refresh mode
and allow bus cycles to the SDRAM to resume.
NOTE
The SDRAM is inaccessible while in the self-refresh mode. Therefore, if
stop mode is used the vector table and any interrupt handlers that could
wake the processor should not be stored in or attempt to access SDRAM.
7.3.2.6
Chip Select Module
In wait and doze modes, the chip select module continues operation but does not generate interrupts;
therefore it cannot bring a device out of a low-power mode. This module is stopped in stop mode.
7.3.2.7
DMA Controller (DMAC0–DMA3)
In wait and doze modes, the DMA controller is capable of bringing the device out of a low-power mode
by generating an interrupt either upon completion of a transfer or upon an error condition. The completion
of transfer interrupt is generated when DMA interrupts are enabled by the setting of the DCR[INT] bit,
and an interrupt is generated when the DSR[DONE] bit is set. The interrupt upon error condition is
generated when the DCR[INT] bit is set, and an interrupt is generated when either the CE, BES or BED
bit in the DSR becomes set.
The DMA controller is stopped in stop mode and thus cannot cause an exit from this low-power mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
7-7
Power Management
7.3.2.8
UART Modules (UART0, UART1, and UART2)
In wait and doze modes, the UART may generate an interrupt to exit the low-power modes.
• Clearing the transmit enable bit (TE) or the receiver enable bit (RE) disables UART functions.
• The UARTs are unaffected by wait mode and may generate an interrupt to exit this mode.
In stop mode, the UARTs stop immediately and freeze their operation, register values, state machines, and
external pins. During this mode, the UART clocks are shut down. Coming out of stop mode returns the
UARTs to operation from the state prior to the low-power mode entry.
7.3.2.9
I2C Module
When the I2C Module is enabled by the setting of the I2CR[IEN] bit and when the device is not in stop
mode, the I2C module is operable and may generate an interrupt to bring the device out of a low-power
mode. For an interrupt to occur, the I2CR[IIE] bit must be set to enable interrupts, and the setting of the
I2SR[IIF] generates the interrupt signal to the CPU and interrupt controller. The setting of I2SR[IIF]
signifies either the completion of one byte transfer or the reception of a calling address matching its own
specified address when in slave receive mode.
In stop mode, the I2C Module stops immediately and freezes operation, register values, and external pins.
Upon exiting stop mode, the I2C resumes operation unless stop mode was exited by reset.
7.3.2.10
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
In wait and doze modes, the queued serial peripheral interface (QSPI) may generate an interrupt to exit the
low-power modes.
• Clearing the QSPI enable bit (SPE) disables the QSPI function.
• The QSPI is unaffected by wait mode and may generate an interrupt to exit this mode.
In stop mode, the QSPI stops immediately and freezes operation, register values, state machines, and
external pins. During this mode, the QSPI clocks are shut down. Coming out of stop mode returns the QSPI
to operation from the state prior to the low-power mode entry.
7.3.2.11
DMA Timers (DMAT0–DMAT3)
In wait and doze modes, the DMA timers may generate an interrupt to exit a low-power mode. This
interrupt can be generated when the DMA Timer is in either input capture mode or reference compare
mode.
In input capture mode, where the capture enable (CE) field of the timer mode register (DTMR) has a
non-zero value and the DMA enable (DMAEN) bit of the DMA timer extended mode register (DTXMR)
is cleared, an interrupt is issued upon a captured input. In reference compare mode, where the output
reference request interrupt enable (ORRI) bit of DTMR is set and the DTXMR[DMAEN] bit is cleared,
an interrupt is issued when the timer counter reaches the reference value.
DMA timer operation is disabled in stop mode, but the DMA timer is unaffected by either the wait or doze
modes and may generate an interrupt to exit these modes. Upon exiting stop mode, the timer will resume
operation unless stop mode was exited by reset.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
7-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Power Management
7.3.2.12
Interrupt Controllers (INTC0, INTC1)
The interrupt controller is not affected by any of the low-power modes. All logic between the input sources
and generating the interrupt to the processor will be combinational to allow the ability to wake up the CPU
processor during low-power stop mode when all system clocks are stopped.
An interrupt request will cause the CPU to exit a low-power mode only if that interrupt’s priority level is
at or above the level programmed in the interrupt priority mask field of the CPU’s status register (SR). The
interrupt must also be enabled in the interrupt controller’s interrupt mask register as well as at the module
from which the interrupt request would originate.
7.3.2.13
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
In wait and doze modes, the FEC may generate an interrupt to exit the low-power modes.
• Clearing the ECNTRL[ETHER_EN] bit disables the FEC function.
• The FEC is unaffected by wait mode and may generate an interrupt to exit this mode.
In stop mode, the FEC stops immediately and freezes operation, register values, state machines, and
external pins. During this mode, the FEC clocks are shut down. Coming out of stop mode returns the FEC
to operation from the state prior to the low-power mode entry.
The MCF5214 and MCF5216 do not contain an FEC.
7.3.2.14
I/O Ports
The I/O ports are unaffected by entry into a low-power mode. These pins may impact low-power current
draw if they are configured as outputs and are sourcing current to an external load. If low-power mode is
exited by a reset, the state of the I/O pins will revert to their default direction settings.
7.3.2.15
Reset Controller
A power-on reset (POR) will always cause a chip reset and exit from any low-power mode.
In wait and doze modes, asserting the external RSTI pin for at least four clocks will cause an external reset
that will reset the chip and exit any low-power modes.
In stop mode, the RSTI pin synchronization is disabled and asserting the external RSTI pin will
asynchronously generate an internal reset and exit any low-power modes. Registers will lose current
values and must be reconfigured from reset state if needed.
If the phase lock loop (PLL) in the clock module is active and if the appropriate (LOCRE, LOLRE) bits
in the synthesizer control register are set, then any loss-of-clock or loss-of-lock will reset the chip and exit
any low-power modes.
If the watchdog timer is still enabled during wait or doze modes, then a watchdog timer timeout may
generate a reset to exit these low-power modes.
When the CPU is inactive, a software reset cannot be generated to exit any low-power mode.
7.3.2.16
Chip Configuration Module
The Chip Configuration Module is unaffected by entry into a low-power mode. If low-power mode is
exited by a reset, chip configuration may be executed if configured to do so.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
7-9
Power Management
7.3.2.17
Clock Module
In wait and doze modes, the clocks to the CPU, Flash, and SRAM will be stopped and the system clocks
to the peripherals are enabled. Each module may disable the module clocks locally at the module level. In
stop mode, all clocks to the system will be stopped.
During stop mode, there are several options for enabling/disabling the PLL and/or crystal oscillator (OSC);
each of these options requires a compromise between wakeup recovery time and stop mode power. The
PLL may be disabled during stop mode. A wakeup time of up to 200 μs is required for the PLL to re-lock.
The OSC may also be disabled during stop mode. The time required for the OSC to restart is dependent
upon the startup time of the crystal used. Power consumption can be reduced in stop mode by disabling
either or both of these functions via the SYNCR[STMPD] bits.
The external CLKOUT signal may be enabled during low-power stop (if the PLL is still enabled) to
support systems using this signal as the clock source.
The system clocks may be enabled during wakeup from stop mode without waiting for the PLL to lock.
This eliminates the wakeup recovery time, but at the risk of sending a potentially unstable clock to the
system. It is recommended, if this option is used, that the PLL frequency divider is set so that the targeted
system frequency is no more than half the maximum allowed. This will allow for any frequency overshoot
of the PLL while still keeping the system clock within specification.
In external clock mode, there are no wait times for the OSC startup or PLL lock.
During wakeup from stop mode, the Flash clock will always clock through 16 cycles before the system
clocks are enabled. This allows the Flash module time to recover from the low-power mode. Thus,
software may immediately continue to fetch instructions from the Flash memory.
The external CLKOUT output pin may be disabled in the low state to lower power consumption via the
DISCLK bit in the SYNCR. The external CLKOUT pin function is enabled by default at reset.
7.3.2.18
Edge Port
In wait and doze modes, the edge port continues to operate normally and may be configured to generate
interrupts (either an edge transition or low level on an external pin) to exit the low-power modes.
In stop mode, there is no system clock available to perform the edge detect function. Thus, only the level
detect logic is active (if configured) to allow any low level on the external interrupt pin to generate an
interrupt (if enabled) to exit the stop mode.
7.3.2.19
Watchdog Timer
In stop mode (or in wait/doze mode, if so programmed), the watchdog ceases operation and freezes at the
current value. When exiting these modes, the watchdog resumes operation from the stopped value. It is the
responsibility of software to avoid erroneous operation.
When not stopped, the watchdog may generate a reset to exit the low-power modes.
7.3.2.20
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0, PIT1, PIT2 and PIT3)
In stop mode (or in doze mode, if so programmed), the programmable interrupt timer (PIT) ceases
operation, and freezes at the current value. When exiting these modes, the PIT resumes operation from the
stopped value. It is the responsibility of software to avoid erroneous operation.
When not stopped, the PIT may generate an interrupt to exit the low-power modes.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
7-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Power Management
7.3.2.21
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Setting the queued analog-to-digital converter (QADC) stop bit (QSTOP) will disable the QADC.
The QADC is unaffected by either wait or doze mode and may generate an interrupt to exit these modes.
Low-power stop mode (or setting the QSTOP bit), immediately freezes operation, register values, state
machines, and external pins. This stops the clock signals to the digital electronics of the module and
eliminates the quiescent current draw of the analog electronics. Any conversion sequences in progress are
stopped. Exit from low-power stop mode (or clearing the QSTOP bit), returns the QADC to operation from
the state prior to stop mode entry, but any conversions in progress are undefined and the QADC requires
recovery time to stabilize the analog circuits before new conversions can be performed.
7.3.2.22
General Purpose Timers (GPTA and GPTB)
When not stopped, the General Purpose Timers may generate an interrupt to exit the low-power modes.
Clearing the timer enable bit (TE) in the GPT system control register 1 (GPTSCR1) or the pulse
accumulator enable bit (PAE) in the GPT pulse accumulator control register (GPTPACTL) disables timer
functions. Timer and pulse accumulator registers are still accessible by the CPU and BDM interface, but
the remaining functions of the timer are disabled.
The timer is unaffected by either the wait or doze modes and may generate an interrupt to exit these modes.
In stop mode, the General Purpose Timers stop immediately and freeze their operation, register values,
state machines, and external pins. Upon exiting stop mode, the timer will resume operation unless stop
mode was exited by reset.
7.3.2.23
FlexCAN
When enabled, the FlexCAN module is capable of generating interrupts and bringing the device out of a
low-power mode. The module has 35 interrupt sources (32 sources due to message buffers and 3 sources
due to Bus-off, Error and Wake-up).
When in stop mode, a recessive to dominant transition on the CAN bus causes the WAKE-INT bit in the
error & status register to be set. This event can cause a CPU interrupt if the WAKE-MASK bit in module
configuration register (MCR) is set.
When setting stop mode in the FlexCAN (by setting the MCR[STOP] bit), the FlexCAN checks for the
CAN bus to be either idle or waits for the third bit of intermission and checks to see if it is recessive. When
this condition exists, the FlexCAN waits for all internal activity other than in the CAN bus interface to
complete and then the following occurs:
• The FlexCAN shuts down its clocks, stopping most of the internal circuits, to achieve maximum
possible power saving.
• The internal bus interface logic continues operation, enabling CPU to access the MCR register.
• The FlexCAN ignores its Rx input pin, and drives its Tx pins as recessive.
• FlexCAN loses synchronization with the CAN bus, and STOP_ACK and NOT_RDY bits in MCR
register are set.
Exiting stop mode is done in one of the following ways:
• Reset the FlexCAN (either by hard reset or by asserting the SOFT_RST bit in MCR).
• Clearing the STOP bit in the MCR.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
7-11
Power Management
•
Self-wake mechanism. If the SELF-WAKE bit in the MCR is set at the time the FlexCAN enters
stop mode, then upon detection of recessive to dominant transition on the CAN bus, the FlexCAN
resets the STOP bit in the MCR and resumes its clocks.
Recommendations for, and features of, FlexCAN’s stop mode operation are as follows:
• Upon stop/self-wake mode entry, the FlexCAN tries to receive the frame that caused it to wake;
that is, it assumes that the dominant bit detected is a start-of-frame bit. It does not arbitrate for the
CAN bus then.
• Before asserting stop Mode, the CPU should disable all interrupts in the FlexCAN, otherwise it
may be interrupted while in stop mode upon a non-wake-up condition. If desired, the
WAKE-MASK bit should be set to enable the WAKE-INT.
• If stop mode is asserted while the FlexCAN is BUSOFF (see error and status register), then the
FlexCAN enters stop mode and stops counting the synchronization sequence; it continues this
count once stop mode is exited.
• The correct flow to enter stop mode with SELF-WAKE:
— assert SELF-WAKE at the same time as STOP.
— wait for STOP_ACK bit to be set.
• The correct flow to negate STOP with SELF-WAKE:
— negate SELF-WAKE at the same time as STOP.
— wait for STOP_ACK negation.
• SELF-WAKE should be set only when the MCR[STOP] bit is negated and the FlexCAN is ready;
that is, the NOT_RDY bit in the MCR is negated.
• If STOP and SELF_WAKE are set and if a recessive to dominant edge immediately follows on the
CAN bus, the STOP_ACK bit in the MCR may never be set, and the STOP bit in the MCR is reset.
• If the user does not want to have old frames sent when the FlexCAN is awakened (STOP with
Self-Wake), the user should disable all Tx sources, including remote-response, before stop mode
entry.
• If halt mode is active at the time the STOP bit is set, then the FlexCAN assumes that halt mode
should be exited; hence it tries to synchronize to the CAN bus (11 consecutive recessive bits), and
only then does it search for the correct conditions to stop.
• Trying to stop the FlexCAN immediately after reset is allowed only after basic initialization has
been performed.
If stop with self-wake is activated, and the FlexCAN operates with single system clock per time-quanta,
then there are extreme cases in which FlexCAN's wake-up upon recessive to dominant edge may not
conform to the standard CAN protocol, in the sense that the FlexCAN synchronization is shifted one time
quanta from the required timing. This shift lasts until the next recessive to dominant edge, which
re-synchronizes the FlexCAN back to conform to the protocol. The same holds for auto-power save mode
upon wake-up by recessive to dominant edge.
The auto-power save mode in the FlexCAN is intended to enable NORMAL operation with optimized
power saving. Upon setting the AUTO POWER SAVE bit in the MCR register, the FlexCAN looks for a
set of conditions in which there is no need for clocks to run. If all these conditions are met, then the
FlexCAN stops its clocks, thus saving power. While its clocks are stopped, if any of the conditions below
is not met, the FlexCAN resumes its clocks. It then continues to monitor the conditions and stops/resumes
its clocks appropriately.
The following are conditions for the automatic shut-off of FlexCAN clocks:
• No Rx/Tx frame in progress.
• No moving of Rx/Tx frames between SMB and MB and no Tx frame is pending for transmission
in any MB.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
7-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Power Management
•
•
No host access to the FlexCAN module.
The FlexCAN is neither in halt mode (MCR bit 8), in stop mode (MCT bit 15), nor in BUSOFF.
7.3.2.24
ColdFire Flash Module
The ColdFire Flash Control Module is capable of generating interrupts by the setting of the CBEIF or
CCIF bits in the CFMUSTAT. These interrupt sources, however, should not occur when the device is in a
low-power mode as long as no Flash operation was in progress when the low-power mode was entered.
When performing a program or erase operation on the Flash, if a command is active (CCIF = 0) when the
MCU enters a low-power mode, the command sequence monitor will perform the following:
1. The command in progress will be aborted.
2. The Flash high voltage circuitry will be switched off and any pending command (CBEIF = 0) will
not be executed when the MCU exits low-power mode.
3. The CCIF and ACCERR flags will be set if a command is active when the MCU enters
low-power mode.
NOTE
The state of any longword(s) being programmed, or any erase
pages/physical blocks being erased, is not guaranteed if the MCU enters
stop mode with a command in progress. Active commands are immediately
aborted when the MCU enters stop mode. Do not execute the STOP
instruction during program and erase operations.
7.3.2.25
BDM
Entering halt mode via the BDM port (by asserting the external BKPT pin) will cause the CPU to exit any
low-power mode.
7.3.2.26
JTAG
The JTAG (Joint Test Action Group) controller logic is clocked using the TCLK input and is not affected
by the system clock. The JTAG cannot generate an event to cause the CPU to exit any low-power mode.
Toggling TCLK during any low-power mode will increase the system current consumption.
7.3.3
Summary of Peripheral State During Low-Power Modes
The functionality of each of the peripherals and CPU during the various low-power modes is summarized
in Table 7-7. The status of each peripheral during a given mode refers to the condition the peripheral
automatically assumes when the STOP instruction is executed and the LPCR[LPMD] field is set for the
particular low-power mode. Individual peripherals may be disabled by programming its dedicated control
bits. The wakeup capability field refers to the ability of an interrupt or reset by that peripheral to force the
CPU into run mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
7-13
Power Management
Table 7-7. CPU and Peripherals in Low-Power Modes
Peripheral Status1 / Wakeup Capability
Module
Wait Mode
Doze Mode
Stop Mode
CPU
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
SRAM
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Flash
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Flash Control Module
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
No
System Integration Module
Enabled
Yes 3
Enabled
Yes 3
Stopped
No
SDRAM Controller
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Stopped
No
Chip Select Module
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Stopped
No
DMA Controller
Enabled
Yes
Enabled
Yes
Stopped
No
UART0, UART1 and UART2
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
No
I2C Module
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
No
QSPI
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
No
DMA Timers
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
No
Interrupt controller
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Fast Ethernet Controller
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
No
I/O Ports
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Reset Controller
Enabled
Yes3
Enabled
Yes3
Enabled
Yes3
Chip Configuration Module
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Stopped
No
Power Management
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Stopped
No
Clock Module
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Program
Yes2
Edge port
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
Yes2
Watchdog timer
Program
Yes 3
Program
Yes 3
Stopped
No
Programmable Interrupt Timers
Enabled
Yes2
Program
Yes2
Stopped
No
QADC
Enabled
Yes2
Program
Yes2
Stopped
No
General Purpose Timers
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
No
FlexCAN
Enabled
Yes2
Enabled
Yes2
Stopped
No
BDM
Enabled
Yes4
Enabled
Yes4
Enabled
Yes4
JTAG
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
1
“Program” Indicates that the peripheral function during the low-power mode is dependent on programmable bits in the
peripheral register map.
2 These modules can generate a interrupt which will exit a low-power mode. The CPU will begin to service the interrupt
exception after wakeup.
3 These modules can generate a reset which will exit any low-power mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
7-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Power Management
4
The BDM logic is clocked by a separate TCLK clock. Entering halt mode via the BDM port exits any low-power mode.
Upon exit from halt mode, the previous low-power mode will be re-entered and changes made in halt mode will remain
in effect.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
7-15
Power Management
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
7-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 8
System Control Module (SCM)
This section details the functionality of the System Control Module (SCM) which provides the
programming model for the System Access Control Unit (SACU), the system bus arbiter, a 32-bit core
watchdog timer (CWT), and the system control registers and logic. Specifically, the system control
includes the internal peripheral system (IPS) base address register (IPSBAR), the processor’s dual-port
RAM base address register (RAMBAR), and system control registers that include the core watchdog timer
control.
8.1
Overview
The SCM provides the control and status for a variety of functions including base addressing and address
space masking for both the IPS peripherals and resources (IPSBAR) and the ColdFire core memory spaces
(RAMBAR). The CPU core supports two memory banks, one for the internal SRAM and the other for the
internal Flash.
The SACU provides the mechanism needed to implement secure bus transactions to the system address
space.
The programming model for the system bus arbitration resides in the SCM. The SCM sources the
necessary control signals to the arbiter for bus master management.
The CWT provides a means of preventing system lockup due to uncontrolled software loops via a special
software service sequence. If periodic software servicing action does not occur, the CWT times out with a
programmed response (interrupt) to allow recovery or corrective action to be taken.
8.2
Features
The SCM includes these distinctive features:
• IPS base address register (IPSBAR)
— Base address location for 1-Gbyte peripheral space
— User control bits
• Processor-local memory base address register (RAMBAR)
• System control registers
— Core reset status register (CRSR) indicates type of last reset
— Core watchdog control register (CWCR) for watchdog timer control
— Core watchdog service register (CWSR) to service watchdog timer
• System bus master arbitration programming model (MPARK)
• System access control unit (SACU) programming model
— Master privilege register (MPR)
— Peripheral access control registers (PACRs)
— Grouped peripheral access control registers (GPACR0, GPACR1)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-1
System Control Module (SCM)
8.3
Memory Map and Register Definition
The memory map for the SCM registers is shown in Table 8-1. All the registers in the SCM are
memory-mapped as offsets within the 1 Gbyte IPS address space and accesses are controlled to these
registers by the control definitions programmed into the SACU.
Table 8-1. SCM Register Map
IPSBAR
Offset
[31:24]
[23:16]
0x00_0000
IPSBAR
0x00_0004
—
0x00_0008
RAMBAR
0x00_000C
—
0x00_0010
CRSR
CWCR
0x00_0018
8.4.1
LPICR1
CWSR
MPARK
MPR
—
0x00_0024
PACR0
PACR1
PACR2
PACR3
0x00_0028
PACR4
—
PACR5
PACR6
0x00_002c
PACR7
—
PACR8
—
0x00_0030
GPACR0
GPACR1
—
—
0x00_0034
—
—
—
—
0x00_0038
—
—
—
—
0x00_003C
—
—
—
—
1
8.4
[7:0]
—
0x00_001C
0x00_0020
[15:8]
The LPICR is described in Chapter 7, “Power Management."
Register Descriptions
Internal Peripheral System Base Address Register (IPSBAR)
The IPSBAR specifies the base address for the 1 Gbyte memory space associated with the on-chip
peripherals. At reset, the base address is loaded with a default location of 0x4000_0000 and marked as
valid (IPSBAR[V]=1). If desired, the address space associated with the internal modules can be moved by
loading a different value into the IPSBAR at a later time.
NOTE
Accessing reserved IPSBAR memory space could result in an unterminated
bus cycle that causes the core to hang. Only a hard reset will allow the core
to recover from this state. Therefore, all bus accesses to IPSBAR space
should fall within a module’s memory map space.
If an address “hits” in overlapping memory regions, the following priority is used to determine what
memory is accessed:
1. IPSBAR
2. RAMBAR
3. Cache
4. SDRAM
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-2
Freescale Semiconductor
System Control Module (SCM)
5. Chip Selects
NOTE
This is the list of memory access priorities when viewed from the processor
core.
See Figure 8-1 and Table 8-2 for descriptions of the bits in IPSBAR.
31
30
29
16
Field BA31 BA30
Reset
0
—
1
—
R/W
R/W
15
1
0
Field
—
V
Reset
—
1
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x000
Figure 8-1. IPS Base Address Register (IPSBAR)
Table 8-2. IPSBAR Field Description
Bits
Name
Description
31–30
BA
Base address. Defines the base address of the 1-Gbyte internal peripheral space. This is the
starting address for the IPS registers when the valid bit is set.
29–1
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
0
V
Valid. Enables/disables the IPS Base address region. V is set at reset.
0 IPS Base address is not valid.
1 IPS Base address is valid.
8.4.2
Memory Base Address Register (RAMBAR)
The processor supports dual-ported local SRAM memory. This processor-local memory can be accessed
directly by the core and/or other system bus masters. Since this memory provides single-cycle accesses at
processor speed, it is ideal for applications where double-buffer schemes can be used to maximize
system-level performance. For example, a DMA channel in a typical double-buffer (also known as a
ping-pong scheme) application may load data into one portion of the dual-ported SRAM while the
processor is manipulating data in another portion of the SRAM. Once the processor completes the data
calculations, it begins processing the just-loaded buffer while the DMA moves out the just-calculated data
from the other buffer, and reloads the next data block into the just-freed memory region. The process
repeats with the processor and the DMA “ping-ponging” between alternate regions of the dual-ported
SRAM.
The processor design implements the dual-ported SRAM in the memory space defined by the RAMBAR
register. There are two physical copies of the RAMBAR register: one located in the processor core and
accessible only via the privileged MOVEC instruction at CPU space address 0xC05, and another located
in the SCM at IPSBAR + 0x008. ColdFire core accesses to this memory are controlled by the
processor-local copy of the RAMBAR, while module accesses are enabled by the SCM's RAMBAR.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-3
System Control Module (SCM)
The physical base address programmed in both copies of the RAMBAR is typically the same value;
however, they can be programmed to different values. By definition, the base address must be a
0-modulo-size value.
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
Field BA31 BA30 BA29 BA28 BA27 BA26 BA25 BA24 BA23 BA22 BA21 BA20 BA19 BA18 BA17 BA16
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
15
Field
10
—
9
8
0
BDE
Reset
—
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x008
Figure 8-2. Memory Base Address Register (RAMBAR)
Table 8-3. RAMBAR Field Description
Bits
Name
Description
31–16
BA
Base address. Defines the memory module's base address on a 64-Kbyte boundary corresponding
to the physical array location within the 4 Gbyte address space supported by ColdFire.
15–10
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
9
BDE
8–0
—
Back door enable. Qualifies the module accesses to the memory.
0 Disables module accesses to the memory.
1 Enables module accesses to the memory.
NOTE: The SPV bit in the CPU’s RAMBAR must also be set to allow dual port access to the SRAM.
For more information, see Section 5.3.1, “SRAM Base Address Register (RAMBAR).”
Reserved, should be cleared.
The SRAM modules are configured through the RAMBAR shown in Figure 8-2.
• RAMBAR specifies the base address of the SRAM.
• All undefined bits are reserved. These bits are ignored during writes to the RAMBAR and return
zeros when read.
• The back door enable bit, RAMBAR[BDE], is cleared at reset, disabling the module access to the
SRAM.
NOTE
The RAMBAR default value of 0x0000_0000 is invalid. The RAMBAR
located in the processor’s CPU space must be initialized with the valid bit
set before the CPU (or modules) can access the on-chip SRAM (see
Chapter 5, “Static RAM (SRAM)” for more information.
For details on the processor's view of the local SRAM memories, see Section 5.3.1, “SRAM Base Address
Register (RAMBAR).”
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-4
Freescale Semiconductor
System Control Module (SCM)
8.4.3
Core Reset Status Register (CRSR)
The CRSR contains a bit for two of the reset sources to the CPU. A bit set to 1 indicates the last type of
reset that occurred. The CRSR is updated by the control logic when the reset is complete. Only one bit is
set at any one time in the CRSR. The register reflects the cause of the most recent reset. To clear a bit, a
logic 1 must be written to the bit location; writing a zero has no effect.
NOTE
The reset status register (RSR) in the reset controller module (see
Chapter 29, “Reset Controller Module”) provides indication of all reset
sources except the core watchdog timer.
7
Field
6
5
4
0
EXT
Reset
—
See Note
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x010
Note: The reset value of EXT and CWDR depend on the last reset
source. All other bits are initialized to zero.
Figure 8-3. Core Reset Status Register (CRSR)
Table 8-4. CRSR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7
EXT
External reset.
1 An external device driving RSTI caused the last reset. Assertion of reset by an external device
causes the processor core to initiate reset exception processing. All registers are forced to their
initial state.
6-0
—
8.4.4
Reserved.
Core Watchdog Control Register (CWCR)
The core watchdog timer prevents system lockup if the software becomes trapped in a loop with no
controlled exit. The core watchdog timer can be enabled or disabled through CWCR[CWE]. By default it
is disabled. If enabled, the watchdog timer requires the periodic execution of a core watchdog servicing
sequence. If this periodic servicing action does not occur, the timer times out, resulting in a watchdog timer
interrupt. If the timer times out and the core watchdog transfer acknowledge enable bit (CWCR[CWTA])
is set, a watchdog timer interrupt is asserted. If a core watchdog timer interrupt acknowledge cycle has not
occurred after another timeout, CWT TA is asserted in an attempt to allow the interrupt acknowledge cycle
to proceed by terminating the bus cycle. The setting of CWCR[CWTAVAL] indicates that the watchdog
timer TA was asserted.
NOTE
The core watchdog timer is available to provide compatibility with the
watchdog timer implemented on previous ColdFire devices. However, there
is a second watchdog timer available that has new features. See Chapter 18,
“Watchdog Timer Module” for more information.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-5
System Control Module (SCM)
When the core watchdog timer times out and CWCR[CWRI] is programmed for a software reset, an
internal reset is asserted and CRSR[CWDR] is set. To prevent the core watchdog timer from interrupting
or resetting, the CWSR must be serviced by performing the following sequence:
1. Write 0x55 to CWSR.
2. Write 0xAA to the CWSR.
Both writes must occur in order before the time-out, but any number of instructions can be executed
between the two writes. This order allows interrupts and exceptions to occur, if necessary, between the two
writes. Caution should be exercised when changing CWCR values after the software watchdog timer has
been enabled with the setting of CWCR[CWE], because it is difficult to determine the state of the core
watchdog timer while it is running. The countdown value is constantly compared with the time-out period
specified by CWCR[CWT]. The following steps must be taken to change CWT:
1. Disable the core watchdog timer by clearing CWCR[CWE].
2. Reset the counter by writing 0x55 and then 0xAA to CWSR.
3. Update CWCR[CWT].
4. Re-enable the core watchdog timer by setting CWCR[CWE]. This step can be performed in step
3.
The CWCR controls the software watchdog timer, time-out periods, and software watchdog timer transfer
acknowledge. The register can be read at any time, but can be written only if the CWT is not pending. At
system reset, the software watchdog timer is disabled.
Field
7
6
5
CWE
CWRI
Reset
3
CWT[2:0]
2
1
0
CWTA
CWTAVAL
CWTIC
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x011
Figure 8-4. Core Watchdog Control Register (CWCR)
Table 8-5. CWCR Field Description
Bits
Name
Description
7
CWE
Core watchdog enable.
0 SWT disabled.
1 SWT enabled.
6
CWRI
Core watchdog reset/interrupt select.
0 If a time-out occurs, the CWT generates an interrupt to the processor core. The interrupt level for
the CWT is programmed in the interrupt control register 8 (ICR8) of INTC0.
1 Reserved; do not use.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-6
Freescale Semiconductor
System Control Module (SCM)
Table 8-5. CWCR Field Description (continued)
5–3
2
1
0
8.4.5
CWT[2:0]
CWTA
Core watchdog timing delay. These bits select the timeout period for the CWT. At system reset, the
CWT field is cleared signaling the minimum time-out period but the watchdog is disabled
(CWCR[CWE] = 0).
CWT
CWT Time-Out Period
CWT
CWT Time-Out Period
000
29 Bus clock frequency
100
219 Bus clock frequency
001
211 Bus clock frequency
101
223 Bus clock frequency
010
213 Bus clock frequency
110
227 Bus clock frequency
011
215 Bus clock frequency
111
231 Bus clock frequency
Core watchdog transfer acknowledge enable.
0 CWTA Transfer acknowledge disabled.
1 CWTA Transfer Acknowledge enabled. After one CWT time-out period of the unacknowledged
assertion of the CWT interrupt, the transfer acknowledge asserts, which allows CWT to terminate
a bus cycle and allow the interrupt acknowledge to occur.
CWTAVAL Core watchdog transfer acknowledge valid.
0 CWTA Transfer Acknowledge has not occurred.
1 CWTA Transfer Acknowledge has occurred. Write a 1 to clear this flag bit.
CWTIF
Core watchdog timer interrupt flag.
0 CWT interrupt has not occurred
1 CWT interrupt has occurred. Write a 1 to clear the interrupt request.
Core Watchdog Service Register (CWSR)
The software watchdog service sequence must be performed using the CWSR as a data register to prevent
a CWT time-out. The service sequence requires two writes to this data register: first a write of 0x55
followed by a write of 0xAA. Both writes must be performed in this order prior to the CWT time-out, but
any number of instructions or accesses to the CWSR can be executed between the two writes. If the CWT
has already timed out, writing to this register has no effect in negating the CWT interrupt. Figure 8-5
illustrates the CWSR. At system reset, the contents of CWSR are uninitialized.
7
0
Field
CWSR[7:0]
Reset
Uninitialized
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x013
Figure 8-5. Core Watchdog Service Register (CWSR)
8.5
Internal Bus Arbitration
The internal bus arbitration is performed by the on-chip bus arbiter, which containing the arbitration logic
that controls which of up to four MBus masters (M0–M3 in Figure 8-6) has access to the external buses.
The function of the arbitration logic is described in this section.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-7
System Control Module (SCM)
“back door” to SRAM and Flash
SRAM1
MPARK
RAMBAR
CPU
M0
DMA
M2
Internal
Bus
Master
M1
EIM
MARB
Internal
Modules
FEC
SDRAMC
*Not used on
MCF5214/16
M3
Figure 8-6. Arbiter Module Functions
8.5.1
Overview
The basic functionality is that of a 4-port, pipelined internal bus arbitration module with the following
attributes:
• The master pointed to by the current arbitration pointer may get on the bus with zero latency if the
address phase is available. All other requesters face at least a one cycle arbitration pipeline delay
in order to meet bus timing constraints on address phase hold.
• If a requester will get an immediate address phase (that is, it is pointed to by the current arbitration
pointer and the bus address phase is available), it will be the current bus master and is ignored by
arbitration. All remaining requesting ports are evaluated by the arbitration algorithm to determine
the next-state arbitration pointer.
• There are two arbitration algorithms, fixed and round-robin. Fixed arbitration sets the next-state
arbitration pointer to the highest priority requester. Round-robin arbitration sets the next-state
arbitration pointer to the highest priority requester (calculated by adding a requester's fixed priority
to the current bus master’s fixed priority and then taking this sum modulo the number of possible
bus masters).
• The default priority is FEC (M3) > DMA (M2) > internal master (M1) > CPU (M0), where M3 is
the highest and M0 the lowest priority. M3 is not used for the MCF5216 and MCF5214.
• There are two actions for an idle arbitration cycle, either leave the current arbitration pointer as is
or set it to the lowest priority requester.
• The anti-lock-out logic for the fixed priority scheme forces the arbitration algorithm to round-robin
if any requester has been held for longer than a specified cycle count.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-8
Freescale Semiconductor
System Control Module (SCM)
8.5.2
Arbitration Algorithms
There are two modes of arbitration: fixed and round-robin. This section discusses the differences between
them.
8.5.2.1
Round-Robin Mode
Round-robin arbitration is the default mode after reset. This scheme cycles through the sequence of
masters as specified by MPARK[Mn_PRTY] bits. Upon completion of a transfer, the master is given the
lowest priority and the priority for all other masters is increased by one.
M3 = 11 M2 =01 M1 = 10 M0 = 00
next +1 M3 = 00 M2 =10 M1 = 11 M0 = 01
next +2 M3 = 01 M2 =11 M1 = 00 M0 = 10
next +3 M3 = 10 M2 =00 M1 = 01 M0 = 11
If no masters are requesting, the arbitration unit must “park”, pointing at one of the masters. There are two
possibilities, park the arbitration unit on the last active master, or park pointing to the highest priority
master. Setting MPARK[PRK_LAST] causes the arbitration pointer to be parked on the highest priority
master. In round-robin mode, programming the timeout enable and lockout bits MPARK[13,11:8] will
have no effect on the arbitration.
8.5.2.2
Fixed Mode
In fixed arbitration the master with highest priority (as specified by the MPARK[Mn_PRTY] bits) will win
the bus. That master will relinquish the bus when all transfers to that master are complete.
If MPARK[TIMEOUT] is set, a counter will increment for each master for every cycle it is denied access.
When a counter reaches the limit set by MPARK[LCKOUT_TIME], the arbitration algorithm will be
changed to round-robin arbitration mode until all locks are cleared. The arbitration will then return to fixed
mode and the highest priority master will be granted the bus.
As in round-robin mode, if no masters are requesting, the arbitration pointer will park on the highest
priority master if MPARK[PRK_LAST] is set, or will park on the master which last requested the bus if
cleared.
8.5.3
Bus Master Park Register (MPARK)
The MPARK controls the operation of the system bus arbitration module. The platform bus master
connections are defined as:
• Master 3 (M3): Fast Ethernet Controller (Not used for the MCF5216 and MCF5214)
• Master 2 (M2): 4-channel DMA
• Master 1 (M1): Internal Bus Master (not used in normal user operation)
• Master 0 (M0): V2 ColdFire Core
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-9
System Control Module (SCM)
31
26
Field
—
25
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
M2_P_EN BCR24BIT M3_PRTY M2_PRTY M0_PRTY M1_PRTY
Reset
0011_0000_1110_0001
R/W
Field
24
R/W
15
14
—
FIXED
Reset
13
12
TIMEOUT PRKLAST
11
8
7
LCKOUT_TIME
0
—
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x01C
Figure 8-7. Default Bus Master Park Register (MPARK)
Table 8-6. MPARK Field Description
Bits
Name
Description
31–26
—
25
M2_P_EN
DMA bandwith control enable
0 disable the use of the DMA's bandwidth control to elevate the priority of its bus requests.
1 enable the use of the DMA's bandwidth control to elevate the priority of its bus requests.
24
BCR24BIT
Enables the use of 24 bit byte count registers in the DMA module
0 DMA BCRs function as 16 bit counters.
1 DMA BCRs function as 24 bit counters.
23–22
M3_PRTY
Master priority level for master 3 (Fast Ethernet Controller)
00 fourth (lowest) priority
01 third priority
10 second priority
11 first (highest) priority
Note: Reserved on the MCF5214 and MCF5216
21–20
M2_PRTY
Master priority level for master 2 (DMA Controller)
00 fourth (lowest) priority
01 third priority
10 second priority
11 first (highest) priority
19–18
M0_PRTY
Master priority level for master 0 (ColdFire Core)
00 fourth (lowest) priority
01 third priority
10 second priority
11 first (highest) priority
17–16
M1_PRTY
Master priority level for master 1 (Not used in user mode)
00 fourth (lowest) priority
01 third priority
10 second priority
11 first (highest) priority
15
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-10
Freescale Semiconductor
System Control Module (SCM)
Table 8-6. MPARK Field Description (continued)
Bits
Name
14
FIXED
13
TIMEOUT
Timeout Enable
0 disable count for when a master is locked out by other masters.
1 enable count for when a master is locked out by other masters and allow access when
LCKOUT_TIME is reached.
12
PRKLAST
Park on the last active master or highest priority master if no masters are active
0 park on last active master
1 park on highest priority master
11–8
7–0
Description
Fixed or round robin arbitration
0 round robin arbitration
1 fixed arbitration
LCKOUT_TIME Lock-out Time. Lock-out time for a master being denied the bus.
The lock out time is defined as 2^ LCKOUT_TIME[3:0].
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
The initial state of the master priorities is M3 > M2 > M1 > M0. System software should guarantee that
the programmed Mn_PRTY fields are unique, otherwise the hardware defaults to the initial-state priorities.
NOTE
The M1_PRTY field should not be set for a priority higher than third
(default).
8.6
System Access Control Unit (SACU)
This section details the functionality of the System Access Control Unit (SACU) which provides the
mechanism needed to implement secure bus transactions to the address space mapped to the internal
modules.
8.6.1
Overview
The SACU supports the traditional model of two privilege levels: supervisor and user. Typically, memory
references with the supervisor attribute have total accessibility to all the resources in the system, while user
mode references cannot access system control and configuration registers. In many systems, the operating
system executes in supervisor mode, while application software executes in user mode.
The SACU further partitions the access control functions into two parts: one control register defines the
privilege level associated with each bus master, and another set of control registers define the access levels
associated with the peripheral modules and the memory space.
The SACU’s programming model is physically implemented as part of the System Control Module (SCM)
with the actual access control logic included as part of the arbitration controller. Each bus transaction
targeted for the IPS space is first checked to see if its privilege rights allow access to the given memory
space. If the privilege rights are correct, the access proceeds on the bus. If the privilege rights are
insufficient for the targeted memory space, the transfer is immediately aborted and terminated with an
exception, and the targeted module not accessed.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-11
System Control Module (SCM)
8.6.2
Features
Each bus transfer can be classified by its privilege level and the reference type. The complete set of access
types includes:
• Supervisor instruction fetch
• Supervisor operand read
• Supervisor operand write
• User instruction fetch
• User operand read
• User operand write
Instruction fetch accesses are associated with the execute attribute.
It should be noted that while the bus does not implement the concept of reference type (code versus data)
and only supports the user/supervisor privilege level, the reference type attribute is supported by the
system bus. Accordingly, the access checking associated with both privilege level and reference type is
performed in the IPS controller using the attributes associated with the reference from the system bus.
The SACU partitions the access control mechanisms into three distinct functions:
• Master privilege register (MPR)
— Allows each bus master to be assigned a privilege level:
– Disable the master’s user/supervisor attribute and force to user mode access
– Enable the master’s user/supervisor attribute
— The reset state provides supervisor privilege to the processor core (bus master 0).
— Input signals allow the non-core bus masters to have their user/supervisor attribute enabled at
reset. This is intended to support the concept of a trusted bus master, and also controls the
ability of a bus master to modify the register state of any of the SACU control registers; that is,
only trusted masters can modify the control registers.
• Peripheral access control registers (PACRs)
— Nine 8-bit registers control access to 17 of the on-chip peripheral modules.
— Provides read/write access rights, supervisor/user privilege levels
— Reset state provides supervisor-only read/write access to these modules
— Grouped peripheral access control registers (GPACR0, GPACR1)
— One single register (GPACR0) controls access to 14 of the on-chip peripheral modules
— One register (GPACR1) controls access for IPS reads and writes to the Flash module
— Provide read/write/execute access rights, supervisor/user privilege levels
— Reset state provides supervisor-only read/write access to each of these peripheral spaces
8.6.3
Memory Map/Register Definition
The memory map for the SACU program-visible registers within the System Control Module (SCM) is
shown in Figure 8-7. The MPR, PACR, and GPACRs are 8 bits in width.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-12
Freescale Semiconductor
System Control Module (SCM)
Table 8-7. SACU Register Memory Map
IPSBA
R
Offset
[31:28]
[27:24]
[23:20]
[19:16]
[15:12]
[11:8]
[7:4]
[3:0]
—
—
—
—
—
—
0x020
MPR
0x024
PACR0
PACR1
PACR2
PACR3
0x028
PACR4
—
PACR5
PACR6
0x02c
PACR7
—
PACR8
—
0x030
GPACR0
GPACR1
—
—
0x034
—
—
—
—
0x038
—
—
—
—
0x03C
—
—
—
—
8.6.3.1
Master Privilege Register (MPR)
The MPR specifies the access privilege level associated with each bus master in the platform. The register
provides one bit per bus master, where bit 3 corresponds to master 3 (Fast Ethernet Controller, not used on
MCF5216 and MCF5214), bit 2 to master 2 (DMA Controller), bit 1 to master 1 (internal bus master), and
bit 0 to master 0 (ColdFire core).
7
Field
0
—
Reset
MPR[3:0]
0000_0011
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x020
Figure 8-8. Master Privilege Register (MPR)
Table 8-8. MPR[n] Field Descriptions
Bits Name
7–4
—
3–0
MPR
Description
Reserved. Should be cleared.
Each 1-bit field defines the access privilege level of the given bus master n.
0 All bus master accesses are in user mode.
1 All bus master accesses use the sourced user/supervisor attribute.
Only trusted bus masters can modify the access control registers. If a non-trusted bus master attempts to
write any of the SACU control registers, the access is aborted with an error termination and the registers
remain unaffected.
The processor core is connected to bus master 0 and is always treated as a trusted bus master. Accordingly,
MPR[0] is forced to 1 at reset.
8.6.3.2
Peripheral Access Control Registers (PACR0–PACR8)
Access to several on-chip peripherals is controlled by shared peripheral access control registers. A single
PACR defines the access level for each of the two modules. These modules only support operand reads
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-13
System Control Module (SCM)
and writes. Each PACR follows the format illustrated in Figure 8-9. For a list of PACRs and the modules
that they control, refer to Table 8-11.
7
Field
6
4
LOCK1
3
ACCESS_CTRL1
Reset
2
LOCK0
0
ACCESS_CTRL0
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x24 + Offset
Figure 8-9. Peripheral Access Control Register (PACRn)
Table 8-9. PACR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7
LOCK1
This bit, when set, prevents subsequent writes to ACCESSCTRL1. Any attempted
write to the PACR generates an error termination and the contents of the register are
not affected. Only a system reset clears this flag.
6–4 ACCESS_CTRL1 This 3-bit field defines the access control for the given platform peripheral.
The encodings for this field are shown in Table 8-10.
3
LOCK0
This bit, when set, prevents subsequent writes to ACCESSCTRL0. Any attempted
write to the PACR generates an error termination and the contents of the register are
not affected. Only a system reset clears this flag.
2–0 ACCESS_CTRL0 This 3-bit field defines the access control for the given platform peripheral.
The encodings for this field are shown in Table 8-10.
Table 8-10. PACR ACCESSCTRL Bit Encodings
Bits
Supervisor Mode
User Mode
000
Read/Write
No Access
001
Read
No Access
010
Read
Read
011
Read
No Access
100
Read/Write
Read/Write
101
Read/Write
Read
110
Read/Write
Read/Write
111
No Access
No Access
Table 8-11. Peripheral Access Control Registers (PACRs)
Modules Controlled
IPSBAR Offset
Name
ACCESS_CTRL1
ACCESS_CTRL0
0x024
PACR0
SCM
SDRAMC
0x025
PACR1
EIM
DMA
0x026
PACR2
UART0
UART1
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-14
Freescale Semiconductor
System Control Module (SCM)
Table 8-11. Peripheral Access Control Registers (PACRs) (continued)
Modules Controlled
IPSBAR Offset
Name
ACCESS_CTRL1
ACCESS_CTRL0
PACR3
UART2
—
0x028
PACR4
2
I C
QSPI
0x029
—
—
—
0x02a
PACR5
DTIM0
DTIM1
0x02b
PACR6
DTIM2
DTIM3
0x02c
PACR7
INTC0
INTC1
0x02d
—
—
—
0x02e
PACR8
FEC0
—
0x027
At reset, these on-chip modules are configured to have only supervisor read/write access capabilities. If an
instruction fetch access to any of these peripheral modules is attempted, the IPS bus cycle is immediately
terminated with an error.
8.6.3.3
Grouped Peripheral Access Control Registers (GPACR0 & GPACR1)
The on-chip peripheral space starting at IPSBAR is subdivided into sixteen 64-Mbyte regions. Each of the
first two regions has a unique access control register associated with it. The other fourteen regions are in
reserved space; the access control registers for these regions are not implemented. Bits [29:26] of the
address select the specific GPACRn to be used for a given reference within the IPS address space. These
access control registers are 8 bits in width so that read, write, and execute attributes may be assigned to the
given IPS region.
NOTE
The access control for modules with memory space protected by
PACR0–PACR8 are determined by the PACR0–PACR8 settings. The access
control is not affected by GPACR0, even though the modules are mapped in
its 64-Mbyte address space.
Field
7
6–4
LOCK
—
Reset
Read/Write
Address
3
0
ACCESS_CTRL
0000_0000
R/W
R
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x030, IPSBAR + 0x31
Figure 8-10. Grouped Peripheral Access Control Register (GPACR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-15
System Control Module (SCM)
Table 8-12. GPACR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7
LOCK
This bit, once set, prevents subsequent writes to the GPACR. Any attempted write to the
GPACR generates an error termination and the contents of the register are not affected.
Only a system reset clears this flag.
6–4
—
3–0
Reserved, should be cleared.
ACCESS_CTRL This 4-bit field defines the access control for the given memory region.
The encodings for this field are shown in Table 8-13.
At reset, these on-chip modules are configured to have only supervisor read/write access capabilities. Bit
encodings for the ACCESS_CTRL field in the GPACR are shown in Table 8-13. Table 8-14 shows the
memory space protected by the GPACRs and the modules mapped to these spaces.
Table 8-13. GPACR ACCESS_CTRL Bit Encodings
Bits
Supervisor Mode
User Mode
0000
Read / Write
No Access
0001
Read
No Access
0010
Read
Read
0011
Read
No Access
0100
Read / Write
Read / Write
0101
Read / Write
Read
0110
Read / Write
Read / Write
0111
No Access
No Access
1000
Read / Write / Execute
No Access
1001
Read / Execute
No Access
1010
Read / Execute
Read / Execute
1011
Execute
No Access
1100
Read / Write / Execute
Read / Write / Execute
1101
Read / Write / Execute
Read / Execute
1110
Read / Write
Read
1111
Read / Write / Execute
Execute
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-16
Freescale Semiconductor
System Control Module (SCM)
Table 8-14. GPACR Address Space
Register
Space Protected
(IPSBAR Offset)
Modules Protected
GPACR0
0x0000_0000–
0x03FF_FFFF
Ports, CCM, PMM, Reset controller, Clock,
EPORT, WDOG, PIT0–PIT3, QADC, GPTA,
GPTB, FlexCAN, CFM (Control)
GPACR1
0x0400_0000–
0x07FF_FFFF
CFM (Flash module’s backdoor access for
programming or access by a bus master other
than the core)
Note: Reserved for the MCF5280
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
8-17
System Control Module (SCM)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
8-18
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 9
Clock Module
The clock module configures the device for one of several clocking methods. Clocking modes include
internal phase-locked loop (PLL) clocking with either an external clock reference or an external crystal
reference supported by an internal crystal amplifier. The PLL can also be disabled and an external
oscillator can be used to clock the device directly. The clock module contains:
• Crystal amplifier and oscillator (OSC)
• Phase-locked loop (PLL)
• Reduced frequency divider (RFD)
• Status and control registers
• Control logic
9.1
Features
Features of the clock module include:
• 2- to 10-MHz reference crystal oscillator
• Support for low-power modes
• Separate clock out signal
9.2
Modes of Operation
The clock module can be operated in normal PLL mode (default), 1:1 PLL mode, or external clock mode.
9.2.1
Normal PLL Mode
In normal PLL mode, the PLL is fully programmable. It can synthesize frequencies ranging from 2x to 9x
the reference frequency and has a post divider capable of reducing this synthesized frequency without
disturbing the PLL. The PLL reference can be either a crystal oscillator or an external clock.
9.2.2
1:1 PLL Mode
In 1:1 PLL mode, the PLL synthesizes a frequency equal to the external clock input reference frequency.
The post divider is not active.
9.2.3
External Clock Mode
In external clock mode, the PLL is bypassed, and the external clock is applied to EXTAL. The resulting
operating frequency is equal to the external clock frequency.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-1
Clock Module
9.3
Low-power Mode Operation
This subsection describes the operation of the clock module in low-power and halted modes of operation.
Low-power modes are described in Chapter 7, “Power Management.” Table 9-1 shows the clock module
operation in low-power modes.
Table 9-1. Clock Module Operation in Low-power Modes
Low-power Mode
Clock Operation
Mode Exit
Wait
Clocks sent to peripheral modules only
Exit not caused by clock module, but normal
clocking resumes upon mode exit
Doze
Clocks sent to peripheral modules only
Exit not caused by clock module, but normal
clocking resumes upon mode exit
Stop
All system clocks disabled
Exit not caused by clock module, but clock
sources are re-enabled and normal clocking
resumes upon mode exit
Halted
Normal
Exit not caused by clock module
During wakeup from a low-power mode, the Flash clock always clocks through at least 16 cycles before
the CPU clocks are enabled. This allows the Flash module time to recover from the low-power mode, and
software can immediately resume fetching instructions from memory.
In wait and doze modes, the system clocks to the peripherals are enabled, and the clocks to the CPU, Flash,
and SRAM are stopped. Each module can disable its clock locally at the module level.
In stop mode, all system clocks are disabled. There are several options for enabling or disabling the PLL
or crystal oscillator in stop mode, compromising between stop mode current and wakeup recovery time.
The PLL can be disabled in stop mode, but requires a wakeup period before it can relock. The oscillator
can also be disabled during stop mode, but requires a wakeup period to restart.
When the PLL is enabled in stop mode (STPMD[1:0]), the external CLKOUT signal can support systems
using CLKOUT as the clock source.
There is also a fast wakeup option for quickly enabling the system clocks during stop recovery. This
eliminates the wakeup recovery time but at the risk of sending a potentially unstable clock to the system.
To prevent a non-locked PLL frequency overshoot when using the fast wakeup option, change the RFD
divisor to the current RFD value plus one before entering stop mode.
In external clock mode, there are no wakeup periods for oscillator startup or PLL lock.
9.4
Block Diagram
Figure shows a block diagram of the entire clock module. The PLL block in this diagram is expanded in
detail in Figure 9-2.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
.
CLKMOD[1:0]
EXTAL
CLKOUT
LOCKS
XTAL
EXTERNAL CLOCK
RSTOUT
MFD
PLLMODE
LOCK
REFERENCE
CLOCK
LOCS
PLL
OSC
RFD[2:0]
TO RESET
MODULE
PLLREF
LOCEN
LOLRE
LOCRE
PLL CLOCK OUT
STPMD[1:0]
SCALED PLL CLOCK OUT
STOP MODE
CLKGEN
INTERNAL CLOCK
PLLSEL
CLKOUT
DISCLK
INTERNAL
CLOCKS
STOP MODE
PLLMODE
LOCK
FWKUP
Figure 9-1. Clock Module Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-3
Clock Module
CLKMOD[1:0]
RSTOUT
STPMD
LOCKS
LOCK
DETECT
LOCK
LOLRE
TO RESET
MODULE
PLLMODE
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOSS OF
CLOCK
DETECT
REFERENCE
CLOCK
LOCS
PHASE AND
FREQUENCY
DETECT
CHARGE
PUMP
FILTER
VCO
RFD[2:0]
SCALED PLL
CLOCK OUT
PLLSEL
DISCLK
MDF[2:0]
CLKOUT
÷ MFD
(4–18)
PLL CLOCK
OUT
Figure 9-2. PLL Block Diagram
9.5
Signal Descriptions
The clock module signals are summarized in Table 9-2 and a brief description follows. For more detailed
information, refer to Chapter 14, “Signal Descriptions.”
Table 9-2. Signal Properties
Name
9.5.1
Function
EXTAL
Oscillator or clock input
XTAL
Oscillator output
CLKOUT
System clock output
CLKMOD[1:0]
Clock mode select inputs
RSTOUT
Reset signal from reset controller
EXTAL
This input is driven by an external clock except when used as a connection to the external crystal when
using the internal oscillator.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
9.5.2
XTAL
This output is an internal oscillator connection to the external crystal.
9.5.3
CLKOUT
This output reflects the internal system clock.
9.5.4
CLKMOD[1:0]
These inputs are used to select the clock mode during chip configuration.
9.5.5
RSTOUT
The RSTOUT pin is asserted by one of the following:
• Internal system reset signal
• FRCRSTOUT bit in the reset control status register (RCR); see Section 29.4.1, “Reset Control
Register (RCR).”
9.6
Memory Map and Registers
The clock module programming model consists of these registers:
• Synthesizer control register (SYNCR), which defines clock operation
• Synthesizer status register (SYNSR), which reflects clock status
9.6.1
Module Memory Map
Table 9-3. Clock Module Memory Map
1
IPSBAR Offset
Register Name
Access1
0x0012_0000
Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR)
S
0x0012_0002
Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR)
S
S = CPU supervisor mode access only.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-5
Clock Module
9.6.2
Register Descriptions
This subsection provides a description of the clock module registers.
9.6.2.1
Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR)
Field
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
LOLRE
MFD2
MFD1
MFD0
LOCRE
RFD2
RFD1
RFD0
Reset
0010_0001
R/W
Field
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LOCEN
DISCLK
FWKUP
—
STPMD1
STPMD0
—
—
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
R
R/W
R
IPSBAR + 0x0012_0000
Figure 9-3. Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR)
Table 9-4. SYNCR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
15
LOLRE
Loss of lock reset enable. Determines how the system handles a loss of lock
indication. When operating in normal mode or 1:1 PLL mode, the PLL must be locked
before setting the LOLRE bit. Otherwise reset is immediately asserted. To prevent an
immediate reset, the LOLRE bit must be cleared before writing the MFD[2:0] bits or
entering stop mode with the PLL disabled.
1 Reset on loss of lock
0 No reset on loss of lock
Note: In external clock mode, the LOLRE bit has no effect.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
Table 9-4. SYNCR Field Descriptions (continued)
Bit(s)
Name
Description
14–12
MFD
Multiplication Factor Divider. Contain the binary value of the divider in the PLL
feedback loop. The MFD[2:0] value is the multiplication factor applied to the reference
frequency. When MFD[2:0] are changed or the PLL is disabled in stop mode, the PLL
loses lock. In 1:1 PLL mode, MFD[2:0] are ignored, and the multiplication factor is one.
Note: In external clock mode, the MFD[2:0] bits have no effect.
((
The following table illustrates the system frequency multiplier of the reference
frequency1 in normal PLL mode.
MFD[2:0]
0002
(4x)
001
(6x)
000 (÷ 1)
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
2)3
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
010 (÷ 4)
1
3/2
2
5/2
3
7/2
4
9/2
011 (÷ 8)
1/2
3/4
1
5/4
3/2
7/4
2
9/4
100 (÷ 16)
1/4
3/8
1/2
5/8
3/4
7/8
1
9/8
101 (÷ 32)
1/8
3/16
1/4
5/16
3/8
7/16
1/2
9/16
110 (÷ 64)
1/16
3/32
1/8
5/32
3/16
7/32
1/4
9/32
111 (÷ 128)
1/32
3/64
1/16
5/64
3/32
7/64
1/8
9/64
RFD[2:0]
001 (÷
1
010
011
100
101
110
111
(8x)(3) (10x) (12x) (14x) (16x) (18x)
f ref × 2 ( MFD + 2 )
- ; f ref × 2 ( MFD + 2 ) ≤ f sys ( max ) ; f sys ≤ f sys ( max ) ,
f sys = --------------------------------------------RFD
2
where fsys(max) is the maximum system frequency for the particular MCF5282
device (66 MHz or 80 MHz).
2 MFD = 000 not valid for f
ref < 3 MHz
3
Default value out of reset
11
LOCRE
10–8
RFD
Loss-of-clock reset enable. Determines how the system handles a loss-of-clock
condition. When the LOCEN bit is clear, LOCRE has no effect. If the LOCS flag in
SYNSR indicates a loss-of-clock condition, setting the LOCRE bit causes an
immediate reset. To prevent an immediate reset, the LOCRE bit must be cleared
before entering stop mode with the PLL disabled.
1 Reset on loss-of-clock
0 No reset on loss-of-clock
Note: In external clock mode, the LOCRE bit has no effect.
Reduced frequency divider field. The binary value written to RFD[2:0] is the PLL
frequency divisor. See table in MFD bit description. Changing RFD[2:0] does not affect
the PLL or cause a relock delay. Changes in clock frequency are synchronized to the
next falling edge of the current system clock. To avoid surpassing the allowable system
operating frequency, write to RFD[2:0] only when the LOCK bit is set.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-7
Clock Module
Table 9-4. SYNCR Field Descriptions (continued)
Bit(s)
Name
7
LOCEN
Enables the loss-of-clock function. LOCEN does not affect the loss of lock function.
1 Loss-of-clock function enabled
0 Loss-of-clock function disabled
Note: In external clock mode, the LOCEN bit has no effect.
6
DISCLK
Disable CLKOUT determines whether CLKOUT is driven. Setting the DISCLK bit
holds CLKOUT low.
1 CLKOUT disabled
0 CLKOUT enabled
5
FWKUP
Fast wakeup determines when the system clocks are enabled during wakeup from
stop mode.
1 System clocks enabled on wakeup regardless of PLL lock status
0 System clocks enabled only when PLL is locked or operating normally
Note: When FWKUP = 0, if the PLL or oscillator is enabled and unintentionally lost in
stop mode, the PLL wakes up in self-clocked mode or reference clock mode
depending on the clock that was lost. In external clock mode, the FWKUP bit has no
effect on the wakeup sequence.
4
—
3–2
STPMD
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Control PLL and CLKOUT operation in stop mode. The following table illustrates
STPMD operation in stop mode.
STPMD[1:0]
1–0
9.6.2.2
—
Operation During Stop Mode
System
Clocks
PLL
OSC
CLKOUT
00
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
01
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Disabled
10
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
11
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Reserved, should be cleared.
Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR)
The SYNSR is a read-only register that can be read at any time. Writing to the SYNSR has no effect and
terminates the cycle normally.
7
6
Field PLLMODE PLLSEL
Reset
See note 1
5
4
3
2
PLLREF
LOCKS
LOCK
LOCS
See note 2
R/W
Address
1
0
—
000
R
IPSBAR + 0x0012_0002
Note: 1. Reset state determined during reset configuration.
2. See the LOCKS and LOCK bit descriptions.
Figure 9-4. Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
Table 9-5. SYNSR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7
PLLMODE
Clock mode bit. The PLLMODE bit is configured at reset and reflects the clock mode
as shown in Table 9-6.
1 PLL clock mode
0 External clock mode
6
PLLSEL
PLL select. Configured at reset and reflects the PLL mode as shown in Table 9-6.
1 Normal PLL mode
0 1:1 PLL mode
5
PLLREF
PLL reference. Configured at reset and reflects the PLL reference source in normal
PLL mode as shown in Table 9-6.
1 Crystal clock reference
0 External clock reference
4
LOCKS
Sticky indication of PLL lock status.
1 No unintentional PLL loss of lock since last system reset or MFD change
0 PLL loss of lock since last system reset or MFD change or currently not locked due
to exit from STOP with FWKUP set
The lock detect function sets the LOCKS bit when the PLL achieves lock after:
• A system reset
• A write to SYNCR that changes the MFD[2:0] bits
When the PLL loses lock, LOCKS is cleared. When the PLL relocks, LOCKS remains
cleared until one of the two listed events occurs.
In stop mode, if the PLL is intentionally disabled, then the LOCKS bit reflects the value
prior to entering stop mode. However, if FWKUP is set, then LOCKS is cleared until
the PLL regains lock. Once lock is regained, the LOCKS bit reflects the value prior to
entering stop mode. Furthermore, reading the LOCKS bit at the same time that the
PLL loses lock does not return the current loss of lock condition.
In external clock mode, LOCKS remains cleared after reset. In normal PLL mode and
1:1 PLL mode, LOCKS is set after reset.
3
LOCK
Set when the PLL is locked. PLL lock occurs when the synthesized frequency is within
approximately 0.75 percent of the programmed frequency. The PLL loses lock when a
frequency deviation of greater than approximately 1.5 percent occurs. Reading the
LOCK flag at the same time that the PLL loses lock or acquires lock does not return
the current condition of the PLL. The power-on reset circuit uses the LOCK bit as a
condition for releasing reset.
If operating in external clock mode, LOCK remains cleared after reset.
1 PLL locked
0 PLL not locked
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-9
Clock Module
Table 9-5. SYNSR Field Descriptions (continued)
Bit(s)
Name
Description
2
LOCS
Sticky indication of whether a loss-of-clock condition has occurred at any time since
exiting reset in normal PLL and 1:1 PLL modes. LOCS = 0 when the system clocks
are operating normally. LOCS = 1 when system clocks have failed due to a reference
failure or PLL failure.
After entering stop mode with FWKUP set and the PLL and oscillator intentionally
disabled (STPMD[1:0] = 11), the PLL exits stop mode in the SCM while the oscillator
starts up. During this time, LOCS is temporarily set regardless of LOCEN. It is cleared
once the oscillator comes up and the PLL is attempting to lock.
If a read of the LOCS flag and a loss-of-clock condition occur simultaneously, the flag
does not reflect the current loss-of-clock condition.
A loss-of-clock condition can be detected only if LOCEN = 1 or the oscillator has not
yet returned from exit from stop mode with FWKUP = 1.
1 Loss-of-clock detected since exiting reset or oscillator not yet recovered from exit
from stop mode with FWKUP = 1
0 Loss-of-clock not detected since exiting reset
Note: The LOCS flag is always 0 in external clock mode.
1–0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
Table 9-6. System Clock Modes
PLLMODE:PLLSEL:PLLREF
9.7
Clock Mode
000
External clock mode
100
1:1 PLL mode
110
Normal PLL mode with external clock reference
111
Normal PLL mode with crystal reference
Functional Description
This subsection provides a functional description of the clock module.
9.7.1
System Clock Modes
The system clock source is determined during reset (see Table 27-8). The values of CLKMOD[1:0] are
latched during reset and are of no importance after reset is negated. If CLKMOD1 or CLKMOD0 is
changed during a reset other than power-on reset, the internal clocks may glitch as the system clock source
is changed between external clock mode and PLL clock mode. Whenever CLKMOD1 or CLKMOD0 is
changed in reset, an immediate loss-of-lock condition occurs.
Table 9-7 shows the clockout frequency to clockin frequency relationships for the possible system clock
modes.
Table 9-7. Clock Out and Clock In Relationships
PLL Options1
System Clock Mode
Normal PLL clock mode
fsys = fref × 2(MFD + 2)/2RFD
1:1 PLL clock mode
fsys = fref
External clock mode
fsys = fref
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
1
fref = input reference frequency
fsys = CLKOUT frequency
MFD ranges from 0 to 7.
RFD ranges from 0 to 7.
CAUTION
XTAL must be tied low in external clock mode when reset is asserted. If it
is not, clocks could be suspended indefinitely.
The external clock is divided by two internally to produce the system clocks.
9.7.2
Clock Operation During Reset
In external clock mode, the system is static and does not recognize reset until a clock is applied to EXTAL.
In PLL mode, the PLL operates in self-clocked mode (SCM) during reset until the input reference clock
to the PLL begins operating within the limits given in the electrical specifications.
If a PLL failure causes a reset, the system enters reset using the reference clock. Then the system clock
source changes to the PLL operating in SCM. If SCM is not functional, the system becomes static.
Alternately, if the LOCEN bit in SYNCR is cleared when the PLL fails, the system becomes static. If
external reset is asserted, the system cannot enter reset unless the PLL is capable of operating in SCM.
9.7.3
System Clock Generation
In normal PLL clock mode, the default system frequency is two times the reference frequency after reset.
The RFD[2:0] and MFD[2:0] bits in the SYNCR select the frequency multiplier.
When programming the PLL, do not exceed the maximum system clock frequency listed in the electrical
specifications. Use this procedure to accommodate the frequency overshoot that occurs when the MFD bits
are changed:
1. Determine the appropriate value for the MFD and RFD fields in the SYNCR. The amount of jitter
in the system clocks can be minimized by selecting the maximum MFD factor that can be paired
with an RFD factor to provide the required frequency.
2. Write a value of RFD (from step 1) + 1 to the RFD field of the SYNCR.
3. Write the MFD value from step 1 to the SYNCR.
4. Monitor the LOCK flag in SYNSR. When the PLL achieves lock, write the RFD value from step
1 to the RFD field of the SYNCR. This changes the system clocks frequency to the required
frequency.
NOTE
Keep the maximum system clock frequency below the limit given in the
Electrical Characteristics.
9.7.4
PLL Operation
In PLL mode, the PLL synthesizes the system clocks. The PLL can multiply the reference clock frequency
by 2x to 9x, provided that the system clock frequency remains within the range listed in electrical
specifications. For example, if the reference frequency is 2 MHz, the PLL can synthesize frequencies of 4
MHz to 18 MHz. In addition, the RFD can reduce the system frequency by dividing the output of the PLL.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-11
Clock Module
The RFD is not in the feedback loop of the PLL, so changing the RFD divisor does not affect PLL
operation.
Figure 9-5 shows the external support circuitry for the crystal oscillator with example component values.
Actual component values depend on crystal specifications.
The following subsections describe each major block of the PLL. Refer to Figure to see how these
functional sub-blocks interact.
C2
C1
VSS
EXTAL
XTAL
ON-CHIP
8-MHz CRYSTAL CONFIGURATIO
C1 = C2 = 16 pF
RF = 1 MΩ
RS = 470 Ω
VSSSYN
RS
RF
Figure 9-5. Crystal Oscillator Example
9.7.4.1
Phase and Frequency Detector (PFD)
The PFD is a dual-latch phase-frequency detector. It compares both the phase and frequency of the
reference and feedback clocks. The reference clock comes from either the crystal oscillator or an external
clock source.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
The feedback clock comes from one of the following:
• CLKOUT in 1:1 PLL mode
• VCO output divided by two if CLKOUT is disabled in 1:1 PLL mode
• VCO output divided by the MFD in normal PLL mode
When the frequency of the feedback clock equals the frequency of the reference clock, the PLL is
frequency-locked. If the falling edge of the feedback clock lags the falling edge of the reference clock, the
PFD pulses the UP signal. If the falling edge of the feedback clock leads the falling edge of the reference
clock, the PFD pulses the DOWN signal. The width of these pulses relative to the reference clock depends
on how much the two clocks lead or lag each other. Once phase lock is achieved, the PFD continues to
pulse the UP and DOWN signals for very short durations during each reference clock cycle. These short
pulses continually update the PLL and prevent the frequency drift phenomenon known as dead-banding.
9.7.4.2
Charge Pump/Loop Filter
In 1:1 PLL mode, the charge pump uses a fixed current. In normal mode the current magnitude of the
charge pump varies with the MFD as shown in Table 9-8.
Table 9-8. Charge Pump Current and MFD in Normal Mode Operation
Charge Pump Current
MFD
1X
0 ≤ MFD < 2
2X
2 ≤ MFD < 6
4X
6 ≤ MFD
The UP and DOWN signals from the PFD control whether the charge pump applies or removes charge,
respectively, from the loop filter. The filter is integrated on the chip.
9.7.4.3
Voltage Control Output (VCO)
The voltage across the loop filter controls the frequency of the VCO output. The frequency-to-voltage
relationship (VCO gain) is positive, and the output frequency is four times the target system frequency.
9.7.4.4
Multiplication Factor Divider (MFD)
When the PLL is not in 1:1 PLL mode, the MFD divides the output of the VCO and feeds it back to the
PFD. The PFD controls the VCO frequency via the charge pump and loop filter such that the reference and
feedback clocks have the same frequency and phase. Thus, the frequency of the input to the MFD, which
is also the output of the VCO, is the reference frequency multiplied by the same amount that the MFD
divides by. For example, if the MFD divides the VCO frequency by six, the PLL is frequency locked when
the VCO frequency is six times the reference frequency. The presence of the MFD in the loop allows the
PLL to perform frequency multiplication, or synthesis.
In 1:1 PLL mode, the MFD is bypassed, and the effective multiplication factor is one.
9.7.4.5
PLL Lock Detection
The lock detect logic monitors the reference frequency and the PLL feedback frequency to determine when
frequency lock is achieved. Phase lock is inferred by the frequency relationship, but is not guaranteed. The
LOCK flag in the SYNSR reflects the PLL lock status. A sticky lock flag, LOCKS, is also provided.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-13
Clock Module
The lock detect function uses two counters. One is clocked by the reference and the other is clocked by the
PLL feedback. When the reference counter has counted N cycles, its count is compared to that of the
feedback counter. If the feedback counter has also counted N cycles, the process is repeated for N + K
counts. Then, if the two counters still match, the lock criteria is relaxed by 1/2 and the system is notified
that the PLL has achieved frequency lock.
After lock is detected, the lock circuit continues to monitor the reference and feedback frequencies using
the alternate count and compare process. If the counters do not match at any comparison time, then the
LOCK flag is cleared to indicate that the PLL has lost lock. At this point, the lock criteria is tightened and
the lock detect process is repeated.
The alternate count sequences prevent false lock detects due to frequency aliasing while the PLL tries to
lock. Alternating between tight and relaxed lock criteria prevents the lock detect function from randomly
toggling between locked and non-locked status due to phase sensitivities. Figure 9-6 shows the sequence
for detecting locked and non-locked conditions.
In external clock mode, the PLL is disabled and cannot lock.
Start
with Tight Lock
Criteria
Loss of Lock Detected
Set Tight Lock Criteria
and Notify System of Loss
of Lock Condition
Reference Count
Reference Count
≠ Feedback Count
≠ Feedback Count
Count N
Reference Cycles
and Compare
Number of Feedback
Cycles Elapsed
Reference Count =
Feedback Count = N
In Same Count/Compare Sequence
Lock Detected.
Set Relaxed Lock
Condition and Notify
System of Lock
Condition
Count N + K
Reference Cycles
and Compare Number
of Feedback Cycles
Elapsed
Reference Count =
Feedback Count = N + K
IN Same Count/Compare Sequence
Figure 9-6. Lock Detect Sequence
9.7.4.6
PLL Loss of Lock Conditions
Once the PLL acquires lock after reset, the LOCK and LOCKS flags are set. If the MFD is changed, or if
an unexpected loss of lock condition occurs, the LOCK and LOCKS flags are negated. While the PLL is
in the non-locked condition, the system clocks continue to be sourced from the PLL as the PLL attempts
to relock. Consequently, during the relocking process, the system clocks frequency is not well defined and
may exceed the maximum system frequency, violating the system clock timing specifications.
However, once the PLL has relocked, the LOCK flag is set. The LOCKS flag remains cleared if the loss
of lock is unexpected. The LOCKS flag is set when the loss of lock is caused by changing MFD. If the
PLL is intentionally disabled during stop mode, then after exit from stop mode, the LOCKS flag reflects
the value prior to entering stop mode once lock is regained.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
9.7.4.7
PLL Loss of Lock Reset
If the LOLRE bit in the SYNCR is set, a loss of lock condition asserts reset. Reset reinitializes the LOCK
and LOCKS flags. Therefore, software must read the LOL bit in the reset status register (RSR) to
determine if a loss of lock caused the reset. See Section 29.4.2, “Reset Status Register (RSR).”
To exit reset in PLL mode, the reference must be present, and the PLL must achieve lock.
In external clock mode, the PLL cannot lock. Therefore, a loss of lock condition cannot occur, and the
LOLRE bit has no effect.
9.7.4.8
Loss of Clock Detection
The LOCEN bit in the SYNCR enables the loss of clock detection circuit to monitor the input clocks to
the phase and frequency detector (PFD). When either the reference or feedback clock frequency falls
below the minimum frequency, the loss of clock circuit sets the sticky LOCS flag in the SYNSR.
NOTE
In external clock mode, the loss of clock circuit is disabled.
9.7.4.9
Loss of Clock Reset
The clock module can assert a reset when a loss of clock or loss of lock occurs. When a loss-of-clock
condition is recognized, reset is asserted if the LOCRE bit in SYNCR is set. The LOCS bit in SYNSR is
cleared after reset. Therefore, the LOC bit must be read in RSR to determine that a loss of clock condition
occurred. LOCRE has no effect in external clock mode.
To exit reset in PLL mode, the reference must be present, and the PLL must acquire lock.
Reset initializes the clock module registers to a known startup state as described in Section 9.6, “Memory
Map and Registers.”
9.7.4.10
Alternate Clock Selection
Depending on which clock source fails, the loss-of-clock circuit switches the system clocks source to the
remaining operational clock. The alternate clock source generates the system clocks until reset is asserted.
As Table 9-9 shows, if the reference fails, the PLL goes out of lock and into self-clocked mode (SCM).
The PLL remains in SCM until the next reset. When the PLL is operating in SCM, the system frequency
depends on the value in the RFD field. The SCM system frequency stated in electrical specifications
assumes that the RFD has been programmed to binary 000. If the loss-of-clock condition is due to PLL
failure, the PLL reference becomes the system clocks source until the next reset, even if the PLL regains
and relocks.
Table 9-9. Loss of Clock Summary
1
Clock
Mode
System Clock Source
Before Failure
Reference Failure Alternate Clock
Selected by LOC Circuit1 Until Reset
PLL Failure Alternate Clock
Selected by LOC Circuit Until Reset
PLL
PLL
PLL self-clocked mode
PLL reference
External
External clock
None
NA
The LOC circuit monitors the reference and feedback inputs to the PFD. See Figure 9-5.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-15
Clock Module
A special loss-of-clock condition occurs when both the reference and the PLL fail. The failures may be
simultaneous, or the PLL may fail first. In either case, the reference clock failure takes priority and the
PLL attempts to operate in SCM. If successful, the PLL remains in SCM until the next reset. If the PLL
cannot operate in SCM, the system remains static until the next reset. Both the reference and the PLL must
be functioning properly to exit reset.
9.7.4.11
Loss of Clock in Stop Mode
Table 9-10 shows the resulting actions for a loss of clock in Stop Mode when the device is being clocked
by the various clocking methods.
EXT
NRM
NRM
X X X X
X
X
—
—
MODE
Out
EXT
Lose reference
clock
Stuck
0 0 0 Off Off 0 Lose lock,
f.b. clock,
reference
clock
Regain
NRM
No regain
Stuck
X 0 0 Off Off 1 Lose lock,
f.b. clock,
reference
clock
0
0
—
‘LK
—
1
LOCS
PLL Action
During Stop
LOCK
Expected
PLL
Action at
Stop
LOCKSS
FWKUP
OSC
MODE
In
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOLRE
PLL
Table 9-10. Stop Mode Operation (Sheet 1 of 5)
Comments
0
—
‘LC
—
—
—
Regain clocks, but SCM–>
don’t regain lock unstable
NRM
0–>‘L
K
0–>
1
1–>‘L
C
Block LOCS and
LOCKS until
clock and lock
respectively
regain; enter
SCM regardless
of LOCEN bit
until reference
regained
No reference
clock regain
SCM–>
0–>
0–>
1–>
Block LOCS and
LOCKS until
clock and lock
respectively
regain; enter
SCM regardless
of LOCEN bit
No f.b. clock
regain
Stuck
—
—
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
NRM
NRM
NRM
0 0 0 Off On 0 Lose lock
0 0 0 Off On 1 Lose lock
0 0 0 On On 0
MODE
Out
NRM
Lose reference
clock or no lock
regain
Stuck
Lose reference
clock,
regain
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Block LOCKS
from being
cleared
No lock regain
Unstable
NRM
0–>‘L
K
0–>
1
‘LC
Block LOCKS
until lock
regained
Lose reference
clock or no f.b.
clock regain
Stuck
—
—
Lose reference
clock, regain
Unstable
NRM
0–>‘L
K
0–>
1
‘LC
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
—
—
Lose lock or clock Stuck
NRM
NRM
0 0 0 On On 1
X X 1 Off X
—
—
‘LC
—
0
1
‘LC
Lose clock and
lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose lock
Unstable
NRM
0
0–>
1
‘LC
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
Lose clock
Stuck
—
—
0
0–>
1
‘LC
Lose clock, regain NRM
with lock
0
1
‘LC
RESET
—
—
LOCS not set
because
LOCEN = 0
—
Lose clock, regain Unstable
without lock
NRM
RESET
LOCS not set
because
LOCEN = 0
—
NRM
—
Block LOCKS
from being
cleared
—
Lose lock, regain
—
X Lose lock,
f.b. clock,
reference
clock
—
1
Comments
Regain
—
‘LK
LOCS
PLL Action
During Stop
LOCK
Expected
PLL
Action at
Stop
LOCKSS
FWKUP
OSC
MODE
In
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOLRE
PLL
Table 9-10. Stop Mode Operation (Sheet 2 of 5)
—
Reset
immediately
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-17
Clock Module
NRM
0 0 1 On On X
—
—
MODE
Out
NRM
‘LK
Lose lock or clock RESET
NRM
NRM
NRM
NRM
NRM
1 0 0 Off Off 0 Lose lock,
f.b. clock,
reference
clock
1 0 0 Off On 0 Lose lock,
f.b. clock
1 0 0 Off On 1 Lose lock,
f.b. clock
1 0 0 On On 0
1 0 0 On On 1
—
—
—
‘LC
—
—
No regain
Stuck
Regain
NRM
No f.b. clock or
lock regain
Stuck
Lose reference
clock
SCM
0
0
1
Wakeup without
lock
Regain f.b. clock
Unstable
NRM
0–>‘L
K
0–>
1
‘LC
REF mode not
entered during
stop
No f.b. clock
regain
Stuck
—
—
Lose reference
clock
SCM
0
0
1
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose reference
clock
SCM
0
0
1
Wakeup without
lock
Lose f.b. clock
REF
0
X
1
Wakeup without
lock
Lose lock
Stuck
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
—
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose reference
clock
SCM
0
0
1
Wakeup without
lock
Lose f.b. clock
REF
0
X
1
Wakeup without
lock
Lose lock
Unstable
NRM
0
0–>
1
‘LC
‘LK
—
—
‘LC
Reset
immediately
NRM
—
1
Comments
Regain
—
‘LK
1
LOCS
PLL Action
During Stop
LOCK
Expected
PLL
Action at
Stop
LOCKSS
FWKUP
OSC
MODE
In
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOLRE
PLL
Table 9-10. Stop Mode Operation (Sheet 3 of 5)
—
1
REF not entered
during stop;
SCM entered
during stop only
during oscillator
startup
—
‘LC
—
REF mode not
entered during
stop
—
—
—
Wakeup without
lock
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-18
Freescale Semiconductor
Clock Module
NRM
1 0 1 On On X
NRM
1 1 X Off X
NRM
1 1 0 On On 0
NRM
NRM
—
—
X Lose lock,
f.b. clock,
reference
clock
1 1 0 On On 1
1 1 1 On On X
—
—
—
MODE
Out
NRM
1 0 0 X
X
X
—
1
‘LC
—
—
—
Reset
immediately
RESET
—
—
—
Reset
immediately
RESET
—
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose clock
RESET
—
—
—
Lose lock
Stuck
—
—
—
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
—
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose clock
RESET
Lose lock
Unstable
NRM
0
0–>
1
‘LC
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
—
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
—
—
—
0
X
1
—
REF
Lose reference
clock
Stuck
—
—
—
—
—
1 0 0 Off X
0 PLL
disabled
Regain SCM
SCM
0
0
1
SCM
1 0 0 Off X
1 PLL
disabled
Regain SCM
SCM
0
0
1
SCM
1 0 0 On On 0
SCM
0
0
1
—
Lose reference
clock
SCM
Reset
immediately
Reset
immediately
Reset
immediately
—
SCM
—
Comments
Lose lock or clock RESET
Lose clock or lock RESET
REF
‘LK
LOCS
PLL Action
During Stop
LOCK
Expected
PLL
Action at
Stop
LOCKSS
FWKUP
OSC
MODE
In
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOLRE
PLL
Table 9-10. Stop Mode Operation (Sheet 4 of 5)
Wakeup without
lock
Wakeup without
lock
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
9-19
Clock Module
SCM
1 0 0 On On 1
—
—
Lose reference
clock
MODE
Out
SCM
0
0
LOCS
PLL Action
During Stop
LOCK
Expected
PLL
Action at
Stop
LOCKSS
FWKUP
OSC
MODE
In
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOLRE
PLL
Table 9-10. Stop Mode Operation (Sheet 5 of 5)
Comments
1
SCM
Note:
PLL = PLL enabled during STOP mode. PLL = On when STPMD[1:0] = 00 or 01
OSC = Oscillator enabled during STOP mode. Oscillator is on when STPMD[1:0] = 00, 01, or 10
MODES
NRM = normal PLL crystal clock reference or normal PLL external reference or PLL 1:1 mode. During PLL 1:1 or
normal external reference mode, the oscillator is never enabled. Therefore, during these modes, refer to the OSC =
On case regardless of STPMD values.
EXT=external clock mode
REF=PLL reference mode due to losing PLL clock or lock from NRM mode
SCM=PLL self-clocked mode due to losing reference clock from NRM mode
RESET= immediate reset
LOCKS
‘LK= expecting previous value of LOCKS before entering stop
0–>‘LK= current value is 0 until lock is regained which then will be the previous value before entering stop
0–> = current value is 0 until lock is regained but lock is never expected to regain
LOCS
‘LC=expecting previous value of LOCS before entering stop
1–>‘LC= current value is 1 until clock is regained which then will be the previous value before entering stop
1–> =current value is 1 until clock is regained but CLK is never expected to regain
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
9-20
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10
Interrupt Controller Modules
This section details the functionality for the interrupt controllers (INTC0, INTC1). The general features of
each interrupt controller include:
• 63 interrupt sources, organized as:
— 56 fully-programmable interrupt sources
— 7 fixed-level interrupt sources
• Each of the 63 sources has a unique interrupt control register (ICRnx) to define the
software-assigned levels and priorities within the level
• Unique vector number for each interrupt source
• Ability to mask any individual interrupt source, plus global mask-all capability
• Supports both hardware and software interrupt acknowledge cycles
• “Wake-up” signal from low-power stop modes
The 56 fully-programmable and seven fixed-level interrupt sources for each of the two interrupt controllers
handle the complete set of interrupt sources from all of the modules on the device. This section describes
how the interrupt sources are mapped to the interrupt controller logic and how interrupts are serviced.
10.1
68K/ColdFire Interrupt Architecture Overview
Before continuing with the specifics of the interrupt controllers, a brief review of the interrupt architecture
of the 68K/ColdFire family is appropriate.
The interrupt architecture of ColdFire is exactly the same as the M68000 family, where there is a 3-bit
encoded interrupt priority level sent from the interrupt controller to the core, providing 7 levels of interrupt
requests. Level 7 represents the highest priority interrupt level, while level 1 is the lowest priority. The
processor samples for active interrupt requests once per instruction by comparing the encoded priority
level against a 3-bit interrupt mask value (I) contained in bits 10:8 of the machine’s status register (SR). If
the priority level is greater than the SR[I] field at the sample point, the processor suspends normal
instruction execution and initiates interrupt exception processing. Level 7 interrupts are treated as
non-maskable and edge-sensitive within the processor, while levels 1-6 are treated as level-sensitive and
may be masked depending on the value of the SR[I] field. For correct operation, the ColdFire requires that,
once asserted, the interrupt source remain asserted until explicitly disabled by the interrupt service routine.
During the interrupt exception processing, the CPU enters supervisor mode, disables trace mode and then
fetches an 8-bit vector from the interrupt controller. This byte-sized operand fetch is known as the interrupt
acknowledge (IACK) cycle with the ColdFire implementation using a special encoding of the transfer type
and transfer modifier attributes to distinguish this data fetch from a “normal” memory access. The fetched
data provides an index into the exception vector table which contains 256 addresses, each pointing to the
beginning of a specific exception service routine. In particular, vectors 64 - 255 of the exception vector
table are reserved for user interrupt service routines. The first 64 exception vectors are reserved for the
processor to handle reset, error conditions (access, address), arithmetic faults, system calls, etc. Once the
interrupt vector number has been retrieved, the processor continues by creating a stack frame in memory.
For ColdFire, all exception stack frames are 2 longwords in length, and contain 32 bits of vector and status
register data, along with the 32-bit program counter value of the instruction that was interrupted (see
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-1
Interrupt Controller Modules
Section 2.3.3.1, “Exception Stack Frame Definition” for more information on the stack frame format).
After the exception stack frame is stored in memory, the processor accesses the 32-bit pointer from the
exception vector table using the vector number as the offset, and then jumps to that address to begin
execution of the service routine. After the status register is stored in the exception stack frame, the SR[I]
mask field is set to the level of the interrupt being acknowledged, effectively masking that level and all
lower values while in the service routine. For many peripheral devices, the processing of the IACK cycle
directly negates the interrupt request, while other devices require that request to be explicitly negated
during the processing of the service routine.
For this device, the processing of the interrupt acknowledge cycle is fundamentally different than previous
68K/ColdFire cores. In the new approach, all IACK cycles are directly handled by the interrupt controller,
so the requesting peripheral device is not accessed during the IACK. As a result, the interrupt request must
be explicitly cleared in the peripheral during the interrupt service routine. For more information, see
Section 10.1.1.3, “Interrupt Vector Determination.”
Unlike the M68000 family, all ColdFire processors guarantee that the first instruction of the service routine
is executed before sampling for interrupts is resumed. By making this initial instruction a load of the SR,
interrupts can be safely disabled, if required.
During the execution of the service routine, the appropriate actions must be performed on the peripheral
to negate the interrupt request.
For more information on exception processing, see the ColdFire Programmer’s Reference Manual at
http://www.freescale.com/coldfire.
10.1.1
Interrupt Controller Theory of Operation
To support the interrupt architecture of the 68K/ColdFire programming model, the combined 63 interrupt
sources are organized as 7 levels, with each level supporting up to 9 prioritized requests. Consider the
interrupt priority structure shown in Table 10-1, which orders the interrupt levels/priorities from highest
to lowest.
Table 10-1. Interrupt Priority Scheme
Interrupt
Level
ICR[IL]
Priority
ICR[IP]
Supported Interrupt
Sources
7
6
#8–63
5
4
7
— (Mid-point)
#7 (IRQ7)
3
2
#8–63
1
0
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Controller Modules
Table 10-1. Interrupt Priority Scheme (continued)
Interrupt
Level
ICR[IL]
6
5
4
3
2
1
Priority
ICR[IP]
Supported Interrupt
Sources
7–4
#8–63
— (Mid-point)
#6 (IRQ6)
3–0
#8–63
7–4
#8–63
— (Mid-point)
#5 (IRQ5)
3–0
#8–63
7–4
#8–63
— (Mid-point)
#4 (IRQ4)
3–0
#8–63
7–4
#8–63
— (Mid-point)
#3 (IRQ3)
3–0
#8–63
7–4
#8–63
— (Mid-point)
#2 (IRQ2)
3–0
#8–63
7–4
#8–63
— (Mid-point)
#1 (IRQ1)
3–0
#8–63
The level and priority is fully programmable for all sources except interrupt sources 1–7. Interrupt source
1–7 (from the Edgeport module) are fixed at the corresponding level’s midpoint priority. Thus, a maximum
of 8 fully-programmable interrupt sources are mapped into a single interrupt level. The “fixed” interrupt
source is hardwired to the given level, and represents the mid-point of the priority within the level. For the
fully-programmable interrupt sources, the 3-bit level and the 3-bit priority within the level are defined in
the 8-bit interrupt control register (ICRnx).
The operation of the interrupt controller can be broadly partitioned into three activities:
• Recognition
• Prioritization
• Vector Determination during IACK
10.1.1.1
Interrupt Recognition
The interrupt controller continuously examines the request sources and the interrupt mask register to
determine if there are active requests. This is the recognition phase.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-3
Interrupt Controller Modules
10.1.1.2
Interrupt Prioritization
As an active request is detected, it is translated into the programmed interrupt level, and the resulting 7-bit
decoded priority level (IRQ[7:1]) is driven out of the interrupt controller. The decoded priority levels from
all the interrupt controllers are logically summed together and the highest enabled interrupt request is then
encoded into a 3-bit priority level that is sent to the processor core during this prioritization phase.
10.1.1.3
Interrupt Vector Determination
Once the core has sampled for pending interrupts and begun interrupt exception processing, it generates
an interrupt acknowledge cycle (IACK). The IACK transfer is treated as a memory-mapped byte read by
the processor, and routed to the appropriate interrupt controller. Next, the interrupt controller extracts the
level being acknowledged from address bits[4:2], and then determines the highest priority interrupt request
active for that level, and returns the 8-bit interrupt vector for that request to complete the cycle. The 8-bit
interrupt vector is formed using the following algorithm:
For INTC0,
vector_number = 64 + interrupt source number
For INTC1,
vector_number = 128 + interrupt source number
Recall vector_numbers 0 - 63 are reserved for the ColdFire processor and its internal exceptions. Thus, the
following mapping of bit positions to vector numbers applies for the INTC0:
if interrupt source 1 is active and acknowledged,
then vector_number =
65
if interrupt source 2 is active and acknowledged,
then vector_number =
66
if interrupt source 8 is active and acknowledged,
then vector_number =
72
if interrupt source 9 is active and acknowledged,
then vector_number =
73
...
...
if interrupt source 62 is active and acknowledged,
then vector_number = 126
The net effect is a fixed mapping between the bit position within the source to the actual interrupt vector
number.
If there is no active interrupt source for the given level, a special “spurious interrupt” vector
(vector_number = 24) is returned and it is the responsibility of the service routine to handle this error
situation.
Note this protocol implies the interrupting peripheral is not accessed during the acknowledge cycle since
the interrupt controller completely services the acknowledge. This means the interrupt source must be
explicitly disabled in the interrupt service routine. This design provides unique vector capability for all
interrupt requests, regardless of the “complexity” of the peripheral device.
Vector numbers 64-71, and 91-255 are unused.
10.2
Memory Map
The register programming model for the interrupt controllers is memory-mapped to a 256-byte space. In
the following discussion, there are a number of program-visible registers greater than 32 bits in size. For
these control fields, the physical register is partitioned into two 32-bit values: a register “high” (the upper
longword) and a register “low” (the lower longword). The nomenclature <reg_name>H and <reg_name>L
is used to reference these values.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Controller Modules
The registers and their locations are defined in Table 10-3. The offsets listed start from the base address
for each interrupt controller. The base addresses for the interrupt controllers are listed below:
Table 10-2. Interrupt Controller Base Addresses
1
Interrupt Controller Number
Base Address
INTC0
IPSBAR + 0xC00
INTC1
IPSBAR + 0xD00
Global IACK Registers Space1
IPSBAR + 0xF00
This address space only contains the L1ACK-L7IACK registers. See Section 10.3.7, “Software and Level n
IACK Registers (SWIACKR, L1IACK–L7IACK)" for more information
Table 10-3. Interrupt Controller Memory Map
Module Offset
Bits[31:24]
Bits[23:16]
Bits[15:8]
Bits[7:0]
0x00
Interrupt Pending Register High (IPRH), [63:32]
0x04
Interrupt Pending Register Low (IPRL), [31:1]
0x08
Interrupt Mask Register High (IMRH), [63:32]
0x0c
Interrupt Mask Register Low (IMRL), [31:0]
0x10
Interrupt Force Register High (INTFRCH), [63:32]
0x14
Interrupt Force Register Low (INTFRCL), [31:1]
0x18
IRLR[7:1]
IACKLPR[7:0]
0x1C–0x3C
Reserved
Reserved
0x40
Reserved
ICR01
ICR02
ICR03
0x44
ICR04
ICR05
ICR06
ICR07
0x48
ICR08
ICR09
ICR10
ICR11
0x4C
ICR12
ICR13
ICR14
ICR15
0x50
ICR16
ICR17
ICR18
ICR19
0x54
ICR20
ICR21
ICR22
ICR23
0x58
ICR24
ICR25
ICR26
ICR27
0x5C
ICR28
ICR29
ICR30
ICR31
0x60
ICR32
ICR33
ICR34
ICR35
0x64
ICR36
ICR37
ICR38
ICR39
0x68
ICR40
ICR41
ICR42
ICR43
0x6C
ICR44
ICR45
ICR46
ICR47
0x70
ICR48
ICR49
ICR50
ICR51
0x74
ICR52
ICR53
ICR54
ICR55
0x78
ICR56
ICR57
ICR58
ICR59
0x7C
ICR60
ICR61
ICR62
ICR63
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-5
Interrupt Controller Modules
Table 10-3. Interrupt Controller Memory Map (continued)
Module Offset
Bits[31:24]
Bits[23:16]
0x80–0xDC
10.3
Bits[15:8]
Bits[7:0]
Reserved
0xE0
SWIACK
Reserved
0xE4
L1IACK
Reserved
0xE8
L2IACK
Reserved
0xEC
L3IACK
Reserved
0xF0
L4IACK
Reserved
0xF4
L5IACK
Reserved
0xF8
L6IACK
Reserved
0xFC
L7IACK
Reserved
Register Descriptions
10.3.1
Interrupt Pending Registers (IPRHn, IPRLn)
The IPRHn and IPRLn registers, Figure 10-1 and Figure 10-2, are each 32 bits in size, and provide a bit
map for each interrupt request to indicate if there is an active request (1 = active request, 0 = no request)
for the given source. The state of the interrupt mask register does not affect the IPRn. The IPRn is cleared
by reset. The IPRn is a read-only register, so any attempted write to this register is ignored. Bit 0 is not
implemented and reads as a zero.
31
16
Field
INT[63:48]
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R
15
0
Field
INT[47:32]
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R
IPSBAR + 0xC00, 0xD00
Figure 10-1. Interrupt Pending Register High (IPRHn)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Controller Modules
Table 10-4. IPRHn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
31–0
INT
Description
Interrupt pending. Each bit corresponds to an interrupt source. The corresponding IMRHn bit
determines whether an interrupt condition can generate an interrupt. At every system clock, the
IPRHn samples the signal generated by the interrupting source. The corresponding IPRHn bit
reflects the state of the interrupt signal even if the corresponding IMRHn bit is set.
0 The corresponding interrupt source does not have an interrupt pending
1 The corresponding interrupt source has an interrupt pending
.
31
16
Field
INT[31:16]
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R
15
1
Field
INT[16:1]
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R
0
—
IPSBAR + 0xC04, 0xD04
Figure 10-2. Interrupt Pending Register Low (IPRLn)
Table 10-5. IPRLn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
31–1
INT
0
—
10.3.2
Description
Interrupt Pending. Each bit corresponds to an interrupt source. The corresponding IMRLn bit
determines whether an interrupt condition can generate an interrupt. At every system clock, the
IPRLn samples the signal generated by the interrupting source. The corresponding IPRLn bit
reflects the state of the interrupt signal even if the corresponding IMRLn bit is set.
0 The corresponding interrupt source does not have an interrupt pending
1 The corresponding interrupt source has an interrupt pending
Reserved, should be cleared.
Interrupt Mask Register (IMRHn, IMRLn)
The IMRHn and IMRLn registers are each 32 bits in size and provide a bit map for each interrupt to allow
the request to be disabled (1 = disable the request, 0 = enable the request). The IMRn is set to all ones by
reset, disabling all interrupt requests. The IMRn can be read and written. A write that sets bit 0 of the IMR
forces the other 63 bits to be set, disabling all interrupt sources, and providing a global mask-all capability.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-7
Interrupt Controller Modules
.
31
16
Field
INT_MASK[63:48]
Reset
1111_1111_1111_1111
R/W
R/W
15
0
Field
INT_MASK[47:32]
Reset
1111_1111_1111_1111
R/W
R/W
IPSBAR + 0xC08, 0xD08
Figure 10-3. Interrupt Mask Register High (IMRHn)
Table 10-6. IMRHn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
31–0
INT_MASK
Interrupt mask. Each bit corresponds to an interrupt source. The corresponding IMRHn bit
determines whether an interrupt condition can generate an interrupt. The corresponding
IPRHn bit reflects the state of the interrupt signal even if the corresponding IMRHn bit is
set.
0 The corresponding interrupt source is not masked
1 The corresponding interrupt source is masked
.
31
16
Field
INT_MASK[31:16]
Reset
1111_1111_1111_1111
R/W
R/W
15
Field
1
INT_MASK[16:1]
Reset
1111_1111_1111_1111
R/W
R/W
0
MASKALL
IPSBAR + 0xC0C, 0xD0C
Figure 10-4. Interrupt Mask Register Low (IMRLn)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Controller Modules
Table 10-7. IMRLn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
31–1
INT_MASK
Interrupt mask. Each bit corresponds to an interrupt source. The corresponding
IMRLn bit determines whether an interrupt condition can generate an interrupt.
The corresponding IPRLn bit reflects the state of the interrupt signal even if the
corresponding IMRLn bit is set.
0 The corresponding interrupt source is not masked
1 The corresponding interrupt source is masked
0
MASKALL
Mask all interrupts. Setting this bit will force the other 63 bits of the IMRHn and
IMRLn to ones, disabling all interrupt sources, and providing a global mask-all
capability.
NOTE
If an interrupt source is being masked in the interrupt controller mask
register (IMR) or a module’s interrupt mask register while the interrupt
mask in the status register (SR[I]) is set to a value lower than the interrupt’s
level, a spurious interrupt may occur. This is because by the time the status
register acknowledges this interrupt, the interrupt has been masked. A
spurious interrupt is generated because the CPU cannot determine the
interrupt source. To avoid this situation for interrupts sources with levels
1-6, first write a higher level interrupt mask to the status register, before
setting the mask in the IMR or the module’s interrupt mask register. After
the mask is set, return the interrupt mask in the status register to its previous
value. Since level seven interrupts cannot be disabled in the status register
prior to masking, use of the IMR or module interrupt mask registers to
disable level seven interrupts is not recommended.
10.3.3
Interrupt Force Registers (INTFRCHn, INTFRCLn)
The INTFRCHn and INTFRCLn registers are each 32 bits in size and provide a mechanism to allow
software generation of interrupts for each possible source for functional or debug purposes. The system
design may reserve one or more sources to allow software to self-schedule interrupts by forcing one or
more of these bits (1 = force request, 0 = negate request) in the appropriate INTFRCn register. The
assertion of an interrupt request via the INTFRCn register is not affected by the interrupt mask register.
The INTFRCn register is cleared by reset.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-9
Interrupt Controller Modules
31
16
Field
INTFRCH[63:48]
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
15
0
Field
INTFRCH[47:32]
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
IPSBAR + 0xC10, 0xD10
Figure 10-5. Interrupt Force Register High (INTFRCHn)
Table 10-8. INTFRCHn Field Descriptions
Bits
31–0
Name
Description
INTFRC Interrupt force. Allows software generation of interrupts for each possible source for functional or
debug purposes.
0 No interrupt forced on corresponding interrupt source
1 Force an interrupt on the corresponding source
.
31
16
Field
INTFRCL[31:16]
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
15
1
Field
INTFRCL[16:1]
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
0
—
IPSBAR + 0xC14, 0xD14
Figure 10-6. Interrupt Force Register Low (INTFRCLn)
Table 10-9. INTFRCLn Field Descriptions
Bits
31–1
0
Name
Description
INTFRC Interrupt force. Allows software generation of interrupts for each possible source for functional or
debug purposes.
0 No interrupt forced on corresponding interrupt source
1 Force an interrupt on the corresponding source
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Controller Modules
10.3.4
Interrupt Request Level Register (IRLRn)
This 7-bit register is updated each machine cycle and represents the current interrupt requests for each
interrupt level, where bit 7 corresponds to level 7, bit 6 to level 6, etc. This register output is combined
with similar outputs from INTC1 and eventually encoded into the 3-bit priority interrupt level driven to
the processor core.
7
2
Field
1
IRQ[7:1]
Reset
0
—
0000_0000
R/W
R
Address
IPSBAR + 0xC18, 0xD18
Figure 10-7. Interrupt Request Level Register (IRLRn)
Table 10-10. IRQn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
7–1
IRQ
0
—
10.3.5
Description
Interrupt requests. Represents the prioritized active interrupts for each level.
0 There are no active interrupts at this level
1 There is an active interrupt at this level
Reserved
Interrupt Acknowledge Level and Priority Register (IACKLPRn)
Each time an IACK is performed, the interrupt controller responds with the vector number of the highest
priority source within the level being acknowledged. In addition to providing the vector number directly
for the byte-sized IACK read, this 8-bit register is also loaded with information about the interrupt level
and priority being acknowledged. This register provides the association between the acknowledged
“physical” interrupt request number and the programmed interrupt level/priority. The contents of this
read-only register are described in Figure 10-8 and Table 10-11.
7
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
—
6
4
3
LEVEL
0
PRI
0000_0000
R
IPSBAR + 0xC19, 0xD19
Figure 10-8. IACK Level and Priority Register (IACKLPRn)
Table 10-11. IACKLPRn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
7
—
Description
Reserved
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-11
Interrupt Controller Modules
Table 10-11. IACKLPRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Bits
Name
6–4
LEVEL
3–0
PRI
10.3.6
Description
Interrupt level. Represents the interrupt level currently being acknowledged.
Interrupt Priority. Represents the priority within the interrupt level of the interrupt currently being
acknowledged.
0 Priority 0
1 Priority 1
2 Priority 2
3 Priority 3
4 Priority 4
5 Priority 5
6 Priority 6
7 Priority 7
8 Mid-Point Priority associated with the fixed level interrupts only
Interrupt Control Register (ICRnx, (x = 1, 2,..., 63))
Each ICRnx specifies the interrupt level (1-7) and the priority within the level (0-7). All ICRnx registers
can be read, but only ICRn8 to ICRn63 can be written. It is the responsibility of the software to program
the ICRnx registers with unique and non-overlapping level and priority definitions. Failure to program the
ICRnx registers in this manner can result in undefined behavior. If a specific interrupt request is completely
unused, the ICRnx value can remain in its reset (and disabled) state.
7
Field
6
5
—
Address
2
IL
Reset
R/W
3
0
IP
0000_0000
R/W (Read only for ICRn1-ICRn7)
See Table 10-2 and Table 10-3 for register offsets
Note: It is the responsibility of the software to program the ICRnx registers
with unique and non-overlapping level and priority definitions. Failure to
program the ICRnx registers in this manner can result in undefined behavior.
If a specific interrupt request is completely unused, the ICRnx value can
remain in its reset (and disabled) state.
Figure 10-9. Interrupt Control Register (ICRnx)
Table 10-12. ICRnx Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7–6
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
5–3
IL
Interrupt level. Indicates the interrupt level assigned to each interrupt input.
2–0
IP
Interrupt priority. Indicates the interrupt priority for internal modules within the interrupt-level
assignment. 000b represents the lowest priority and 111b represents the highest. For the fixed level
interrupt sources, the priority is fixed at the midpoint for the level, and the IP field will always read as
000b.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Controller Modules
10.3.6.1
Interrupt Sources
Table 10-13 and Table 10-14 list the interrupt sources for each interrupt request line for INTC0 and
INTC1.
Table 10-13. Interrupt Source Assignment for INTC0
Source
Module
Flag
Source Description
Flag Clearing Mechanism
1
EPORT
EPF1
Edge port flag 1
Write EPF1 = 1
2
EPF2
Edge port flag 2
Write EPF2 = 1
3
EPF3
Edge port flag 3
Write EPF3 = 1
4
EPF4
Edge port flag 4
Write EPF4 = 1
5
EPF5
Edge port flag 5
Write EPF5 = 1
6
EPF6
Edge port flag 6
Write EPF6 = 1
7
EPF7
Edge port flag 7
Write EPF7 = 1
Cleared when service complete
8
SCM
SWT1
Software watchdog timeout
9
DMA
DONE
DMA Channel 0 transfer complete Write DONE = 1
10
DONE
DMA Channel 1 transfer complete Write DONE = 1
11
DONE
DMA Channel 2 transfer complete Write DONE = 1
12
DONE
DMA Channel 3 transfer complete Write DONE = 1
13
UART0
Multiple
UART0 interrupt
Cleared when service complete
14
UART1
Multiple
UART1 interrupt
Cleared when service complete
15
UART2
Multiple
UART2 interrupt
Cleared when service complete
16
Not used
17
I 2C
I2C
IIF
18
QSPI
Multiple
19
DTIM0
CAP/REF DTIM0 capture/reference event
Write CAP = 1 or REF = 1
20
DTIM1
CAP/REF DTIM1 capture/reference event
Write CAP = 1 or REF = 1
21
DTIM2
CAP/REF DTIM2 capture/reference event
Write CAP = 1 or REF = 1
22
DTIM3
CAP/REF DTIM3 capture/reference event
Write CAP = 1 or REF = 1
interrupt
QSPI interrupt
Write IIF = 0
See QIR description
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-13
Interrupt Controller Modules
Table 10-13. Interrupt Source Assignment for INTC0 (continued)
Source
Module
Flag
23
FEC
X_INTF
Transmit frame interrupt
Write X_INTF = 1
24
Note:
Not used
on
MCF5214
&
MCF5216
X_INTB
Transmit buffer interrupt
Write X_INTB = 1
UN
Transmit FIFO underrun
Write UN = 1
RL
Collision retry limit
Write RL = 1
R_INTF
Receive frame interrupt
Write R_INTF = 1
28
R_INTB
Receive buffer interrupt
Write R_INTB = 1
29
MII
MII interrupt
Write MII = 1
30
LC
Late collision
Write LC = 1
31
HBERR
Heartbeat error
Write HBERR = 1
32
GRA
Graceful stop complete
Write GRA = 1
33
EBERR
Ethernet bus error
Write EBERR = 1
34
BABT
Babbling transmit error
Write BABT = 1
35
BABR
Babbling receive error
Write BABR = 1
25
26
27
Source Description
Flag Clearing Mechanism
36
PMM
LVDF
LVD
Write LVDF = 1
37
QADC
CF1
Queue 1 conversion complete
Write CF1 = 0 after reading CF1 = 1
38
CF2
Queue 2 conversion complete
Write CF2 = 0 after reading CF2 = 1
39
PF1
Queue 1 conversion pause
Write PF1 = 0 after reading PF1 = 1
40
PF2
Queue 2 conversion pause
Write PF2 = 0 after reading PF2 = 1
TOF
Timer overflow
Write TOF = 1 or access TIMCNTH/L if TFFCA = 1
42
PAIF
Pulse accumulator input
Write PAIF = 1 or access PAC if TFFCA = 1
43
PAOVF
Pulse accumulator overflow
Write PAOVF = 1 or access PAC if TFFCA = 1
44
C0F
Timer channel 0
Write C0F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
45
C1F
Timer channel 1
Write C1F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
46
C2F
Timer channel 2
Write C2F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
47
C3F
Timer channel 3
Write C3F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
TOF
Timer overflow
Write TOF = 1 or access TIMCNTH/L if TFFCA = 1
49
PAIF
Pulse accumulator input
Write PAIF = 1 or access PAC if TFFCA = 1
50
PAOVF
Pulse accumulator overflow
Write PAOVF = 1 or access PAC if TFFCA = 1
51
C0F
Timer channel 0
Write C0F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
52
C1F
Timer channel 1
Write C1F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
53
C2F
Timer channel 2
Write C2F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
54
C3F
Timer channel 3
Write C3F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
PIF
PIT interrupt flag
Write PIF = 1 of write PMR
41
48
55
GPTA
GPTB
PIT0
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Controller Modules
Table 10-13. Interrupt Source Assignment for INTC0 (continued)
Source
Module
Flag
56
PIT1
PIF
PIT interrupt flag
Write PIF = 1 of write PMR
57
PIT2
PIF
PIT interrupt flag
Write PIF = 1 of write PMR
58
PIT3
PIF
PIT interrupt flag
Write PIF = 1 of write PMR
59
CFM
CBEIF
SGFM buffer empty
Write CBEIF = 1
60
CFM
CCIF
SGFM command complete
Cleared automatically
61
CFM
PVIF
Protection violation
Cleared automatically
62
CFM
AEIF
Access error
Cleared automatically
63
Source Description
Flag Clearing Mechanism
Not Used
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-15
Interrupt Controller Modules
Table 10-14. Interrupt Source Assignment for INTC1
Source Module
Flag
Source Description
1-7
8
Flag Clearing Mechanism
Not Used
BUF0I
Message buffer 0 interrupt
Write BUF0I = 1 after reading BUF0I = 1
BUF1I
Message buffer 1 interrupt
Write BUF1I = 1 after reading BUF1I = 1
10
BUF2I
Message buffer 2 interrupt
Write BUF2I = 1 after reading BUF2I = 1
11
BUF3I
Message buffer 3 interrupt
Write BUF3I = 1 after reading BUF3I = 1
12
BUF4I
Message buffer 4 interrupt
Write BUF4I = 1 after reading BUF4I = 1
13
BUF5I
Message buffer 5 interrupt
Write BUF5I = 1 after reading BUF5I = 1
14
BUF6I
Message buffer 6 interrupt
Write BUF6I = 1 after reading BUF6I = 1
15
BUF7I
Message buffer 7 interrupt
Write BUF7I = 1 after reading BUF7I = 1
16
BUF8I
Message buffer 8 interrupt
Write BUF8I = 1 after reading BUF8I = 1
17
BUF9I
Message buffer 9 interrupt
Write BUF9I = 1 after reading BUF9I = 1
18
BUF10I
Message buffer 10 interrupt
Write BUF10I = 1 after reading BUF10I = 1
19
BUF11I
Message buffer 11 interrupt
Write BUF11I = 1 after reading BUF11I = 1
20
BUF12I
Message buffer 12 interrupt
Write BUF12I = 1 after reading BUF12I = 1
21
BUF13I
Message buffer 13 interrupt
Write BUF13I = 1 after reading BUF13I = 1
22
BUF14I
Message buffer 14 interrupt
Write BUF14I = 1 after reading BUF14I = 1
23
BUF15I
Message buffer 15 interrupt
Write BUF15I = 1 after reading BUF15I = 1
24
ERR_INT
Error interrupt
Write ERR_INT = 1 after reading ERR_INT = 1
25
BOFF_INT Bus-off interrupt
Write BOFF_INT = 1 after reading BOFF_INT = 1
26
WAKE_INT Wake-up interrupt
Write WAKE_INT = 1 after reading WAKE_INT = 1
9
27-63
10.3.7
FLEX
CAN
Not used
Software and Level n IACK Registers (SWIACKR, L1IACK–L7IACK)
The eight IACK registers can be explicitly addressed via the CPU, or implicitly addressed via a
processor-generated interrupt acknowledge cycle during exception processing. In either case, the interrupt
controller’s actions are very similar.
First, consider an IACK cycle to a specific level: that is, a level-n IACK. When this type of IACK arrives
in the interrupt controller, the controller examines all the currently-active level n interrupt requests,
determines the highest priority within the level, and then responds with the unique vector number
corresponding to that specific interrupt source. The vector number is supplied as the data for the byte-sized
IACK read cycle. In addition to providing the vector number, the interrupt controller also loads the level
and priority number for the level into the IACKLPR register, where it may be retrieved later.
This interrupt controller design also supports the concept of a software IACK. A software IACK is a useful
concept that allows an interrupt service routine to determine if there are other pending interrupts so that
the overhead associated with interrupt exception processing (including machine state save/restore
functions) can be minimized. In general, the software IACK is performed near the end of an interrupt
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Controller Modules
service routine, and if there are additional active interrupt sources, the current interrupt service routine
(ISR) passes control to the appropriate service routine, but without taking another interrupt exception.
When the interrupt controller receives a software IACK read, it returns the vector number associated with
the highest level, highest priority unmasked interrupt source for that interrupt controller. The IACKLPR
register is also loaded as the software IACK is performed. If there are no active sources, the interrupt
controller returns an all-zero vector as the operand. For this situation, the IACKLPR register is also
cleared.
In addition to the IACK registers within each interrupt controller, there are global LnIACK registers. A
read from one of the global LnIACK registers returns the vector for the highest priority unmasked interrupt
within a level for all interrupt controllers. There is no global SWIACK register. However, reading the
SWIACK register from each interrupt controller returns the vector number of the highest priority
unmasked request within that controller.
7
6
4
3
Field
VECTOR
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
Address
0
R
See Table 10-2 and Table 10-3 for register offsets
Figure 10-10. Software and Level n IACK Registers (SWIACKR, L1IACK–L7IACK)
Table 10-15. SWIACK and L1IACK-L7IACK Field Descriptions
Bits
7–0
10.4
Name
Description
VECTOR Vector number. A read from the SWIACK register returns the vector number associated with the
highest level, highest priority unmasked interrupt source. A read from one of the LnACK registers
returns the highest priority unmasked interrupt source within the level.
Prioritization Between Interrupt Controllers
The interrupt controllers have a fixed priority, where INTC0 has the highest priority, and INTC1 has the
lowest priority. If both interrupt controllers have active interrupts at the same level and priority, then the
INTC0 interrupt will be serviced first. If INTC1 has an active interrupt that has a higher level or priority
than the highest INTC0 interrupt, then the INTC1 interrupt will be serviced first.
10.5
Low-Power Wakeup Operation
The System Control Module (SCM) contains an 8-bit low-power interrupt control register (LPICR) used
explicitly for controlling the low-power stop mode. This register must explicitly be programmed by
software to enter low-power mode.
Each interrupt controller provides a special combinatorial logic path to provide a special wake-up signal
to exit from the low-power stop mode. This special mode of operation works as follows:
• First, LPICR[6:4] is loaded with the mask level that will be specified while the core is in stop mode.
LPICR[7] must be set to enable this mode of operation.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
10-17
Interrupt Controller Modules
NOTE
The wakeup mask level taken from LPICR[6:4] is adjusted by hardware to
allow a level 7 IRQ to generate a wakeup. That is, the wakeup mask value
used by the interrupt controller must be in the range of 0–6.
•
Second, the processor executes a STOP instruction which places it in stop mode. Once the
processor is stopped, each interrupt controller enables a special logic path which evaluates the
incoming interrupt sources in a purely combinatorial path; that is, there are no clocked storage
elements. If an active interrupt request is asserted and the resulting interrupt level is greater than
the mask value contained in LPICR[6:4], then each interrupt controller asserts the wake-up output
signal, which is routed to the SCM where it is combined with the wakeup signals from the other
interrupt controller and then to the PLL module to re-enable the device’s clock trees and resume
processing.
•
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
10-18
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
11.1
Introduction
The edge port module (EPORT) has seven external interrupt pins, IRQ7–IRQ1. Each pin can be configured
individually as a level-sensitive interrupt pin, an edge-detecting interrupt pin (rising edge, falling edge, or
both), or a general-purpose input/output (I/O) pin. See Figure 11-1.
Stop
Mode
EPPAR[2n, 2n + 1]
Edge Detect
Logic
EPFR[n]
D0
Q
D0
D1
Q
IPBUS
D1
To Interrupt
Controller
EPPDR[n]
Synchronizer
Rising Edge
of System Clock
EPIER[n]
IRQx PIN
EPDR[n]
EPDDR[n]
Figure 11-1. EPORT Block Diagram
11.2
Low-Power Mode Operation
This section describes the operation of the EPORT module in low-power modes. For more information on
low-power modes, see Chapter 7, “Power Management.” Table 11-1 shows EPORT module operation in
low-power modes, and describes how this module may exit from each mode.
NOTE
The low-power interrupt control register (LPICR) in the System Control
Module specifies the interrupt level at or above which is needed to bring the
device out of a low-power mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
11-1
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Table 11-1. Edge Port Module Operation in Low-power Modes
Low-power Mode
EPORT Operation
Mode Exit
Wait
Normal
Any IRQx Interrupt at or above level in LPICR
Doze
Normal
Any IRQx Interrupt at or above level in LPICR
Stop
Level-sensing Only
Any IRQx Interrupt set for level-sensing at or
above level in LPICR
In wait and doze modes, the EPORT module continues to operate as it does in run mode. It may be
configured to exit the low-power modes by generating an interrupt request on either a selected edge or a
low level on an external pin. In stop mode, there are no clocks available to perform the edge-detect
function. Only the level-detect logic is active (if configured) to allow any low level on the external
interrupt pin to generate an interrupt (if enabled) to exit stop mode.
NOTE
The input pin synchronizer is bypassed for the level-detect logic since no
clocks are available.
11.3
Interrupt/General-Purpose I/O Pin Descriptions
All pins default to general-purpose input pins at reset. The pin value is synchronized to the rising edge of
CLKOUT when read from the EPORT pin data register (EPPDR). The values used in the edge/level detect
logic are also synchronized to the rising edge of CLKOUT. These pins use Schmitt triggered input buffers
which have built in hysteresis designed to decrease the probability of generating false edge-triggered
interrupts for slow rising and falling input signals.
When a pin is configured as an output, it is driven to a state whose level is determined by the corresponding
bit in the EPORT data register (EPDR). All bits in the EPDR are high at reset.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
11-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
11.4
Memory Map and Registers
This subsection describes the memory map and register structure.
11.4.1
Memory Map
Refer to Table 11-2 for a description of the EPORT memory map. The EPORT has an IPSBAR offset for
base address of 0x0013_0000.
Table 11-2. Edge Port Module Memory Map
IPSBAR
Offset
Bits 15–8
0x0013_0000
Access1
Bits 7–0
EPORT Pin Assignment Register (EPPAR)
S
0x0013_0002 EPORT Data Direction Register (EPDDR) EPORT Interrupt Enable Register (EPIER)
0x0013_0004
EPORT Data Register (EPDR)
0x0013_0006
S
EPORT Pin Data Register (EPPDR)
EPORT Flag Register (EPFR)
Reserved
S/U
2
S/U
1
S = CPU supervisor mode access only. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to
supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
2 Writing to reserved address locations has no effect, and reading returns 0s.
11.4.2
Registers
The EPORT programming model consists of these registers:
• The EPORT pin assignment register (EPPAR) controls the function of each pin individually.
• The EPORT data direction register (EPDDR) controls the direction of each one of the pins
individually.
• The EPORT interrupt enable register (EPIER) enables interrupt requests for each pin individually.
• The EPORT data register (EPDR) holds the data to be driven to the pins.
• The EPORT pin data register (EPPDR) reflects the current state of the pins.
• The EPORT flag register (EPFR) individually latches EPORT edge events.
11.4.2.1
EPORT Pin Assignment Register (EPPAR)
15
Field
14
EPPA7
Reset
R/W
Address
13
12
EPPA6
11
10
EPPA5
9
8
EPPA4
7
6
EPPA3
5
4
EPPA2
3
2
EPPA1
1
0
—
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R
IPSBAR + 0x0013_0000, 0x0013_0001
Figure 11-2. EPORT Pin Assignment Register (EPPAR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
11-3
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Table 11-3. EPPAR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
15–2
EPPAx
EPORT pin assignment select fields. The read/write EPPAx fields configure EPORT
pins for level detection and rising and/or falling edge detection.
Pins configured as level-sensitive are inverted so that a logic 0 on the external pin
represents a valid interrupt request. Level-sensitive interrupt inputs are not latched. To
guarantee that a level-sensitive interrupt request is acknowledged, the interrupt
source must keep the signal asserted until acknowledged by software. Level
sensitivity must be selected to bring the device out of stop mode with an IRQx
interrupt.
Pins configured as edge-triggered are latched and need not remain asserted for
interrupt generation. A pin configured for edge detection can trigger an interrupt
regardless of its configuration as input or output.
Interrupt requests generated in the EPORT module can be masked by the interrupt
controller module. EPPAR functionality is independent of the selected pin direction.
Reset clears the EPPAx fields.
00 Pin IRQx level-sensitive
01 Pin IRQx rising edge triggered
10 Pin IRQx falling edge triggered
11 Pin IRQx both falling edge and rising edge triggered
1–0
—
11.4.2.2
Reserved, should be cleared.
EPORT Data Direction Register (EPDDR)
Field
7
6
5
4
EPDD7
EPDD6
EPDD5
EPDD4
Reset
R/W
Address
3
2
1
0
EPDD3 EPDD2 EPDD1
—
0000_0000
R/W
R
IPSBAR + 0x0013_0002
Figure 11-3. EPORT Data Direction Register (EPDDR)
Table 11-4. EPDD Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–1
EPDDx
Setting any bit in the EPDDR configures the corresponding pin as an output. Clearing
any bit in EPDDR configures the corresponding pin as an input. Pin direction is
independent of the level/edge detection configuration. Reset clears EPDD7-EPDD1.
To use an EPORT pin as an external interrupt request source, its corresponding bit in
EPDDR must be clear. Software can generate interrupt requests by programming the
EPORT data register when the EPDDR selects output.
1 Corresponding EPORT pin configured as output
0 Corresponding EPORT pin configured as input
0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
11-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
11.4.2.3
Edge Port Interrupt Enable Register (EPIER)
Field
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EPIE7
EPIE6
EPIE5
EPIE4
EPIE3
EPIE2
EPIE1
—
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
R
IPSBAR + 0x0013_0003
Figure 11-4. EPORT Port Interrupt Enable Register (EPIER)
Table 11-5. EPIER Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–1
EPIEx
Edge port interrupt enable bits enable EPORT interrupt requests. If a bit in EPIER is
set, EPORT generates an interrupt request when:
• The corresponding bit in the EPORT flag register (EPFR) is set or later becomes
set.
• The corresponding pin level is low and the pin is configured for level-sensitive
operation.
Clearing a bit in EPIER negates any interrupt request from the corresponding EPORT
pin. Reset clears EPIE7-EPIE1.
1 Interrupt requests from corresponding EPORT pin enabled
0 Interrupt requests from corresponding EPORT pin disabled
0
—
11.4.2.4
Reserved, should be cleared.
Edge Port Data Register (EPDR)
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EPD7
EPD6
EPD5
EPD4
EPD3
EPD2
EPD1
—
1111_1111
R/W
R
IPSBAR + 0x0013_0004
Figure 11-5. EPORT Port Data Register (EPDR)
Table 11-6. EPDR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–1
EPDx
Edge port data bits. Data written to EPDR is stored in an internal register; if any pin of
the port is configured as an output, the bit stored for that pin is driven onto the pin.
Reading EDPR returns the data stored in the register. Reset sets EPD7-EPD1.
0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
11-5
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
11.4.2.5
Edge Port Pin Data Register (EPPDR)
Field
7
6
5
4
EPPD7
EPPD6
EPPD5
EPPD4
Reset
3
2
1
0
EPPD3 EPPD2 EPPD1
Current pin state
R/W
—
0
R
Address
IPSBAR + 0x0013_0005
Figure 11-6. EPORT Port Pin Data Register (EPPDR)
Table 11-7. EPPDR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–1
EPPDx
Edge port pin data bits. The read-only EPPDR reflects the current state of the EPORT
pins IRQ7–IRQ1. Writing to EPPDR has no effect, and the write cycle terminates
normally. Reset does not affect EPPDR.
0
—
11.4.2.6
Reserved, should be cleared.
Edge Port Flag Register (EPFR)
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EPF7
EPF6
EPF5
EPF4
EPF3
EPF2
EPF1
—
0000_0000
R/W
R
IPSBAR + 0x0013_0006
Figure 11-7. EPORT Port Flag Register (EPFR)
Table 11-8. EPFR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–1
EPFx
Edge port flag bits. When an EPORT pin is configured for edge triggering, its
corresponding read/write bit in EPFR indicates that the selected edge has been
detected. Reset clears EPF7-EPF1.
Bits in this register are set when the selected edge is detected on the corresponding
pin. A bit remains set until cleared by writing a 1 to it. Writing 0 has no effect. If a pin
is configured as level-sensitive (EPPARx = 00), pin transitions do not affect this
register.
1 Selected edge for IRQx pin has been detected.
0 Selected edge for IRQx pin has not been detected.
0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
11-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12
Chip Select Module
This chapter describes the chip select module, including the operation and programming model of the chip
select registers, which include the chip select address, mask, and control registers.
NOTE
Unless otherwise noted, in this chapter, “clock” refers to the CLKOUT used
for the bus.
12.1
Overview
The following list summarizes the key chip select features:
• Up to seven independent, user-programmable chip select signals (CS[6:0]) that can interface with
external SRAM, PROM, EPROM, EEPROM, Flash, and peripherals
• Address masking for 64-Kbyte to 4-Gbyte memory block sizes
12.2
Chip Select Module Signals
Table 12-1 lists signals used by the chip select module.
Table 12-1. Chip Select Module Signals
Signal
Chip Selects
(CS[6:0])
Description
Each CSn can be independently programmed for an address location as well as for masking, port
size, read/write burst capability, wait-state generation, and internal/external termination. Only CS0 is
initialized at reset and may act as an external boot chip select to allow boot ROM to be at an external
address space. Port size for CS0 is configured by the logic levels of D[19:18] when RSTO negates
and RCON is asserted.
Output Enable Interfaces to memory or to peripheral devices and enables a read transfer. It is asserted and negated
on the falling edge of the clock. OE is asserted only when one of the chip selects matches for the
(OE)
current address decode.
Byte Strobes
BS[3:0]
These signals are individually programmed through the byte-enable mode bit, CSCRn[BEM],
described in Section 12.4.1.3, “Chip Select Control Registers (CSCR0–CSCR6)”.
These generated signals provide byte data select signals, which are decoded from the transfer size,
A1, and A0 signals in addition to the programmed port size and burstability of the memory accessed,
as Table 12-2 shows.
Table 12-2 shows the interaction of the byte-enable/byte-write enables with related signals.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
12-1
Chip Select Module
Table 12-2. Byte Enables/Byte Write Enable Signal Settings
Transfer Size
Byte
Port Size
8-bit
BS1
BS0
D[31:24]
D[23:16]
D[15:8]
D[7:0]
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
32-bit
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
8-bit
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
32-bit
0
0
0
0
0
0
8-bit
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
8-bit
16-bit
16-bit
Line
BS2
1
32-bit
Longword
BS3
A0
0
16-bit
Word
A1
16-bit
32-bit
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
12-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Chip Select Module
12.3
Chip Select Operation
Each chip select has a dedicated set of registers for configuration and control.
• Chip select address registers (CSARn) control the base address of the chip select. See
Section 12.4.1.1, “Chip Select Address Registers (CSAR0–CSAR6)”.
• Chip select mask registers (CSMRn) provide 16-bit address masking and access control. See
Section 12.4.1.2, “Chip Select Mask Registers (CSMR0–CSMR6)”.
• Chip select control registers (CSCRn) provide port size and burst capability indication, wait-state
generation, and automatic acknowledge generation features. See Section 12.4.1.3, “Chip Select
Control Registers (CSCR0–CSCR6)”.
CS0 is a global chip select after reset and provides relocatable boot ROM capability.
12.3.1
General Chip Select Operation
When a bus cycle is initiated, the device first compares its address with the base address and mask
configurations programmed for chip selects 0–6 (configured in CSCR0–CSCR6) and DRAM blocks 0 and
1 (configured in DACR0 and DACR1). If the driven address matches a programmed chip select or DRAM
block, the appropriate chip select is asserted or the DRAM block is selected using the specifications
programmed in the respective configuration register. Otherwise, the following occurs:
• If the address and attributes do not match in CSAR or DACR, the device runs an external
burst-inhibited bus cycle with a default of external termination on a 32-bit port.
• Should an address and attribute match in multiple CSCRs, the matching chip select signals are
driven; however, the chip select signals are driven during an external burst-inhibited bus cycle with
external termination on a 32-bit port.
• If the address and attribute match both DACRs or a DACR and a CSAR, the operation is undefined.
Table 12-3 shows the type of access as a function of match in the CSARs and DACRs.
Table 12-3. Accesses by Matches in CSARs and DACRs
12.3.1.1
Number of CSCR Matches
Number of DACR Matches
Type of Access
0
0
External
1
0
Defined by CSAR
Multiple
0
External, burst-inhibited, 32-bit
0
1
Defined by DACRs
1
1
Undefined
Multiple
1
Undefined
0
Multiple
Undefined
1
Multiple
Undefined
Multiple
Multiple
Undefined
8-, 16-, and 32-Bit Port Sizing
Static bus sizing is programmable through the port size bits, CSCR[PS]. See Section 12.4.1.3, “Chip Select
Control Registers (CSCR0–CSCR6)” for more information. Figure 12-1 shows the correspondence
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
12-3
Chip Select Module
between the data bus and the external byte strobe control lines (BS[3:0]). Note that all byte lanes are
driven, although the state of unused byte lanes is undefined.
External
data bus
BS3
BS2
BS1
BS0
D[31:24]
D[23:16]
D[15:8]
D[7:0]
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
Byte 0
Byte 2
Byte 1
Byte 3
Driven, undefined
32-bit port
memory
16-bit port
memory
8-bit port
memory
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
Driven, undefined
Figure 12-1. Connections for External Memory Port Sizes
12.3.1.2
External Boot Chip Select Operation
CS0, the external boot chip select, allows address decoding for boot ROM before system initialization. Its
operation differs from other external chip select outputs after system reset.
After system reset, CS0 is asserted for every external access. No other chip select can be used until the
valid bit, CSMR0[V], is set, at which point CS0 functions as configured and CS[6:1] can be used. At reset,
the port size function of the external boot chip select is determined by the logic levels of the inputs on
D[19:18]. Table 12-4 and Table 12-4 list the various reset encodings for the configuration signals
multiplexed with D[19:18].
Table 12-4. D[19:18] External Boot Chip Select Configuration
D[19:18]
Boot Device/Data Port Size
00
Internal (32-bit)
01
External (16-bit)
10
External (8-bit)
11
External (32-bit)
Provided the required address range is in the chip select address register (CSAR0), CS0 can be
programmed to continue decoding for a range of addresses after the CSMR0[V] is set, after which the
external boot chip select can be restored only by a system reset.
12.4
Chip Select Registers
Table 12-5 shows the chip select register memory map. Reading reserved locations returns zeros.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
12-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Chip Select Module
Table 12-5. Chip Select Registers
IPSBAR
Offset
0x00_0080
[31:24]
[23:16]
Chip select address register—bank 0 (CSAR0)
[p. 12-6]
0x00_0084
[15:8]
[7:0]
Reserved1
Chip select mask register—bank 0 (CSMR0) [p. 12-6]
0x00_0088
Reserved1
Chip select control register—bank 0
(CSCR0) [p. 12-7]
0x00_008C
Chip select address register—bank 1 (CSAR1)
[p. 12-6]
Reserved1
0x00_0090
Chip select mask register—bank 1 (CSMR1) [p. 12-6]
0x00_0094
Reserved1
Chip select control register—bank 1
(CSCR1) [p. 12-7]
0x00_0098
Chip select address register—bank 2 (CSAR2)
[p. 12-6]
Reserved1
0x00_009C
Chip select mask register—bank 2 (CSMR2) [p. 12-6]
0x00_00A0
Reserved1
Chip select control register—bank 2
(CSCR2) [p. 12-7]
0x00_00A4
Chip select address register—bank 3 (CSAR3)
[p. 12-6]
Reserved1
0x00_00A8
Chip select mask register—bank 3 (CSMR3) [p. 12-6]
0x00_00AC
Reserved1
Chip select control register—bank 3
(CSCR3) [p. 12-7]
0x00_00B0
Chip select address register—bank 4 (CSAR4)
[p. 12-6]
Reserved1
0x00_00B4
Chip select mask register—bank 4 (CSMR4) [p. 12-6]
0x00_00B8
Reserved1
Chip select control register—bank 4
(CSCR4) [p. 12-7]
0x00_00BC
Chip select address register—bank 5 (CSAR5)
[p. 12-6]
Reserved1
0x00_00C0
Chip select mask register—bank 5 (CSMR5) [p. 12-6]
0x00_00C4
Reserved1
Chip select control register—bank 5
(CSCR5) [p. 12-7]
0x00_00C8
Chip select address register—bank 6 (CSAR6)
[p. 12-6]
Reserved1
0x00_00CC
0x00_00D0
1
Chip select mask register—bank 6 (CSMR6) [p. 12-6]
Reserved1
Chip select control register—bank 6
(CSCR6) [p. 12-7]
Addresses not assigned to a register and undefined register bits are reserved for expansion. Write accesses to
these reserved address spaces and reserved register bits have no effect.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
12-5
Chip Select Module
12.4.1
Chip Select Module Registers
The chip select module is programmed through the chip select address registers (CSAR0–CSAR6), chip
select mask registers (CSMR0–CSMR6), and the chip select control registers (CSCR0–CSCR6).
12.4.1.1
Chip Select Address Registers (CSAR0–CSAR6)
The CSARs, Figure 12-2, specify the chip select base addresses.
15
0
Field
BA
Reset
Uninitialized
R/W
Address
R/W
0x080 (CSAR0); 0x08C (CSAR1); 0x098 (CSAR2); 0x0A4 (CSAR3);
0x0B0 (CSAR4); 0x0BC (CSAR5); 0x0C8 (CSAR6)
Figure 12-2. Chip Select Address Registers (CSARn)
Table 12-6 describes CSAR[BA].
Table 12-6. CSARn Field Description
Bits
Name
Description
15–0
BA
Base address. Defines the base address for memory dedicated to chip select CS[6:0]. BA is compared
to bits 31–16 on the internal address bus to determine if chip select memory is being accessed.
12.4.1.2
Chip Select Mask Registers (CSMR0–CSMR6)
The CSMRs, Figure 12-3, are used to specify the address mask and allowable access types for the
respective chip selects.
.
31
Field
16 15
9
BAM
Reset
—
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WP — AM C/I SC SD UC UD V
Unitialized
0
R/W
R/W
Addr
0x084 (CSMR0); 0x090 (CSMR1); 0x09C (CSMR2); 0x0A8 (CSMR3);
0x0B4 (CSMR4); 0x0C0 (CSMR5); 0x0CC (CSMR6)
Figure 12-3. Chip Select Mask Registers (CSMRn)
Table 12-7 describes CSMR fields.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
12-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Chip Select Module
Table 12-7. CSMRn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
31–16
BAM
Base address mask. Defines the chip select block by masking address bits. Setting a BAM bit causes the
corresponding CSAR bit to be ignored in the decode.
0 Corresponding address bit is used in chip select decode.
1 Corresponding address bit is a don’t care in chip select decode.
The block size for CS[6:0] is 2n where n = (number of bits set in respective CSMR[BAM]) + 16.
So, if CSAR0 = 0x0000 and CSMR0[BAM] = 0x0001, CS0 addresses a 128-Kbyte (217 byte) range from
0x0000–0x1_FFFF.
Likewise, for CS0 to access 32 Mbytes (225 bytes) of address space starting at location 0x0000, and for
CS1 to access 16 Mbytes (224 bytes) of address space starting after the CS0 space, then CSAR0 =
0x0000, CSMR0[BAM] = 0x01FF, CSAR1 = 0x0200, and CSMR1[BAM] = 0x00FF.
8
WP
Write protect. Controls write accesses to the address range in the corresponding CSAR. Attempting to
write to the range of addresses for which CSARn[WP] = 1 results in the appropriate chip select not being
selected. No exception occurs.
0 Both read and write accesses are allowed.
1 Only read accesses are allowed.
7
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
6
AM
Alternate master. When AM = 0 during a DMA access, SC, SD, UC, and UD are don’t cares in the chip
select decode.
5–1
C/I,
SC,
SD,
UC, UD
Address space mask bits. These bits determine whether the specified accesses can occur to the address
space defined by the BAM for this chip select.
C/I CPU space and interrupt acknowledge cycle mask
SC Supervisor code address space mask
SD Supervisor data address space mask
UC User code address space mask
UD User data address space mask
0 The address space assigned to this chip select is available to the specified access type.
1 The address space assigned to this chip select is not available (masked) to the specified access type.
If this address space is accessed, chip select is not activated and a regular external bus cycle occurs.
Note that if AM = 0, SC, SD, UC, and UD are ignored in the chip select decode on DMA access.
0
V
Valid bit. Indicates whether the corresponding CSAR, CSMR, and CSCR contents are valid. Programmed
chip selects do not assert until V is set (except for CS0, which acts as the global chip select). Reset clears
each CSMRn[V].
0 Chip select invalid
1 Chip select valid
12.4.1.3
Chip Select Control Registers (CSCR0–CSCR6)
Each CSCR, shown in Figure 12-4, controls the auto-acknowledge, port size, burst capability, and
activation of each chip select. Note that to support the external boot chip select, CS0, the CSCR0 reset
values differ from the other CSCRs. CS0 allows address decoding for boot ROM before system
initialization.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
12-7
Chip Select Module
15
14
13
10
9
Field
—
WS
—
Reset: CSCR0
—
11_11
—
Reset: Other CSCRs
7
6
5
4
3
2
AA PS1 PS0 BEM BSTR BSTW
1
D19 D18
—
0
—
—
Uninitialized
R/W
Address
8
R/W
0x08A (CSCR0); 0x096 (CSCR1); 0x0A2 (CSCR2); 0x0AE (CSCR3);
0x0BA (CSCR4); 0x0C6 (CSCR5); 0x0D2 (CSCR6)
Figure 12-4. Chip Select Control Registers (CSCRn)
Table 12-8 describes CSCRn fields.
Table 12-8. CSCRn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
15–14
—
13–10
WS
9
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
8
AA
Auto-acknowledge enable. Determines the assertion of the internal transfer acknowledge for accesses
specified by the chip select address.
0 No internal TA is asserted. Cycle is terminated externally.
1 Internal TA is asserted as specified by WS. Note that if AA = 1 for a corresponding CSn and the
external system asserts an external TA before the wait-state countdown asserts the internal TA, the
cycle is terminated. Burst cycles increment the address bus between each internal termination.
7–6
PS
Port size. Specifies the width of the data associated with each chip select. It determines where data is
driven during write cycles and where data is sampled during read cycles. See Section 12.3.1.1, “8-,
16-, and 32-Bit Port Sizing”.
00 32-bit port size. Valid data sampled and driven on D[31:0]
01 8-bit port size. Valid data sampled and driven on D[31:24]
1x 16-bit port size. Valid data sampled and driven on D[31:16]
5
BEM
Byte enable mode. Specifies the byte enable operation. Certain SRAMs have byte enables that must
be asserted during reads as well as writes. BEM can be set in the relevant CSCR to provide the
appropriate mode of byte enable in support of these SRAMs.
0 BS is not asserted for read. BS is asserted for data write only.
1 BS is asserted for read and write accesses.
4
BSTR Burst read enable. Specifies whether burst reads are used for memory associated with each CSn.
0 Data exceeding the specified port size is broken into individual, port-sized non-burst reads. For
example, a longword read from an 8-bit port is broken into four 8-bit reads.
1 Enables data burst reads larger than the specified port size, including longword reads from 8- and
16-bit ports, word reads from 8-bit ports, and line reads from 8-, 16-, and 32-bit ports.
Reserved, should be cleared.
Wait states. The number of wait states inserted before an internal transfer acknowledge is generated
(WS = 0 inserts zero wait states, WS = 0xF inserts 15 wait states). If AA = 0, TA must be asserted by
the external system regardless of the number of wait states generated. In that case, the external
transfer acknowledge ends the cycle. An external TA supercedes the generation of an internal TA.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
12-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Chip Select Module
Table 12-8. CSCRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Bits
3
2–0
Name
Description
BSTW Burst write enable. Specifies whether burst writes are used for memory associated with each CSn.
0 Break data larger than the specified port size into individual port-sized, non-burst writes. For
example, a longword write to an 8-bit port takes four byte writes.
1 Enables burst write of data larger than the specified port size, including longword writes to 8 and
16-bit ports, word writes to 8-bit ports and line writes to 8-, 16-, and 32-bit ports.
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
12-9
Chip Select Module
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
12-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13
External Interface Module (EIM)
This chapter describes data-transfer operations, error conditions, and reset operations. Chapter 15,
“Synchronous DRAM Controller Module,” describes DRAM cycles.
NOTE
Unless otherwise noted, in this chapter, “clock” refers to the CLKOUT used
for the bus.
13.1
Features
The following list summarizes bus operation features:
• Up to 24 bits of address and 32 bits of data
• Access 8-, 16-, and 32-bit data port sizes
• Generates byte, word, longword, and line-size transfers
• Burst and burst-inhibited transfer support
• Optional internal termination for external bus cycles
13.2
Bus and Control Signals
Table 13-1 summarizes the bus signals described in Chapter 14, “Signal Descriptions”.
Table 13-1. ColdFire Bus Signal Summary
Signal Name
A[23:0]
I/O
CLKOUT Edge
Address bus
O
Rising
Byte selects
O
Falling
Chip selects
O
Falling
Data bus
I/O
Rising
Output enable
O
Falling
Read/write
O
Rising
Transfer size
O
Rising
TA
Transfer acknowledge
I
Rising
TIP
Transfer in progress
O
Rising
TS
Transfer start
O
Rising
BS 1
CS[6:0]
1
D[31:0]
OE
1
R/W
SIZ[1:0]
1
Description
These signals change after the falling edge. In the Electrical Specifications, these signals are
specified off of the rising edge because CLKIN is squared up internally.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
13-1
External Interface Module (EIM)
13.3
Bus Characteristics
The device uses its system clock to generate CLKOUT. Therefore, the external bus operates at the same
speed as the bus clock rate, where all bus operations are synchronous to the rising edge of CLKOUT, and
some of the bus control signals (BS, OE, and CSn,) are synchronous to the falling edge, shown in
Figure 13-1. Bus characteristics may differ somewhat for interfacing with external DRAM.
CLKOUT
tho
tvo
Rising-Edge
Signals
tvo
tho
Falling-Edge
Signals
tsi
thi
Inputs
tvo = Propagation delay of signal relative to CLKOUT edge
tho = Output hold time relative to CLKOUT edge
tsi = Required input setup time relative to CLKOUT edge
thi = Required input hold time relative to CLKOUT edge
Figure 13-1. Signal Relationship to CLKOUT for Non-DRAM Access
13.4
Data Transfer Operation
Data transfers between the processor and other devices involve the following signals:
• Address bus (A[23:0])
• Data bus (D[31:0])
• Control signals (TS and TA)
• CSn, OE, BS
• Attribute signals (R/W, SIZ, and TIP)
The address bus, write data, TS, and all attribute signals change on the rising edge of CLKOUT. Read data
is latched into the processor on the rising edge of CLKOUT.
The bus supports byte, word, and longword operand transfers and allows accesses to 8-, 16-, and 32-bit
data ports. Aspects of the transfer, such as the port size, the number of wait states for the external slave
being accessed, and whether internal transfer termination is enabled, can be programmed in the chip-select
control registers (CSCRs) and the DRAM control registers (DACRs).
Figure 13-2 shows the byte lanes that external memory should be connected to and the sequential transfers
if a longword is transferred for three port sizes. For example, an 8-bit memory should be connected to
D[31:24] (BS3). A longword transfer takes four transfers on D[31:24], starting with the MSB and going
to the LSB.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
13-2
Freescale Semiconductor
External Interface Module (EIM)
Byte Enable
BS3
BS2
BS1
BS0
D[31:24]
D[23:16]
D[15:8]
D[7:0]
32-Bit Port
Memory
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
16-Bit Port
Memory
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
Processor
External
Data Bus
8-Bit Port
Memory
Driven with
indeterminate values
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
Driven with
indeterminate values
Byte 3
Figure 13-2. Connections for External Memory Port Sizes
The timing relationship of chip selects (CS[7:0]), byte selects (BS[3:0]), and output enable (OE) with
respect to CLKOUT is similar in that all transitions occur during the low phase of CLKOUT. However,
due to differences in on-chip signal routing, signals may not assert simultaneously.
CLKOUT
CS[7:0]
BS[3:0]
OE
Figure 13-3. Chip-Select Module Output Timing Diagram
13.4.1
Bus Cycle Execution
When a bus cycle is initiated, the device first compares the address of that bus cycle with the base address
and mask configurations programmed for chip selects 0–7 (configured in CSCR0–CSCR7) and DRAM
block 0 and 1 address and control registers (configured in DACR0 and DACR1). If the driven address
compares with one of the programmed chip selects or DRAM blocks, the appropriate chip select is asserted
or the DRAM block is selected using the specifications programmed by the user in the respective
configuration register. Otherwise, the following occurs:
• If the address and attributes do not match in CSCR or DACR, the processor runs an external
burst-inhibited bus cycle with a default of external termination on a 32-bit port.
• Should an address and attribute match in multiple CSCRs, the matching chip-select signals are
driven; however, the processor runs an external burst-inhibited bus cycle with external termination
on a 32-bit port.
• Should an address and attribute match both DACRs or a DACR and a CSCR, the operation is
undefined.
Table 13-2 shows the type of access as a function of match in the CSCRs and DACRs.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
13-3
External Interface Module (EIM)
Table 13-2. Accesses by Matches in CSCRs and DACRs
Number of CSCR Matches
Number of DACR Matches
Type of Access
0
0
External
1
0
Defined by CSCR
Multiple
0
External, burst-inhibited, 32-bit
0
1
Defined by DACRs
1
1
Undefined
Multiple
1
Undefined
0
Multiple
Undefined
1
Multiple
Undefined
Multiple
Multiple
Undefined
Basic operation of the bus is a three-clock bus cycle:
1. During the first clock, the address, attributes, and TS are driven.
2. Data and TA are sampled during the second clock of a bus-read cycle. During a read, the external
device provides data and is sampled at the rising edge at the end of the second bus clock. This data
is concurrent with TA, which is also sampled at the rising edge of the clock.
During a write, the ColdFire device drives data from the rising clock edge at the end of the first
clock to the rising clock edge at the end of the bus cycle. Wait states can be added between the first
and second clocks by delaying the assertion of TA. TA can be configured to be generated internally
through the CSCRs. If TA is not generated internally, the system must provide it externally.
3. The last clock of the bus cycle uses what would be an idle clock between cycles to provide hold
time for address, attributes and write data. Figure 13-6 and Figure 13-8 show the basic read and
write operations.
13.4.2
Data Transfer Cycle States
The data transfer operation is controlled by an on-chip state machine. Each bus clock cycle is divided into
two states. Even states occur when CLKOUT is high and odd states occur when CLKOUT is low. The state
transition diagram for basic and fast termination read and write cycles are shown in Figure 13-4.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
13-4
Freescale Semiconductor
External Interface Module (EIM)
Next Cycle
S0
S5
S1
Basic
Read/Write
Fast
Termination
S4
S2
Wait
States
S3
Figure 13-4. Data Transfer State Transition Diagram
Table 13-3 describes the states as they appear in subsequent timing diagrams.
Table 13-3. Bus Cycle States
State
Cycle
CLKOUT
Description
S0
All
High
The read or write cycle is initiated in S0. On the rising edge of CLKOUT, the device
places a valid address on the address bus and drives R/W high for a read and low
for a write, if it is not already in the appropriate state. The processor asserts TIP,
SIZ[1:0], and TS on the rising edge of CLKOUT.
S1
All
Low
The appropriate CSn, BS, and OE signals assert on the CLKOUT falling edge.
S2
S3
Fast
Termination
TA must be asserted during S1. Data is made available by the external device and
is sampled on the rising edge of CLKOUT with TA asserted.
Read/write
High
(skipped fast
termination)
TS is negated on the rising edge of CLKOUT in S2.
Write
The data bus is driven out of high impedance as data is placed on the bus on the
rising edge of CLKOUT.
Read/write
(skipped for
fast
termination)
Low
Read
S4
All
Read
(including
fast-terminati
on)
The processor waits for TA assertion. If TA is not sampled as asserted before the
rising edge of CLKOUT at the end of the first clock cycle, the processor inserts wait
states (full clock cycles) until TA is sampled as asserted.
Data is made available by the external device on the falling edge of CLKOUT and
is sampled on the rising edge of CLKOUT with TA asserted.
High
The external device should negate TA.
The external device can stop driving data after the rising edge of CLKOUT.
However data could be driven through the end of S5.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
13-5
External Interface Module (EIM)
Table 13-3. Bus Cycle States (continued)
State
S5
Cycle
S5
CLKOUT
Low
Description
CS, BS, and OE are negated on the CLKOUT falling edge of S5. The processor
stops driving address lines and R/W on the rising edge of CLKOUT, terminating the
read or write cycle. At the same time, the processor negates TIP, and SIZ[1:0] on
the rising edge of CLKOUT.
Note that the rising edge of CLKOUT may be the start of S0 for the next access
cycle.
Read
The external device stops driving data between S4 and S5.
Write
The data bus returns to high impedance on the rising edge of CLKOUT. The rising
edge of CLKOUT may be the start of S0 for the next access.
NOTE
An external device has at most two CLKOUT cycles after the start of S4 to
three-state the data bus. This applies to basic read cycles, fast termination
cycles, and the last transfer of a burst.
13.4.3
Read Cycle
During a read cycle, the device receives data from memory or from a peripheral device. Figure 13-5 is a
read cycle flowchart.
External device
ColdFire processor
1.
Set R/W to read
2.
Place address on A[31:0]
3.
Assert TIP, and SIZ[1:0]
4.
Assert TS
5.
Negate TS
1.
1.
1.
Decode address and select the
appropriate slave device.
2.
Drive data on D[31:0]
3.
Assert TA
1.
Negate TA.
2.
Stop driving D[31:0]
Sample TA low and latch data
Start next cycle
Figure 13-5. Read Cycle Flowchart
The read cycle timing diagram is shown in Figure 13-6.
NOTE
In the following timing diagrams, TA waveforms apply for chip selects
programmed to enable either internal or external termination. TA assertion
should look the same in either case.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
13-6
Freescale Semiconductor
External Interface Module (EIM)
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
CLKOUT
R/W
A[31:0], SIZ[1:0]
TIP
TS
CSn, BSn, OE
Read
D[31:0]
TA
Figure 13-6. Basic Read Bus Cycle
Note the following characteristics of a basic read:
• In S3, data is made available by the external device on the falling edge of CLKOUT and is sampled
on the rising edge of CLKOUT with TA asserted.
• In S4, the external device can stop driving data after the rising edge of CLKOUT. However data
could be driven up to S5.
• For a read cycle, the external device stops driving data between S4 and S5.
States are described in Table 13-3.
13.4.4
Write Cycle
During a write cycle, the processor sends data to the memory or to a peripheral device. The write cycle
flowchart is shown in Figure 13-7.
External Device
ColdFire processor
1.
Set R/W to write
2.
Place address on A[31:0]
3.
Assert TIP and SIZ[1:0]
4.
Assert TS
5.
Place data on D[31:0]
6.
Negate TS
1.
Sample TA low
2.
Stop driving data from D[31:0]
1.
Start next cycle
1.
Decode address
2.
Store data on D[31:0]
3.
Assert TA
1.
Negate TA
Figure 13-7. Write Cycle Flowchart
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
13-7
External Interface Module (EIM)
The write cycle timing diagram is shown in Figure 13-8.
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
CLKOUT
A[31:0], SIZ[1:0]
R/W
TIP
TS
CSn, BSn
Write
D[31:0]
TA
Figure 13-8. Basic Write Bus Cycle
Table 13-3 describes the six states of a basic write cycle.
13.4.5
Fast Termination Cycles
Two clock cycle transfers are supported on the external bus. In most cases, this is impractical to use in a
system because the termination must take place in the same half-clock during which TS is asserted. As this
is atypical, it is not referred to as the zero-wait-state case but is called the fast-termination case. Fast
termination cycles occur when the external device or memory asserts TA less than one clock after TS is
asserted. This means that the processor samples TA on the rising edge of the second cycle of the bus
transfer. Figure 13-9 shows a read cycle with fast termination. Note that fast termination cannot be used
with internal termination.
S0
S1
S4
S5
CLKOUT
A[31:0], SIZ[1:0]
R/W
TIP
TS
CSn, BSn, OE
D[31:0]
Read
TA
Figure 13-9. Read Cycle with Fast Termination
Figure 13-10 shows a write cycle with fast termination.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
13-8
Freescale Semiconductor
External Interface Module (EIM)
S0
S1
S4
S5
CLKOUT
A[31:0], SIZ[1:0]
R/W
TIP
TS
CSn, BSn
D[31:0]
Write
TA
Figure 13-10. Write Cycle with Fast Termination
13.4.6
Back-to-Back Bus Cycles
The processor runs back-to-back bus cycles whenever possible. For example, when a longword read is
started on a word-size bus, the processor performs two back-to-back word read accesses. Back-to-back
accesses are distinguished by the continuous assertion of TIP throughout the cycle. Figure 13-11 shows a
read back-to-back with a write.
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
CLKOUT
A[31:0], SIZ[1:0]
R/W
TIP
TS
CSn, BSn
OE
D[31:0]
Read
Write
TA
Figure 13-11. Back-to-Back Bus Cycles
Basic read and write cycles are used to show a back-to-back cycle, but there is no restriction as to the type
of operations to be placed back to back. The initiation of a back-to-back cycle is not user definable.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
13-9
External Interface Module (EIM)
13.4.7
Burst Cycles
The processor can be programmed to initiate burst cycles if its transfer size exceeds the size of the port it
is transferring to. For example, a word transfer to an 8-bit port would take a 2-byte burst cycle. A line
transfer to a 32-bit port would take a 4-longword burst cycle.
The external bus can support 2-1-1-1 burst cycles to maximize cache performance and optimize DMA
transfers. A user can add wait states by delaying termination of the cycle. The initiation of a burst cycle is
encoded on the size pins. For burst transfers to smaller port sizes, SIZ[1:0] indicates the size of the entire
transfer. For example, if the processor writes a longword to an 8-bit port, SIZ[1:0] = 00 for the first byte
transfer and does not change.
The CSCRs can be used to enable bursting for reads, writes, or both. Processor memory space can be
declared burst-inhibited for reads and writes by clearing the appropriate CSCRn[BSTR,BSTW]. A line
access to a burst-inhibited region first accesses the processor bus encoded as a line access. The SIZ[1:0]
encoding does not exceed the programmed port size. The address changes if internal termination is used
but does not change if external termination is used, as shown in Figure 13-12 and Figure 13-13.
13.4.7.1
Line Transfers
A line is a 16-byte-aligned, 16-byte value. Despite the alignment, a line access may not begin on the
aligned address; therefore, the bus interface supports line transfers on multiple address boundaries.
Table 13-4 shows allowable patterns for line accesses.
Table 13-4. Allowable Line Access Patterns
13.4.7.2
A[3:2]
Longword Accesses
00
0–4–8–C
01
4–8–C–0
10
8–C–0–4
11
C–0–4–8
Line Read Bus Cycles
Figure 13-12 and Figure 13-13 show a line access read with zero wait states. The access starts like a basic
read bus cycle with the first data transfer sampled on the rising edge of S4, but the next pipelined burst
data is sampled a cycle later on the rising edge of S6. Each subsequent pipelined data burst is single cycle
until the last one, which can be held for up to two CLKOUT cycles after TA is asserted. Note that CSn are
asserted throughout the burst transfer. This example shows the timing for external termination, which
differs from the internal termination example in Figure 13-13 only in that the address lines change only at
the beginning (assertion of TS and TIP) and end (negation of TIP) of the transfer.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
13-10
Freescale Semiconductor
External Interface Module (EIM)
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
S8
S9
S10 S11
S12 S13
CLKOUT
A[31:0], SIZ[1:0]
R/W
TIP
TS
CSn, BSn, OE
Read
Read
D[31:0]
Read
Read
TA
Figure 13-12. Line Read Burst (2-1-1-1), External Termination
Figure 13-13 shows timing when internal termination is used.
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
S8
S9
S10 S11
S12 S13
CLKOUT
A[31:0]
A[31:0], SIZ[1:0]
R/W
TIP
TS
CSn, BSn, OE
D[31:0]
Read
Read
Read
Read
TA
Figure 13-13. Line Read Burst (2-1-1-1), Internal Termination
Figure 13-14 shows a line access read with one wait state programmed in CSCRn to give the peripheral or
memory more time to return read data. This figure follows the same execution as a zero-wait state read
burst with the exception of an added wait state.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
13-11
External Interface Module (EIM)
.
WS
S0 S1 S2 S3
S4 S5
WS
S6 S7
WS
S8 S9
WS
S10
S12
S13
S11
CLKOUT
A[31:0], SIZ[1:0]
R/W
TIP
TS
CSn, BSn, OE
Read
D[31:0]
Read
Read
Read
TA
Figure 13-14. Line Read Burst (3-2-2-2), External Termination
Figure 13-15 shows a burst-inhibited line read access with fast termination. The external device executes
a basic read cycle while determining that a line is being transferred. The external device uses fast
termination for subsequent transfers.
S0
S1
S2 S3 S4 S5 S0 S1 S4 S5
S0 S1 S4 S5
S0 S1 S4 S5
A[3:2] = 10
A[3:2] = 11
S6 S7
CLKOUT
A[31:0]
A[3:2] = 00
A[3:2] = 01
R/W
TIP
SIZ[1:0]
Line
Longword
TS
CSn, BSn, OE
D[31:0]
Read
Read
Read
Read
Fast
Fast
Fast
TA
Basic
Figure 13-15. Line Read Burst-Inhibited, Fast Termination, External Termination
13.4.7.3
Line Write Bus Cycles
Figure 13-16 shows a line access write with zero wait states. It begins like a basic write bus cycle with data
driven one clock after TS. The next pipelined burst data is driven a cycle after the write data is registered
(on the rising edge of S6). Each subsequent burst takes a single cycle. Note that as with the line read
example in Figure 13-12, CSn remain asserted throughout the burst transfer. This example shows the
behavior of the address lines for both internal and external termination. Note that when external
termination is used, the address lines change with SIZ[1:0].
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
13-12
Freescale Semiconductor
External Interface Module (EIM)
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
S8
S9
S10
S11
CLKOUT
A[31:0]
Internal Termination
A[31:0]
External Termination
SIZ[1:0]
R/W, TIP
TS
CSn, OE, BSn
Write
D[31:0]
Write
Write
Write
TA
Figure 13-16. Line Write Burst (2-1-1-1), Internal/External Termination
Figure 13-17 shows a line burst write with one wait-state insertion.
S0 S1 S2 S3
WS
S4 S5
WS
S6 S7
WS
S8 S9
WS
S10S11
CLKOUT
A[31:0]
R/W, TIP
SIZ[1:0]
TS
CSn, OE, BSn
D[31:0]
Write
Write
Write
Write
TA
Figure 13-17. Line Write Burst (3-2-2-2) with One Wait State
Figure 13-18 shows a burst-inhibited line write. The external device executes a basic write cycle while
determining that a line is being transferred. The external device uses fast termination to end each
subsequent transfer.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
13-13
External Interface Module (EIM)
S0
S1
S2 S3 S4 S5 S0 S1 S4 S5
S0 S1 S4 S5
S0 S1 S4 S5
A[3:2] = 10
A[3:2] = 11
CLKOUT
A[31:0]
A[3:2] = 00
A[3:2] = 01
R/W, TIP
SIZ[1:0]
Line
Longword
TS
CSn
OE, BSn
D[31:0]
Write
Write
Write
Write
TA
Basic
Fast
Fast
Fast
Figure 13-18. Line Write Burst-Inhibited
13.5
Misaligned Operands
Because operands can reside at any byte boundary, unlike opcodes, they are allowed to be misaligned. A
byte operand is properly aligned at any address, a word operand is misaligned at an odd address, and a
longword is misaligned at an address not a multiple of four. Although the processor enforces no alignment
restrictions for data operands (including program counter (PC) relative data addressing), additional bus
cycles are required for misaligned operands.
Instruction words and extension words (opcodes) must reside on word boundaries. Attempting to prefetch
a misaligned instruction word causes an address error exception.
The processor converts misaligned, cache-inhibited operand accesses to multiple aligned accesses.
Figure 13-19 shows the transfer of a longword operand from a byte address to a 32-bit port. In this
example, SIZ[1:0] specify a byte transfer and a byte offset of 0x1. The slave device supplies the byte and
acknowledges the data transfer. When the processor starts the second cycle, SIZ[1:0] specify a word
transfer with a byte offset of 0x2. The next two bytes are transferred in this cycle. In the third cycle, byte
3 is transferred. The byte offset is now 0x0, the port supplies the final byte, and the operation is complete.
31
24 23
16 15
87
A[2:0]
0
Transfer 1
—
Byte 0
—
—
001
Transfer 2
—
—
Byte 1
Byte 2
010
Transfer 3
Byte 3
—
—
—
100
Figure 13-19. Example of a Misaligned Longword Transfer (32-Bit Port)
If an operand is cacheable and is misaligned across a cache-line boundary, both lines are loaded into the
cache. The example in Figure 13-20 differs from that in Figure 13-19 in that the operand is word-sized and
the transfer takes only two bus cycles.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
13-14
Freescale Semiconductor
External Interface Module (EIM)
31
24 23
16 15
87
0
A[2:0]
Transfer 1
—
—
—
Byte 0
001
Transfer 2
Byte 1
—
—
—
100
Figure 13-20. Example of a Misaligned Word Transfer (32-Bit Port)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
13-15
External Interface Module (EIM)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
13-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14
Signal Descriptions
This chapter describes the processor’s external signals. It includes an alphabetical listing of signals that
characterizes each signal as an input or output, defines its state at reset, and identifies whether a pull-up
resistor should be used. Chapter 13, “External Interface Module (EIM),” describes how these signals
interact.
NOTE
The terms ‘assertion’ and ‘negation’ are used to avoid confusion when
dealing with a mixture of active-low and active-high signals. The term
‘asserted’ indicates that a signal is active, independent of the voltage level.
The term ‘negated’ indicates that a signal is inactive.
Active-low signals, such as SRAS and TA, are indicated with an overbar.
14.1
Overview
Figure 14-1 shows the block diagram with the signal interface.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-1
Signal Descriptions
RCON
Reset
Controller
RSTO
JTAG
Port
TDI/DSI
TRST/DSCLK
TEA
4
JTAG_EN
TEST
RSTI
TCLK
TMS/BKPT
PST[3:0]
CLKMOD1
TDO/DSO
Power
Management
Chip
Configuration
CLKMOD0
TA
TS
BS[3:0]
4
OE
SIZ[1:0]
2
External
Interface
Module
Test
Controller
Debug Module
Ports
Module
DDATA[3:0]
4
ColdFire V2 Core
R/W
Flash
Module
VDDF
TIP
64K
SRAM
32
Note:
Not present
on MCF5280
24
DIV
D[31:0]
VSTBY
EMAC
A[23:0]
2-Kbyte
D-Cache/I-Cache
Edgeport
IRQ[7:1]
Interrupt
Controller 0
Interrupt
Controller 1
SDRAM_CS[1:0]
2
DMA
Controller
Chip
Selects
Internal Bus
Arbiter
7
System
Control
Module (SCM)
CS[6:0]
DRAMW
SRAS
SCAS
DRAM
Controller
SCKE
UART0
Serial
I/O
CLKOUT
DMA
Timer
Modules
(DTIM0–
DTIM3)
ETXCLK
I2C
Module
Watchdog
Timer
4
XTAL
Clock Module
(PLL)
UART2
Serial
I/O
4
EXTAL
UART1
Serial
I/O
ERXCLK
ERXDV
ERXD0
ECRS
ETXD[3:1]
ETXER
SCL
SDA
DTOUT[3:0]
DTIN[3:0]
UTxD2
URxD2
URTS1
UCTS1
URTS0
UCTS0
UTxD1
URxD1
UTxD0
ECOL
URxD0
ETXEN
ETXDO
FEC
Note:
Not present
on MCF5214
and MCF5216
General
Purpose
Timer A
QADC
ERXD[3:1]
General
Purpose
Timer B
QSPI
FlexCAN
PIT
Timers
(PIT0–
PIT3)
CANRX
CANTX
QSPI_CLK
QSPI_CS[3:0]
QSPI_DIN
QSPI_DOUT
4
GPTB[3:0]
SYNCB
SYNCA
AN56/TRIG2
AN55/TRIG1
AN53/MA1
AN3/ANZ
AN52/MA0
AN2/ANY
AN1/ANX
VREFL
AN0/ANW
EMDC
VREFH
EMDIO
GPTA[3:0]
4
ERXER
Figure 14-1. MCF5282 Block Diagram with Signal Interfaces
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-1 lists the external signals grouped by functionality.
NOTE
The primary functionality of a pin is not necessarily its default functionality.
Pins that are muxed with GPIO will default to their GPIO functionality.
Table 14-1. MCF5282 Signal Description
Signal Name
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
Page
External Memory Interface
Address
A[23:0]
Define the address of external byte,
word, longword, and 16-byte burst
accesses.
I/O
14-19
Data
D[31:0]
Data bus. Provide the general purpose
data path between the MCU and all
other devices.
I/O
14-19
Byte strobes
BS[3:0]
Define the byte lane of data on the
data bus.
I/O
14-19
Output enable
OE
Indicates when an external device can
drive data on the bus.
O
14-19
Transfer acknowledge
TA
Indicates that the external data
transfer is complete and should be
asserted for one clock.
I
14-19
Transfer error
acknowledge
TEA
Indicates that an error condition exists
for the bus transfer.
I
14-20
Read/Write
R/W
Indicates the direction of the data
transfer on the bus.
I/O
14-20
Transfer size
SIZ[1:0]
Specify the data access size of the
current external bus reference.
O
14-20
Transfer start
TS
Asserted during the first CLKOUT
cycle of a transfer when address and
attributes are valid.
O
14-20
Transfer in progress
TIP
Asserted to indicate that a bus transfer
is in progress. Negated during idle bus
cycles.
O
14-21
Chip selects
CS[6:0]
Programmed for a base address
location and for masking addresses,
port size and burst capability
indication, wait state generation, and
internal/external termination.
O
14-21
SDRAM Controller Signals
SDRAM row
address strobe
SRAS
SDRAM synchronous row address
strobe.
O
14-21
SDRAM column
address strobe
SCAS
SDRAM synchronous column address
strobe.
O
14-21
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-3
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-1. MCF5282 Signal Description (continued)
Signal Name
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
Page
SDRAM write enable
DRAMW
Asserted to signify that a DRAM write
cycle is underway. Negated to indicate
a read cycle.
O
14-21
SDRAM bank selects
SDRAM_CS[1:0]
Interface to the chip-select lines of the
SDRAMs within a memory block.
O
14-21
SDRAM clock enable
SCKE
SDRAM clock enable.
O
14-22
Clock and Reset Signals
Reset in
RSTI
Asserted to enter reset exception
processing.
I
14-22
Reset out
RSTO
Automatically asserted with RSTI.
Negation indicates that the PLL has
regained its lock.
O
14-22
EXTAL
EXTAL
Driven by an external clock except
when used as a connection to the
external crystal.
I
14-22
XTAL
XTAL
Internal oscillator connection to the
external crystal.
O
14-22
Clock output
CLKOUT
Reflects the system clock.
O
14-22
Chip Configuration Module
Clock mode
CLKMOD[1:0]
Clock mode select
I
14-22
Reset configuration
RCON
Reset configuration select
I
14-22
I
14-23
Transfers control information between
the external PHY and the media
access controller.
I/O
14-23
Management data clock EMDC
Provides a timing reference to the PHY
for data transfers on the EMDIO signal.
O
14-23
Transmit clock
ETXCLK
Provides a timing reference for
ETXEN, ETXD[3:0], and ETXER.
I
14-23
Transmit enable
ETXEN
Indicates when valid nibbles are
present on the MII.
O
14-23
Transmit data 0
ETXD0
Serial output Ethernet data.
O
14-23
Collision
ECOL
Asserted to indicate a collision.
I
14-24
Receive clock
ERXCLK
Provides a timing reference for
ERXDV, ERXD[3:0], and ERXER.
I
14-24
External Interrupt Signals
External interrupts
IRQ[7:1]
External interrupt sources.
Ethernet Module Signals
(not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216)
Management data
EMDIO
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-1. MCF5282 Signal Description (continued)
Signal Name
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
Page
Receive data valid
ERXDV
Asserted to indicate that the PHY has
valid nibbles present on the MII.
I
14-24
Receive data 0
ERXD0
Ethernet input data transferred from
the PHY to the media access controller
(when ERXDV is asserted).
I
14-24
Carrier receive sense
ECRS
Asserted to indicate that the transmit
or receive medium is not idle.
I
14-24
Transmit data
ETXD[3:1]
Contain the serial output Ethernet
data.
O
14-24
Transmit error
ETXER
Asserted (for one or more E_TXCLKs
while ETXEN is also asserted) to
cause the PHY to send one or more
illegal symbols.
O
14-24
Receive data
ERXD[3:1]
Contain the Ethernet input data
transferred from the PHY to the media
access controller (when ERXDV is
asserted in MII mode).
I
14-24
Receive error
ERXER
Indicates (when asserted with
ERXDV) that the PHY has detected an
error in the current frame.
I
14-25
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI) Signals
QSPI synchronous
serial data output
QSPI_DOUT
Provides serial data from the QSPI.
O
14-25
QSPI synchronous
serial data input
QSPI_DIN
Provides serial data to the QSPI.
I
14-25
QSPI serial clock
QSPI_CLK
Provides the serial clock from the
QSPI.
O
14-25
QSPI chip selects
QSPI_CS[3:0]
Provide QSPI peripheral chip selects.
O
14-25
FlexCAN Signals
FlexCAN transmit
CANTX
Controller area network transmit data.
O
14-25
FlexCAN transmit
CANRX
Controller area network transmit data.
I
14-25
I/O
14-26
I/O
14-26
I2C Signals
Serial clock
Serial data
SCL
SDA
Clock signal for the I2C interface.
Data input/output for the
I2C
interface.
UART Signals
Transmit serial
data output
UTXD[2:0]
Transmitter serial data outputs.
O
14-26
Receive serial
data input
URXD[2:0]
Receiver serial data inputs.
I
14-26
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-5
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-1. MCF5282 Signal Description (continued)
Signal Name
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
Page
Clear-to-send
UCTS[1:0]
Signals UART that it can begin data
transmission.
I
14-26
Request to send
URTS[1:0]
Automatic UART request to send
outputs.
O
14-27
General Purpose Timer Signals
GPTA
GPTA[3:0]
Provide the external interface to the
timer A functions.
I/O
14-27
GPTB
GPTB[3:0]
Provide the external interface to the
timer B functions.
I/O
14-27
External clock input
SYNCA/SYNCB
Clear the timer’s clock, providing a
means of synchronization to externally
clocked or timed events.
I
14-27
DMA Timer Signals
DMA timer input
DTIN[3:0]
Clock the event counter or provide a
trigger to timer value capture logic.
I/O
14-27
DMA timer output
DTOUT[3:0]
Pulse or toggle on timer events.
I/O
14-27
I
14-28
I/O
14-29
I
14-29
Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC) Signals
QADC analog input
AN[0:3]/AN[W:Z]
Direct analog input ANn, or
multiplexed input ANx.
QADC analog input
AN[52:53]/MA[0:1] Direct analog input ANn, or
multiplexed output MAn. MAn selects
the output of the external multiplexer.
QADC analog input
AN[55:56]/
TRIG[1:2]
Direct analog input ANn, or input
TRIGn. TRIGn causes one of the two
queues to execute.
Debug Support Signals
JTAG_EN
JTAG_EN
Selects between multiplexed debug
module and JTAG signals at reset.
I
14-29
Development serial
clock/Test reset
DSCLK/TRST
Development serial clock for the serial
interface to debug module (DSCLK).
Asynchronously resets the internal
JTAG controller to the test logic reset
state (TRST).
I
14-30
Breakpoint/
Test mode select
BKPT/TMS
Signals a hardware breakpoint in
debug mode (BKPT). Provides
information that determines JTAG test
operation mode (TMS).
I
14-30
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-1. MCF5282 Signal Description (continued)
Signal Name
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
Page
Development serial
input/Test data
DSI/TDI
Provides single-bit communication for
debug module commands (DSI).
Provides serial data port for loading
JTAG boundary scan, bypass, and
instruction registers (TDI).
I
14-30
Development serial
output/Test data
DSO/TDO
Provides single-bit communication for
debug module responses (DSO).
Provides serial data port for outputting
JTAG logic data (TDO).
O
14-30
Test clock
TCLK
JTAG test logic clock.
I
14-30
Debug data
DDATA[3:0]
Display captured processor
addresses, data, and breakpoint
status.
O
14-31
Processor status
outputs
PST[3:0]
Indicate core status.
O
14-31
I
14-31
Test Signals
Test
TEST
Reserved, should be connected to
VSS.
Power and Reference Signals
QADC analog reference VRH, VRL
High (VRH) and low (VRL) reference
potentials for the analog converter.
Ground
14-32
QADC analog supply
VDDA, VSSA
Isolate the QADC analog circuitry from
digital power supply noise.
I
14-32
PLL analog supply
VDDPLL, VSSPLL Isolate the PLL analog circuitry from
digital power supply noise.
I
14-32
QADC positive supply
VDDH
Supplies positive power to the ESD
structures in the QADC pads.
I
14-32
Flash erase/program
power
VPP
Used for Flash stress testing.
I
14-32
Flash array power
and ground
VDDF, VSSF
Supply power and ground to Flash
array.
I
14-32
Standby power
VSTBY
Provides standby voltage to RAM array
if VDD is lost.
I
14-32
Positive supply
VDD
Supplies positive power to the core
logic and I/O pads.
I
14-32
Ground
VSS
Negative supply.
14-32
Table 14-2 lists signals in alphabetical order by abbreviated name.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-7
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-2. MCF5282 Alphabetical Signal Index
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
A[23:0]
Define the address of external byte, word, longword, and
16-byte burst accesses.
I/O
AN[0:3]/AN[W:Z]
Direct analog input ANn, or multiplexed input ANx.
AN[52:53]/MA[0:1]
Direct analog input ANn, or multiplexed output MAn. MAn
selects the output of the external multiplexer.
AN[55:56]/
TRIG[1:2]
Direct analog input ANn, or input TRIGn. TRIGn causes one of
the two queues to execute.
I
Breakpoint/
Test mode select
Signals a hardware breakpoint in debug mode (BKPT). Provides
information that determines JTAG test operation mode (TMS).
I
BS[3:0]
Define the byte lane of data on the data bus.
CANRX
Controller area network transmit data.
I
CANTX
Controller area network transmit data.
O
CLKMOD[1:0]
Clock mode select
I
CLKOUT
Reflects the system clock.
O
CS[6:0]
Programmed for a base address location and for masking
addresses, port size and burst capability indication, wait state
generation, and internal/external termination.
O
D[31:0]
Data bus. Provide the general purpose data path between the
MCU and all other devices.
I/O
DDATA[3:0]
Display captured processor addresses, data, and breakpoint
status.
O
DSO/TDO
Provides single-bit communication for debug module responses
(DSO). Provides serial data port for outputting JTAG logic data
(TDO).
O
DSI/TDI
Development serial clock for the serial interface to debug
module (DSCLK). Asynchronously resets the internal JTAG
controller to the test logic reset state (TRST).
I
DSCLK/TRST
Provides single-bit communication for debug module commands
(DSI). Provides serial data port for loading JTAG boundary scan,
bypass, and instruction registers (TDI).
I
DRAMW
Asserted to signify that a DRAM write cycle is underway.
Negated to indicate a read cycle.
O
DTIN[3:0]
Clock the event counter or provide a trigger to timer value
capture logic.
I/O
DTOUT[3:0]
Pulse or toggle on timer events.
I/O
ECOL
Asserted to indicate a collision.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I
ECRS
Asserted to indicate that the transmit or receive medium is not
idle.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I
I
I/O
I/O
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-2. MCF5282 Alphabetical Signal Index (continued)
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
EMDC
Provides a timing reference to the PHY for data transfers on the
EMDIO signal.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
O
EMDIO
Transfers control information between the external PHY and the
media access controller.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I/O
ERXCLK
Provides a timing reference for ERXDV, ERXD[3:0], and
ERXER.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I
ERXD[3:1]
Contain the Ethernet input data transferred from the PHY to the
media access controller (when ERXDV is asserted in MII mode).
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I
ERXD0
Ethernet input data transferred from the PHY to the media
access controller (when ERXDV is asserted).
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I
ERXDV
Asserted to indicate that the PHY has valid nibbles present on
the MII.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I
ERXER
Indicates (when asserted with ERXDV) that the PHY has
detected an error in the current frame.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I
ETXCLK
Provides a timing reference for ETXEN, ETXD[3:0], and ETXER.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
I
ETXD[3:1]
Contain the serial output Ethernet data.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
O
ETXD0
Serial output Ethernet data.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
O
ETXEN
Indicates when valid nibbles are present on the MII.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
O
ETXER
Asserted (for one or more E_TXCLKs while ETXEN is also
asserted) to cause the PHY to send one or more illegal symbols.
Note: Not available on MCF5214 and MCF5216
O
EXTAL
Driven by an external clock except when used as a connection
to the external crystal.
I
VDDF, VSSF
Supply power and ground to Flash array.
I
VPP
Used for Flash stress testing.
I
GPTA[3:0]
Provide the external interface to the timer A functions.
I/O
GPTB[3:0]
Provide the external interface to the timer B functions.
I/O
Ground
Negative supply.
IRQ[7:1]
External interrupt sources.
I
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-9
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-2. MCF5282 Alphabetical Signal Index (continued)
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
JTAG_EN
Selects between multiplexed debug module and JTAG signals at
reset.
I
OE
Indicates when an external device can drive data on the bus.
O
VDDPLL
Isolate the PLL analog circuitry from digital power supply noise.
I
VDD
Supplies positive power to the core logic and I/O pads.
I
PST[3:0]
Indicate core status.
O
VRH, VRL
High (VRH) and low (VRL) reference potentials for the analog
converter.
I
VDDA, VSSA
Isolate the QADC analog circuitry from digital power supply
noise.
I
QADC analog supply
Supplies positive power to the ESD structures in the QADC
pads.
I
QSPI_CLK
Provides the serial clock from the QSPI.
O
QSPI_CS[3:0]
Provide QSPI peripheral chip selects.
O
QSPI_DIN
Provides serial data to the QSPI.
I
QSPI_DOUT
Provides serial data from the QSPI.
O
R/W
Indicates the direction of the data transfer on the bus.
I/O
RCON
Reset configuration select.
I
RSTI
Asserted to enter reset exception processing.
I
RSTO
Automatically asserted with RSTI. Negation indicates that the
PLL has regained its lock.
O
SCAS
SDRAM synchronous column address strobe.
O
SCKE
SDRAM clock enable.
O
I2C
SCL
Clock signal for the
interface.
I/O
SDA
Data input/output for the I2C interface.
I/O
SDRAM_CS[1:0]
Interface to the chip-select lines of the SDRAMs within a
memory block.
O
SIZ[1:0]
Specify the data access size of the current external bus
reference.
O
SRAS
SDRAM synchronous row address strobe.
O
VSTBY
Provides standby voltage to RAM array if VDD is lost.
I
SYNCA/SYNCB
Clear the timer’s clock, providing a means of synchronization to
externally clocked or timed events.
I
TA
Indicates that the external data transfer is complete and should
be asserted for one CLKOUT cycle.
I
TEA
Indicates that an error condition exists for the bus transfer.
I
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-2. MCF5282 Alphabetical Signal Index (continued)
Abbreviation
Function
I/O
TEST
Reserved, should be connected to VSS.
I
TCK
JTAG test logic clock.
I
TIP
Asserted to indicate that a bus transfer is in progress. Negated
during idle bus cycles.
O
TS
Asserted during the first CLKOUT cycle of a transfer when
address and attributes are valid.
O
UCTS[1:0]
Signals UART that it can begin data transmission.
I
URTS[1:0]
Automatic UART request to send outputs.
O
URXD[2:0]
Receiver serial data inputs.
I
UTXD[2:0]
Transmitter serial data outputs.
O
XTAL
Internal oscillator connection to the external crystal.
O
Table 14-3. MCF5282 Signals and Pin Numbers Sorted by Function
Pin Functions
MAPBGA Pin
Description
Primary2
Secondary
Tertiary
Primary
I/O
Internal
Pull-up1
Reset
R11
RSTI
—
—
Reset in
I
Yes
P11
RSTO
—
—
Reset out
O
—
Clock
T8
EXTAL
—
—
External clock/crystal in
I
—
R8
XTAL
—
—
Crystal drive
O
—
N7
CLKOUT
—
—
Clock out
O
—
Chip Configuration/Mode Selection
R14
CLKMOD0
—
—
Clock mode select
I
Yes
T14
CLKMOD1
—
—
Clock mode select
I
Yes
T11
RCON
—
—
Reset configuration enable
I
Yes
H1
D26
PA2
—
Chip mode
I/O
—
K2
D17
PB1
—
Chip mode
I/O
—
K3
D16
PB0
—
Chip mode
I/O
—
J4
D19
PB3
—
Boot device/data port size
I/O
—
K1
D18
PB2
—
Boot device/data port size
I/O
—
J2
D21
PB5
—
Output pad drive strength
I/O
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-11
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-3. MCF5282 Signals and Pin Numbers Sorted by Function (continued)
Pin Functions
MAPBGA Pin
Description
Primary
2
Secondary
Tertiary
Primary
I/O
Internal
Pull-up1
External Memory Interface and Ports
C6:B6:A5
A[23:21]
PF[7:5]
CS[6:4]
Address bus
O
Yes
C4:B4:A4:B3:A3
A[20:16]
PF[4:0]
—
Address bus
O
Yes
A2:B1:B2:C1:
C2:C3:D1:D2
A[15:8]
PG[7:0]
—
Address bus
O
Yes
D3:D4:E1:E2:
E3:E4:F1:F2
A[7:0]
PH[7:0]
—
Address bus
O
Yes
F3:G1:G2:G3:
G4:H1:H2:H3
D[31:24]
PA[7:0]
—
Data bus
I/O
—
H4:J1:J2:J3:
J4:K1:K2:K3
D[23:16]
PB[7:0]
—
Data bus
I/O
—
L1:L2:L3:L4:
M1:M2:M3:M4
D[15:8]
PC[7:0]
—
Data bus
I/O
—
N1:N2:N3:P1:
N5:T6:R6:P6
D[7:0]
PD[7:0]
—
Data bus
I/O
—
P14:T15:R15:R16
BS[3:0]
PJ[7:4]
—
Byte strobe
I/O
Yes
N16
OE
PE7
—
Output enable
I/O
—
P16
TA
PE6
—
Transfer acknowledge
I/O
Yes
P15
TEA
PE5
—
Transfer error acknowledge
I/O
Yes
N15
R/W
PE4
—
Read/write
I/O
Yes
N14
SIZ1
PE3
SYNCA
Transfer size
I/O
Yes3
M16
SIZ0
PE2
SYNCB
Transfer size
I/O
Yes4
M15
TS
PE1
SYNCA
Transfer start
I/O
Yes
M14
TIP
PE0
SYNCB
Transfer in progress
I/O
Yes
Chip Selects
L16:L15:L14:L13
CS[3:0]
PJ[3:0]
—
Chip selects 3-0
I/O
Yes
C6:B6:A5
A[23:21]
PF[7:5]
CS[6:4]
Chip selects 6-4
O
Yes
SDRAM Controller
H15
SRAS
PSD5
—
SDRAM row address strobe
I/O
—
H16
SCAS
PSD4
—
SDRAM column address strobe
I/O
—
G15
DRAMW
PSD3
—
SDRAM write enable
I/O
—
H13:G16
SDRAM_CS[1:0]
PSD[2:1]
—
SDRAM chip selects
I/O
—
H14
SCKE
PSD0
—
SDRAM clock enable
I/O
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-3. MCF5282 Signals and Pin Numbers Sorted by Function (continued)
Pin Functions
MAPBGA Pin
Description
Primary
2
Secondary
Tertiary
Primary
I/O
Internal
Pull-up1
I/O
—
External Interrupts Port
B15:B16:C14:C15:
C16: D14:D15
IRQ[7:1]
PNQ[7:1]
—
External interrupt request
Ethernet
For MCF5280, MCF5281 and MCF5282 only
C10
EMDIO
PAS5
URXD2
Management channel
serial data
I/O
—
B10
EMDC
PAS4
UTXD2
Management channel clock
I/O
—
A8
ETXCLK
PEH7
—
MAC Transmit clock
I/O
—
D6
ETXEN
PEH6
—
MAC Transmit enable
I/O
—
D7
ETXD0
PEH5
—
MAC Transmit data
I/O
—
B11
ECOL
PEH4
—
MAC Collision
I/O
—
A10
ERXCLK
PEH3
—
MAC Receive clock
I/O
—
C8
ERXDV
PEH2
—
MAC Receive enable
I/O
—
D9
ERXD0
PEH1
—
MAC Receive data
I/O
—
A11
ECRS
PEH0
—
MAC Carrier sense
I/O
—
A7:B7:C7
ETXD[3:1]
PEL[7:5]
—
MAC Transmit data
I/O
—
D10
ETXER
PEL4
—
MAC Transmit error
I/O
—
A9:B9:C9
ERXD[3:1]
PEL[3:1]
—
MAC Receive data
I/O
—
B8
ERXER
PEL0
—
MAC Receive error
I/O
—
GPIO
For MCF5214 and MCF5216 only
C10
PAS5
URXD2
—
GPIO/serial data
I/O
—
B10
NC
—
—
No connect
—
—
A8
PEL0
—
—
GPIO
I/O
—
D6
NC
—
—
No connect
—
—
D7
NC
—
—
No connect
—
—
B11
NC
—
—
No connect
—
—
A10
PAS4
UTXD2
—
GPIO/serial data
I/O
—
C8
NC
—
—
No connect
—
—
D9
NC
—
—
No connect
—
—
A11
NC
—
—
No connect
—
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-13
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-3. MCF5282 Signals and Pin Numbers Sorted by Function (continued)
Pin Functions
MAPBGA Pin
Description
Primary
2
Secondary
Tertiary
Primary
I/O
Internal
Pull-up1
A7:B7:C7
PEL[7:5]
—
—
GPIO
I/O
—
D10
PEL4
—
—
GPIO
I/O
—
A9:B9:C9
PEL[3:1]
—
—
GPIO
I/O
—
B8
NC
—
—
No connect
—
—
FlexCAN
D16
CANRX
PAS3
URXD2
FlexCAN Receive data
I/O
—
E13
CANTX
PAS2
UTXD2
FlexCAN Transmit data
I/O
—
I2C
E14
SDA
PAS1
URXD2
I2C Serial data
I/O
Yes5
E15
SCL
PAS0
UTXD2
I2C Serial clock
I/O
Yes6
QSPI
F13
QSPI_DOUT
PQS0
—
QSPI data out
I/O
—
E16
QSPI_DIN
PQS1
—
QSPI data in
I/O
—
F14
QSPI_CLK
PQS2
—
QSPI clock
I/O
—
G14:G13:F16:F15
QSPI_CS[3:0]
PQS[6:3]
—
QSPI chip select
I/O
—
UARTs
R7
URXD1
PUA3
—
U1 receive data
I/O
—
P7
UTXD1
PUA2
—
U1 transmit data
I/O
—
N6
URXD0
PUA1
—
U0 receive data
I/O
—
T7
UTXD0
PUA0
—
U0 transmit data
I/O
—
D16
CANRX
PAS3
URXD2
U2 receive data
I/O
—
E13
CANTX
PAS2
UTXD2
U2 transmit data
I/O
—
E14
SDA
PAS1
URXD2
U2 receive data
I/O
Yes5
E15
SCL
PAS0
UTXD2
U2 transmit data
I/O
Yes6
K16
DTIN3
PTC3
URTS1/
URTS0
U1/U0 Request to Send
I/O
—
K15
DTOUT3
PTC2
URTS1/
URTS0
U1/U0 Request to Send
I/O
—
K14
DTIN2
PTC1
UCTS1/
UCTS0
U1/U0 Clear to Send
I/O
—
K13
DTOUT2
PTC0
UCTS1/
UCTS0
U1/U0 Clear to Send
I/O
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-3. MCF5282 Signals and Pin Numbers Sorted by Function (continued)
Pin Functions
MAPBGA Pin
Description
Primary
2
Secondary
Tertiary
Primary
I/O
Internal
Pull-up1
J16
DTIN1
PTD3
URTS1/
URTS0
U1/U0 Request to Send
I/O
—
J15
DTOUT1
PTD2
URTS1/
URTS0
U1/U0 Request to Send
I/O
—
J14
DTIN0
PTD1
UCTS1/
UCTS0
U1/U0 Clear to Send
I/O
—
J13
DTOUT0
PTD0
UCTS1/
UCTS0
U1/U0 Clear to Send
I/O
—
Note: The below two pins are for the MCF5280, MCF5281, and MCF5282 only.
C10
EMDIO
PAS5
URXD2
U2 receive data
I/O
—
B10
EMDC
PAS4
UTXD2
U2 transmit data
I/O
—
Note: The below two pins are for the MCF5214 and MCF5216 only.
C10
PAS5
URXD2
—
U2 receive data
I/O
—
B10
NC
—
—
No connect
I/O
—
General Purpose Timers
T13:R13:P13:N13
GPTA[3:0]
PTA[3:0]
—
Timer A IC/OC/PAI
I/O
Yes
T12:R12:P12:N12
GPTB[3:0]
PTB[3:0]
—
Timer B IC/OC/PAI
I/O
Yes
N14
SIZ1
PE3
SYNCA
Timer A synchronization input
I/O
Yes3
M16
SIZ0
PE2
SYNCB
Timer B synchronization input
I/O
Yes4
M15
TS
PE1
SYNCA
Timer A synchronization input
I/O
Yes
M14
TIP
PE0
SYNCB
Timer B synchronization input
I/O
Yes
DMA Timers
K16
DTIN3
PTC3
URTS1/
URTS0
Timer 3 in
I/O
—
K15
DTOUT3
PTC2
URTS1/
URTS0
Timer 3 out
I/O
—
K14
DTIN2
PTC1
UCTS1/
UCTS0
Timer 2 in
I/O
—
K13
DTOUT2
PTC0
UCTS1/
UCTS0
Timer 2 out
I/O
—
J16
DTIN1
PTD3
URTS1/
URTS0
Timer 1 in
I/O
—
J15
DTOUT1
PTD2
URTS1/
URTS0
Timer 1 out
I/O
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-15
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-3. MCF5282 Signals and Pin Numbers Sorted by Function (continued)
Pin Functions
MAPBGA Pin
Description
Primary
2
Secondary
Tertiary
Primary
I/O
Internal
Pull-up1
J14
DTIN0
PTD1
UCTS1/
UCTS0
Timer 0 in
I/O
—
J13
DTOUT0
PTD0
UCTS1/
UCTS0
Timer 0 out
I/O
—
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
T3
AN0
PQB0
ANW
Analog channel 0
I/O
—
R2
AN1
PQB1
ANX
Analog channel 1
I/O
—
T2
AN2
PQB2
ANY
Analog channel 2
I/O
—
R1
AN3
PQB3
ANZ
Analog channel 3
I/O
—
R4
AN52
PQA0
MA0
Analog channel 52
I/O
—
T4
AN53
PQA1
MA1
Analog channel 53
I/O
—
P3
AN55
PQA3
ETRIG1
Analog channel 55
I/O
—
R3
AN56
PQA4
ETRIG2
Analog channel 56
I/O
—
P4
VRH
—
—
High analog reference
I
—
T5
VRL
—
—
Low analog reference
I
—
Debug and JTAG Test Port Control
R9
JTAG_EN
—
—
JTAG Enable
I
—
P9
DSCLK
TRST
—
Debug clock / TAP reset
I
Yes7
T9
TCLK
—
—
TAP clock
I
Yes7
P10
BKPT
TMS
—
Breakpoint/TAP test mode select
I
Yes7
R10
DSI
TDI
—
Debug data in / TAP data in
I
Yes7
T10
DSO
TDO
—
Debug data out / TAP data out
O
—
C12:D12:A13:B13
DDATA[3:0]
PDD[7:4]
—
Debug data
I/O
—
C13:A14:B14:A15
PST[3:0]
PDD[3:0]
—
Processor status data
I/O
—
I
—
Test
N10
TEST
—
Test mode pin
Power Supplies
R5
VDDA
—
—
Analog positive supply
I
—
P5:T1
VSSA
—
—
Analog ground
I
—
P2
VDDH
—
—
ESD positive supply
I
—
N8
VDDPLL
—
—
PLL positive supply
I
—
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-3. MCF5282 Signals and Pin Numbers Sorted by Function (continued)
Pin Functions
MAPBGA Pin
Description
Primary
2
Secondary
Tertiary
Primary
I/O
Internal
Pull-up1
P8
VSSPLL
—
—
PLL ground
I
—
A6:C11
VPP
—
—
Flash (stress) programming
voltage
I
—
A12:C5:D5:D11
VDDF
—
—
Flash positive supply
I
—
B5:B12:
VSSF
—
—
Flash module ground
I
—
N11
VSTBY
—
—
Standby power
I
—
E6-E11:F5:F7-F10:
F12:G5:G6:G11:
G12:H5:H6:H11:
H12:J5:J6:J11:J12:
K5:K6:K11:K12:L5:
L7-L10:L12:
M6-M11
VDD
—
—
Positive supply
I
—
A1:A16:E5:E12:F6:
F11:G7-G10:H7-H10
:J7-J10:K7-K10:L6:
L11:M5:M12:T16
VSS
—
—
Ground
I
—
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Pull-ups are not active when GPIO functions are selected for the pins.
The primary functionality of a pin is not necessarily its default functionality. Pins that have GPIO functionality will default to
GPIO inputs.
Pull-up is active only with the SYNCA function.
Pull-up is active only with the SYNCB function.
Pull-up is active only with the SDA function.
Pull-up is active only with SCL function.
Pull-up is active when JTAG_EN is driven high.
14.1.1
Single-Chip Mode
In single-chip mode, signals default to GPIO inputs after a system reset. Table 14-4 is a listing of signals
that do not default to a GPIO function.
Table 14-4. Pin Reset States at Reset (Single-Chip Mode)
Signal
Reset
I/O
Clock and Reset Signals
RSTI
—
I
RSTO
Low
O
EXTAL
—
I
XTAL
XTAL
O
CLKOUT
CLKOUT
O
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-17
Signal Descriptions
Table 14-4. Pin Reset States at Reset (Single-Chip Mode) (continued)
Signal
Reset
I/O
Debug Support Signals
14.1.2
JTAG_EN
—
I
DSCLK/TRST
—
I
BKPT/TMS
—
I
DSI/TDI
—
I
DSO/TDO
High
O
TCLK
—
I
DDATA[3:0]
DDATA{3:0]
O
PST[3:0]
PST[3:0]
O
External Boot Mode
When booting from external memory, the address bus, data bus, and bus control signals will default to their
bus functionalities as shown in Table 14-5. As in single-chip mode, the signals listed in Table 14-4 will
operate as described above. All other signals will default to GPIO inputs.
Table 14-5. Default Signal Functions After System Reset (External Boot Mode)
Signal
14.2
Reset
I/O
A[23:0]
A[23:0]
O
D[31:0]
—
I/O
BS[3:0]
High
O
OE
High
O
TA
—
I
TEA
—
I
R/W
High
O
SIZ[1:0]
High
O
TS
High
O
TIP
High
O
CS[6:0]
High
O
External Signals
The following sections describe the external signals on the device.
14.2.1
External Interface Module (EIM) Signals
These signals are used for doing transactions on the external bus.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-18
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
14.2.1.1
Address Bus (A[23:0])
The 24 dedicated address signals, A[23:0], define the address of external byte, word, longword and
16-byte burst accesses. These three-state outputs are the 24 lsbs of the internal 32-bit address bus. The
address lines also serve as the SDRAM addressing, providing multiplexed row and column address
signals.
These pins are configured for GPIO ports F, G and H in single-chip mode. The A[23:21] pins can also be
configured for CS[6:4].
14.2.1.2
Data Bus (D[31:0])
These three-state bidirectional signals provide the general purpose data path between the MCU and all
other devices. Data is sampled by the processor on the rising CLKOUT edge. The data bus port width and
wait states are initially defined for the external boot chip select, CS0, by D[19:18] during chip
configuration at reset. The port width for each chip select and SDRAM bank is programmable. The data
bus uses a default configuration if none of the chip selects or SDRAM bank match the address decode. The
default configuration is a 32-bit port with external termination and burst-inhibited transfers. The data bus
can transfer byte, word, or longword data widths. All 32 data bus signals are driven during writes,
regardless of port width and operand size.
D[26:24, 21, 19:16] are used during chip configuration as inputs to configure the functions as described in
Chapter 27, “Chip Configuration Module (CCM).”
These pins are configured as GPIO ports A, B, C and D in single-chip mode.
14.2.1.3
Byte Strobes (BS[3:0])
The byte strobes (BS[3:0]) define the byte lane of data on the data bus. During accesses, these outputs act
as the byte select signals that indicate valid data is to be latched or driven onto a byte lane when driven
low. For SRAM or Flash devices, the BS[3:0] outputs should be connected to individual byte strobe
signals. For SDRAM devices, the BS[3:0] should be connected to individual SDRAM DQM signals. Note
that most SDRAMs associate DQM3 with the MSB, in which case BS3 is connected to the SDRAM's
DQM3 input.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PJ[7:4].
14.2.1.4
Output Enable (OE)
This output signal indicates when an external device can drive data during external read cycles.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PE7.
14.2.1.5
Transfer Acknowledge (TA)
This signal indicates that the external data transfer is complete. During a read cycle, when the processor
recognizes TA, it latches the data and then terminates the bus cycle. During a write cycle, when the
processor recognizes TA, the bus cycle is terminated. If all bus cycles support fast termination, TA can be
tied low.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PE6.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-19
Signal Descriptions
14.2.1.6
Transfer Error Acknowledge (TEA)
This signal indicates an error condition exists for the bus transfer. The bus cycle is terminated and the CPU
begins execution of the access error exception. This signal is an input in master mode.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PE5.
14.2.1.7
Read/Write (R/W)
This output signal indicates the direction of the data transfer on the bus. A logic 1 indicates a read from a
slave device and a logic 0 indicates a write to a slave device.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PE4.
14.2.1.8
Transfer Size(SIZ[1:0])
When the device is in normal mode, static bus sizing lets the programmer change data bus width between
8, 16, and 32 bits for each chip select. The SIZ[1:0] outputs specify the data access size of the current
external bus reference as shown in Table 14-6.
Table 14-6. Transfer Size Encoding
SIZ[1:0]
Transfer Size
00
Longword
01
Byte
10
Word
11
16-byte line
Note that for misaligned transfers, SIZ[1:0] indicate the size of each transfer. For example, if a longword
access occurs at a misaligned offset of 0x1, a byte is transferred first (SIZ[1:0] = 01), a word is next
transferred at offset 0x2 (SIZ[1:0] = 10), then the final byte is transferred at offset 0x4 (SIZ[1:0] = 01).
For aligned transfers larger than the port size, SIZ[1:0] behaves as follows:
• If bursting is used, SIZ[1:0] stays at the size of transfer.
• If bursting is inhibited, SIZ[1:0] first shows the size of the transfer and then shows the port size.
For burst-inhibited transfers, SIZ[1:0] changes with each TS assertion to reflect the next transfer size. For
transfers to port sizes smaller than the transfer size, SIZ[1:0] indicates the size of the entire transfer on the
first access and the size of the current port transfer on subsequent transfers. For example, for a longword
write to an 8-bit port, SIZ[1:0] = 00 for the first byte transfer and 01 for the next three.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PE[3:2] or SYNCA, SYNCB.
14.2.1.9
Transfer Start (TS)
The device asserts TS during the first CLKOUT cycle of a transfer when address and attributes (TIP, R/W,
and SIZ[1:0]) are valid. TS is negated in the following CLKOUT cycle.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PE1 or SYNCA.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-20
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
14.2.1.10 Transfer In Progress (TIP)
The TIP output is asserted indicating a bus transfer is in progress. It is negated during idle bus cycles. Note
that TIP is held asserted on back-to-back cycles.
NOTE
TIP is not asserted during SDRAM accesses.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PE0 or SYNCB.
14.2.1.11 Chip Selects (CS[6:0])
Each chip select can be programmed for a base address location and for masking addresses, port size and
burst-capability indication, wait-state generation, and internal/external termination.
Reset clears all chip select programming; CS0 is the only chip select initialized out of reset. CS0 is also
unique because it can function at reset as a global chip select that allows boot ROM to be selected at any
defined address space. The port size for boot CS0 is set during chip configuration by the levels on D[19:18]
on the rising edge of RSTI, as described in Chapter 27, “Chip Configuration Module (CCM).” The
chip-select implementation is described in Chapter 12, “Chip Select Module.”
These pins can also be configured as A[23:21] and GPIO PJ[3:0].
14.2.2
SDRAM Controller Signals
These signals are used for SDRAM accesses.
14.2.2.1
SDRAM Row Address Strobe (SRAS)
This output is the SDRAM synchronous row address strobe.
This pin is configured as GPIO PSD5 in single-chip mode.
14.2.2.2
SDRAM Column Address Strobe (SCAS)
This output is the SDRAM synchronous column address strobe.
This pin is configured as GPIO PSD4 in single-chip mode.
14.2.2.3
SDRAM Write Enable (DRAMW)
The DRAM write signal (DRAMW) is asserted to signify that a DRAM write cycle is underway. A read
cycle is indicated by the negation of DRAMW.
This pin is configured as GPIO PSD3 in single-chip mode.
14.2.2.4
SDRAM Bank Selects (SDRAM_CS[1:0])
These signals interface to the chip-select lines of the SDRAMs within a memory block. Thus, there is one
SDRAM_CS line for each memory block (the processor supports two SDRAM memory blocks).
These pins is configured as GPIO PSD[2:1] in single-chip mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-21
Signal Descriptions
14.2.2.5
SDRAM Clock Enable (SCKE)
This output is the SDRAM clock enable.
This pin is configured as GPIO PSD0 in single-chip mode.
14.2.3
Clock and Reset Signals
The clock and reset signals configure the device and provide interface signals to the external system.
14.2.3.1
Reset In (RSTI)
Asserting RSTI causes the device to enter reset exception processing. When RSTI is recognized the
address bus, data bus, SIZ, R/W, AS, and TS are three-stated. RSTO is asserted automatically when RSTI
is asserted.
14.2.3.2
Reset Out (RSTO)
After RSTI is asserted, the PLL temporarily loses its lock, during which time RSTO is asserted. When the
PLL regains its lock, RSTO negates again. This signal can be used to reset external devices.
14.2.3.3
EXTAL
This input is driven by an external clock except when used as a connection to the external crystal when
using the internal oscillator.
14.2.3.4
XTAL
This output is an internal oscillator connection to the external crystal.
14.2.3.5
Clock Output (CLKOUT)
The internal PLL generates CLKOUT. This output reflects the internal system clock.
14.2.4
14.2.4.1
Chip Configuration Signals
RCON
If the external RCON signal is asserted, then various chip functions, including the reset configuration pin
functions after reset, are configured according to the levels driven onto the external data pins (see
Section 27.6, “Functional Description”). The internal configuration signals are driven to reflect the levels
on the external configuration pins to allow for module configuration.
14.2.4.2
CLKMOD[1:0]
The state of the CLKMOD[1:0] pins during reset determines the clock mode after reset.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-22
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
14.2.5
14.2.5.1
External Interrupt Signals
External Interrupts (IRQ[7:1])
These inputs are the external interrupt sources. See Chapter 11, “Edge Port Module (EPORT)” for more
information on these interrupt sources and their corresponding registers.
These pins are configured as GPIO PNQ[7:1] in single-chip mode.
14.2.6
Ethernet Module Signals
The following signals are used by the Ethernet module for data and clock signals.
NOTE
These signals are not available on the MCF5214 and MCF5216.
14.2.6.1
Management Data (EMDIO)
The bidirectional EMDIO signal transfers control information between the external PHY and the
media-access controller. Data is synchronous to EMDC and applies to MII mode operation. This signal is
an input after reset. When the FEC is operated in 10 Mbps 7-wire interface mode, this signal should be
connected to VSS.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PAS5 or URXD2.
14.2.6.2
Management Data Clock (EMDC)
EMDC is an output clock which provides a timing reference to the PHY for data transfers on the EMDIO
signal and applies to MII mode operation.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PAS4 or UTXD2.
14.2.6.3
Transmit Clock (ETXCLK)
This is an input clock which provides a timing reference for ETXEN, ETXD[3:0] and ETXER.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PEH7.
14.2.6.4
Transmit Enable (ETXEN)
The transmit enable (ETXEN) output indicates when valid nibbles are present on the MII. This signal is
asserted with the first nibble of a preamble and is negated before the first ETXCLK following the final
nibble of the frame.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PEH6.
14.2.6.5
Transmit Data 0 (ETXD0)
ETXD0 is the serial output Ethernet data and is only valid during the assertion of ETXEN. This signal is
used for 10 Mbps Ethernet data. This signal is also used for MII mode data in conjunction with ETXD[3:1].
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PEH5.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-23
Signal Descriptions
14.2.6.6
Collision (ECOL)
The ECOL input is asserted upon detection of a collision and remains asserted while the collision persists.
This signal is not defined for full-duplex mode.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PEH4.
14.2.6.7
Receive Clock (ERXCLK)
The receive clock (ERXCLK) input provides a timing reference for ERXDV, ERXD[3:0], and ERXER.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PEH3.
14.2.6.8
Receive Data Valid (ERXDV)
Asserting the receive data valid (ERXDV) input indicates that the PHY has valid nibbles present on the
MII. ERXDV should remain asserted from the first recovered nibble of the frame through to the last
nibble. Assertion of ERXDV must start no later than the SFD and exclude any EOF.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PEH2.
14.2.6.9
Receive Data 0 (ERXD0)
ERXD0 is the Ethernet input data transferred from the PHY to the media-access controller when ErXDV
is asserted. This signal is used for 10 Mbps Ethernet data. This signal is also used for MII mode Ethernet
data in conjunction with ERXD[3:1]. This pin can also be configured as GPIO PEH1.
14.2.6.10 Carrier Receive Sense (ECRS)
ECRS is an input signal which, when asserted, signals that transmit or receive medium is not idle, and
applies to MII mode operation.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PEH0.
14.2.6.11 Transmit Data 1–3 (ETXD[3:1])
These pins contain the serial output Ethernet data and are valid only during assertion of ETXEN in MII
mode.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PEL[7:5].
14.2.6.12 Transmit Error (ETXER)
When the ETXER output is asserted for one or more E_TXCLKs while ETXEN is also asserted, the PHY
sends one or more illegal symbols. ETXER has no effect at 10 Mbps or when ETXEN is negated, and
applies to MII mode operation.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PEL4.
14.2.6.13 Receive Data 1–3 (ERXD[3:1])
These pins contain the Ethernet input data transferred from the PHY to the media-access controller when
ERXDV is asserted in MII mode operation.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PEL[3:1].
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-24
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
14.2.6.14 Receive Error (ERXER)
ERXER is an input signal which when asserted along with ERXDV signals that the PHY has detected an
error in the current frame. When ERXDV is not asserted ERXER has no effect, and applies to MII mode
operation.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PEL0.
14.2.7
14.2.7.1
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI) Signals
QSPI Synchronous Serial Output (QSPI_DOUT)
The QSPI_DOUT output provides the serial data from the QSPI and can be programmed to be driven on
the rising or falling edge of QSPICLK. Each byte is sent msb first.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQS0.
14.2.7.2
QSPI Synchronous Serial Data Input (QSPI_DIN)
The QSPI_DIN input provides the serial data to the QSPI and can be programmed to be sampled on the
rising or falling edge of QSPICLK. Each byte is written to RAM lsb first.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQS1.
14.2.7.3
QSPI Serial Clock (QSPI_CLK)
The QSPI serial clock (QSPI_CLK) provides the serial clock from the QSPI. The polarity and phase of
QSPI_CLK are programmable. The output frequency is programmed according to the following formula,
in which n can be any value between 2 and 255: QSPI_CLK = CLKOUT/(2n).
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQS2.
14.2.7.4
QSPI Chip Selects (QSPI_CS[3:0])
The synchronous peripheral chip selects (QSPI_CS[3:0]) outputs provide QSPI peripheral chip selects that
can be programmed to be active high or low.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQS[6:3].
14.2.8
14.2.8.1
FlexCAN Signals
FlexCAN Transmit (CANTX)
Controller Area Network Transmit data output.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PAS2.
14.2.8.2
FlexCAN Receive (CANRX)
Controller Area Network Transmit data input.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PAS3.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-25
Signal Descriptions
14.2.9
I2C Signals
The I2C module acts as a two-wire, bidirectional serial interface between the processor and peripherals
with an I2C interface (such as LCD controller, A-to-D converter, or D-to-A converter). Devices connected
to the I2C must have open-drain or open-collector outputs.
14.2.9.1
Serial Clock (SCL)
This bidirectional open-drain signal is the clock signal for the I2C interface. Either it is driven by the I2C
module when the bus is in the master mode or it becomes the clock input when the I2C is in the slave mode.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PAS0 or UTXD2.
14.2.9.2
Serial Data (SDA)
This bidirectional open-drain signal is the data input/output for the I2C interface.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PAS1 or URXD2.
14.2.10 UART Module Signals
The signals in the following sections are used to transfer serial data between three UART modules and
external peripherals.
14.2.10.1 Transmit Serial Data Output (UTXD[2:0])
UTXD[2:0] are the transmitter serial data outputs for the UART modules. The output is held high (mark
condition) when the transmitter is disabled, idle, or in the local loopback mode. Data is shifted out, lsb
first, on this pin at the falling edge of the serial clock source.
The UTXD[1:0] pins can be configured as GPIO ports PUA2 and PUA0. The UTXD2 output is offered on
3 pins and is a secondary function of the EMDC/ GPIO port PAS4 pin, CANTX/GPIO port PAS2 pin, and
SCL/GPIO port PAS0 pin.
14.2.10.2 Receive Serial Data Input (URXD[2:0])
URXD[2:0] are the receiver serial data inputs for the UART modules. Data received on these pins is
sampled on the rising edge of the serial clock source lsb first. When the UART clock is stopped for
power-down mode, any transition on this pin restarts it.
The URXD[1:0] pins can be configured as GPIO ports PUA3 and PUA1. The URXD2 input is offered on
3 pins and is a secondary function of the EMDIO/GPIO port PAS5 pin, CANRX/GPIO port PAS3 pin, and
SDA/GPIO port PAS1 pin.
14.2.10.3 Clear-to-Send (UCTS[1:0])
The UCTS[1:0] signals are the clear-to-send (CTS) inputs, indicating to the UART modules that they can
begin data transmission.
The UCTS[1:0] inputs are each offered as secondary functions on four pins--DTIN2, DTOUT2, DTIN0
and DTOUT0.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-26
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
14.2.10.4 Request-to-Send (URTS[1:0])
The URTS[1:0] signals are automatic request to send outputs from the UART modules. URTS[1:0] can
also be configured to be asserted and negated as a function of the Rx FIFO level.
The URTS[1:0] outputs are each offered as secondary functions on four pins: DTIN3, DTOUT3, DTIN1
and DTOUT1.
14.2.11 General Purpose Timer Signals
These pins provide the external interface to the general purpose timer functions.
14.2.11.1 GPTA[3:0]
These pins provide the external interface to the timer A functions.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PTA[3:0].
14.2.11.2 GPTB[3:0]
These pins provide the external interface to the timer B functions.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PTB[3:0].
14.2.11.3 External Clock Input (SYNCA/SYNCB)
These pins are used to clear the clock for each of the two timers, and are provided as a means of
synchronization to externally clocked or timed events.
14.2.12 DMA Timer Signals
This section describes the signals of the four DMA timer modules.
14.2.12.1 DMA Timer 0 Input (DTIN0)
The DMA timer 0 input (DTIN0) can be programmed to cause events to occur in DMA timer 0. It can
either clock the event counter or provide a trigger to the timer value capture logic.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PTD1, secondary function UCTS1, or secondary function
UCTS0.
14.2.12.2 DMA Timer 0 Output (DTOUT0)
The programmable DMA timer output (DTOUT0) pulse or toggle on various timer events.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PTD0, secondary function UCTS1, or secondary function
UCTS0.
14.2.12.3 DMA Timer 1 Input (DTIN1)
The DMA timer 1 input (DTIN1) can be programmed to cause events to occur in DMA timer 1. This can
either clock the event counter or provide a trigger to the timer value capture logic.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-27
Signal Descriptions
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PTD3, secondary function URTS1, or secondary function URTS0.
14.2.12.4 DMA Timer 1 Output (DTOUT1)
The programmable DMA timer output (DTOUT1) pulse or toggle on various timer events.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PTD2, secondary function URTS1, or secondary function URTS0.
14.2.12.5 DMA Timer 2 Input (DTIN2)
The DMA timer 2 input (DTIN2) can be programmed to cause events to occur in DMA timer 2. It can
either clock the event counter or provide a trigger to the timer value capture logic.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PTC1, secondary function UCTS1, or secondary function
UCTS0.
14.2.12.6 DMA Timer 2 Output (DTOUT2)
The programmable DMA timer output (DTOUT2) pulse or toggle on various timer events.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PTC0, secondary function UCTS1, or secondary function
UCTS0.
14.2.12.7 DMA Timer 3 Input (DTIN3)
The DMA timer 3 input (DTIN3) can be programmed as an input that causes events to occur in DMA timer
3. This can either clock the event counter or provide a trigger to the timer value capture logic. This pin can
also be configured as GPIO PTC3, secondary function URTS1, or secondary function URTS0.
14.2.12.8 DMA Timer 3 Output (DTOUT3)
The programmable DMA timer output (DTOUT0) pulse or toggle on various timer events.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PTC2, secondary function URTS1, or secondary function URTS0.
14.2.13 Analog-to-Digital Converter Signals
These pins provide the analog inputs to the QADC.
The PQA and PQB pins may also be used as general purpose digital I/O.
14.2.13.1 QADC Analog Input (AN0/ANW)
This PQB signal is the direct analog input AN0. When using external multiplexing this pin can also be
configured as multiplexed input ANW.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQB0.
14.2.13.2 QADC Analog Input (AN1/ANX)
This PQB signal is the direct analog input AN1. When using external multiplexing this pin can also be
configured as multiplexed input ANX.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQB1.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-28
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
14.2.13.3 QADC Analog Input (AN2/ANY)
This PQB signal is the direct analog input AN2. When using external multiplexing this pin can also be
configured as multiplexed input ANY.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQB2.
14.2.13.4 QADC Analog Input (AN3/ANZ)
This PQB signal is the direct analog input AN3. When using external multiplexing this pin can also be
configured as multiplexed input ANZ.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQB3.
14.2.13.5 QADC Analog Input (AN52/MA0)
This PQA signal is the direct analog input AN52. When using external multiplexing this pin can also be
configured as an output signal, MA0, to select the output of the external multiplexer.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQA0.
14.2.13.6 QADC Analog Input (AN53/MA1)
This PQA signal is the direct analog input AN53. When using external multiplexing this pin can also be
configured as an output signal, MA1, to select the output of the external multiplexer.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQA1.
14.2.13.7 QADC Analog Input (AN55/TRIG1)
This PQA signal is the direct analog input AN55. This pin can also be configured as an input signal,
TRIG1, to trigger the execution of one of the two queues.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQA3.
14.2.13.8 QADC Analog Input (AN56/TRIG2)
This PQA signal is the direct analog input AN56. This pin can also be configured as an input signal,
TRIG2, to trigger the execution of one of the two queues.
This pin can also be configured as GPIO PQA4.
14.2.14 Debug Support Signals
These signals are used as the interface to the on-chip JTAG controller and also to interface to the BDM
logic.
14.2.14.1 JTAG_EN
This input signal is used to select between multiplexed debug module and JTAG signals at reset. If
JTAG_EN is low, the part is in normal and background debug mode (BDM); if it is high, it is in normal
and JTAG mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-29
Signal Descriptions
14.2.14.2 Development Serial Clock/Test Reset (DSCLK/TRST)
Debug mode operation: DSCLK is selected. DSCLK is the development serial clock for the serial interface
to the debug module. The maximum DSCLK frequency is 1/5 CLKIN.
JTAG mode operation: TRST is selected. TRST asynchronously resets the internal JTAG controller to the
test logic reset state, causing the JTAG instruction register to choose the bypass instruction. When this
occurs, JTAG logic is benign and does not interfere with normal device functionality.
Although TRST is asynchronous, Freescale recommends that it makes an asserted-to-negated transition
only while TMS is held high. TRST has an internal pull-up resistor so if it is not driven low, it defaults to
a logic level of 1. If TRST is not used, it can be tied to ground or, if TCK is clocked, to VDD. Tying TRST
to ground places the JTAG controller in test logic reset state immediately. Tying it to VDD causes the JTAG
controller (if TMS is a logic level of 1) to eventually enter test logic reset state after 5 TCK clocks.
14.2.14.3 Breakpoint/Test Mode Select (BKPT/TMS)
Debug mode operation: If JTAG_EN is low, BKPT is selected. BKPT signals a hardware breakpoint to the
processor in debug mode.
JTAG mode operation: TMS is selected. The TMS input provides information to determine the JTAG test
operation mode. The state of TMS and the internal 16-state JTAG controller state machine at the rising
edge of TCK determine whether the JTAG controller holds its current state or advances to the next state.
This directly controls whether JTAG data or instruction operations occur. TMS has an internal pull-up
resistor so that if it is not driven low, it defaults to a logic level of 1. But if TMS is not used, it should be
tied to VDD.
14.2.14.4 Development Serial Input/Test Data (DSI/TDI)
Debug mode operation: If JTAG_EN is low, DSI is selected. DSI provides the single-bit communication
for debug module commands.
JTAG mode operation: TDI is selected. TDI provides the serial data port for loading the various JTAG
boundary scan, bypass, and instruction registers. Shifting in data depends on the state of the JTAG
controller state machine and the instruction in the instruction register. Shifts occur on the TCK rising edge.
TDI has an internal pull-up resistor, so when not driven low it defaults to high. But if TDI is not used, it
should be tied to VDD.
14.2.14.5 Development Serial Output/Test Data (DSO/TDO)
Debug mode operation: DSO is selected. DSO provides single-bit communication for debug module
responses.
JTAG mode operation: TDO is selected. The TDO output provides the serial data port for outputting data
from JTAG logic. Shifting out data depends on the JTAG controller state machine and the instruction in
the instruction register. Data shifting occurs on the falling edge of TCK. When TDO is not outputting test
data, it is three-stated. TDO can be three-stated to allow bused or parallel connections to other devices
having JTAG.
14.2.14.6 Test Clock (TCLK)
TCK is the dedicated JTAG test logic clock independent of the processor clock. Various JTAG operations
occur on the rising or falling edge of TCK. Holding TCK high or low for an indefinite period does not
cause JTAG test logic to lose state information. If TCK is not used, it must be tied to ground.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-30
Freescale Semiconductor
Signal Descriptions
14.2.14.7 Debug Data (DDATA[3:0])
Debug data signals (DDATA[3:0]) display captured processor addresses, data and breakpoint status.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PDD[7:4].
14.2.14.8 Processor Status Outputs (PST[3:0])
PST[3:0] outputs indicate core status, as shown below in Table 14-7. Debug mode timing is synchronous
with the processor clock; status is unrelated to the current bus transfer.
These pins can also be configured as GPIO PDD[3:0].
Table 14-7. Processor Status Encoding
PST[3:0]
Definition
0000
Continue execution
0001
Begin execution of an instruction
0010
Reserved
0011
Entry into user mode
0100
Begin execution of PULSE and WDDATA instruction
0101
Begin execution of taken branch
0110
Reserved
0111
Begin execution of RTE instruction
1000
Begin one-byte transfer on DDATA
1001
Begin two-byte transfer on DDATA
1010
Begin three-byte transfer on DDATA
1011
Begin four-byte transfer on DDATA
1100
Exception Processing
1101
Emulator-Mode Exception Processing
1110
Processor is stopped
1111
Processor is halted
14.2.15 Test Signals
14.2.15.1 Test (TEST)
This input signal is reserved for factory testing only and should be connected to VSS to prevent
unintentional activation of test functions.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
14-31
Signal Descriptions
14.2.16 Power and Reference Signals
These signals provide system power, ground and references to the device. Multiple pins are provided for
adequate current capability. All power supply pins must have adequate bypass capacitance for
high-frequency noise suppression.
14.2.16.1 QADC Analog Reference (VRH, VRL)
These signals serve as the high (VRH) and low (VRL) reference potentials for the analog converter in the
QADC.
14.2.16.2 QADC Analog Supply (VDDA, VSSA)
These are dedicated power supply signals to isolate the sensitive QADC analog circuitry from the normal
levels of noise present on the digital power supply.
14.2.16.3 PLL Analog Supply (VDDPLL, VSSPLL)
These are dedicated power supply signals to isolate the sensitive PLL analog circuitry from the normal
levels of noise present on the digital power supply.
14.2.16.4 QADC Positive Supply (VDDH)
This pin supplies positive power to the ESD structures in the QADC pads.
14.2.16.5 Power for Flash Erase/Program (VPP)
This pin is used for Flash stress testing and can be left unconnected in normal device operation.
14.2.16.6 Power and Ground for Flash Array (VDDF, VSSF)
These signals supply a power and ground to the Flash array.
14.2.16.7 Standby Power (VSTBY)
This pin is used to provide standby voltage to the RAM array if VDD is lost.
14.2.16.8 Positive Supply (VDD)
This pin supplies positive power to the core logic and I/O pads.
14.2.16.9 Ground (VSS)
This pin is the negative supply (ground) to the chip.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
14-32
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 15
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
This chapter describes configuration and operation of the synchronous DRAM (SDRAM) controller. It
begins with a general description and brief glossary, and includes a description of signals involved in
DRAM operations. The remainder of the chapter describes the programming model and signal timing, as
well as the command set required for synchronous operations. It also includes extensive examples that the
designer can follow to better understand how to configure the DRAM controller for synchronous
operations.
15.1
Overview
The synchronous DRAM controller module provides glueless integration of SDRAM with the ColdFire
product. The key features of the DRAM controller include the following:
• Support for two independent blocks of SDRAM
• Interface to standard SDRAM components
• Programmable SRAS, SCAS, and refresh timing
• Support for 8-, 16-, and 32-bit wide SDRAM blocks
15.1.1
Definitions
The following terminology is used in this chapter:
• SDRAM block: Any group of DRAM memories selected by one of the SRAS[1:0] signals. Thus,
the processor can support two independent memory blocks. The base address of each block is
programmed in the DRAM address and control registers (DACR0 and DACR1).
• SDRAM: RAMs that operate like asynchronous DRAMs but with a synchronous clock, a
pipelined, multiple-bank architecture, and a faster speed.
• SDRAM bank: An internal partition in an SDRAM device. For example, a 64-Mbit SDRAM
component might be configured as four 512K x 32 banks. Banks are selected through the SDRAM
component’s bank select lines.
15.1.2
Block Diagram and Major Components
The basic components of the SDRAM controller are shown in Figure 15-1.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-1
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
DRAM Controller Module
D[31:0] internal
Q[31:0] internal
Data
Generation
A[23:0]
Address
Multiplexing
Internal
Bus
Control Logic
and
State Machine
Memory Block 0 Hit Logic
DRAM Address/Control Register 0
(DACR0)
DRAM Control
Register (DCR)
Memory Block 1 Hit Logic
DRAM Address/Control Register 1
(DACR1)
D[31:0]
D[31:0]
A[23:0]
SCAS
SRAS
SCKE
SDRAM_CS[1:0]
DRAMW
BS[3:0]
Refresh Counter
Figure 15-1. Synchronous DRAM Controller Block Diagram
The DRAM controller’s major components are as follows:
• DRAM address and control registers (DACR0 and DACR1)—The DRAM controller consists of
two configuration register units, one for each supported memory block. DACR0 is accessed at
IPSBAR + 0x048; DACR1 is accessed at IPSBAR + 0x050. The register information is passed on
to the hit logic.
• Control logic and state machine—Generates all SDRAM signals, taking hit information and
bus-cycle characteristic data from the block logic in order to generate SDRAM accesses. Handles
refresh requests from the refresh counter.
— DRAM control register (DCR)—Contains data to control refresh operation of the DRAM
controller. Both memory blocks are refreshed concurrently as controlled by DCR[RC].
— Refresh counter—Determines when refresh should occur; controlled by the value of DCR[RC].
It generates a refresh request to the control block.
• Hit logic—Compares address and attribute signals of a current SDRAM bus cycle to both DACRs
to determine if an SDRAM block is being accessed. Hits are passed to the control logic along with
characteristics of the bus cycle to be generated.
• Address multiplexing—Multiplexes addresses to allow column and row addresses to share pins.
This allows glueless interface to SDRAMs.
• Data Generation—Controls the data input and data output transmission between the on-platform
and off-platform data buses.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.2
SDRAM Controller Operation
By running synchronously with the system clock, SDRAM can (after an initial latency period) be accessed
on every clock; 5-1-1-1 is a typical burst rate to the SDRAM. Unlike the MCF5272, this processor does
not have an independent SDRAM clock signal. For this processor, the timing of the SDRAM controller is
controlled by the CLKOUT signal.
Note that because the processor cannot have more than one page open at a time, it does not support
interleaving.
SDRAM controllers are more sophisticated than asynchronous DRAM controllers. Not only must they
manage addresses and data, but they must send special commands for such functions as precharge, read,
write, burst, auto-refresh, and various combinations of these functions. Table 15-1 lists common SDRAM
commands.
Table 15-1. SDRAM Commands
Command
Definition
ACTV
Activate. Executed before READ or WRITE executes; SDRAM registers and decodes row address.
MRS
Mode register set.
NOP
No-op. Does not affect SDRAM state machine; DRAM controller control signals negated;
SDRAM_CS[1:0] asserted.
PALL
Precharge all. Precharges all internal banks of an SDRAM component; executed before new page is
opened.
READ
Read access. SDRAM registers column address and decodes that a read access is occurring.
REF
Refresh. Refreshes internal bank rows of an SDRAM component.
SELF
Self refresh. Refreshes internal bank rows of an SDRAM component when it is in low-power mode.
SELFX
Exit self refresh. This command is sent to the DRAM controller when DCR[IS] is cleared.
WRITE
Write access. SDRAM registers column address and decodes that a write access is occurring.
SDRAMs operate differently than asynchronous DRAMs, particularly in the use of data pipelines and
commands to initiate special actions. Commands are issued to memory using specific encodings on
address and control pins. Soon after system reset, a command must be sent to the SDRAM mode register
to configure SDRAM operating parameters.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-3
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.2.1
DRAM Controller Signals
Table 15-2 describes the behavior of DRAM signals in synchronous mode.
Table 15-2. Synchronous DRAM Signal Connections
Signal
Description
SRAS
Synchronous row address strobe. Indicates a valid SDRAM row address is present and can be latched by
the SDRAM. SRAS should be connected to the corresponding SDRAM SRAS.
SCAS
Synchronous column address strobe. Indicates a valid column address is present and can be latched by
the SDRAM. SCAS should be connected to the corresponding SDRAM SCAS.
DRAMW
DRAM read/write. Asserted for write operations and negated for read operations.
SDRAM_CS[1:0 Row address strobe. Select each memory block of SDRAMs connected to the processor. One
]
SDRAM_CS signal selects one SDRAM block and connects to the corresponding CS signals.
SCKE
Synchronous DRAM clock enable. Connected directly to the CKE (clock enable) signal of SDRAMs.
Enables and disables the clock internal to SDRAM. When CKE is low, memory can enter a power-down
mode in which operations are suspended or capable of entering self-refresh mode. SCKE functionality is
controlled by DCR[COC]. For designs using external multiplexing, setting COC allows SCKE to provide
command-bit functionality.
BS[3:0]
Column address strobe. BS[3:0] function as byte enables to the SDRAMs. They connect to the BS signals
(or mask qualifiers) of the SDRAMs.
15.2.2
Memory Map for SDRAMC Registers
The DRAM controller registers memory map is shown in Table 15-3.
Table 15-3. DRAM Controller Registers
IPSBAR
Offset
0x040
[31:24]
[23:16]
[15:8]
DRAM control register (DCR) [p. 15-4]
[7:0]
—
0x044
—
0x048
DRAM address and control register 0 (DACR0) [p. 15-6]
0x04C
DRAM mask register block 0 (DMR0) [p. 15-8]
0x050
DRAM address and control register 1 (DACR1) [p. 15-6]
0x054
DRAM mask register block 1 (DMR1) [p. 15-8]
15.2.2.1
DRAM Control Register (DCR)
The DCR, shown in Figure 15-2, controls refresh logic.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15
Field
14
—
13
12
11
NAM COC
10
IS
Reset
9
8
0
RTIM
RC
Uninitialized
R/W
R/W
Addr
IPSBAR + 0x040
Figure 15-2. DRAM Control Register (DCR)
Table 15-4 describes DCR fields.
Table 15-4. DCR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
15-14
—
13
NAM
No address multiplexing. Some implementations require external multiplexing. For example, when
linear addressing is required, the SDRAM should not multiplex addresses on SDRAM accesses.
0 The SDRAM controller multiplexes the external address bus to provide column addresses.
1 The SDRAM controller does not multiplex the external address bus to provide column addresses.
12
COC
Command on SDRAM clock enable (SCKE). Implementations that use external multiplexing (NAM = 1)
must support command information to be multiplexed onto the SDRAM address bus.
0 SCKE functions as a clock enable; self-refresh is initiated by the SDRAM controller through
DCR[IS].
1 SCKE drives command information. Because SCKE is not a clock enable, self-refresh cannot be
used (setting DCR[IS]). Thus, external logic must be used if this functionality is desired. External
multiplexing is also responsible for putting the command information on the proper address bit.
11
IS
Initiate self-refresh command.
0 Take no action or issue a SELFX command to exit self refresh.
1 If DCR[COC] = 0, the SDRAM controller sends a SELF command to both SDRAM blocks to put them
in low-power, self-refresh state where they remain until IS is cleared. When IS is cleared, the
controller sends a SELFX command for the SDRAMs to exit self-refresh. The refresh counter is
suspended while the SDRAMs are in self-refresh; the SDRAM controls the refresh period.
10–9
8–0
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
RTIM Refresh timing. Determines the timing operation of auto-refresh in the SDRAM controller. Specifically,
it determines the number of bus clocks inserted between a REF command and the next possible ACTV
command. This same timing is used for both memory blocks controlled by the SDRAM controller. This
corresponds to tRC in the SDRAM specifications.
00 3 clocks
01 6 clocks
1x 9 clocks
RC
Refresh count. Controls refresh frequency. The number of bus clocks between refresh cycles is
(RC + 1) x 16. Refresh can range from 16–8192 bus clocks to accommodate both standard and
low-power SDRAMs with bus clock operation from less than 2 MHz to greater than 50 MHz.
The following example calculates RC for an auto-refresh period for 4096 rows to receive 64 ms of
refresh every 15.625 µs for each row (1031 bus clocks at 66 MHz). This operation is the same as in
asynchronous mode.
# of bus clocks = 1031 = (RC field + 1) x 16
RC = (1031 bus clocks/16) -1 = 63.44, which rounds to 63; therefore, RC = 0x3F.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-5
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.2.2.2
DRAM Address and Control Registers (DACR0/DACR1)
The DACRn registers, shown in Figure 15-3, contain the base address compare value and the control bits
for memory blocks 0 and 1 of the SDRAM controller. Address and timing are also controlled by bits in
DACRn.
31
Field
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
BA
Reset
—
RE — CASL —
Uninitialized
0
R/W
8
CBM
7
6
5
4
3
— IMRS PS IP
Uninitialized
0
2
0
—
Uninitialized
R/W
Address
IPSBAR+0x048 (DACR0); 0x050 (DACR1)
Figure 15-3. DRAM Address and Control Register (DACRn)
Table 15-5 describes DACRn fields.
Table 15-5. DACRn Field Descriptions
Bit
Name
31–18
BA
Base address register. With DCMR[BAM], determines the address range in which the associated
DRAM block is located. Each BA bit is compared with the corresponding address of the current bus
cycle. If all unmasked bits match, the address hits in the associated DRAM block. BA functions the
same as in asynchronous operation.
17–16
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
15
RE
Refresh enable. Determines when the DRAM controller generates a refresh cycle to the DRAM block.
0 Do not refresh associated DRAM block
1 Refresh associated DRAM block
14
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
13–12
Description
CASL CAS latency. Affects the following SDRAM timing specifications. Timing nomenclature varies with
manufacturers. Refer to the SDRAM specification for the appropriate timing nomenclature:
Number of Bus Clocks
Parameter
CASL= 00 CASL = 01 CASL= 10 CASL= 11
11
—
tRCD—SRAS assertion to SCAS assertion
1
2
3
3
tCASL—SCAS assertion to data out
1
2
3
3
tRAS—ACTV command to precharge command
2
4
6
6
tRP—Precharge command to ACTV command
1
2
3
3
tRWL,tRDL—Last data input to precharge
command
1
1
1
1
tEP—Last data out to precharge command
1
1
1
1
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Table 15-5. DACRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Bit
Name
10–8
CBM
Description
Command and bank MUX [2:0]. Because different SDRAM configurations cause the command and
bank select lines to correspond to different addresses, these resources are programmable. CBM
determines the addresses onto which these functions are multiplexed.
Note: It is important to set CBM according to the location of the command bit.
CBM
Command Bit
Bank Select Bits
000
17
18 and up
001
18
19 and up
010
19
20 and up
011
20
21 and up
100
21
22 and up
101
22
23 and up
110
23
24 and up
111
24
25 and up
This encoding and the address multiplexing scheme handle common SDRAM organizations. Bank
select bits include a base bit and all address bits above for SDRAMs with multiple bank select bits.
7
6
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
IMRS Initiate mode register set (MRS) command. Setting IMRS generates a MRS command to the associated
SDRAMs. In initialization, IMRS should be set only after all DRAM controller registers are initialized
and PALL and REFRESH commands have been issued. After IMRS is set, the next access to an SDRAM
block programs the SDRAM’s mode register. Thus, the address of the access should be programmed
to place the correct mode information on the SDRAM address pins. Because the SDRAM does not
register this information, it doesn’t matter if the IMRS access is a read or a write or what, if any, data is
put onto the data bus. The DRAM controller clears IMRS after the MRS command finishes.
0 Take no action
1 Initiate MRS command
5–4
PS
Port size. Indicates the port size of the associated block of SDRAM, which allows for dynamic sizing of
associated SDRAM accesses. PS functions the same in asynchronous operation.
00 32-bit port
01 8-bit port
1x 16-bit port
3
IP
Initiate precharge all (PALL) command. The DRAM controller clears IP after the PALL command is
finished. Accesses via IP should be no wider than the port size programmed in PS.
0 Take no action.
1 A PALL command is sent to the associated SDRAM block. During initialization, this command is
executed after all DRAM controller registers are programmed. After IP is set, the next write to an
appropriate SDRAM address generates the PALL command to the SDRAM block.
2–0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-7
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.2.2.3
DRAM Controller Mask Registers (DMR0/DMR1)
The DMRn, Figure 15-4, includes mask bits for the base address and for address attributes.
31
18 17
Field
9
BAM
—
Reset
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WP — C/I AM SC SD UC UD V
Uninitialized
0
R/W
R/W
Addr
IPSBAR + 0x04C (DMR0), 0x054 (DMR1)
Figure 15-4. DRAM Controller Mask Registers (DMRn)
Table 15-6 describes DMRn fields.
Table 15-6. DMRn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
31–18
BAM
17–9
—
8
WP
7
—
6–1
AMx
Description
Base address mask. Masks the associated DACRn[BA]. Lets the DRAM controller connect to various
DRAM sizes. Mask bits need not be contiguous (see Section 15.3, “SDRAM Example.”)
0 The associated address bit is used in decoding the DRAM hit to a memory block.
1 The associated address bit is not used in the DRAM hit decode.
Reserved, should be cleared.
Write protect. Determines whether the associated block of DRAM is write protected.
0 Allow write accesses
1 Ignore write accesses. The DRAM controller ignores write accesses to the memory block and an
address exception occurs. Write accesses to a write-protected DRAM region are compared in the
chip select module for a hit. If no hit occurs, an external bus cycle is generated. If this external bus
cycle is not acknowledged, an access exception occurs.
Reserved, should be cleared.
Address modifier masks. Determine which accesses can occur in a given DRAM block.
0 Allow access type to hit in DRAM
1 Do not allow access type to hit in DRAM
Bit
0
V
Associated Access Type
Access Definition
C/I
CPU space/interrupt acknowledge
MOVEC instruction or interrupt acknowledge cycle
AM
Alternate master
DMA master
SC
Supervisor code
Any supervisor-only instruction access
SD
Supervisor data
Any data fetched during the instruction access
UC
User code
Any user instruction
UD
User data
Any user data
Valid. Cleared at reset to ensure that the DRAM block is not erroneously decoded.
0 Do not decode DRAM accesses.
1 Registers controlling the DRAM block are initialized; DRAM accesses can be decoded.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.2.3
General Synchronous Operation Guidelines
To reduce system logic and to support a variety of SDRAM sizes, the DRAM controller provides SDRAM
control signals as well as a multiplexed row address and column address to the SDRAM.
15.2.3.1
Address Multiplexing
Table 15-7 shows the generic address multiplexing scheme for SDRAM configurations. All possible
address connection configurations can be derived from this table.
NOTE
Because the processor has 24 extermal address lines, the maximum
SDRAM address size is 128 Mbits.
The following tables provide a more comprehensive, step-by-step way to determine the correct address
line connections for interfacing the ColdFire processor to the SDRAM. To use the tables, find the one that
corresponds to the number of column address lines on the SDRAM and to the port size as seen by the
processor, which is not necessarily the SDRAM port size. For example, if two 1M x 16-bit SDRAMs
together form a 1M x 32-bit memory, the port size is 32 bits. Most SDRAMs likely have fewer address
lines than are shown in the tables, so follow only the connections shown until all SDRAM address lines
are connected.
Table 15-7. Generic Address Multiplexing Scheme
Address Pin
Row Address
Column Address
Notes Relating to Port Sizes
17
17
0
8-bit port only
16
16
1
8- and 16-bit ports only
15
15
2
14
14
3
13
13
4
12
12
5
11
11
6
10
10
7
9
9
8
17
17
16
32-bit port only
18
18
17
16-bit port only or 32-bit port with only 8 column address lines
19
19
18
16-bit port only when at least 9 column address lines are used
20
20
19
21
21
20
22
22
21
23
23
22
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-9
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Table 15-8. Processor to SDRAM Interface (8-Bit Port, 9-Column Address Lines)
Process A17 A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A18 A19 A20 A21 A22 A23
or Pins
Row
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Column
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SDRAM
Pins
18
19
20
21
22
23
A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14
Table 15-9. Processor to SDRAM Interface (8-Bit Port,10-Column Address Lines)
Process A17 A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A19 A20 A21 A22 A23
or Pins
Row
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
19
Column
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
18
SDRAM
Pins
20
21
22
23
A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13
Table 15-10. Processor to SDRAM Interface (8-Bit Port,11-Column Address Lines)
Processo A17 A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A19 A21 A22 A23
r Pins
Row
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
19
21
Column
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
18
20
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
22
23
A9 A10 A11 A12
Table 15-11. Processor to SDRAM Interface (8-Bit Port,12-Column Address Lines)
Processor A17 A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A19 A21 A23
Pins
Row
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
19
21
23
Column
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
18
20
22
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9 A10 A11
Table 15-12. Processor to SDRAM Interface (8-Bit Port,13-Column Address Lines)
Process
or Pins
A17 A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10
A9 A19 A21 A23
Row
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
19
21
23
Column
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
18
20
22
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10 A11
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Table 15-13. Processor to SDRAM Interface (16-Bit Port, 8-Column Address Lines)
Process A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A17 A18 A19 A20 A21 A22 A23
or Pins
Row
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Column
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SDRAM
Pins
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14
Table 15-14. Processor to SDRAM Interface (16-Bit Port, 9-Column Address Lines)
Processo A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A18 A19 A20 A21 A22 A23
r Pins
Row
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
18
Column
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
19
20
21
22
23
A9 A10 A11 A12 A13
Table 15-15. Processor to SDRAM Interface (16-Bit Port, 10-Column Address Lines)
Processo A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A18 A20 A21 A22 A23
r Pins
Row
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
18
20
21
22
23
Column
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
19
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9 A10 A11 A12
Table 15-16. Processor to SDRAM Interface (16-Bit Port, 11-Column Address Lines)
Processo A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10
r Pins
A9
A18 A20 A22 A23
Row
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
18
20
22
Column
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
19
21
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
23
A10 A11
Table 15-17. Processor to SDRAM Interface (16-Bit Port, 12-Column Address Lines)
Processor
A16
Pins
A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A18
A20
A22
Row
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
18
20
22
Column
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
19
21
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-11
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Table 15-18. Processor to SDRAM Interface (16-Bit Port, 13-Column-Address Lines)
Processo A16
r Pins
A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A18
A20
A22
Row
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
18
20
22
Column
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
19
21
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
Table 15-19. Processor to SDRAM Interface (32-Bit Port, 8-Column Address Lines)
Processo A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A17 A18 A19 A20 A21 A22 A23
r Pins
Row
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
17
Column
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
SDRAM
Pins
A0 A1 A2
A3 A4 A5 A6
18
19
20
21
22
23
A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13
Table 15-20. Processor to SDRAM Interface (32-Bit Port, 9-Column Address Lines)
Processor A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A17 A19 A20 A21 A22 A23
Pins
Row
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
17
19
20
Column
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
18
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
21
22
23
A9 A10 A11 A12
Table 15-21. Processor to SDRAM Interface (32-Bit Port, 10-Column Address Lines)
Processor A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10
Pins
A9
A17 A19 A21 A22 A23
Row
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
17
19
21
Column
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
18
20
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
22
23
A10 A11
Table 15-22. Processor to SDRAM Interface (32-Bit Port, 11-Column Address Lines)
Processor
Pins
A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A17
A19
A21
A23
Row
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
17
19
21
23
Column
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
18
20
22
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Table 15-23. Processor to SDRAM Interface (32-Bit Port, 12-Column Address Lines)
Processor
Pins
15.2.3.2
A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A17
A19
A21
A23
Row
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
17
19
21
23
Column
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
18
20
22
SDRAM
Pins
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
SDRAM Byte Strobe Connections
Figure 15-5 shows SDRAM connections for port sizes of 32, 16, or 8 bits.
Byte Enable
BS3
BS2
BS1
BS0
Processor
External
Data Bus
D[31:24]
D[23:16]
D[15:8]
D[7:0]
32-Bit Port
Memory
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
16-Bit Port
Memory
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
8-Bit Port
Memory
Driven with
indeterminate values
Byte 0
Byte 1
Driven with
indeterminate values
Byte 2
Byte 3
Figure 15-5. Connections for External Memory Port Sizes
15.2.3.3
Interfacing Example
The tables in the previous section can be used to configure the interface in the following example. To
interface one 2M x 32-bit x 4 bank SDRAM component (8 columns), use the connections shown in
Table 15-24.
Table 15-24. SDRAM Hardware Connections
SDRAM Pins
A0
Processor Pins A15
15.2.3.4
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10 = CMD
BA0
BA1
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A17
A18
A19
A20
A21
A22
Burst Page Mode
SDRAM can efficiently provide data when an SDRAM page is opened. As soon as SCAS is issued, the
SDRAM accepts a new address and asserts SCAS every CLKOUT for as long as accesses occur in that
page. In burst page mode, there are multiple read or write operations for every ACTV command in the
SDRAM if the requested transfer size exceeds the port size of the associated SDRAM. The primary cycle
of the transfer generates the ACTV and READ or WRITE commands; secondary cycles generate only READ
or WRITE commands. As soon as the transfer completes, the PALL command is generated to prepare for the
next access.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-13
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Note that in synchronous operation, burst mode and address incrementing during burst cycles are
controlled by the DRAM controller. Thus, instead of the SDRAM enabling its internal burst incrementing
capability, the processor controls this function. This means that the burst function that is enabled in the
mode register of SDRAMs must be disabled when interfacing to the processor.
Figure 15-6 shows a burst read operation. In this example, DACR[CASL] = 01 for an SRAS-to-SCAS
delay (tRCD) of 2 system clock cycles. Because tRCD is equal to the read CAS latency (SCAS assertion to
data out), this value is also 2 system clock cycles. Notice that NOPs are executed until the last data is read.
A PALL command is executed one cycle after the last data transfer.
CLKOUT
A[23:0]
Row
Column
Column Column
Column
SRAS
tRCD = 2
SCAS
tEP
DRAMW
tCASL = 2
D[31:0]
SDRAM_CS[0] or [1]
BS[3:0]
ACTV
NOP
READ
READ
READ
READ
NOP
NOP
PALL
Figure 15-6. Burst Read SDRAM Access
Figure 15-7 shows the burst write operation. In this example, DACR[CASL] = 01, which creates an
SRAS-to-SCAS delay (tRCD) of 2 system clock cycles. Note that data is available upon SCAS assertion
and a burst write cycle completes two cycles sooner than a burst read cycle with the same tRCD. The next
bus cycle is initiated sooner, but cannot begin an SDRAM cycle until the precharge-to-ACTV delay
completes.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
CLKOUT
A[23:0]
Row
Column
Column Column
Column
SRAS
tRP
SCAS
tCASL = 2
tRWL
DRAMW
D[31:0]
SDRAM_CS[0] or [1]
BS[3:0]
ACTV
NOP
WRITE
WRITE
WRITE
WRITE
NOP
PALL
Figure 15-7. Burst Write SDRAM Access
Accesses in synchronous burst page mode always cause the following sequence:
1. ACTV command
2. NOP commands to assure SRAS-to-SCAS delay (if CAS latency is 1, there are no NOP
commands).
3. Required number of READ or WRITE commands to service the transfer size with the given port
size.
4. Some transfers need more NOP commands to assure the ACTV-to-precharge delay.
5. PALL command
6. Required number of idle clocks inserted to assure precharge-to-ACTV delay.
15.2.3.5
Auto-Refresh Operation
The DRAM controller is equipped with a refresh counter and control. This logic is responsible for
providing timing and control to refresh the SDRAM without user interaction. Once the refresh counter is
set, and refresh is enabled, the counter counts to zero. At this time, an internal refresh request flag is set
and the counter begins counting down again. The DRAM controller completes any active burst operation
and then performs a PALL operation. The DRAM controller then initiates a refresh cycle and clears the
refresh request flag. This refresh cycle includes a delay from any precharge to the auto-refresh command,
the auto-refresh command, and then a delay until any ACTV command is allowed. Any SDRAM access
initiated during the auto-refresh cycle is delayed until the cycle is completed.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-15
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Figure 15-8 shows the auto-refresh timing. In this case, there is an SDRAM access when the refresh
request becomes active. The request is delayed by the precharge to ACTV delay programmed into the active
SDRAM bank by the CAS bits. The REF command is then generated and the delay required by
DCR[RTIM] is inserted before the next ACTV command is generated. In this example, the next bus cycle
is initiated, but does not generate an SDRAM access until TRC is finished. Because both chip selects are
active during the REF command, it is passed to both blocks of external SDRAM.
CLKOUT
A[23:0]
SRAS
tRC = 6
tRCD = 2
SCAS
DRAMW
SDRAM_CS[0] or [1]
REF
PALL
ACTV
Figure 15-8. Auto-Refresh Operation
15.2.3.6
Self-Refresh Operation
Self-refresh is a method of allowing the SDRAM to enter into a low-power state, while at the same time
to perform an internal refresh operation and to maintain the integrity of the data stored in the SDRAM. The
DRAM controller supports self-refresh with DCR[IS]. When IS is set, the SELF command is sent to the
SDRAM. When IS is cleared, the SELFX command is sent to the DRAM controller. Figure 15-9 shows the
self-refresh operation.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
CLKOUT
SRAS
SCAS
tRCD = 2
tRC = 6
DRAMW
SDRAM_CS[0] or [1]
SCKE
(DCR[COC] = 0)
PALL
SELF
SELFX
SelfRefresh
Active
First
Possible
ACTV
Figure 15-9. Self-Refresh Operation
15.2.4
Initialization Sequence
Synchronous DRAMs have a prescribed initialization sequence. The DRAM controller supports this
sequence with the following procedure:
1. SDRAM control signals are reset to idle state. Wait the prescribed period after reset before any
action is taken on the SDRAMs. This is normally around 100 µs.
2. Initialize the DCR, DACR, and DMR in their operational configuration. Do not yet enable PALL
or REF commands.
3. Issue a PALL command to the SDRAMs by setting DACR[IP] and accessing a SDRAM location.
Wait the time (determined by tRP) before any other execution.
4. Enable refresh (set DACR[RE]) and wait for at least 8 refreshes to occur.
5. Before issuing the MRS command, determine if the DMR mask bits need to be modified to allow
the MRS to execute properly
6. Issue the MRS command by setting DACR[IMRS] and accessing a location in the SDRAM. Note
that mode register settings are driven on the SDRAM address bus, so care must be taken to change
DMR[BAM] if the mode register configuration does not fall in the address range determined by
the address mask bits. After the mode register is set, DMR mask bits can be restored to their
desired configuration.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-17
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.2.4.1
Mode Register Settings
It is possible to configure the operation of SDRAMs, namely their burst operation and CAS latency,
through the SDRAM component’s mode register. CAS latency is a function of the speed of the SDRAM
and the bus clock of the DRAM controller. The DRAM controller operates at a CAS latency of 1, 2, or 3.
Although the DRAM controller supports bursting operations, it does not use the bursting features of the
SDRAMs. Because the processor can burst operand sizes of 1, 2, 4, or 16 bytes long, the concept of a fixed
burst length in the SDRAMs mode register becomes problematic. Therefore, the processor DRAM
controller generates the burst cycles rather than the SDRAM device. Because the processor generates a
new address and a READ or WRITE command for each transfer within the burst, the SDRAM mode register
should be set either not to burst or to a burst length of one. This allows bursting to be controlled by the
processor.
The SDRAM mode register is written by setting the associated block’s DACR[IMRS]. First, the base
address and mask registers must be set to the appropriate configuration to allow the mode register to be
set. Note that improperly set DMR mask bits may prevent access to the mode register address. Thus, the
user should determine the mapping of the mode register address to the processor address bits to find out if
an access is blocked. If the DMR setting prohibits mode register access, the DMR should be reconfigured
to enable the access and then set to its necessary configuration after the MRS command executes.
The associated CBM bits should also be initialized. After DACR[IMRS] is set, the next access to the
SDRAM address space generates the MRS command to that SDRAM. The address of the access should be
selected to place the correct mode information on the SDRAM address pins. The address is not multiplexed
for the MRS command. The MRS access can be a read or write. The important thing is that the address output
of that access needs the correct mode programming information on the correct address bits.
Figure 15-10 shows the MRS command, which occurs in the first clock of the bus cycle.
CLKOUT
A[23:0]
SRAS, SCAS
DRAMW
D[31:0]
SD_CS[1] or [0]
MRS
Figure 15-10. Mode Register Set (MRS) Command
15.3
SDRAM Example
This example interfaces a 512K x 32-bit x 4 bank SDRAM component to processor operating at 40 MHz.
Table 15-25 lists design specifications for this example.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-18
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Table 15-25. SDRAM Example Specifications
Parameter
Speed grade (-8E)
Specification
40 MHz (25-ns period)
10 rows, 8 columns
Two bank-select lines to access four internal banks
ACTV-to-read/write
delay (tRCD)
Period between auto-refresh and ACTV command (tRC)
ACTV
command to precharge command (tRAS)
20 ns (min.)
70 ns
48 ns (min.)
Precharge command to ACTV command (tRP)
20 ns (min.)
Last data input to PALL command (tRWL)
1 bus clock (25 ns)
Auto-refresh period for 4096 rows (tREF)
64 mS
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-19
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.3.1
SDRAM Interface Configuration
To interface this component to the DRAM controller, use the connection table that corresponds to a 32-bit
port size with 8 columns (Table 15-24). Two pins select one of four banks when the part is functional.
Table 15-26 shows the proper hardware connections.
Table 15-26. SDRAM Hardware Connections
Processor Pins A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A17
A18
A19
A20
A21
A22
SDRAM Pins
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10 = CMD
BA0
BA1
15.3.2
A0
DCR Initialization
At power-up, the DCR has the following configuration if synchronous operation and SDRAM address
multiplexing are desired.
Field
15
14
—
—
13
12
11
NAM COC
IS
Setting
10
9
8
0
RTIM
RC
0000_0000_0010_0110
(hex)
0026
Figure 15-11. Initialization Values for DCR
This configuration results in a value of 0x0026 for DCR, as shown in Table 15-27.
Table 15-27. DCR Initialization Values
Bits
Name
Setting
15
—
0
Reserved.
14
—
0
Reserved.
13
NAM
0
Indicating SDRAM controller multiplexes address lines internally
12
COC
0
SCKE is used as clock enable instead of command bit because user is not multiplexing
address lines externally and requires external command feed.
11
IS
0
At power-up, allowing power self-refresh state is not appropriate because registers are being
set up.
10–9
RTIM
00
Because tRC value is 70 ns, indicating a 3-clock refresh-to-ACTV timing.
8–0
RC
0x26
15.3.3
Description
Specification indicates auto-refresh period for 4096 rows to be 64 mS or refresh every 15.625
µs for each row, or 625 bus clocks at 40 MHz. Because DCR[RC] is incremented by 1 and
multiplied by 16, RC = (625 bus clocks/16) -1 = 38.06 = 0x38
DACR Initialization
As shown in Figure 15-12, the SDRAM is programmed to access only the second 512-Kbyte block of each
1-Mbyte partition in the SDRAM (each 16 Mbytes). The starting address of the SDRAM is 0xFF88_0000.
Continuous page mode feature is used.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-20
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Accessible
Memory
SDRAM Component
Bank 0
Bank 1
512 Kbyte
Bank 2
512 Kbyte
1 Mbyte
Bank 3
512 Kbyte
1 Mbyte
1 Mbyte
512 Kbyte
512 Kbyte
1 Mbyte
512 Kbyte
512 Kbyte
512 Kbyte
Figure 15-12. SDRAM Configuration
The DACRs should be programmed as shown in Figure 15-13.
31
18
Field
BA
Setting
16
—
1111_1111_1000_10xx
(hex)
Field
17
F
15
14
RE
—
F
13
12
11
CASL
—
Setting
8
10
8
CBM
7
6
—
IMRS
8
5
4
PS
3
IP
2
1
0
—
0000_x011_x000_0000
(hex)
0300
Figure 15-13. DACR Register Configuration
This configuration results in a value of DACR0 = 0xFF88_0300, as described in Table 15-28. DACR1
initialization is not needed because there is only one block. Subsequently, DACR1[RE,IMRS,IP] should
be cleared; everything else is a don’t care.
Table 15-28. DACR Initialization Values
Bits
Name
Setting
Description
31–18
BA
17–16
—
15
RE
14
—
13–12
CASL
11
—
10–8
CBM
7
—
6
IMRS
0
Indicates MRS command has not been initiated.
5–4
PS
00
32-bit port.
1111_1111_ Base address. So DACR0[31–16] = 0xFF88, placing the starting
1000_10 address of the SDRAM accessible memory at 0xFF88_0000.
Reserved. Don’t care.
0
Keeps auto-refresh disabled because registers are being set up
at this time.
Reserved. Don’t care.
00
Indicates a delay of data 1 cycle after SCAS is asserted
Reserved. Don’t care.
011
Command bit is pin 20 and bank selects are 21 and up.
Reserved. Don’t care.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-21
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Table 15-28. DACR Initialization Values (continued)
15.3.4
Bits
Name
Setting
3
IP
0
2–0
—
Description
Indicates precharge has not been initiated.
Reserved. Don’t care.
DMR Initialization
Again, in this example only the second 512-Kbyte block of each 1-Mbyte space is accessed in each bank.
In addition, the SDRAM component is mapped only to readable and writable supervisor and user data. The
DMRs have the following configuration.
31
18
Field
17
BAM
Setting
16
—
0000_0000_0111_01xx
(hex)
0 074
15
9
Field
—
Setting
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WP
—
C/I
AM
SC
SD
UC
UD
V
xxxx_xxx0_x111_0101
(hex)
0075
Figure 15-14. DMR0 Register
With this configuration, the DMR0 = 0x0074_0075, as described in Table 15-29.
Table 15-29. DMR0 Initialization Values
Bits
Name
Setting
Description
31–18
BAM
17–16
—
Reserved. Don’t care.
15–9
—
Reserved. Don’t care.
8
WP
7
—
6
C/I
1
Disable CPU space access.
5
AM
1
Disable alternate master access.
4
SC
1
Disable supervisor code accesses.
3
SD
0
Enable supervisor data accesses.
2
UC
1
Disable user code accesses.
1
UD
0
Enable user data accesses.
0
V
1
Enable accesses.
With bits 17 and 16 as don’t cares, BAM = 0x0074, which leaves bank select bits and upper
512K select bits unmasked. Note that bits 22 and 21 are set because they are used as bank
selects; bit 20 is set because it controls the 1-Mbyte boundary address.
0
Allow reads and writes
Reserved. Don’t care.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-22
Freescale Semiconductor
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
15.3.5
Mode Register Initialization
When DACR[IMRS] is set, a bus cycle initializes the mode register. If the mode register setting is read on
A[10:0] of the SDRAM on the first bus cycle, the bit settings on the corresponding processor address pins
must be determined while being aware of masking requirements.
Table 15-30 lists the desired initialization setting:
Table 15-30. Mode Register Initialization
Processor Pins
SDRAM Pins
Mode Register Initialization
A20
A10
Reserved
X
A19
A9
WB
0
A18
A8
Opmode
0
A17
A7
Opmode
0
A9
A6
CASL
0
A10
A5
CASL
0
A11
A4
CASL
1
A12
A3
BT
0
A13
A2
BL
0
A14
A1
BL
0
A15
A0
BL
0
Next, this information is mapped to an address to determine the hexadecimal value.
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
5
4
3
2
1
0
Field
Setting
xxxx_xxxx_xxxx_000x
(hex)
0000
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
Field
V
Setting
0000_100x_xxxx_xxxx
(hex)
0800
Table 15-31. Mode Register Mapping to A[31:0]
Although A[31:20] corresponds to the address programmed in DACR0, according to how DACR0 and
DMR0 are initialized, bit 19 must be set to hit in the SDRAM. Thus, before the mode register bit is set,
DMR0[19] must be set to enable masking.
15.3.6
Initialization Code
The following assembly code initializes the SDRAM example.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
15-23
Synchronous DRAM Controller Module
Power-Up Sequence:
move.w
move.w
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
#0x0026, d0//Initialize DCR
d0, DCR
#0xFF880300, d0 //Initialize DACR0
d0, DACR0
#0x00740075, d0//Initialize DMR0
d0, DMR0
Precharge Sequence:
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
#0xFF880308, d0//Set DACR0[IP]
d0, DACR0
#0xBEADDEED, d0//Write and value to memory location to init. precharge
d0, 0xFF880000
Refresh Sequence:
move.l
move.l
#0xFF888300, d0//Enable refresh bit in DACR0
d0, DACR0
Mode Register Initialization Sequence:
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
move.l
#0x00600075, d0//Mask bit 19 of address
d0, DMR0
#0xFF888340, d0//Enable DACR0[IMRS]; DACR0[RE] remains set
d0, DACR0
#0x00000000, d0//Access SDRAM address to initialize mode register
d0, 0xFF800800
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
15-24
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 16
DMA Controller Module
This chapter describes the direct memory access (DMA) controller module. It provides an overview of the
module and describes in detail its signals and registers. The latter sections of this chapter describe
operations, features, and supported data transfer modes in detail.
NOTE
The designation “n” is used throughout this section to refer to registers or
signals associated with one of the four identical DMA channels: DMA0,
DMA1, DMA2 or DMA3.
16.1
Overview
The DMA controller module provides an efficient way to move blocks of data with minimal processor
interaction. The DMA module, shown in Figure 16-1, provides four channels that allow byte, word,
longword, or 16-byte burst data transfers. Each channel has a dedicated source address register (SARn),
destination address register (DARn), byte count register (BCRn), control register (DCRn), and status
register (DSRn). Transfers are dual address to on-chip devices, such as UART, SDRAM controller, and
GPIOs.
Channel 0 Channel 1 Channel 2 Channel 3
Internal
Bus
External
Requests
SAR0
SAR1
SAR2
SAR3
DAR0
DAR1
DAR2
DAR3
BCR0
BCR1
BCR2
BCR3
DCR0
DCR1
DCR2
DCR3
DSR0
DSR1
DSR2
DSR3
Channel
Requests
Interrupts
Channel
Attributes
Channel
Enables
System Bus Address
MUX
MUX
Control
System Bus Size
Current Master Attributes
Arbitration/
Control
Data Path
Read Data Bus
Data Path
Control
Write Data Bus
Bus Interface
Registered
Bus Signals
Figure 16-1. DMA Signal Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
16-1
DMA Controller Module
NOTE
Throughout this chapter “external request” and DREQ are used to refer to a
DMA request from one of the on-chip UARTS or DMA timers. For details
on the connections associated with DMA request inputs, see Section 16.2,
“DMA Request Control (DMAREQC).”
16.1.1
DMA Module Features
The DMA controller module features are as follows:
• Four independently programmable DMA controller channels
• Auto-alignment feature for source or destination accesses
• Dual-address transfers
• Channel arbitration on transfer boundaries
• Data transfers in 8-, 16-, 32-, or 128-bit blocks using a 16-byte buffer
• Continuous-mode or cycle-steal transfers
• Independent transfer widths for source and destination
• Independent source and destination address registers
16.2
DMA Request Control (DMAREQC)
The DMAREQC register provides a software-controlled connection matrix for DMA requests. It logically
routes DMA requests from the DMA timers and UARTs to the four channels of the DMA controller.
Writing to this register determines the exact routing of the DMA request to the four channels of the DMA
modules. If DCRn[EEXT] is set and the channel is idle, the assertion of the appropriate DREQn activates
channel n.
31
20
Field
19
—
—
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
15
Field
12
DMAC3
11
16
8
7
DMAC2
4
3
DMAC1
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
0
DMAC0
IPSBAR + 0x014
Figure 16-2. DMA Request Control Register (DMAREQC)
Table 16-1. DMAREQC Field Description
Bits
Name
Description
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
16-2
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Controller Module
Table 16-1. DMAREQC Field Description (continued)
31–16
—
15–0
DMACn
Reserved. Should be cleared.
DMA Channel n. Each four bit field defines the logical connection between the DMA requestors and
that DMA channel. There are seven possible requesters (4 DMA Timers and 3 UARTs). Any request
can be routed to any of the DMA channels. Effectively, the DMAREQC provides a
software-controlled routing matrix of the 7 DMA request signals to the 4 channels of the DMA
module. DMAC3 controls DMA channel 3. DMAC2 controls DMA channel 2. DMAC1 controls DMA
channel 1. DMAC0 controls DMA channel 0.
1000 UART0.
1001 UART1.
1010 UART2.
0100 DMA Timer 0.
0101 DMA Timer 1.
0110 DMA Timer 2.
0111 DMA Timer 3.
All other values are reserved and will not generate a DMA request.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
16-3
DMA Controller Module
16.3
DMA Transfer Overview
The DMA module can transfer data faster than the ColdFire core. The term “direct memory access” refers
to a fast method of moving data within system memory (including memory and peripheral devices) with
minimal processor intervention, greatly improving overall system performance. The DMA module
consists of four independent, functionally equivalent channels, so references to DMA in this chapter apply
to any of the channels. It is not possible to implicitly address all four channels at once.
The processor generates DMA requests internally by setting DCR[START]; the UART modules and DMA
timers can generate a DMA request by asserting internal DREQ signals. The processor can program bus
bandwidth for each channel. The channels support cycle-steal and continuous transfer modes; see
Section 16.5.1, “Transfer Requests (Cycle-Steal and Continuous Modes).”
The DMA controller supports dual-address transfers. The DMA channels support up to 32 data bits.
• Dual-address transfers—A dual-address transfer consists of a read followed by a write and is
initiated by an internal request using the START bit or by asserting DREQ. Two types of transfer
can occur: a read from a source device or a write to a destination device. See Figure 16-3 for more
information.
Control and Data
Memory/
Peripheral
DMA
Control and Data
Memory/
Peripheral
Figure 16-3. Dual-Address Transfer
Any operation involving the DMA module follows the same three steps:
1. Channel initialization—Channel registers are loaded with control information, address pointers,
and a byte-transfer count.
2. Data transfer—The DMA accepts requests for operand transfers and provides addressing and bus
control for the transfers.
3. Channel termination—Occurs after the operation is finished, either successfully or due to an error.
The channel indicates the operation status in the channel’s DSR, described in Section 16.4.5,
“DMA Status Registers (DSR0–DSR3).”
16.4
DMA Controller Module Programming Model
This section describes each internal register and its bit assignment. Note that modifying DMA control
registers during a DMA transfer can result in undefined operation. Table 16-2 shows the mapping of DMA
controller registers. Note the differences for the byte count registers depending on the value of
MPARK[BCR24BIT]. See Section 8.5.3, “Bus Master Park Register (MPARK)” for further information.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
16-4
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Controller Module
Table 16-2. Memory Map for DMA Controller Module Registers
DMA
IPSBAR
Channel Offset
0
Destination address register 0 (DAR0) [p. 16-6]
0x108
DMA control register 0 (DCR0) [p. 16-7]
Byte count register 0 (BCR24BIT = 0) 1
Reserved
0x10C
Reserved
Byte count register 0 (BCR24BIT = 1) 1 (BCR0) [p. 16-7]
0x110
DMA status register 0
(DSR0) [p. 16-10]
Reserved
0x140
Source address register 1 (SAR1) [p. 16-5]
0x144
Destination address register 1 (DAR1) [p. 16-6]
0x148
DMA control register 1 (DCR1) [p. 16-7]
Byte count register 1 (BCR24BIT = 0) 1
Reserved
0x14C
Reserved
Byte count register 1 (BCR24BIT = 1) 1 (BCR1) [p. 16-7]
0x150
DMA status register 1
(DSR1) [p. 16-10]
Reserved
0x180
Source address register 2 (SAR2) [p. 16-5]
0x184
Destination address register 2 (DAR2) [p. 16-6]
0x188
DMA control register 2 (DCR2) [p. 16-7]
Byte count register 2 (BCR24BIT = 0) 1
Reserved
0x18C
Reserved
Byte count register 2 (BCR24BIT = 1) 1 (BCR2) [p. 16-7]
0x190
DMA status register 2
(DSR2) [p. 16-10]
Reserved
0x1C0
Source address register 3 (SAR3) [p. 16-5]
0x1C4
Destination address register 3 (DAR3) [p. 16-6]
0x1C8
DMA control register 3 (DCR3) [p. 16-7]
0x1CC
1
[7:0]
0x104
0x18C
3
[15:8]
Source address register 0 (SAR0) [p. 16-5]
0x14C
2
[23:16]
0x100
0x10C
1
[31:24]
Byte count register 3 (BCR24BIT = 0)1
Reserved
0x1CC
Reserved
Byte count register 3 (BCR24BIT = 1)1 (BCR3) [p. 16-7]
0x1D0
DMA status register 3
(DSR3) [p. 16-10]
Reserved
The DMA module originally supported a left-justified 16-bit byte count register (BCR). This function was later
reimplemented as a right-justified 24-bit BCR. The operation of the DMA and the interpretation of the BCR is controlled
by the MPARK[BCR24BIT]. See Section 8.5.3, “Bus Master Park Register (MPARK)" for more details.
16.4.1
Source Address Registers (SAR0–SAR3)
SARn, shown in Figure 16-4, contains the address from which the DMA controller requests data.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
16-5
DMA Controller Module
31
0
Field
SAR
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000_0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x100, 0x140, 0x180, 0x1C0
Figure 16-4. Source Address Registers (SARn)
NOTE
The backdoor enable bit must be set in both the core and SCM in order to
enable backdoor accesses from the DMA to SRAM. See Section 8.4.2,
“Memory Base Address Register (RAMBAR)” for more details.
NOTE
Flash accesses (reads/writes) by a bus master other than the core (DMA
controller or Fast Ethernet Controller), or writes to Flash by the core during
programming, must use the backdoor Flash address of IPSBAR plus an
offset of 0x0400_0000. For example, for a DMA transfer from the first
Flash location when IPSBAR is still at its default location of 0x4000_0000,
the source register would be loaded with 0x4400_0000. Backdoor Flash
read accesses can be made with the bus master, but it takes two cycles longer
than a direct read of the Flash when using the FLASHBAR address.
16.4.2
Destination Address Registers (DAR0–DAR3)
DARn, shown in Figure 16-5, holds the address to which the DMA controller sends data.
31
0
Field
DAR
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000_0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
Address
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x104, 0x144, 0x184, 0x1C4
Figure 16-5. Destination Address Registers (DARn)
NOTE
The DMA does not maintain coherency with the cache. Therefore, DMAs
should not transfer data to cacheable memory unless software is used to
maintain the cache coherency.
NOTE
The DMA should not be used to write data to the UART transmit FIFO in
cycle steal mode. When the UART interrupt is used as a DMA request it
does not negate fast enough to get a single transfer. The UART transmit
FIFO only has one entry so the data from the second byte would be lost.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
16-6
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Controller Module
16.4.3
Byte Count Registers (BCR0–BCR3)
BCRn, shown in Figure 16-6 and Figure 16-7, hold the number of bytes yet to be transferred for a given
block. The offset within the memory map is based on the value of MPARK[BCR24BIT]. BCRn
decrements on the successful completion of the address transfer of a write transfer. BCRn decrements by
1, 2, 4, or 16 for byte, word, longword, or line accesses, respectively.
Figure 16-6 shows BCRn for BCR24BIT = 1.
31
24 23
0
Field
—
BCR
Reset
—
0000_0000_0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x10C, 0x14C, 0x18C, 0x1CC
Figure 16-6. Byte Count Registers (BCRn)—BCR24BIT = 1
Figure 16-7 shows BCRn for BCR24BIT = 0.
15
0
Field
BCR
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x10C, 0x14C, 0x18C, 0x1CC
Figure 16-7. Byte Count Registers (BCRn)—BCR24BIT = 0
DSRn[DONE], shown in Figure 16-9, is set when the block transfer is complete.
When a transfer sequence is initiated and BCRn[BCR] is not a multiple of 16, 4, or 2 when the DMA is
configured for line, longword, or word transfers, respectively, DSRn[CE] is set and no transfer occurs. See
Section 16.4.5, “DMA Status Registers (DSR0–DSR3).”
16.4.4
DMA Control Registers (DCR0–DCR3)
DCRn, shown in Figure 16-8, is used for configuring the DMA controller module. Note that DCRn[AT] is
available only if MPARK[BCR24BIT] is set. See Section 8.5.3, “Bus Master Park Register (MPARK)” for
more information.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
16-7
DMA Controller Module
31
30
Field INT EEXT
29
28
CS
AA
Reset
27
25
BWC
23
22
—
—
SINC
21
20
SSIZE
19
DINC
18
17
DSIZE
16
START
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
15
Field AT
Reset
24
14
0
1
—
N/A
0
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x108, 0x148, 0x188, 0x1C8
Figure 16-8. DMA Control Registers (DCRn)
1
Available only if BCR24BIT = 1, otherwise reserved.
Table 16-3 describes DCRn fields.
Table 16-3. DCRn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
31
INT
30
EEXT
Enable external request. Care should be taken because a collision can occur between the START bit
and DREQ when EEXT = 1.
0 External request is ignored.
1 Enables external request to initiate transfer. The internal request (initiated by setting the START
bit) is always enabled.
29
CS
Cycle steal.
0 DMA continuously makes read/write transfers until the BCR decrements to 0.
1 Forces a single read/write transfer per request. The request may be internal by setting the START
bit, or external by asserting DREQ.
28
AA
Auto-align. AA and SIZE determine whether the source or destination is auto-aligned, that is,
transfers are optimized based on the address and size. See Section 16.5.4.1, “Auto-Alignment.”
0 Auto-align disabled
1 If SSIZE indicates a transfer no smaller than DSIZE, source accesses are auto-aligned; otherwise,
destination accesses are auto-aligned. Source alignment takes precedence over destination
alignment. If auto-alignment is enabled, the appropriate address register increments, regardless
of DINC or SINC.
Interrupt on completion of transfer. Determines whether an interrupt is generated by completing a
transfer or by the occurrence of an error condition.
0 No interrupt is generated.
1 Internal interrupt signal is enabled.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
16-8
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Controller Module
Table 16-3. DCRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Bits
Name
Description
27–25
BWC
Bandwidth control. Indicates the number of bytes in a block transfer. When the byte count reaches a
multiple of the BWC value, the DMA releases the bus. For example, if BCR24BIT is 0, BWC is 001
(512 bytes or value of 0x0200), and BCR is 0x1000, the bus is relinquished after BCR values of
0x0E00, 0x0C00, 0x0A00, 0x0800, 0x0600, 0x0400, and 0x0200. If BCR24BIT is 0, BWC is 110, and
BCR is 33000, the bus is released after 232 bytes because the BCR is at 32768, a multiple of 16384.
Encoding
000
BCR24BIT = 0
BCR24BIT = 1
DMA has priority and does not negate its
request until transfer completes.
001
512
16384
010
1024
32768
011
2048
65536
100
4096
131072
101
8192
262144
110
16384
524288
111
32768
1048576
24–23
—
22
SINC
Source increment. Controls whether a source address increments after each successful transfer.
0 No change to SAR after a successful transfer.
1 The SAR increments by 1, 2, 4, or 16, as determined by the transfer size.
21–20
SSIZE
Source size. Determines the data size of the source bus cycle for the DMA control module.
00 Longword
01 Byte
10 Word
11 Line (16-byte burst)
19
DINC
Destination increment. Controls whether a destination address increments after each successful
transfer.
0 No change to the DAR after a successful transfer.
1 The DAR increments by 1, 2, 4, or 16, depending upon the size of the transfer.
18–17
16
Reserved, should be cleared.
DSIZE Destination size. Determines the data size of the destination bus cycle for the DMA controller.
00 Longword
01 Byte
10 Word
11 Line (16-byte burst)
START Start transfer.
0 DMA inactive
1 The DMA begins the transfer in accordance to the values in the control registers. START is cleared
automatically after one system clock and is always read as logic 0.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
16-9
DMA Controller Module
Table 16-3. DCRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Bits
Name
Description
15
AT
AT is available only if MPARK[BCR24BIT] = 1.
DMA acknowledge type. Controls whether acknowledge information is provided for the entire transfer
or only the final transfer.
0 Entire transfer. DMA acknowledge information is displayed anytime the channel is selected as the
result of an external request.
1 Final transfer (when BCR reaches zero). For dual-address transfer, the acknowledge information
is displayed for both the read and write cycles.
14–0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
16.4.5
DMA Status Registers (DSR0–DSR3)
In response to an event, the DMA controller writes to the appropriate DSRn bit, Figure 16-9. Only a write
to DSRn[DONE] results in action.
Field
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
CE
BES
BED
—
REQ
BSY
DONE
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x110, 0x150, 0x190, 0x1D0
Figure 16-9. DMA Status Registers (DSRn)
Table 16-4 describes DSRn fields.
Table 16-4. DSRn Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
6
CE
Configuration error. Occurs when BCR, SAR, or DAR does not match the requested transfer size,
or if BCR = 0 when the DMA receives a start condition. CE is cleared at hardware reset or by writing
a 1 to DSR[DONE].
0 No configuration error exists.
1 A configuration error has occurred.
5
BES
Bus error on source
0 No bus error occurred.
1 The DMA channel terminated with a bus error during the read portion of a transfer.
4
BED
Bus error on destination
0 No bus error occurred.
1 The DMA channel terminated with a bus error during the write portion of a transfer.
3
—
2
REQ
Reserved, should be cleared.
Request
0 No request is pending or the channel is currently active. Cleared when the channel is selected.
1 The DMA channel has a transfer remaining and the channel is not selected.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
16-10
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Controller Module
Table 16-4. DSRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Bits
Name
1
BSY
0
DONE
16.5
Description
Busy
0 DMA channel is inactive. Cleared when the DMA has finished the last transaction.
1 BSY is set the first time the channel is enabled after a transfer is initiated.
Transactions done. Set when all DMA controller transactions complete, as determined by transfer
count or error conditions. When BCR reaches zero, DONE is set when the final transfer completes
successfully. DONE can also be used to abort a transfer by resetting the status bits. When a transfer
completes, software must clear DONE before reprogramming the DMA.
0 Writing or reading a 0 has no effect.
1 DMA transfer completed. Writing a 1 to this bit clears all DMA status bits and can be used in an
interrupt handler to clear the DMA interrupt and error bits.
DMA Controller Module Functional Description
In the following discussion, the term “DMA request” implies that DCRn[START] or DCRn[EEXT] is set,
followed by assertion of DREQn. The START bit is cleared when the channel begins an internal access.
Before initiating a dual-address access, the DMA module verifies that DCRn[SSIZE,DSIZE] are
consistent with the source and destination addresses. If they are not consistent, the configuration error bit,
DSRn[CE], is set. If misalignment is detected, no transfer occurs, DSRn[CE] is set, and, depending on the
DCR configuration, an interrupt event is issued. Note that if the auto-align bit, DCRn[AA], is set, error
checking is performed on the appropriate registers.
A read/write transfer reads bytes from the source address and writes them to the destination address. The
number of bytes is the larger of the sizes specified by DCRn[SSIZE] and DCRn[DSIZE]. See
Section 16.4.4, “DMA Control Registers (DCR0–DCR3).”
Source and destination address registers (SARn and DARn) can be programmed in the DCRn to increment
at the completion of a successful transfer.
16.5.1
Transfer Requests (Cycle-Steal and Continuous Modes)
The DMA channel supports internal and external requests. A request is issued by setting DCRn[START]
or by asserting DREQn. Setting DCRn[EEXT] enables recognition of external DMA requests. Selecting
between cycle-steal and continuous modes minimizes bus usage for either internal or external requests.
• Cycle-steal mode (DCRn[CS] = 1)—Only one complete transfer from source to destination occurs
for each request. If DCRn[EEXT] is set, a request can be either internal or external. An internal
request is selected by setting DCRn[START]. An external request is initiated by asserting DREQn
while DCRn[EEXT] is set. Note that multiple transfers will occur if DREQn is continuously
asserted.
• Continuous mode (DCRn[CS] = 0)—After an internal or external request, the DMA continuously
transfers data until BCRn reaches zero or a multiple of DCRn[BWC] or until DSRn[DONE] is set.
If BCRn is a multiple of BWC, the DMA request signal is negated until the bus cycle terminates
to allow the internal arbiter to switch masters. DCRn[BWC] = 000 specifies the maximum transfer
rate; other values specify a transfer rate limit.
The DMA performs the specified number of transfers, then relinquishes bus control. The DMA
negates its internal bus request on the last transfer before BCRn reaches a multiple of the boundary
specified in BWC. On completion, the DMA reasserts its bus request to regain mastership at the
earliest opportunity. The DMA loses bus control for a minimum of one bus cycle.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
16-11
DMA Controller Module
16.5.2
Data Transfer Modes
Each channel supports dual-address transfers, described in the next section.
16.5.2.1
Dual-Address Transfers
Dual-address transfers consist of a source data read and a destination data write. The DMA controller
module begins a dual-address transfer sequence during a DMA request. If no error condition exists,
DSRn[REQ] is set.
• Dual-address read—The DMA controller drives the SARn value onto the internal address bus. If
DCRn[SINC] is set, the SARn increments by the appropriate number of bytes upon a successful
read cycle. When the appropriate number of read cycles complete (multiple reads if the destination
size is larger than the source), the DMA initiates the write portion of the transfer.
If a termination error occurs, DSRn[BES,DONE] are set and DMA transactions stop.
• Dual-address write—The DMA controller drives the DARn value onto the address bus. If
DCRn[DINC] is set, DARn increments by the appropriate number of bytes at the completion of a
successful write cycle. BCRn decrements by the appropriate number of bytes. DSRn[DONE] is set
when BCRn reaches zero. If the BCRn is greater than zero, another read/write transfer is initiated.
If the BCRn is a multiple of DCRn[BWC], the DMA request signal is negated until termination of
the bus cycle to allow the internal arbiter to switch masters.
If a termination error occurs, DSRn[BES,DONE] are set and DMA transactions stop.
16.5.3
Channel Initialization and Startup
Before a block transfer starts, channel registers must be initialized with information describing
configuration, request-generation method, and the data block.
16.5.3.1
Channel Prioritization
The four DMA channels are prioritized in ascending order (channel 0 having highest priority and channel
3 having the lowest) or in an order determined by DCRn[BWC]. If the BWC encoding for a DMA channel
is 000, that channel has priority only over the channel immediately preceding it. For example, if
DCR3[BWC] = 000, DMA channel 3 has priority over DMA channel 2 (assuming DCR2[BWC] ≠ 000)
but not over DMA channel 1.
If DCR0[BWC] = DCR1[BWC] = 000, DMA0 still has priority over DMA1. In this case, DCR1[BWC] =
000 does not affect prioritization.
Simultaneous external requests are prioritized either in ascending order or in an order determined by each
channel’s DCRn[BWC] bits.
16.5.3.2
Programming the DMA Controller Module
Note the following general guidelines for programming the DMA:
• No mechanism exists within the DMA module itself to prevent writes to control registers during
DMA accesses.
• If the DCRn[BWC] value of sequential channels are equal, the channels are prioritized in
ascending order.
The SARn is loaded with the source (read) address. If the transfer is from a peripheral device to memory,
the source address is the location of the peripheral data register. If the transfer is from memory to either a
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
16-12
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Controller Module
peripheral device or memory, the source address is the starting address of the data block. This can be any
aligned byte address.
The DARn should contain the destination (write) address. If the transfer is from a peripheral device to
memory, or from memory to memory, the DARn is loaded with the starting address of the data block to be
written. If the transfer is from memory to a peripheral device, DARn is loaded with the address of the
peripheral data register. This address can be any aligned byte address.
SARn and DARn change after each cycle depending on DCRn[SSIZE,DSIZE, SINC,DINC] and on the
starting address. Increment values can be 1, 2, 4, or 16 for byte, word, longword, or 16-byte line transfers,
respectively. If the address register is programmed to remain unchanged (no count), the register is not
incremented after the data transfer.
BCRn[BCR] must be loaded with the number of byte transfers to occur. It is decremented by 1, 2, 4, or 16
at the end of each transfer, depending on the transfer size. DSRn[DONE] must be cleared for channel
startup.
As soon as the channel has been initialized, it is started by writing a one to DCRn[START] or asserting
DREQn, depending on the status of DCRn[EEXT]. Programming the channel for internal requests causes
the channel to request the bus and start transferring data immediately. If the channel is programmed for
external request, DREQn must be asserted before the channel requests the bus.
Changes to DCRn are effective immediately while the channel is active. To avoid problems with changing
a DMA channel setup, write a one to DSRn[DONE] to stop the DMA channel.
16.5.4
Data Transfer
This section describes auto-alignment and bandwidth control for DMA transfers.
16.5.4.1
Auto-Alignment
Auto-alignment allows block transfers to occur at the optimal size based on the address, byte count, and
programmed size. To use this feature, DCRn[AA] must be set. The source is auto-aligned if DCRn[SSIZE]
indicates a transfer size larger than DCRn[DSIZE]. Source alignment takes precedence over the
destination when the source and destination sizes are equal. Otherwise, the destination is auto-aligned. The
address register chosen for alignment increments regardless of the increment value. Configuration error
checking is performed on registers not chosen for alignment.
If BCRn is greater than 16, the address determines transfer size. Bytes, words, or longwords are transferred
until the address is aligned to the programmed size boundary, at which time accesses begin using the
programmed size.
If BCRn is less than 16 at the start of a transfer, the number of bytes remaining dictates transfer size. For
example, AA = 1, SARn = 0x0001, BCRn = 0x00F0, SSIZE = 00 (longword), and DSIZE = 01 (byte).
Because SSIZE > DSIZE, the source is auto-aligned. Error checking is performed on destination registers.
The access sequence is as follows:
1. Read byte from 0x0001—write 1 byte, increment SARn.
2. Read word from 0x0002—write 2 bytes, increment SARn.
3. Read longword from 0x0004—write 4 bytes, increment SARn.
4. Repeat longwords until SARn = 0x00F0.
5. Read byte from 0x00F0—write byte, increment SARn.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
16-13
DMA Controller Module
If DSIZE is another size, data writes are optimized to write the largest size allowed based on the address,
but not exceeding the configured size.
16.5.4.2
Bandwidth Control
Bandwidth control makes it possible to force the DMA off the bus to allow access to another device.
DCRn[BWC] provides seven levels of block transfer sizes. If the BCRn decrements to a multiple of the
decode of the BWC, the DMA bus request negates until the bus cycle terminates. If a request is pending,
the arbiter may then pass bus mastership to another device. If auto-alignment is enabled, DCRn[AA] = 1,
the BCRn may skip over the programmed boundary, in which case, the DMA bus request is not negated.
If BWC = 000, the request signal remains asserted until BCRn reaches zero. DMA has priority over the
core. Note that in this scheme, the arbiter can always force the DMA to relinquish the bus. See
Section 8.5.3, “Bus Master Park Register (MPARK).”
16.5.5
Termination
An unsuccessful transfer can terminate for one of the following reasons:
• Error conditions—When the processor encounters a read or write cycle that terminates with an
error condition, DSRn[BES] is set for a read and DSRn[BED] is set for a write before the transfer
is halted. If the error occurred in a write cycle, data in the internal holding register is lost.
• Interrupts—If DCRn[INT] is set, the DMA drives the appropriate internal interrupt signal. The
processor can read DSRn to determine whether the transfer terminated successfully or with an
error. DSRn[DONE] is then written with a one to clear the interrupt and the DONE and error bits.
•
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
16-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 17
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.1
Introduction
This chapter provides a feature-set overview, a functional block diagram, and transceiver connection
information for the 10 and 100 Mbps MII (media independent interface), as well as the 7-wire serial
interface. Additionally, detailed descriptions of operation and the programming model are included.
NOTE
The MCF5214 and MCF5216 do NOT contain an FEC module.
17.1.1
Overview
The Ethernet media access controller (MAC) supports 10 and 100 Mbps Ethernet/IEEE 802.3 networks.
An external transceiver interface and transceiver function are required to complete the interface to the
media. The FEC supports three different standard MAC-PHY (physical) interfaces for connection to an
external Ethernet transceiver. The FEC supports the 10/100 Mbps MII and the 10 Mbps-only 7-wire
interface.
NOTE
The GPIO module must be configured to enable the peripheral function of
the appropriate pins (refer to Chapter 26, “General Purpose I/O Module”)
prior to configuring the FEC.
17.1.2
Block Diagram
Figure 17-1 shows the block diagram of the FEC. The FEC is implemented with a combination of
hardware and microcode. The off-chip (Ethernet) interfaces are compliant with industry and IEEE 802.3
standards.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-1
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Internal Bus
Crossbar Switch
Master Bus
Internal Bus
Interface
MIB
Counter RAM
Bus
Controller
Control/Status
Registers
FIFO
RAM
FEC DMA
FIFO
Controller
RAM
Interface
Descriptor
Controller
(RISC +
microcode)
FEC Bus
MII
MDO
MDEN
Transmit
Receive
MDI
I/O
PAD
FEC_MDIO
FEC_MDC
FEC_TXEN
FEC_TXD[3:0]
FEC_TXER
FEC_TXCLK
FEC_CRS
FEC_COL
FEC_RXCLK
FEC_RXDV
FEC_RXD[3:0]
FEC_RXER
MII/7-Wire data
option
Figure 17-1. FEC Block Diagram
The descriptor controller is a RISC-based controller providing these functions in the FEC:
• Initialization (those internal registers not initialized by you or hardware)
• High level control of the DMA channels (initiating DMA transfers)
• Interpreting buffer descriptors
• Address recognition for receive frames
• Random number generation for transmit collision backoff timer
NOTE
DMA references in this section refer to the FEC’s DMA engine. This DMA
engine transfers FEC data only and is not related to the eDMA controller
described in Chapter 16, “DMA Controller Module,” nor to the DMA timers
described in Chapter 21, “DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3).”
The RAM is the focal point of all data flow in the Fast Ethernet controller and divides into transmit and
receive FIFOs. The FIFO boundaries are programmable using the FRSR register. User data flows to/from
the DMA block from/to the receive/transmit FIFOs. Transmit data flows from the transmit FIFO into the
transmit block, and receive data flows from the receive block into the receive FIFO.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
You control the FEC by writing into control registers located in each block. The CSR (control and status
registers) block provides global control (Ethernet reset and enable) and interrupt managing registers.
The MII block provides a serial channel for control/status communication with the external physical layer
device (transceiver). This serial channel consists of the FEC_MDC (management data clock) and
FEC_MDIO (management data input/output) lines of the MII interface.
The FEC DMA block (not to be confused with the device’s eDMA controller) provides multiple channels
allowing transmit data, transmit descriptor, receive data and receive descriptor accesses to run
independently.
The transmit and receive blocks provide the Ethernet MAC functionality (with some assist from
microcode).
The message information block (MIB) maintains counters for a variety of network events and statistics. It
is not necessary for operation of the FEC, but provides valuable counters for network management. The
counters supported are the RMON (RFC 1757) Ethernet Statistics group and some of the IEEE 802.3
counters. See Section 17.4.1, “MIB Block Counters Memory Map,” for more information.
17.1.3
Features
The FEC incorporates the following features:
• Support for three different Ethernet physical interfaces:
— 100-Mbps IEEE 802.3 MII
— 10-Mbps IEEE 802.3 MII
— 10-Mbps 7-wire interface (industry standard)
• IEEE 802.3 full duplex flow control
• Programmable max frame length supports IEEE 802.1 VLAN tags and priority
• Support for full-duplex operation (200 Mbps throughput) with a minimum internal bus clock rate
of 50 MHz
• Support for half-duplex operation (100 Mbps throughput) with a minimum internal bus clock rate
of 50 MHz
• Retransmission from transmit FIFO following a collision (no processor bus utilization)
• Automatic internal flushing of the receive FIFO for runts (collision fragments) and address
recognition rejects (no processor bus utilization)
• Address recognition
— Frames with broadcast address may be always accepted or always rejected
— Exact match for single 48-bit individual (unicast) address
— Hash (64-bit hash) check of individual (unicast) addresses
— Hash (64-bit hash) check of group (multicast) addresses
— Promiscuous mode
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-3
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.2
Modes of Operation
The primary operational modes are described in this section.
17.2.1
Full and Half Duplex Operation
Full duplex mode is for use on point-to-point links between switches or end node to switch. Half duplex
mode works in connections between an end node and a repeater or between repeaters. TCR[FDEN]
controls duplex mode selection.
When configured for full duplex mode, flow control may be enabled. Refer to the
TCR[RFC_PAUSE,TFC_PAUSE] bits, the RCR[FCE] bit, and Section 17.5.11, “Full Duplex Flow
Control,” for more details.
17.2.2
Interface Options
The following interface options are supported. A detailed discussion of the interface configurations is
provided in Section 17.5.6, “Network Interface Options.”
17.2.2.1
10 Mbps and 100 Mbps MII Interface
The IEEE 802.3 standard defines the media independent interface (MII) for 10/100 Mbps operation. The
MAC-PHY interface may be configured to operate in MII mode by setting RCR[MII_MODE].
FEC_TXCLK and FEC_RXCLK pins driven by the external transceiver determine the operation speed.
The transceiver auto-negotiates the speed or software controls it via the serial management interface
(FEC_MDC/FEC_MDIO pins) to the transceiver. Refer to the MMFR and MSCR register descriptions, as
well as the section on the MII, for a description of how to read and write registers in the transceiver via
this interface.
17.2.2.2
10 Mpbs 7-Wire Interface Operation
The FEC supports 7-wire interface used by many 10 Mbps Ethernet transceivers. The RCR[MII_MODE]
bit controls this functionality. If this bit is cleared, MII mode is disabled and the 10 Mbps 7-wire mode is
enabled.
17.2.3
Address Recognition Options
The address options supported are promiscuous, broadcast reject, individual address (hash or exact match),
and multicast hash match. Address recognition options are discussed in detail in Section 17.5.9, “Ethernet
Address Recognition.”
17.2.4
Internal Loopback
Internal loopback mode is selected via RCR[LOOP]. Loopback mode is discussed in detail in
Section 17.5.14, “MII Internal and External Loopback.”
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.3
External Signal Description
Table 17-1 describes the various FEC signals, as well as indicating which signals work in available modes.
Signal Name
MII
7-wire
Table 17-1. FEC Signal Descriptions
FEC_COL
X
X
FEC_CRS
X
— When asserted, indicates that transmit or receive medium is not idle.
FEC_MDC
X
— Output clock which provides a timing reference to the PHY for data transfers on the FEC_MDIO
signal.
FEC_MDIO
X
— Transfers control information between the external PHY and the media-access controller. Data
is synchronous to FEC_MDC. This signal is an input after reset. When the FEC is operated in
10Mbps 7-wire interface mode, this signal should be connected to VSS.
FEC_RXCLK
X
X
Provides a timing reference for FEC_RXDV, FEC_RXD[3:0], and FEC_RXER.
FEC_RXDV
X
X
Asserting the FEC_RXDV input indicates that the PHY has valid nibbles present on the MII.
FEC_RXDV should remain asserted from the first recovered nibble of the frame through to the
last nibble. Assertion of FEC_RXDV must start no later than the SFD and exclude any EOF.
FEC_RXD0
X
X
This pin contains the Ethernet input data transferred from the PHY to the media-access
controller when FEC_RXDV is asserted.
FEC_RXD1
X
— This pin contains the Ethernet input data transferred from the PHY to the media access
controller when FEC_RXDV is asserted.
FEC_RXD[3:2]
X
— These pins contain the Ethernet input data transferred from the PHY to the media access
controller when FEC_RXDV is asserted.
FEC_RXER
X
— When asserted with FEC_RXDV, indicates that the PHY has detected an error in the current
frame. When FEC_RXDV is not asserted FEC_RXER has no effect.
FEC_TXCLK
X
X
Input clock which provides a timing reference for FEC_TXEN, FEC_TXD[3:0] and FEC_TXER.
FEC_TXD0
X
X
The serial output Ethernet data and is only valid during the assertion of FEC_TXEN.
FEC_TXD1
X
— This pin contains the serial output Ethernet data and is valid only during assertion of
FEC_TXEN.
FEC_TXD[3:2]
X
— These pins contain the serial output Ethernet data and are valid only during assertion of
FEC_TXEN.
FEC_TXEN
X
X
FEC_TXER
X
— When asserted for one or more clock cycles while FEC_TXEN is also asserted, the PHY sends
one or more illegal symbols. FEC_TXER has no effect at 10 Mbps or when FEC_TXEN is
negated.
17.4
Description
Asserted upon detection of a collision and remains asserted while the collision persists. This
signal is not defined for full-duplex mode.
Indicates when valid nibbles are present on the MII. This signal is asserted with the first nibble
of a preamble and is negated before the first FEC_TXCLK following the final nibble of the frame.
Memory Map/Register Definition
The FEC is programmed by a combination of control/status registers (CSRs) and buffer descriptors. The
CSRs control operation modes and extract global status information. The descriptors pass data buffers and
related buffer information between the hardware and software.
Each FEC implementation requires a 1-Kbyte memory map space, which is divided into two sections of
512 bytes each for:
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-5
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
•
•
Control/status registers
Event/statistic counters held in the MIB block
Table 17-2 defines the top level memory map.
Table 17-2. Module Memory Map
Address
Function
IPSBAR + 0x1000 – 11FF
Control/Status Registers
IPSBAR + 0x1200 – 12FF
MIB Block Counters
Table 17-3 shows the FEC register memory map.
Table 17-3. FEC Register Memory Map
IPSBAR Offset
Register
Width
Access
(bits)
Reset Value
Section/Page
0x1004
Interrupt Event Register (EIR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
17.4.2/17-9
0x1008
Interrupt Mask Register (EIMR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
17.4.3/17-10
0x1010
Receive Descriptor Active Register (RDAR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
17.4.4/17-11
0x1014
Transmit Descriptor Active Register (TDAR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
17.4.5/17-12
0x1024
Ethernet Control Register (ECR)
32
R/W
0xF000_0000
17.4.6/17-12
0x1040
MII Management Frame Register (MMFR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.7/17-13
0x1044
MII Speed Control Register (MSCR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
17.4.8/17-15
0x1064
MIB Control/Status Register (MIBC)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
17.4.9/17-16
0x1084
Receive Control Register (RCR)
32
R/W
0x05EE_0001
17.4.10/17-16
0x10C4
Transmit Control Register (TCR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
17.4.11/17-17
0x10E4
Physical Address Low Register (PALR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.12/17-18
0x10E8
Physical Address High Register (PAUR)
32
R/W
See Section
17.4.13/17-19
0x10EC
Opcode/Pause Duration (OPD)
32
R/W
See Section
17.4.14/17-19
0x1118
Descriptor Individual Upper Address Register (IAUR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.15/17-20
0x111C
Descriptor Individual Lower Address Register (IALR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.16/17-20
0x1120
Descriptor Group Upper Address Register (GAUR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.17/17-21
0x1124
Descriptor Group Lower Address Register (GALR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.18/17-21
0x1144
Transmit FIFO Watermark (TFWR)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
17.4.19/17-22
0x114C
FIFO Receive Bound Register (FRBR)
32
R
0x0000_0600
17.4.20/17-22
0x1150
FIFO Receive FIFO Start Register (FRSR)
32
R
0x0000_0500
17.4.21/17-23
0x1180
Pointer to Receive Descriptor Ring (ERDSR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.22/17-23
0x1184
Pointer to Transmit Descriptor Ring (ETDSR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.23/17-24
0x1188
Maximum Receive Buffer Size (EMRBR)
32
R/W
Undefined
17.4.24/17-24
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.4.1
MIB Block Counters Memory Map
The MIB counters memory map (Table 17-4) defines the locations in the MIB RAM space where
hardware-maintained counters reside. The counters are divided into two groups:
• RMON counters include the Ethernet statistics counters defined in RFC 1757
• A counter is included to count truncated frames since only frame lengths up to 2047 bytes are
supported
The transmit and receive RMON counters are independent, which ensures accurate network statistics when
operating in full duplex mode.
The included IEEE counters support the mandatory and recommended counter packages defined in
Section 5 of ANSI/IEEE Std. 802.3 (1998 edition). The FEC supports IEEE Basic Package objects, but
these do not require counters in the MIB block. In addition, some of the recommended package objects
supported do not require MIB counters. Counters for transmit and receive full duplex flow control frames
are also included.
Table 17-4. MIB Counters Memory Map
IPSBAR Offset
Register
0x1200
Count of frames not counted correctly (RMON_T_DROP)
0x1204
RMON Tx packet count (RMON_T_PACKETS)
0x1208
RMON Tx broadcast packets (RMON_T_BC_PKT)
0x120C
RMON Tx multicast packets (RMON_T_MC_PKT)
0x1210
RMON Tx packets with CRC/align error (RMON_T_CRC_ALIGN)
0x1214
RMON Tx packets < 64 bytes, good CRC (RMON_T_UNDERSIZE)
0x1218
RMON Tx packets > MAX_FL bytes, good CRC (RMON_T_OVERSIZE)
0x121C
RMON Tx packets < 64 bytes, bad CRC (RMON_T_FRAG)
0x1220
RMON Tx packets > MAX_FL bytes, bad CRC (RMON_T_JAB)
0x1224
RMON Tx collision count (RMON_T_COL)
0x1228
RMON Tx 64 byte packets (RMON_T_P64)
0x122C
RMON Tx 65 to 127 byte packets (RMON_T_P65TO127)
0x1230
RMON Tx 128 to 255 byte packets (RMON_T_P128TO255)
0x1234
RMON Tx 256 to 511 byte packets (RMON_T_P256TO511)
0x1238
RMON Tx 512 to 1023 byte packets (RMON_T_P512TO1023)
0x123C
RMON Tx 1024 to 2047 byte packets (RMON_T_P1024TO2047)
0x1240
RMON Tx packets with > 2048 bytes (RMON_T_P_GTE2048)
0x1244
RMON Tx Octets (RMON_T_OCTETS)
0x1248
Count of transmitted frames not counted correctly (IEEE_T_DROP)
0x124C
Frames transmitted OK (IEEE_T_FRAME_OK)
0x1250
Frames transmitted with single collision (IEEE_T_1COL)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-7
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-4. MIB Counters Memory Map (continued)
IPSBAR Offset
Register
0x1254
Frames transmitted with multiple collisions (IEEE_T_MCOL)
0x1258
Frames transmitted after deferral delay (IEEE_T_DEF)
0x125C
Frames transmitted with late collision (IEEE_T_LCOL)
0x1260
Frames transmitted with excessive collisions (IEEE_T_EXCOL)
0x1264
Frames transmitted with Tx FIFO underrun (IEEE_T_MACERR)
0x1268
Frames transmitted with carrier sense error (IEEE_T_CSERR)
0x126C
Frames transmitted with SQE error (IEEE_T_SQE)
0x1270
Flow control pause frames transmitted (IEEE_T_FDXFC)
0x1274
Octet count for frames transmitted without error (IEEE_T_OCTETS_OK)
0x1280
Count of received frames not counted correctly (RMON_R_DROP)
0x1284
RMON Rx packet count (RMON_R_PACKETS)
0x1288
RMON Rx broadcast packets (RMON_R_BC_PKT)
0x128C
RMON Rx multicast packets (RMON_R_MC_PKT)
0x1290
RMON Rx packets with CRC/Align error (RMON_R_CRC_ALIGN)
0x1294
RMON Rx packets < 64 bytes, good CRC (RMON_R_UNDERSIZE)
0x1298
RMON Rx packets > MAX_FL bytes, good CRC (RMON_R_OVERSIZE)
0x129C
RMON Rx packets < 64 bytes, bad CRC (RMON_R_FRAG)
0x12A0
RMON Rx packets > MAX_FL bytes, bad CRC (RMON_R_JAB)
0x12A4
Reserved (RMON_R_RESVD_0)
0x12A8
RMON Rx 64 byte packets (RMON_R_P64)
0x12AC
RMON Rx 65 to 127 byte packets (RMON_R_P65TO127)
0x12B0
RMON Rx 128 to 255 byte packets (RMON_R_P128TO255)
0x12B4
RMON Rx 256 to 511 byte packets (RMON_R_P256TO511)
0x12B8
RMON Rx 512 to 1023 byte packets (RMON_R_P512TO1023)
0x12BC
RMON Rx 1024 to 2047 byte packets (RMON_R_P1024TO2047)
0x12C0
RMON Rx packets with > 2048 bytes (RMON_R_P_GTE2048)
0x12C4
RMON Rx octets (RMON_R_OCTETS)
0x12C8
Count of received frames not counted correctly (IEEE_R_DROP)
0x12CC
Frames received OK (IEEE_R_FRAME_OK)
0x12D0
Frames received with CRC error (IEEE_R_CRC)
0x12D4
Frames received with alignment error (IEEE_R_ALIGN)
0x12D8
Receive FIFO overflow count (IEEE_R_MACERR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-4. MIB Counters Memory Map (continued)
IPSBAR Offset
17.4.2
Register
0x12DC
Flow control pause frames received (IEEE_R_FDXFC)
0x12E0
Octet count for frames received without error (IEEE_R_OCTETS_OK)
Ethernet Interrupt Event Register (EIR)
When an event occurs that sets a bit in EIR, an interrupt occurs if the corresponding bit in the interrupt
mask register (EIMR) is also set. Writing a 1 to an EIR bit clears it; writing 0 has no effect. This register
is cleared upon hardware reset.
These interrupts can be divided into operational interrupts, transceiver/network error interrupts, and
internal error interrupts. Interrupts which may occur in normal operation are GRA, TXF, TXB, RXF, RXB,
and MII. Interrupts resulting from errors/problems detected in the network or transceiver are HBERR,
BABR, BABT, LC, and RL. Interrupts resulting from internal errors are HBERR and UN.
Some of the error interrupts are independently counted in the MIB block counters:
• HBERR - IEEE_T_SQE
• BABR - RMON_R_OVERSIZE (good CRC), RMON_R_JAB (bad CRC)
• BABT - RMON_T_OVERSIZE (good CRC), RMON_T_JAB (bad CRC)
• LATE_COL - IEEE_T_LCOL
• COL_RETRY_LIM - IEEE_T_EXCOL
• XFIFO_UN - IEEE_T_MACERR
Software may choose to mask off these interrupts because these errors are visible to network management
via the MIB counters.
IPSBAR 0x1004
Offset:
31
R
R
30
29
28
HB
BABR BABT GRA
ERR
W w1c
Reset
Access: User read/write
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
LC
RL
UN
0
0
0
0
0
0
TXF
TXB
RXF
RXB
MII
EB
ERR
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
w1c
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
W
Reset
Figure 17-2. Ethernet Interrupt Event Register (EIR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-9
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-5. EIR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31
Heartbeat error. Indicates TCR[HBC] is set and that the COL input was not asserted within the heartbeat window
HBERR following a transmission.
30
BABR
Babbling receive error. Indicates a frame was received with length in excess of RCR[MAX_FL] bytes.
29
BABT
Babbling transmit error. Indicates the transmitted frame length exceeds RCR[MAX_FL] bytes. Usually this condition
is caused by a frame that is too long is placed into the transmit data buffer(s). Truncation does not occur.
28
GRA
Graceful stop complete. Indicates the graceful stop is complete. During graceful stop the transmitter is placed into a
pause state after completion of the frame currently being transmitted. This bit is set by one of three conditions:
1) A graceful stop initiated by the setting of the TCR[GTS] bit is now complete.
2) A graceful stop initiated by the setting of the TCR[TFC_PAUSE] bit is now complete.
3) A graceful stop initiated by the reception of a valid full duplex flow control pause frame is now complete. Refer
to Section 17.5.11, “Full Duplex Flow Control.”
27
TXF
Transmit frame interrupt. Indicates a frame has been transmitted and the last corresponding buffer descriptor has
been updated.
26
TXB
Transmit buffer interrupt. Indicates a transmit buffer descriptor has been updated.
25
RXF
Receive frame interrupt. Indicates a frame has been received and the last corresponding buffer descriptor has been
updated.
24
RXB
Receive buffer interrupt. Indicates a receive buffer descriptor not the last in the frame has been updated.
23
MII
MII interrupt. Indicates the MII has completed the data transfer requested.
22
EBERR
Ethernet bus error. Indicates a system bus error occurred when a DMA transaction is underway. When the EBERR
bit is set, ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared, halting frame processing by the FEC. When this occurs, software needs to
ensure that the FIFO controller and DMA also soft reset.
21
LC
Late collision. Indicates a collision occurred beyond the collision window (slot time) in half duplex mode. The frame
truncates with a bad CRC and the remainder of the frame is discarded.
20
RL
Collision retry limit. Indicates a collision occurred on each of 16 successive attempts to transmit the frame. The frame
is discarded without being transmitted and transmission of the next frame commences. This error can only occur in
half duplex mode.
19
UN
Transmit FIFO underrun. Indicates the transmit FIFO became empty before the complete frame was transmitted. A
bad CRC is appended to the frame fragment and the remainder of the frame is discarded.
18–0
17.4.3
Reserved, must be cleared.
Interrupt Mask Register (EIMR)
The EIMR register controls which interrupt events are allowed to generate actual interrupts. All
implemented bits in this CSR are read/write. A hardware reset clears this register. If the corresponding bits
in the EIR and EIMR registers are set, an interrupt is generated. The interrupt signal remains asserted until
a 1 is written to the EIR bit (write 1 to clear) or a 0 is written to the EIMR bit.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
IPSBAR 0x1008
Offset:
31
Access: User read/write
30
29
28
R
27
HB
BABR BABT GRA
ERR
W
Reset
R
26
25
24
23
22
LC
RL
UN
0
0
0
TXF
TXB
RXF
RXB
MII
EB
ERR
0
0
0
0
21
20
19
18
17
16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
W
Reset
Figure 17-3. Ethernet Interrupt Mask Register (EIMR)
Table 17-6. EIMR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–19
See
Figure 17-3
and Table 17-5
Interrupt mask. Each bit corresponds to an interrupt source defined by the EIR register. The corresponding
EIMR bit determines whether an interrupt condition can generate an interrupt. At every processor clock, the
EIR samples the signal generated by the interrupting source. The corresponding EIR bit reflects the state of
the interrupt signal even if the corresponding EIMR bit is set.
0 The corresponding interrupt source is masked.
1 The corresponding interrupt source is not masked.
18–0
Reserved, must be cleared.
17.4.4
Receive Descriptor Active Register (RDAR)
RDAR is a command register, written by the user, indicating the receive descriptor ring is updated (the
driver produced empty receive buffers with the empty bit set).
When the register is written, the RDAR bit is set. This is independent of the data actually written by the
user. When set, the FEC polls the receive descriptor ring and processes receive frames (provided
ECR[ETHER_EN] is also set). After the FEC polls a receive descriptor whose empty bit is not set, FEC
clears the RDAR bit and ceases receive descriptor ring polling until the user sets the bit again, signifying
that additional descriptors are placed into the receive descriptor ring.
The RDAR register is cleared at reset and when ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared.
IPSBAR 0x1010
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
24
RDAR
0
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 17-4. Receive Descriptor Active Register (RDAR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-11
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-7. RDAR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–25
Reserved, must be cleared.
24
RDAR
Set to 1 when this register is written, regardless of the value written. Cleared by the FEC device when no additional
empty descriptors remain in the receive ring. Also cleared when ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared.
23–0
Reserved, must be cleared.
17.4.5
Transmit Descriptor Active Register (TDAR)
The TDAR is a command register which the user writes to indicate the transmit descriptor ring is updated
(transmit buffers have been produced by the driver with the ready bit set in the buffer descriptor).
When the register is written, the TDAR bit is set. This value is independent of the data actually written by
the user. When set, the FEC polls the transmit descriptor ring and processes transmit frames (provided
ECR[ETHER_EN] is also set). After the FEC polls a transmit descriptor that is a ready bit not set, FEC
clears the TDAR bit and ceases transmit descriptor ring polling until the user sets the bit again, signifying
additional descriptors are placed into the transmit descriptor ring.
The TDAR register is cleared at reset, when ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared, or when ECR[RESET] is set.
IPSBAR 0x1014
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
24
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
TDAR
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 17-5. Transmit Descriptor Active Register (TDAR)
Table 17-8. TDAR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–25
Reserved, must be cleared.
24
TDAR
Set to 1 when this register is written, regardless of the value written. Cleared by the FEC device when no additional
ready descriptors remain in the transmit ring. Also cleared when ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared.
23–0
Reserved, must be cleared.
17.4.6
Ethernet Control Register (ECR)
ECR is a read/write user register, though hardware may alter fields in this register as well. The ECR
enables/disables the FEC.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
IPSBAR 0x1024
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ETHER
RESET
_EN
W
Reset 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
0
Figure 17-6. Ethernet Control Register (ECR)
Table 17-9. ECR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–2
Reserved, must be cleared.
1
When this bit is set, FEC is enabled, and reception and transmission are possible. When this bit is cleared,
ETHER_EN reception immediately stops and transmission stops after a bad CRC is appended to any currently transmitted
frame. The buffer descriptor(s) for an aborted transmit frame are not updated after clearing this bit. When
ETHER_EN is cleared, the DMA, buffer descriptor, and FIFO control logic are reset, including the buffer descriptor
and FIFO pointers. Hardware alters the ETHER_EN bit under the following conditions:
• ECR[RESET] is set by software, in which case ETHER_EN is cleared
• An error condition causes the EIR[EBERR] bit to set, in which case ETHER_EN is cleared
0
RESET
17.4.7
When this bit is set, the equivalent of a hardware reset is performed but it is local to the FEC. ECR[ETHER_EN]
is cleared and all other FEC registers take their reset values. Also, any transmission/reception currently in progress
is abruptly aborted. This bit is automatically cleared by hardware during the reset sequence. The reset sequence
takes approximately eight internal bus clock cycles after this bit is set.
MII Management Frame Register (MMFR)
The MMFR is user-accessible and does not reset to a defined value. The MMFR register is used to
communicate with the attached MII compatible PHY device(s), providing read/write access to their MII
registers. Performing a write to the MMFR causes a management frame to be sourced unless the MSCR is
programmed to 0. If MSCR is cleared while MMFR is written and then MSCR is written with a non-zero
value, an MII frame is generated with the data previously written to the MMFR. This allows MMFR and
MSCR to be programmed in either order if MSCR is currently zero.
IPSBAR 0x1040
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
W
ST
OP
PA
RA
TA
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-7. MII Management Frame Register (MMFR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-13
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-10. MMFR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–30
ST
Start of frame delimiter. These bits must be programmed to 0b01 for a valid MII management frame.
29–28
OP
Operation code.
00 Write frame operation, but not MII compliant.
01 Write frame operation for a valid MII management frame.
10 Read frame operation for a valid MII management frame.
11 Read frame operation, but not MII compliant.
27–23
PA
PHY address. This field specifies one of up to 32 attached PHY devices.
22–18
RA
Register address. This field specifies one of up to 32 registers within the specified PHY device.
17–16
TA
Turn around. This field must be programmed to 10 to generate a valid MII management frame.
15–0
DATA
Management frame data. This is the field for data to be written to or read from the PHY register.
To perform a read or write operation on the MII Management Interface, write the MMFR register. To
generate a valid read or write management frame, ST field must be written with a 01 pattern, and the TA
field must be written with a 10. If other patterns are written to these fields, a frame is generated, but does
not comply with the IEEE 802.3 MII definition.
To generate an IEEE 802.3-compliant MII Management Interface write frame (write to a PHY register),
the user must write {01 01 PHYAD REGAD 10 DATA} to the MMFR register. Writing this pattern causes
the control logic to shift out the data in the MMFR register following a preamble generated by the control
state machine. During this time, contents of the MMFR register are altered as the contents are serially
shifted and are unpredictable if read by the user. After the write management frame operation completes,
the MII interrupt is generated. At this time, contents of the MMFR register match the original value
written.
To generate an MII management interface read frame (read a PHY register), the user must write {01 10
PHYAD REGAD 10 XXXX} to the MMFR register (the content of the DATA field is a don’t care). Writing
this pattern causes the control logic to shift out the data in the MMFR register following a preamble
generated by the control state machine. During this time, contents of the MMFR register are altered as the
contents are serially shifted and are unpredictable if read by the user. After the read management frame
operation completes, the MII interrupt is generated. At this time, the contents of the MMFR register match
the original value written except for the DATA field whose contents are replaced by the value read from
the PHY register.
If the MMFR register is written while frame generation is in progress, the frame contents are altered.
Software must use the MII interrupt to avoid writing to the MMFR register while frame generation is in
progress.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.4.8
MII Speed Control Register (MSCR)
The MSCR provides control of the MII clock (FEC_MDC pin) frequency and allows a preamble drop on
the MII management frame.
IPSBAR 0x1044
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
7
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DIS_
PRE
W
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
6
5
4
3
2
MII_SPEED
1
0
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 17-8. MII Speed Control Register (MSCR)
Table 17-11. MSCR Field Descriptions
Field
31–8
7
DIS_PRE
Description
Reserved, must be cleared.
Setting this bit causes the preamble (32 ones) not to be prepended to the MII management frame. The MII
standard allows the preamble to be dropped if the attached PHY device(s) does not require it.
6–1
Controls the frequency of the MII management interface clock (FEC_MDC) relative to the internal bus clock. A
MII_SPEED value of 0 in this field turns off the FEC_MDC and leaves it in low voltage state. Any non-zero value results in the
FEC_MDC frequency of 1/(MII_SPEED × 2) of the internal bus frequency.
0
Reserved, must be cleared.
The MII_SPEED field must be programmed with a value to provide an FEC_MDC frequency of less than
or equal to 2.5 MHz to be compliant with the IEEE 802.3 MII specification. The MII_SPEED must be set
to a non-zero value to source a read or write management frame. After the management frame is complete,
the MSCR register may optionally be set to 0 to turn off the FEC_MDC. The FEC_MDC generated has a
50% duty cycle except when MII_SPEED changes during operation (change takes effect following a rising
or falling edge of FEC_MDC).
If the internal bus clock is 25 MHz, programming this register to 0x0000_0005 results in an FEC_MDC
as stated the equation below.
1
25 MHz × ------------ = 2.5 MHz
5×2
Eqn. 17-1
A table showing optimum values for MII_SPEED as a function of internal bus clock frequency is provided
below.
Table 17-12. Programming Examples for MSCR
Internal FEC Clock
Frequency
MSCR[MII_SPEED]
FEC_MDC frequency
25 MHz
0x5
2.50 MHz
33 MHz
0x7
2.36 MHz
40 MHz
0x8
2.50 MHz
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-15
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-12. Programming Examples for MSCR (continued)
17.4.9
Internal FEC Clock
Frequency
MSCR[MII_SPEED]
FEC_MDC frequency
50 MHz
0xA
2.50 MHz
66 MHz
0xE
2.36 MHz
MIB Control Register (MIBC)
The MIBC is a read/write register controlling and observing the state of the MIB block. User software
accesses this register if there is a need to disable the MIB block operation. For example, to clear all MIB
counters in RAM:
1. Disable the MIB block
2. Clear all the MIB RAM locations
3. Enable the MIB block
The MIB_DIS bit is reset to 1. See Table 17-4 for the locations of the MIB counters.
IPSBAR 0x1064
Offset:
31
R
W
Reset
Access: User read/write
30
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MIB_
MIB_ IDLE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
DIS
1
1
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 17-9. MIB Control Register (MIBC)
Table 17-13. MIBC Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31
A read/write control bit. If set, the MIB logic halts and not update any MIB counters.
MIB_DIS
30
A read-only status bit. If set the MIB block is not currently updating any MIB counters.
MIB_IDLE
29–0
Reserved.
17.4.10 Receive Control Register (RCR)
RCR controls the operational mode of the receive block and must be written only when ECR[ETHER_EN]
is cleared (initialization time).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
IPSBAR 0x1084
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31
30
29
28
27
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
26
25
24
23
22
R
0
1
1
19
18
17
16
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
W
Reset
20
MAX_FL
W
Reset
21
FCE
0
BC_
MII_
PROM
DRT LOOP
REJ
MODE
0
0
0
0
1
Figure 17-10. Receive Control Register (RCR)
Table 17-14. RCR Field Descriptions
Field
31–27
26–16
MAX_FL
Description
Reserved, must be cleared.
Maximum frame length. Resets to decimal 1518. Length is measured starting at DA and includes the CRC at the
end of the frame. Transmit frames longer than MAX_FL causes the BABT interrupt to occur. Receive frames longer
than MAX_FL causes the BABR interrupt to occur and sets the LG bit in the end of frame receive buffer descriptor.
The recommended default value to be programmed is 1518 or 1522 if VLAN tags are supported.
15–6
Reserved, must be cleared.
5
FCE
Flow control enable. If asserted, the receiver detects PAUSE frames. Upon PAUSE frame detection, the transmitter
stops transmitting data frames for a given duration.
4
BC_REJ
Broadcast frame reject. If asserted, frames with DA (destination address) equal to FFFF_FFFF_FFFF are rejected
unless the PROM bit is set. If BC_REJ and PROM are set, frames with broadcast DA are accepted and the M
(MISS) is set in the receive buffer descriptor.
3
PROM
2
MII_MODE
Promiscuous mode. All frames are accepted regardless of address matching.
Media independent interface mode. Selects the external interface mode for transmit and receive blocks.
0 7-wire mode (used only for serial 10 Mbps)
1 MII mode
1
DRT
Disable receive on transmit.
0 Receive path operates independently of transmit (use for full duplex or to monitor transmit activity in half duplex
mode).
1 Disable reception of frames while transmitting (normally used for half duplex mode).
0
LOOP
Internal loopback. If set, transmitted frames are looped back internal to the device and transmit output signals are
not asserted. The internal bus clock substitutes for the FEC_TXCLK when LOOP is asserted. DRT must be set to
0 when setting LOOP.
17.4.11 Transmit Control Register (TCR)
TCR is read/write and configures the transmit block. This register is cleared at system reset. Bits 2 and 1
must be modified only when ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-17
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
IPSBAR 0x10C4
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
W
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RFC_
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
PAUSE TFC_ FDEN HBC GTS
PAUSE
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 17-11. Transmit Control Register (TCR)
Table 17-15. TCR Field Descriptions
Field
31–5
Description
Reserved, must be cleared.
4
Receive frame control pause. This read-only status bit is asserted when a full duplex flow control pause frame is
RFC_PAUSE received and the transmitter pauses for the duration defined in this pause frame. This bit automatically clears
when the pause duration is complete.
3
Transmit frame control pause. Transmits a PAUSE frame when asserted. When this bit is set, the MAC stops
TFC_PAUSE transmission of data frames after the current transmission is complete. At this time, GRA interrupt in the EIR
register is asserted. With transmission of data frames stopped, MAC transmits a MAC Control PAUSE frame.
Next, the MAC clears the TFC_PAUSE bit and resumes transmitting data frames. If the transmitter pauses due
to user assertion of GTS or reception of a PAUSE frame, the MAC may continue transmitting a MAC Control
PAUSE frame.
2
FDEN
Full duplex enable. If set, frames transmit independent of carrier sense and collision inputs. This bit should only
be modified when ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared.
1
HBC
Heartbeat control. If set, the heartbeat check performs following end of transmission and the HB bit in the status
register is set if the collision input does not assert within the heartbeat window. This bit should only be modified
when ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared.
0
GTS
Graceful transmit stop. When this bit is set, MAC stops transmission after any frame currently transmitted is
complete and GRA interrupt in the EIR register is asserted. If frame transmission is not currently underway, the
GRA interrupt is asserted immediately. After transmission finishes, clear GTS to restart. The next frame in the
transmit FIFO is then transmitted. If an early collision occurs during transmission when GTS is set, transmission
stops after the collision. The frame is transmitted again after GTS is cleared. There may be old frames in the
transmit FIFO that transmit when GTS is reasserted. To avoid this, clear ECR[ETHER_EN] following the GRA
interrupt.
17.4.12 Physical Address Lower Register (PALR)
PALR contains the lower 32 bits (bytes 0,1,2,3) of the 48-bit address used in the address recognition
process to compare with the DA (destination address) field of receive frames with an individual DA. In
addition, this register is used in bytes 0 through 3 of the 6-byte source address field when transmitting
PAUSE frames. This register is not reset and you must initialize it.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-18
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
IPSBAR 0x10E4
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PADDR1
W
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-12. Physical Address Lower Register (PALR)
Table 17-16. PALR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–0
Bytes 0 (bits 31:24), 1 (bits 23:16), 2 (bits 15:8), and 3 (bits 7:0) of the 6-byte individual address are used for exact
PADDR1 match and the source address field in PAUSE frames.
17.4.13 Physical Address Upper Register (PAUR)
PAUR contains the upper 16 bits (bytes 4 and 5) of the 48-bit address used in the address recognition
process to compare with the DA (destination address) field of receive frames with an individual DA. In
addition, this register is used in bytes 4 and 5 of the 6-byte Source Address field when transmitting PAUSE
frames. Bits 15:0 of PAUR contain a constant type field (0x8808) for transmission of PAUSE frames. The
upper 16 bits of this register are not reset and you must initialize it.
IPSBAR 0x10E8
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
W
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TYPE
PADDR2
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
Figure 17-13. Physical Address Upper Register (PAUR)
Table 17-17. PAUR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–16 Bytes 4 (bits 31:24) and 5 (bits 23:16) of the 6-byte individual address used for exact match, and the source address
PADDR2 field in PAUSE frames.
15–0
TYPE
Type field in PAUSE frames. These 16 read-only bits are a constant value of 0x8808.
17.4.14 Opcode/Pause Duration Register (OPD)
The OPD is read/write accessible. This register contains the 16-bit opcode and 16-bit pause duration fields
used in transmission of a PAUSE frame. The opcode field is a constant value, 0x0001. When another node
detects a PAUSE frame, that node pauses transmission for the duration specified in the pause duration
field. The lower 16 bits of this register are not reset and you must initialize them.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-19
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
IPSBAR 0x10EC
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
OPCODE
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAUSE_DUR
W
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-14. Opcode/Pause Duration Register (OPD)
Table 17-18. OPD Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–16
OPCODE
Opcode field used in PAUSE frames. These read-only bits are a constant, 0x0001.
15–0
Pause Duration field used in PAUSE frames.
PAUSE_DUR
17.4.15 Descriptor Individual Upper Address Register (IAUR)
IAUR contains the upper 32 bits of the 64-bit individual address hash table. The address recognition
process uses this table to check for a possible match with the destination address (DA) field of receive
frames with an individual DA. This register is not reset and you must initialize it.
IPSBAR 0x1118
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
W
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IADDR1
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-15. Descriptor Individual Upper Address Register (IAUR)
Table 17-19. IAUR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–0
The upper 32 bits of the 64-bit hash table used in the address recognition process for receive frames with a unicast
IADDR1 address. Bit 31 of IADDR1 contains hash index bit 63. Bit 0 of IADDR1 contains hash index bit 32.
17.4.16 Descriptor Individual Lower Address Register (IALR)
IALR contains the lower 32 bits of the 64-bit individual address hash table. The address recognition
process uses this table to check for a possible match with the DA field of receive frames with an individual
DA. This register is not reset and you must initialize it.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-20
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
IPSBAR 0x111C
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IADDR2
W
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-16. Descriptor Individual Lower Address Register (IALR)
Table 17-20. IALR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–0
The lower 32 bits of the 64-bit hash table used in the address recognition process for receive frames with a unicast
IADDR2 address. Bit 31 of IADDR2 contains hash index bit 31. Bit 0 of IADDR2 contains hash index bit 0.
17.4.17 Descriptor Group Upper Address Register (GAUR)
GAUR contains the upper 32 bits of the 64-bit hash table used in the address recognition process for
receive frames with a multicast address. You must initialize this register.
IPSBAR 0x1120
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GADDR1
W
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-17. Descriptor Group Upper Address Register (GAUR)
Table 17-21. GAUR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–0
The GADDR1 register contains the upper 32 bits of the 64-bit hash table used in the address recognition process for
GADDR1 receive frames with a multicast address. Bit 31 of GADDR1 contains hash index bit 63. Bit 0 of GADDR1 contains
hash index bit 32.
17.4.18 Descriptor Group Lower Address Register (GALR)
GALR contains the lower 32 bits of the 64-bit hash table used in the address recognition process for
receive frames with a multicast address. You must initialize this register.
IPSBAR 0x1124
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GADDR2
W
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-18. Descriptor Group Lower Address Register (GALR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-21
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-22. GALR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–0
The GADDR2 register contains the lower 32 bits of the 64-bit hash table used in the address recognition process for
GADDR2 receive frames with a multicast address. Bit 31 of GADDR2 contains hash index bit 31. Bit 0 of GADDR2 contains
hash index bit 0.
17.4.19 Transmit FIFO Watermark Register (TFWR)
The TFWR controls the amount of data required in the transmit FIFO before transmission of a frame can
begin. This allows you to minimize transmit latency (TFWR = 00 or 01) or allow for larger bus access
latency (TFWR = 11) due to contention for the system bus. Setting the watermark to a high value
minimizes the risk of transmit FIFO underrun due to contention for the system bus. The byte counts
associated with the TFWR field may need to be modified to match a given system requirement (worst case
bus access latency by the transmit data DMA channel).
IPSBAR 0x1144
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
1
0
TFWR
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
Figure 17-19. Transmit FIFO Watermark Register (TFWR)
Table 17-23. TFWR Field Descriptions
Field
31–2
1–0
TFWR
Description
Reserved, must be cleared.
Number of bytes written to transmit FIFO before transmission of a frame begins
00 64 bytes written
01 64 bytes written
10 128 bytes written
11 192 bytes written
17.4.20 FIFO Receive Bound Register (FRBR)
FRBR indicates the upper address bound of the FIFO RAM. Drivers can use this value, along with the
FRSR, to appropriately divide the available FIFO RAM between the transmit and receive data paths.
IPSBAR 0x114C
Offset:
Access: User read-only
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
1
0
0
0
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
7
6
5
4
R_BOUND
3
2
W
Figure 17-20. FIFO Receive Bound Register (FRBR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-22
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-24. FRBR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–10
Reserved, read as 0 (except bit 10, which is read as 1).
9–2
Read-only. Highest valid FIFO RAM address.
R_BOUND
1–0
Reserved, read as 0.
17.4.21 FIFO Receive Start Register (FRSR)
FRSR indicates the starting address of the receive FIFO. FRSR marks the boundary between the transmit
and receive FIFOs. The transmit FIFO uses addresses from the start of the FIFO to the location four bytes
before the address programmed into the FRSR. The receive FIFO uses addresses from FRSR to FRBR
inclusive.
Hardware initializes the FRSR register at reset. FRSR only needs to be written to change the default value.
IPSBAR 0x1150
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
1
0
0
0
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
W
7
6
5
4
R_FSTART
3
2
Figure 17-21. FIFO Receive Start Register (FRSR)
Table 17-25. FRSR Field Descriptions
Field
31–11
10
Description
Reserved, must be cleared.
Reserved, must be set.
9–2
Address of first receive FIFO location. Acts as delimiter between receive and transmit FIFOs. For proper
R_FSTART operation, ensure that R_FSTART is set to 0x48 or greater.
1–0
Reserved, must be cleared.
17.4.22 Receive Descriptor Ring Start Register (ERDSR)
ERDSR points to the start of the circular receive buffer descriptor queue in external memory. This pointer
must be 32-bit aligned; however, it is recommended it be made 128-bit aligned (evenly divisible by 16).
This register is not reset and must be initialized prior to operation.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-23
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
IPSBAR 0x1180
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
R_DES_START
W
1
0
0
0
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-22. Ethernet Receive Descriptor Ring Start Register (ERDSR)
Table 17-26. ERDSR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–2
Pointer to start of receive buffer descriptor queue.
R_DES_START
1–0
Reserved, must be cleared.
17.4.23 Transmit Buffer Descriptor Ring Start Registers (ETSDR)
ETSDR provides a pointer to the start of the circular transmit buffer descriptor queue in external memory.
This pointer must be 32-bit aligned; however, it is recommended it be made 128-bit aligned (evenly
divisible by 16). You should write zeros to bits 1 and 0. Hardware ignores non-zero values in these two bit
positions.
This register is undefined at reset and must be initialized prior to operation.
IPSBAR 0x1184
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
X_DES_START
W
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-23. Transmit Buffer Descriptor Ring Start Register (ETDSR)
Table 17-27. ETDSR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–2
Pointer to start of transmit buffer descriptor queue.
X_DES_START
1–0
Reserved, must be cleared.
17.4.24 Receive Buffer Size Register (EMRBR)
The EMRBR is a user-programmable register that dictates the maximum size of all receive buffers. This
value should take into consideration that the receive CRC is always written into the last receive buffer. To
allow one maximum size frame per buffer, EMRBR must be set to RCR[MAX_FL] or larger. To properly
align the buffer, EMRBR must be evenly divisible by 16. To ensure this, bits 3–0 are forced low.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-24
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
To minimize bus utilization (descriptor fetches), it is recommended that EMRBR be greater than or equal
to 256 bytes.
The EMRBR register is undefined at reset and must be initialized by the user.
IPSBAR 0x1188
Offset:
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
W
8
7
6
5
R_BUF_SIZE
4
1
0
0 0 0
3
2
0
Reset — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Figure 17-24. Receive Buffer Size Register (EMRBR)
Table 17-28. EMRBR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–11
Reserved, must be cleared.
10–4
Maximum size of receive buffer size in bytes. To minimize bus utilization (descriptor fetches), set this field to 256
R_BUF_SIZE bytes (0x10) or larger.
0x10 256 + 15 bytes (minimum size recommended)
0x11 272 + 15 bytes
...
0x7F 2032 + 15 bytes. The FEC writes up to 2047 bytes in the receive buffer. If data larger than 2047 is
received, the FEC truncates it and shows 0x7FF in the receive descriptor
3–0
17.5
Reserved, must be cleared.
Functional Description
This section describes the operation of the FEC, beginning with the buffer descriptors, the hardware and
software initialization sequence, then the software (Ethernet driver) interface for transmitting and
receiving frames.
Following the software initialization and operation sections are sections providing a detailed description
of the functions of the FEC.
17.5.1
Buffer Descriptors
This section provides a description of the operation of the driver/DMA via the buffer descriptors. It is
followed by a detailed description of the receive and transmit descriptor fields.
17.5.1.1
Driver/DMA Operation with Buffer Descriptors
The data for the FEC frames resides in one or more memory buffers external to the FEC. Associated with
each buffer is a buffer descriptor (BD), which contains a starting address (32-bit aligned pointer), data
length, and status/control information (which contains the current state for the buffer). To permit
maximum user flexibility, the BDs are also located in external memory and are read by the FEC DMA
engine.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-25
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Software produces buffers by allocating/initializing memory and initializing buffer descriptors. Setting the
RxBD[E] or TxBD[R] bit produces the buffer. Software writing to TDAR or RDAR tells the FEC that a
buffer is placed in external memory for the transmit or receive data traffic, respectively. The hardware
reads the BDs and consumes the buffers after they have been produced. After the data DMA is complete
and the DMA engine writes the buffer descriptor status bits, hardware clears RxBD[E] or TxBD[R] to
signal the buffer has been consumed. Software may poll the BDs to detect when the buffers are consumed
or may rely on the buffer/frame interrupts. The driver may process these buffers, and they can return to the
free list.
The ECR[ETHER_EN] bit operates as a reset to the BD/DMA logic. When ECR[ETHER_EN] is cleared,
the DMA engine BD pointers are reset to point to the starting transmit and receive BDs. The buffer
descriptors are not initialized by hardware during reset. At least one transmit and receive buffer descriptor
must be initialized by software before ECR[ETHER_EN] is set.
The buffer descriptors operate as two separate rings. ERDSR defines the starting address for receive BDs
and ETDSR defines the starting address for transmit BDs. The wrap (W) bit defines the last buffer
descriptor in each ring. When W is set, the next descriptor in the ring is at the location pointed to by
ERDSR and ETDSR for the receive and transmit rings, respectively. Buffer descriptor rings must start on
a 32-bit boundary; however, it is recommended they are made 128-bit aligned.
17.5.1.1.1
Driver/DMA Operation with Transmit BDs
Typically, a transmit frame is divided between multiple buffers. An example is to have an application
payload in one buffer, TCP header in a second buffer, IP header in a third buffer, and Ethernet/IEEE 802.3
header in a fouth buffer. The Ethernet MAC does not prepend the Ethernet header (destination address,
source address, length/type field(s)), so the driver must provide this in one of the transmit buffers. The
Ethernet MAC can append the Ethernet CRC to the frame. TxBD[TC], which must be set by the driver,
determines whether the MAC or driver appends the CRC.
The driver (TxBD software producer) should set up Tx BDs so a complete transmit frame is given to the
hardware at once. If a transmit frame consists of three buffers, the BDs should be initialized with pointer,
length, and control (W, L, TC, ABC) and then the TxBD[R] bit should be set in reverse order (third,
second, then first BD) to ensure that the complete frame is ready in memory before the DMA begins. If
the TxBDs are set up in order, the DMA controller could DMA the first BD before the second was made
available, potentially causing a transmit FIFO underrun.
In the FEC, the driver notifies the DMA that new transmit frame(s) are available by writing to TDAR.
When this register is written to (data value is not significant) the FEC, RISC tells the DMA to read the next
transmit BD in the ring. After started, the RISC + DMA continues to read and interpret transmit BDs in
order and DMA the associated buffers until a transmit BD is encountered with the R bit cleared. At this
point, the FEC polls this BD one more time. If the R bit is cleared the second time, RISC stops the transmit
descriptor read process until software sets up another transmit frame and writes to TDAR.
When the DMA of each transmit buffer is complete, the DMA writes back to the BD to clear the R bit,
indicating that the hardware consumer is finished with the buffer.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-26
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.5.1.1.2
Driver/DMA Operation with Receive BDs
Unlike transmit, the length of the receive frame is unknown by the driver ahead of time. Therefore, the
driver must set a variable to define the length of all receive buffers. In the FEC, this variable is written to
the EMRBR register.
The driver (RxBD software producer) should set up some number of empty buffers for the Ethernet by
initializing the address field and the E and W bits of the associated receive BDs. The hardware (receive
DMA) consumes these buffers by filling them with data as frames are received and clearing the E bit and
writing to the L bit (1 indicates last buffer in frame), the frame status bits (if L is set), and the length field.
If a receive frame spans multiple receive buffers, the L bit is only set for the last buffer in the frame. For
non-last buffers, the length field in the receive BD is written by the DMA (at the same time the E bit is
cleared) with the default receive buffer length value. For end-of-frame buffers, the receive BD is written
with L set and information written to the status bits (M, BC, MC, LG, NO, CR, OV, TR). Some of the status
bits are error indicators which, if set, indicate the receive frame should be discarded and not given to higher
layers. The frame status/length information is written into the receive FIFO following the end of the frame
(as a single 32-bit word) by the receive logic. The length field for the end of frame buffer is written with
the length of the entire frame, not only the length of the last buffer.
For simplicity, the driver may assign a large enough default receive buffer length to contain an entire
frame, keeping in mind that a malfunction on the network or out-of-spec implementation could result in
giant frames. Frames of 2K (2048) bytes or larger are truncated by the FEC at 2047 bytes so software never
sees a receive frame larger than 2047 bytes.
Similar to transmit, the FEC polls the receive descriptor ring after the driver sets up receive BDs and writes
to the RDAR register. As frames are received, the FEC fills receive buffers and updates the associated BDs,
then reads the next BD in the receive descriptor ring. If the FEC reads a receive BD and finds the E bit
cleared, it polls this BD once more. If RxBD[E] is clear a second time, FEC stops reading receive BDs
until the driver writes to RDAR.
17.5.1.2
Ethernet Receive Buffer Descriptor (RxBD)
In the RxBD, the user initializes the E and W bits in the first longword and the pointer in the second
longword. When the buffer has been DMA’d, the Ethernet controller modifies the E, L, M, BC, MC, LG,
NO, CR, OV, and TR bits and writes the length of the used portion of the buffer in the first longword. The
M, BC, MC, LG, NO, CR, OV, and TR bits in the first longword of the buffer descriptor are only modified
by the Ethernet controller when the L bit is set.
Offset + 0
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
E
RO1
W
RO2
L
—
—
M
BC
MC
LG
NO
—
CR
OV
TR
Offset + 2
Data Length
Offset + 4
Rx Data Buffer Pointer - A[31:16]
Offset + 6
Rx Data Buffer Pointer - A[15:0]
Figure 17-25. Receive Buffer Descriptor (RxBD)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-27
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-29. Receive Buffer Descriptor Field Definitions
Word
Field
Description
Offset + 0
15
E
Empty. Written by the FEC (=0) and user (=1).
0 The data buffer associated with this BD is filled with received data, or data reception has aborted
due to an error condition. The status and length fields have been updated as required.
1 The data buffer associated with this BD is empty, or reception is currently in progress.
Offset + 0
14
RO1
Offset + 0
13
W
Offset + 0
12
RO2
Offset + 0
11
L
Offset + 0
10–9
Offset + 0
8
M
Miss. Written by the FEC. This bit is set by the FEC for frames accepted in promiscuous mode, but
flagged as a miss by the internal address recognition. Therefore, while in promiscuous mode, you
can use the M-bit to quickly determine whether the frame was destined to this station. This bit is
valid only if the L-bit is set and the PROM bit is set.
0 The frame was received because of an address recognition hit.
1 The frame was received because of promiscuous mode.
Offset + 0
7
BC
Set if the DA is broadcast (FFFF_FFFF_FFFF).
Offset + 0
6
MC
Set if the DA is multicast and not BC.
Offset + 0
5
LG
Rx frame length violation. Written by the FEC. A frame length greater than RCR[MAX_FL] was
recognized. This bit is valid only if the L-bit is set. The receive data is not altered in any way unless
the length exceeds 2047 bytes.
Offset + 0
4
NO
Receive non-octet aligned frame. Written by the FEC. A frame that contained a number of bits not
divisible by 8 was received, and the CRC check that occurred at the preceding byte boundary
generated an error. This bit is valid only if the L-bit is set. If this bit is set, the CR bit is not set.
Offset + 0
3
Offset + 0
2
CR
Receive CRC error. Written by the FEC. This frame contains a CRC error and is an integral number
of octets in length. This bit is valid only if the L-bit is set.
Offset + 0
1
OV
Overrun. Written by the FEC. A receive FIFO overrun occurred during frame reception. If this bit is
set, the other status bits, M, LG, NO, CR, and CL lose their normal meaning and are zero. This bit
is valid only if the L-bit is set.
Offset + 0
0
TR
Set if the receive frame is truncated (frame length > 2047 bytes). If the TR bit is set, the frame must
be discarded and the other error bits must be ignored as they may be incorrect.
Offset + 2
15–0
Data
Length
Data length. Written by the FEC. Data length is the number of octets written by the FEC into this
BD’s data buffer if L equals 0 (the value is equal to EMRBR), or the length of the frame including
CRC if L is set. It is written by the FEC once as the BD is closed.
Receive software ownership. This field is reserved for use by software. This read/write bit is not
modified by hardware, nor does its value affect hardware.
Wrap. Written by user.
0 The next buffer descriptor is found in the consecutive location
1 The next buffer descriptor is found at the location defined in ERDSR.
Receive software ownership. This field is reserved for use by software. This read/write bit is not
modified by hardware, nor does its value affect hardware.
Last in frame. Written by the FEC.
0 The buffer is not the last in a frame.
1 The buffer is the last in a frame.
Reserved, must be cleared.
Reserved, must be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-28
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-29. Receive Buffer Descriptor Field Definitions (continued)
1
Word
Field
Description
0ffset + 4
15–0
A[31:16]
RX data buffer pointer, bits [31:16]1
Offset + 6
15–0
A[15:0]
RX data buffer pointer, bits [15:0]
The receive buffer pointer, containing the address of the associated data buffer, must always be evenly divisible by 16. The
buffer must reside in memory external to the FEC. The Ethernet controller never modifies this value.
NOTE
When the software driver sets an E bit in one or more receive descriptors,
the driver should follow with a write to RDAR.
17.5.1.3
Ethernet Transmit Buffer Descriptor (TxBD)
Data is presented to the FEC for transmission by arranging it in buffers referenced by the channel’s TxBDs.
The Ethernet controller confirms transmission by clearing the ready bit (TxBD[R]) when DMA of the
buffer is complete. In the TxBD, the user initializes the R, W, L, and TC bits and the length (in bytes) in
the first longword and the buffer pointer in the second longword.
The FEC clears the R bit when the buffer is transferred. Status bits for the buffer/frame are not included in
the transmit buffer descriptors. Transmit frame status is indicated via individual interrupt bits (error
conditions) and in statistic counters in the MIB block. See Section 17.4.1, “MIB Block Counters Memory
Map,” for more details.
Offset + 0
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
TO1
W
TO2
L
TC
ABC
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Offset + 2
Data Length
Offset + 4
Tx Data Buffer Pointer - A[31:16]
Offset + 6
Tx Data Buffer Pointer - A[15:0]
Figure 17-26. Transmit Buffer Descriptor (TxBD)
Table 17-30. Transmit Buffer Descriptor Field Definitions
Word
Field
Description
Offset + 0
15
R
Ready. Written by the FEC and you.
0 The data buffer associated with this BD is not ready for transmission. You are free to manipulate
this BD or its associated data buffer. The FEC clears this bit after the buffer has been transmitted
or after an error condition is encountered.
1 The data buffer, prepared for transmission by you, has not been transmitted or currently transmits.
You may write no fields of this BD after this bit is set.
Offset + 0
14
TO1
Transmit software ownership. This field is reserved for software use. This read/write bit is not modified
by hardware nor does its value affect hardware.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-29
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-30. Transmit Buffer Descriptor Field Definitions (continued)
1
Word
Field
Description
Offset + 0
13
W
Offset + 0
12
TO2
Offset + 0
11
L
Last in frame. Written by user.
0 The buffer is not the last in the transmit frame
1 The buffer is the last in the transmit frame
Offset + 0
10
TC
Transmit CRC. Written by user (only valid if L is set).
0 End transmission immediately after the last data byte
1 Transmit the CRC sequence after the last data byte
Offset + 0
9
ABC
Append bad CRC. Written by user (only valid if L is set).
0 No effect
1 Transmit the CRC sequence inverted after the last data byte (regardless of TC value)
Offset + 0
8–0
Reserved, must be cleared.
Offset + 2
15–0
Data
Length
Offset + 4
15–0
A[31:16]
Tx data buffer pointer, bits [31:16]1
Offset + 6
15–0
A[15:0]
Tx data buffer pointer, bits [15:0]
Wrap. Written by user.
0 The next buffer descriptor is found in the consecutive location
1 The next buffer descriptor is found at the location defined in ETDSR.
Transmit software ownership. This field is reserved for use by software. This read/write bit is not
modified by hardware nor does its value affect hardware.
Data length, written by user.
Data length is the number of octets the FEC should transmit from this BD’s data buffer. It is never
modified by the FEC.
The transmit buffer pointer, containing the address of the associated data buffer, must always be evenly divisible by 4. The
buffer must reside in memory external to the FEC. This value is never modified by the Ethernet controller.
NOTE
After the software driver has set up the buffers for a frame, it should set up
the corresponding BDs. The last step in setting up the BDs for a transmit
frame is setting the R bit in the first BD for the frame. The driver must
follow that with a write to TDAR that triggers the FEC to poll the next BD
in the ring.
17.5.2
Initialization Sequence
This section describes which registers are reset due to hardware reset, which are reset by the FEC RISC,
and what locations you must initialize prior to enabling the FEC.
17.5.2.1
Hardware Controlled Initialization
In the FEC, hardware resets registers and control logic that generate interrupts. A hardware reset negates
output signals and resets general configuration bits.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-30
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Other registers reset when the ECR[ETHER_EN] bit is cleared (which is accomplished by a hard reset or
software to halt operation). By clearing ECR[ETHER_EN], configuration control registers such as the
TCR and RCR are not reset, but the entire data path is reset.
Table 17-31. ECR[ETHER_EN] De-Assertion Effect on FEC
17.5.3
Register/Machine
Reset Value
XMIT block
Transmission is aborted (bad CRC
appended)
RECV block
Receive activity is aborted
DMA block
All DMA activity is terminated
RDAR
Cleared
TDAR
Cleared
Descriptor Controller block
Halt operation
User Initialization (Prior to Setting ECR[ETHER_EN])
You need to initialize portions the FEC prior to setting the ECR[ETHER_EN] bit. The exact values depend
on the particular application. The sequence is not important.
Table 17-32 defines Ethernet MAC registers requiring initialization.
Table 17-32. User Initialization (Before ECR[ETHER_EN])
Description
Initialize EIMR
Clear EIR (write 0xFFFF_FFFF)
TFWR (optional)
IALR / IAUR
GAUR / GALR
PALR / PAUR (only needed for full duplex flow control)
OPD (only needed for full duplex flow control)
RCR
TCR
MSCR (optional)
Clear MIB_RAM
Table 17-33 defines FEC FIFO/DMA registers that require initialization.
Table 17-33. FEC User Initialization (Before ECR[ETHER_EN])
Description
Initialize FRSR (optional)
Initialize EMRBR
Initialize ERDSR
Initialize ETDSR
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-31
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-33. FEC User Initialization (Before ECR[ETHER_EN]) (continued)
Description
Initialize (Empty) Transmit Descriptor ring
Initialize (Empty) Receive Descriptor ring
17.5.4
Microcontroller Initialization
In the FEC, the descriptor control RISC initializes some registers after ECR[ETHER_EN] is asserted.
After the microcontroller initialization sequence is complete, hardware is ready for operation.
Table 17-34 shows microcontroller initialization operations.
Table 17-34. Microcontroller Initialization
Description
Initialize BackOff Random Number Seed
Activate Receiver
Activate Transmitter
Clear Transmit FIFO
Clear Receive FIFO
Initialize Transmit Ring Pointer
Initialize Receive Ring Pointer
Initialize FIFO Count Registers
17.5.5
User Initialization (After Setting ECR[ETHER_EN])
After setting ECR[ETHER_EN], you can set up the buffer/frame descriptors and write to TDAR and
RDAR. Refer to Section 17.5.1, “Buffer Descriptors,” for more details.
17.5.6
Network Interface Options
The FEC supports an MII interface for 10/100 Mbps Ethernet and a 7-wire serial interface for 10 Mbps
Ethernet. The RCR[MII_MODE] bit select the interface mode. In MII mode (RCR[MII_MODE] set),
there are 18 signals defined by the IEEE 802.3 standard and supported by the EMAC. Table 17-35 shows
these signals.
Table 17-35. MII Mode
Signal Description
EMAC pin
Transmit Clock
FEC_TXCLK
Transmit Enable
FEC_TXEN
Transmit Data
FEC_TXD[3:0]
Transmit Error
FEC_TXER
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-32
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-35. MII Mode (continued)
Signal Description
EMAC pin
Collision
FEC_COL
Carrier Sense
FEC_CRS
Receive Clock
FEC_RXCLK
Receive Data Valid
FEC_RXDV
Receive Data
FEC_RXD[3:0]
Receive Error
FEC_RXER
Management Data Clock
FEC_MDC
Management Data
Input/Output
FEC_MDIO
The 7-wire serial mode interface (RCR[MII_MODE] cleared) is generally referred to as AMD mode.
Table 17-36 shows the 7-wire mode connections to the external transceiver.
Table 17-36. 7-Wire Mode Configuration
17.5.7
Signal description
EMAC Pin
Transmit Clock
FEC_TXCLK
Transmit Enable
FEC_TXEN
Transmit Data
FEC_TXD[0]
Collision
FEC_COL
Receive Clock
FEC_RXCLK
Receive Data Valid
FEC_RXDV
Receive Data
FEC_RXD[0]
FEC Frame Transmission
The Ethernet transmitter is designed to work with almost no intervention from software. After
ECR[ETHER_EN] is set and data appears in the transmit FIFO, the Ethernet MAC can transmit onto the
network. The Ethernet controller transmits bytes least significant bit (lsb) first.
When the transmit FIFO fills to the watermark (defined by TFWR), MAC transmit logic asserts
FEC_TXEN and starts transmitting the preamble (PA) sequence, the start frame delimiter (SFD), and then
the frame information from the FIFO. However, the controller defers the transmission if the network is
busy (FEC_CRS is asserted). Before transmitting, the controller waits for carrier sense to become inactive,
then determines if carrier sense stays inactive for 60 bit times. If so, transmission begins after waiting an
additional 36 bit times (96 bit times after carrier sense originally became inactive). See Section 17.5.15.1,
“Transmission Errors,” for more details.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-33
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
If a collision occurs during transmission of the frame (half duplex mode), the Ethernet controller follows
the specified backoff procedures and attempts to retransmit the frame until the retry limit is reached. The
transmit FIFO stores at least the first 64 bytes of the transmit frame, so they do not have to be retrieved
from system memory in case of a collision. This improves bus utilization and latency in case immediate
retransmission is necessary.
When all the frame data is transmitted, FCS (frame check sequence) or 32-bit cyclic redundancy check
(CRC) bytes are appended if the TC bit is set in the transmit frame control word. If the ABC bit is set in
the transmit frame control word, a bad CRC is appended to the frame data regardless of the TC bit value.
Following the transmission of the CRC, the Ethernet controller writes the frame status information to the
MIB block. Transmit logic automatically pads short frames (if the TC bit in the transmit buffer descriptor
for the end of frame buffer is set).
Settings in the EIMR determine interrupts generated to the buffer (TXB) and frame (TFINT).
The transmit error interrupts are HBERR, BABT, LATE_COL, COL_RETRY_LIM, and XFIFO_UN. If
the transmit frame length exceeds MAX_FL bytes, BABT interrupt is asserted. However, the entire frame
is transmitted (no truncation).
To pause transmission, set TCR[GTS] (graceful transmit stop). The FEC transmitter stops immediately if
transmission is not in progress; otherwise, it continues transmission until the current frame finishes or
terminates with a collision. After the transmitter has stopped, the GRA (graceful stop complete) interrupt
is asserted. If TCR[GTS] is cleared, the FEC resumes transmission with the next frame.
17.5.7.1
Duplicate Frame Transmission
The FEC fetches transmit buffer descriptors (TxBDs) and the corresponding transmit data continuously
until the transmit FIFO is full. It does not determine whether the TxBD to be fetched is already being
processed internally (as a result of a wrap). As the FEC nears the end of the transmission of one frame, it
begins to DMA the data for the next frame. To remain one BD ahead of the DMA, it also fetches the TxBD
for the next frame. It is possible that the FEC fetches from memory a BD that has already been processed
but not yet written back (it is read a second time with the R bit remains set). In this case, the data is fetched
and transmitted again.
Using at least three TxBDs fixes this problem for large frames, but not for small frames. To ensure correct
operation for large or small frames, one of the following must be true:
• The FEC software driver ensures that there is always at least one TxBD with the ready bit cleared.
• Every frame uses more than one TxBD and every TxBD but the last is written back immediately
after the data is fetched.
• The FEC software driver ensures a minimum frame size, n. The minimum number of TxBDs is
then (Tx FIFO Size ÷ (n + 4)) rounded up to the nearest integer (though the result cannot be less
than three). The default Tx FIFO size is 192 bytes; this size is programmable.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-34
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.5.8
FEC Frame Reception
The FEC receiver works with almost no intervention from the host and can perform address recognition,
CRC checking, short frame checking, and maximum frame length checking. The Ethernet controller
receives serial data lsb first.
When the driver enables the FEC receiver by setting ECR[ETHER_EN], it immediately starts processing
receive frames. When FEC_RXDV is asserted, the receiver first checks for a valid PA/SFD header. If the
PA/SFD is valid, it is stripped and the receiver processes the frame. If a valid PA/SFD is not found, the
frame is ignored.
In serial mode, the first 16 bit times of RX_D0 following assertion of FEC_RXDV are ignored. Following
the first 16 bit times, the data sequence is checked for alternating 1/0s. If a 11 or 00 data sequence is
detected during bit times 17 to 21, the remainder of the frame is ignored. After bit time 21, the data
sequence is monitored for a valid SFD (11). If a 00 is detected, the frame is rejected. When a 11 is detected,
the PA/SFD sequence is complete.
In MII mode, the receiver checks for at least one byte matching the SFD. Zero or more PA bytes may occur,
but if a 00 bit sequence is detected prior to the SFD byte, the frame is ignored.
After the first 6 bytes of the frame are received, the FEC performs address recognition on the frame.
After a collision window (64 bytes) of data is received and if address recognition has not rejected the
frame, the receive FIFO signals the frame is accepted and may be passed on to the DMA. If the frame is a
runt (due to collision) or is rejected by address recognition, the receive FIFO is notified to reject the frame.
Therefore, no collision fragments are presented to you except late collisions, which indicate serious LAN
problems.
During reception, the Ethernet controller checks for various error conditions and after the entire frame is
written into the FIFO, a 32-bit frame status word is written into the FIFO. This status word contains the
M, BC, MC, LG, NO, CR, OV, and TR status bits, and the frame length. See Section 17.5.15.2, “Reception
Errors,” for more details.
Receive buffer (RXB) and frame interrupts (RFINT) may be generated if enabled by the EIMR register. A
receive error interrupt is a babbling receiver error (BABR). Receive frames are not truncated if they exceed
the max frame length (MAX_FL); however, the BABR interrupt occurs and the LG bit in the receive buffer
descriptor (RxBD) is set. See Section 17.5.1.2, “Ethernet Receive Buffer Descriptor (RxBD),” for more
details.
When the receive frame is complete, the FEC sets the L-bit in the RxBD, writes the other frame status bits
into the RxBD, and clears the E-bit. The Ethernet controller next generates a maskable interrupt (RFINT
bit in EIR, maskable by RFIEN bit in EIMR), indicating that a frame is received and is in memory. The
Ethernet controller then waits for a new frame.
17.5.9
Ethernet Address Recognition
The FEC filters the received frames based on destination address (DA) type — individual (unicast), group
(multicast), or broadcast (all-ones group address). The difference between an individual address and a
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-35
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
group address is determined by the I/G bit in the destination address field. A flowchart for address
recognition on received frames appears in the figures below.
Address recognition is accomplished through the use of the receive block and microcode running on the
microcontroller. The flowchart shown in Figure 17-27 illustrates the address recognition decisions made
by the receive block, while Figure 17-28 illustrates the decisions made by the microcontroller.
If the DA is a broadcast address and broadcast reject (RCR[BC_REJ]) is cleared, then the frame is
accepted unconditionally, as shown in Figure 17-27. Otherwise, if the DA is not a broadcast address, then
the microcontroller runs the address recognition subroutine, as shown in Figure 17-28.
If the DA is a group (multicast) address and flow control is disabled, then the microcontroller performs a
group hash table lookup using the 64-entry hash table programmed in GAUR and GALR. If a hash match
occurs, the receiver accepts the frame.
If flow control is enabled, the microcontroller does an exact address match check between the DA and the
designated PAUSE DA (01:80:C2:00:00:01). If the receive block determines the received frame is a valid
PAUSE frame, the frame is rejected. The receiver detects a PAUSE frame with the DA field set to the
designated PAUSE DA or the unicast physical address.
If the DA is the individual (unicast) address, the microcontroller performs an individual exact match
comparison between the DA and 48-bit physical address that you program in the PALR and PAUR
registers. If an exact match occurs, the frame is accepted; otherwise, the microcontroller does an individual
hash table lookup using the 64-entry hash table programmed in registers, IAUR and IALR. In the case of
an individual hash match, the frame is accepted. Again, the receiver accepts or rejects the frame based on
PAUSE frame detection, shown in Figure 17-27.
If neither a hash match (group or individual) nor an exact match (group or individual) occur, and if
promiscuous mode is enabled (RCR[PROM] set), the frame is accepted and the MISS bit in the receive
buffer descriptor is set; otherwise, the frame is rejected.
Similarly, if the DA is a broadcast address, broadcast reject (RCR[BC_REJ]) is asserted, and promiscuous
mode is enabled, the frame is accepted and the MISS bit in the receive buffer descriptor is set; otherwise,
the frame is rejected.
In general, when a frame is rejected, it is flushed from the FIFO.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-36
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Accept/Reject
Frame
True
Broadcast Addr
?
False
Receive
Address
Recognition
False
Receive Frame
Set BC bit in RCV BD
True
Hash Match
?
BC_REJ = 1
?
False
True
Receive Frame
Set MC bit in RCV BD if multicast
Exact Match
?
True
False
True
Pause Frame
?
False
Reject Frame
Flush from FIFO
Notes:
BC_REJ - field in RCR register (BroadCast REJect)
PROM - field in RCR register (PROMiscous mode)
Pause Frame - valid PAUSE frame received
PROM = 1
?
True
Receive Frame
Set M (Miss) bit in Rcv BD
Set MC bit in Rcv BD if multicast
Set BC bit in Rcv BD if broadcast
False
Reject Frame
Flush from FIFO
Receive Frame
Figure 17-27. Ethernet Address Recognition—Receive Block Decisions
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-37
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Receive Address
Recognition
Group
False
Individual
False
True
FCE
?
False
I/G Address
?
Pause Address
?
Exact Match
?
True
Hash Search
Individual Table
Receive Frame
Receive Frame
Hash Search
Group Table
Match
?
True
False
Receive Frame
Reject Frame
Flush from FIFO
True
True
Match
?
False
Receive Frame
Reject Frame
Notes:
Flush from FIFO
FCE - field in RCR register (flow control enable)
I/G - Individual/Group bit in destination address (lsb in first byte received in MAC frame)
Figure 17-28. Ethernet Address Recognition—Microcode Decisions
17.5.10 Hash Algorithm
The hash table algorithm used in the group and individual hash filtering operates as follows. The 48-bit
destination address is mapped into one of 64 bits, represented by 64 bits stored in GAUR, GALR (group
address hash match), or IAUR, IALR (individual address hash match). This mapping is performed by
passing the 48-bit address through the on-chip 32-bit CRC generator and selecting the six most significant
bits of the CRC-encoded result to generate a number between 0 and 63. The msb of the CRC result selects
GAUR (msb = 1) or GALR (msb = 0). The five least significant bits of the hash result select the bit within
the selected register. If the CRC generator selects a bit set in the hash table, the frame is accepted;
otherwise, it is rejected.
For example, if eight group addresses are stored in the hash table and random group addresses are received,
the hash table prevents roughly 56/64 (87.5%) of the group address frames from reaching memory. Those
that do reach memory must be further filtered by the processor to determine if they truly contain one of the
eight desired addresses.
The effectiveness of the hash table declines as the number of addresses increases.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-38
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
The user must initialize the hash table registers. Use this CRC32 polynomial to compute the hash:
X 32 + X 26 + X 23 + X 22 + X 16 + X 12 + X 11 + X 10 + X 8 + X 7 + X 5 + X 4 + X 2 + X + 1
Eqn. 17-2
Table 17-37 contains example destination addresses and corresponding hash values.
Table 17-37. Destination Address to 6-Bit Hash
48-bit DA
6-bit Hash
(in hex)
Hash Decimal
Value
65FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x0
0
55FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x1
1
15FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x2
2
35FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x3
3
B5FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x4
4
95FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x5
5
D5FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x6
6
F5FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x7
7
DBFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x8
8
FBFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x9
9
BBFF_FFFF_FFFF
0xA
10
8BFF_FFFF_FFFF
0xB
11
0BFF_FFFF_FFFF
0xC
12
3BFF_FFFF_FFFF
0xD
13
7BFF_FFFF_FFFF
0xE
14
5BFF_FFFF_FFFF
0xF
15
27FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x10
16
07FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x11
17
57FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x12
18
77FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x13
19
F7FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x14
20
C7FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x15
21
97FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x16
22
A7FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x17
23
99FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x18
24
B9FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x19
25
F9FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x1A
26
C9FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x1B
27
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-39
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-37. Destination Address to 6-Bit Hash (continued)
48-bit DA
6-bit Hash
(in hex)
Hash Decimal
Value
59FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x1C
28
79FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x1D
29
29FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x1E
30
19FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x1F
31
D1FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x20
32
F1FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x21
33
B1FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x22
34
91FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x23
35
11FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x24
36
31FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x25
37
71FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x26
38
51FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x27
39
7FFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x28
40
4FFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x29
41
1FFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x2A
42
3FFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x2B
43
BFFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x2C
44
9FFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x2D
45
DFFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x2E
46
EFFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x2F
47
93FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x30
48
B3FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x31
49
F3FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x32
50
D3FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x33
51
53FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x34
52
73FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x35
53
23FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x36
54
13FF_FFFF_FFFF
0x37
55
3DFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x38
56
0DFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x39
57
5DFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x3A
58
7DFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x3B
59
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-40
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
Table 17-37. Destination Address to 6-Bit Hash (continued)
48-bit DA
6-bit Hash
(in hex)
Hash Decimal
Value
FDFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x3C
60
DDFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x3D
61
9DFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x3E
62
BDFF_FFFF_FFFF
0x3F
63
17.5.11 Full Duplex Flow Control
Full-duplex flow control allows you to transmit pause frames and to detect received pause frames. Upon
detection of a pause frame, MAC data frame transmission stops for a given pause duration.
To enable PAUSE frame detection, the FEC must operate in full-duplex mode (TCR[FDEN] set) with flow
control (RCR[FCE] set). The FEC detects a pause frame when the fields of the incoming frame match the
pause frame specifications, as shown in Table 17-38. In addition, the receive status associated with the
frame should indicate that the frame is valid.
Table 17-38. PAUSE Frame Field Specification
48-bit Destination Address
0x0180_C200_0001 or Physical Address
48-bit Source Address
Any
16-bit Type
0x8808
16-bit Opcode
0x0001
16-bit PAUSE Duration
0x0000 – 0xFFFF
The receiver and microcontroller modules perform PAUSE frame detection. The microcontroller runs an
address recognition subroutine to detect the specified pause frame destination address, while the receiver
detects the type and opcode pause frame fields. On detection of a pause frame, TCR[GTS] is set by the
FEC internally. When transmission has paused, the EIR[GRA] interrupt is asserted and the pause timer
begins to increment. The pause timer uses the transmit backoff timer hardware for tracking the appropriate
collision backoff time in half-duplex mode. The pause timer increments once every slot time, until
OPD[PAUSE_DUR] slot times have expired. On OPD[PAUSE_DUR] expiration, TCR[GTS] is cleared
allowing MAC data frame transmission to resume. The receive flow control pause status bit
(TCR[RFC_PAUSE]) is set while the transmitter pauses due to reception of a pause frame.
To transmit a pause frame, the FEC must operate in full-duplex mode and you must set flow control pause
(TCR[TFC_PAUSE]). After TCR[TFC_PAUSE] is set, the transmitter sets TCR[GTS] internally. When
the transmission of data frames stops, the EIR[GRA] (graceful stop complete) interrupt asserts and the
pause frame is transmitted. TCR[TFC_PAUSE,GTS] are then cleared internally.
You must specify the desired pause duration in the OPD register.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-41
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
When the transmitter pauses due to receiver/microcontroller pause frame detection, TCR[TFC_PAUSE]
may remain set and cause the transmission of a single pause frame. In this case, the EIR[GRA] interrupt
is not asserted.
17.5.12 Inter-Packet Gap (IPG) Time
The minimum inter-packet gap time for back-to-back transmission is 96 bit times. After completing a
transmission or after the backoff algorithm completes, the transmitter waits for carrier sense to be negated
before starting its 96 bit time IPG counter. Frame transmission may begin 96 bit times after carrier sense
is negated if it stays negated for at least 60 bit times. If carrier sense asserts during the last 36 bit times, it
is ignored and a collision occurs.
The receiver accepts back-to-back frames with a minimum spacing of at least 28 bit times. If an
inter-packet gap between receive frames is less than 28 bit times, the receiver may discard the following
frame.
17.5.13 Collision Managing
If a collision occurs during frame transmission, the Ethernet controller continues the transmission for at
least 32 bit times, transmitting a JAM pattern consisting of 32 ones. If the collision occurs during the
preamble sequence, a JAM pattern is sent after the end of the preamble sequence.
If a collision occurs within 512 bit times (one slot time), the retry process is initiated. The transmitter waits
a random number of slot times. If a collision occurs after 512 bit times, then no retransmission is performed
and the end of frame buffer is closed with a Late Collision (LC) error indication.
17.5.14 MII Internal and External Loopback
Internal and external loopback are supported by the Ethernet controller. In loopback mode, both of the
FIFOs are used and the FEC actually operates in a full-duplex fashion. Internal and external loopback are
configured using combinations of the RCR[LOOP, DRT] and TCR[FDEN] bits.
Set FDEN for internal and external loopback.
For internal loopback, set RCR[LOOP] and clear RCR[DRT]. FEC_TXEN and FEC_TXER do not assert
during internal loopback. During internal loopback, the transmit/receive data rate is higher than in normal
operation because the transmit and receive blocks use the internal bus clock instead of the clocks from the
external transceiver. This causes an increase in the required system bus bandwidth for transmit and receive
data being DMA’d to/from external memory. It may be necessary to pace the frames on the transmit side
and/or limit the size of the frames to prevent transmit FIFO underruns and receive FIFO overflows.
For external loopback, clear RCR[LOOP] and RCR[DRT], and configure the external transceiver for
loopback.
17.5.15 Ethernet Error-Managing Procedure
The Ethernet controller reports frame reception and transmission error conditions using the MIB block
counters, the FEC RxBDs, and the EIR register.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-42
Freescale Semiconductor
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.5.15.1 Transmission Errors
17.5.15.1.1 Transmitter Underrun
If this error occurs, the FEC sends 32 bits that ensure a CRC error and stops transmitting. All remaining
buffers for that frame are then flushed and closed, and EIR[UN] is set. The FEC then continues to the next
transmit buffer descriptor and begin transmitting the next frame. The UN interrupt is asserted if enabled
in the EIMR register.
17.5.15.1.2 Retransmission Attempts Limit Expired
When this error occurs, the FEC terminates transmission. All remaining buffers for that frame are flushed
and closed, and EIR[RL] is set. The FEC then continues to the next transmit buffer descriptor and begins
transmitting the next frame. The RL interrupt is asserted if enabled in the EIMR register.
17.5.15.1.3 Late Collision
When a collision occurs after the slot time (512 bits starting at the Preamble), the FEC terminates
transmission. All remaining buffers for that frame are flushed and closed, and EIR[LC] is set. The FEC
then continues to the next transmit buffer descriptor and begin transmitting the next frame. The LC
interrupt is asserted if enabled in the EIMR register.
17.5.15.1.4 Heartbeat
Some transceivers have a self-test feature called heartbeat or signal quality error. To signify a good
self-test, the transceiver indicates a collision to the FEC within four microseconds after completion of a
frame transmitted by the Ethernet controller. This indication of a collision does not imply a real collision
error on the network, but is rather an indication that the transceiver continues to function properly. This is
the heartbeat condition.
If TCR[HBC] is set and the heartbeat condition is not detected by the FEC after a frame transmission, a
heartbeat error occurs. When this error occurs, the FEC closes the buffer, sets EIR[HB], and generates the
HBERR interrupt if it is enabled.
17.5.15.2 Reception Errors
17.5.15.2.1 Overrun Error
If the receive block has data to put into the receive FIFO and the receive FIFO is full, FEC sets RxBD[OV].
All subsequent data in the frame is discarded and subsequent frames may also be discarded until the
receive FIFO is serviced by the DMA and space is made available. At this point the receive frame/status
word is written into the FIFO with the OV bit set. The driver must discard this frame.
17.5.15.2.2 Non-Octet Error (Dribbling Bits)
The Ethernet controller manages up to seven dribbling bits when the receive frame terminates past an
non-octet aligned boundary. Dribbling bits are not used in the CRC calculation. If there is a CRC error, the
frame non-octet aligned (NO) error is reported in the RxBD. If there is no CRC error, no error is reported.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
17-43
Fast Ethernet Controller (FEC)
17.5.15.2.3 CRC Error
When a CRC error occurs with no dribble bits, FEC closes the buffer and sets RxBD[CR]. CRC checking
cannot be disabled, but the CRC error can be ignored if checking is not required.
17.5.15.2.4 Frame Length Violation
When the receive frame length exceeds MAX_FL bytes the BABR interrupt is generated, and RxBD[LG]
is set. The frame is not truncated unless the frame length exceeds 2047 bytes.
17.5.15.2.5 Truncation
When the receive frame length exceeds 2047 bytes, frame is truncated and RxBD[TR] is set.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
17-44
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 18
Watchdog Timer Module
18.1
Introduction
The watchdog timer is a 16-bit timer used to help software recover from runaway code. The watchdog
timer has a free-running down-counter (watchdog counter) that generates a reset on underflow. To prevent
a reset, software must periodically restart the countdown by servicing the watchdog.
18.2
Low-Power Mode Operation
This subsection describes the operation of the watchdog module in low-power modes and halted mode of
operation. Low-power modes are described in Chapter 7, “Power Management.” Table 3-1 shows the
watchdog module operation in the low-power modes, and shows how this module may facilitate exit from
each mode.
Table 18-1. Watchdog Module Operation in Low-power Modes
Low-power Mode
Watchdog Operation
Wait
Normal if WCR[WAIT] cleared,
stopped otherwise
Upon Watchdog reset
Doze
Normal if WCR[DOZE] cleared,
stopped otherwise
Upon Watchdog reset
Stop
Stopped
Halted
Mode Exit
No
Normal if WCR[HALTED] cleared, Upon Watchdog reset
stopped otherwise
In wait mode with the watchdog control register’s WAIT bit (WCR[WAIT]) set, watchdog timer operation
stops. In wait mode with the WCR[WAIT] bit cleared, the watchdog timer continues to operate normally.
In doze mode with the WCR[DOZE] bit set, the watchdog timer module operation stops. In doze mode
with the WCR[DOZE] bit cleared, the watchdog timer continues to operate normally. Watchdog timer
operation stops in stop mode. When stop mode is exited, the watchdog timer continues to operate in its
pre-stop mode state.
In halted mode with the WCR[HALTED] bit set, watchdog timer module operation stops. In halted mode
with the WCR[HALTED] bit cleared, the watchdog timer continues to operate normally. When halted
mode is exited, watchdog timer operation continues from the state it was in before entering halted mode,
but any updates made in halted mode remain.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
18-1
Watchdog Timer Module
18.3
Block Diagram
IPBUS
16-bit WCNTR
System
Clock
16-bit WSR
Count = 0
Divide by
8192
16-bit Watchdog Counter
EN
Reset
Load Counter
WAIT
DOZE
16-bit WMR
HALTED
IPBUS
Figure 18-1. Watchdog Timer Block Diagram
18.4
Signals
The watchdog timer module has no off-chip signals.
18.5
Memory Map and Registers
This subsection describes the memory map and registers for the watchdog timer. The watchdog timer has
a IPSBAR offset for base address of 0x0014_0000.
18.5.1
Memory Map
Refer to Table 18-2 for an overview of the watchdog memory map.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
18-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Watchdog Timer Module
Table 18-2. Watchdog Timer Module Memory Map
IPSBAR Offset
1
18.5.2
Bits 15–8
Access1
Bits 7–0
0x0014_0000
Watchdog Control Register (WCR)
S
0x0014_0002
Watchdog Modulus Register (WMR)
S
0x0014_0004
Watchdog Count Register (WCNTR)
S/U
0x0014_0006
Watchdog Service Register (WSR)
S/U
S = CPU supervisor mode access only. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User
mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination
transfer error.
Registers
The watchdog timer programming model consists of these registers:
• Watchdog control register (WCR), which configures watchdog timer operation
• Watchdog modulus register (WMR), which determines the timer modulus
reload value
• Watchdog count register (WCNTR), which provides visibility to the watchdog counter value
• Watchdog service register (WSR), which requires a service sequence to
prevent reset
18.5.2.1
Watchdog Control Register (WCR)
The 16-bit WCR configures watchdog timer operation.
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
WAIT
DOZE
HALTED
EN
Field
—
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R
7
Field
6
5
—
Reset
R/W
Address
4
0000_1111
R
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x0014_0000, 0x0014_0001
Figure 18-2. Watchdog Control Register (WCR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
18-3
Watchdog Timer Module
Table 18-3. WCR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
15–4
—
3
WAIT
Wait mode bit. Controls the function of the watchdog timer in wait mode. Once written,
the WAIT bit is not affected by further writes except in halted mode. Reset sets WAIT.
1 Watchdog timer stopped in wait mode
0 Watchdog timer not affected in wait mode
2
DOZE
Doze mode bit. Controls the function of the watchdog timer in doze mode. Once
written, the DOZE bit is not affected by further writes except in halted mode. Reset
sets DOZE.
1 Watchdog timer stopped in doze mode
0 Watchdog timer not affected in doze mode
1
HALTED
Halted mode bit. Controls the function of the watchdog timer in halted mode. Once
written, the HALTED bit is not affected by further writes except in halted mode.
During halted mode, watchdog timer registers can be written and read normally. When
halted mode is exited, timer operation continues from the state it was in before
entering halted mode, but any updates made in halted mode remain. If a write-once
register is written for the first time in halted mode, the register is still writable when
halted mode is exited.
1 Watchdog timer stopped in halted mode
0 Watchdog timer not affected in halted mode
Note: Changing the HALTED bit from 1 to 0 during halted mode starts the watchdog
timer. Changing the HALTED bit from 0 to 1 during halted mode stops the watchdog
timer.
0
EN
Watchdog enable bit. Enables the watchdog timer. Once written, the EN bit is not
affected by further writes except in halted mode. When the watchdog timer is disabled,
the watchdog counter and prescaler counter are held in a stopped state.
1 Watchdog timer enabled
0 Watchdog timer disabled
18.5.2.2
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Watchdog Modulus Register (WMR)
Field
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
WM15
WM14
WM13
WM12
WM11
WM10
WM9
WM8
Reset
1111_1111
R/W
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WM7
WM6
WM5
WM4
WM3
WM2
WM1
WM0
1111_1111
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x0014_0002, 0x0014_0003
Figure 18-3. Watchdog Modulus Register (WMR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
18-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Watchdog Timer Module
Table 18-4. WMR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
15–0
WM
Watchdog modulus. Contains the modulus that is reloaded into the watchdog counter
by a service sequence. Once written, the WM[15:0] field is not affected by further
writes except in halted mode. Writing to WMR immediately loads the new modulus
value into the watchdog counter. The new value is also used at the next and all
subsequent reloads. Reading WMR returns the value in the modulus register.
Reset initializes the WM[15:0] field to 0xFFFF.
Note: The prescaler counter is reset anytime a new value is loaded into the watchdog
counter and also during reset.
18.5.2.3
Watchdog Count Register (WCNTR)
Field
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
WC15
WC14
WC13
WC12
WC11
WC10
WC9
WC8
Reset
1111_1111
R/W
Field
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WC7
WC6
WC5
WC4
WC3
WC2
WC1
WC0
Reset
1111_1111
R/W
R
Address
IPSBAR + x0014_0004, 0x0014_0005
Figure 18-4. Watchdog Count Register (WCNTR)
Table 18-5. WCNTR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
15–0
WC
Watchdog count field. Reflects the current value in the watchdog counter. Reading the
16-bit WCNTR with two 8-bit reads is not guaranteed to return a coherent value.
Writing to WCNTR has no effect, and write cycles are terminated normally.
18.5.2.4
Watchdog Service Register (WSR)
When the watchdog timer is enabled, writing 0x5555 and then 0xAAAA to WSR before the watchdog
counter times out prevents a reset. If WSR is not serviced before the timeout, the watchdog timer sends a
signal to the reset controller module that sets the RSR[WDR] bit and asserts a system reset.
Both writes must occur in the order listed before the timeout, but any number of instructions can be
executed between the two writes. However, writing any value other than 0x5555 or 0xAAAA to WSR
resets the servicing sequence, requiring both values to be written to keep the watchdog timer from causing
a reset.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
18-5
Watchdog Timer Module
Field
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
WS15
WS14
WS13
WS12
WS11
WS10
WS9
WS8
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WS7
WS6
WS5
WS4
WS3
WS2
WS1
WS0
0000_0000
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x0014_0006, 0x0014_0007
Figure 18-5. Watchdog Service Register (WSR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
18-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 19
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
19.1
Introduction
This chapter describes the operation of the four programmable interrupt timer modules: PIT0–PIT3.
19.1.1
Overview
Each PIT is a 16-bit timer that provides precise interrupts at regular intervals with minimal processor
intervention. The timer can count down from the value written in the modulus register or it can be a
free-running down-counter.
19.1.2
Block Diagram
Internal Bus
16-bit PCNTRn
Internal Bus
Clock (fsys)
Prescaler
16-bit PIT Counter
COUNT = 0
PIF
To Interrupt
Controller
Load
Counter
EN
PRE[3:0]
PIE
OVW
RLD
DOZE
DBG
16-bit PMRn
Internal Bus
Figure 19-1. PIT Block Diagram
19.1.3
Low-Power Mode Operation
This subsection describes the operation of the PIT modules in low-power modes and debug mode of
operation. Low-power modes are described in the power management module, Chapter 7, “Power
Management.” Table 19-1 shows the PIT module operation in low-power modes and how it can exit from
each mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
19-1
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
NOTE
The low-power interrupt control register (LPICR) in the system control
module specifies the interrupt level at or above which the device can be
brought out of a low-power mode.
Table 19-1. PIT Module Operation in Low-power Modes
Low-power Mode
PIT Operation
Wait
Normal
Doze
Mode Exit
N/A
Normal if PCSRn[DOZE] cleared, Any interrupt at or above level in LPICR, exit doze
stopped otherwise
mode if PCSRn[DOZE] is set. Otherwise
interrupt assertion has no effect.
Stop
Stopped
Debug
Normal if PCSRn[DBG] cleared,
stopped otherwise
No
No. Any interrupt is serviced upon normal exit
from debug mode
In wait mode, the PIT module continues to operate as in run mode and can be configured to exit the
low-power mode by generating an interrupt request. In doze mode with the PCSRn[DOZE] bit set, PIT
module operation stops. In doze mode with the PCSRn[DOZE] bit cleared, doze mode does not affect PIT
operation. When doze mode is exited, PIT continues operating in the state it was in prior to doze mode. In
stop mode, the internal bus clock is absent and PIT module operation stops.
In debug mode with the PCSRn[DBG] bit set, PIT module operation stops. In debug mode with the
PCSRn[DBG] bit cleared, debug mode does not affect PIT operation. When debug mode is exited, the PIT
continues to operate in its pre-debug mode state, but any updates made in debug mode remain.
19.2
Memory Map/Register Definition
This section contains a memory map (see Table 19-2) and describes the register structure for PIT0–PIT3.
Table 19-2. Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules Memory Map
IPSBAR Offset
PIT 0
PIT 1
PIT 2
PIT 3
Register
Width
Access1
(bits)
Reset Value
Section/Page
Supervisor Access Only Registers2
0x15_0000
0x16_0000
0x17_0000
0x18_0000
PIT Control and Status Register (PCSRn)
16
R/W
0x0000
19.2.1/19-3
0x15_0002
0x16_0002
0x17_0002
0x18_0002
PIT Modulus Register (PMRn)
16
R/W
0xFFFF
19.2.2/19-5
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
19-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
Table 19-2. Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules Memory Map (continued)
IPSBAR Offset
PIT 0
PIT 1
PIT 2
PIT 3
Width
Access1
(bits)
Register
Reset Value
Section/Page
0xFFFF
19.2.3/19-5
User/Supervisor Access Registers
0x15_0004
0x16_0004
0x17_0004
0x18_0004
1
2
PIT Count Register (PCNTRn)
16
R
Accesses to reserved address locations have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
User mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
19.2.1
PIT Control and Status Register (PCSRn)
The PCSRn registers configure the corresponding timer’s operation.
IPSBAR 0x15_0000 (PCSR0)
Offset: 0x16_0000 (PCSR1)
0x17_0000 (PCSR2)
0x18_0000 (PCSR3)
R
Access: Supervisor
read/write
15
14
13
12
0
0
0
0
11
10
0
0
0
0
8
0
0
7
0
PRE
W
Reset
9
0
0
0
6
5
4
DOZE DBG OVW
0
0
0
3
PIE
0
2
PIF
w1c
0
1
0
RLD
EN
0
0
Figure 19-2. PCSRn Register
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
19-3
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
Table 19-3. PCSRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15–12
Reserved, must be cleared.
11–8
PRE
Prescaler. The read/write prescaler bits select the internal bus clock divisor to generate the PIT clock. To accurately
predict the timing of the next count, change the PRE[3:0] bits only when the enable bit (EN) is clear. Changing
PRE[3:0] resets the prescaler counter. System reset and the loading of a new value into the counter also reset the
prescaler counter. Setting the EN bit and writing to PRE[3:0] can be done in this same write cycle. Clearing the EN
bit stops the prescaler counter.
7
PRE
Internal Bus Clock
Divisor
Decimal
Equivalent
0000
20
1
0001
21
2
0010
22
4
...
...
...
1101
213
8192
1110
214
16384
1111
215
32768
Reserved, must be cleared.
6
DOZE
Doze Mode Bit. The read/write DOZE bit controls the function of the PIT in doze mode. Reset clears DOZE.
0 PIT function not affected in doze mode
1 PIT function stopped in doze mode. When doze mode is exited, timer operation continues from the state it was in
before entering doze mode.
5
DBG
Debug mode bit. Controls the function of PIT in halted/debug mode. Reset clears DBG. During debug mode, register
read and write accesses function normally. When debug mode is exited, timer operation continues from the state it
was in before entering debug mode, but any updates made in debug mode remain.
0 PIT function not affected in debug mode
1 PIT function stopped in debug mode
Note: Changing the DBG bit from 1 to 0 during debug mode starts the PIT timer. Likewise, changing the DBG bit
from 0 to 1 during debug mode stops the PIT timer.
4
OVW
Overwrite. Enables writing to PMRn to immediately overwrite the value in the PIT counter.
0 Value in PMRn replaces value in PIT counter when count reaches 0x0000.
1 Writing PMRn immediately replaces value in PIT counter.
3
PIE
PIT interrupt enable. This read/write bit enables PIF flag to generate interrupt requests.
0 PIF interrupt requests disabled
1 PIF interrupt requests enabled
2
PIF
PIT interrupt flag. This read/write bit is set when PIT counter reaches 0x0000. Clear PIF by writing a 1 to it or by
writing to PMR. Writing 0 has no effect. Reset clears PIF.
0 PIT count has not reached 0x0000.
1 PIT count has reached 0x0000.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
19-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
Table 19-3. PCSRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Field
Description
1
RLD
Reload bit. The read/write reload bit enables loading the value of PMRn into PIT counter when the count reaches
0x0000.
0 Counter rolls over to 0xFFFF on count of 0x0000
1 Counter reloaded from PMRn on count of 0x0000
0
EN
PIT enable bit. Enables PIT operation. When PIT is disabled, counter and prescaler are held in a stopped state. This
bit is read anytime, write anytime.
0 PIT disabled
1 PIT enabled
19.2.2
PIT Modulus Register (PMRn)
The 16-bit read/write PMRn contains the timer modulus value loaded into the PIT counter when the count
reaches 0x0000 and the PCSRn[RLD] bit is set.
When the PCSRn[OVW] bit is set, PMRn is transparent, and the value written to PMRn is immediately
loaded into the PIT counter. The prescaler counter is reset (0xFFFF) anytime a new value is loaded into
the PIT counter and also during reset. Reading the PMRn returns the value written in the modulus latch.
Reset initializes PMRn to 0xFFFF.
IPSBAR 0x15_0002 (PMR0)
Offset: 0x16_0002 (PMR1)
0x17_0002 (PMR2)
0x18_0002 (PMR3)
15
14
13
Access: Supervisor
read/write
12
11
10
9
8
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
PM
W
Reset
7
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Figure 19-3. PIT Modulus Register (PMRn)
Table 19-4. PMRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15–0
PM
Timer modulus. The value of this register is loaded into the PIT counter when the count reaches zero and the
PCSRn[RLD] bit is set. However, if PCSRn[OVW] is set, the value written to this field is immediately loaded into the
counter. Reading this field returns the value written.
19.2.3
PIT Count Register (PCNTRn)
The 16-bit, read-only PCNTRn contains the counter value. Reading the 16-bit counter with two 8-bit reads
is not guaranteed coherent. Writing to PCNTRn has no effect, and write cycles are terminated normally.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
19-5
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
IPSBAR 0x15_0004 (PCNTR0)
Offset: 0x16_0004 (PCNTR1)
0x17_0004 (PCNTR2)
0x18_0004 (PCNTR3)
15
14
13
Access: User read only
12
11
10
9
8
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
PC
W
Reset
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Figure 19-4. PIT Count Register (PCNTRn)
Table 19-5. PCNTRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15–0
PC
Counter value. Reading this field with two 8-bit reads is not guaranteed coherent. Writing to PCNTRn has no effect,
and write cycles are terminated normally.
19.3
Functional Description
This section describes the PIT functional operation.
19.3.1
Set-and-Forget Timer Operation
This mode of operation is selected when the RLD bit in the PCSR register is set.
When PIT counter reaches a count of 0x0000, PIF flag is set in PCSRn. The value in the modulus register
loads into the counter, and the counter begins decrementing toward 0x0000. If the PCSRn[PIE] bit is set,
the PIF flag issues an interrupt request to the CPU.
When the PCSRn[OVW] bit is set, the counter can be directly initialized by writing to PMRn without
having to wait for the count to reach 0x0000.
PIT Clock
Counter
0x0002
0x0001
Modulus
0x0000
0x0005
0x0005
PIF
Figure 19-5. Counter Reloading from the Modulus Latch
19.3.2
Free-Running Timer Operation
This mode of operation is selected when the PCSRn[RLD] bit is clear. In this mode, the counter rolls over
from 0x0000 to 0xFFFF without reloading from the modulus latch and continues to decrement.
When the counter reaches a count of 0x0000, PCSRn[PIF] flag is set. If the PCSRn[PIE] bit is set, PIF flag
issues an interrupt request to the CPU.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
19-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
When the PCSRn[OVW] bit is set, counter can be directly initialized by writing to PMRn without having
to wait for the count to reach 0x0000.
PIT CLOCK
COUNTER
0x0002
0x0001
MODULUS
0x0000
0xFFFF
0x0005
PIF
Figure 19-6. Counter in Free-Running Mode
19.3.3
Timeout Specifications
The 16-bit PIT counter and prescaler supports different timeout periods. The prescaler divides the internal
bus clock period as selected by the PCSRn[PRE] bits. The PMRn[PM] bits select the timeout period.
Timeout period
19.3.4
=
2 PCSRn[PRE] × (PMRn[PM] + 1)
-----------------------------------------------------------------------f sys
Eqn. 19-1
Interrupt Operation
Table 19-6 shows the interrupt request generated by the PIT.
Table 19-6. PIT Interrupt Requests
Interrupt Request
Flag
Enable Bit
Timeout
PIF
PIE
The PIF flag is set when the PIT counter reaches 0x0000. The PIE bit enables the PIF flag to generate
interrupt requests. Clear PIF by writing a 1 to it or by writing to the PMR.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
19-7
Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT0–PIT3)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
19-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 20
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
The processor has two 4-channel general purpose timer modules (GPTA and GPTB). Each consists of a
16-bit counter driven by a 7-stage programmable prescaler.
A timer overflow function allows software to extend the timing capability of the system beyond the 16-bit
range of the counter. Each of the four timer channels can be configured for input capture, which can
capture the time of a selected transition edge, or for output compare, which can generate output waveforms
and timer software delays. These functions allow simultaneous input waveform measurements and output
waveform generation.
Additionally, one of the channels, channel 3, can be configured as a 16-bit pulse accumulator that can
operate as a simple event counter or as a gated time accumulator. The pulse accumulator uses the GPT
channel 3 input/output pin in either event mode or gated time accumulation mode.
20.1
Features
Features of the general-purpose timer include:
• Four 16-bit input capture/output compare channels
• 16-bit architecture
• Programmable prescaler
• Pulse widths variable from microseconds to seconds
• Single 16-bit pulse accumulator
• Toggle-on-overflow feature for pulse-width modulator (PWM) generation
• External timer clock input (SYNCA/SYNCB)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-1
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.2
Block Diagram
CLK[1:0]
System
Clock
SYNCx
Pin
PR[2:0]
PACLK
PACLK/256
PACLK/65536
Divide
by 2
MUX
Channel 3 Output Compare
X
Prescaler
TCRE
CxI
GPTCNTH:GPTCNTL
CxF
Clear Counter
16-Bit Counter
TOF
Interrupt
Request
Interrupt
Logic
TOI
TE
Channel 0
16-Bit Comparator
Edge
Detect
C0F
IOS0
CH. 0 Capture
PT0
LOGIC
GPTC0H:GPTC0L
16-Bit Latch
EDG0A
OM:OL0
EDG0B
TOV0
CH. 0 Compare
GPTx0
Pin
CHANNEL 1
16-Bit Comparator
Edge
Detect
C1F
IOS1
CH. 1 Capture
GPTC1H:GPTC1L
16-Bit Latch
EDG1A
OM:OL1
EDG1B
TOV1
PT1
LOGIC
CH. 1 Compare
GPTx1
Pin
Channel 2
Channel3
16-Bit Comparator
Edge
Detect
C3F
IOS3
PT3
LOGIC
GPTC3H:GPTC3L
16-Bit Latch
EDG3A
OM:OL3
EDG3B
TOV3
PEDGE
PAOVF
GPTPACNTH:GPTPACNTL
PACLK/256
Interrupt
Request
Interrupt
Logic
GPTx3
Pin
PAIF
MUX
PACLK
CH. 3 Compare
EDGE
DETECT
PAE
16-Bit Counter
PACLK/65536
CH.3 Capture
PA Input
Divide-by-64
Divide
by 2
System
Clock
PAMOD
PAOVI
PAI
PAOVF
PAIF
Figure 20-1. GPT Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-2
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.3
Low-Power Mode Operation
This subsection describes the operation of the general purpose time module in low-power modes and
halted mode of operation. Low-power modes are described in the Power Management Module. Table 3-1
shows the general purpose timer module operation in the low-power modes, and shows how this module
may facilitate exit from each mode.
Table 20-1. Watchdog Module Operation in Low-power Modes
Low-power Mode
Watchdog Operation
Mode Exit
Wait
Normal
No
Doze
Normal
No
Stop
Stopped
No
Halted
Normal
No
General purpose timer operation stops in stop mode. When stop mode is exited, the general purpose timer
continues to operate in its pre-stop mode state.
20.4
Signal Description
Table 20-2 provides an overview of the signal properties.
NOTE
Throughout this section, an “n” in the pin name, as in “GPTn0,” designates
GPTA or GPTB.
Table 20-2. Signal Properties
1
20.4.1
Pin
Name
GPTPORT
Register Bit
GPTn0
PORTTn0
GPTn1
Function
Reset State
Pull-up
GPTn channel 0 IC/OC pin
Input
Active
PORTTn1
GPTn channel 1 IC/OC pin
Input
Active
GPTn2
PORTTn2
GPTn channel 2 IC/OC pin
Input
Active
GPTn3
PORTTn3
GPTn channel 3 IC/OC or PA pin
Input
Active
SYNCn
PORTE[3:0]1
GPTn counter synchronization
Input
Active
SYNCA is available on either PORTE3 or PORTE1; SYNCB is available on either PORTE2 or
PORTE0.
GPTn[2:0]
The GPTn[2:0] pins are for channel 2–0 input capture and output compare functions. These pins are
available for general-purpose input/output (I/O) when not configured for timer functions.
20.4.2
GPTn3
The GPTn3 pin is for channel 3 input capture and output compare functions or for the pulse accumulator
input. This pin is available for general-purpose I/O when not configured for timer functions.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-3
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.4.3
SYNCn
The SYNCn pin is for synchronization of the timer counter. It can be used to synchronize the counter with
externally-timed or clocked events. A high signal on this pin clears the counter.
20.5
Memory Map and Registers
See Table 20-3 for a memory map of the two GPT modules. GPTA has a base address of IPSBAR +
0x1A_0000. GPTB has a base address of IPSBAR + 0x1B_0000.
NOTE
Reading reserved or unimplemented locations returns zeroes. Writing to
reserved or unimplemented locations has no effect.
Table 20-3. GPT Modules Memory Map
IPSBAR Offset
Bits 7–0
Access1
GPTA
GPTB
0x1A_0000
0x1B_0000
GPT IC/OC Select Register (GPTIOS)
S
0x1A_0001
0x1B_0001
GPT Compare Force Register (GPTCFORC)
S
0x1A_0002
0x1B_0002
GPT Output Compare 3 Mask Register (GPTOC3M)
S
0x1A_0003
0x1B_0003
GPT Output Compare 3 Data Register (GPTOC3D)
S
0x1A_0004
0x1B_0004
GPT Counter Register (GPTCNT)
S
0x1A_0006
0x1B_0006
GPT System Control Register 1 (GPTSCR1)
S
0x1A_0007
0x1B_0007
Reserved2
—
0x1A_0008
0x1B_0008
GPT Toggle-on-Overflow Register (GPTTOV)
S
0x1A_0009
0x1B_0009
GPT Control Register 1 (GPTCTL1)
S
0x1A_000A
0x1B_000a
Reserved(2)
—
0x1A_000B
0x1B_000b
GPT Control Register 2 (GPTCTL2)
S
0x1A_000C
0x1B_000c
GPT Interrupt Enable Register (GPTIE)
S
0x1A_000D
0x1B_000d
GPT System Control Register 2 (GPTSCR2)
S
0x1A_000E
0x1B_000e
GPT Flag Register 1 (GPTFLG1)
S
0x1A_000F
0x1B_000f
GPT Flag Register 2 (GPTFLG2)
S
0x1A_0010
0x1B_0010
GPT Channel 0 Register High (GPTC0H)
S
0x1A_0011
0x1Bb_0011
GPT Channel 0 Register Low (GPTC0L)
S
0x1A_0012
0x1B_0012
GPT Channel 1 Register High (GPTC1H)
S
0x1A_0013
0x1B_0013
GPT Channel 1 Register Low (GPTC1L)
S
0x1A_0014
0x1B_0014
GPT Channel 2 Register High (GPTC2H)
S
0x1A_0015
0x1B_0015
GPT Channel 2 Register Low (GPTC2L)
S
0x1A_0016
0x1B_0016
GPT Channel 3 Register High (GPTC3H)
S
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-4
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-3. GPT Modules Memory Map (continued)
IPSBAR Offset
1
2
Bits 7–0
Access1
GPTA
GPTB
0x1A_0017
0x1B_0017
GPT Channel 3 Register Low (GPTC3L)
S
0x1A_0018
0x1B_0018
Pulse Accumulator Control Register (GPTPACTL)
S
0x1A_0019
0x1B_0019
Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (GPTPAFLG)
S
0x1A_001A
0x1B_001A
Pulse Accumulator Counter Register High (GPTPACNTH)
S
0x1A_001B
0x1B_001B
Pulse Accumulator Counter Register Low (GPTPACNTL)
S
(2)
0x1A_001C
0x1B_001C
Reserved
—
0x1A_001D
0x1B_001D
GPT Port Data Register (GPTPORT)
S
0x1A_001E
0x1B_001E
GPT Port Data Direction Register (GPTDDR)
S
0x1A_001F
0x1B_001F
GPT Test Register (GPTTST)
S
S = CPU supervisor mode access only.
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
20.5.1
GPT Input Capture/Output Compare Select Register (GPTIOS)
7
Field
Reset
4
0
IOS
0000_0000
R/W
Address
3
—
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x401A_0000, 0x401B_0000
Figure 20-2. GPT Input Capture/Output Compare Select Register (GPTIOS)
Table 20-4. GPTIOS Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
7–4
—
3–0
IOS
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
I/O select. The IOS[3:0] bits enable input capture or output compare operation for the
corresponding timer channels. These bits are read anytime (always read 0x00), write
anytime.
1 Output compare enabled
0 Input capture enabled
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-5
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.5.2
GPT Compare Force Register (GPCFORC)
7
Field
4
3
—
Reset
0
FOC
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_00001, 0x1B_0001
Figure 20-3. GPT Input Compare Force Register (GPCFORC)
Table 20-5. GPTCFORC Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
7–4
—
3–0
FOC
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Force output compare.Setting an FOC bit causes an immediate output compare on
the corresponding channel. Forcing an output compare does not set the output
compare flag. These bits are read anytime, write anytime.
1 Force output compare
0 No effect
NOTE
A successful channel 3 output compare overrides any compare on channels
2:0. For each OC3M bit that is set, the output compare action reflects the
corresponding OC3D bit.
20.5.3
GPT Output Compare 3 Mask Register (GPTOC3M)
7
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
4
3
—
0
OC3M
0000_0000
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0002, 0x1B_0002
Figure 20-4. GPT Output Compare 3 Mask Register (GPTOC3M)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-6
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-6. GPTOC3M Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
7–4
—
3–0
OC3M
20.5.4
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Output compare 3 mask. Setting an OC3M bit configures the corresponding PORTTn
pin to be an output. OC3Mn makes the GPT port pin an output regardless of the data
direction bit when the pin is configured for output compare (IOSx = 1). The OC3Mn
bits do not change the state of the PORTTnDDR bits. These bits are read anytime,
write anytime.
1 Corresponding PORTTn pin configured as output
0 No effect
GPT Output Compare 3 Data Register (GPTOC3D)
7
Field
4
3
—
Reset
0
OC3D
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0003, 0x1B_0003
Figure 20-5. GPT Output Compare 3 Data Register (GPTOC3D)
Table 20-7. GPTOC3D Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
7–4
—
3–0
OC3D
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Output compare 3 data. When a successful channel 3 output compare occurs, these
bits transfer to the PORTTn data register if the corresponding OC3Mn bits are set.
These bits are read anytime, write anytime.
NOTE
A successful channel 3 output compare overrides any channel 2:0 compares.
For each OC3M bit that is set, the output compare action reflects the
corresponding OC3D bit.
20.5.5
GPT Counter Register (GPTCNT)
15
0
Field
CNTR
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
Address
Read only
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0004, 0x1B_0004
Figure 20-6. GPT Counter Register (GPTCNT)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-7
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-8. GPTCNT Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
15–0
CNTR
Read-only field that provides the current count of the timer counter. To ensure
coherent reading of the timer counter, such that a timer rollover does not occur
between two back-to-back 8-bit reads, it is recommended that only word (16-bit)
accesses be used.
A write to GPTCNT may have an extra cycle on the first count because the write is not
synchronized with the prescaler clock. The write occurs at least one cycle before the
synchronization of the prescaler clock.
These bits are read anytime. They should be written to only in test (special) mode;
writing to them has no effect in normal modes.
20.5.6
GPT System Control Register 1 (GPTSCR1)
7
Field
6
GPTEN
Reset
5
—
4
TFFCA
0
—
0000_0000
R/W
Address
3
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0006, 0x1B_0006
Figure 20-7. GPT System Control Register 1 (GPTSCR1)
Table 20-9. GPTSCR1 Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7
GPTEN
Enables the general purpose timer. When the timer is disabled, only the registers are
accessible. Clearing GPTEN reduces power consumption. These bits are read
anytime, write anytime.
1 GPT enabled
0 GPT and GPT counter disabled
6–5
—
4
TFFCA
3–0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
Timer fast flag clear all. Enables fast clearing of the main timer interrupt flag registers
(GPTFLG1 and GPTFLG2) and the PA flag register (GPTPAFLG). TFFCA eliminates
the software overhead of a separate clear sequence. See Figure 20-8.
When TFFCA is set:
• An input capture read or a write to an output compare channel clears the
corresponding channel flag, CxF.
• Any access of the GPT count registers (GPTCNTH/L) clears the TOF flag.
• Any access of the PA counter registers (GPTPACNT) clears both the PAOVF and
PAIF flags in GPTPAFLG.
Writing logic 1s to the flags clears them only when TFFCA is clear.
1 Fast flag clearing
0 Normal flag clearing
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-8
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Write GPTFLG1 Register
Data Bit n
CnF
Clear
CnF Flag
TFFCA
Read GPTCn Registers
Write GPTCn Registers
Figure 20-8. Fast Clear Flag Logic
20.5.7
GPT Toggle-On-Overflow Register (GPTTOV)
7
6
Field
5
4
3
0
—
TOV
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0008, 0x1B_0008
Figure 20-9. GPT Toggle-On-Overflow Register (GPTTOV)
Table 20-10. GPTTOV Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
7–4
—
3–0
TOV
20.5.8
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Toggles the output compare pin on overflow for each channel. This feature only takes
effect when in output compare mode. When set, it takes precedence over forced
output compare but not channel 3 override events. These bits are read anytime, write
anytime.
1 Toggle output compare pin on overflow feature enabled
0 Toggle output compare pin on overflow feature disabled
GPT Control Register 1 (GPTCTL1)
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
OM3
OL3
OM2
OL2
OM1
OL1
OM0
OL0
0000_0000
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0009, 0x1B_0009
Figure 20-10. GPT Control Register 1 (GPTCTL1)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-9
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-11. GPTCL1 Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–0
OMx/OLx
Output mode/output level. Selects the output action to be taken as a result of a
successful output compare on each channel. When either OMn or OLn is set and the
IOSn bit is set, the pin is an output regardless of the state of the corresponding DDR
bit. These bits are read anytime, write anytime.
00 GPT disconnected from output pin logic
01 Toggle OCn output line
10 Clear OCn output line
11 Set OCn line
Note: Channel 3 shares a pin with the pulse accumulator input pin. To use the PAI
input, clear both the OM3 and OL3 bits and clear the OC3M3 bit in the output compare
3 mask register.
20.5.9
GPT Control Register 2 (GPTCTL2)
7
Field
6
EDG3B
5
4
3
2
1
EDG3A EDG2B EDG2A EDG1B EDG1A EDG0B
Reset
0
EDG0A
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_000B, 0x1B_000B
Figure 20-11. GPT Control Register 2 (GPTCTL2)
Table 20-12. GPTLCTL2 Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–0
EDGn[B:A]
Input capture edge control. Configures the input capture edge detector circuits for
each channel. These bits are read anytime, write anytime.
00 Input capture disabled
01 Input capture on rising edges only
10 Input capture on falling edges only
11 Input capture on any edge (rising or falling)
20.5.10 GPT Interrupt Enable Register (GPTIE)
7
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
6
5
4
3
—
0
CI
0000_0000
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1A_000C, 0x1B_000C
Figure 20-12. GPT Interrupt Enable Register (GPTIE)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-10
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-13. GPTIE Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–4
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
3–0
CnI
Channel interrupt enable. Enables the C[3:0]F flags in GPT flag register 1 to generate
interrupt requests for each channel. These bits are read anytime, write anytime.
1 Corresponding channel interrupt requests enabled
0 Corresponding channel interrupt requests disabled
20.5.11 GPT System Control Register 2 (GPTSCR2)
Field
Reset
7
6
5
4
3
TOI
—
PUPT
RDPT
TCRE
0
PR
0000_0000
R/W
Address
2
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1A_000D, 0x1B_000D
Figure 20-13. GPT System Control Register 2 (GPTSCR2)
Table 20-14. GPTSCR2 Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7
TOI
6
—
5
PUPT
Enables pull-up resistors on the GPT ports when the ports are configured as inputs.
1 Pull-up resistors enabled
0 Pull-up resistors disabled
4
RDPT
GPT drive reduction. Reduces the output driver size.
1 Output drive reduction enabled
0 Output drive reduction disabled
3
TCRE
Enables a counter reset after a channel 3 compare.
1 Counter reset enabled
0 Counter reset disabled
Note: When the GPT channel 3 registers contain 0x0000 and TCRE is set, the GPT
counter registers remain at 0x0000 all the time. When the GPT channel 3 registers
contain 0xFFFF and TCRE is set, TOF does not get set even though the GPT counter
registers go from 0xFFFF to 0x0000.
Enables timer overflow interrupt requests.
1 Overflow interrupt requests enabled
0 Overflow interrupt requests disabled
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-11
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-14. GPTSCR2 Field Descriptions (continued)
Bit(s)
Name
Description
2–0
PRn
Prescaler bits. Select the prescaler divisor for the GPT counter.
000 Prescaler divisor 1
001 Prescaler divisor 2
010 Prescaler divisor 4
011 Prescaler divisor 8
100 Prescaler divisor 16
101 Prescaler divisor 32
110 Prescaler divisor 64
111 Prescaler divisor 128
Note: The newly selected prescaled clock does not take effect until the next
synchronized edge of the prescaled clock when the clock count transitions to 0x0000.)
20.5.12 GPT Flag Register 1 (GPTFLG1)
7
6
Field
5
4
3
—
0
CF
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_000E, 0x1B_000E
Figure 20-14. GPT Flag Register 1 (GPTFLG1)
Table 20-15. GPTFLG1 Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
7–4
—
3–0
CnF
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Channel flags. A channel flag is set when an input capture or output compare event
occurs. These bits are read anytime, write anytime (writing 1 clears the flag, writing 0
has no effect).
Note: When the fast flag clear all bit, GPTSCR1[TFFCA], is set, an input capture read
or an output compare write clears the corresponding channel flag. When a channel
flag is set, it does not inhibit subsequent output compares or input captures.
20.5.13 GPT Flag Register 2 (GPTFLG2)
7
Field
Reset
R/W
Address
6
5
4
3
TOF
0
—
0000_0000
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1A_000F, 0x1B_000F
Figure 20-15. GPT Flag Register 2 (GPTFLG2)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-12
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-16. GPTFLG2 Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7
TOF
Timer overflow flag. Set when the GPT counter rolls over from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. If
the TOI bit in GPTSCR2 is also set, TOF generates an interrupt request. This bit is
read anytime, write anytime (writing 1 clears the flag, and writing 0 has no effect).
1 Timer overflow
0 No timer overflow
Note: When the GPT channel 3 registers contain 0xFFFF and TCRE is set, TOF does
not get set even though the GPT counter registers go from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. When
TOF is set, it does not inhibit subsequent overflow events.
6–0
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
Note: When the fast flag clear all bit, GPTSCR1[TFFCA], is set, any access to the GPT counter registers clears GPT flag register
2.
20.5.14 GPT Channel Registers (GPTCn)
15
0
Field
CCNT
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0010, 0x1A_0012, 0x1A_0014, 0x1A_0016,
0x1B_0010, 0x1B_0012, 0x1B_0014, 0x1B_0016
Figure 20-16. GPT Channel[0:3] Register (GPTCn)
Table 20-17. GPTCn Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
15–0
CCNT
When a channel is configured for input capture (IOSn = 0), the GPT channel registers
latch the value of the free-running counter when a defined transition occurs on the
corresponding input capture pin.
When a channel is configured for output compare (IOSn = 1), the GPT channel
registers contain the output compare value.
To ensure coherent reading of the GPT counter, such that a timer rollover does not
occur between back-to-back 8-bit reads, it is recommended that only word (16-bit)
accesses be used. These bits are read anytime, write anytime (for the output compare
channel); writing to the input capture channel has no effect.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-13
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.5.15 Pulse Accumulator Control Register (GPTPACTL)
Field
Reset
7
6
—
PAE
5
4
3
PAMOD PEDGE
0
CLK
PAOVI
PAI
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0018, 0x1B_0018
Figure 20-17. Pulse Accumulator Control Register (GPTPACTL)
Table 20-18. GPTPACTL Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7
—
6
PAE
5
PAMOD
Pulse accumulator mode. Selects event counter mode or gated time accumulation
mode.
1 Gated time accumulation mode
0 Event counter mode
4
PEDGE
Pulse accumulator edge. Selects falling or rising edges on the PAI pin to increment the
counter.
In event counter mode (PAMOD = 0):
1 Rising PAI edge increments counter
0 Falling PAI edge increments counter
In gated time accumulation mode (PAMOD = 1):
1 Low PAI input enables divide-by-64 clock to pulse accumulator and trailing rising
edge on PAI sets PAIF flag.
0 High PAI input enables divide-by-64 clock to pulse accumulator and trailing falling
edge on PAI sets PAIF flag.
Note: The timer prescaler generates the divide-by-64 clock. If the timer is not active,
there is no divide-by-64 clock.
To operate in gated time accumulation mode:
1. Apply logic 0 to RSTI pin.
2. Initialize registers for pulse accumulator mode test.
3. Apply appropriate level to PAI pin.
4. Enable GPT.
3–2
CLK
Select the GPT counter input clock. Changing the CLK bits causes an immediate
change in the GPT counter clock input.
00 GPT prescaler clock (When PAE = 0, the GPT prescaler clock is always the GPT
counter clock.)
01 PACLK
10 PACLK/256
11 PACLK/65536
Reserved, should be cleared.
Enables the pulse accumulator.
1 Pulse accumulator enabled
0 Pulse accumulator disabled
Note: The pulse accumulator can operate in event mode even when the GPT enable
bit, GPTEN, is clear.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-14
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-18. GPTPACTL Field Descriptions (continued)
Bit(s)
Name
1
PAOVI
0
PAI
Description
Pulse accumulator overflow interrupt enable. Enables the PAOVF flag to generate
interrupt requests.
1 PAOVF interrupt requests enabled
0 PAOVF interrupt requests disabled
Pulse accumulator input interrupt enable. Enables the PAIF flag to generate interrupt
requests.
1 PAIF interrupt requests enabled
0 PAIF interrupt requests disabled
20.5.16 Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (GPTPAFLG)
7
Field
2
—
Reset
1
0
PAOVF
PAIF
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_0019, 0x1B_0019
Figure 20-18. Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (GPTPAFLG)
Table 20-19. GPTPAFLG Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
7–2
—
1
PAOVF
Pulse accumulator overflow flag. Set when the 16-bit pulse accumulator rolls over from
0xFFFF to 0x0000. If the GPTPACTL[PAOVI] bit is also set, PAOVF generates an
interrupt request. Clear PAOVF by writing a 1 to it. This bit is read anytime, write
anytime. (Writing 1 clears the flag; writing 0 has no effect.)
1 Pulse accumulator overflow
0 No pulse accumulator overflow
0
PAIF
Pulse accumulator input flag. Set when the selected edge is detected at the PAI pin.
In event counter mode, the event edge sets PAIF. In gated time accumulation mode,
the trailing edge of the gate signal at the PAI pin sets PAIF. If the PAI bit in GPTPACTL
is also set, PAIF generates an interrupt request. Clear PAIF by writing a 1 to it.
1 Active PAI input
0 No active PAI input
Reserved, should be cleared.
NOTE
When the fast flag clear all enable bit, GPTSCR1[TFFCA], is set, any access
to the pulse accumulator counter registers clears all the flags in GPTPAFLG.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-15
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.5.17 Pulse Accumulator Counter Register (GPTPACNT)
15
0
Field
PACNT
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_001A, 0x1B_001B
Figure 20-19. Pulse Accumulator Counter Register (GPTPACNT)
Table 20-20. GPTPACR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
Description
15–0
PACNT
Contains the number of active input edges on the PAI pin since the last reset.
Note: Reading the pulse accumulator counter registers immediately after an active
edge on the PAI pin may miss the last count since the input first has to be synchronized
with the bus clock.
To ensure coherent reading of the PA counter, such that the counter does not
increment between back-to-back 8-bit reads, it is recommended that only word (16-bit)
accesses be used. These bits are read anytime, write anytime.
20.5.18 GPT Port Data Register (GPTPORT)
7
Field
Reset
6
5
4
—
0
PORTT
0000_0000
R/W
Address
3
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x1A_001D, 0x1B_001D
Figure 20-20. GPT Port Data Register (GPTPORT)
Table 20-21. GPTPORT Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
7–4
—
3–0
PORTT
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
GPT port input capture/output compare data. Data written to GPTPORT is buffered
and drives the pins only when they are configured as general-purpose outputs.
Reading an input (DDR bit = 0) reads the pin state; reading an output (DDR bit = 1)
reads the latched value. Writing to a pin configured as a GPT output does not change
the pin state. These bits are read anytime (read pin state when corresponding
PORTTn bit is 0, read pin driver state when corresponding GPTDDR bit is 1), write
anytime.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-16
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.5.19 GPT Port Data Direction Register (GPTDDR)
7
6
5
4
3
0
Field
—
DDRT
GPT Function
—
IC/OC
Pulse Accumulator Function
—
PAI
Reset
—
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1A_001E, 0x1B_001E
Figure 20-21. GPT Port Data Direction Register (GPTDDR)
Table 20-22. GPTDDR Field Descriptions
Bit(s)
Name
7–4
—
3–0
DDRT
20.6
Description
Reserved, should be cleared.
Control the port logic of PORTTn. Reset clears the PORTTn data direction register,
configuring all GPT port pins as inputs. These bits are read anytime, write anytime.
1 Corresponding pin configured as output
0 Corresponding pin configured as input
Functional Description
The General Purpose Timer (GPT) module is a 16-bit, 4-channel timer with input capture and output
compare functions and a pulse accumulator.
20.6.1
Prescaler
The prescaler divides the module clock by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128. The GPTSCR2[PR] bits select the
prescaler divisor.
20.6.2
Input Capture
Clearing an I/O select bit, IOSn, configures channel n as an input capture channel. The input capture
function captures the time at which an external event occurs. When an active edge occurs on the pin of an
input capture channel, the timer transfers the value in the GPT counter into the GPT channel registers,
GPTCn.
The minimum pulse width for the input capture input is greater than two module clocks.
The input capture function does not force data direction. The GPT port data direction register controls the
data direction of an input capture pin. Pin conditions such as rising or falling edges can trigger an input
capture only on a pin configured as an input.
An input capture on channel n sets the CnF flag. The CnI bit enables the CnF flag to generate interrupt
requests.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-17
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
20.6.3
Output Compare
Setting an I/O select bit, IOSn, configures channel n as an output compare channel. The output compare
function can generate a periodic pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the
GPT counter reaches the value in the channel registers of an output compare channel, the timer can set,
clear, or toggle the channel pin. An output compare on channel n sets the CnF flag. The CnI bit enables the
CnF flag to generate interrupt requests.
The output mode and level bits, OMn and OLn, select, set, clear, or toggle on output compare. Clearing
both OMn and OLn disconnects the pin from the output logic.
Setting a force output compare bit, FOCn, causes an output compare on channel n. A forced output
compare does not set the channel flag.
A successful output compare on channel 3 overrides output compares on all other output compare
channels. A channel 3 output compare can cause bits in the output compare 3 data register to transfer to
the GPT port data register, depending on the output compare 3 mask register. The output compare 3 mask
register masks the bits in the output compare 3 data register. The GPT counter reset enable bit, TCRE,
enables channel 3 output compares to reset the GPT counter. A channel 3 output compare can reset the
GPT counter even if the OC3/PAI pin is being used as the pulse accumulator input.
An output compare overrides the data direction bit of the output compare pin but does not change the state
of the data direction bit.
Writing to the PORTTn bit of an output compare pin does not affect the pin state. The value written is
stored in an internal latch. When the pin becomes available for general-purpose output, the last value
written to the bit appears at the pin.
20.6.4
Pulse Accumulator
The pulse accumulator (PA) is a 16-bit counter that can operate in two modes:
1. Event counter mode: counts edges of selected polarity on the pulse accumulator input pin, PAI
2. Gated time accumulation mode: counts pulses from a divide-by-64 clock
The PA mode bit, PAMOD, selects the mode of operation.
The minimum pulse width for the PAI input is greater than two module clocks.
20.6.5
Event Counter Mode
Clearing the PAMOD bit configures the PA for event counter operation. An active edge on the PAI pin
increments the PA. The PA edge bit, PEDGE, selects falling edges or rising edges to increment the PA.
An active edge on the PAI pin sets the PA input flag, PAIF. The PA input interrupt enable bit, PAI, enables
the PAIF flag to generate interrupt requests.
NOTE
The PAI input and GPT channel 3 use the same pin. To use the PAI input,
disconnect it from the output logic by clearing the channel 3 output mode
and output level bits, OM3 and OL3. Also clear the channel 3 output
compare 3 mask bit, OC3M3.
The PA counter register, GPTPACNT, reflects the number of active input edges on the PAI pin since the
last reset.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-18
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
The PA overflow flag, PAOVF, is set when the PA rolls over from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. The PA overflow
interrupt enable bit, PAOVI, enables the PAOVF flag to generate interrupt requests.
NOTE
The PA can operate in event counter mode even when the GPT enable bit,
GPTEN, is clear.
20.6.6
Gated Time Accumulation Mode
Setting the PAMOD bit configures the PA for gated time accumulation operation. An active level on the
PAI pin enables a divide-by-64 clock to drive the PA. The PA edge bit, PEDGE, selects low levels or high
levels to enable the divide-by-64 clock.
The trailing edge of the active level at the PAI pin sets the PA input flag, PAIF. The PA input interrupt
enable bit, PAI, enables the PAIF flag to generate interrupt requests.
NOTE
The PAI input and GPT channel 3 use the same pin. To use the PAI input,
disconnect it from the output logic by clearing the channel 3 output mode
and output level bits, OM3 and OL3. Also clear the channel 3 output
compare mask bit, OC3M3.
The PA counter register, GPTPACNT, reflects the number of pulses from the divide-by-64 clock since the
last reset.
NOTE
The GPT prescaler generates the divide-by-64 clock. If the timer is not
active, there is no divide-by-64 clock.
PULSE
ACCUMULATOR
PAD
CHANNEL 3 OUTPUT COMPARE
OM3
OL3
OC3M3
Figure 20-22. Channel 3 Output Compare/Pulse Accumulator Logic
20.6.7
General-Purpose I/O Ports
An I/O pin used by the timer defaults to general-purpose I/O unless an internal function which uses that
pin is enabled.
The PORTTn pins can be configured for either an input capture function or an output compare function.
The IOSn bits in the GPT IC/OC select register configure the PORTTn pins as either input capture or
output compare pins.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-19
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
The PORTTn data direction register controls the data direction of an input capture pin. External pin
conditions trigger input captures on input capture pins configured as inputs.
To configure a pin for input capture:
1. Clear the pin’s IOS bit in GPTIOS.
2. Clear the pin’s DDR bit in PORTTnDDR.
3. Write to GPTCTL2 to select the input edge to detect.
PORTTnDDR does not affect the data direction of an output compare pin. The output compare function
overrides the data direction register but does not affect the state of the data direction register.
To configure a pin for output compare:
1. Set the pin’s IOS bit in GPTIOS.
2. Write the output compare value to GPTCn.
3. Clear the pin’s DDR bit in PORTTnDDR.
4. Write to the OMn/OLn bits in GPTCTL1 to select the output action.
Table 20-23 shows how various timer settings affect pin functionality.
Table 20-23. GPT Settings and Pin Functions
GPTE
N
DDR1 GPTIOS
EDGx
[B:A]
OMx/
OLx2
OC3Mx
3
Pin
Data
Dir.
Pin
Driven
by
Pin
Function
Comments
0
0
X4
X
X
X
In
Ext.
Digital input
GPT disabled by GPTEN = 0
0
1
X
X
X
X
Out
Data reg.
Digital output
GPT disabled by GPTEN = 0
1
0
0 (IC)
0 (IC
disable
d)
X
0
In
Ext.
Digital input
Input capture disabled by EDGn
setting
1
1
0
0
X
0
Out
Data reg.
Digital output
Input capture disabled by EDGn
setting
1
0
0
<> 0
X
0
In
Ext.
IC and
digital input
Normal settings for input capture
1
1
0
<> 0
X
0
Out
Data reg.
Digital output
Input capture of data driven to output
pin by CPU
1
0
0
<> 0
X
1
In
Ext.
IC and
digital input
OC3M setting has no effect because
IOS = 0
1
1
0
<> 0
X
1
Out
Data reg.
Digital output
OC3M setting has no effect because
IOS = 0; input capture of data driven
to output pin by CPU
1
0
1 (OC)
X(3)
05
0
In
Ext.
Digital input
Output compare takes place but
does not affect the pin because of
the OMn/OLn setting
1
1
1
X
0
0
Out
Data reg.
Digital output
Output compare takes place but
does not affect the pin because of
the OMn/OLn setting
1
0
1
X
<> 0
0
Out
OC action Output compare Pin readable only if DDR = 0(5)
1
1
1
X
<> 0
0
Out
OC action Output compare Pin driven by OC action(5)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-20
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
Table 20-23. GPT Settings and Pin Functions (continued)
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
0
1
X
X
1
Out
OC
action/
OC3Dn
1
1
1
X
X
1
Out
OC
action/
OC3Dn
Output compare Pin readable only if DDR = 06
(ch 3)
Output
compare/
OC3Dn
(ch 3)
Pin driven by channel OC action and
OC3Dn via channel 3 OC(6)
When DDR set the pin as input (0), reading the data register will return the state of the pin. When DDR set the pin as output (1),
reading the data register will return the content of the data latch. Pin conditions such as rising or falling edges can trigger an input
capture on a pin configured as an input.
OMn/OLn bit pairs select the output action to be taken as a result of a successful output compare. When either OMn or OLn is
set and the IOSn bit is set, the pin is an output regardless of the state of the corresponding DDR bit.
Setting an OC3M bit configures the corresponding PORTTn pin to be output. OC3Mn makes the PORTTn pin an output regardless
of the data direction bit when the pin is configured for output compare (IOSn = 1). The OC3Mn bits do not change the state of the
PORTTnDDR bits.
X = Don’t care
An output compare overrides the data direction bit of the output compare pin but does not change the state of the data direction
bit. Enabling output compare disables data register drive of the pin.
A successful output compare on channel 3 causes an output value determined by OC3Dn value to temporarily override the output
compare pin state of any other output compare channel.The next OC action for the specific channel will still be output to the pin.
A channel 3 output compare can cause bits in the output compare 3 data register to transfer to the GPT port data register,
depending on the output compare 3 mask register.
20.7
Reset
Reset initializes the GPT registers to a known startup state as described in Section 20.5, “Memory Map
and Registers.”
20.8
Interrupts
Table 20-24 lists the interrupt requests generated by the timer.
Table 20-24. GPT Interrupt Requests
Interrupt Request
Flag
Enable Bit
Channel 3 IC/OC
C3F
C3I
Channel 2 IC/OC
C2F
C2I
Channel 1 IC/OC
C1F
C1I
Channel 0 IC/OC
C0F
C0I
PAOVF
PAOVI
PA input
PAIF
PAI
Timer overflow
TOF
TOI
PA overflow
20.8.1
GPT Channel Interrupts (CnF)
A channel flag is set when an input capture or output compare event occurs. Clear a channel flag by writing
a 1 to it.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-21
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
NOTE
When the fast flag clear all bit, GPTSCR1[TFFCA], is set, an input capture
read or an output compare write clears the corresponding channel flag.
When a channel flag is set, it does not inhibit subsequent output compares
or input captures
20.8.2
Pulse Accumulator Overflow (PAOVF)
PAOVF is set when the 16-bit pulse accumulator rolls over from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. If the PAOVI bit in
GPTPACTL is also set, PAOVF generates an interrupt request. Clear PAOVF by writing a 1 to this flag.
NOTE
When the fast flag clear all enable bit, GPTSCR1[TFFCA], is set, any access
to the pulse accumulator counter registers clears all the flags in GPTPAFLG.
20.8.3
Pulse Accumulator Input (PAIF)
PAIF is set when the selected edge is detected at the PAI pin. In event counter mode, the event edge sets
PAIF. In gated time accumulation mode, the trailing edge of the gate signal at the PAI pin sets PAIF. If the
PAI bit in GPTPACTL is also set, PAIF generates an interrupt request. Clear PAIF by writing a 1 to this
flag.
NOTE
When the fast flag clear all enable bit, GPTSCR1[TFFCA], is set, any access
to the pulse accumulator counter registers clears all the flags in GPTPAFLG.
20.8.4
Timer Overflow (TOF)
TOF is set when the GPT counter rolls over from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. If the GPTSCR2[TOI] bit is also set,
TOF generates an interrupt request. Clear TOF by writing a 1 to this flag.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-22
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
NOTE
When the GPT channel 3 registers contain 0xFFFF and TCRE is set, TOF
does not get set even though the GPT counter registers go from 0xFFFF to
0x0000.
When the fast flag clear all bit, GPTSCR1[TFFCA], is set, any access to the
GPT counter registers clears GPT flag register 2.
When TOF is set, it does not inhibit future overflow events.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
20-23
General Purpose Timer Modules (GPTA and GPTB)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
20-24
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 21
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
21.1
Introduction
This chapter describes the configuration and operation of the four direct memory access (DMA) timer
modules (DTIM0, DTIM1, DTIM2, and DTIM3). These 32-bit timers provide input capture and reference
compare capabilities with optional signaling of events using interrupts or DMA triggers. Additionally,
programming examples are included.
NOTE
The designation n appears throughout this section to refer to registers or
signals associated with one of the four identical timer modules: DTIM0,
DTIM1, DTIM2, or DTIM3.
21.1.1
Overview
Each DMA timer module has a separate register set for configuration and control. The timers can be
configured to operate from the internal bus clock or from an external clocking source using the DTINn
signal. If the internal bus clock is selected, it can be divided by 16 or 1. The selected clock source is routed
to an 8-bit programmable prescaler that clocks the actual DMA timer counter register (DTCNn). Using the
DTMRn, DTXMRn, DTCRn, and DTRRn registers, the DMA timer may be configured to assert an output
signal, generate an interrupt, or request a DMA transfer on a particular event.
NOTE
The GPIO module must be configured to enable the peripheral function of
the appropriate pins (refer to Chapter 26, “General Purpose I/O Module”)
prior to configuring the DMA Timers.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
21-1
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
Figure 21-1 is a block diagram of one of the four identical timer modules.
Internal Bus to/from DMA Timer Registers
DMA Timer
0
15
Internal Bus Clock
(÷1 or ÷16)
DMA Timer Mode Register (DTMRn)
Prescaler
Mode Bits
DMA Timer
Clock
Generator
DTINn
7
0
DMA Timer Extended Mode
Register (DTXMRn)
Divider
clock
31
Capture
Detection
0
DMA Timer Counter Register (DTCNn)
(contains incrementing value)
31
0
DMA Timer Capture Register (DTCRn)
(latches DTCN value when triggered byDTINn)
DTOUTn
Interrupt Request
DMA Request
31
0
DMA Timer Reference Register (DTRRn)
(reference value for comparison with DTCN)
0
7
DMA Timer Event Register (DTERn)
(indicates capture or when DTCN = DTRRn)
Figure 21-1. DMA Timer Block Diagram
21.1.2
Features
Each DMA timer module has:
• Maximum timeout period of 219,902 seconds at 80 MHz (~61 hours)
• 12.5-ns resolution at 80 MHz
• Programmable sources for the clock input, including external clock
• Programmable prescaler
• Input-capture capability with programmable trigger edge on input pin
• Programmable mode for the output pin on reference compare
• Free run and restart modes
• Programmable interrupt or DMA request on input capture or reference-compare
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
21-2
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
21.2
Memory Map/Register Definition
The timer module registers, shown in Table 21-1, can be modified at any time.
Table 21-1. DMA Timer Module Memory Map
IPSBAR Offset
DMA Timer 0
DMA Timer 1
DMA Timer 2
DMA Timer 3
Width
Access
(bits)
Register
Reset Value
Section/Page
0x00_0400
0x00_0440
0x00_0480
0x00_04C0
DMA Timer n Mode Register (DTMRn)
16
R/W
0x0000
21.2.1/21-3
0x00_0402
0x00_0442
0x00_0482
0x00_04C2
DMA Timer n Extended Mode Register (DTXMRn)
8
R/W
0x00
21.2.2/21-5
0x00_0403
0x00_0443
0x00_0483
0x00_04C3
DMA Timer n Event Register (DTERn)
8
R/W
0x00
21.2.3/21-5
0x00_0404
0x00_0444
0x00_0484
0x00_04C4
DMA Timer n Reference Register (DTRRn)
32
R/W
0xFFFF_FFFF
21.2.4/21-7
0x00_0408
0x00_0448
0x00_0488
0x00_04C8
DMA Timer n Capture Register (DTCRn)
32
R/W
0x0000_0000
21.2.5/21-7
0x00_040C
0x00_044C
0x00_048C
0x00_04CC
DMA Timer n Counter Register (DTCNn)
32
R
0x0000_0000
21.2.6/21-8
21.2.1
DMA Timer Mode Registers (DTMRn)
The DTMRn registers program the prescaler and various timer modes.
IPSBAR 0x00_0400 (DTMR0)
Offset: 0x00_0440 (DTMR1)
0x00_0480 (DTMR2)
0x00_04C0 (DTMR3)
15
14
13
Access: User read/write
12
R
10
9
8
7
PS
W
Reset
11
0
0
0
0
6
CE
0
0
0
0
0
5
OM
0
0
4
3
2
ORRI FRR
0
0
1
CLK
0
0
RST
0
0
Figure 21-2. DTMRn Registers
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
21-3
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
Table 21-2. DTMRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15–8
PS
Prescaler value. Divides the clock input (internal bus clock/(16 or 1) or clock on DTINn)
0x00 1
...
0xFF 256
7–6
CE
Capture edge.
00 Disable capture event output. Timer in reference mode.
01 Capture on rising edge only
10 Capture on falling edge only
11 Capture on any edge
5
OM
Output mode.
0 Active-low pulse for one internal bus clock cycle (12.5-ns resolution at 80 MHz)
1 Toggle output.
4
ORRI
Output reference request, interrupt enable. If ORRI is set when DTERn[REF] is set, a DMA request or an interrupt
occurs, depending on the value of DTXMRn[DMAEN] (DMA request if set, interrupt if cleared).
0 Disable DMA request or interrupt for reference reached (does not affect DMA request or interrupt on capture
function).
1 Enable DMA request or interrupt upon reaching the reference value.
3
FRR
Free run/restart
0 Free run. Timer count continues incrementing after reaching the reference value.
1 Restart. Timer count is reset immediately after reaching the reference value.
2–1
CLK
Input clock source for the timer. Avoid setting CLK when RST is already set. Doing so causes CLK to zero (stop
counting).
00 Stop count
01 Internal bus clock divided by 1
10 Internal bus clock divided by 16. This clock source is not synchronized with the timer; therefore, successive
time-outs may vary slightly.
11 DTINn pin (falling edge)
0
RST
Reset timer. Performs a software timer reset similar to an external reset, although other register values can be written
while RST is cleared. A transition of RST from 1 to 0 resets register values. The timer counter is not clocked unless
the timer is enabled.
0 Reset timer (software reset)
1 Enable timer
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
21-4
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
21.2.2
DMA Timer Extended Mode Registers (DTXMRn)
The DTXMRn registers program DMA request and increment modes for the timers.
IPSBAR 0x00_0402 (DTXMR0)
Offset: 0x00_0442 (DTXMR1)
0x00_0482 (DTXMR2)
0x00_04C2 (DTXMR3)
7
R
Access: User read/write
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
DMAEN
0
MODE16
W
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 21-3. DTXMRn Registers
Table 21-3. DTXMRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7
DMA request. Enables DMA request output on counter reference match or capture edge event.
DMAEN 0 DMA request disabled
1 DMA request enabled
6–1
Reserved, must be cleared.
0
Selects the increment mode for the timer. Setting MODE16 is intended to exercise the upper bits of the 32-bit timer
MODE16 in diagnostic software without requiring the timer to count through its entire dynamic range. When set, the counter’s
upper 16 bits mirror its lower 16 bits. All 32 bits of the counter remain compared to the reference value.
0 Increment timer by 1
1 Increment timer by 65,537
21.2.3
DMA Timer Event Registers (DTERn)
DTERn, shown in Figure 21-4, reports capture or reference events by setting DTERn[CAP] or
DTERn[REF]. This reporting happens regardless of the corresponding DMA request or interrupt enable
values, DTXMRn[DMAEN] and DTMRn[ORRI,CE].
Writing a 1 to DTERn[REF] or DTERn[CAP] clears it (writing a 0 does not affect bit value); both bits can
be cleared at the same time. If configured to generate an interrupt request, clear REF and CAP early in the
interrupt service routine so the timer module can negate the interrupt request signal to the interrupt
controller. If configured to generate a DMA request, processing of the DMA data transfer automatically
clears the REF and CAP flags via the internal DMA ACK signal.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
21-5
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
IPSBAR 0x00_0403 (DTER0)
Offset: 0x00_0443 (DTER1)
0x00_0483 (DTER2)
0x00_04C3 (DTER3)
R
Access: User read/write
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
REF
CAP
w1c
w1c
0
0
W
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 21-4. DTERn Registers
Table 21-4. DTERn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7–2
Reserved, must be cleared.
1
REF
Output reference event. The counter value (DTCNn) equals DTRRn. Writing a 1 to REF clears the event condition.
Writing a 0 has no effect.
0
CAP
REF
DTMRn[ORRI]
DTXMRn[DMAEN]
0
X
X
No event
1
0
0
No request asserted
1
0
1
No request asserted
1
1
0
Interrupt request asserted
1
1
1
DMA request asserted
Capture event. The counter value has been latched into DTCRn. Writing a 1 to CAP clears the event condition.
Writing a 0 has no effect.
CAP
DTMRn[CE]
DTXMRn
[DMAEN]
0
XX
X
No event
1
00
0
Disable capture event output
1
00
1
Disable capture event output
1
01
0
Capture on rising edge and trigger interrupt
1
01
1
Capture on rising edge and trigger DMA
1
10
0
Capture on falling edge and trigger interrupt
1
10
1
Capture on falling edge and trigger DMA
1
11
0
Capture on any edge and trigger interrupt
1
11
1
Capture on any edge and trigger DMA
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
21-6
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
21.2.4
DMA Timer Reference Registers (DTRRn)
As part of the output-compare function, each DTRRn contains the reference value compared with the
respective free-running timer counter (DTCNn).
The reference value is matched when DTCNn equals DTRRn. The prescaler indicates that DTCNn should
be incremented again. Therefore, the reference register is matched after DTRRn + 1 time intervals.
IPSBAR 0x00_0404 (DTRR0)
Offset: 0x00_0444 (DTRR1)
0x00_0484 (DTRR2)
0x00_04C4 (DTRR3)
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
REF (32-bit reference value)
W
Reset 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Figure 21-5. DTRRn Registers
Table 21-5. DTRRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
31–0
REF
Reference value compared with the respective free-running timer counter (DTCNn) as part of the output-compare
function.
21.2.5
DMA Timer Capture Registers (DTCRn)
Each DTCRn latches the corresponding DTCNn value during a capture operation when an edge occurs on
DTINn, as programmed in DTMRn. The internal bus clock is assumed to be the clock source. DTINn
cannot simultaneously function as a clocking source and as an input capture pin. Indeterminate operation
results if DTINn is set as the clock source when the input capture mode is used.
Access: User read-only
IPSBAR 0x00_0408 (DTCR0)
Offset: 0x00_0448 (DTCR1)
0x00_0488 (DTCR2)
0x00_04C8 (DTCR3)
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CAP (32-bit capture counter value)
W
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 21-6. DTCRn Registers
Table 21-6. DTCRn Field Descriptions
Field
31–0
CAP
Description
Captures the corresponding DTCNn value during a capture operation when an edge occurs on DTINn, as
programmed in DTMRn.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
21-7
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
21.2.6
DMA Timer Counters (DTCNn)
The current value of the 32-bit timer counter can be read at anytime without affecting counting. Writes to
DTCNn clear the timer counter. The timer counter increments on the clock source rising edge (internal bus
clock divided by 1, internal bus clock divided by 16, or DTINn).
IPSBAR 0x00_040C (DTCN0)
Offset: 0x00_044C (DTCN1)
0x00_048C (DTCN2)
0x00_04CC (DTCN3)
Access: User read/write
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
R
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CNT (32-bit timer counter value count)
W
Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 21-7. DMA Timer Counters (DTCNn)
Table 21-7. DTCNn Field Descriptions
Field
31–0
CNT
21.3
21.3.1
Description
Timer counter. Can be read at anytime without affecting counting and any write to this field clears it.
Functional Description
Prescaler
The prescaler clock input is selected from the internal bus clock (fsys divided by 1 or 16) or from the
corresponding timer input, DTINn. DTINn is synchronized to the internal bus clock, and the
synchronization delay is between two and three internal bus clocks. The corresponding DTMRn[CLK]
selects the clock input source. A programmable prescaler divides the clock input by values from 1 to 256.
The prescaler output is an input to the 32-bit counter, DTCNn.
21.3.2
Capture Mode
Each DMA timer has a 32-bit timer capture register (DTCRn) that latches the counter value when the
corresponding input capture edge detector senses a defined DTINn transition. The capture edge bits
(DTMRn[CE]) select the type of transition that triggers the capture and sets the timer event register capture
event bit, DTERn[CAP]. If DTERn[CAP] and DTXMRn[DMAEN] are set, a DMA request is asserted. If
DTERn[CAP] is set and DTXMRn[DMAEN] is cleared, an interrupt is asserted.
21.3.3
Reference Compare
Each DMA timer can be configured to count up to a reference value. If the reference value is met,
DTERn[REF] is set.
• If DTMRn[ORRI] is set and DTXMRn[DMAEN] is cleared, an interrupt is asserted.
• If DTMRn[ORRI] and DTXMRn[DMAEN] are set, a DMA request is asserted.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
21-8
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
If the free run/restart bit (DTMRn[FRR]) is set, a new count starts. If it is clear, the timer keeps running.
21.3.4
Output Mode
When a timer reaches the reference value selected by DTRR, it can send an output signal on DTOUTn.
DTOUTn can be an active-low pulse or a toggle of the current output, as selected by the DTMRn[OM] bit.
21.4
Initialization/Application Information
The general-purpose timer modules typically, but not necessarily, follow this program order:
• The DTMRn and DTXMRn registers are configured for the desired function and behavior.
— Count and compare to a reference value stored in the DTRRn register
— Capture the timer value on an edge detected on DTINn
— Configure DTOUTn output mode
— Increment counter by 1 or by 65,537 (16-bit mode)
— Enable/disable interrupt or DMA request on counter reference match or capture edge
• The DTMRn[CLK] register is configured to select the clock source to be routed to the prescaler.
— Internal bus clock (can be divided by 1 or 16)
— DTINn, the maximum value of DTINn is 1/5 of the internal bus clock, as described in the
device’s electrical characteristics
NOTE
DTINn may not be configured as a clock source when the timer capture
mode is selected or indeterminate operation results.
•
•
•
The 8-bit DTMRn[PS] prescaler value is set.
Using DTMRn[RST], counter is cleared and started.
Timer events are managed with an interrupt service routine, a DMA request, or by a software
polling mechanism.
21.4.1
Code Example
The following code provides an example of how to initialize and use DMA Timer0 for counting time-out
periods.
DTMR0
DTMR1
DTRR0
DTRR1
DTCR0
DTCR1
DTCN0
DTCN1
DTER0
DTER1
EQU
EQU
EQU
EQU
EQU
EQU
EQU
EQU
EQU
EQU
IPSBARx+0x400
IPSBARx+0x440
IPSBARx+0x404
IPSBARx+0x444
IPSBARx+0x408
IPSBARx+0x448
IPSBARx+0x40C
IPSBARx+0x44C
IPSBARx+0x403
IPSBARx+0x443
;Timer0
;Timer1
;Timer0
;Timer1
;Timer0
;Timer1
;Timer0
;Timer1
;Timer0
;Timer1
mode register
mode register
reference register
reference register
capture register
capture register
counter register
counter register
event register
event register
* TMR0 is defined as: *
*[PS] = 0xFF,
divide clock by 256
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
21-9
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
*[CE] = 00
*[OM] = 0
*[ORRI] = 0,
*[FRR] = 1,
*[CLK] = 10,
*[RST] = 0,
disable capture event output
output=active-low pulse
disable ref. match output
restart mode enabled
internal bus clock/16
timer0 disabled
move.w #0xFF0C,D0
move.w D0,TMR0
move.l #0x0000,D0;writing to the timer counter with any
move.l DO,TCN0 ;value resets it to zero
move.l #0xAFAF,DO ;set the timer0 reference to be
move.l #D0,TRR0 ;defined as 0xAFAF
The simple example below uses Timer0 to count time-out loops. A time-out occurs when the reference
value, 0xAFAF, is reached.
timer0_ex
clr.l DO
clr.l D1
clr.l D2
move.l #0x0000,D0
move.l D0,TCN0
move.b #0x03,D0
move.b D0,TER0
move.w TMR0,D0
bset #0,D0
move.w D0,TMR0
;reset the counter to 0x0000
;writing ones to TER0[REF,CAP]
;clears the event flags
;save the contents of TMR0 while setting
;the 0 bit. This enables timer 0 and starts counting
;load the value back into the register, setting TMR0[RST]
T0_LOOP
move.b TER0,D1
btst #1,D1
beq T0_LOOP
;load TER0 and see if
;TER0[REF] has been set
addi.l #1,D2
cmp.l #5,D2
beq T0_FINISH
;Increment D2
;Did D2 reach 5? (i.e. timer ref has timed)
;If so, end timer0 example. Otherwise jump back.
move.b #0x02,D0
move.b D0,TER0
jmp T0_LOOP
;writing one to TER0[REF] clears the event flag
T0_FINISH
HALT
21.4.2
;End processing. Example is finished
Calculating Time-Out Values
Equation 21-1 determines time-out periods for various reference values:
Timeout period = ( 1 ⁄ clock frequency ) × ( 1 or 16 ) × ( DTMRn[PS] + 1 ) × ( DTRRn[REF] + 1 )
Eqn. 21-1
When calculating time-out periods, add one to the prescaler to simplify calculating, because
DTMRn[PS] equal to 0x00 yields a prescaler of one, and DTMRn[PS] equal to 0xFF yields a prescaler of
256.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
21-10
Freescale Semiconductor
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
For example, if a 80-MHz timer clock is divided by 16, DTMRn[PS] equals 0x7F, and the timer is
referenced at 0x1312C (78,124 decimal), the time-out period is:
1
Timeout period = -------------------6- × 16 × ( 127 + 1 ) × ( 78124 + 1 ) = 2.00 seconds
×
80 10
Eqn. 21-2
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
21-11
DMA Timers (DTIM0–DTIM3)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
21-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 22
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
22.1
Introduction
This chapter describes the queued serial peripheral interface (QSPI) module.
22.1.1
Block Diagram
Figure 22-1 illustrates the QSPI module.
Queue Control
Block
4
Queue
Pointer
Comparator
End Queue
Pointer
80-byte
QSPI
RAM
Done
QSPI
Address
Register
QSPI
Data
Register
4
Control Logic
Chip
Selects
Status
Regs
msb
lsb
8/16 Bit Shift Reg.
Logic
Array
Control
Regs
QSPI_DIN
Rx/Tx Data Reg.
4
QSPI_DOUT
Command
QSPI_CS[3:0]
Delay
Counter
Internal Bus
Internal Bus
Clock (fsys)
Divide by 2
Baud Rate
Generator
QSPI_CLK
Figure 22-1. QSPI Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
22-1
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
22.1.2
Overview
The queued serial peripheral interface module provides a serial peripheral interface with queued transfer
capability. It allows users to queue up to 16 transfers at once, eliminating CPU intervention between
transfers. Transfer RAM in the QSPI is indirectly accessible using address and data registers.
NOTE
The GPIO module must be configured to enable the peripheral function of
the appropriate pins (refer to Chapter 26, “General Purpose I/O Module”)
prior to configuring the QSPI module.
22.1.3
Features
Features include:
• Programmable queue to support up to 16 transfers without user intervention
— 80 bytes of data storage provided
• Supports transfer sizes of 8 to 16 bits in 1-bit increments
• Four peripheral chip-select lines for control of up to 15 devices (All chip selects may not be
available on all devices. See Chapter 14, “Signal Descriptions,” for details on which chip-selects
are pinned-out.)
• Baud rates from 156.9 Kbps to 20 Mbps at 80 MHz internal bus frequency
• Programmable delays before and after transfers
• Programmable QSPI clock phase and polarity
• Supports wraparound mode for continuous transfers
22.1.4
Modes of Operation
Because the QSPI module only operates in master mode, the master bit in the QSPI mode register
(QMR[MSTR]) must be set for the QSPI to function properly. If the master bit is not set, QSPI activity is
indeterminate. The QSPI can initiate serial transfers but cannot respond to transfers initiated by other QSPI
masters.
22.2
External Signal Description
The module provides access to as many as 15 devices with a total of seven signals: QSPI_DOUT,
QSPI_DIN, QSPI_CLK, QSPI_CS[3:0].
Peripheral chip-select signals, QSPI_CSn, are used to select an external device as the source or destination
for serial data transfer. Signals are asserted when a command in the queue is executed. More than one
chip-select signal can be asserted simultaneously.
Although QSPI_CSn signals function as simple chip selects in most applications, up to 15 devices can be
selected by decoding them with an external 4-to-16 decoder.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
22-2
Freescale Semiconductor
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
Table 22-1. QSPI Input and Output Signals and Functions
Signal Name
22.3
Hi-Z or Actively Driven
Function
Data output (QSPI_DOUT)
Configurable
Serial data output from QSPI
Data input (QSPI_DIN)
N/A
Serial data input to QSPI
Serial clock (QSPI_CLK)
Actively driven
Clock output from QSPI
Peripheral chip selects (QSPI_CSn)
Actively driven
Peripheral selects from QSPI
Memory Map/Register Definition
Table 22-2 is the QSPI register memory map. Reading reserved locations returns zeros.
Table 22-2. QSPI Memory Map
IPSBAR
Offset1
1
2
Width
(bits)
Register
Access Reset Value
Section/Page
0x00_0340
QSPI Mode Register (QMR)
16
R/W
0x0104
22.3.1/22-3
0x00_0344
QSPI Delay Register (QDLYR)
16
R/W
0x0404
22.3.2/22-5
0x00_0348
QSPI Wrap Register (QWR)
16
R/W2
0x0000
22.3.3/22-6
0x00_034C
QSPI Interrupt Register (QIR)
16
R/W2
0x0000
22.3.4/22-6
0x00_0350
QSPI Address Register (QAR)
16
R/W2
0x0000
22.3.5/22-7
0x00_0354
QSPI Data Register (QDR)
16
R/W
0x0000
22.3.6/22-8
Addresses not assigned to a register and undefined register bits are reserved for expansion.
See the register description for special cases. Some bits may be read- or write-only.
22.3.1
QSPI Mode Register (QMR)
The QMR, shown in Figure 22-2, determines the basic operating modes of the QSPI module. Parameters
such as QSPI_CLK polarity and phase, baud rate, master mode operation, and transfer size are determined
by this register.
NOTE
Because the QSPI does not operate in slave mode, the master mode enable
bit (QMR[MSTR]) must be set for the QSPI module to operate correctly.
IPSBAR 0x00_0340 (QMR)
Offset:
15
R
W
Reset
MSTR
0
14
Access: User read/write
13
12
0
0
11
10
BITS
0
0
9
8
7
6
5
CPOL CPHA
0
0
0
1
4
3
2
1
0
1
0
0
BAUD
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 22-2. QSPI Mode Register (QMR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
22-3
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
Table 22-3. QMR Field Descriptions
Field
15
MSTR
14
13–10
BITS
Description
Master mode enable.
0 Reserved, do not use.
1 The QSPI is in master mode. Must be set for the QSPI module to operate correctly.
Reserved, must be cleared.
Transfer size. Determines the number of bits to be transferred for each entry in the queue.
BITS
Bits per Transfer
0000
16
0001–0111
Reserved
1000
8
1001
9
1010
10
1011
11
1100
12
1101
13
1110
14
1111
15
9
CPOL
Clock polarity. Defines the clock polarity of QSPI_CLK.
0 The inactive state value of QSPI_CLK is logic level 0.
1 The inactive state value of QSPI_CLK is logic level 1.
8
CPHA
Clock phase. Defines the QSPI_CLK clock-phase.
0 Data captured on the leading edge of QSPI_CLK and changed on the following edge of QSPI_CLK.
1 Data changed on the leading edge of QSPI_CLK and captured on the following edge of QSPI_CLK.
7–0
BAUD
Baud rate divider. The baud rate is selected by writing a value in the range 2–255. A value of zero disables the QSPI.
A value of 1 is an invalid setting. The desired QSPI_CLK baud rate is related to the internal bus clock and
QMR[BAUD] by the following expression:
QMR[BAUD] = fsys/ / (2 × [desired QSPI_CLK baud rate])
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
22-4
Freescale Semiconductor
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
Figure 22-3 shows an example of a QSPI clocking and data transfer.
QSPI_CLK
QSPI_DOUT
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
msb
QSPI_DIN
15
A
B
QSPI_CS
QMR[CPOL] = 0
QMR[CPHA] = 1
QCR[CONT] = 0
Chip selects are active low
A = QDLYR[QCD]
B = QDLYR[DTL]
Figure 22-3. QSPI Clocking and Data Transfer Example
22.3.2
QSPI Delay Register (QDLYR)
The QDLYR is used to initiate master mode transfers and to set various delay parameters.
IPSBAR 0x00_0344 (QDLYR)
Offset:
15
R
W
Reset
14
13
Access: User read/write
12
SPE
0
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
QCD
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
0
0
1
0
0
DTL
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 22-4. QSPI Delay Register (QDLYR)
Table 22-4. QDLYR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15
SPE
QSPI enable. When set, the QSPI initiates transfers in master mode by executing commands in the command RAM.
The QSPI clears this bit automatically when a transfer completes. The user can also clear this bit to abort transfer
unless QIR[ABRTL] is set. The recommended method for aborting transfers is to set QWR[HALT].
14–8
QCD
QSPI_CLK delay. When the DSCK bit in the command RAM is set this field determines the length of the delay from
assertion of the chip selects to valid QSPI_CLK transition. See Section 22.4.3, “Transfer Delays” for information on
setting this bit field.
7–0
DTL
Delay after transfer. When the DT bit in the command RAM is set this field determines the length of delay after the
serial transfer.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
22-5
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
22.3.3
QSPI Wrap Register (QWR)
The QSPI wrap register provides halt transfer control, wraparound settings, and queue pointer locations.
IPSBAR 0x00_0348 (QWR)
Offset:
15
R
W
Reset
14
Access: User read/write
13
12
11
10
HALT WREN WRTO CSIV
0
0
0
0
9
8
7
6
ENDQP
0
0
5
4
3
CPTQP
0
0
0
0
2
1
0
NEWQP
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 22-5. QSPI Wrap Register (QWR)
Table 22-5. QWR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15
HALT
Halt transfers. Assertion of this bit causes the QSPI to stop execution of commands after it has completed execution
of the current command.
14
WREN
Wraparound enable. Enables wraparound mode.
0 Execution stops after executing the command pointed to by QWR[ENDQP].
1 After executing command pointed to by QWR[ENDQP], wrap back to entry zero, or the entry pointed to by
QWR[NEWQP] and continue execution.
13
WRTO
Wraparound location. Determines where the QSPI wraps to in wraparound mode.
0 Wrap to RAM entry zero.
1 Wrap to RAM entry pointed to by QWR[NEWQP].
12
CSIV
QSPI_CS inactive level.
0 QSPI chip select outputs return to zero when not driven from the value in the current command RAM entry during
a transfer (that is, inactive state is 0, chip selects are active high).
1 QSPI chip select outputs return to one when not driven from the value in the current command RAM entry during
a transfer (that is, inactive state is 1, chip selects are active low).
11–8
End of queue pointer. Points to the RAM entry that contains the last transfer description in the queue.
ENDQP
7–4
CPTQP
Completed queue entry pointer. Points to the RAM entry that contains the last command to have been completed.
This field is read only.
3–0
Start of queue pointer. This 4-bit field points to the first entry in the RAM to be executed on initiating a transfer.
NEWQP
22.3.4
QSPI Interrupt Register (QIR)
The QIR contains QSPI interrupt enables and status flags.
IPSBAR 0x00_034C (QIR)
Offset:
15
R
W
Reset
14
WCEFB ABRTB
0
0
Access: User read/write
13
0
0
12
11
10
ABRTL WCEFE ABRTE
0
0
0
9
0
0
8
SPIFE
0
7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
3
2
WCEF ABRT
w1c
w1c
0
0
1
0
0
SPIF
w1c
0
0
Figure 22-6. QSPI Interrupt Register (QIR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
22-6
Freescale Semiconductor
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
Table 22-6. QIR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15
Write collision access error enable. A write collision occurs during a data transfer when the RAM entry containing
WCEFB the current command is written to by the CPU with the QDR. When this bit is asserted, the write access to QDR
results in an access error.
14
ABRTB
13
12
ABRTL
Abort access error enable. An abort occurs when QDLYR[SPE] is cleared during a transfer. When set, an attempt to
clear QDLYR[SPE] during a transfer results in an access error.
Reserved, must be cleared.
Abort lock-out. When set, QDLYR[SPE] cannot be cleared by writing to the QDLYR. QDLYR[SPE] is only cleared by
the QSPI when a transfer completes.
11
Write collision (WCEF) interrupt enable.
WCEFE 0 Write collision interrupt disabled
1 Write collision interrupt enabled
10
ABRTE
9
8
SPIFE
7–4
Abort (ABRT) interrupt enable.
0 Abort interrupt disabled
1 Abort interrupt enabled
Reserved, must be cleared.
QSPI finished (SPIF) interrupt enable.
0 SPIF interrupt disabled
1 SPIF interrupt enabled
Reserved, must be cleared.
3
WCEF
Write collision error flag. Indicates that an attempt has been made to write to the RAM entry that is currently being
executed. Writing a 1 to this bit (w1c) clears it and writing 0 has no effect.
2
ABRT
Abort flag. Indicates that QDLYR[SPE] has been cleared by the user writing to the QDLYR rather than by completion
of the command queue by the QSPI. Writing a 1 to this bit (w1c) clears it and writing 0 has no effect.
1
0
SPIF
22.3.5
Reserved, must be cleared.
QSPI finished flag. Asserted when the QSPI has completed all the commands in the queue. Set on completion of
the command pointed to by QWR[ENDQP], and on completion of the current command after assertion of
QWR[HALT]. In wraparound mode, this bit is set every time the command pointed to by QWR[ENDQP] is completed.
Writing a 1 to this bit (w1c) clears it and writing 0 has no effect.
QSPI Address Register (QAR)
The QAR is used to specify the location in the QSPI RAM that read and write operations affect. As shown
in Section 22.4.1, “QSPI RAM”, the transmit RAM is located at addresses 0x0 to 0xF, the receive RAM
is located at 0x10 to 0x1F, and the command RAM is located at 0x20 to 0x2F. (These addresses refer to
the QSPI RAM space, not the device memory map.)
NOTE
A read or write to the QSPI RAM causes QAR to increment. However, the
QAR does not wrap after the last queue entry within each section of the
RAM. The application software must manage address range errors.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
22-7
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
IPSBAR 0x00_0350 (QAR)
Offset:
R
Access: User read/write
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
5
4
3
1
0
0
0
ADDR
W
Reset
2
0
0
0
0
Figure 22-7. QSPI Address Register (QAR)
Table 22-7. QAR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15–6
Reserved, must be cleared.
5–0
ADDR
22.3.6
Address used to read/write the QSPI RAM. Ranges are as follows:
0x00–0x0F Transmit RAM
0x10–0x1F Receive RAM
0x20–0x2F Command RAM
0x30–0x3F Reserved
QSPI Data Register (QDR)
The QDR is used to access QSPI RAM indirectly. The CPU reads and writes all data from and to the QSPI
RAM through this register.
A write to QDR causes data to be written to the RAM entry specified by QAR[ADDR]. This also causes
the value in QAR to increment. Correspondingly, a read at QDR returns the data in the RAM at the address
specified by QAR[ADDR]. This also causes QAR to increment. A read access requires a single wait state.
IPSBAR 0x00_0354 (QDR)
Offset:
15
14
Access: User read/write
13
12
11
10
9
8
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DATA
W
Reset
7
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 22-8. QSPI Data Register (QDR)
Table 22-8. QDR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15–0
DATA
A write to this field causes data to be written to the QSPI RAM entry specified by QAR[ADDR]. Similarly, a read of
this field returns the data in the QSPI RAM at the address specified by QAR[ADDR]. During command RAM
accesses (QAR[ADDR] = 0x20–0x2F), only the most significant byte of this field is used.
22.3.7
Command RAM Registers (QCR0–QCR15)
The command RAM is accessed using the upper byte of the QDR; the QSPI cannot modify information in
command RAM. There are 16 bytes in the command RAM. Each byte is divided into two fields. The chip
select field enables external peripherals for transfer. The command field provides transfer operations.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
22-8
Freescale Semiconductor
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
NOTE
The command RAM is accessed only using the most significant byte of
QDR and indirect addressing based on QAR[ADDR].
Address: QAR[ADDR]
15
14
Access: CPU write-only
13
12
DT
DSCK
—
—
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
R
W CONT BITSE
Reset
—
—
QSPI_CS
—
—
—
—
Figure 22-9. Command RAM Registers (QCR0–QCR15)
Table 22-9. QCR0–QCR15 Field Descriptions
Field
Description
15
CONT
Continuous.
0 Chip selects return to inactive level defined by QWR[CSIV] when a single word transfer is complete.
1 Chip selects return to inactive level defined by QWR[CSIV] only after the transfer of the queue entries (max of 16
words).
Note: To keep the chip selects asserted for transfers beyond 16 words, the QWR[CSIV] bit must be set to control
the level that the chip selects return to after the first transfer.
14
BITSE
Bits per transfer enable.
0 Eight bits
1 Number of bits set in QMR[BITS]
13
DT
12
DSCK
Delay after transfer enable.
0 Default reset value.
1 The QSPI provides a variable delay at the end of serial transfer to facilitate interfacing with peripherals that have
a latency requirement. The delay between transfers is determined by QDLYR[DTL].
Chip select to QSPI_CLK delay enable.
0 Chip select valid to QSPI_CLK transition is one-half QSPI_CLK period.
1 QDLYR[QCD] specifies the delay from QSPI_CS valid to QSPI_CLK.
11–8
Peripheral chip selects. Used to select an external device for serial data transfer. More than one chip select may be
QSPI_CS active at once, and more than one device can be connected to each chip select. Bits 11-8 map directly to the
corresponding QSPI_CSn pins. If more than four chip selects are needed, then an external demultiplexor can be
used with the QSPI_CSn pins.
0 Enable chip select.
1 Mask chip select.
Note: Not all chip selects may be available on all device packages. See Chapter 14, “Signal Descriptions,” for details
on which chip selects are pinned-out.
7–0
22.4
Reserved, must be cleared.
Functional Description
The QSPI uses a dedicated 80-byte block of static RAM accessible to the module and CPU to perform
queued operations. The RAM is divided into three segments:
• 16 command control bytes (command RAM)
• 32 transmit data bytes (transmit data RAM)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
22-9
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
•
32 receive data bytes (receive data RAM)
The RAM is organized so that 1 byte of command control data, 1 word of transmit data, and 1 word of
receive data comprise 1 of the 16 queue entries (0x0–0xF).
NOTE
Throughout ColdFire documentation, the term word is used to designate a
16-bit data unit. The only exceptions to this appear in discussions of serial
communication modules such as QSPI that support variable-length data
units. To simplify these discussions, the functional unit is referred to as a
word regardless of length.
The user initiates QSPI operation by loading a queue of commands in command RAM, writing transmit
data into transmit RAM, and then enabling the QSPI data transfer. The QSPI executes the queued
commands and sets the completion flag in the QSPI interrupt register (QIR[SPIF]) to signal their
completion. As another option, QIR[SPIFE] can be enabled to generate an interrupt.
The QSPI uses four queue pointers. The user can access three of them through fields in QSPI wrap register
(QWR):
• New queue pointer (QWR[NEWQP])—points to the first command in the queue
• Internal queue pointer—points to the command currently being executed
• Completed queue pointer (QWR[CPTQP])—points to the last command executed
• End queue pointer (QWR[ENDQP]) —points to the final command in the queue
The internal pointer is initialized to the same value as QWR[NEWQP]. During normal operation, the
following sequence repeats:
1. The command pointed to by the internal pointer is executed.
2. The value in the internal pointer is copied into QWR[CPTQP].
3. The internal pointer is incremented.
Execution continues at the internal pointer address unless the QWR[NEWQP] value is changed. After each
command is executed, QWR[ENDQP] and QWR[CPTQP] are compared. When a match occurs,
QIR[SPIF] is set and the QSPI stops unless wraparound mode is enabled. Setting QWR[WREN] enables
wraparound mode.
QWR[NEWQP] is cleared at reset. When the QSPI is enabled, execution begins at address 0x0 unless
another value has been written into QWR[NEWQP]. QWR[ENDQP] is cleared at reset but is changed to
show the last queue entry before the QSPI is enabled. QWR[NEWQP] and QWR[ENDQP] can be written
at any time. When the QWR[NEWQP] value changes, the internal pointer value also changes unless a
transfer is in progress, in which case the transfer completes normally. Leaving QWR[NEWQP] and
QWR[ENDQP] set to 0x0 causes a single transfer to occur when the QSPI is enabled.
Data is transferred relative to QSPI_CLK, which can be generated in any one of four combinations of
phase and polarity using QMR[CPHA,CPOL]. Data is transferred with the most significant bit (msb) first.
The number of bits transferred defaults to 8, but can be set to any value between 8 and 16 by writing a
value into the BITSE field of the command RAM (QCR[BITSE]).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
22-10
Freescale Semiconductor
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
22.4.1
QSPI RAM
The QSPI contains an 80-byte block of static RAM that can be accessed by the user and the QSPI. This
RAM does not appear in the device memory map, because it can only be accessed by the user indirectly
through the QSPI address register (QAR) and the QSPI data register (QDR). The RAM is divided into
three segments with 16 addresses each:
•
•
•
Receive data RAM—the initial destination for all incoming data
Transmit data RAM—a buffer for all out-bound data
Command RAM—where commands are loaded
The transmit data and command RAM are user write-only. The receive RAM is user read-only.
Figure 22-10 shows the RAM configuration. The RAM contents are undefined immediately after a reset.
The command and data RAM in the QSPI are indirectly accessible with QDR and QAR as 48 separate
locations that comprise 16 words of transmit data, 16 words of receive data, and 16 bytes of commands.
A write to QDR causes data to be written to the RAM entry specified by QAR[ADDR] and causes the
value in QAR to increment. Correspondingly, a read from QDR returns the data in the RAM at the address
specified by QAR[ADDR]. This also causes QAR to increment. A read access requires a single wait state.
Relative
Address
Register
0x00
QTR0
0x01
QTR1
...
...
0x0F
QTR15
0x10
QRR0
0x11
QRR1
...
...
0x1F
QRR15
0x20
QCR0
0x21
QCR1
...
...
0x2F
QCR15
Function
Transmit RAM
16 bits wide
Receive RAM
16 bits wide
Command RAM
8 bits wide
Figure 22-10. QSPI RAM Model
22.4.1.1
Receive RAM
Data received by the QSPI is stored in the receive RAM segment located at 0x10 to 0x1F in the QSPI RAM
space. Read this segment to retrieve data from the QSPI. Data words with less than 16 bits are stored in
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
22-11
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
the least significant bits of the RAM. Unused bits in a receive queue entry are set to zero upon completion
of the individual queue entry. Receive RAM is not writeable.
QWR[CPTQP] shows which queue entries have been executed. The user can query this field to determine
which locations in receive RAM contain valid data.
22.4.1.2
Transmit RAM
Data to be transmitted by the QSPI is stored in the transmit RAM segment located at addresses 0x0 to 0xF.
The user normally writes 1 word into this segment for each queue command to be executed. The user
cannot read data in the transmit RAM.
Outbound data must be written to transmit RAM in a right-justified format. The unused bits are ignored.
The QSPI copies the data to its data serializer (shift register) for transmission. The data is transmitted most
significant bit first and remains in transmit RAM until overwritten by the user.
22.4.1.3
Command RAM
The CPU writes one byte of control information to this segment for each QSPI command to be executed.
Command RAM, referred to as QCR0–15, is write-only memory from a user’s perspective.
Command RAM consists of 16 bytes, each divided into two fields. The peripheral chip select field controls
the QSPI_CS signal levels for the transfer. The command control field provides transfer options.
A maximum of 16 commands can be in the queue. Queue execution proceeds from the address in
QWR[NEWQP] through the address in QWR[ENDQP].
The QSPI executes a queue of commands defined by the control bits in each command RAM entry that
sequence the following actions:
• Chip-select pins are activated.
• Data is transmitted from the transmit RAM and received into the receive RAM.
• The synchronous transfer clock QSPI_CLK is generated.
Before any data transfers begin, control data must be written to the command RAM, and any out-bound
data must be written to the transmit RAM. Also, the queue pointers must be initialized to the first and last
entries in the command queue.
Data transfer is synchronized with the internally generated QSPI_CLK, whose phase and polarity are
controlled by QMR[CPHA] and QMR[CPOL]. These control bits determine which QSPI_CLK edge is
used to drive outgoing data and to latch incoming data.
22.4.2
Baud Rate Selection
The maximum QSPI clock frequency is one-fourth the clock frequency of the internal bus clock (fsys).
Baud rate is selected by writing a value from 2–255 into QMR[BAUD]. The QSPI uses a prescaler to
derive the QSPI_CLK rate from the internal bus clock divided by two. Table 22-10 shows the QSPI_CLK
frequency as a function of internal bus clock and baud rate.
A baud rate value of zero turns off the QSPI_CLK.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
22-12
Freescale Semiconductor
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
The desired QSPI_CLK baud rate is related to the internal bus clock and QMR[BAUD] by the following
expression:
f sys
QMR[BAUD] = ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------2 × [desired QSPI_CLK baud rate]
Eqn. 22-1
Table 22-10. QSPI_CLK Frequency as Function of Internal Bus Clock and Baud Rate
Internal Bus Clock = 80 MHz
22.4.3
QMR [BAUD]
QSPI_CLK
2
20 MHz
4
10 MHz
8
5 MHz
16
2.5 MHz
32
1.25 Hz
255
156.9 kHz
Transfer Delays
The QSPI supports programmable delays for the QSPI_CS signals before and after a transfer. The time
between QSPI_CS assertion and the leading QSPI_CLK edge, and the time between the end of one transfer
and the beginning of the next, are both independently programmable.
The chip select to clock delay enable bit in the command RAM, QCR[DSCK], enables the programmable
delay period from QSPI_CS assertion until the leading edge of QSPI_CLK. QDLYR[QCD] determines the
period of delay before the leading edge of QSPI_CLK. The following expression determines the actual
delay before the QSPI_CLK leading edge:
QDLYR[QCD]
QSPI_CS-to-QSPI_CLK delay = ------------------------------------f sys
Eqn. 22-2
QDLYR[QCD] has a range of 1–127.
When QDLYR[QCD] or QCR[DSCK] equals zero, the standard delay of one-half the QSPI_CLK period
is used.
The command RAM delay after transmit enable bit, QCR[DT], enables the programmable delay period
from the negation of the QSPI_CS signals until the start of the next transfer. The delay after transfer can
be used to provide a peripheral deselect interval. A delay can also be inserted between consecutive
transfers to allow serial A/D converters to complete conversion. There are two transfer delay options: the
user can choose to delay a standard period after serial transfer is complete or can specify a delay period.
Writing a value to QDLYR[DTL] specifies a delay period. QCR[DT] determines whether the standard
delay period (DT = 0) or the specified delay period (DT = 1) is used. The following expression is used to
calculate the delay when DT equals 1:
32 × QDLYR[DTL]
Delay after transfer = -----------------------------------------------f sys
(DT = 1)
Eqn. 22-3
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
22-13
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
where QDLYR[DTL] has a range of 1–255. A zero value for DTL causes a delay-after-transfer value of
8192/fsys. Standard delay period (DT = 0) is calculated by the following:
17
Standard delay after transfer = ------f sys
(DT = 0)
Eqn. 22-4
Adequate delay between transfers must be specified for long data streams because the QSPI module
requires time to load a transmit RAM entry for transfer. Receiving devices need at least the standard delay
between successive transfers. If the internal bus clock is operating at a slower rate, the delay between
transfers must be increased proportionately.
22.4.4
Transfer Length
There are two transfer length options. The user can choose a default value of 8 bits or a programmed value
of 8 to 16 bits. The programmed value must be written into QMR[BITS]. The command RAM bits per
transfer enable field, QCR[BITSE], determines whether the default value (BITSE = 0) or the BITS[3–0]
value (BITSE = 1) is used. QMR[BITS] indicates the required number of bits to be transferred, with the
default value of 16 bits.
22.4.5
Data Transfer
The transfer operation is initiated by setting QDLYR[SPE]. Shortly after QDLYR[SPE] is set, the QSPI
executes the command at the command RAM address pointed to by QWR[NEWQP]. Data at the pointer
address in transmit RAM is loaded into the data serializer and transmitted. Data that is simultaneously
received is stored at the pointer address in receive RAM.
When the proper number of bits has been transferred, the QSPI stores the working queue pointer value in
QWR[CPTQP], increments the working queue pointer, and loads the next data for transfer from the
transmit RAM. The command pointed to by the incremented working queue pointer is executed next
unless a new value has been written to QWR[NEWQP]. If a new queue pointer value is written while a
transfer is in progress, the current transfer is completed normally.
When the CONT bit in the command RAM is set, the QSPI_CSn signals are asserted between transfers.
When CONT is cleared, QSPI_CSn are negated between transfers. The QSPI_CSn signals are not high
impedance.
When the QSPI reaches the end of the queue, it asserts the SPIF flag, QIR[SPIF]. If QIR[SPIFE] is set, an
interrupt request is generated when QIR[SPIF] is asserted. Then the QSPI clears QDLYR[SPE] and stops,
unless wraparound mode is enabled.
Wraparound mode is enabled by setting QWR[WREN]. The queue can wrap to pointer address 0x0, or to
the address specified by QWR[NEWQP], depending on the state of QWR[WRTO].
In wraparound mode, the QSPI cycles through the queue continuously, even while requesting interrupt
service. QDLYR[SPE] is not cleared when the last command in the queue is executed. New receive data
overwrites previously received data in the receive RAM. Each time the end of the queue is reached,
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
22-14
Freescale Semiconductor
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
QIR[SPIFE] is set. QIR[SPIF] is not automatically reset. If interrupt driven QSPI service is used, the
service routine must clear QIR[SPIF] to abort the current request. Additional interrupt requests during
servicing can be prevented by clearing QIR[SPIFE].
There are two recommended methods of exiting wraparound mode: clearing QWR[WREN] or setting
QWR[HALT]. Exiting wraparound mode by clearing QDLYR[SPE] is not recommended because this may
abort a serial transfer in progress. The QSPI sets SPIF, clears QDLYR[SPE], and stops the first time it
reaches the end of the queue after QWR[WREN] is cleared. After QWR[HALT] is set, the QSPI finishes
the current transfer, then stops executing commands. After the QSPI stops, QDLYR[SPE] can be cleared.
22.5
Initialization/Application Information
The following steps are necessary to set up the QSPI 12-bit data transfers and a QSPI_CLK of 5 MHz. The
QSPI RAM is set up for a queue of 16 transfers. All four QSPI_CS signals are used in this example.
1. Write the QMR with 0xB308 to set up 12-bit data words with the data shifted on the falling clock
edge, and a QSPI_CLK frequency of 5 MHz (assuming a 80-MHz internal bus clock).
2. Write QDLYR with the desired delays.
3. Write QIR with 0xD00F to enable write collision, abort bus errors, and clear any interrupts.
4. Write QAR with 0x0020 to select the first command RAM entry.
5. Write QDR with 0x7E00, 0x7E00, 0x7E00, 0x7E00, 0x7D00, 0x7D00, 0x7D00, 0x7D00, 0x7B00,
0x7B00, 0x7B00, 0x7B00, 0x7700, 0x7700, 0x7700, and 0x7700 to set up four transfers for each
chip select. The chip selects are active low in this example.
6. Write QAR with 0x0000 to select the first transmit RAM entry.
7. Write QDR with sixteen 12-bit words of data.
8. Write QWR with 0x0F00 to set up a queue beginning at entry 0 and ending at entry 15.
9. Set QDLYR[SPE] to enable the transfers.
10. Wait until the transfers are complete. QIR[SPIF] is set when the transfers are complete.
11. Write QAR with 0x0010 to select the first receive RAM entry.
12. Read QDR to get the received data for each transfer.
13. Repeat steps 5 through 13 to do another transfer.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
22-15
Queued Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
22-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 23
UART Modules
23.1
Introduction
This chapter describes the use of the three universal asynchronous receiver/transmitters (UARTs) and
includes programming examples.
NOTE
The designation n appears throughout this section to refer to registers or
signals associated with one of the three identical UART modules: UART0,
UART1, or UART2.
23.1.1
Overview
The internal bus clock can clock each of the three independent UARTs, eliminating the need for an external
UART clock. As Figure 23-1 shows, each UART module interfaces directly to the CPU and consists of:
• Serial communication channel
• Programmable clock generation
• Interrupt control logic and DMA request logic
• Internal channel control logic
Internal Bus
UART
UCTSn
Internal Channel
Control Logic
Serial
Communications
Channel
URTSn
URXDn
UTXDn
Interrupt Request
(to Interrupt Controller)
Transmit DMA Request
Receive DMA Request
Interrupt Control
Logic
DMA Request
Logic
Programmable
Clock
Generation
External Signals
UART Registers
Internal Bus Clock (fsys)
or External Clock (DTINn)
(To DMA Controller)
Figure 23-1. UART Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-1
UART Modules
NOTE
The DTINn pin can clock UARTn. However, if the timers are operating and
the UART uses DTINn as a clock source, input capture mode is not available
for that timer.
The serial communication channel provides a full-duplex asynchronous/synchronous receiver and
transmitter deriving an operating frequency from the internal bus clock or an external clock using the timer
pin. The transmitter converts parallel data from the CPU to a serial bit stream, inserting appropriate start,
stop, and parity bits. It outputs the resulting stream on the transmitter serial data output (UTXDn). See
Section 23.4.2.1, “Transmitter.”
The receiver converts serial data from the receiver serial data input (URXDn) to parallel format, checks
for a start, stop, and parity bits, or break conditions, and transfers the assembled character onto the bus
during read operations. The receiver may be polled, interrupt driven, or use DMA requests for servicing.
See Section 23.4.2.2, “Receiver.”
NOTE
The GPIO module must be configured to enable the peripheral function of
the appropriate pins (refer to Chapter 26, “General Purpose I/O Module”)
prior to configuring the UART module.
23.1.2
Features
The device contains three independent UART modules with:
• Each clocked by external clock or internal bus clock (eliminates need for an external UART clock)
• Full-duplex asynchronous/synchronous receiver/transmitter
• Quadruple-buffered receiver
• Double-buffered transmitter
• Independently programmable receiver and transmitter clock sources
• Programmable data format:
— 5–8 data bits plus parity
— Odd, even, no parity, or force parity
— One, one-and-a-half, or two stop bits
• Each serial channel programmable to normal (full-duplex), automatic echo, local loopback, or
remote loopback mode
• Automatic wake-up mode for multidrop applications
• Four maskable interrupt conditions
• All three UARTs have DMA request capability
• Parity, framing, and overrun error detection
• False-start bit detection
• Line-break detection and generation
• Detection of breaks originating in the middle of a character
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-2
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
•
Start/end break interrupt/status
23.2
External Signal Description
Table 23-1 briefly describes the UART module signals.
Table 23-1. UART Module External Signals
Signal
Description
UTXDn
Transmitter Serial Data Output. UTXDn is held high (mark condition) when the transmitter is
disabled, idle, or operating in the local loopback mode. Data is shifted out on UTXDn on the
falling edge of the clock source, with the least significant bit (lsb) sent first.
URXDn
Receiver Serial Data Input. Data received on URXDn is sampled on the rising edge of the clock
source, with the lsb received first.
UCTSn
Clear-to- Send. This input can generate an interrupt on a change of state.
URTSn
Request-to-Send. This output can be programmed to be negated or asserted automatically by
the receiver or the transmitter. When connected to a transmitter’s UCTSn, URTSn can control
serial data flow.
Figure 23-2 shows a signal configuration for a UART/RS-232 interface.
UART
RS-232 Transceiver
URTSn
DI2
UCTSn
DO2
UTXDn
DI1
URXDn
DO1
Figure 23-2. UART/RS-232 Interface
23.3
Memory Map/Register Definition
This section contains a detailed description of each register and its specific function. Flowcharts in
Section 23.5, “Initialization/Application Information,” describe basic UART module programming.
Writing control bytes into the appropriate registers controls the operation of the UART module.
NOTE
UART registers are accessible only as bytes.
NOTE
Interrupt can mean an interrupt request asserted to the CPU or a DMA
request.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-3
UART Modules
Table 23-2. UART Module Memory Map
UART0
UART1
UART2
Register
Width
Access Reset Value Section/Page
(bit)
0x00
0x0
0x0
UART Mode Registers1 (UMR1n), (UMR2n)
8
R/W
0x00
23.3.1/23-5
23.3.2/23-6
0x04
0x4
0x4
UART Status Register (USRn)
8
R
0x00
23.3.3/23-8
UART Clock Select Register1(UCSRn)
8
W
See Section
23.3.4/23-9
0x08
0x8
0x8
UART Command Registers (UCRn)
8
W
0x00
23.3.5/23-9
0x0C
0xC
0xC
UART Receive Buffers (URBn)
8
R
0xFF
23.3.6/23-11
UART Transmit Buffers (UTBn)
8
W
0x00
23.3.7/23-12
0x10
0x0
0x0
UART Input Port Change Register (UIPCRn)
8
R
See Section
23.3.8/23-12
UART Auxiliary Control Register (UACRn)
8
W
0x00
23.3.9/23-13
0x14
0x4
0x4
UART Interrupt Status Register (UISRn)
8
R
0x00
23.3.10/23-13
UART Interrupt Mask Register (UIMRn)
8
W
0x00
0x18
0x8
0x8
UART Baud Rate Generator Register (UBG1n)
8
W2
0x00
23.3.11/23-15
0x1C
0xC
0xC
UART Baud Rate Generator Register (UBG2n)
8
W2
0x00
23.3.11/23-15
0x34
0x4
0x4
UART Input Port Register (UIPn)
8
R
0xFF
23.3.12/23-15
0x38
0x8
0x8
UART Output Port Bit Set Command Register (UOP1n)
8
W2
0x00
23.3.13/23-16
0x3C
0xC
0xC
UART Output Port Bit Reset Command Register (UOP0n)
8
W2
0x00
23.3.13/23-16
1
UMR1n, UMR2n, and UCSRn must be changed only after the receiver/transmitter is issued a software reset command. If
operation is not disabled, undesirable results may occur.
2 Reading this register results in undesired effects and possible incorrect transmission or reception of characters. Register
contents may also be changed.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-4
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
23.3.1
UART Mode Registers 1 (UMR1n)
The UMR1n registers control UART module configuration. UMR1n can be read or written when the mode
register pointer points to it, at RESET or after a RESET MODE REGISTER POINTER command using
UCRn[MISC]. After UMR1n is read or written, the pointer points to UMR2n.
Access: User read/write1
IPSBAR 0x00_0200 (UMR10)
Offset: 0x00_0240 (UMR11)
0x00_0280 (UMR12)
7
6
5
RXRTS
RXIRQ/
FFULL
ERR
0
0
0
R
W
Reset:
1
4
3
PM
0
2
1
PT
0
0
0
B/C
0
0
After UMR1n is read or written, the pointer points to UMR2n
Figure 23-3. UART Mode Registers 1 (UMR1n)
Table 23-3. UMR1n Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7
RXRTS
Receiver request-to-send. Allows the URTSn output to control the UCTSn input of the transmitting device to prevent
receiver overrun. If the receiver and transmitter are incorrectly programmed for URTSn control, URTSn control is
disabled for both. Transmitter RTS control is configured in UMR2n[TXRTS].
0 The receiver has no effect on URTSn.
1 When a valid start bit is received, URTSn is negated if the UART's FIFO is full. URTSn is reasserted when the
FIFO has an empty position available.
6
RXIRQ/
FFULL
Receiver interrupt select.
0 RXRDY is the source generating interrupt or DMA requests.
1 FFULL is the source generating interrupt or DMA requests.
5
ERR
Error mode. Configures the FIFO status bits, USRn[RB,FE,PE].
0 Character mode. The USRn values reflect the status of the character at the top of the FIFO. ERR must be 0 for
correct A/D flag information when in multidrop mode.
1 Block mode. The USRn values are the logical OR of the status for all characters reaching the top of the FIFO since
the last RESET ERROR STATUS command for the UART was issued. See Section 23.3.5, “UART Command
Registers (UCRn).”
4–3
PM
Parity mode. Selects the parity or multidrop mode for the UART. The parity bit is added to the transmitted character,
and the receiver performs a parity check on incoming data. The value of PM affects PT, as shown below.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-5
UART Modules
Table 23-3. UMR1n Field Descriptions (continued)
Field
2
PT
Description
Parity type. PM and PT together select parity type (PM = 0x) or determine whether a data or address character is
transmitted (PM = 11).
1–0
B/C
PM
Parity Mode
Parity Type (PT= 0)
Parity Type (PT= 1)
00
With parity
Even parity
Odd parity
01
Force parity
Low parity
High parity
10
No parity
11
Multidrop mode
N/A
Data character
Address character
Bits per character. Selects the number of data bits per character to be sent. The values shown do not include start,
parity, or stop bits.
00 5 bits
01 6 bits
10 7 bits
11 8 bits
23.3.2
UART Mode Register 2 (UMR2n)
The UMR2n registers control UART module configuration. UMR2n can be read or written when the mode
register pointer points to it, which occurs after any access to UMR1n. UMR2n accesses do not update the
pointer.
Access: User read/write1
IPSBAR 0x00_0200 (UMR20)
Offset: 0x00_0240 (UMR21)
0x00_0280 (UMR22)
7
6
5
4
TXRTS
TXCTS
0
0
3
2
1
0
0
0
R
CM
SB
W
Reset:
0
1
0
0
0
After UMR1n is read or written, the pointer points to UMR2n
Figure 23-4. UART Mode Registers 2 (UMR2n)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-6
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
Table 23-4. UMR2n Field Descriptions
Field
7–6
CM
Description
Channel mode. Selects a channel mode. Section 23.4.3, “Looping Modes,” describes individual modes.
00 Normal
01 Automatic echo
10 Local loopback
11 Remote loopback
5
TXRTS
Transmitter ready-to-send. Controls negation of URTSn to automatically terminate a message transmission.
Attempting to program a receiver and transmitter in the same UART for URTSn control is not permitted and disables
URTSn control for both.
0 The transmitter has no effect on URTSn.
1 In applications where the transmitter is disabled after transmission completes, setting this bit automatically clears
UOP[RTS] one bit time after any characters in the transmitter shift and holding registers are completely sent,
including the programmed number of stop bits.
4
TXCTS
Transmitter clear-to-send. If TXCTS and TXRTS are set, TXCTS controls the operation of the transmitter.
0 UCTSn has no effect on the transmitter.
1 Enables clear-to-send operation. The transmitter checks the state of UCTSn each time it is ready to send a
character. If UCTSn is asserted, the character is sent; if it is deasserted, the signal UTXDn remains in the high
state and transmission is delayed until UCTSn is asserted. Changes in UCTSn as a character is being sent do
not affect its transmission.
3–0
SB
Stop-bit length control. Selects length of stop bit appended to the transmitted character. Stop-bit lengths of 9/16 to
2 bits are programmable for 6–8 bit characters. Lengths of 1-1/16 to 2 bits are programmable for 5-bit characters. In
all cases, the receiver checks only for a high condition at the center of the first stop-bit position, one bit time after the
last data bit or after the parity bit, if parity is enabled. If an external 1x clock is used for the transmitter, clearing bit 3
selects one stop bit and setting bit 3 selects two stop bits for transmission.
SB
5 Bits
6–8 Bits
SB
5–8 Bits
0000
1.063
0.563
1000
1.563
0001
1.125
0.625
1001
1.625
0010
1.188
0.688
1010
1.688
0011
1.250
0.750
1011
1.750
0100
1.313
0.813
1100
1.813
0101
1.375
0.875
1101
1.875
0110
1.438
0.938
1110
1.938
0111
1.500
1.000
1111
2.000
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-7
UART Modules
23.3.3
UART Status Registers (USRn)
The USRn registers show the status of the transmitter, the receiver, and the FIFO.
IPSBAR 0x00_0204 (USR0)
Offset: 0x00_0244 (USR1)
0x00_0284 (USR2)
R
Access: User read-only
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RB
FE
PE
OE
TXEMP
TXRDY
FFULL
RXRDY
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
W
Reset:
Figure 23-5. UART Status Registers (USRn)
Table 23-5. USRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7
RB
Received break. The received break circuit detects breaks originating in the middle of a received character. However,
a break in the middle of a character must persist until the end of the next detected character time.
0 No break was received.
1 An all-zero character of the programmed length was received without a stop bit. Only a single FIFO position is
occupied when a break is received. Further entries to the FIFO are inhibited until URXDn returns to the high state
for at least one-half bit time, which equals two successive edges of the UART clock. RB is valid only when RXRDY
is set.
6
FE
Framing error.
0 No framing error occurred.
1 No stop bit was detected when the corresponding data character in the FIFO was received. The stop-bit check
occurs in the middle of the first stop-bit position. FE is valid only when RXRDY is set.
5
PE
Parity error. Valid only if RXRDY is set.
0 No parity error occurred.
1 If UMR1n[PM] equals 0x (with parity or force parity), the corresponding character in the FIFO was received with
incorrect parity. If UMR1n[PM] equals 11 (multidrop), PE stores the received address or data (A/D) bit. PE is valid
only when RXRDY is set.
4
OE
Overrun error. Indicates whether an overrun occurs.
0 No overrun occurred.
1 One or more characters in the received data stream have been lost. OE is set upon receipt of a new character
when the FIFO is full and a character is already in the shift register waiting for an empty FIFO position. When this
occurs, the character in the receiver shift register and its break detect, framing error status, and parity error, if any,
are lost. The RESET ERROR STATUS command in UCRn clears OE.
3
TEMP
Transmitter empty.
0 The transmit buffer is not empty. A character is shifted out, or the transmitter is disabled. The transmitter is
enabled/disabled by programming UCRn[TC].
1 The transmitter has underrun (the transmitter holding register and transmitter shift registers are empty). This bit
is set after transmission of the last stop bit of a character if there are no characters in the transmitter holding
register awaiting transmission.
2
TXRDY
Transmitter ready.
0 The CPU loaded the transmitter holding register, or the transmitter is disabled.
1 The transmitter holding register is empty and ready for a character. TXRDY is set when a character is sent to the
transmitter shift register or when the transmitter is first enabled. If the transmitter is disabled, characters loaded
into the transmitter holding register are not sent.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-8
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
Table 23-5. USRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Field
Description
1
FFULL
FIFO full.
0 The FIFO is not full but may hold up to two unread characters.
1 A character was received and the receiver FIFO is now full. Any characters received when the FIFO is full are lost.
0
RXRDY
Receiver ready.
0 The CPU has read the receive buffer and no characters remain in the FIFO after this read.
1 One or more characters were received and are waiting in the receive buffer FIFO.
23.3.4
UART Clock Select Registers (UCSRn)
The UCSRs select an external clock on the DTIN input (divided by 1 or 16) or a prescaled internal bus
clock as the clocking source for the transmitter and receiver. See Section 23.4.1, “Transmitter/Receiver
Clock Source.” The transmitter and receiver can use different clock sources. To use the internal bus clock
for both, set UCSRn to 0xDD.
IPSBAR 0x00_0204 (UCSR0)
Offset: 0x00_0244 (UCSR1)
0x00_0284 (UCSR2)
7
Access: User write-only
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
Reset:
RCS
TCS
See Note
See Note
Note: The RCS and TCS reset values are set so the receiver and transmiter use the prescaled internal bus
clock as their clock source.
Figure 23-6. UART Clock Select Registers (UCSRn)
Table 23-6. UCSRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7–4
RCS
Receiver clock select. Selects the clock source for the receiver.
1101 Prescaled internal bus clock (fsys)
1110 DTINn divided by 16
1111 DTINn
3–0
TCS
Transmitter clock select. Selects the clock source for the transmitter.
1101 Prescaled internal bus clock (fsys)
1110 DTINn divided by 16
1111 DTINn
23.3.5
UART Command Registers (UCRn)
The UCRs supply commands to the UART. Only multiple commands that do not conflict can be specified
in a single write to a UCRn. For example, RESET TRANSMITTER and ENABLE TRANSMITTER cannot be
specified in one command.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-9
UART Modules
IPSBAR 0x00_0208 (UCR0)
Offset: 0x00_0248 (UCR1)
0x00_0288 (UCR2)
7
Access: User write-only
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
W
0
Reset:
0
MISC
0
0
TC
0
0
RC
0
0
0
Figure 23-7. UART Command Registers (UCRn)
Table 23-7 describes UCRn fields and commands. Examples in Section 23.4.2, “Transmitter and Receiver
Operating Modes,” show how these commands are used.
Table 23-7. UCRn Field Descriptions
Field
7
6–4
MISC
Description
Reserved, must be cleared.
MISC Field (this field selects a single command)
Command
Description
000
NO COMMAND
—
001
RESET MODE
Causes the mode register pointer to point to UMR1n.
REGISTER POINTER
010
RESET RECEIVER
Immediately disables the receiver, clears USRn[FFULL,RXRDY], and reinitializes
the receiver FIFO pointer. No other registers are altered. Because it places the
receiver in a known state, use this command instead of RECEIVER DISABLE when
reconfiguring the receiver.
011
RESET
Immediately disables the transmitter and clears USRn[TXEMP,TXRDY]. No other
registers are altered. Because it places the transmitter in a known state, use this
command instead of TRANSMITTER DISABLE when reconfiguring the transmitter.
TRANSMITTER
100
Clears USRn[RB,FE,PE,OE]. Also used in block mode to clear all error bits after
a data block is received.
RESET ERROR
STATUS
101
RESET BREAK
–
Clears the delta break bit, UISRn[DB].
CHANGE INTERRUPT
110
START BREAK
Forces UTXDn low. If the transmitter is empty, break may be delayed up to one bit
time. If the transmitter is active, break starts when character transmission
completes. Break is delayed until any character in the transmitter shift register is
sent. Any character in the transmitter holding register is sent after the break.
Transmitter must be enabled for the command to be accepted. This command
ignores the state of UCTSn.
111
STOP BREAK
Causes UTXDn to go high (mark) within two bit times. Any characters in the
transmit buffer are sent.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-10
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
Table 23-7. UCRn Field Descriptions (continued)
Field
3–2
TC
Description
Transmit command field. Selects a single transmit command.
Command
00
NO ACTION TAKEN
Causes the transmitter to stay in its current mode: if the transmitter is enabled, it
remains enabled; if the transmitter is disabled, it remains disabled.
01
TRANSMITTER
Enables operation of the UART’s transmitter. USRn[TXEMP,TXRDY] are set. If the
transmitter is already enabled, this command has no effect.
ENABLE
10
TRANSMITTER
DISABLE
11
1–0
RC
Description
—
Terminates transmitter operation and clears USRn[TXEMP,TXRDY]. If a character
is being sent when the transmitter is disabled, transmission completes before the
transmitter becomes inactive. If the transmitter is already disabled, the command
has no effect.
Reserved, do not use.
Receive command field. Selects a single receive command.
Command
00
NO ACTION TAKEN
01
RECEIVER ENABLE
10
RECEIVER DISABLE
11
23.3.6
—
Description
Causes the receiver to stay in its current mode. If the receiver is enabled, it
remains enabled; if disabled, it remains disabled.
If the UART module is not in multidrop mode (UMR1n[PM] ≠ 11), RECEIVER ENABLE
enables the UART's receiver and forces it into search-for-start-bit state. If the
receiver is already enabled, this command has no effect.
Disables the receiver immediately. Any character being received is lost. The
command does not affect receiver status bits or other control registers. If the
UART module is programmed for local loopback or multidrop mode, the receiver
operates even though this command is selected. If the receiver is already
disabled, the command has no effect.
Reserved, do not use.
UART Receive Buffers (URBn)
The receive buffers contain one serial shift register and three receiver holding registers, which act as a
FIFO. URXDn is connected to the serial shift register. The CPU reads from the top of the FIFO while the
receiver shifts and updates from the bottom when the shift register is full (see Figure 23-18). RB contains
the character in the receiver.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-11
UART Modules
IPSBAR 0x00_020C (URB0)
Offset: 0x00_024C (URB1)
0x00_028C (URB2)
7
6
Access: User read-only
5
4
R
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
RB
W
Reset:
1
1
1
1
Figure 23-8. UART Receive Buffer (URBn)
23.3.7
UART Transmit Buffers (UTBn)
The transmit buffers consist of the transmitter holding register and the transmitter shift register. The
holding register accepts characters from the bus master if UART’s USRn[TXRDY] is set. A write to the
transmit buffer clears USRn[TXRDY], inhibiting any more characters until the shift register can accept
more data. When the shift register is empty, it checks if the holding register has a valid character to be sent
(TXRDY = 0). If there is a valid character, the shift register loads it and sets USRn[TXRDY] again. Writes
to the transmit buffer when the UART’s TXRDY is cleared and the transmitter is disabled have no effect
on the transmit buffer.
Figure 23-9 shows UTBn. TB contains the character in the transmit buffer.
IPSBAR 0x00_020C (UTB0)
Offset: 0x00_024C (UTB1)
0x00_028C (UTB2)
7
6
Access: User write-only
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
R
W
Reset:
TB
0
0
0
0
Figure 23-9. UART Transmit Buffer (UTBn)
23.3.8
UART Input Port Change Registers (UIPCRn)
The UIPCRs hold the current state and the change-of-state for UCTSn.
IPSBAR 0x00_0210 (UIPCR0)
Offset: 0x00_0250 (UIPCR1)
0x00_0290 (UIPCR2)
R
Access: User read-only
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
COS
1
1
1
CTS
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
UCTSn
W
Reset:
Figure 23-10. UART Input Port Changed Registers (UIPCRn)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-12
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
Table 23-8. UIPCRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7–5
Reserved
4
COS
Change of state (high-to-low or low-to-high transition).
0 No change-of-state since the CPU last read UIPCRn. Reading UIPCRn clears UISRn[COS].
1 A change-of-state longer than 25–50 μs occurred on the UCTSn input. UACRn can be programmed to generate
an interrupt to the CPU when a change of state is detected.
3–1
Reserved
0
CTS
Current state of clear-to-send. Starting two serial clock periods after reset, CTS reflects the state of UCTSn. If
UCTSn is detected asserted at that time, COS is set, which initiates an interrupt if UACRn[IEC] is enabled.
0 The current state of the UCTSn input is asserted.
1 The current state of the UCTSn input is deasserted.
23.3.9
UART Auxiliary Control Register (UACRn)
The UACRs control the input enable.
IPSBAR 0x00_0210 (UACR0)
Offset: 0x00_0250 (UACR1)
0x00_0290 (UACR2)
Access: User write-only
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IEC
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
Figure 23-11. UART Auxiliary Control Registers (UACRn)
Table 23-9. UACRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7–1
Reserved, must be cleared.
0
IEC
Input enable control.
0 Setting the corresponding UIPCRn bit has no effect on UISRn[COS].
1 UISRn[COS] is set and an interrupt is generated when the UIPCRn[COS] is set by an external transition on the
UCTSn input (if UIMRn[COS] = 1).
23.3.10 UART Interrupt Status/Mask Registers (UISRn/UIMRn)
The UISRs provide status for all potential interrupt sources. UISRn contents are masked by UIMRn. If
corresponding UISRn and UIMRn bits are set, internal interrupt output is asserted. If a UIMRn bit is
cleared, state of the corresponding UISRn bit has no effect on the output.
The UISRn and UIMRn registers share the same space in memory. Reading this register provides the user
with interrupt status, while writing controls the mask bits.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-13
UART Modules
NOTE
True status is provided in the UISRn regardless of UIMRn settings. UISRn
is cleared when the UART module is reset.
IPSBAR 0x00_0214 (UISR0)
Offset: 0x00_0254 (UISR1)
0x00_0294 (UISR2)
Access: User read/write
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R
(UISRn)
COS
0
0
0
0
DB
FFULL/
RXRDY
TXRDY
W
(UIMRn)
COS
0
0
0
0
DB
FFULL/
RXRDY
TXRDY
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reset:
Figure 23-12. UART Interrupt Status/Mask Registers (UISRn/UIMRn)
Table 23-10. UISRn/UIMRn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7
COS
Change-of-state.
0 UIPCRn[COS] is not selected.
1 Change-of-state occurred on UCTSn and was programmed in UACRn[IEC] to cause an interrupt.
6–3
Reserved, must be cleared.
2
DB
Delta break.
0 No new break-change condition to report. Section 23.3.5, “UART Command Registers (UCRn),” describes the
RESET BREAK-CHANGE INTERRUPT command.
1 The receiver detected the beginning or end of a received break.
1
FFULL/
RXRDY
0
TXRDY
Status of FIFO or receiver, depending on UMR1[FFULL/RXRDY] bit. Duplicate of USRn[FIFO] and USRn[RXRDY]
UIMRn
UISRn
[FFULL/RXRDY] [FFULL/RXRDY]
UMR1n[FFULL/RXRDY]
0 (RXRDY)
1 (FIFO)
0
0
Receiver not ready
FIFO not full
1
0
Receiver not ready
FIFO not full
0
1
Receiver is ready,
Do not interrupt
FIFO is full,
Do not interrupt
1
1
Receiver is ready,
interrupt
FIFO is full,
interrupt
Transmitter ready. This bit is the duplication of USRn[TXRDY].
0 The transmitter holding register was loaded by the CPU or the transmitter is disabled. Characters loaded into the
transmitter holding register when TXRDY is cleared are not sent.
1 The transmitter holding register is empty and ready to be loaded with a character.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-14
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
23.3.11 UART Baud Rate Generator Registers (UBG1n/UBG2n)
The UBG1n registers hold the MSB, and the UBG2n registers hold the LSB of the preload value. UBG1n
and UBG2n concatenate to provide a divider to the internal bus clock for transmitter/receiver operation,
as described in Section 23.4.1.2.1, “Internal Bus Clock Baud Rates.”
IPSBAR 0x00_0218 (UBG10)
Offset: 0x00_0258 (UBG11)
0x00_0298 (UBG12)
7
6
Access: User write-only
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
R
W
Reset:
Divider MSB
0
0
0
0
Figure 23-13. UART Baud Rate Generator Registers (UBG1n)
IPSBAR 0x00_021C (UBG20)
Offset: 0x00_025C (UBG21)
0x00_029C (UBG22)
7
6
Access: User write-only
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
R
W
Reset:
Divider LSB
0
0
0
0
Figure 23-14. UART Baud Rate Generator Registers (UBG2n)
NOTE
The minimum value loaded on the concatenation of UBG1n with UBG2n is
0x0002. The UBG2n reset value of 0x00 is invalid and must be written to
before the UART transmitter or receiver are enabled. UBG1n and UBG2n
are write-only and cannot be read by the CPU.
23.3.12 UART Input Port Register (UIPn)
The UIPn registers show the current state of the UCTSn input.
IPSBAR 0x00_0234 (UIP0)
Offset: 0x00_0274 (UIP1)
0x00_02B4 (UIP2)
R
Access: User read-only
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CTS
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
W
Reset:
Figure 23-15. UART Input Port Registers (UIPn)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-15
UART Modules
Table 23-11. UIPn Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7–1
Reserved
0
CTS
Current state of clear-to-send. The UCTSn value is latched and reflects the state of the input pin when UIPn is read.
Note: This bit has the same function and value as UIPCRn[CTS].
0 The current state of the UCTSn input is logic 0.
1 The current state of the UCTSn input is logic 1.
23.3.13 UART Output Port Command Registers (UOP1n/UOP0n)
The URTSn output can be asserted by writing a 1 to UOP1n[RTS] and negated by writing a 1 to
UOP0n[RTS].
IPSBAR 0x00_0238 (UOP10)
Offset: 0x00_023C (UOP00)
0x00_0278 (UOP11)
0x00_027C (UOP01)
0x00_02B8 (UOP12)
0x00_02BC (UOP02)
Access: User write-only
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RTS
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
Figure 23-16. UART Output Port Command Registers (UOP1n/UOP0n)
Table 23-12. UOP1n/UOP0n Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7–1
Reserved, must be cleared.
0
RTS
Output port output. Controls assertion (UOP1)/negation (UOP0) of URTSn output.
0 Not affected.
1 Asserts URTSn in UOP1. Negates URTSn in UOP0.
23.4
Functional Description
This section describes operation of the clock source generator, transmitter, and receiver.
23.4.1
Transmitter/Receiver Clock Source
The internal bus clock serves as the basic timing reference for the clock source generator logic, which
consists of a clock generator and a programmable 16-bit divider dedicated to each UART. The 16-bit
divider is used to produce standard UART baud rates.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-16
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
23.4.1.1
Programmable Divider
As Figure 23-17 shows, the UARTn transmitter and receiver can use the following clock sources:
• An external clock signal on the DTINn pin. When not divided, DTINn provides a synchronous
clock; when divided by 16, it is asynchronous.
•
The internal bus clock supplies an asynchronous clock source divided by 32 and then divided by
the 16-bit value programmed in UBG1n and UBG2n. See Section 23.3.11, “UART Baud Rate
Generator Registers (UBG1n/UBG2n).”
The choice of DTIN or internal bus clock is programmed in the UCSR.
DTOUTn
On-Chip
Timer Module
DTINn
UART
UTXDn
Tx Buffer
Clocking sources programmed in UCSR
TIN
÷1
Tx
÷ 16
TIN
Rx
16-bit
Divider
URXDn
÷ 32
Internal
Bus Clock
fsys
Rx Buffer
Figure 23-17. Clocking Source Diagram
NOTE
If DTINn is a clocking source for the timer or UART, that timer module
cannot use DTINn for timer input capture.
23.4.1.2
Calculating Baud Rates
The following sections describe how to calculate baud rates.
23.4.1.2.1
Internal Bus Clock Baud Rates
When the internal bus clock is the UART clocking source, it goes through a divide-by-32 prescaler and
then passes through the 16-bit divider of the concatenated UBG1n and UBG2n registers. The baud-rate
calculation is:
f sys
Baudrate = ----------------------------------[ 32 x Divider ]
Eqn. 23-1
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-17
UART Modules
Using a 80-MHz internal bus clock and letting baud rate equal 9600, then
80MHz
Divider = ------------------------------- = 260 ( decimal ) = 0x0104 ( hexadecimal )
[ 32 x 9600 ]
Eqn. 23-2
Therefore, UBG1n equals 0x01 and UBG2n equals 0x04.
23.4.1.2.2
External Clock
An external source clock (DTINn) passes through a divide-by-1 or 16 prescaler. If fextc is the external clock
frequency, baud rate can be described with this equation:
f extc
Baudrate = --------------------(16 or 1)
23.4.2
Eqn. 23-3
Transmitter and Receiver Operating Modes
Figure 23-18 is a functional block diagram of the transmitter and receiver showing the command and
operating registers, which are described generally in the following sections. For detailed descriptions, refer
to Section 23.3, “Memory Map/Register Definition.”
UARTn
UART Command Register (UCRn)
UART
Transmit Buffer
(UTBn)
(2 Registers)
W
UART Mode Register 1 (UMR1n)
R/W
UART Mode Register 2 (UMR2n)
R/W
UART Status Register (USRn)
R
Transmitter Holding Register
W
UTXDn
Transmitter Shift Register
Receiver Holding Register 1
R
FIFO
Receiver Holding Register 2
External
Interface
Receiver Holding Register 3
UART Receive
Buffer (URBn)
(4 Registers)
Receiver Shift Register
URXDn
Figure 23-18. Transmitter and Receiver Functional Diagram
23.4.2.1
Transmitter
The transmitter is enabled through the UART command register (UCRn). When it is ready to accept a
character, UART sets USRn[TXRDY]. The transmitter converts parallel data from the CPU to a serial bit
stream on UTXDn. It automatically sends a start bit followed by the programmed number of data bits, an
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-18
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
optional parity bit, and the programmed number of stop bits. The lsb is sent first. Data is shifted from the
transmitter output on the falling edge of the clock source.
After the stop bits are sent, if no new character is in the transmitter holding register, the UTXDn output
remains high (mark condition) and the transmitter empty bit (USRn[TXEMP]) is set. Transmission
resumes and TXEMP is cleared when the CPU loads a new character into the UART transmit buffer
(UTBn). If the transmitter receives a disable command, it continues until any character in the transmitter
shift register is completely sent.
If the transmitter is reset through a software command, operation stops immediately (see Section 23.3.5,
“UART Command Registers (UCRn)”). The transmitter is reenabled through the UCRn to resume
operation after a disable or software reset.
If the clear-to-send operation is enabled, UCTSn must be asserted for the character to be transmitted. If
UCTSn is negated in the middle of a transmission, the character in the shift register is sent and UTXDn
remains in mark state until UCTSn is reasserted. If transmitter is forced to send a continuous low condition
by issuing a SEND BREAK command, transmitter ignores the state of UCTSn.
If the transmitter is programmed to automatically negate URTSn when a message transmission completes,
URTSn must be asserted manually before a message is sent. In applications in which the transmitter is
disabled after transmission is complete and URTSn is appropriately programmed, URTSn is negated one
bit time after the character in the shift register is completely transmitted. The transmitter must be manually
reenabled by reasserting URTSn before the next message is sent.
Figure 23-19 shows the functional timing information for the transmitter.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-19
UART Modules
C1 in transmission
C11
UTXDn
C2
C3
C4
Break
C6
Transmitter
Enabled
USRn[TXRDY]
internal
module
select
W2
W
W
C11
C2
C3 Start
break
W
W
W
C4 Stop
break
W
W
C5
not
transmitted
C6
UCTSn3
URTSn4
Manually asserted
by BIT-SET command
Manually
asserted
1 Cn = transmit characters
2 W = write
3 UMR2n[TXCTS] = 1
4 UMR2n[TXRTS] = 1
Figure 23-19. Transmitter Timing Diagram
23.4.2.2
Receiver
The receiver is enabled through its UCRn, as described in Section 23.3.5, “UART Command Registers
(UCRn).”
When the receiver detects a high-to-low (mark-to-space) transition of the start bit on URXDn, the state of
URXDn is sampled eight times on the edge of the bit time clock starting one-half clock after the transition
(asynchronous operation) or at the next rising edge of the bit time clock (synchronous operation). If
URXDn is sampled high, start bit is invalid and the search for the valid start bit begins again.
If URXDn remains low, a valid start bit is assumed. The receiver continues sampling the input at one-bit
time intervals at the theoretical center of the bit until the proper number of data bits and parity, if any, is
assembled and one stop bit is detected. Data on the URXDn input is sampled on the rising edge of the
programmed clock source. The lsb is received first. The data then transfers to a receiver holding register
and USRn[RXRDY] is set. If the character is less than 8 bits, the most significant unused bits in the
receiver holding register are cleared.
After the stop bit is detected, receiver immediately looks for the next start bit. However, if a non-zero
character is received without a stop bit (framing error) and URXDn remains low for one-half of the bit
period after the stop bit is sampled, receiver operates as if a new start bit were detected. Parity error,
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-20
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
framing error, overrun error, and received break conditions set the respective PE, FE, OE, and RB error
and break flags in the USRn at the received character boundary. They are valid only if USRn[RXRDY] is
set.
If a break condition is detected (URXDn is low for the entire character including the stop bit), a character
of all 0s loads into the receiver holding register and USRn[RB,RXRDY] are set. URXDn must return to a
high condition for at least one-half bit time before a search for the next start bit begins.
The receiver detects the beginning of a break in the middle of a character if the break persists through the
next character time. The receiver places the damaged character in the Rx FIFO and sets the corresponding
USRn error bits and USRn[RXRDY]. Then, if the break lasts until the next character time, the receiver
places an all-zero character into the Rx FIFO and sets USRn[RB,RXRDY].
Figure 23-20 shows receiver functional timing.
URXDn
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C6, C7, and C8 is lost
Receiver
Enabled
USRn[RXRDY]
USRn[FFULL]
Internal
module
select
Status
Data
(C1)
C5 is
lost
Status Status Status
Data Data Data
(C2) (C3) (C4)
Reset by
command
Overrun
USRn[OE]
URTSn1
Manually asserted first time,
automatically negated if overrun occurs
UOP0[RTS] = 1
1 UMR2n[RXRTS]
Automatically asserted
when ready to receive
=1
Figure 23-20. Receiver Timing Diagram
23.4.2.3
FIFO
The FIFO is used in the UART’s receive buffer logic. The FIFO consists of three receiver holding registers.
The receive buffer consists of the FIFO and a receiver shift register connected to the URXDn (see
Figure 23-18). Data is assembled in the receiver shift register and loaded into the top empty receiver
holding register position of the FIFO. Therefore, data flowing from the receiver to the CPU is
quadruple-buffered.
In addition to the data byte, three status bits—parity error (PE), framing error (FE), and received break
(RB)—are appended to each data character in the FIFO; overrun error (OE) is not appended. By
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-21
UART Modules
programming the ERR bit in the UART’s mode register (UMR1n), status is provided in character or block
modes.
USRn[RXRDY] is set when at least one character is available to be read by the CPU. A read of the receive
buffer produces an output of data from the top of the FIFO. After the read cycle, the data at the top of the
FIFO and its associated status bits are popped and the receiver shift register can add new data at the bottom
of the FIFO. The FIFO-full status bit (FFULL) is set if all three positions are filled with data. The RXRDY
or FFULL bit can be selected to cause an interrupt and TXRDY or RXRDY can be used to generate a DMA
request.
The two error modes are selected by UMR1n[ERR]:
• In character mode (UMR1n[ERR] = 0), status is given in the USRn for the character at the top of
the FIFO.
• In block mode, the USRn shows a logical OR of all characters reaching the top of the FIFO since
the last RESET ERROR STATUS command. Status is updated as characters reach the top of the
FIFO. Block mode offers a data-reception speed advantage where the software overhead of
error-checking each character cannot be tolerated. However, errors are not detected until the check
is performed at the end of an entire message—the faulting character is not identified.
In either mode, reading the USRn does not affect the FIFO. The FIFO is popped only when the receive
buffer is read. The USRn should be read before reading the receive buffer. If all three receiver holding
registers are full, a new character is held in the receiver shift register until space is available. However, if
a second new character is received, the contents of the character in the receiver shift register is lost, the
FIFOs are unaffected, and USRn[OE] is set when the receiver detects the start bit of the new overrunning
character.
To support flow control, the receiver can be programmed to automatically negate and assert URTSn, in
which case the receiver automatically negates URTSn when a valid start bit is detected and the FIFO is
full. The receiver asserts URTSn when a FIFO position becomes available; therefore, connecting URTSn
to the UCTSn input of the transmitting device can prevent overrun errors.
NOTE
The receiver continues reading characters in the FIFO if the receiver is
disabled. If the receiver is reset, the FIFO, URTSn control, all receiver status
bits, interrupts, and DMA requests are reset. No more characters are
received until the receiver is reenabled.
23.4.3
Looping Modes
The UART can be configured to operate in various looping modes. These modes are useful for local and
remote system diagnostic functions. The modes are described in the following paragraphs and in
Section 23.3, “Memory Map/Register Definition.”
The UART’s transmitter and receiver should be disabled when switching between modes. The selected
mode is activated immediately upon mode selection, regardless of whether a character is being received
or transmitted.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-22
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
23.4.3.1
Automatic Echo Mode
In automatic echo mode, shown in Figure 23-21, the UART automatically resends received data bit by bit.
The local CPU-to-receiver communication continues normally, but the CPU-to-transmitter link is
disabled. In this mode, received data is clocked on the receiver clock and re-sent on UTXDn. The receiver
must be enabled, but the transmitter need not be.
URXDn Input
Rx
CPU
Disabled
Tx
Disabled
UTXDn Output
Figure 23-21. Automatic Echo
Because the transmitter is inactive, USRn[TXEMP,TXRDY] is inactive and data is sent as it is received.
Received parity is checked but not recalculated for transmission. Character framing is also checked, but
stop bits are sent as they are received. A received break is echoed as received until the next valid start bit
is detected.
23.4.3.2
Local Loopback Mode
Figure 23-22 shows how UTXDn and URXDn are internally connected in local loopback mode. This
mode is for testing the operation of a UART by sending data to the transmitter and checking data
assembled by the receiver to ensure proper operations.
Rx
Disabled URXDn Input
Tx
Disabled UTXDn Output
CPU
Figure 23-22. Local Loopback
Features of this local loopback mode are:
• Transmitter and CPU-to-receiver communications continue normally in this mode.
• URXDn input data is ignored.
• UTXDn is held marking.
• The receiver is clocked by the transmitter clock. The transmitter must be enabled, but the receiver
need not be.
23.4.3.3
Remote Loopback Mode
In remote loopback mode, shown in Figure 23-23, the UART automatically transmits received data bit by
bit on the UTXDn output. The local CPU-to-transmitter link is disabled. This mode is useful in testing
receiver and transmitter operation of a remote UART. For this mode, transmitter uses the receiver clock.
Because the receiver is not active, received data cannot be read by the CPU and all status conditions are
inactive. Received parity is not checked and is not recalculated for transmission. Stop bits are sent as they
are received. A received break is echoed as received until next valid start bit is detected.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-23
UART Modules
Disabled
Rx
Disabled
URXDn Input
Disabled
UTXDn Output
CPU
Disabled
Tx
Figure 23-23. Remote Loopback
23.4.4
Multidrop Mode
Setting UMR1n[PM] programs the UART to operate in a wake-up mode for multidrop or multiprocessor
applications. In this mode, a master can transmit an address character followed by a block of data
characters targeted for one of up to 256 slave stations.
Although slave stations have their receivers disabled, they continuously monitor the master’s data stream.
When the master sends an address character, the slave receiver notifies its respective CPU by setting
USRn[RXRDY] and generating an interrupt (if programmed to do so). Each slave station CPU then
compares the received address to its station address and enables its receiver if it wishes to receive the
subsequent data characters or block of data from the master station. Unaddressed slave stations continue
monitoring the data stream. Data fields in the data stream are separated by an address character. After a
slave receives a block of data, its CPU disables the receiver and repeats the process. Functional timing
information for multidrop mode is shown in Figure 23-24.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-24
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
Master Station
A/D
UTXDn
ADD1 1
A/D
A/D
C0
ADD2 1
Transmitter
Enabled
USRn[TXRDY]
internal
module
select
C0
UMR1n[PM] = 11 ADD 1
UMR1n[PT] = 1
UMR1n[PT] = 0
ADD 2
UMR1n[PT] = 1
Peripheral Station
URXDn
A/D
A/D
0
ADD1 1
A/D
C0
A/D
A/D
ADD2 1
0
Receiver
Enabled
USRn[RXRDY]
internal
module
select
UMR1n[PM] = 11
ADD 1
Status Data
(C0)
Status Data
(ADD 2)
Figure 23-24. Multidrop Mode Timing Diagram
A character sent from the master station consists of a start bit, a programmed number of data bits, an
address/data (A/D) bit flag, and a programmed number of stop bits. A/D equals 1 indicates an address
character; A/D equals 0 indicates a data character. The polarity of A/D is selected through UMR1n[PT].
UMR1n should be programmed before enabling the transmitter and loading the corresponding data bits
into the transmit buffer.
In multidrop mode, the receiver continuously monitors the received data stream, regardless of whether it
is enabled or disabled. If the receiver is disabled, it sets the RXRDY bit and loads the character into the
receiver holding register FIFO provided the received A/D bit is a 1 (address tag). The character is
discarded if the received A/D bit is 0 (data tag). If the receiver is enabled, all received characters are
transferred to the CPU through the receiver holding register during read operations.
In either case, data bits load into the data portion of the FIFO while the A/D bit loads into the status portion
of the FIFO normally used for a parity error (USRn[PE]).
Framing error, overrun error, and break detection operate normally. The A/D bit takes the place of the
parity bit; therefore, parity is neither calculated nor checked. Messages in this mode may continues
containing error detection and correction information. If 8-bit characters are not required, one way to
provide error detection is to use software to calculate parity and append it to the 5-, 6-, or 7-bit character.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-25
UART Modules
23.4.5
Bus Operation
This section describes bus operation during read, write, and interrupt acknowledge cycles to the UART
module.
23.4.5.1
Read Cycles
The UART module responds to reads with byte data. Reserved registers return zeros.
23.4.5.2
Write Cycles
The UART module accepts write data as bytes only. Write cycles to read-only or reserved registers
complete normally without an error termination, but data is ignored.
23.5
Initialization/Application Information
The software flowchart, Figure 23-25, consists of:
• UART module initialization—These routines consist of SINIT and CHCHK (See Sheet 1 p. 23-30
and Sheet 2 p. 23-31). Before SINIT is called at system initialization, the calling routine allocates
2 words on the system FIFO. On return to the calling routine, SINIT passes UART status data on
the FIFO. If SINIT finds no errors, the transmitter and receiver are enabled. SINIT calls CHCHK
to perform the checks. When called, SINIT places the UART in local loopback mode and checks
for the following errors:
— Transmitter never ready
— Receiver never ready
— Parity error
— Incorrect character received
• I/O driver routine—This routine (See Sheet 4 p. 23-33 and Sheet 5 p. 23-34) consists of INCH, the
terminal input character routine which gets a character from the receiver, and OUTCH, which
sends a character to the transmitter.
• Interrupt handling—This consists of SIRQ (See Sheet 4 p. 23-33), which is executed after the
UART module generates an interrupt caused by a change-in-break (beginning of a break). SIRQ
then clears the interrupt source, waits for the next change-in-break interrupt (end of break), clears
the interrupt source again, then returns from exception processing to the system monitor.
23.5.1
23.5.1.1
Interrupt and DMA Request Initialization
Setting up the UART to Generate Core Interrupts
The list below provides steps to properly initialize the UART to generate an interrupt request to the
processor’s interrupt controller. See Section 10.3.6.1, “Interrupt Sources,” for details on interrupt
assignments for the UART modules.
1. Initialize the appropriate ICRx register in the interrupt controller.
2. Unmask appropriate bits in IMR in the interrupt controller.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-26
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
3. Unmask appropriate bits in the core’s status register (SR) to enable interrupts.
4. If TXRDY or RXRDY generates interrupt requests, verify that DMAREQC (in the SCM) does not
also assign the UART’s TXRDY and RXRDY into DMA channels.
5. Initialize interrupts in the UART, see Table 23-13.
Table 23-13. UART Interrupts
23.5.1.2
Register
Bit
Interrupt
UMR1n
6
RxIRQ
UIMRn
7
Change of State (COS)
UIMRn
2
Delta Break
UIMRn
1
RxFIFO Full
UIMRn
0
TXRDY
Setting up the UART to Request DMA Service
The UART is capable of generating two internal DMA request signals: transmit and receive.
The transmit DMA request signal is asserted when the TXRDY (transmitter ready) in the UART interrupt
status register (UISRn[TXRDY]) is set. When the transmit DMA request signal is asserted, the DMA can
initiate a data copy, reading the next character transmitted from memory and writing it into the UART
transmit buffer (UTBn). This allows the DMA channel to stream data from memory to the UART for
transmission without processor intervention. After the entire message has been moved into the UART, the
DMA would typically generate an end-of-data-transfer interrupt request to the CPU. The resulting
interrupt service routine (ISR) could query the UART programming model to determine the
end-of-transmission status.
Similarly, the receive DMA request signal is asserted when the FIFO full or receive ready
(FFULL/RXRDY) flag in the interrupt status register (UISRn[FFULL/RXRDY]) is set. When the receive
DMA request signal is asserted, the DMA can initiate a data move, reading the appropriate characters from
the UART receive buffer (URBn) and storing them in memory. This allows the DMA channel to stream
data from the UART receive buffer into memory without processor intervention. After the entire message
has been moved from the UART, the DMA would typically generate an end-of-data-transfer interrupt
request to the CPU. The resulting interrupt service routine (ISR) should query the UART programming
model to determine the end-of-transmission status. In typical applications, the receive DMA request
should be configured to use RXRDY directly (and not FFULL) to remove any complications related to
retrieving the final characters from the FIFO buffer.
The implementation described in this section allows independent DMA processing of transmit and receive
data while continuing to support interrupt notification to the processor for CTS change-of-state and delta
break error managing.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-27
UART Modules
To configure the UART for DMA requests:
1. Initialize the DMAREQC in the SCM to map the desired UART DMA requests to the desired DMA
channels. For example, setting DMAREQC[7:4] to 1000 maps UART0 receive DMA requests to
DMA channel 1, setting DMAREQC[11:8] to 1101 maps UART1 transmit DMA requests to DMA
channel 2, and so on. It is possible to independently map transmit-based and receive-based UART
DMA requests in the DMAREQC.
2. Disable interrupts using the UIMR register. The appropriate UIMR bits must be cleared so that
interrupt requests are disabled for those conditions for which a DMA request is desired. For
example, to generate transmit DMA requests from UART1, UIMR1[TXRDY] should be cleared.
This prevents TXRDY from generating an interrupt request while a transmit DMA request is
generated.
3. Enable DMA access to the UARTn registers by setting the corresponding PACR register in the
SCM for read/write in supervisor and user modes.
4. Enable DMA access to SRAM by setting the SPV bit in the core RAMBAR, and the BDE bit in
the SCM RAMBAR
5. Initialize the DMA channel. The DMA should be configured for cycle steal mode and a source and
destination size of one byte. This causes a single byte to be transferred for each UART DMA
request. Set the disable request bit (DCRn[D_REQ] to disable external requests when the BCR
reaches zero.
6. For a transmit process:
— Set the DMA SAR register to the address of the source data
— Set DCRn[SINC] to increment the source pointer
— Set DAR to the address if the UART transmit buffer (UTB)
— Clear DCRn[DINC]
— Set BCR to the number of bytes to transmit.
7. For a receive process:
— Set the DMA SAR register to the address of the UART receive buffer (URB)
— Clear DCRn[SINC]
— Set DAR to the address of the source data
— Set DCRn[DINC] to increment the destination pointer
— Set BCR to the number of bytes to transmit.
8. Start the data transfer by setting DCRn[EEXT], which enables the UART channel to issue DMA
requests.
Table 23-14 shows the DMA requests.
Table 23-14. UART DMA Requests
Register
Bit
DMA Request
UISRn
1
Receive DMA request
UISRn
0
Transmit DMA request
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-28
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
23.5.2
UART Module Initialization Sequence
The following shows the UART module initialization sequence.
1. UCRn:
a) Reset the receiver and transmitter.
b) Reset the mode pointer (MISC[2–0] = 0b001).
2. UIMRn: Enable the desired interrupt sources.
3. UACRn: Initialize the input enable control (IEC bit).
4. UCSRn: Select the receiver and transmitter clock. Use timer as source if required.
5. UMR1n:
a) If preferred, program operation of receiver ready-to-send (RXRTS bit).
a) Select receiver-ready or FIFO-full notification (RXRDY/FFULL bit).
b) Select character or block error mode (ERR bit).
c) Select parity mode and type (PM and PT bits).
d) Select number of bits per character (B/Cx bits).
6. UMR2n:
a) Select the mode of operation (CM bits).
b) If preferred, program operation of transmitter ready-to-send (TXRTS).
c) If preferred, program operation of clear-to-send (TXCTS bit).
d) Select stop-bit length (SB bits).
7. UCRn: Enable transmitter and/or receiver.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-29
UART Modules
Enable
Serial Module
Any
Errors?
Y
SINIT
N
Initiate:
Channel
Interrupts
Enable Receiver
CHK1
Assert
Request To Send
Call CHCHK
SINITR
Save Channel
Status
Return
Figure 23-25. UART Mode Programming Flowchart (Sheet 1 of 5)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-30
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
CHCHK
CHCHK
Place Channel In
Local Loopback
Mode
Enable
Transmitter Clear
Status Word
TxCHK
N
Is
Transmitter
Ready?
N
Waited
Too Long?
Y
Set TransmitterNever-ready Flag
Y
Set ReceiverNever-ready Flag
Y
SNDCHR
Send Character
To Transmitter
RxCHK
N
Has
Character Been
Received?
N
Waited
Too Long?
Y
B
A
Figure 23-25. UART Mode Programming Flowchart (Sheet 2 of 5)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-31
UART Modules
A
B
RSTCHN
FRCHK
Have
Framing Error?
N
Disable
Transmitter
Y
Restore
To Original Mode
Set Framing
Error Flag
PRCHK
Have
Parity Error?
N
Return
Y
Set Parity
Error Flag
CHRCHK
Get Character
From Receiver
Same As
Transmitted
Character?
Y
N
Set Incorrect
Character Flag
B
Figure 23-25. UART Mode Programming Flowchart (Sheet 3 of 5)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-32
Freescale Semiconductor
UART Modules
INCH
SIRQ
ABRKI
Was
IRQ Caused
By Beginning
Of A Break?
N
Y
Does
Channel A
Receiver Have A
Character?
N
Y
Clear Change-inBreak Status Bit
Place Character
In D0
ABRKI1
Has
End-of-break
IRQ Arrived
Yet?
N
Return
Y
Clear Change-inBreak Status Bit
Remove Break
Character From
Receiver FIFO
Replace Return
Address On System
Stack And Monitor
Warm Start Address
SIRQR
RTE
Figure 23-25. UART Mode Programming Flowchart (Sheet 4 of 5)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
23-33
UART Modules
OUTCH
Is
Transmitter
Ready?
N
Y
Send Character
To Transmitter
Return
Figure 23-25. UART Mode Programming Flowchart (Sheet 5 of 5)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
23-34
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 24
I2C Interface
24.1
Introduction
This chapter describes the I2C module, clock synchronization, and I2C programming model registers. It
also provides extensive programming examples.
24.1.1
Block Diagram
Figure 24-1 is a I2C module block diagram, illustrating the interaction of the registers described in
Section 24.2, “Memory Map/Register Definition”.
Internal Bus
IRQ
Address
Data
Address Decode
Data MUX
I2C Data
I/O Register
(I2DR)
I2C Address
Register
(I2ADR)
Registers and Slave Interface
I2C Frequency
Divider Register
(I2FDR)
I2C Control
Register
(I2CR)
I2C Status
Register
(I2SR)
Clock
Control
Start, Stop,
and
Arbitration
Control
In/Out
Data
Shift
Register
Address
Compare
Input
Sync
I2C_SCL
I2C_SDA
Figure 24-1. I2C Module Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
24-1
I2C Interface
24.1.2
Overview
I2C is a two-wire, bidirectional serial bus that provides a simple, efficient method of data exchange,
minimizing the interconnection between devices. This bus is suitable for applications that require
occasional communication between many devices over a short distance. The flexible I2C bus allows
additional devices to connect to the bus for expansion and system development.
The interface operates up to 100 Kbps with maximum bus loading and timing. The device is capable of
operating at higher baud rates, up to a maximum of the internal bus clock divided by 20, with reduced bus
loading. The maximum communication length and the number of devices connected are limited by a
maximum bus capacitance of 400 pF.
The I2C system is a true multiple-master bus; it uses arbitration and collision detection to prevent data
corruption in the event that multiple devices attempt to control the bus simultaneously. This feature
supports complex applications with multiprocessor control and can be used for rapid testing and alignment
of end products through external connections to an assembly-line computer.
NOTE
The
module is compatible with the Philips I2C bus protocol. For
information on system configuration, protocol, and restrictions, see The I2C
Bus Specification, Version 2.1.
I2C
NOTE
The GPIO module must be configured to enable the peripheral function of
the appropriate pins (refer to Chapter 26, “General Purpose I/O Module”)
prior to configuring the I2C module.
24.1.3
Features
The I2C module has these key features:
• Compatibility with I2C bus standard version 2.1
• Multiple-master operation
• Software-programmable for one of 50 different serial clock frequencies
• Software-selectable acknowledge bit
• Interrupt-driven, byte-by-byte data transfer
• Arbitration-lost interrupt with automatic mode switching from master to slave
• Calling address identification interrupt
• START and STOP signal generation/detection
• Repeated START signal generation
• Acknowledge bit generation/detection
• Bus-busy detection
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
24-2
Freescale Semiconductor
I2C Interface
24.2
Memory Map/Register Definition
The below table lists the configuration registers used in the I2C interface.
Table 24-1. I2C Module Memory Map
IPSBAR
Offset
Register
Access Reset Value
Section/Page
0x00_0300
I2C Address Register (I2ADR)
R/W
0x00
24.2.1/24-3
0x00_0304
I2C Frequency Divider Register (I2FDR)
R/W
0x00
24.2.2/24-3
2
0x00_0308
I C Control Register (I2CR)
R/W
0x00
24.2.3/24-4
0x00_030C
I2C Status Register (I2SR)
R/W
0x81
24.2.4/24-5
R/W
0x00
24.2.5/24-6
0x00_0310
2
I C Data I/O Register (I2DR)
I2C Address Register (I2ADR)
24.2.1
I2ADR holds the address the I2C responds to when addressed as a slave. It is not the address sent on the
bus during the address transfer when the module is performing a master transfer.
IPSBAR 0x00_0300 (I2ADR)
Offset:
7
Access: User read/write
6
5
4
3
2
1
R
0
0
ADR
W
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 24-2. I2C Address Register (I2ADR)
Table 24-2. I2ADR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7–1
ADR
Slave address. Contains the specific slave address to be used by the I2C module. Slave mode is the default I2C mode
for an address match on the bus.
0
24.2.2
Reserved, must be cleared.
I2C Frequency Divider Register (I2FDR)
The I2FDR, shown in Figure 24-3, provides a programmable prescaler to configure the I2C clock for
bit-rate selection.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
24-3
I2C Interface
IPSBAR 0x00_0304 (I2FDR)
Offset:
R
7
6
0
0
Access: User read/write
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
IC
W
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 24-3. I2C Frequency Divider Register (I2FDR)
Table 24-3. I2FDR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7–6
Reserved, must be cleared.
5–0
IC
I2C clock rate. Prescales the clock for bit-rate selection. The serial bit clock frequency is equal to the internal bus
clock divided by the divider shown below. Due to potentially slow I2C_SCL and I2C_SDA rise and fall times, bus
signals are sampled at the prescaler frequency.
24.2.3
IC
Divider
IC
Divider
IC
Divider
IC
Divider
0x00
28
0x10
288
0x20
20
0x30
160
0x01
30
0x11
320
0x21
22
0x31
192
0x02
34
0x12
384
0x22
24
0x32
224
0x03
40
0x13
480
0x23
26
0x33
256
0x04
44
0x14
576
0x24
28
0x34
320
0x05
48
0x15
640
0x25
32
0x35
384
0x06
56
0x16
768
0x26
36
0x36
448
0x07
68
0x17
960
0x27
40
0x37
512
0x08
80
0x18
1152
0x28
48
0x38
640
0x09
88
0x19
1280
0x29
56
0x39
768
0x0A
104
0x1A
1536
0x2A
64
0x3A
896
0x0B
128
0x1B
1920
0x2B
72
0x3B
1024
0x0C
144
0x1C
2304
0x2C
80
0x3C
1280
0x0D
160
0x1D
2560
0x2D
96
0x3D
1536
0x0E
192
0x1E
3072
0x2E
112
0x3E
1792
0x0F
240
0x1F
3840
0x2F
128
0x3F
2048
I2C Control Register (I2CR)
I2CR enables the I2C module and the I2C interrupt. It also contains bits that govern operation as a slave or
a master.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
24-4
Freescale Semiconductor
I2C Interface
IPSBAR 0x00_0308 (I2CR)
Offset:
Reset:
Access: User read/write
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 24-4. I2C Control Register (I2CR)
Table 24-4. I2CR Field Descriptions
Field
Description
7
IEN
I2C enable. Controls the software reset of the entire I2C module. If the module is enabled in the middle of a byte
transfer, slave mode ignores the current bus transfer and starts operating when the next START condition is detected.
Master mode is not aware that the bus is busy; initiating a start cycle may corrupt the current bus cycle, ultimately
causing the current master or the I2C module to lose arbitration, after which bus operation returns to normal.
0 The I2C module is disabled, but registers can be accessed.
1 The I2C module is enabled. This bit must be set before any other I2CR bits have any effect.
6
IIEN
I2C interrupt enable.
0 I2C module interrupts are disabled, but currently pending interrupt condition is not cleared.
1 I2C module interrupts are enabled. An I2C interrupt occurs if I2SR[IIF] is also set.
5
MSTA
Master/slave mode select bit. If the master loses arbitration, MSTA is cleared without generating a STOP signal.
0 Slave mode. Changing MSTA from 1 to 0 generates a STOP and selects slave mode.
1 Master mode. Changing MSTA from 0 to 1 signals a START on the bus and selects master mode.
4
MTX
Transmit/receive mode select bit. Selects the direction of master and slave transfers.
0 Receive
1 Transmit. When the device is addressed as a slave, software must set MTX according to I2SR[SRW]. In master
mode, MTX must be set according to the type of transfer required. Therefore, when the MCU addresses a slave
device, MTX is always 1.
3
TXAK
Transmit acknowledge enable. Specifies the value driven onto I2C_SDA during acknowledge cycles for master and
slave receivers. Writing TXAK applies only when the I2C bus is a receiver.
0 An acknowledge signal is sent to the bus at the ninth clock bit after receiving one byte of data.
1 No acknowledge signal response is sent (acknowledge bit = 1).
2
RSTA
Repeat start. Always read as 0. Attempting a repeat start without bus mastership causes loss of arbitration.
0 No repeat start
1 Generates a repeated START condition.
1
Reserved, must be cleared.
I2C Status Register (I2SR)
24.2.4
I2SR contains bits that indicate transaction direction and status.
IPSBAR 0x00_030C (I2SR)
Offset:
R
Access: User read/write
7
6
5
ICF
IAAS
IBB
4
3
2
0
SRW
IAL
1
0
RXAK
IIF
W
Reset:
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Figure 24-5. I2C Status Register (I2SR)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
24-5
I2C Interface
Table 24-5. I2SR Field Descriptions
Field
7
ICF
6
IAAS
Description
I2C Data transferring bit. While one byte of data is transferred, ICF is cleared.
0 Transfer in progress
1 Transfer complete. Set by falling edge of ninth clock of a byte transfer.
I2C addressed as a slave bit. The CPU is interrupted if I2CR[IIEN] is set. Next, the CPU must check SRW and set
its TX/RX mode accordingly. Writing to I2CR clears this bit.
0 Not addressed.
1 Addressed as a slave. Set when its own address (IADR) matches the calling address.
5
IBB
I2C bus busy bit. Indicates the status of the bus.
0 Bus is idle. If a STOP signal is detected, IBB is cleared.
1 Bus is busy. When START is detected, IBB is set.
4
IAL
I2C arbitration lost. Set by hardware in the following circumstances. (IAL must be cleared by software by writing zero
to it.)
• I2C_SDA sampled low when the master drives high during an address or data-transmit cycle.
• I2C_SDA sampled low when the master drives high during the acknowledge bit of a data-receive cycle.
• A start cycle is attempted when the bus is busy.
• A repeated start cycle is requested in slave mode.
• A stop condition is detected when the master did not request it.
3
Reserved, must be cleared.
2
SRW
Slave read/write. When IAAS is set, SRW indicates the value of the R/W command bit of the calling address sent
from the master. SRW is valid only when a complete transfer has occurred, no other transfers have been initiated,
and the I2C module is a slave and has an address match.
0 Slave receive, master writing to slave.
1 Slave transmit, master reading from slave.
1
IIF
I2C interrupt. Must be cleared by software by writing a 0 in the interrupt routine.
0 No I2C interrupt pending
1 An interrupt is pending, which causes a processor interrupt request (if IIEN = 1). Set when one of the following
occurs:
• Complete one byte transfer (set at the falling edge of the ninth clock)
• Reception of a calling address that matches its own specific address in slave-receive mode
• Arbitration lost
0
RXAK
24.2.5
Received acknowledge. The value of I2C_SDA during the acknowledge bit of a bus cycle.
0 An acknowledge signal was received after the completion of 8-bit data transmission on the bus
1 No acknowledge signal was detected at the ninth clock.
I2C Data I/O Register (I2DR)
In master-receive mode, reading I2DR allows a read to occur and for the next data byte to be received. In
slave mode, the same function is available after the I2C has received its slave address.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
24-6
Freescale Semiconductor
I2C Interface
IPSBAR 0x00_0310 (I2DR)
Offset:
7
Access: User read/write
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
R
DATA
W
Reset:
0
0
0
0
Figure 24-6. I2C Data I/O Register (I2DR)
Table 24-6. I2DR Field Description
Field
Description
7–0
DATA
I2C data. When data is written to this register in master transmit mode, a data transfer is initiated. The most significant
bit is sent first. In master receive mode, reading this register initiates the reception of the next byte of data. In slave
mode, the same functions are available after an address match has occurred.
Note: In master transmit mode, the first byte of data written to I2DR following assertion of I2CR[MSTA] is used for
the address transfer and should comprise the calling address (in position D7–D1) concatenated with the
required R/W bit (in position D0). This bit (D0) is not automatically appended by the hardware, software must
provide the appropriate R/W bit.
Note: I2CR[MSTA] generates a start when a master does not already own the bus. I2CR[RSTA] generates a start
(restart) without the master first issuing a stop (i.e., the master already owns the bus). To start the read of data,
a dummy read to this register starts the read process from the slave. The next read of the I2DR register
contains the actual data.
24.3
Functional Description
The I2C module uses a serial data line (I2C_SDA) and a serial clock line (I2C_SCL) for data transfer. For
I2C compliance, all devices connected to these two signals must have open drain or open collector outputs.
The logic AND function is exercised on both lines with external pull-up resistors.
Out of reset, the I2C default state is as a slave receiver. Therefore, when not programmed to be a master or
responding to a slave transmit address, the I2C module should return to the default slave receiver state. See
Section 24.4.1, “Initialization Sequence,” for exceptions.
Normally, a standard communication is composed of four parts: START signal, slave address transmission,
data transfer, and STOP signal. These are discussed in the following sections.
24.3.1
START Signal
When no other device is bus master (I2C_SCL and I2C_SDA lines are at logic high), a device can initiate
communication by sending a START signal (see A in Figure 24-7). A START signal is defined as a
high-to-low transition of I2C_SDA while I2C_SCL is high. This signal denotes the beginning of a data
transfer (each data transfer can be several bytes long) and awakens all slaves.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
24-7
I2C Interface
Interrupt bit set
(Byte complete)
msb
I2C_SCL
2
3
4
5
6
7
msb
8
9
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W
A
Interrupt is serviced
lsb
1
I2C_SDA
I2C_SCL held low while
Calling Address
START
Signal
XXX
B
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
C
9
Data Byte
ACK
Bit
R/W
lsb
1
No
ACK
Bit
E
D
STOP
Signal
F
2
Figure 24-7. I C Standard Communication Protocol
24.3.2
Slave Address Transmission
The master sends the slave address in the first byte after the START signal (B). After the seven-bit calling
address, it sends the R/W bit (C), which tells the slave data transfer direction (0 equals write transfer, 1
equals read transfer).
Each slave must have a unique address. An I2C master must not transmit its own slave address; it cannot
be master and slave at the same time.
The slave whose address matches that sent by the master pulls I2C_SDA low at the ninth serial clock (D)
to return an acknowledge bit.
24.3.3
Data Transfer
When successful slave addressing is achieved, data transfer can proceed (see E in Figure 24-7) on a
byte-by-byte basis in the direction specified by the R/W bit sent by the calling master.
Data can be changed only while I2C_SCL is low and must be held stable while I2C_SCL is high, as
Figure 24-7 shows. I2C_SCL is pulsed once for each data bit, with the msb being sent first. The receiving
device must acknowledge each byte by pulling I2C_SDA low at the ninth clock; therefore, a data byte
transfer takes nine clock pulses. See Figure 24-8.
I2C_SCL held low while
Interrupt is serviced
I2C_SCL
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Bit4
Bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
Interrupt Bit Set
(Byte Complete)
I2C_SDA
Bit7
Bit6
Bit5
Bit4
Bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
R/W
Bit7
Bit6
Slave Address
START
Signal
Bit5
Data Byte
ACK from
Receiver
No
ACK Bit
STOP
Signal
Figure 24-8. Data Transfer
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
24-8
Freescale Semiconductor
I2C Interface
24.3.4
Acknowledge
The transmitter releases the I2C_SDA line high during the acknowledge clock pulse as shown in
Figure 24-9. The receiver pulls down the I2C_SDA line during the acknowledge clock pulse so that it
remains stable low during the high period of the clock pulse.
If it does not acknowledge the master, the slave receiver must leave I2C_SDA high. The master can then
generate a STOP signal to abort data transfer or generate a START signal (repeated start, shown in
Figure 24-10 and discussed in Section 24.3.6, “Repeated START”) to start a new calling sequence.
I2C_SCL
I2C_SDA by Transmitter
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Bit7
Bit6
Bit5
Bit4
Bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
R/W
9
I2C_SDA by Receiver
START Signal
ACK
Figure 24-9. Acknowledgement by Receiver
If the master receiver does not acknowledge the slave transmitter after a byte transmission, it means
end-of-data to the slave. The slave releases I2C_SDA for the master to generate a STOP or START signal
(Figure 24-9).
24.3.5
STOP Signal
The master can terminate communication by generating a STOP signal to free the bus. A STOP signal is
defined as a low-to-high transition of I2C_SDA while I2C_SCL is at logical high (see F in Figure 24-7).
The master can generate a STOP even if the slave has generated an acknowledgment, at which point the
slave must release the bus. The master may also generate a START signal following a calling address,
without first generating a STOP signal. Refer to Section 24.3.6, “Repeated START.”
24.3.6
Repeated START
A repeated START signal is a START signal generated without first generating a STOP signal to terminate
the communication, as shown in Figure 24-10. The master uses a repeated START to communicate with
another slave or with the same slave in a different mode (transmit/receive mode) without releasing the bus.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
24-9
I2C Interface
msb
I2C_SCL
1
I2C_SDA
lsb
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
1
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W
START
Signal
Calling Address
lsb
msb
8
XX
R/W ACK
Bit
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 R/W
New Calling Address
Repeated
START
Signal A
R/W
No
ACK
Bit
STOP
Signal
Figure 24-10. Repeated START
Various combinations of read/write formats are then possible:
• The first example in Figure 24-11 is the case of master-transmitter transmitting to slave-receiver.
The transfer direction is not changed.
• The second example in Figure 24-11 is the master reading the slave immediately after the first byte.
At the moment of the first acknowledge, the master-transmitter becomes a master-receiver and the
slave-receiver becomes slave-transmitter.
• In the third example in Figure 24-11, START condition and slave address are repeated using the
repeated START signal. This is to communicate with same slave in a different mode without
releasing the bus. The master transmits data to the slave first, and then the master reads data from
slave by reversing the R/W bit.
ST = Start
SP = Stop
From Master to Slave
A = Acknowledge (I2C_SDA low)
A = Not Acknowledge (I2C_SDA high)
From Slave to Master
Rept ST = Repeated Start
R/W
Example 1:
ST 7bit Slave Address
0
A
Data
A
Data
A
Data
A
Data
A/A SP
R/W
Example 2:
ST 7bit Slave Address
1
A
SP
Note: No acknowledge on the last byte
Example 3:
ST 7-bit Slave
Address
R/W
1
R/W
A
Data
A
Master Reads from Slave
Rept
ST
7-bit Slave
Address
0
A
Data
A Data
A/A SP
Master Writes to Slave
Figure 24-11. Data Transfer, Combined Format
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
24-10
Freescale Semiconductor
I2C Interface
24.3.7
Clock Synchronization and Arbitration
I2C is a true multi-master bus that allows more than one master connected to it. If two or more master
devices simultaneously request control of the bus, a clock synchronization procedure determines the bus
clock. Because wire-AND logic is performed on the I2C_SCL line, a high-to-low transition on the
I2C_SCL line affects all the devices connected on the bus. The devices start counting their low period and
after a device’s clock has gone low, it holds the I2C_SCL line low until the clock high state is reached.
However, change of low to high in this device’s clock may not change the state of the I2C_SCL line if
another device clock remains within its low period. Therefore, synchronized clock I2C_SCL is held low
by the device with the longest low period.
Devices with shorter low periods enter a high wait state during this time (see Figure 24-12). When all
devices concerned have counted off their low period, the synchronized clock (I2C_SCL) line is released
and pulled high. At this point, the device clocks and the I2C_SCL line are synchronized, and the devices
start counting their high periods. The first device to complete its high period pulls the I2C_SCL line low
again.
Wait
Start counting high period
I2C_SCL1
I2C_SCL2
I2C_SCL
Internal Counter Reset
Figure 24-12. Clock Synchronization
A data arbitration procedure determines the relative priority of the contending masters. A bus master loses
arbitration if it transmits logic 1 while another master transmits logic 0. The losing masters immediately
switch over to slave receive mode and stop driving I2C_SDA output (see Figure 24-13). In this case,
transition from master to slave mode does not generate a STOP condition. Meanwhile, hardware sets
I2SR[IAL] to indicate loss of arbitration.
I2C_SCL
I2C_SDA by
Master1
I2C_SDA by
Master2
Master 2 Loses Arbitration,
and becomes slave-receiver
I2C_SDA
Figure 24-13. Arbitration Procedure
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
24-11
I2C Interface
24.3.8
Handshaking and Clock Stretching
The clock synchronization mechanism can acts as a handshake in data transfers. Slave devices can hold
I2C_SCL low after completing one byte transfer. In such a case, the clock mechanism halts the bus clock
and forces the master clock into wait states until the slave releases I2C_SCL.
Slaves may also slow down the transfer bit rate. After the master has driven I2C_SCL low, the slave can
drive I2C_SCL low for the required period and then release it. If the slave I2C_SCL low period is longer
than the master I2C_SCL low period, the resulting I2C_SCL bus signal low period is stretched.
24.4
Initialization/Application Information
The following examples show programming for initialization, signaling START, post-transfer software
response, signaling STOP, and generating a repeated START.
24.4.1
Initialization Sequence
Before the interface can transfer serial data, registers must be initialized:
1. Set I2FDR[IC] to obtain I2C_SCL frequency from the system bus clock. See Section 24.2.2, “I2C
Frequency Divider Register (I2FDR).”
2. Update the I2ADR to define its slave address.
3. Set I2CR[IEN] to enable the I2C bus interface system.
4. Modify the I2CR to select or deselect master/slave mode, transmit/receive mode, and
interrupt-enable or not.
NOTE
If I2SR[IBB] is set when the
bus module is enabled, execute the
following pseudocode sequence before proceeding with normal
initialization code. This issues a STOP command to the slave device,
placing it in idle state as if it were power-cycled on.
I2C
I2CR = 0x0
I2CR = 0xA0
dummy read of I2DR
I2SR = 0x0
I2CR = 0x0
I2CR = 0x80
24.4.2
; re-enable
Generation of START
After completion of the initialization procedure, serial data can be transmitted by selecting the master
transmitter mode. On a multiple-master bus system, I2SR[IBB] must be tested to determine whether the
serial bus is free. If the bus is free (IBB is cleared), the START signal and the first byte (the slave address)
can be sent. The data written to the data register comprises the address of the desired slave and the lsb
indicates the transfer direction.
The free time between a STOP and the next START condition is built into the hardware that generates the
START cycle. Depending on the relative frequencies of the system clock and the I2C_SCL period, the
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
24-12
Freescale Semiconductor
I2C Interface
processor may need to wait until the I2C is busy after writing the calling address to the I2DR before
proceeding with the following instructions.
The following example signals START and transmits the first byte of data (slave address):
1. Check I2SR[IBB]. If it is set, wait until it is clear.
2. After cleared, set to transmit mode by setting I2CR[MTX].
3. Set master mode by setting I2CR[MSTA]. This generates a START condition.
4. Transmit the calling address via the I2DR.
5. Check I2SR[IBB]. If it is clear, wait until it is set and go to step #1.
24.4.3
Post-Transfer Software Response
Sending or receiving a byte sets the I2SR[ICF], which indicates one byte communication is finished.
I2SR[IIF] is also set. An interrupt is generated if the interrupt function is enabled during initialization by
setting I2CR[IIEN]. Software must first clear I2SR[IIF] in the interrupt routine. Reading from I2DR in
receive mode or writing to I2DR in transmit mode can clear I2SR[ICF].
Software can service the I2C I/O in the main program by monitoring the IIF bit if the interrupt function is
disabled. Polling should monitor IIF rather than ICF, because that operation is different when arbitration
is lost.
When an interrupt occurs at the end of the address cycle, the master is always in transmit mode; the address
is sent. If master receive mode is required, I2CR[MTX] should be toggled.
During slave-mode address cycles (I2SR[IAAS] = 1), I2SR[SRW] is read to determine the direction of the
next transfer. MTX is programmed accordingly. For slave-mode data cycles (IAAS = 0), SRW is invalid.
MTX should be read to determine the current transfer direction.
The following is an example of a software response by a master transmitter in the interrupt routine (see
Figure 24-14).
1. Clear the I2CR[IIF] flag.
2. Check if acknowledge has been received, I2SR[RXAK].
3. If no ACK, end transmission. Else, transmit next byte of data via I2DR.
24.4.4
Generation of STOP
A data transfer ends when the master signals a STOP, which can occur after all data is sent, as in the
following example.
1. Check if acknowledge has been received, I2SR[RXAK]. If no ACK, end transmission and go to
step #5.
2. Get value from transmitting counter, TXCNT. If no more data, go to step #5.
3. Transmit next byte of data via I2DR.
4. Decrement TXCNT and go to step #1
5. Generate a stop condition by clearing I2CR[MSTA].
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
24-13
I2C Interface
For a master receiver to terminate a data transfer, it must inform the slave transmitter by not
acknowledging the last data byte. This is done by setting I2CR[TXAK] before reading the next-to-last
byte. Before the last byte is read, a STOP signal must be generated, as in the following example.
1. Decrement RXCNT.
2. If last byte (RXCNT = 0) go to step #4.
3. If next to last byte (RXCNT = 1), set I2CR[TXAK] to disable ACK and go to step #5.
4. This is last byte, so clear I2CR[MSTA] to generate a STOP signal.
5. Read data from I2DR.
6. If there is more data to be read (RXCNT ≠ 0), go to step #1 if desired.
24.4.5
Generation of Repeated START
If the master wants the bus after the data transfer, it can signal another START followed by another slave
address without signaling a STOP, as in the following example.
1. Generate a repeated START by setting I2CR[RSTA].
2. Transmit the calling address via I2DR.
24.4.6
Slave Mode
In the slave interrupt service routine, software must poll the I2SR[IAAS] bit to determine if the controller
has received its slave address. If IAAS is set, software must set the transmit/receive mode select bit
(I2CR[MTX]) according to the I2SR[SRW]. Writing to I2CR clears IAAS automatically. The only time
IAAS is read as set is from the interrupt at the end of the address cycle where an address match occurred;
interrupts resulting from subsequent data transfers have IAAS cleared. A data transfer can now be initiated
by writing information to I2DR for slave transmits, or read from I2DR in slave-receive mode. A dummy
read of I2DR in slave/receive mode releases I2C_SCL, allowing the master to send data.
In the slave transmitter routine, I2SR[RXAK] must be tested before sending the next byte of data. Setting
RXAK means an end-of-data signal from the master receiver, after which software must switch it from
transmitter to receiver mode. Reading I2DR releases I2C_SCL so the master can generate a STOP signal.
24.4.7
Arbitration Lost
If several devices try to engage the bus at the same time, one becomes master. Hardware immediately
switches devices that lose arbitration to slave receive mode. Data output to I2C_SDA stops, but I2C_SCL
continues generating until the end of the byte during which arbitration is lost. An interrupt occurs at the
falling edge of the ninth clock of this transfer with I2SR[IAL] set and I2CR[MSTA] cleared.
If a non-master device tries to transmit or execute a START, hardware inhibits the transmission, clears
MSTA without signaling a STOP, generates an interrupt to the CPU, and sets IAL to indicate a failed
attempt to engage the bus. When considering these cases, slave service routine should first test IAL and
software should clear it if it is set.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
24-14
Freescale Semiconductor
I2C Interface
Clear
IIF
Y
TX
TX/Rx
?
Master
Mode?
N
Y
RX
Arbitration
Lost?
N
Last Byte
Transmitted
?
N
RXAK= 0
?
Clear IAL
Y
Last
Byte to be
Read ?
N
Y
Y
N
End of
ADDR Cycle
(Master RX)
?
N
Write Next
Byte to I2DR
N
Y
Y
(Read)Y
N Data
Cycle
SRW=1
?
Generate
STOP Signal
Switch to
Rx Mode
Generate
STOP Signal
Tx/Rx
?
N (WRITE)
N
Read Data
from I2DR
And Store
RX
TX
ACK from
Receiver
?
N
Y
Set TX
Mode
Write Data
to I2DR
Dummy Read
from I2DR
IAAS=1
?
Address Y
Cycle
2nd Last
Byte to be
Read?
Set TXAK =1
Y
IAAS=1
?
Tx Next
Byte
Read Data
from I2DR
and Store
Set RX
Mode
Switch to
Rx Mode
Dummy Read
from I2DR
Dummy Read
from I2DR
RTE
Figure 24-14. Flow-Chart of Typical I2C Interrupt Routine
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
24-15
I2C Interface
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
24-16
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 25
FlexCAN
The FlexCAN module is a communication controller implementing the controller area network (CAN)
protocol, an asynchronous communications protocol used in automotive and industrial control systems. It
is a high speed (1 Mbit/sec), short distance, priority based protocol which can communicate using a variety
of mediums (for example, fiber optic cable or an unshielded twisted pair of wires). The FlexCAN supports
both the standard and extended identifier (ID) message formats specified in the CAN protocol
specification, revision 2.0, part B.
The CAN protocol was primarily, but not only, designed to be used as a vehicle serial data bus, meeting
the specific requirements of this field: real-time processing, reliable operation in the EMI environment of
a vehicle, cost-effectiveness and required bandwidth. A general working knowledge of the CAN protocol
revision 2.0 is assumed in this document. For details, refer to the CAN protocol revision 2.0 specification.
25.1
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Features
Based on and includes all existing Freescale TouCAN module features
Freescale IP interface architecture
Full implementation of the CAN protocol specification version 2.0
— Standard data and remote frames (up to 109 bits long)
— Extended data and remote frames (up to 127 bits long)
— 0–8 bytes data length
— Programmable bit rate up to 1Mbit/sec
Up to 16 flexible message buffers of 0–8 bytes data length, each configurable as Rx or Tx, all
supporting standard and extended messages
Listen-only mode capability
Content-related addressing
No read/write semaphores
Three programmable mask registers: global (for MBs 0-13), special for MB14, and special for
MB15
Programmable transmit-first scheme: lowest ID or lowest buffer number
“Time Stamp”, based on 16-bit free-running timer
Global network time, synchronized by a specific message
Programmable I/O modes
Maskable interrupts
Independent of the transmission medium (external transceiver is assumed)
Open network architecture
Multimaster bus
High immunity to EMI
Short latency time for high-priority messages
Low-power “sleep” mode, with programmable “wake up” on bus activity
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-1
FlexCAN
A block diagram describing the various submodules of the FlexCAN module is shown in Figure 25-1.
Each submodule is described in detail in subsequent sections.
MB15
MB14
Control
MB13
Transmitter
CANTX
Receiver
CANRX
MB12
MB #
(0-15)
0.25k/0.5KB
RAM
MB3
MB2
MB1
Bus Interface Unit
MB0
Internal Bus
Figure 25-1. FlexCAN Block Diagram and Pinout
25.1.1
FlexCAN Memory Map
The FlexCAN module address space is split into 128 bytes starting at the base address, and then an extra
256 bytes starting at the base address +128. The upper 256 are fully used for the message buffer structures,
as described in Section 25.3.2, “Message Buffer Memory Map.” Out of the lower 128 bytes, only part is
occupied by various registers.
Table 25-1. FlexCAN Memory Map
IPSBAR
Offset
[31:24]
[23:16]
0x1C_0000
Module Configuration Register (MCR)
0x1C_0004
Reserved
[15:8]
[7:0]
Reserved
Control Register 0
(CANCTRL0)
Control Register 1
(CANCTRL1)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-2
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
Table 25-1. FlexCAN Memory Map (continued)
IPSBAR
Offset
[31:24]
0x1C_0008
[23:16]
[15:8]
Prescaler Divider (PRESDIV) Control Register 2
(CANCTRL2)
0x1C_000C
Free Running Timer (TIMER)
Reserved
Reserved
0x1C_0010
Rx Global Mask (RXGMASK)
0x1C_0014
Rx Buffer 14 Mask (RX14MASK)
0x1C_0018
Rx Buffer 15 Mask (RX15MASK)
0x1C_0020
Error and Status (ESTAT)
0x1C_0024
Interrupt Flags (IFLAG)
0x1C_0034–
0x1C_007F
Reserved
0x1C_0080–
0x1C_017F
25.1.2
[7:0]
Interrupt Masks (IMASK)
Rx Error Counter
(RXECTR)
Tx Error Counter
(TXECTR)
Reserved
Message Buffers 0–15
External Signals
The FlexCAN module/CAN transceiver is composed of two signals: CANTX, which is the serial
transmitted data, and CANRX, which is the serial received data.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-3
FlexCAN
25.2
The CAN System
A typical CAN system is shown below in Figure 25-2.
CAN Station 2
CAN Station 1
CAN Station n
ColdFire Processor
FlexCAN
CANTX
CANRX
Transceiver
CAN Bus
Figure 25-2. Typical CAN system
Each CAN station is connected physically to the CAN bus through a transceiver. The transceiver provides
the transmit drive, waveshaping, and receive/compare functions required for communicating on the CAN
bus. It can also provide protection against damage to the FlexCAN caused by a defective CAN bus or
defective stations.
25.3
25.3.1
Message Buffers
Message Buffer Structure
Figure 25-3 shows the extended (29 bit) ID message buffer structure. Figure 25-4 displays the standard (11
bit) ID message buffer structure.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-4
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
0x0
15–8
7–4
3–0
TIME STAMP
CODE
LENGTH
0x2
ID[28:18]
0x4
SRR IDE
ID[17-15]
ID[14-0]
ID_HIGH
RTR ID_LOW
0x6
DATA BYTE 0
DATA BYTE 1
0x8
DATA BYTE 2
DATA BYTE 3
0xA
DATA BYTE 4
DATA BYTE 5
0xC
DATA BYTE 6
DATA BYTE 7
0xE
CONTROL/STATUS
Reserved
Figure 25-3. Extended ID Message Buffer Structure
0x0
15–8
7–4
3–0
TIME STAMP
CODE
LENGTH
0x2
ID[28:18]
0x4
RTR
0
0
0
16-BIT TIME STAMP
0
ID_HIGH
ID_LOW
0x6
DATA BYTE 0
DATA BYTE 1
0x8
DATA BYTE 2
DATA BYTE 3
0xA
DATA BYTE 4
DATA BYTE 5
0xC
DATA BYTE 6
DATA BYTE 7
0xE
CONTROL/STATUS
Reserved
Figure 25-4. Standard ID Message Buffer Structure
25.3.1.1
Common Fields for Extended and Standard Format Frames
Table 25-2 describes the message buffer fields that are common to both extended and standard identifier
format frames.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-5
FlexCAN
Table 25-2. Common Extended/Standard Format Frames
Field
Description
Time Stamp Contains a copy of the high byte of the free running timer, which is captured at the beginning of the
identifier field of the frame on the CAN bus.
Code
Refer to Table 25-3 and Table 25-4.
Rx Length
Length (in bytes) of the Rx data stored in offset 0x6 through 0xD of the buffer. This field is written by
the FlexCAN module, copied from the data length code (DLC) field of the received frame.
Tx Length
Length (in bytes) of the data to be transmitted, located in offset 0x6 through 0xD of the buffer. This
field is written by the CPU, and is used as the DLC field value. If remote transmission request (RTR))
= 1, the frame is a remote frame and will be transmitted without the data field, regardless of the value
in Tx length.
Data
This field can store up to eight data bytes for a frame. For Rx frames, the data is stored as it is
received from the bus. For Tx frames, the CPU provides the data to be transmitted within the frame.
Reserved
This word entry field (16 bits) should not be accessed by the CPU.
Table 25-3. Message Buffer Codes for Receive Buffers
Rx Code
Before Rx
New Frame
Description
0000
NOT ACTIVE — message buffer is not active.
0100
EMPTY — message buffer is active and empty.
0010
FULL — message buffer is full.
0110
OVERRUN — second frame was received into a full
buffer before the CPU read the first one.
01011
BUSY — message buffer is now being filled with a new
receive frame. This condition will be cleared within 20
cycles.
00111
01111
1For
Rx Code
After Rx
New Frame
Comment
—
—
0010
—
0110
If a CPU read occurs before
the new frame, new receive
code is 0010.
0010
An empty buffer was filled.
0110
A full buffer was filled.
0110
An overrun buffer was filled.
transmit message buffers, upon read, the BUSY bit should be ignored.
Table 25-4. Message Buffer Codes for Transmit Buffers
Description
Code After
Successful
Transmission
RTR
Initial Tx Code
X
1000
Message buffer not ready for transmit.
0
1100
Data frame to be transmitted once, unconditionally.
1000
1
1100
Remote frame to be transmitted once, and message buffer
becomes an Rx message buffer for data frames.
0100
0
10101
Data frame to be transmitted only as a response to a remote
frame.
1010
0
1110
Data frame to be transmitted only once, unconditionally, and
then only as a response to remote frame.
1010
—
1
When a matching remote request frame is detected, the code for such a message buffer is changed to be 1110.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-6
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
25.3.1.2
Fields for Extended Format Frames
Table 25-5 describes the message buffer fields used only for extended identifier format frames.
Table 25-5. Extended Format Frames
Field
Description
ID[28:18]/[17:15] Contains the 14 most significant bits of the extended identifier, located in the ID HIGH word of the
message buffer.
Substitute
Contains a fixed recessive bit, used only in extended format. Should be set to one by the user for
Remote Request Tx buffers. It will be stored as received on the CAN bus for Rx buffers. This is a bit in the ID HIGH
(SRR)
word of the message buffer.
ID Extended
(IDE)
If extended format frame is used, this field should be set to one. If zero, standard format frame
should be used. This is a bit in the ID HIGH word of the message buffer.
ID[14:0]
Bits [14:0] of the extended identifier, located in the ID LOW word of the message buffer.
Remote
Transmission
Request (RTR)
This bit is located in the least significant bit of the ID LOW word of the message buffer;
0 Data Frame
1 Remote Frame.
25.3.1.3
Fields for Standard Format Frames
Table 25-6 describes the message buffer fields used only for standard identifier format frames.
Table 25-6. Standard Format Frames
Field
Description
ID[28:18]
Contains bits [28:18] of the identifier, located in the ID HIGH word of the message buffer. The four
least significant bits in this register (corresponding to the IDE bit and ID[17:15] for an extended
identifier message) must all be written as logic zeros to ensure proper operation of the FlexCAN.
RTR
Remote Transmission Request. This bit is located in the ID HIGH word of the message buffer.
0 data frame
1 remote frame.
If the FlexCAN transmits this bit as a one and receives it as a zero, an “arbitration loss” is
indicated. If the FlexCAN transmits this bit as a zero and receives it as a one, a bit error is
indicated.
If the FlexCAN transmits a value and receives a matching response, a successful bit transmission
is indicated.
16-Bit Time
Stamp
The 16-bit time stamp, located in the ID LOW word of the message buffer, is not needed for
standard format, and is used in a standard format buffer to store the 16-bit value of the
free-running timer. The timer value is captured at the beginning of the identifier field of the frame
on the CAN bus.
25.3.2
Message Buffer Memory Map
The message buffer memory map starts at an offset of 0x80 from the FlexCAN’s base address
(0x1C_0000). The 256-byte message buffer space is fully used by the 16 message buffer structures.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-7
FlexCAN
Message Buffers
FlexCAN Base
Address Offset
Control/Status
ID_HIGH
ID_LOW
0x80-0x8F
0x82
0x84
0x86
Message Buffer 0
8 bytes Data field
0x8C
0x8E
Reserved
0x90
Message Buffer 1
0x9E
0xA0
Message Buffer 2
0xAE
Message Buffer 3
0xB0
through
0x16E
Message Buffer 14
0x170
Message Buffer 15
0x17E
Figure 25-5. FlexCAN Memory Map
25.4
Functional Overview
The FlexCAN module is flexible in that each one of its 16 message buffers (MBs) can be assigned either
as a transmit buffer or a receive buffer. Each MB, which is up to 8 bytes long, is also assigned an interrupt
flag bit that indicates successful completion of either transmission or reception.
NOTE
Note that for both processes, the first CPU action in preparing a MB should
be to deactivate it by setting its code field to the proper value. This
requirement is mandatory to assure proper operation.
25.4.1
Transmit Process
The CPU prepares or changes an MB for transmission by executing the following steps:
• Writing the Control/Status word to hold Tx MB inactive (code = 1000).
• Writing the ID_HIGH and ID_LOW words.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-8
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
•
•
Writing the Data bytes
Writing the Control/Status word (active Code, Length)
NOTE
The first and last steps are mandatory!
Starting from the last step, this MB will participate in the internal arbitration process, which takes place
every time the CAN bus is sensed as free by the receiver or at the inter-frame space, and there is at least
one MB ready for transmission. This internal arbitration process is intended to select the MB from which
the next frame is transmitted.
When this process is over, and there is a ‘winner’ MB for transmission, the frame is transferred to the serial
message buffer (SMB) for transmission (Move Out).
While transmitting, the FlexCAN transmits up to eight data bytes, even if the DLC is bigger in value.
At the end of the successful transmission, the value of the free-running timer (which was captured at the
beginning of the Identifier field on the CAN bus), is written into the “Time Stamp” field in the MB, the
Code field in the Control/Status word of the MB is updated and a status flag is set in the IFLAG register.
25.4.2
Receive Process
The CPU prepares or changes an MB for frame reception by executing the following steps:
• Writing the control/status word to hold Rx MB inactive (code = 0000).
• Writing the ID_HIGH and ID_LOW words.
• Writing the control/status word to mark the Rx MB as active and empty.
NOTE
The first and last steps are mandatory!
Starting from the last step, this MB is an active receive buffer and will participate in the internal matching
process, which takes place every time the receiver receives an error-free frame. In this process, all active
receive buffers compare their ID value to the newly received one, and if a match occurs, the frame is
transferred (Move In) to the first (that is, lowest entry) matching MB. The value of the free-running timer
(which was captured at the beginning of the Identifier field on the CAN bus) is written into the “Time
Stamp” field in the MB, the ID field, data field (8 bytes at most) and the LENGTH field are stored, the
Code field is updated and a status flag is set in the IFLAG register.
The CPU should read a receive frame from its MB in the following way:
• Control/status word (mandatory—activates internal lock for this buffer).
• ID (Optional—needed only if a mask was used).
• Data field word(s).
• Free-running timer (Releases internal lock —optional).
The read of the free-running timer is not mandatory. If not executed, the MB remains locked, unless the
CPU starts the read process for another MB. Note that only a single MB is locked at a time. The only
mandatory CPU read operation is of the Control/Status word, to assure data coherency. If the BUSY bit is
set in the MB code, then the CPU should defer until this bit is negated.
The CPU should synchronize to frame reception by the status flag for the specific MB (see
Section 25.5.10, “Interrupt Flag Register (IFLAG)”), and not by the control/status word code field for that
MB. This is because polling the control/status word may lock the MB (see above), and the Code may
change before the full frame is received into the MB.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-9
FlexCAN
Note that the received identifier field is always stored in the matching MB, thus the contents of the
identifier field in a MB may change if the match was due to mask.
25.4.2.1
Self-Received Frames
The FlexCAN receives self-transmitted frames if there exists a matching receive MB.
25.4.3
Message Buffer Handling
To maintain data coherency and proper FlexCAN operation, the CPU must obey the rules listed in
Section 25.4.1, “Transmit Process” and in Section 25.4.2, “Receive Process.” Deactivation of a message
buffer (MB) is a host action that causes that message buffer to be excluded from FlexCAN transmit or
receive processes. Any CPU write access to a control/status word of MB structure deactivates that MB,
thus excluding it from Rx/Tx processes. Any form of CPU MB structure access within the FlexCAN (other
than those specified in Section 25.4.1, “Transmit Process” and in Section 25.4.2, “Receive Process”) may
cause the FlexCAN to behave in an unpredictable manner.
The match/arbitration processes are performed only during one period by the FlexCAN. Once a winner or
match is determined, there is no re-evaluation whatsoever, in order to ensure that a receive frame is not
lost. Two receive MBs or more that hold a matching ID to a received frame do not assure reception in the
FlexCAN if the user has deactivated the matching MB after FlexCAN has scanned the second.
25.4.3.1
Serial Message Buffers (SMBs)
To allow double buffering of messages, the FlexCAN has two shadow buffers called serial message
buffers. These two buffers are used by the FlexCAN for buffering both received messages and messages
to be transmitted. Only one SMB is active at a time, and its function depends upon the operation of the
FlexCAN at that time. At no time does the user have access to or visibility of these two buffers.
25.4.3.2
Transmit Message Buffer Deactivation
Any write access to the control/status word of a transmit message buffer during the process of selecting a
message buffer for transmission immediately deactivates that message buffer, removing it from the
transmission process.
If the user deactivates the transmit MB while a message is being transferred from a transmit message buffer
to a SMB the message will not be transmitted.
If the user deactivates the transmit message buffer after the message is transferred to the SMB, the message
will be transmitted, but no interrupt will be requested and the transmit code will not be updated.
If a message buffer containing the lowest ID is deactivated while that message is undergoing the internal
arbitration process to determine which message should be sent, then that message may not be transmitted.
25.4.3.3
Receive Message Buffer Deactivation
Any write access to the control/status word of a receive message buffer during the process of selecting a
message buffer for reception immediately deactivates that message buffer, removing it from the reception
process.
If a receive message buffer is deactivated while a message is being transferred into it, the transfer is halted
and no interrupt is requested. If this occurs, that receive message buffer may contain mixed data from two
different frames.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-10
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
Data should never be written into a receive message buffer. If this is done while a message is being
transferred from an SMB, the control/status word will reflect a full or overrun condition, but no interrupt
will be requested.
25.4.3.4
Locking and Releasing Message Buffers
The lock/release/busy mechanism is designed to guarantee data coherency during the receive process. The
following examples demonstrate how the lock/release/busy mechanism will affect FlexCAN operation.
1. Reading a control/status word of a message buffer triggers a lock for that message buffer. A new
received message frame which matches the message buffer cannot be written into this message
buffer while it is locked.
2. To release a locked message buffer, the CPU either locks another message buffer (by reading its
control/status word) or globally releases any locked message buffer (by reading the free-running
timer).
3. If a receive frame with a matching ID is received during the time the message buffer is locked, the
receive frame will not be immediately transferred into that message buffer, but will remain in the
SMB. There is no indication when this occurs.
4. When a locked message buffer is released, if a frame with a matching identifier exists within the
SMB, then this frame will be transferred to the matching message buffer.
5. If two or more receive frames with matching IDs are received while a message buffer with a
matching ID is locked, the last received frame with that ID is kept within the serial message
buffer, while all preceding ones are lost. There is no indication when this occurs.
6. If the user reads the control/status word of a receive message buffer while a frame is being
transferred from a serial message buffer, the BUSY code will be indicated. The user should wait
until this code is cleared before continuing to read from the message buffer to ensure data
coherency. In this situation, the read of the control/status word will not lock the message buffer.
Polling the control/status word of a receive message buffer can lock it, preventing a message from being
transferred into that buffer. If the control/status word of a receive message buffer is read, it should then be
followed by a read of the control/status word of another buffer, or by reading the free-running timer, to
ensure that the locked buffer is unlocked.
25.4.4
Remote Frames
The remote frame is a message frame which is transmitted to request a data frame. The FlexCAN can be
configured to transmit a data frame automatically in response to a remote frame, or to transmit a remote
frame and then wait for the responding data frame to be received.
When transmitting a remote frame, the user initializes a message buffer as a transmit message buffer with
the RTR bit set to one. Once this remote frame is transmitted successfully, the transmit message buffer
automatically becomes a receive message buffer, with the same ID as the remote frame which was
transmitted.
When a remote frame is received by the FlexCAN, the remote frame ID is compared to the IDs of all
transmit message buffers programmed with a code of 1010. If there is an exact matching ID, the data frame
in that message buffer is transmitted. If the RTR bit in the matching transmit message buffer is set, the
FlexCAN will transmit a remote frame as a response.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-11
FlexCAN
A received remote frame is not stored in a receive message buffer. It is only used to trigger the automatic
transmission of a frame in response. The mask registers are not used in remote frame ID matching. All ID
bits (except RTR) of the incoming received frame must match for the remote frame to trigger a response
transmission.
25.4.5
Overload Frames
Overload frame transmissions are not initiated by the FlexCAN unless certain conditions are detected on
the CAN bus. These conditions include:
• Detection of a dominant bit in the first or second bit of intermission.
• Detection of a dominant bit in the seventh (last) bit of the end-of-frame (EOF) field in receive
frames.
• Detection of a dominant bit in the eighth (last) bit of the error frame delimiter or overload frame
delimiter.
25.4.6
Time Stamp
The value of the free-running 16-bit timer is sampled at the beginning of the identifier field on the CAN
bus. For a message being received, the time stamp will be stored in the time stamp entry of the receive
message buffer at the time the message is written into that buffer. For a message being transmitted, the time
stamp entry will be written into the transmit message buffer once the transmission has completed
successfully.
The free-running timer can optionally be reset upon the reception of a frame into message buffer 0. This
feature allows network time synchronization to be performed.
25.4.7
Listen-Only Mode
In listen-only mode, the FlexCAN module is able to receive messages without giving an acknowledgment.
Whenever the module enters this mode the status of the Error Counters is frozen and the FlexCAN module
operates like in error passive mode. Since the module does not influence the CAN bus in this mode the
host device is capable of functioning like a monitor or for automatic bit-rate detection.
25.4.8
Bit Timing
The FlexCAN module uses three 8-bit registers to set up the bit timing parameters required by the CAN
protocol. Control registers 1 and 2 (CANCTRL1, CANCTRL2) contain the PROPSEG, PSEG1, PSEG2,
and the RJW fields which allow the user to configure the bit timing parameters. The prescaler divide
register (PRESDIV) allows the user to select the ratio used to derive the S-clock from the system clock.
The time quanta clock operates at the S-clock frequency. Table 25-7 provides examples of system clock,
CAN bit rate, and S-clock bit timing parameters.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-12
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
Table 25-7. Examples of System Clock/CAN Bit-Rate/S-Clock
System Clock
Freq (Mhz)
Can bit-rate
(Mhz)
Possible
S-Clock Freq
(Mhz)
Possible
number of
time-quanta/bit
Pre-Scaler
programed
value + 1
48
1
8,12,24
8,12,24
3,2,1
40
1
10,20
10,20
2,1
32
1
8,16
8,16
2,1
48
0.125
1,1.5,2,3
8,12,16,24
24,16,12,8
40
0.125
1,2,2.5
8,16,20
20,10,8
32
0.125
1,2
8,16
16,8
25.4.8.1
Comments
Min 8 time-quanta
Max 25 time-quanta
Configuring the FlexCAN Bit Timing
The following considerations must be observed when programming bit timing functions.
• If the programmed PRESDIV value results in a single system clock per one time quantum, then the
PSEG2 field in CANCTRL1 register should not be programmed to zero.
• If the programmed PRESDIV value results in a single system clock per one time quantum, then the
information processing time (IPT) equals three time quanta, otherwise it equals two time quanta.
If PSEG2 equals two, then the FlexCAN transmits one time quantum late relative to the scheduled
sync segment.
• If the prescaler and bit timing control fields are programmed to values that result in fewer than ten
system clock periods per CAN bit time and the CAN bus loading is 100%, anytime the rising edge
of a start-of-frame (SOF) symbol transmitted by another node occurs during the third bit of the
intermission between messages, the FlexCAN may not be able to prepare a message buffer for
transmission in time to begin its own transmission and arbitrate against the message which
transmitted the early SOF.
• The FlexCAN bit time must be programmed to be greater than or equal to nine system clocks, or
correct operation is not guaranteed.
25.4.9
FlexCAN Error Counters
There are two error counters in the FlexCAN: transmit error counter (TXECTR), and receive error counter
(RXCTR). The rules for increasing and decreasing these counters are described in the CAN protocol, and
are fully implemented in the FlexCAN. Each counter comprises the following:
• 8 bit up/down counter
• Increment by 8 (Rx_Err_Counter also by 1)
• Decrement by 1
• Avoid decrement when equal to zero
• Rx_Err_Counter preset to a value 119 ≤ x ≤ 127
• Value after reset = zero
• Detect values for Error Passive, Bus Off and Error Active transitions and for alerting the host.
Both counters are read only (except for Test/Freeze/Halt modes).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-13
FlexCAN
The FlexCAN responds to any bus state as described in the protocol, e.g. transmit error active or error
passive flag, delay its transmission start time (Error Passive) and avoid any influence on the bus when in
Bus Off state. The following are the basic rules for FlexCAN bus state transitions:
• If the value of TXCTR or RXCTR increases to be greater than or equal to 128, the FCS field in the
error status register is updated to reflect it (set Error Passive state).
• If the FlexCAN state is Error Passive, and either TXCTR counter or RXCTR then decrements to a
value less than or equal to 127 while the other already satisfies this condition, the ESTAT[FCS]
field is updated to reflect it (set Error Active state).
• If the value of the TXCTR increases to be greater than 255, the ESTAT[FCS] field is updated to
reflect it (set Bus Off state) and an interrupt may be issued. The value of TXCTR is then reset to
zero.
• If the FlexCAN state is Bus_Off, then TXCTR, together with an internal counter are cascaded to
count the 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits on the bus. Hence, TXCTR is reset to
zero, and counts in a manner where the internal counter counts 11 such bits and then wraps around
while incrementing the TXCTR. When TXCTR reaches the value of 128, ESTAT[FCS] is updated
to be Error Active, and both error counters are reset to zero. At any instance of dominant bit
following a stream of less than 11 consecutive recessive bits, the internal counter resets itself to
zero, but does NOT affect the TXCTR value.
• If during system start-up, only one node is operating, then its TXCTR increases with each message
it’s trying to transmit as a result of ACK_ERROR. A transition to bus state Error Passive should
be executed as described, while this device never enters the Bus_Off state.
• If the RXCTR increases to a value greater than 127, it is no longer incremented, even if more errors
are detected while being a receiver. At the next successful message reception, the counter is set to
a value between 119 and 127, in order to return to Error Active state.
25.4.10 FlexCAN Initialization Sequence
Initialization of the FlexCAN includes the initial configuration of the message buffers and configuration
of the CAN communication parameters following a reset, as well as any reconfiguration which may be
required during operation. The following is a generic initialization sequence for the FlexCAN:
1. Initialize all operation modes
a) Initialize the transmit and receive pin modes in control register 0 (CANCTRL0).
b) Initialize the bit timing parameters PROPSEG, PSEGS1, PSEG2, and RJW
in control registers 1 and 2 (CANCTRL[1:2]).
c) Select the S-clock rate by programming the PRESDIV register.
d) Select the internal arbitration mode (LBUF bit in CANCTRL1).
2. Initialize message buffers
a) The control/status word of all message buffers must be written either as an active or inactive
message buffer.
b) All other entries in each message buffer should be initialized as required.
3. Initialize mask registers for acceptance mask as needed
4. Initialize FlexCAN interrupt handler
a) Initialize the interrupt configuration register (ICRn) with a specific request level and vector
base address.
b) Set the required mask bits in the IMASK register (for all message buffer interrupts), in
CANCTRL0 (for bus off and error interrupts), and in CANMCR for the WAKE interrupt.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-14
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
5. Negate the HALT bit in the module configuration register
a) At this point, the FlexCAN will attempt to synchronize with the CAN bus.
NOTE
In both the transmit and receive processes, the first action in preparing a
message buffer should be to deactivate the buffer by setting its code field to
the proper value. This requirement is mandatory to assure data coherency.
25.4.11 Special Operating Modes
25.4.11.1 Debug Mode
Debug mode is entered by setting the HALT bit in the CANMCR, or by assertion of the BKPT line. In both
cases, the FRZ bit in CANMCR must also be set to allow HALT or BKPT to place the FlexCAN in debug
mode.
Once entry into debug mode is requested, the FlexCAN waits until an intermission or idle condition exists
on the CAN bus, or until the FlexCAN enters the error passive or bus off state. Once one of these
conditions exists, the FlexCAN waits for the completion of all internal activity. When this happens, the
following events occur:
• The FlexCAN stops transmitting/receiving frames.
• The prescaler is disabled, thus halting all CAN bus communication.
• The FlexCAN ignores its Rx pins and drives its Tx pins as recessive.
• The FlexCAN loses synchronization with the CAN bus and the NOTRDY and FRZACK bits in
CANMCR are set.
• The CPU is allowed to read and write the error counter registers.
After engaging one of the mechanisms to place the FlexCAN in debug mode, the user must wait for the
FRZACK bit to be set before accessing any other registers in the FlexCAN, otherwise unpredictable
operation may occur.
To exit debug mode, the BKPT line must be negated or the HALT bit in CANMCR must be cleared.
Once debug mode is exited, the FlexCAN will resynchronize with the CAN bus by waiting for 11
consecutive recessive bits before beginning to participate in CAN bus communication.
25.4.11.2 Low-Power Stop Mode for Power Saving
Before entering low-power stop mode, the FlexCAN will wait for the CAN bus to be in an idle state, or
for the third bit of intermission to be recessive. The FlexCAN then waits for the completion of all internal
activity (except in the CAN bus interface) to be complete. Afterwards, the following events occur:
• The FlexCAN shuts down its clocks, stopping most internal circuits, thus achieving maximum
power savings.
• The bus interface unit continues to operate, allowing the CPU to access the module configuration
register.
• The FlexCAN ignores its Rx pins and drives its Tx pins as recessive.
• The FlexCAN loses synchronization with the CAN bus, and the STOPACK and NOTRDY bits in
the module configuration register are set.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-15
FlexCAN
To exit low-power stop mode:
• Reset the FlexCAN either by asserting RSTI or by setting the SOFTRST bit CANMCR.
• Clear the STOP bit in CANMCR.
• The FlexCAN module can optionally exit low-power stop mode via the self-wake mechanism. If
the SELFWAKE bit in CANMCR was set at the time the FlexCAN entered stop mode, then upon
detection of a recessive to dominant transition on the CAN bus, the FlexCAN clears the STOP bit
in CANMCR and its clocks begin running.
When in low-power stop mode, a recessive to dominant transition on the CAN bus causes the WAKEINT
bit in the error and status register (ESTAT) to be set. This event can generate an interrupt if the WAKEMSK
bit in CANMCR is set.
Consider the following notes regarding low-power stop mode:
• When the self-wake mechanism activates, the FlexCAN tries to receive the frame that woke it up.
(It assumes that the dominant bit detected is a start-of-frame bit). It will not arbitrate for the CAN
bus at this time.
• The CPU should disable all interrupts in the FlexCAN before entering low-power stop mode.
Otherwise it may be interrupted while in STOP mode upon a non wake-up condition; If desired,
the WAKEMASK bit should be set to enable the WAKEINT.
• If the STOP bit is set while the FlexCAN is in the bus off state, then the FlexCAN will enter
low-power stop mode and stop counting recessive bit times. The count will continue when STOP
is cleared.
• To place the FlexCAN in low-power stop mode with the self-wake mechanism engaged, write to
CANMCR with both STOP and SELFWAKE set, then wait for the FlexCAN to set the STOPACK
bit.
• To take the FlexCAN out of low-power stop mode when the self-wake mechanism is enabled, write
to CANMCR with both STOP and SELFWAKE clear, then wait for the FlexCAN to clear the
STOPACK bit.
• The SELFWAKE bit should not be set after the FlexCAN has already entered low-power stop
mode.
• If both STOP and SELFWAKE are set and a recessive to dominant edge immediately occurs on the
CAN bus, the FlexCAN may never set the STOPACK bit, and the STOP bit will be cleared.
• To prevent old frames from being sent when the FlexCAN awakes from low-power stop mode via
the self-wake mechanism, disable all transmit sources, including transmit buffers configured for
remote request responses, before placing the FlexCAN in low-power stop mode.
• If the FlexCAN is in debug mode when the STOP bit is set, the FlexCAN will assume that debug
mode should be exited. As a result, it will try to synchronize with the CAN bus, and only then will
it await the conditions required for entry into low-power stop mode.
• Unlike other modules, the FlexCAN does not come out of reset in low-power stop mode. The basic
FlexCAN initialization procedure (see Section 25.4.10, “FlexCAN Initialization Sequence”)
should be executed before placing the module in low-power stop mode.
• If the FlexCAN is in low-power stop mode with the self-wake mechanism engaged and is operating
with a single system clock per time quantum, there can be extreme cases in which FlexCAN
wake-up on recessive to dominant edge may not conform to the CAN protocol. FlexCAN
synchronization will be shifted one time quantum from the wake-up event. This shift lasts until the
next recessive to dominant edge, which resynchronizes the FlexCAN to be in conformance with
the CAN protocol. The same holds true when the FlexCAN is in auto-power save mode and
awakens on a recessive to dominant edge.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-16
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
25.4.11.3 Auto-Power Save Mode
Auto-power save mode enables normal operation with optimized power savings. Once the auto-power
save (APS) bit in CANMCR is set, the FlexCAN looks for a set of conditions in which there is no need for
its clocks to be running. If these conditions are met, the FlexCAN stops its clocks, thus saving power. The
following conditions will activate auto-power save mode.
• No Rx/Tx frame in progress.
• No transfer of Rx/Tx frames to and from an SMB, and no Tx frame awaiting transmission in any
message buffer.
• No CPU access to the FlexCAN module.
• The FlexCAN is not in debug mode, low-power stop mode, or the bus off state.
While its clocks are stopped, if the FlexCAN senses that any one of the aforementioned conditions is no
longer true, it restarts its clocks. The FlexCAN then continues to monitor these conditions and
stops/restarts its clocks accordingly.
25.4.12 Interrupts
The module can generate up to 19 interrupt sources (16 interrupts due to message buffers and 3 interrupts
due to Bus-off, Error and Wake-up). Each one of the message buffers can be an interrupt source, if its
corresponding IMASK bit is set.
There is no distinction between Tx and Rx interrupts for a particular buffer, under the assumption that the
buffer is initialized for either transmission or reception, and thus its interrupt routine can be fixed at
compilation time. Each of the buffers is assigned a bit in the IFLAG register. The bit is set when the
corresponding buffer completes a successful transmission or reception, and cleared when the CPU reads
the interrupt flag register (IFLAG) while the associated bit is set, and then writes it back as ‘1’ (and no new
event of the same type occurs between the read and the write actions).
The other 3 interrupt sources (Bus-off, Error and Wake-up) act in the same way, and are located in the Error
& Status register. The Bus-off and Error interrupt mask bits are located in the CANCTRL0 register, and
the Wake-up interrupt mask bit is located in the CANMCR.
25.5
Programmer’s Model
This section describes the registers in the FlexCAN module.
NOTE
The FlexCAN has no hard-wired protection against invalid bit/field
programming within its registers. Specifically, no protection is provided if
the programming does not meet CAN protocol requirements.
Programming the FlexCAN control registers is typically done during system initialization, prior to the
FlexCAN becoming synchronized with the CAN bus. The configuration registers can be changed after
synchronization by halting the FlexCAN module. This is done when the user sets the HALT bit in the
FlexCAN module configuration register (CANMCR). The FlexCAN responds by setting the
CANMCR[NOTRDY] bit. Additionally, the control registers can be modified while the MCU is in
background debug mode.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-17
FlexCAN
25.5.1
CAN Module Configuration Register (CANMCR)
Field
15
14
13
12
11
STOP
FRZ
—
HALT
NOTRDY
Reset
10
9
WAKEMSK SOFTRST
8
FRZACK
0101_1001
R/W
R/W
Field
7
6
5
4
SUPV
SELFWAKE
APS
STOPACK
Reset
3
0
—
1000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0000
Figure 25-6. CAN Module Configuration Register (CANMCR)
Table 25-8 describes the CANMCR fields.
Table 25-8. CANMCR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
STOP
Low-power stop mode enable. The STOP bit may only be set by the CPU. It may be cleared either
by the CPU or by the FlexCAN, if the SELFWAKE bit is set.
0 Enable FlexCAN clocks
1 Disable FlexCAN clocks
14
FRZ
FREEZE assertion response. When FRZ = 1, the FlexCAN can enter debug mode when the BKPT
line is asserted or the HALT bit is set. Clearing this bit field causes the FlexCAN to exit debug
mode. Refer to Section 25.4.11.1, “Debug Mode” for more information.
0 FlexCAN ignores the BKPT signal and the HALT bit in the module configuration register.
1 FlexCAN module enabled to enter debug mode.
13
—
15
12
HALT
Reserved
Halt FlexCAN S-Clock. Setting the HALT bit has the same effect as assertion of the BKPT signal
on the FlexCAN without requiring that BKPT be asserted. This bit is set to one after reset. It should
be cleared after initializing the message buffers and control registers. FlexCAN message buffer
receive and transmit functions are inactive until this bit is cleared.
When HALT is set, write access to certain registers and bits that are normally read-only is allowed.
0 The FlexCAN operates normally
1 FlexCAN enters debug mode if FRZ = 1
11
FlexCAN not ready. This bit indicates that the FlexCAN is either in low-power stop mode or debug
mode. This bit is read-only and is set only when the FlexCAN enters low-power stop mode or
debug mode. It is cleared once the FlexCAN exits either mode, either by synchronization to the
NOTRDY
CAN bus or by the self-wake mechanism.
0 FlexCAN has exited low-power stop mode or debug mode.
1 FlexCAN is in low-power stop mode or debug mode.
10
Wakeup interrupt mask. The WAKEMSK bit enables wake-up interrupt requests.
WAKEMS
0 Wake up interrupt is disabled.
K
1 Wake up interrupt is enabled.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-18
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
Table 25-8. CANMCR Field Descriptions (continued)
Bits
Name
Description
Soft reset. When this bit is asserted, the FlexCAN resets its internal state machines (sequencer,
error counters, error flags, and timer) and the host interface registers (CANMCR, CANICR,
CANTCR, IMASK, and IFLAG).
The configuration registers that control the interface with the CAN bus are not changed (CANCTRL[0:2] and PRESDIV). Message buffers and receive message masks are also not changed.
This allows SOFTRST to be used as a debug feature while the system is running.
9
SOFTRST
Setting SOFTRST also clears the STOP bit in CANMCR.
After setting SOFTRST, allow one complete bus cycle to elapse for the internal FlexCAN circuitry
to completely reset before executing another access to CANMCR.
The FlexCAN clears this bit once the internal reset cycle is completed.
0 Soft reset cycle completed
1 Soft reset cycle initiated
8
7
FRZACK
FlexCAN disable. When the FlexCAN enters debug mode, it sets the FRZACK bit. This bit should
be polled to determine if the FlexCAN has entered debug mode. When debug mode is exited, this
bit is negated once the FlexCAN prescaler is enabled. This is a read-only bit.
0 The FlexCAN has exited debug mode and the prescaler is enabled.
1 The FlexCAN has entered debug mode, and the prescaler is disabled.
SUPV
Supervisor/user data space. The SUPV bit places the FlexCAN registers in either supervisor or
user data space.
0 Registers with access controlled by the SUPV bit are accessible in either user or supervisor
privilege mode.
1 Registers with access controlled by the SUPV bit are restricted to supervisor mode.
Self wake enable. This bit allows the FlexCAN to wake up when bus activity is detected after the
STOP bit is set. If this bit is set when the FlexCAN enters low-power stop mode, the FlexCAN will
monitor the bus for a recessive to dominant transition. If a recessive to dominant transition is
detected, the FlexCAN immediately clears the STOP bit and restarts its clocks.
6
5
4
3–0
SELFWAKE
APS
If a write to CANMCR with SELFWAKE set occurs at the same time a recessive-to-dominant edge
appears on the CAN bus, the bit will not be set, and the module clocks will not stop. The user
should verify that this bit has been set by reading CANMCR. Refer to Section 25.4.11.2,
“Low-Power Stop Mode for Power Saving” for more information on entry into and exit from
low-power stop mode.
0 Self wake disabled.
1 Self wake enabled.
Auto-power save. The APS bit allows the FlexCAN to automatically shut off its clocks to save
power when it has no process to execute, and to automatically restart these clocks when it has a
task to execute without any CPU intervention.
0 Auto-power save mode disabled; clocks run normally.
1 Auto-power save mode enabled; clocks stop and restart as needed.
Stop acknowledge. When the FlexCAN is placed in low-power stop mode and shuts down its
clocks, it sets the STOPACK bit. This bit should be polled to determine if the FlexCAN has entered
low-power stop mode. When the FlexCAN exits low-power stop mode, the STOPACK bit is
STOPACK
cleared once the FlexCAN’s clocks are running.
0 The FlexCAN is not in low-power stop mode and its clocks are running.
1 The FlexCAN has entered low-power stop mode and its clocks are stopped
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-19
FlexCAN
25.5.2
FlexCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTRL0)
7
6
Field BOFFMSK
5
ERRMSK
4
3
—
Reset
2
1
RXMODE
0
TXMODE
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0006
Figure 25-7. FlexCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTRL0)
Table 25-9 describes the CANCTRL0 fields.
Table 25-9. CANCTRL0 Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
7
BOFFMSK
6
Error interrupt mask. The ERRMSK bit provides a mask for the error interrupt.
ERRMSK 0 Error interrupt disabled.
1 Error interrupt enabled.
5–3
2
1–0
—
Description
Bus off interrupt mask. The BOFF MASK bit provides a mask for the bus off interrupt.
0 Bus off interrupt disabled.
1 Bus off interrupt enabled.
Reserved
Receive pin configuration control. This bit determines the polarity of the CANRX pin.
RXMODE 0 A logical ‘0’ is interpreted as a dominant bit; a logical ‘1’ is interpreted as a recessive bit.
1 A logical ‘1’ is interpreted as a dominant bit; a logical ‘0’ is interpreted as a recessive bit.
TXMODE
Transmit pin configuration control. This bit field controls the configuration of the CANTX pin. See
Table 25-10.
Table 25-10. Transmit Pin Configuration
TXMODE[1:0]
1
2
Transmit Pin Configuration
00
Full CMOS1; positive polarity (CANTX= 0 is a dominant level)
01
Full CMOS1; negative polarity (CANTX = 1 is a dominant level)
1X
Open drain2; positive polarity
Full CMOS drive indicates that both dominant and recessive levels are driven by the chip.
Open drain drive indicates that only a dominant level is driven by the chip. During a recessive
level, the CANTX pin is disabled (three stated), and the electrical level is achieved by external
pull-up/pull-down devices. The assertion of both Tx mode bits causes the polarity inversion to be
cancelled (open drain mode forces the polarity to be positive).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-20
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
25.5.3
FlexCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTRL1)
Field
7
6
5
4
3
SAMP
—
TSYNC
LBUF
LOM
Reset
2
1
0
PROPSEG
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0007
Figure 25-8. FlexCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTRL1)
Table 25-11 describes the CANCTRL1 fields.
Table 25-11. CANCTRL1 Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7
SAMP
Sampling mode. The SAMP bit determines whether the FlexCAN module will sample each
received bit one time or three times to determine its value.
0 One sample, taken at the end of phase buffer segment 1, is used to determine the value of the
received bit.
1 Three samples are used to determine the value of the received bit. The samples are taken at the
normal sample point and at the two preceding periods of the S-clock.
6
—
5
TSYNC
Reserved, should be cleared.
Timer synchronize mode. The TSYNC bit enables the mechanism that resets the free-running timer
each time a message is received in Message Buffer 0. This feature provides the means to synchronize multiple FlexCAN stations with a special “SYNC” message (global network time).
0 Timer synchronization disabled.
1 Timer synchronization enabled.
Note: there can be a bit clock skew of four to five counts between different FlexCAN modules that
are using this feature on the same network.
4
3
LBUF
Lowest buffer transmitted first. The LBUF bit defines the transmit-first scheme.
0 Message buffer with lowest ID is transmitted first.
1 Lowest numbered buffer is transmitted first.
LOM
Listen Only Mode. In this mode the FlexCAN is able to receive messages without giving an
acknowledgment or being active on the bus.
0 Regular operation (listen only mode off).
1 Enable listen only mode.
Propagation segment time. PROPSEG defines the length of the propagation segment in the bit
time. The valid programmed values are 0 to 7. The propagation segment time is calculated as
follows:
2–0
PROPSE
Propagation Segment Time = (PROPSEG + 1) Time Quanta
G
where
1 Time Quantum = 1 Serial Clock (S-Clock) Period
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-21
FlexCAN
25.5.4
Prescaler Divide Register (PRESDIV)
7
0
Field
PRES_DIV
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0008
Figure 25-9. Prescaler Divide Register (PRESDIV)
Table 25-12 describes the PRESDIV fields.
Table 25-12. PRESDIV Field Descriptions
Bits
7–0
Name
Description
PRES_DIV Prescaler divide factor. PRESDIV determines the ratio between the system clock frequency and
the serial clock (S-clock). The S-clock is determined by the following calculation:
f sys
S-clock = --------------------------------------------2 ( PRESDIV + 1 )
The reset value of PRESDIV is 0x00, which forces the S-clock to default to the same frequency
as the system clock. The valid programmed values are 0 through 255. See Section 25.4.8, “Bit
Timing” for more information.
25.5.5
FlexCAN Control Register 2 (CANCTRL2)
7
Field
6
5
RJW
3
2
PSEG1
Reset
0
PSEG2
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0009
Figure 25-10. FlexCAN Control Register 2 (CANCTRL2)
Table 25-13 describes the CANCTRL2 fields.
Table 25-13. CANCTRL2 Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7–6
RJW
Resynchronization jump width. The RJW field defines the maximum number of time quanta a bit time
may be changed during resynchronization. The valid programmed values are 0 through 3.
The resynchronization jump width is calculated as follows:
Resynchronizaton Jump Width = (RJW + 1) Time Quanta
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-22
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
Table 25-13. CANCTRL2 Field Descriptions (continued)
Bits
Name
5–3
PSEG PSEG1[2:0] — Phase buffer segment 1. The PSEG1 field defines the length of phase buffer segment
1
1 in the bit time. The valid programmed values are 0 through 7.
The length of phase buffer segment 1 is calculated as follows:
Phase Buffer Segment 1 = (PSEG1 + 1) Time Quanta
2–0
PSEG PSEG2 — Phase Buffer Segment 2. The PSEG2 field defines the length of phase buffer segment 2
2
in the bit time. The valid programmed values are 0 through 7.
The length of phase buffer segment 2 is calculated as follows:
Phase Buffer Segment 2 = (PSEG2 + 1) Time Quanta
25.5.6
Description
Free Running Timer (TIMER)
15
0
Field
TIMER
Reset
0000_0000_0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_000A
Figure 25-11. Free Running Timer (TIMER)
Table 25-14 describes the TIMER fields.
Table 25-14. TIMER Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
15–0
TIMER The free running timer counter can be read and written by the CPU. The timer starts from zero after
reset, counts linearly to 0xFFFF, and wraps around.
The timer is clocked by the FlexCAN bit-clock. During a message, it increments by one for each bit
that is received or transmitted. When there is no message on the bus, it increments at the nominal bit
rate.
The timer value is captured at the beginning of the identifier field of any frame on the CAN bus. The
captured value is written into the “time stamp” entry in a message buffer after a successful reception
or transmission of a message.
25.5.7
Description
Rx Mask Registers
These registers are used as acceptance masks for received frame IDs. 3 masks are defined: A global mask,
used for Rx buffers 0-13, and 2 more separate masks for buffers 14 and 15.
Mask bit = 0: The corresponding incoming ID bit is “don’t care”.
Mask bit = 1: The corresponding ID bit is checked against the incoming ID bit, to see if a match exists.
Note that these masks are used both for Standard and Extended ID formats. The value of mask registers
should NOT be changed while in normal operation, as locked frames which matched a MB through a mask,
may be transferred into the MB (upon release) but may no longer match.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-23
FlexCAN
Table 25-15. Mask examples for Normal/Extended Messages
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Base ID
ID28.................ID18
I
D
E
MB2-Id
11111111000
0
MB3-Id
11111111000
1
MB4-Id
00000011111
0
MB5-Id
00000011101
1
010101010101010101
MB14-Id
11111111000
1
010101010101010101
Rx_Global_Mas
k
11111111110
Rx_Msg in
11111111001
1
Rx_Msg in
11111111001
0
Rx_Msg in
11111111001
1
Rx_Msg in
01111111000
0
Rx_Msg in
01111111000
1
Rx_14_Mask
01111111111
Rx_Msg in
10111111000
1
010101010101010101
6
Rx_Msg in
01111111000
1
010101010101010101
147
Extended ID
ID17......................................ID0
Match
010101010101010101
111111100000000001
010101010101010101
31
22
3
010101010101010100
4
5
010101010101010101
111111100000000000
Match for Extended Format (MB3).
Match for Standard Format. (MB2).
Un-Match for MB3 because of ID0.
Un-Match for MB2 because of ID28.
Un-Match for MB3 because of ID28, Match for MB14.
Un-Match for MB14 because of ID27.
Match for MB14.
25.5.7.1
Receive Mask Registers (RXGMASK, RX14MASK, RX15MASK)
The Rx global mask register (RXGMASK) is composed of 4 bytes. The mask bits are applied to all
Rx-Identifiers excluding Rx-buffers 14-15, that have their specific Rx-mask registers (RX14MASK and
RX15MASK).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-24
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
31
21
Field
MID[28:18]
Reset
20
19
—
18
17
16
MID[17:15]
1111_1111_1110_1111
R/W
R/W
15
1
Field
MID[14:0]
Reset
0
—
1111_1111_1111_1110
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0010 (RXGMASK), 0x1C_0014 (RX14MASK), 0x1C_0018 (RX15MASK)
Figure 25-12. Rx Mask Registers (RXGMASK, RX14MASK, and RX15MASK)
Table 25-16. RXGMASK, RX14MASK, and RX15MASK Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
31–21
MID
20
—
Reserved. The IDE bit of a received frame is always compared. Its location in the mask (bit 19) is
always 1, regardless of any CPU write to this bit.
19
—
Reserved. The RTR/SRR bit of a received frame is never compared to the corresponding bit in the
MB ID field. Note, however, that remote request frames (RTR = 1) are never received into MBs. RTR
mask bits locations in the mask (bits 20 and 0) are always read as ’0’, regardless of any CPU write
to these bits.
18–1
MID
0
—
25.5.8
Description
Mask ID. MID[28:18] are used to mask standard or extended format frames.
0 corresponding incoming ID bit is “don’t care”.
1 corresponding ID bit is checked against the incoming ID bit, to see if a match exists.
Mask ID. MID[17:0] are only used to mask extended format frames.
0 corresponding incoming ID bit is “don’t care”.
1 corresponding ID bit is checked against the incoming ID bit, to see if a match exists.
Reserved. The RTR/SRR bit of a received frame is never compared to the corresponding bit in the
MB ID field. Note, however, that remote request frames (RTR = 1) are never received into MBs. RTR
mask bits locations in the mask (bits 20 and 0) are always read as ’0’, regardless of any CPU write
to these bits.
FlexCAN Error and Status Register (ESTAT)
ESTAT reflects various error conditions, some general status of the device, and is the source of three
interrupts to the host. The reported error conditions (bits 15:10) are those occurred since the last time the
host read this register. The read action clears these bits to 0.
All the bits in this register are read only, except for BOFF_INT, WAKE_INT and ERR_INT, which are
interrupt sources and can be written by the host to ‘1’. Section 25.4.12, “Interrupts.”
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-25
FlexCAN
15
Field
14
BITERR
13
12
ACKERR
CRCERR
Reset
10
9
FORMERR STUFFERR TXWARN
8
RXWARN
0000_0000
R/W
Field
11
R
7
6
IDLE
TX/RX
5
4
FCS
Reset
3
2
1
0
—
BOFFINT
ERRINT
WAKEINT
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
R
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0020
Figure 25-13. FlexCAN Error and Status Register (ESTAT)
Table 25-17 describes the ESTAT fields.
Table 25-17. ESTAT Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
15–14
BITERR
Transmit bit error. The BITERR[1:0] field is used to indicate when a transmit bit error occurs.
00 No transmit bit error
01 At least one bit sent as dominant was received as recessive
10 At least one bit sent as recessive was received as dominant
11 Reserved
NOTE: The transmit bit error field is not modified during the arbitration field or the ACK slot
bit time of a message, or by a transmitter that detects dominant bits while sending a passive
error frame.
13
ACKERR
Acknowledge error. The ACKERR bit indicates whether an acknowledgment has been
correctly received for a transmitted message.
0 No ACK error was detected since the last read of this register.
1 An ACK error was detected since the last read of this register.
12
CRCERR
Cyclic redundancy check error. The CRCERR bit indicates whether or not the CRC of the
last transmitted or received message was valid.
0 No CRC error was detected since the last read of this register.
1 A CRC error was detected since the last read of this register.
11
FORMERR Message format error. The FORMERR bit indicates whether or not the message format of
the last transmitted or received message was correct.
0 No format error was detected since the last read of this register.
1 A format error was detected since the last read of this register.
10
STUFERR Bit stuff error. The STUFFERR bit indicates whether or not the bit stuffing that occurred in
the last transmitted or received message was correct.
0 No bit stuffing error was detected since the last read of this register.
1 A bit stuffing error was detected since the last read of this register.
9
TXWARN
Transmit error status flag. The TXWARN status flag reflects the status of the FlexCAN
transmit error counter.
0 Transmit error counter < 96.
1 Transmit error counter ≥ 96.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-26
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
Table 25-17. ESTAT Field Descriptions (continued)
Bits
Name
8
RXWARN
7
IDLE
6
TX/RX
Transmit/receive status. The TX/RX bit indicates when the FlexCAN module is transmitting
or receiving a message. TX/RX has no meaning when IDLE = 1.
0 The FlexCAN is receiving a message if IDLE = 0.
1 The FlexCAN is transmitting a message if IDLE = 0.
5–4
FCS
Fault confinement state. The FCS[1:0] field describes the state of the FlexCAN. If the
SOFTRST bit in CANMCR is asserted while the FlexCAN is in the bus off state, the error and
status register is reset, including FCS[1:0]. However, as soon as the FlexCAN exits reset,
FCS[1:0] bits will again reflect the bus off state. Refer to Section 25.5.11, “FlexCAN Receive
Error Counter (RXECTR)” for more information on entry into and exit from the various fault
confinement states.
00 Error active
01 Error passive
1X Reserved
3
—
2
BOFFINT
Bus off interrupt. The BOFFINT bit is used to request an interrupt when the FlexCAN enters
the bus off state. To clear this bit, first read it as a one, then write a one. Writing zero has no
effect.
0 No bus off interrupt requested.
1 When the FlexCAN state changes to bus off, this bit is set, and if the BOFFMSK bit in
CANCTRL0 is set, an interrupt request is generated. This interrupt is not requested after
reset.
1
ERRINT
Error interrupt. The ERRINT bit is used to request an interrupt when the FlexCAN detects a
transmit or receive error. To clear this bit, first read it as a one, then write a one. Writing zero
has no effect.
0 No error interrupt request.
1 If an event which causes one of the error bits in the error and status register to be set
occurs, the error interrupt bit is set. If the ERRMSK bit in CANCTRL0 is set, an interrupt
request is generated.
0
WAKEINT
Wake interrupt. The WAKEINT bit indicates that bus activity has been detected while the
FlexCAN module is in low-power stop mode. To clear this bit, first read it as a one, then write
a one. Writing zero has no effect.
0 No wake interrupt requested.
1 When the FlexCAN is in low-power stop mode and a recessive to dominant transition is
detected on the CAN bus, this bit is set. If the WAKEMSK bit is set in CANMCR, an
interrupt request is generated.
25.5.9
Description
Receiver error status flag. The RXWARN status flag reflects the status of the FlexCAN
receive error counter.
0 Receive error counter < 96.
1 Receive error counter ≥ 96.
Idle status. The IDLE bit indicates when there is activity on the CAN bus.
0 The CAN bus is not idle.
1 The CAN bus is idle.
Reserved, should be cleared.
Interrupt Mask Register (IMASK)
IMASK contains one interrupt mask bit per buffer. It enables the CPU to determine which buffer will
generate an interrupt after a successful transmission/reception (that is, when the corresponding IFLAG bit
is set).
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-27
FlexCAN
The interrupt mask register contains two 8-bit fields: bits 15-8 (IMASK_H) and bits 7-0 (IMASK_L). The
register can be accessed by the master as a 16-bit register, or each byte can be accessed individually using
an 8-bit (byte) access cycle.
Field
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
BUF15M
BUF14M
BUF13M
BUF12
BUF11M
BUF10M
BUF9M
BUF8M
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
Field
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
BUF7M
BUF6M
BUF5M
BUF4M
BUF3M
Reset
0
BUF2M
BUF1M
BUF0M
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0022
Figure 25-14. Interrupt Mask Register (IMASK)
Table 25-18 describes the IMASK fields.
Table 25-18. IMASK Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
15–0
BUFn
M
Description
IMASK contains one interrupt mask bit per buffer. It allows the CPU to designate which buffers will
generate interrupts after successful transmission/reception.
0 The interrupt for the corresponding buffer is disabled.
1 The interrupt for the corresponding buffer is enabled.
25.5.10 Interrupt Flag Register (IFLAG)
IFLAG contains one interrupt flag bit per buffer. Each successful transmission/reception sets the
corresponding IFLAG bit and, if the corresponding IMASK bit is set, will generate an interrupt.
This register contains two 8-bit fields: bits 15-8 (IFLAG_H) and bits 7-0 (IFLAG_L). The register can be
accessed by the master as a 16-bit register, or each byte can be accessed individually using an 8-bit (byte)
access cycle.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-28
Freescale Semiconductor
FlexCAN
Field
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
BUF15I
BUF14I
BUF13I
BUF1I
BUF11I
BUF10I
BUF9I
BUF8I
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
Field
R/w
7
6
5
4
3
BUF7I
BUF6I
BUF5I
BUF4I
BUF3I
Reset
0
BUF2I
BUF1I
BUF0I
0000_0000
R/W
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0024
Figure 25-15. Interrupt Flag Register (IFLAG)
Table 25-19 describes the IFLAG fields.
Table 25-19. IFLAG Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
15–0
BUFnI IFLAG contains one interrupt flag bit per buffer. Each successful transmission/reception sets the
corresponding IFLAG bit and, if the corresponding IMASK bit is set, an interrupt request will be
generated.
To clear an interrupt flag, first read the flag as a one, and then write it as a one. Should a new flag
setting event occur between the time that the CPU reads the flag as a one and writes the flag as a
zero, the flag is not cleared. This register can be written to zeros only.
0 The interrupt for the corresponding buffer is disabled.
1 The interrupt for the corresponding buffer is enabled.
25.5.11 FlexCAN Receive Error Counter (RXECTR)
7
0
Field
RXECTR
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0026
Figure 25-16. FlexCAN Receive Error Counter (RXECTR)
Table 25-20 describes the RXECTR fields.
Table 25-20. RXECTR Field Descriptions
Bits
7–0
Name
Description
RXECT Receive error counter. Indicates the current receive error count as defined in the CAN protocol. See
R
Section 25.4.9, “FlexCAN Error Counters” for more details.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
25-29
FlexCAN
25.5.12 FlexCAN Transmit Error Counter (TXECTR)
7
0
Field
TXECTR
Reset
0000_0000
R/W
R
Address
IPSBAR + 0x1C_0028
Figure 25-17. FlexCAN Transmit Error Counter (TXECTR)
Table 25-21 describes the TXECTR fields.
Table 25-21. TXECTR Field Descriptions
Bits
Name
Description
7–0
TXECT Transmit error counter. Indicates the current transmit error count as defined in the CAN protocol. See
R
Section 25.4.9, “FlexCAN Error Counters” for more details.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
25-30
Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 26
General Purpose I/O Module
26.1
Introduction
Many of the pins associated with the external interface may be used for several different functions. Their
primary function is to provide an external memory interface to access off-chip resources. When not used
for their primary function, many of the pins may be used as general-purpose digital I/O pins. In some cases,
the pin function is set by the operating mode, and the alternate pin functions are not supported.
The digital I/O pins are grouped into 8-bit ports. Some ports do not use all eight bits. Each port has registers
that configure, monitor, and control the port pins. Figure 26-1 and Figure 26-2 are block diagrams of the
ports for the MCF521x and MCF528x.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
26-1
General Purpose I/O Module
PAS5 / URXD2
D[31:24] / PA[7:0]
PORT A
D[23:16] / PB[7:0]
PORT B
D[15:8] / PC[7:0]
D[7:0] / PD[7:0]
A[23:21] / PF[7:5] /
CS[6:4]
SDA / PAS1 / URXD2
PORT AS
PORT NQ1
1
PORT C
PORT QA
PORT D
PORT QB1
SCL / PAS0 / UTXD2
IRQ[7:1] / PNQ[7:1]
AN56 / PQA4 / ETRIG2
AN55 / PQA3 / ETRIG1
AN53 / PQA1 / MA1
AN52 / PQA0 / MA0
AN3 / PQB3 / ANZ
AN2 / PQB2 / ANY
AN1 / PQB1 / ANX
AN0 / PQB0 / ANW
QSPI_CS[3:0] / PQS[6:3]
SIZ1 / PE3 / SYNCA
SIZ0 / PE2 / SYNCB
TS / PE1 / SYNCA
TIP / PE0 / SYNCB
PAS4 / UTXD2
CANRX / PAS3 / URXD2
CANTX / PAS2 / UTXD2
PORT E
PORT F
OE / PE7
TA / PE6
TEA / PE5
R/W / PE4
SDRAM_CS[1:0] /
PSD[2:1]
PORT QS
QSPI_CLK / PQS2
QSPI_DIN / PQS1
QSPI_DOUT / PQS0
PORT SD
SRAS / PSD5
SCAS / PSD4
DRAMW / PSD3
SCKE / PSD0
A[20:16] / PF[4:0]
A[15:8] / PG[7:0]
PORT G
PORT TA1
GPTA[3:0] / PTA[3:0]
A[7:0] / PH[7:0]
PORT H
PORT TB1
GPTB[3:0] / PTB[3:0]
PORT TC
DTIN3 / PTC[3] / URTS1 / URTS0
DTOUT3 / PTC[2] / URTS1 / URTS0
DTIN2 / PTC[1] / UCTS1 / UCTS0
DTOUT2 / PTC[0] / UCTS1 / UCTS0
BS[3:0] / PJ[7:4]
PORT J
CS[3:0] / PJ[3:0]
DTIN1 / PTD[3] / URTS1 / URTS0
DDATA[3:0] / PDD[7:4]
PST[3:0] / PDD[3:0]
PEL[0]
PORT EL
PEL[6]
PEL[5]
PEL[4]
DTOUT1 / PTD[2] / URTS1 / URTS0
DTIN0 / PTD[1] / UCTS1 / UCTS0
DTOUT0 / PTD[0] / UCTS1 / UCTS0
URXD1 / PUA[3]
PEL[7]
PEL[3]
PEL[2]
PEL[1]
PORT TD
PORT DD
PORT UA
UTXD1 / PUA[2]
URXD0 / PUA[1]
UTXD0 / PUA[0]
1. Although ports NQ, QA, QB, TA, and TB are not part of the ports module, they are included here for comprehensiveness.
Figure 26-1. MCF5214 and MCF5216 Ports Module Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
26-2
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose I/O Module
EMDIO / PAS5 / URXD2
D[31:24] / PA[7:0]
PORT A
D[23:16] / PB[7:0]
PORT B
D[15:8] / PC[7:0]
D[7:0] / PD[7:0]
A[23:21] / PF[7:5] /
CS[6:4]
SDA / PAS1 / URXD2
PORT AS
PORT NQ1
1
PORT C
PORT QA
PORT D
PORT QB1
SCL / PAS0 / UTXD2
IRQ[7:1] / PNQ[7:1]
AN56 / PQA4 / ETRIG2
AN55 / PQA3 / ETRIG1
AN53 / PQA1 / MA1
AN52 / PQA0 / MA0
AN3 / PQB3 / ANZ
AN2 / PQB2 / ANY
AN1 / PQB1 / ANX
AN0 / PQB0 / ANW
QSPI_CS[3:0] / PQS[6:3]
SIZ1 / PE3 / SYNCA
SIZ0 / PE2 / SYNCB
TS / PE1 / SYNCA
TIP / PE0 / SYNCB
EMDC / PAS4 / UTXD2
CANRX / PAS3 / URXD2
CANTX / PAS2 / UTXD2
PORT E
PORT F
OE / PE7
TA / PE6
TEA / PE5
R/W / PE4
SDRAM_CS[1:0] /
PSD[2:1]
PORT QS
QSPI_CLK / PQS2
QSPI_DIN / PQS1
QSPI_DOUT / PQS0
PORT SD
SRAS / PSD5
SCAS / PSD4
DRAMW / PSD3
SCKE / PSD0
A[20:16] / PF[4:0]
A[15:8] / PG[7:0]
PORT G
PORT TA1
GPTA[3:0] / PTA[3:0]
A[7:0] / PH[7:0]
PORT H
PORT TB1
GPTB[3:0] / PTB[3:0]
PORT TC
DTIN3 / PTC[3] / URTS1 / URTS0
DTOUT3 / PTC[2] / URTS1 / URTS0
DTIN2 / PTC[1] / UCTS1 / UCTS0
DTOUT2 / PTC[0] / UCTS1 / UCTS0
BS[3:0] / PJ[7:4]
PORT J
CS[3:0] / PJ[3:0]
DTIN1 / PTD[3] / URTS1 / URTS0
DDATA[3:0] / PDD[7:4]
PST[3:0] / PDD[3:0]
ERXCLK / PEH[3]
ERXDV / PEH[2]
ERXD[0] / PEH[1]
ECRS / PEH[0]
PORT EH
ERXER / PEL[0]
ETXEN / PEH[6]
ETXD[0] / PEH[5]
ECOL / PEH[4]
DTOUT1 / PTD[2] / URTS1 / URTS0
DTIN0 / PTD[1] / UCTS1 / UCTS0
DTOUT0 / PTD[0] / UCTS1 / UCTS0
URXD1 / PUA[3]
ETXCLK / PEH[7]
ERXD[3] / PEL[3]
ERXD[2] / PEL[2]
ERXD[1] / PEL[1]
PORT TD
PORT DD
PORT UA
UTXD1 / PUA[2]
URXD0 / PUA[1]
UTXD0 / PUA[0]
ETXD[3] / PEL[7]
PORT EL
ETXD[2] / PEL[6]
ETXD[1] / PEL[5]
ETXER / PEL[4]
1. Although ports NQ, QA, QB, TA, and TB are not part of the ports module, they are included here for comprehensiveness.
Figure 26-2. MCF5280, MCF5281, and MCF5282 Ports Module Block Diagram
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
26-3
General Purpose I/O Module
26.1.1
Overview
The ports module controls the configuration for various external pins, including those used for:
• External bus accesses
• Chip selects
• Debug data
• Processor status
• Ethernet data and control (not present on the MCF5214 and MCF5216)
• FlexCAN transmit/receive data
• I2C serial control
• QSPI
• SDRAM control
• 32-bit DMA timers
• UART transmit/receive
26.1.2
Features
The ports includes these distinctive features:
• Control of primary function use on all ports
• Digital I/O support for all ports
— Registers for storing output pin data
— Registers for controlling pin data direction
— Registers for reading current pin state
— Registers for setting and clearing output pin data registers
26.1.3
Modes of Operation
The operational modes for the ports are listed below. For more detailed descriptions of each mode, refer
to Section 26.4, “Functional Description.”
• Single-chip mode
All pins are configured as digital I/O by default, except for debug data pins (DDATA[3:0]) and
processor status pins (PST[3:0]).
• Master mode
Ports A and B function as the upper external data bus. Ports C and D can function as the lower
external data bus. Ports E–J are configured to support external memory.
26.2
External Signal Description
The ports control the functionality of several external pins. These pins are listed in Table 26-1.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
26-4
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose I/O Module
Table 26-1. Ports External Signals
Primary
Function
(Pin Name)1
GPIO
Alternate Alternate
(Default
Function 1 Function 2
Function)
Description
D[31:0]2
PA, PB,
PC, PD
—
—
External data bus / Ports A, B, C, D
OE1
PE[7]
—
—
Output enable for external reads / Port E[7]
TA1
PE[6]
—
—
Transfer acknowledge for external data transfer / Port E[6]
TEA1
PE[5]
—
—
Transfer error acknowledge for external data transfer / Port E[5]
R/W1
PE[4]
—
—
Read/Write indication for external data transfer / Port E[4]
SIZ11
PE[3]
SYNCA
—
Size of the external data transfer / Port E[3] / Timer A sync
SIZ01
PE[2]
SYNCB
—
Size of the external data transfer / Port E[3:2] / Timer B sync
TS1
PE[1]
SYNCA
—
Transfer start indication for external data transfer / Port E[1] /
Timer A sync
TIP1
PE[0]
SYNCB
—
Transfer in progress indication for external data transfer / Port
E[0] / Timer B sync
A[23:21]1
PF[7:5]
CS[6:4]
—
External address bus [23:21] / Port F[7:5] / Chip selects 6–4
A[20:0]1
PF[4:0],
PG, PH
—
—
External address bus [20:0] / Ports F[4:0], G, H
BS[3:0]1
PJ[7:4]
—
—
Byte strobes for external data transfer / Port J[7:4] / SDRAM
column address strobes
CS[3:0]1
PJ[3:0]
—
—
Chip selects 3 - 0 / Port J[3:0]
DDATA[3:0]
PDD[7:4]
—
—
Debug data / Port DD[7:4]
PST[3:0]
PDD[7:4]
—
—
Processor status / Port DD[3:0]
CANRX
PAS[3]
URXD2
—
FlexCAN receive data / Port AS[3] / URXD2
CANTX
PAS[2]
UTXD2
—
FlexCAN transmit data / Port AS[2] / UTXD2
SDA
PAS[1]
URXD2
—
I2C serial data / Port AS[1] / URXD2
SCL
PAS[0]
UTXD2
—
I2C serial clock / Port AS[0] / UTXD2
IRQ[7:1]3
PNQ[7:1]
—
—
Edge Port external interrupt pins / Port NQ[7:1]
AN[56:55:53:52]
PQA
[4:3:1:0]
ETRIG[2:1],
MA[1:0]
—
2
QADC analog inputs / Port QA[4:3:1:0] / external triggers /
external multiplex control
AN[3:0] 2
PQB[3:0]
ANZ, ANY,
ANX, ANW
—
QADC analog inputs / Port QB[3:0] / multiplexed analog inputs
QSPI_CS
[3:0]
PQS[6:3]
—
—
QSPI synchronous peripheral chip selects / Port QS[3:6]
QSPI_CLK
PQS[2]
—
—
QSPI serial clock / Port QS[2]
QSPI_DIN
PQS[1]
—
—
QSPI serial data input / Port QS[1]
QSPI_DOUT
PQS[0]
—
—
QSPI serial data output / Port QS[0]
SRAS
PSD[5]
—
—
SDRAM synchronous row address strobe / Port SD[5]
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
26-5
General Purpose I/O Module
Table 26-1. Ports External Signals (continued)
Primary
Function
(Pin Name)1
GPIO
Alternate Alternate
(Default
Function 1 Function 2
Function)
SCAS
PSD[4]
DRAMW
PSD[3]
SDRAM_CS[1:0]
Description
—
SDRAM synchronous column address strobe / Port SD[4]
—
—
SDRAM write enable / Port SD[3]
PSD[2:1]
—
—
SDRAM row address strobes 1, 0 / Port SD[2:1]
SCKE
PSD[0]
—
—
SDRAM clock enable / Port SD[0]
GPTA[3:0] 2
PTA[3:0]
—
—
General purpose timer A input/output / Port TA[3:0]
GPTB[3:0] 2
PTB[3:0]
—
—
General purpose timer B input/output / Port TB[3:0]
DTIN3
PTC[3]
URTS1
URTS0
DMA timer 3 input / Port TC[3] / UART1 request to send / UART0
request to send
DTOUT3
PTC[2]
URTS1
URTS0
DMA timer 3 output / Port TC[2] / UART1 request to send /
UART0 request to send
DTIN2
PTC[1]
UCTS1
UCTS0
DMA timer 2 input / Port TC[1] / UART1 clear to send / UART0
clear to send
DTOUT2
PTC[0]
UCTS1
UCTS0
DMA timer 2 output / Port TC[0] / UART1 clear to send / UART0
clear to send
DTIN1
PTD[3]
URTS1
URTS0
DMA timer 1 input / Port TD[3] / UART1 request to send / UART0
request to send
DTOUT1
PTD[2]
URTS1
URTS0
DMA timer 1 output / Port TD[2] / UART1 request to send /
UART0 request to send
DTIN0
PTD[1]
UCTS1
UCTS0
DMA timer 0 input / Port TD[1] / UART1 clear to send / UART0
clear to send
DTOUT0
PTD[0]
UCTS1
UCTS0
DMA timer 0 output / Port TD[0] / UART1 clear to send / UART0
clear to send
URXD1
PUA[3]
—
—
UART1 receive serial data / Port UA[3]
UTXD1
PUA[2]
—
—
UART1 transmit serial data / Port UA[2]
URXD0
PUA[1]
—
—
UART0 receive serial data / Port UA[1]
UTXD0
PUA[0]
—
—
UART0 transmit serial data / Port UA[0]
The following signals apply to the MCF5280, MCF5281, and MCF5282
ETXCLK
PEH[7]
—
—
Ethernet transmit clock / PEH[7]
ETXEN
PEH[6]
—
—
Ethernet transmit enable / PEH[6]
ETXD[0]
PEH[5]
—
—
Ethernet transmit data [0] / PEH[5]
ECOL
PEH[4]
—
—
Ethernet collision / PEH[4]
ERXCLK
PEH[3]
—
—
Ethernet receive clock / PEH[3]
ERXDV
PEH[2]
—
—
Ethernet receive data valid / PEH[2]
ERXD[0]
PEH[1]
—
—
Ethernet receive data [0] / PEH[1]
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
26-6
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose I/O Module
Table 26-1. Ports External Signals (continued)
Primary
Function
(Pin Name)1
GPIO
Alternate Alternate
(Default
Function 1 Function 2
Function)
Description
ECRS
PEH[0]
—
—
Ethernet carrier receive sense / PEH[0]
ETXD[3:1]
PEL[7:5]
—
—
Ethernet transmit data / Port EL[7:5]
ETXER
PEL[4]
—
—
Ethernet transmit error / Port EL[4]
ERXD[3:1]
PEL[3:1]
—
—
Ethernet receive data [3:1] / Port EL[3:1]
ERXER
PEL[0]
—
—
Ethernet receive error / Port EL[0]
EMDIO
PAS[5]
URXD2
—
Ethernet management data control / Port AS[5] / URXD2
EMDC
PAS[4]
UTXD2
—
Ethernet management data clock / Port AS[4] / UTXD2
The following signals apply to MCF5214 and MCF5216 only
PEL[0]
—
—
—
Port EL[0]
PAS[4]
UTXD[2]
—
—
Port AS[4] / UTXD2
PEL[7:5]
—
—
—
Port EL[7:5]
PEL[4]
—
—
—
Port EL[4]
PEL[3:1]
—
—
—
Port EL[3:1]
PAS[5]
URXD2
—
—
Port AS[5] / URXD2
1
The primary functionality of a pin is not necessarily the default function of the pin after reset. Pins that have muxed GPIO
functionality will default to GPIO inputs.
2 Function available in master mode only
3 Pins not actually part of Port Module, but included here for complete listing of available I/O ports. See separate section for
description of this port.
Refer to Chapter 14, “Signal Descriptions” for more detailed descriptions of these pins. The function of
the pins (primary function, GPIO, etc.) is determined by the various ports registers and the mode of
operation. Refer to Table 14-1 for detailed descriptions of pin functions.
26.3
26.3.1
Memory Map/Register Definition
Register Overview
Table 26-2 summarizes all the registers in the ports address space.
Table 26-2. Ports Module Memory Map
IPSBAR +
Offset
31–24
23–16
15–8
7–0
Access1
Port Output Data Registers
0x10_0000
PORTA
PORTB
PORTC
PORTD
S/U
0x10_0004
PORTE
PORTF
PORTG
PORTH
S/U
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
26-7
General Purpose I/O Module
Table 26-2. Ports Module Memory Map (continued)
IPSBAR +
Offset
31–24
23–16
15–8
7–0
Access1
0x10_0008
PORTJ
PORTDD
PORTEH
(Reserved on MCF521x)
PORTEL
S/U
0x10_000C
PORTAS
PORTQS
PORTSD
PORTTC
S/U
0x10_0010
PORTTD
PORTUA
Reserved2
S/U
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
26-8
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose I/O Module
Table 26-2. Ports Module Memory Map (continued)
IPSBAR +
Offset
31–24
23–16
15–8
7–0
Access1
Port Data Direction Registers
0x10_0014
DDRA
DDRB
DDRC
DDRD
S/U
0x10_0018
DDRE
DDRF
DDRG
DDRH
S/U
0x10_001C
DDRJ
DDRDD
DDREH
(Reserved on MCF521x)
DDREL
S/U
0x10_0020
DDRAS
DDRQS
DDRSD
DDRTC
S/U
0x10_0024
DDRTD
Reserved2
DDRUA
S/U
Port Pin Data/Set Data Registers
0x10_0028
PORTAP/SETA
PORTBP/SETB
PORTCP/SETC
PORTDP/SETD
S/U
0x10_002C
PORTEP/SETE
PORTFP/SETF
PORTGP/SETG
PORTHP/SETH
S/U
0x10_0030
PORTJP/SETJ
PORTDDP/SETDD
PORTEHP/SETEH
(Reserved on MCF521x)
PORTELP/SETEL
S/U
0x10_0034
PORTASP/SETAS
PORTQSP/SETQS
PORTSDP/SETSD
PORTTCP/SETTC
S/U
2
S/U
0x10_0038
PORTTDP/SETTD
PORTUAP/SETUA
Reserved
Port Clear Output Data Registers
0x10_003C
CLRA
CLRB
CLRC
CLRD
S/U
0x10_0040
CLRE
CLRF
CLRG
CLRH
S/U
0x10_0044
CLRJ
CLRDD
CLREH
(Reserved on MCF521x)
CLREL
S/U
0x10_0048
CLRAS
CLRQS
CLRSD
CLRTC
S/U
0x10_004C
CLRTD
CLRUA
Reserved2
S/U
Port Pin Assignment Registers
0x10_0050
PBCDPAR
PFPAR
PEPAR
S/U
0x10_0054
PJPAR
PSDPAR
PASPAR
S/U
0x10_0058
PEHLPAR
PQSPAR
0x10_005C
PUAPAR
0x10_0060
–
0x10_007C
PTCPAR
Reserved2
PTDPAR
S/U
S/U
Reserved2
1
S/U = supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to supervisor-only addresses have no effect and cause a cycle
termination transfer error.
2 Writing to reserved address locations has no effect and reading returns 0s.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
26-9
General Purpose I/O Module
26.3.2
26.3.2.1
Register Descriptions
Port Output Data Registers (PORTn)
The PORTn registers store the data to be driven on the corresponding port n pins when the pins are
configured for digital output.
Most PORTn registers have a full 8-bit implementation, as shown in Figure 26-3. The remaining PORTn
registers use fewer than eight bits. Their bit definitions are shown in Figure 26-4, Figure 26-5, and
Figure 26-6.
At reset, all bits in the PORTn registers are set.
Reading a PORTn register returns the current values in the register, not the port n pin values.
PORTn bits can be set by setting the PORTn register, or by setting the corresponding bits in the
PORTnP/SETn register. They can be cleared by clearing the PORTn register, or by clearing the
corresponding bits in the CLRn register.
Field
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PORTn7
PORTn6
PORTn5
PORTn4
PORTn3
PORTn2
PORTn1
PORTn0
Reset
1111_1111
R/W:
R/W
Address IPSBAR + 0x10_0000 (PORTA), 0x10_0001 (PORTB), 0x10_0002 (PORTC), 0x10_0003 (PORTD),
0x10_0004 (PORTE), 0x10_0005 (PORTF), 0x10_0006 (PORTG), 0x10_0007 (PORTH),
0x10_0008 (PORTJ), 0x10_0009 (PORTDD), 0x10_000A (PORTEH), 0x10_000B (PORTEL)
Figure 26-3. Port Output Data Registers (8-bit)
Field
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
PORTn6
PORTn5
PORTn4
PORTn3
PORTn2
PORTn1
PORTn0
Reset
R/W:
0011_1111
R
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x10_000D (PORTQS)
Figure 26-4. Port Output Data Register (7-bit)
7
Field
6
—
Reset
R/W:
Address
5
4
3
2
1
0
PORTn5
PORTn4
PORTn3
PORTn2
PORTn1
PORTn0
0011_1111
R
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x10_000C (PORTAS), 0x10_000E (PORTSD)
Figure 26-5. Port Output Data Registers (6-bit)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
26-10
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose I/O Module
7
4
Field
—
Reset
3
2
1
0
PORTn3
PORTn2
PORTn1
PORTn0
0000_1111
R/W:
R
Address
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x10_000F (PORTTC), 0x10_0010 (PORTTD), 0x10_0011 (PORTUA)
Figure 26-6. Port Output Data Registers (4-bit)
PORTn bits are described in Table 26-3.
Table 26-3. PORTn (8-bit, 7-bit, 6-bit, and 4-bit) Field Descriptions
26.3.2.2
Register
Bits
Name
Description
8-bit
7–0
PORTnx
7-bit
6–0
6-bit
5–0
4-bit
3–0
7-bit
7
6-bit
7–6
4-bit
7–4
Port output data bits.
1 Drives 1 when the port n pin is a digital output
0 Drives 0 when the port n pin is a digital output
—
Reserved, should be cleared.
Port Data Direction Registers (DDRn)
The DDRs control the direction of the port n pin drivers when the pins are configured for digital I/O.
Most DDRs have a full 8-bit implementation, as shown in Figure 26-7. The remaining DDRs use fewer
than eight bits. Their bit definitions are shown in Figure 26-8, Figure 26-9, and Figure 26-10.
The DDRs are read/write. At reset, all bits in the DDRs are cleared.
Setting any bit in a DDRn register configures the corresponding port n pin as an output. Clearing any bit
in a DDRn register configures the corresponding pin as an input.
Field
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DDRn7
DDRn6
DDRn5
DDRn4
DDRn3
DDRn2
DDRn1
DDRn0
Reset
0000_0000
R/W:
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x10_0014 (DDRA), 0x10_0015 (DDRB), 0x10_0016 (DDRC), 0x10_0017 (DDRD),
0x10_0018 (DDRE), 0x10_0019 (DDRF), 0x10_001A (DDRG), 0x10_001B (DDRH),
0x10_001C (DDRJ), 0x10_001D (DDRDD), 0x10_001E (DDREH), 0x10_001F (DDREL)
Figure 26-7. Port Data Direction Registers (8-bit)
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
Freescale Semiconductor
26-11
General Purpose I/O Module
Field
7
6
—
DDRn6
0
DDRn5
DDRn4
Reset
R/W:
DDRn3
DDRn2
DDRn1
DDRn0
0000_0000
R
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x10_0021(DDRQS)
Figure 26-8. Port Data Direction Register (7-bit)
7
Field
6
—
5
4
3
2
1
0
DDRn5
DDRn4
DDRn3
DDRn2
DDRn1
DDRn0
Reset
0000_0000
R/W:
R
R/W
Address
IPSBAR + 0x10_0020 (DDRAS), 0x10_0022 (DDRSD)
Figure 26-9. Port Data Direction Registers (6-bit)
7
4
Field
—
Reset
2
1
0
DDRn3
DDRn2
DDRn1
DDRn0
0000_0000
R/W:
Address
3
R
R/W
IPSBAR + 0x10_0023 (DDRTC), 0x10_0024 (DDRTD), 0x10_0025 (DDRUA)
Figure 26-10. Port Data Direction Registers (4-bit)
Table 26-4. DDRn (8-bit, 6-bit, and 4-bit) Field Descriptions
Register
Bits
Name
8-bit
7–0
DDRnx
7-bit
6–0
6-bit
5–0
4-bit
3–0
7-bit
7
6-bit
7–6
4-bit
7–4
—
Description
Port n data direction bits.
1 Port n pin configured as an output
0 Port n pin configured as an input
Reserved, should be cleared.
MCF5282 and MCF5216 ColdFire Microcontroller User’s Manual, Rev. 3
26-12
Freescale Semiconductor
General Purpose I/O Module
26.3.2.3
Port Pin Data/Set Data Registers (PORTnP/SETn)
The PORTnP/SETn registers reflect the current pin states and control the setting of output pins when the
pin is configured for digital I/O.
Most PORTn registers have a full 8-bit implementat
Similar pages